Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
WIT Press publishes leading books in Science and Technology. Visit our website for new and current list of titles. www.witpress.com
WITeLibrary Home of the Transactions of the Wessex Institute. Papers presented at Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII are archived in the WIT eLibrary in volume 46 of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation (ISSN 1743-355X). The WIT eLibrary provides the international scientific community with immediate and permanent access to individual papers presented at WIT conferences. Visit the WIT eLibrary at www.witpress.com.
THIRTEENTH INTERNATIONAL CONFERENCE ON COMPUTATIONAL METHODS AND EXPERIMENTAL MEASUREMENTS
CMEM XIII CONFERENCE CHAIRMEN C.A. Brebbia Wessex Institute of Technology, UK G. M. Carlomagno University of Naples Federico II, Italy
INTERNATIONAL SCIENTIFIC ADVISORY COMMITTEE M. Attard Z. Bielecki R. Cerny J. Everett L. Fryba C. Golia W. Graf S. Hernandez
C. Karayannis R. Khanbilvardi G. Lorenzini O. Manca R.A. Pitarma P. Prochazka H. Sakamoto
F. Seiler P. Stehlik K. Takayama M. Trajkovic M. Tsutahara F. Viadero Rueda M. Wnuk
Organised by Wessex Institute of Technology, UK,and University of Naples Federico II, Italy Sponsored by WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation Transactions Editor Carlos Brebbia Wessex Institute of Technology Ashurst Lodge, Ashurst Southampton SO40 7AA, UK Email:
[email protected]
Editorial Board C Alessandri Universita di Ferrara Italy J Baish Bucknell University USA D E Beskos University of Patras Greece J A Bryant University of Exeter UK M A Celia Princeton University USA J J Connor Massachusetts Institute of Technology USA D F Cutler Royal Botanic Gardens UK G De Mey Ghent State University Belgium Q H Du Tsinghua University China A El-Zafrany Cranfield University UK S Finger Carnegie Mellon University USA M J Fritzler University of Calgary Canada G S Gipson Oklahoma State University USA
M A Atherton South Bank University UK C D Bertram The University of New South Wales Australia M Bonnet Ecole Polytechnique France M B Bush The University of Western Australia Australia A H-D Cheng University of Mississippi USA D E Cormack University of Toronto Canada E R de Arantes e Oliveira Insituto Superior Tecnico Portugal J Dominguez University of Seville Spain S Elghobashi University of California Irvine USA P Fedelinski Silesian Technical University Poland J I Frankel University of Tennessee USA L Gaul Universitat Stuttgart Germany S Grilli University of Rhode Island USA
K Hayami National Institute of Informatics Japan D B Ingham The University of Leeds UK D L Karabalis University of Patras Greece H Lui State Seismological Bureau Harbin China R A Meric Research Institute for Basic Sciences Turkey K Onishi Ibaraki University Japan M Predeleanu University Paris VI France S Rinaldi Politecnico di Milano Italy G Schmid Ruhr-Universitat Bochum Germany X Shixiong Fudan University China V Sladek Slovak Academy of Sciences Slovakia J Stasiek Technical University of Gdansk Poland M Tanaka Shinshu University Japan T Tran-Cong University of Southern Queensland Australia J F V Vincent The University of Bath UK Z-Y Yan Peking University China G Zharkova Institute of Theoretical and Applied Mechanics Russia
J A C Humphrey Bucknell University USA N Kamiya Nagoya University Japan J T Katsikadelis National Technical University of Athens Greece W J Mansur COPPE/UFRJ Brazil J Mikielewicz Polish Academy of Sciences Poland E L Ortiz Imperial College London UK D Qinghua Tsinghua University China T J Rudolphi Iowa State University USA A P S Selvadurai McGill University Canada P Skerget University of Maribor Slovenia T Speck Albert-Ludwigs-Universitaet Freiburg Germany S Syngellakis University of Southampton UK N Tosaka Nihon University Japan W S Venturini University of Sao Paulo Brazil J R Whiteman Brunel University UK K Yoshizato Hiroshima University Japan
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII EDITORS C.A. Brebbia Wessex Institute of Technology, UK G.M. Carlomagno University of Naples Federico II, Italy
Editors: C.A. Brebbia Wessex Institute of Technology, UK G.M. Carlomagno University of Naples Federico II, Italy Published by WIT Press Ashurst Lodge, Ashurst, Southampton, SO40 7AA, UK Tel: 44 (0) 238 029 3223; Fax: 44 (0) 238 029 2853 E-Mail:
[email protected] http://www.witpress.com For USA, Canada and Mexico Computational Mechanics Inc 25 Bridge Street, Billerica, MA 01821, USA Tel: 978 667 5841; Fax: 978 667 7582 E-Mail:
[email protected] http://www.witpress.com British Library Cataloguing-in-Publication Data A Catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library ISBN: 978-1-84564-084-2 ISSN: 1746-4064 (print) ISSN: 1743-355X (on-line) The texts of the papers in this volume were set individually by the authors or under their supervision. Only minor corrections to the text may have been carried out by the publisher. No responsibility is assumed by the Publisher, the Editors and Authors for any injury and/or damage to persons or property as a matter of products liability, negligence or otherwise, or from any use or operation of any methods, products, instructions or ideas contained in the material herein. © WIT Press 2007 Printed in Great Britain by Athenaeum Press Ltd. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of the Publisher.
Preface
This book contains most of the papers presented at the 13 th International Conference on Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements (CMEM/07) held in Prague in 2007. This series of conferences started in Washington DC at the beginning of the 1980s and has been reconvened every two years with continuous success. The primary aim of the meeting is to offer to the international scientific community an arena for the presentation and exchange of advanced approaches and applications in the fields of numerical methods and experimental determinations, with the principal attention and emphasis being devoted to their beneficial interaction and mutual influence. Recent advances in the speed and efficiency of computers, and in computational techniques, have been major factors in the growth of numerical methods that now affect not only engineering, but our everyday lives. However, even if computational codes have been increasingly successful in simulating engineering problems, there still exists a wide range of them that need a comprehensive validation that can be accomplished only by means of experimental analysis. In the meantime, experimental measurements have become so sophisticated that experiments must very often be carried out with the help of computers and the data obtained have to be processed by means of numerical methods. This volume contains a substantial number of excellent scientific papers, which have been grouped in the following sections: • Computational and experimental methods • Experimental and computational analysis • Fluid flow • Salts in porous materials • Heat transfer • Structural and stress analysis • Experiments and analysis of reinforced concrete members • Structural dynamics • Dynamics and vibrations • Detection and signal • Advances in measurements and experiments • Industrial applications
The Editors are grateful to all the authors for their valuable contributions and to the Members of the International Scientific Advisory Committee, as well as other colleagues, for their help in reviewing the papers published in this book and are most especially indebted to Prof. R. Èerný, C. G. Karayannis and Z. Bielecki who organised special sessions within the conference. The Editors Prague, 2007
Contents Section 1: Computational and experimental methods Direct simulations of fluid dynamic sounds by the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method M. Tsutahara, A. Tamura, S. Tajiri & W. Long ....................................................3 Spectral analysis of a transitional separated-reattached flow using Fourier and wavelet transforms I. E. Abdalla & M. J. Cook..................................................................................13 Observation of solid fuel in a supersonic flowfield J. M. Char & U. K. Hsu ......................................................................................25 Temperature field at the twin-roll casting of aluminium alloys: computational model and measurements H. Gjerkeš, S. Hartman, R. Vertnik & B. Šarler .................................................35 A newly developed test rig for the study of thermal fatigue M. Fazarinc, R. Turk, G. Kugler & M. Terčelj ...................................................45 Numerical simulation with flow feature extraction of a propeller turbine unsteady rotor-stator interaction J.-M. Gagnon & C. Deschênes............................................................................55 Computer and experimental study of the gate dielectric in a memory transistor R. Avichail-Bibi, D. Fuks, A. Kiv & Ya. Roizin...................................................65 Electron band structure and properties of disordered semiconductor compound alloys D. Alexandrov, K. S. A. Butcher & T. L. Tansley................................................75
Fast calculation of the dimensioning factors of the railway power supply system L. Abrahamsson & L. Söder................................................................................85 A formulation of a multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element K. Kazakov ..........................................................................................................97 Section 2: Experimental and computational analysis Influence of the collision speed and angle of a bullet: experimental reconstruction of bullet configuration and FE-analysis H. Sakamoto, T. Hiwatashi, T. Yamaguchi & M. Yamamoto............................109 Influence of the cross-section shape on the lateral torsional buckling capacity D. Djurić-Mijović & M. Trajković ....................................................................117 Computational fluid dynamic modelling and simulation evaluation of the plume evacuation device efficiencies F. Farshad, H. Rieke, L. C. LaHaye & S. C. Nulu............................................127 Flow estimations through spillways under submerged tidal conditions P. D. Scarlatos, M. Ansar & Z. Chen................................................................137 Analysis of the wave-flow interaction with submerged breakwaters A. C. Neves, F. Veloso Gomes & F. Taveira Pinto ...........................................147 An application of an edge effect based vacuum blower to a lyophilizer M. Kitamura, M. Tsutahara & H. Sasaki..........................................................155 The wavelength reconstruction from toroidal spectrometer image data J. Blazej, M. Tamas, L. Pina, A. Jancarek, S. Palinek, P. Vrba & M. Vrbova .....................................................................................................165 Numerical noise in satellite laser ranging data processing J. Blazej & I. Prochazka ...................................................................................171 Expanding the definition of multivariate correlation W. Conley ..........................................................................................................177
3D analysis of solid reinforced concrete beams subjected to combined load of bending, torsion and shear A. S. Alnuaimi....................................................................................................185 Use of correlation of iron loss and copper loss for improving the efficiency of three phase squirrel cage induction motors B. B. Saanane, A. H. Nzali & D. J. Chambega .................................................195 Effect of Zr addition on the fatigue strength of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloy M. Goto, S.-Z. Han, C.-J. Kim & N. Kawagoishi..............................................205 An analysis of superplastic free forming at constant pressure G. Giuliano & S. Franchitti ..............................................................................215 A mathematical model approach to a glycerolysis reaction for monoacylglycerol production B. Cheirsilp & A. H-Kittikul..............................................................................225 Evaluation of experimental procedures for confined concrete columns using 3D finite element analyses H. O. Köksal, C. Karakoç, Z. Polat, T. Turgay & Ş. Akgün .............................233 Geometrically nonlinear static analysis of 3D trusses using the arc-length method G. A. Hrinda......................................................................................................243 Section 3: Fluid flow On the accuracy of integral representation of differential operators in Lagrangian blob mesh-less methods C. Golia & B. Buonomo ....................................................................................255 Construction of a non-Newtonian fluid model based on the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method S. Tajiri & M. Tsutahara...................................................................................267 Experimental measurements for the control of a vortex shaft theoretical model G. Ciaravino, L. Ciaravino & G. Pulci Doria ..................................................277 Stability of stratified spin-up flows S. A. Smirnov .....................................................................................................287
On the relation between geometric and flow properties of a miniaturized fluid oscillator J. O. Sotero-Esteva, R. Furlan & J. J. Santiago-Avilés ....................................297 On-stream floodplain storage: experimental research G. De Martino, F. De Paola, G. Marini & A. Ranucci.....................................307 Analytical and hydraulic model study of highway culvert sand-blockages M. Kamaka, E. Cheng, M. Teng & C. Matsuda ................................................319 Incorporating computational fluid dynamics in the design/build of a single family residence J. Chang & N. Rosemann..................................................................................329 Section 4: Salts in porous materials (Special session organised by Professor R. Černý) Mathematical modeling of water and salt transport in porous materials R. Černý ............................................................................................................339 Determination of water and salt transport parameters of porous materials using methods of inverse modelling L. Fiala, Z. Pavlík, M. Pavlíková & R. Černý...................................................349 Effect of metakaolin on chloride binding in lime-based composites R. Pernicová, M. Pavlíková & R. Černý ...........................................................357 Computational simulation of the effect of crystallization inhibitors on salt transport and crystallization in porous materials J. Kelnar, J. Maděra & R. Černý ......................................................................367 Desalination of historical masonry using hydrophilic mineral wool boards P. Michálek, V. Tydlitát, M. Jerman & R. Černý..............................................377 Section 5: Heat transfer Numerical investigation on natural convection in asymmetric channel-chimney systems A. Andreozzi, B. Buonomo & O. Manca ...........................................................389
Plate distance effect on mixed convection in horizontal channels heated from below G. Foglia, O. Manca & S. Nardini....................................................................399 Numerical analysis of mixed convection in air in an inclined channel with a moving plate A. Andreozzi, N. Bianco, G. Lacasa & V. Naso ................................................411 A numerical method for studying impulsively generated convection from heated tubes S. J. D. D'Alessio...............................................................................................425 Heat transfer in a ribbed square duct by Large-Eddy-Simulation O. Labbé............................................................................................................437 Effect of thermal boundary conditions on conjugate natural convection flow in vertical eccentric annuli A. Jamal, M. A. I. El-Shaarawi & E. M. A. Mokheimer....................................447 Foam flow turn influence on the in-line tube bundle heat transfer intensity J. Gylys, S. Sinkunas, T. Zdankus, V. Giedraitis & A. Balcius .........................457 Importance of experimental measurements and simulations for “sludge-to-energy” systems L. Houdkova, J. Boran, T. Elsäßer & P. Stehlik ...............................................465 Simulation of thermal barrier coating behaviour during dynamic thermal loading by the Exodus method J. Sroub, M. Honner & Z. Vesely ......................................................................475 Forced convection in a variable section axisymmetric channel with different porous layers and heat generation E. Pilevne & A. Misirlioglu...............................................................................485 Comparison of h-, p- and hp-adaptation for convective heat transfer D. W. Pepper & X. Wang ..................................................................................495 Modified spherical harmonics method for one-speed transport equation with anisotropic scattering M. S. Li & B. Yang ............................................................................................505
Section 6: Structural and stress analysis Inverse variational principle based coupled modeling of underground structures P. Procházka .....................................................................................................517 Elastic-plastic simulation of plate with a blunt slit subjected to uni-axial tension S. Ohtaki, S. Kobayashi & T. Yamamoto ..........................................................527 A simplified shear strength evaluation model for reinforced concrete corbels J. K. Lu, S. Y. Kuo, J. Y. Lin & S. H. Hsu .........................................................537 Post-buckling behaviour of a slender beam in a circular tube, under axial load M. Gh. Munteanu & A. Barraco .......................................................................547 Structural properties of a new material made of waste paper J. Santamaria, B. Fuller & A. Fafitis................................................................557 Non-Hertzian rolling contact stress analysis C. H. Liu & W.-E. Hsu ......................................................................................569 The areolar strain concept applied to elasticity I. D. Kotchergenko ............................................................................................579 Methodology for the manufacture of smart composites with thermoplastic matrix L. Elsoufi, K. Khalil, R. Lachat, W. Charon & M. Zoaeter...............................589 Experimental investigation on the folding of axially crushed hexagonal tubes M. R. Said, A. A. Mokhtar, A. Alias & A. Ibrahim ............................................601 Application of the shakedown analysis in the elastic: plastic assessment of cracked plates M. A. Belouchrani .............................................................................................611 Section 7: Experiments and analysis of reinforced concrete members (Special session organised by Professor C. G. Karayannis) Cyclic testing of reinforced concrete beam-column joints with crossed inclined bars C. E. Chalioris, C. G. Karayannis & M. I. Favvata .........................................623
Tests and analysis of reinforced concrete beams under torsion retrofitted with FRP strips C. E. Chalioris ..................................................................................................633 Influence of masonry strength and rectangular spiral shear reinforcement on infilled RC frames under cyclic loading D. J. Kakaletsis .................................................................................................643 Application of the Cement Hydration Equation in self-compacting concrete’s compressive strength N. Anagnostopoulos, A. Gergiadis & K. K. Sideris ..........................................655 Section 8: Structural dynamics Response of a double system beam and string with an elastic layer to the dynamic excitations L. Frýba, C. Fischer & Sh. Urushadze .............................................................671 Excessive accelerations in bridges for Korea high-speed railway J. W. Kwark, J. R. Cho, W. J. Chin, B. S. Kim & E. K. Cho .............................681 Parameter identification for multiple modes of cable-stayed bridge cables using ambient vibration measurements from a single station W.-H. Wu, C.-A. Liao & C.-C. Chen ........................................................ 691 Experimental evaluation of dynamic properties of an incrementally prestressed concrete girder railway bridge S. I. Kim, I. H. Yeo, N. S. Kim, J. W. Kwark & J. S. Lee...................................701 Section 9: Dynamics and vibrations A model of spur gears supported by ball bearings F. Viadero, A. Fernandez del Rincon, R. Sancibrian, P. Garcia Fernandez & A. de Juan...................................................................711 On a numerical model of a complete washing machine T. Argentini, M. Belloli, N. Gaudiano, G. Fraternale, F. Panetta, D. Sabato & M. Vanali......................................................................................723
Section 10: Detection and signal processing (Special session organised by Professor Z. Bielecki) EUV detection system with calibrated responsivity J. Mikolajczyk & Z. Bielecki .............................................................................737 Analysis of radiating structures placed on multilayer dielectric M. Wnuk & M. Bugaj ........................................................................................747 Method of signal processing in passive infrared detectors for security systems H. Madura .........................................................................................................757 Influence of the displacement effect on compressed LFM signal parameters A. Kawalec, Cz. Leśnik, W. Komorniczak, W. Czarnecki & J. Pietrasiński................................................................................................769 A comparison of estimation accuracy by the use of KF, EKF & UKF filters S. Konatowski & A. T. Pieniężny.......................................................................779 Novel method for watermarking system operating on the HF and VHF radio links Z. Piotrowski & P. Gajewski.............................................................................791 Optoelectronic system for phase array antenna beam steering E. Sędek, Z. Bielecki, M. Muszkowski, W. Kołosowski, G. Różański & M. Wnuk....................................................................................801 Nitrogen dioxide detection using an optoelectronic sensor Z. Bielecki, W. Kołosowski, G. Różański, E. Sędek & J. Wojtas.......................809 Automatic processing analysis of infrared images for monitoring pantograph catenary interactions A. Balestrino, O. Bruno, A. Landi & L. Sani.....................................................819 Architectural hot-swap in NURBS surfaces: versioning of case studies, work in progress A. Prichard-Schmitzberger ...............................................................................829
Section 11: Advances in measurements and experiments Development of advanced instrumentation for operational oceanography G. Zappalà ........................................................................................................841 In-situ measurement of formwork pressures generated by Self-Compacting Concrete M. M. Giammatteo, A. Gregori & G. Totani.....................................................851 Evaluation of phenolic resins from one-pot microwave synthesis A. Britten, M. M. MacIntyre & A. Miadonye ....................................................861 Modern techniques of measure and control of deformations – an experimental test: Senerchia landslide M. Caprioli & G. Strisciuglio ...........................................................................871 Section 12: Industrial applications Calculating the dilution between successive trainloads of iron ore during processing J. E. Everett .......................................................................................................883 Rock bumps due to the creation of a dislocation during deep mining V. Doležel & P. Procházka ...............................................................................893 Author Index ...................................................................................................903
This page intentionally left blank
Section 1 Computational and experimental methods
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Direct simulations of fluid dynamic sounds by the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method M. Tsutahara, A. Tamura, S. Tajiri & W. Long Graduate School of Science and Technology, Kobe University, Rokko, Nada, Kobe, Japan
Abstract In this paper we present some applications of the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method (FDLBM) to direct simulations of fluid dynamic sound. The Arbitrary Lagrangian Eulerian formulation is introduced to FDLBM and the sounds emitted from moving bodies are successfully simulated. The two-particle model is used to simulate two-phase flows, and introducing a fluid elasticity the sound propagation inside the liquid is simulated. The sounds generated on the interface between the liquid and gas are also successfully simulated. Keywords: fluid dynamic sound, lattice Boltzmann method, Arbitrary Lagrangian Eulerian formulation, two-phase flow, under water sound.
1
Introduction
The lattice Boltzmann method [1–6] is now a very powerful tool of computational fluid dynamics (CFD). This method is different from ordinary Navier-Stokes equations based CFD methods, and is based on the particle motions. However, mostly successful model so far is for incompressible fluids, but several models for thermal compressible models have been proposed including our model [7–13]. On the other hand, this method has great advantage to simulate multi-phase flows, because the interface is automatically determined in this method without special treatment [14–17]. We use a compressible fluid model of LBM and perform direct simulations of aerodynamic sound emitted from moving bodies using the arbitrary Lagrangian Eulerian formulation, especially the sound sources are detected. We also propose a new model for liquids considering the elasticity of liquid, and the sound speed propagating inside the liquid is correctly realized. A simulation of a water drop colliding the water surface and sound emission is performed. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070011
4 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
Discrete BGK equation
In this paper, we apply the discrete BGK equation as a governing equation of the FDLBM. The discrete BGK equation represents evolution of a velocity distribution function of particles fi (x, t ) as ∂fi ( x, t )
∂fi ( x, t )
1 (1) { f ( x, t ) − fi (0) ( x, t )} τ i where t and x indicate the time and the space, respectively. Subscript i and α denote directions of particles' motion and the space directions in Cartesian coordinates, and ciα represents a particle velocity. τ is called a relaxation time and fi (0) (x, t ) is the equilibrium distribution function, that is determined so as to ∂t
+ ciα
∂xα
=−
recover the corresponding fluid dynamic equations. The details are shown later. The right hand side is a collision term, and represents that a particle distribution approaches an equilibrium state by the collisions among particles. We introduce a particle model into equation (1) in order to determine the particle velocity and the equilibrium distribution function. In this paper, we apply the D2Q21 model for two-dimensional flows and the D3Q39 model for three-dimensional flows proposed by Takada and Tsutahara [9]. The particle velocity vector is shown in Tables 1 and 2. The equilibrium distribution function is given by a following polynomial of the flow velocity up to the third order.
f i ( 0 ) = F i ρ (1 − 2 Bc iα u α + 2 B 2 c i α c iβ u α u β + Bu
2
(2) 4 3 B c iα c iβ c iγ u α u β u γ ) 3 where ρ, u and e denote the density, the flow velocity and the internal energy, respectively. They are defined by the particle velocity and the distribution function as follows. (3) ρ (x, t ) = ∑ f (x, t )
− 2 B 2 c iα u α u 2 −
i
i
ρ (x, t )uα (x, t ) = ∑ f i (x, t )ciα
(4)
i
u (x, t ) 2
c2 (5) = ∑ f i (x, t ) i 2 i The coefficients Fi and B in equation (2) depend on the internal energy. They are determined to satisfy following constraints in order to recover the compressible Navier-Stokes equations. The coefficients Fi and B are presented in Tsutahara et al [13]. (6) ∑ f i (0) = ρ
ρ (x, t ) e(x, t ) +
2
i
∑
∑f
f i c iα = ρ u α (0)
(7)
i
(0) i
c iα c iβ = ρ (eδ αβ + u α u β )
i
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(8)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
∑f
i
c i2 u2 = ρ e + 2 2
c iα
c i2 u2 = ρu 2e + 2 2
( 0)
i
∑f i
Table 1:
2-7 8-13 14-19 20-31 32-39
3
(9)
(10)
Velocity set in D2Q21 model.
i 1 2-5 6-9 10-13
Velocity vector (0, 0) (1, 0), (0, 1), (-1, 0), (0,-1) (2, 0), (0, 2), (-2, 0), (0,-2) (3, 0), (0, 3), (-3, 0), (0,-3)
|c| 0 1 2 3
14-17
(1, 1), (-1, 1), (-1,-1), (1,-1)
2
18-21
(2, 2), (-2, 2), (-2,-2), (2,-2)
2 2
Table 2: i 1
( 0) i
5
Velocity set in 3D39V model.
Velocity vector (0,0,0) (1, 0, 0), (-1, 0, 0), (0, 1, 0), (0,-1, 0), (0, 0, 1), (0, 0,-1) (2, 0, 0), (-2, 0, 0), (0, 2, 0), (0,-2, 0), (0, 0, 2), (0, 0,-2) (3, 0, 0), (-3, 0, 0), (0, 3, 0), (0,-3, 0), (0, 0, 3), (0, 0,-3) (2, 2, 0), (-2, 2, 0), (-2,-2, 0), (2,-2, 0), (0, 2, 2), (0,-2, 2), (0,-2,-2), (0, 2,-2), (2, 0, 2), (-2, 0, 2), (-2, 0,-2), (2, 0,-2) (1, 1, 1), (-1, 1, 1), (-1,-1, 1), (1,-1, 1), (1, 1,-1), (-1, 1,-1), (-1,-1,-1), (1,-1,-1)
|c| 0 1 2 3
2 2 3
Arbitrary Lagrangian Eulerian (ALE) formulation
The ALE method is generally used to simulate flows around moving bodies or to calculate the problem that contains interface of multi-phase flows. In the ALE method, a flow-field is described by the Eulerian formulation, and a grid moves together with moving boundaries. In this paper, a grid deformation is not considered and the grid only translates or rotates as a solid body. Thus, we can easily present a formulation of the ALE method, where the convection velocity of the equation is replaced with the relative velocity between the convection velocity and the grid velocity. On the surface of moving boundary, a flow velocity is given by that of the moving body as the boundary condition.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
6 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII If the discrete BGK equation is regarded as a convection equation, the particle velocity corresponds to a convection velocity. Thus, the discrete BGK equation is reformulated as follows [18]. ∂fi ( x, t ) ∂t =−
1
φ
+ {ciα − Vα ( x, t )}
∂f i ( x, t ) ∂xα
−
A
φ
ciα
{
}
∂ fi ( x, t ) − f i (0) ( x, t ) ∂xα
(11)
{ f ( x, t ) − f ( x, t )} (0)
i
i
where V is the grid velocity vector. The third term of the left hand side means negative viscosity. We can set large time increment in high Reynolds number flows due to this additional term [19]. As a result, computational time becomes shorter. This term is not replaced although it includes a particle velocity, because this term represents the negative viscosity and is not a convection term. By applying the Chapman-Enskog expansion, we obtain the Navier-Stokes equations
∂ρ ∂ + {ρ (uα − Vα )} = 0 ∂t ∂xα ∂ (ρuα ) + ∂ {ρuα (u β − Vβ ) + pδ αβ } ∂t ∂x β ∂ ∂u β ∂uα + − µ ∂x β ∂xα ∂x β
(13)
∂u + λ γ δ αβ = 0 ∂xγ
+ puα ∂u β ∂uα ∂u ∂ ∂e + λuα β = 0 + − + µu β κ ′ ∂x β ∂xα ∂xα ∂xα ∂x β ∂ u2 ρ e + ∂t 2
(12)
∂ u2 + ρ (uα − Vα ) e + 2 ∂xα
(14)
where the pressure, the viscosity, the second viscosity, and the thermal diffusivity are expressed as follows p = ρ e , µ = ρ e (φ − A ) , λ = − ρ e (φ − A) = − µ , κ ' = 2ρe(φ − A) (15) The sound speed is given as
c s = 2e
(16)
3.1 Sound emitted from a rapidly rotating elliptic cylinder and the grid system
The grid system consists of a boundary fitted co-ordinate system near the elliptic cylinder which rotates with the cylinder and outside of which is a cylindrical coordinates at rest as shown in Fig.1. Between the two grid systems, we set a buffer region and variables are connected through the region.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
7
Grid for computation.
3.2 Sound pressure field and sound source
The Reynolds number, the Mach number and the aspect ratio are nondimensional parameters of this problem and they are defined as follows. Re =
L ρUL , U , Ar = Ma = l µ cs
(17)
where U is the peripheral velocity of the edge of the elliptic cylinder, L is the chord length, l is the thickness. We show the result for Ar= 10.0, Re=10000 and Ma=0.2. The number of the grid is (r×θ)=(421×301). The streamlines are shown in Fig. 2(a) and two vortices appear and rotate slowly in the same direction as the cylinder rotation. The pressure field in the vicinity of the cylinder at the same time is shown in Fig.2(b). When the edge of the cylinder passes through the vortices and goes into the potential region, the pressure on the front side of the edge rise sharply and on the other side the pressure drops and this pressure change is the sound source. The sound pressure fields when the sound is emitted are shown in Fig.3.
(a) Figure 2:
(b)
Stream-lines and pressure distributions at non-dimensional time t* = 6.24.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
8 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(a) t* = 6.24 Figure 3:
4
(b) t* = 6.40
Sound pressure field near the elliptic cylinder.
Two-phase flow model
As a two-phase, liquid and gas, model, Swift et al have presented models employing free energy and they are widely used. But it is difficult to extend these models to a real liquid and gas model. We use a two-particle model in this paper. Two particle distribution functions are defined for, say, blue and red particles, and are written as fb and f r , respectively. Macroscopic variables are defined in (3) (4) and (5) for each fluid, but the fluid velocity is common to both fluids and the internal energy for liquid is neglected. 4.1 A model for liquid
The liquid has density much larger than that of the gas and also has larger elasticity, but it is difficult to realize these properties by the LBM because the LBM model is for an ideal gas. For large elasticity model, we introduce a new definition of pressure, which has a relation with the bulk elasticity as (18) P ' = P + β ( ρb − ρb ,ref ) where ρb ,ref is the reference density defined appropriately. Then the sound speed in liquid is given as
cs =
∆P ' ∼ β ∆ρ
(19)
and this sound speed is shown to be realized properly. 4.2 Two-phase flow model with large density difference
For two-phase, liquid and gas, flow models with large density, He et al. [20] introduce a model with the density difference up to 20 or so. They introduce two distribution functions, and one is only used as an index function that is detected the position of the interface. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
9
Inamuro et al. [21] also present a model with the density difference up to 1000, but in their model the velocity field and the pressure field must be recalculated because the densities are uniformly defined in liquid and gas phases. We present novel model including the density difference. The idea is very simple, that is the effect of the density difference appears the difference of the acceleration of the fluid acted some force. Therefore, we can consider the density difference by changing the acceleration. If the density of liquid, corresponding to the blue particles, is m times larger than that of gas, corresponding the red particles, the decelerations of the gas and liquid are
µ 2 1 1 µ ( − ∇P + ∇ 2 u) + τ g ∇ u) + ρ ρ mr ρ 1 µ 1 1 µ (− ∇P '+ ∇ 2u) + τ g = −(− ∇P + ∇ 2u) + mb ρ ρ ρ ρ
a mod,r = −(− a mod,b
1
ρ
∇P +
(20) (21)
in which mr and mb are the masses of the gas and the liquid particles, respectively, and the last terms in (20) and (21) are effect of the gravitational force. 4.3 Phase separation and surface tension 4.3.1 Shang-Chen model The surface tension is defined by the gradient of blue particles, and the velocity for determining the local equilibrium distribution function is changed by the fluid velocity due to the impulse of the surface tension force [16,17] as (22) ub = u + τ × a mod,b + τ × κρ r ∇ρ b
(23) u r = u + τ × a mod,r − τ × κρ b∇ρ b where κ represent the strength of the surface tension. By substituting the above mentioned velocities to the local equilibrium distribution function, a two-phase fluid model with large density difference is obtained. 4.3.2 Latva-Kokko and Rothman model In order to separate the liquid and the gas phases, the surface tension force is commonly used as the above mentioned Shang-Chen model, but this technique gives large spurious velocities. Then we use a method proposed by Latva-Kokko and Rothman [22], in which the distribution of particles is separated on the liquid side and the gas side on the interface.
ρ L ρG f eq (0) + f iGeq (0) ) cos ϕ 2 ( iL ρ L + ρG ( ρ L + ρG ) ρG ρ ρ fiG′ = ( fiL + fiG ) + κ1 L G 2 ( fiLeq (0) + fiGeq (0) ) cos ϕ ρ L + ρG ( ρ L + ρG ) fiL′ =
ρL
( fiL + fiG ) − κ1
(24) (25)
where κ1 is a factor of particle separation on the interface, f iLeq ( 0 ) is a local equilibrium distribution function for velocity 0, and ϕ represents the angle of the interface. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
10 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The surface tension is defined as a normal force to the interface, and the force is proportional to the radius of curvature as (26) Fsα = σκnα where σ is the radius of curvature,
κ
is the surface tension, and nα is a normal
unit vector on the interface. By substituting the above mentioned velocities to the local equilibrium distribution function, a two-phase fluid model with large density difference is obtained.
Figure 4:
Phase separation model of Latova-Kokko and Rothman.
Figure 5:
Surface tension model.
4.4 Water drop colliding the water surface and generated sound
Figure 6 shows the sound generated by the collision of a 3D water drop with a water surface. Calculation parameters are as follows: the factor of particle separation κ1 =2.0, the surface tension κ = 0.004, the bulk elasticity β =16000, and the acceleration of gravity g =0.001. In (a) the shape of the drop at the collision and the shadow graph of the sound generated on the interface are shown. In (b) the shape of the splash and the its shadow graph are shown. The sound propagating in the air and also the under water sound are clearly seen.
5
Conclusions
Direct simulations of fluid dynamic sound are performed by the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method. The Arbitrary Lagrangian Eulerian formulation is WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
11
applied to the simulation of sound emitted from a rapidly rotating elliptic cylinder and the sound source is detected. A two-phase flow model with large density difference and including the elasticity of liquid is proposed and a simulation of sound generated when a water drop collides with a water surface is also performed.
(a) Figure 6:
(b)
Sound generated at the collision of a water drop with a water surface.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9]
Qian, Y.H., Succi, S. and Orszag, S.A., Recent Advances in Lattice Boltzmann Computing, Ann. Rev. of Comp. Phy. III, D. Stauffer ed. World Scientific, pp.195-242, 1995. Rothman, D.H. and Zalenski, S., Lattice-Gas Cellular Automata, Cambridge U.P., 1997. Chopard, B. and Droz, M., Cellular Automata Modeling of Physical Systems, Cambridge University Press, 1998. Chen, S. and Doolen, G.D., Lattice Boltzmann method for fluid flows, Ann. Rev. Fluid Mech., Ann. Rev. Inc. pp.329-364, 1998. Wolf-Gladrow, D.A., Lattice-Gas Cellular Automata and Lattice Boltzmann Models, Lecture Notes in Mathematics, Springer, 2000. Succi, S., The lattice Boltzmann Equation for Fluid Dynamics and Beyond, Oxford, 2001. Alexander, F.J. et al., Lattice Boltzmann thermodynamics, Phys. Rev. E, 47 R2249-R2252, 1993. Chen, Y., et al., Thermal lattice Bhatanagar Gross Knook model without nonlinear deviations in macrodynamic equations, Phys. Rev. E, 50, pp.2776-2283, 1994. Takada, N. and Tsutahara M., Proposal of Lattice BGK model with internal degrees of freedom in lattice Boltzmann method, Transaction of JSME B, 65-629, pp.92-99, 1999 (in Japanese). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
12 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18]
[19] [20]
[21] [22]
McNamara, G.R., et al., Stabilization of thermal lattice Boltzmann models, J. Stat. Phys., 81(1/2), pp. 395-408, 1995. Kataoka, T. and Tsutahara, T., Lattice Boltzmann model for the compressible Navier-Stokes equations with flexible specific-heat ratio, Phys. Rev. E, 67, pp.036306-1-4, 2004. Watari, M. and Tsutahara, T., Two-dimensional thermal model of the finite-difference lattice Boltzmann method with high spatial isotropy, Phys. Rev. E, 69, pp.035701-1-7, 2004. Tsutahara M, Takada N, Kataoka T, Lattice gas and lattice Boltzmann methods, Corona-sha, (in Japanese) 1999. Swift, M.R., Orlandini, E., Osborn, W.R., and Yeomans, J.M., Lattice Boltzmann simulations of liquid-gas and binary-fluid systems. Phys. Rev. E 54, pp.5041-5052, 1996. Swift, M.R., Osborn, W.R., and Yeomans, J.M., Lattice Boltzmann simulation of non-ideal fluids. Phys. Rev. Lett. 75, pp.830-833, 1995. Shan, X. and Chen, H., Lattice Boltzmann model for simulating flows with multiple phases and components. Phys. Rev. E 47, pp.1815-1819, 1993. Shan, X. and Chen, H. Simulation of non-ideal gases and liquid-gas phase-transitions by the lattice Boltzmann-equation. Phys. Rev. E 49, pp.2941-2948, 1994. Tamura, A., Tsutahara, M., Matsuoka. H. Direct simulation of bladevortex interaction by the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method, WESPAC 2006 CD-ROM, 2006. Tsutahara, M., Kurita, M., and Kataoka, T., Direct simulation of Aeolian tone by the finite difference Lattice Boltzmann method, Computational Fluid Dynamics 2002, pp.508-513, 2003. He X., Chen S., and Zhang R., A lattice Boltzmann Scheme for Incompressible Multiphase Flow and Its Application in Simulation of Rayleigh-Taylor Instability, J. Computational Physics 152, pp.642-663, 1999. Inamuro T., Ogata T., Tajima S. and Konishi N., A lattice Boltzmann method for incompressible two-phase flows with large density differences, J. Computational Physics 198, pp.628-644, 2004. Latva-Kokko, M. and Rothman D.H., Diffusion Properties of Gradientbased Lattice Boltzmann Models of Immiscible Fluids, Physical Review E, 71 pp. 056702 1-8, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
13
Spectral analysis of a transitional separated-reattached flow using Fourier and wavelet transforms I. E. Abdalla & M. J. Cook Institute of Energy & Sustainable Development, De Montfort University, Leicester, UK
Abstract Large-eddy simulations (LES) of transitional separating-reattaching flow over a square surface mounted obstacle (SSMO) and a forward-facing step (FFS) have been performed. The Reynolds number based on the uniform inlet velocity and the obstacle height is 4.5 × 103 . A dynamic subgrid-scale model is employed in this work. The mean LES results compare favourably with the available experimental and DNS data. This paper addresses the characteristic shedding modes associated with the separated-reattached flows on the SSMO and the FFS and sheds light on the use of the wavelet transform (WT) in extracting the content of a time history of a (velocity and/or pressure) signal compared to the traditional Fourier transform (FT). The turbulence spectra for the geometries revealed amplified frequency modes both upstream and downstream of the separation edge with those associated with the SSMO showing more clearly compared to the FFS. A frequency peak was detected at a location upstream of the separation line and immediately above the SSMO. The value of this frequency suggests that the upstream separated region is unstable via the Kelvin–Helmholtz instability and the peak can not be attributed to the flapping of the separated shear layer which is a phenomenon commonly associated with this class of flows. The WT captured events that are characterised by narrow periods (scales) and which happened over shorter times. Such events are smoothed out by the Fourier transform indicating the superiority of the WT over the FT. Keywords: large-eddy simulation, wavelet and Fourier transform, spectral analysis, transitional to turbulence.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070021
14 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1 Introduction Turbulent and transitional flows over obstruction such as the SSMO and the FFS are an important group of separated-reattached flows that occur in many industrial and environmental applications. For example, control of boundary layers, river flows, wind loads on structures, and the spread of pollutants in the vicinity of buildings. Separated-reattached flows over an obstruction is quite complicated when compared with other bluff body geometries such as the backward-facing step and the blunt leading edge plate aligned to a flow field. The complication comes as a result of an additional separation in the upstream region displayed by the obstruction leading to a closed or open bubble (Sat¨ur et al [1]). For the SSMO, there exist few studies which are focused on the very basic features of this class of flows such as the variation of the mean reattachment length with the Reynolds number (Tropea and Gackstatter [2]), the influence of the obstacle aspect ratio ( hl ) on the mean reattachment length (Bergeles and Athanassiadis [3]), the effect of varying the blockage ratio (Durst and Rastogi [4]). Little work has been published on either laminar or turbulent separated flows over the FFS flow. Recently, Sat¨ur et al [1] and Wilhelm et al [5] performed experimental and computational work respectively to study the laminar separation on a forward facing step for Reynolds numbers as low as 30. This work is mainly focused on the flow structure and the instability causing three-dimensionality of the flow downstream of the leading edge. Previous studies for separated-reattached flows have identified specific frequency modes associated with some physical phenomena of the separatedreattached flows, such as the shedding frequency, in addition to a lower one which is attributed to flapping of the shear layer (Kiya and Sasaki [6]). The main technique used by the researchers to identify these range of frequencies is through FT to a time series of the velocity and pressure field with the aid of flow visualization. Kaiser [7] suggests that the FT method is inaccurate and inefficient for time-frequency localisation. The spectra of transitional/turbulent flow usually contain a range of frequencies. For analysis where a predetermined scaling may not be appropriate because of a wide range of dominant frequencies (such as signals resulting from a transitional/turbulent flows), a method of timefrequency localization that is scale dependent, such as wavelet analysis, might be more successful. The aim of this paper is to shed light on the use of the WT as a method of extracting the content of a time series of the velocity and pressure fields obtained from a large-eddy simulation on separated-reattached flow on a SSMO and a FFS and discuss the processes responsible for the content of the spectra (shedding and interaction of the coherent structures). The WT method is not commonly used in this field and its strengths/weaknesses are not well known when applied to data from unsteady turbulent flows. The objectives are: (i) to identify the amplified
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
15
frequencies associated with the SSMO and FFS, and (ii) to compare the spectra details using the FT and WT and highlight the strengths and weaknesses of the two methods.
2 Details of numerical computation The governing equations are discretised on a staggered grid using the finite volume method. Any small-scale (smaller than the control volume) motions are averaged out and have to be accounted for by a subgrid-scale model. A standard dynamic subgrid-scale model in cartesian co-ordinates has been employed in the present study. The ratio νs /ν is zero in the laminar region before transition occurs and starts to increase shortly after the separation line reaching a maximum value of about 9 around the mean reattachment location and dropping down to about 5 after reattachment. The explicit second order AdamsBashforth scheme is used for the momentum advancement. The Poisson equation for pressure is solved using an efficient hybrid Fourier multigrid method. The spatial discretisation is secondorder central differencing which is widely used in LES owing to its non-dissipative and conservative properties. More details of the mathematical formulation and numerical methods have been reported elsewhere by Yang and Voke [8]. 8
y/h
6 4 2 0 -5
-2.5
0
2.5
5
7.5
10
12.5
x/h
15
17.5
20
22.5
25
27.5
30
Figure 1: The computational domain and mesh used for the first simulation of the SSMO.
Two simulations were performed for the obstacle case. In the first simulation (figure 1) 288 × 128 × 64 cells along the streamwise, wall-normal and spanwise directions respectively were employed. The blockage ratio is 8 and the spanwise dimension of the domain is 4h. A free-slip but impermeable boundary is applied at the lateral boundary, periodic boundary along the spanwise and no-slip boundary conditions are used at all other walls. At the inflow boundary, a uniform velocity profile is applied and the Reynolds number based on the inflow velocity and obstacle height is 4500. At the outflow boundary, a convective boundary condition is applied. In terms of wall units based on the friction velocity downstream of reattachment at x/h = 27, the streamwise mesh sizes vary from ∆x+ = 6.77 to ∆x+ = 43.04 , while ∆z + = 10.625 and at the wall ∆y + = 1.28. The time step used in this simulation is 4.75 × 10−6 second (0.001425 Uh0 ). The simulation ran for 129, 000 time steps, equivalent to more than 5 flow passes through the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
16 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII domain (or residence times) to allow the transition and turbulent boundary layer to be established, i.e. the flow to have reached a statistically stationary state. The averaged results were gathered over a further 249, 900 time steps, with a sample taken every 10 time steps (24, 990 samples) averaged over the spanwise direction, corresponding to more than 10 flow passes or residence times. The second simulation used 320 × 220 × 64 cells for 0.25 m × 0.15 m × 0.04 m resulting in a blockage ratio of 15. The streamwise mesh sizes vary from ∆x+ = 6.09 to ∆x+ = 19.988 , while ∆z + = 10.96 and at the wall ∆y + = 1.14. The averaged results gathered from this simulation show no significant changes in the mean reattachment length from the first simulation. The same computational domain used in the second SSMO simulation was adopted for the FFS (with the step leading edge again located at x/h=5). The FFS case ran for a total of 404,000 time steps with the sampling for the mean field started 100,000 after the start of the run.
3 Mean flow field An important parameter characterising a separated-reattached flow is the time mean position of the reattachment. The mean streamlines and the mean axial velocity profile at the first cell from the solid boundary (a method used to determine the mean reattachment location) are shown in figure 2(a) and b respectively and indicate that the mean reattachment length is ≈ 15.5h. The predicted mean reattachment length compares well with the experimental measurements of 15.5h reported by Tropea and Gackstatter [2] which is the benchmark used in this work for the current LES of the SSMO. Other values include Bergeles and Athanassiadis [3] (xR /h = 11), Durst and Rastogi [4] (xR /h = 16), all of which are under a turbulent condition with high free-stream turbulence. Similar scatter was reported for the fence geometry including Tropea and Gackstatter [2] (xR /h = 17), the DNS study of Orellano and Wengle [9] (xR /h = 13.2) and the experiment of Larsen [10] (xR /h = 11.7). Overall, the LES simulation has predicted the line mean position of the reattachment well. Similarly, figures 3(a), and (b) are the corresponding mean stream line and the mean streamline velocity profiles at the first cell from the solid surface for the FFS flow. The predicted mean reattachment length downstream the separation line read from the two figures is 8.1h. Experimental and computational studies for the FFS are few and those which exist have predicted a shorter length than 8.1h. Ko [11] simulation predicted this length as 5.5h and the measured value from Moss and Baker [12] experiment is 4.8h. Similarly, the work of Bergeles and Athanassiadis [3] showed that the mean reattachment length downstream an extended obstacle is of order 4h. In contrast with the current simulation it appears that the LES has over-predicted this parameter. But once again the difference is thought to be due to the high Reynolds number and the nature of turbulent flows in the work cited here. For laminar separation, as in the current case, the transition could be delayed leading to a longer bubble than the case for turbulent separation. A relevant type of flow to the FFS is the blunt plate experiment of Castro and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
y/h
2 1.5 1 0.5 0 -0.5 -1
(a)
-2
0
2
4
6x/h
8
10
8
10
12
14
17
16
0.5
y/h
0.25 0 -0.25 (b) -0.5
2
4
6
x/h
12
14
16
Figure 2: LES prediction of flow over the SSMO: (a) Mean streamlines, (b) profile of mean axial velocity at the first cell from the solid surface along the streamwise direction. 1.5
(a)
y/h
1 0.5 0 -0.5 -1 -3
-2
-1
0
1
2
3
4
x/h
5
6
7
8
1
(b)
y/h
0.5
0
-0.5
-1
1
2
3
4
x/h
5
6
7
8
9
Figure 3: LES prediction of flow over the FFS: (a) Mean streamlines, (b) profile of mean axial velocity at the first cell from the solid surface along the streamwise direction.
Epik [13] (ReD = 6500) in which the reattachment is reported to be 7.7D, where D is the plate thickness. This is comparable to the mean reattachment length for the current simulation. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
y/h
18 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0
1
2
3
4
5
Um/U0
6
7
8
9
10
y/h
Figure 4: The SSMO flow: profiles of mean streamwise velocity Um /U0 at six streamwise locations measured from the separation line (leading edge). Left to right x/xR =0.05, 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1.025. Also shown are measurements by Tropea and Gackstatter [2] (triangle), Larsen [10] (square) and the DNS data of Orellano and Wengle [9] (circle symbol) at Re=3,000. 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0
0.4
0.8
1.2
1.6
2
urms/U0
Figure 5: The SSMO flow: profiles of mean streamwise turbulent intensity urms /U0 at six streamwise locations measured from the separation line (leading edge). Left to right x/xR =0.05, 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1.025. Also shown are measurements by Larsen [10] (square) and the DNS data of Orellano and Wengle [9] (circle) at Re=3,000. 8 7 6 y/h
5 4 3 2 1 0
0
1
2
3 Um/U0
4
5
6
Figure 6: The FFS flow: profiles of mean streamwise velocity Um /U0 at four streamwise locations measured from the separation line (leading edge). Left to right x/xR =0.208, 0.625, 1.04, and 1.25. Also shown are measurements by Moss and Baker [12] (circle) at Re=46,000.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
19
Figure 4 compares the mean streamwise velocity distribution U /U0 at 6 locations downstream of the separation line with the experimental data of Tropea and Gackstatter [2] (available only at 3 locations), Larsen [10] and the DNS data of Orellano and Wengle [9]. The results show good agreement with the data of Larsen [10] and the DNS data of Orellano and Wengle [9]. The freestream velocities of the data from Tropea and Gackstatter [2] are bigger than those predicted by the LES and the other two results, and peak at lower y-values. This is attributed to the difference in blockage ratio used by Tropea and Gackstatter [2] which is very low (= 2), 5 in the case of Orellano and Wengle [9] and 8 for the current LES. Profiles of the rms streamwise velocity, urms , normalised by U0 , at the same six stations are shown in figure 5. The agreement between the LES results and the data of Larsen [10] and the DNS data of Orellano and Wengle [9] is encouraging. No measured data were presented by Tropea and Gackstatter [2]. Data for the mean velocity profiles for the FFS flow at low Reynolds number does not exist. Therefore, the results were compared with experimental data by Moss and Baker [12] at higher Reynolds number (Reh = 46 000). This is thought not to be detrimental to the comparison and any discrepancy will be discussed taking this fact into consideration. Figure 6 compares the mean streamwise velocity distribution U /U0 at 4 locations downstream of the separation line with the experimental data of Baker [12]. The agreement between the experimental and LES results is reasonably good. At the location x/xR = 0.625 the peak negative value is slightly higher than the experimental value. This could be due to the low Reynolds number for the LES case leading to a stronger back flow and low mixing at this specific region of the recirculation region downstream the step. The profiles of the rms streamwise velocity, urms , normalised by U0 (not shown here), at the same four locations presented in figure 6 also display good agreement when compared with the data of Moss and Baker [12].
4 Spectra using Fourier and wavelet transforms For the current work, a well tested code that uses the FT methods for autocorrelation is used to process the data. For the WT, the Morlet wavelet is used and a code developed by Torrence and Compo ([14]) was modified to perform the analysis for the time series signals shown in this section. The WT analysis produces a 2D picture showing wavelet power concentration in time (x-axis) vs scales or period (y-axis) (which is an approximate measure to the Fourier period of the signal). For more details on wavelet transform techniques, the reader is advised to consult Torrence and Compo [14]. A total of 24990 samples at each point taken every 10 time-steps with time step = 4.75 × 10−6 seconds (sampling frequency 21.053 kHz) were collected for the SSMO case. This corresponds to a total period of 1.187025 seconds. For the FFS simulation, 32,312 samples were collected with each sample taken every 10 time-steps with time step = 1.5 × 10−6 seconds (sampling frequency 66.67 kHz). This corresponds to a total period of 0.484680 seconds. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
20 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII It is essential to choose a set of scaling parameters s, such that the wavelet transform adequately samples all the frequencies present in the time series. The smallest resolvable scale, s0 , is usually selected as a multiple of the time resolution dt and for the current studies is chosen as 2dt for the SSMO and FFS data. Torrence and Compo [14] recommended that the largest scale chosen should be less than 1/2 the length of the entire time series. For the two cases presented here, the largest scale chosen is of order one third of the total time span and hence, no interest in event with long periods is sought. However, larger periods are also investigated to shed light on the difference of choosing this parameter associated with WT. Shown in figures 7(a) and (c) are the time history for the velocity u and v at the position described by the co-ordinates (h=-0.375, y/h=0.04, z/h=2), immediately upstream and slightly above the leading edge of the SSMO. The WT spectra based, on scales of order one third of the total sampling time, is shown in figures 7(b) and (d) and the spectra based on the FT for these velocities appear in figure 7(e). The FT spectra clearly show a sharp frequency peak (band) centered at approximately 105 Hz for both velocity components (the normalised value is 5.425 xUR0 ). The wavelet spectra for the velocity U (figure 7(c)) reveal power concentration associated with four instances of time. The major power is centered around t ≈ 0.26s with a band scale ≤ 0.2. Linked to this event, there is another event which is characterised by less power compared the major event, having a lower band (0.1 ≤ scale ≤ 0.2) and centered around t ≈ 0.5s (the two events are thought to be associated with the peak noticed in the FT spectra). The wavelet spectra also indicates that an event with lower power concentration and much narrower band (0.09 ≤ scale ≤ 0.11) has taken place between 0.85 ≤ t ≤ 1.2. Also, towards the end of the sampling period, the WT spectra indicates that the major event (or velocity peak) could possibly reoccur. The last point is clear from the WT spectra for the velocity v (figure 7(d)) which shows power concentration shortly after the start of the sampling and towards the end of the time history. Comparing the events shown by the WT spectra with the time series, it is clear that the WT is able to interpret exactly the content of the event displayed in the history for each velocity component. Whenever the signal shows a sharp positive or negative peak which is most likely an indication of an event (shedding, or pairing of large-scale structures), it was captured in the WT spectra with its representative magnitude and at the exact time where the process happened. All these features represent the benefits of using WT to perform spectral analysis for unsteady turbulent flow. One of the critical features of the WT spectra is the fact that it provides only qualitative results (many criticise the method for this feature). However, it does give a clear picture of the extent of the event (amplitude) and any smaller events associated with it and the time of occurrence and possibly the cyclic behaviour of the major event. This information could be useful in controlling such events (damping or exciting as required for specific applications) It is essential to set an appropriate range of scales for the WT spectra to be realistic. As an example, the largest scale for the velocity u in figure 7(b) has been increased in figure 7(f) in order to seek events with higher period. It is clear that the content shown by this figure is a little misleading when compared with the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
21
corresponding time history of the signal where events with lower concentration and those occurring at shorter times have vanished. This confirms that care should be taken when using WT spectra for turbulent flow data analysis. For the FFS flow and for a point similar to the location of the SSMO discussed above (x/h=-0.225, y/h=0.2, z/h=2), the time series for the velocities u and w are shown in figures 7(g) and (i) respectively with the WT spectra shown in figures 7(h) and (j) respectively. The FT spectra is displayed in figure 7(k). The interesting point here is the fact that the FT spectra does not show any particularly amplified frequency. However, the WT spectra for the velocity u shows power concentrations both at the beginning of the sampling period and towards the end while that for the velocity w shows a clear and significant concentration shortly after the start of the sampling process. The reason for these events not being shown in the FT spectra is probably due to the short total time (≈ 0.45 sec compared to 1.25 sec for the SSMO) for the samples collected in the FFS which may be too short to resolve this particular frequency. However, the WT spectra shows that there are significant events at the location mentioned above for the SSMO flow. It is worth pointing out that this detected frequency is most likely due to Kelvin-Helmholtz (K-H) instability rather than being attributed to the flapping of the shear layer since its reduced value is much higher than the later which is of order 0.15 xUR0 . For the SSMO and downstream the separation line (x/h=1.65, y/h=0.85, z/h=2), figures 7(l) shows a fading frequency peak (centered at f=200 Hz) which most likely represents vortex shedding/pairing of vortices rolling-up at the fundamental instability frequency of the separating shear layer. A similar value is reported for the FFS downstream the leading edge (not shown here).
5 Conclusion Analysis of the velocities and pressure fields signals predicted by LES for a transitional separated-reattached flow over a SSMO and FFS was performed employing the FT and the WT. The turbulence spectra for the geometries revealed amplified frequency modes both upstream and downstream of the separation edge with those associated with the SSMO more apparent compared to the FFS. The value of amplified frequency upstream strongly suggest that the upstream separated region is unstable via the K-H instability and the frequency could not be attributed to the flapping of the shear layer as commonly reported for such class of flows. Those which appear downstream the separation line are attributed to the shedding and pairing activities of large-scale motions dominating the separated boundary layer. The WT correctly interpreted the content of the time signal for the presented data. Whenever the time signal indicates the occurrence of a certain event, it was marked in the WT spectra with its representative amplitude. The WT was also able to capture events that are characterised by narrow periods (scales) and which happened over shorter times. Such events are smoothed out by the Fourier transform indicating the superiority of the WT over the FT in revealing a signal WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
22 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 7: Time signal, FT and WT spectra for the SSMO (a), (b), (c), (d), (e), (f) and (l) and FFS (g), (h), (i), and (j).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
23
contents. However, it was found that appropriate range of scales must be selected for the WT in order to adequately sample the existing frequencies within a signal and avoid misleading interpretation.
References [1] Sat¨ur, H., Gyr, A. and Kinzelbach, W. Laminar separation on a forward facing step. Eur. J. Mechj. B/Fluids 18, 675-692, 1999. [2] Tropea CD, Gackstatter R. The flow over two-dimensional surface-mounted obstacles at low Reynolds number, Journal of Fluids Engineering; 107:489494, 1984. [3] Bergeles G, and Athanassiadis N. The flow pass a surface mounted obstacle. ASME Journal of Fluid Engineering; 105:461-463, 1983. [4] Durst F, Rastogi AK. Turbulent flow over two-dimensional fences, in Turb. Shear Flows 2. Springer Verlag: Berlin, 218-231, 1980. [5] Wilhelm, D., H¨artel, C., and Kleiser, L. Computational analysis of the two-dimensional-three-dimensional transition in forward-facing step flow. J. Fluid Mech; 179:439-468, 1987. [6] Kiya M, Sasaki K. Structure of a turbulent separation bubble, J. Fluid Mech; 137:83-113, 1983. [7] Kaiser G. A Friendly Guide to Wavelets. Cambridge, MA: Birkhuser, 300pp, 1994. [8] Yang, Z. and Voke, R.P. Large-eddy simulation of separated leading-edge flow in general co-ordinates. International J. Numer. Meth. Engng. 49, pp. 681696, 2000. [9] Orellano A, Wengle H. Numerical simulation (DNS and LES) of manipulated turbulent boundary layer flow over a surface-mounted fence. Er. J. B - Fluids, 19:765-788, 2000. [10] Larsen, P. S. Database on tc-2C and tc-2D fence-on-wall and obstacle-onwall test case. Report AFM-ETMA 95-01, ISSN 0590-8809; TU Denmark, 1995. [11] Ko, S. H. Computation of turbulent flows over backward and forward-facing steps using a near-wall Reynolds stress model. CTR Annual Research Briefs, Stanford University/NASA Ames, 75-90, 1993. [12] Moss W. D., Baker S. Re-circulating Flows Associated with Twodimensional Steps, Aero Quart., 151-172, 1980. [13] Castro IP, Epik E. Boundary layer development after a separated region. Journal of Fluid Mechanics, Vol.374(), pp.91-116, 1998. [14] Torrence C, Compo GP. A practical guide to wavelet analysis. Bulletin of the American Meteorological Society, 61-77, 1998.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
25
Observation of solid fuel in a supersonic flowfield J. M. Char1 & U. K. Hsu2 1
Air Force Institute of Technology, Gangshan, Kaohsiung, Taiwan, Republic of China 2 Department of Aircraft Engineering, Air Force Institute of Technology, Gangshan, Kaohsiung, Taiwan, Republic of China
Abstract Hypersonic vehicles will be the new-generation of aerial transport. Hence, supersonic combustor design becomes important. Many investigations have been conducted on this subject, however, they are focused on gaseous or liquid fuels combustor. The use of a solid fuel combustor can substantially decrease complexity and cost, so for certain purposes, solid fuel supersonic combustors show advantages over other fuel systems. This research adopts a shock tube, 16 meter long and with a bore of 9 cm to create a supersonic, high-temperature, and high-pressure flowfield to observe the gasification and ignition of HTPB solid fuel under different environments. Also, full-scale 3D numerical simulation is executed to enhance the comprehension of this complex phenomenon. The CFD code is based on the control volume method and the pre-conditioning method for solving the Navier-Stokes equations to simulate the compressible and incompressible coupling problem. In the tests, a HTPB slab is placed in the windowed-test section. Various test conditions generate different supersonic Mach numbers and environmental temperatures, meanwhile the HTPB slab changes its incident angles relative to the coming shock wave. Results show that when the Mach number around the slab section is beyond 1.25, the flowfield temperature can achieve above 1100K, which is higher than the HTPB gasification temperature (930K~1090K), then the gasification happens and a short-period ignition can be observed. In particular, as the slab angle is 7°, the phenomenon is more visible. This is due to the flowfield temperature increasing when the slab angle is at 7°. The comparison between test results and CFD simulation show good agreement, so the CFD results help the understanding and analysis of this complicated test event. Several pictures demonstrating the research results are shown below. Keywords: ignition, shock tube, HTPB, scramjet, finite volume. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070031
26 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
With the development of the space shuttle and solar system exploration, the hypersonic high technology in aviation will play an important role in the nextgeneration frontier [1]. However, the engine of the hypersonic vehicle is a kind of scamjet, but the combustor inlet air is supersonic and will be much more useful and powerful than the Ramjet [2]. In the 1960’s, researchers indicated that regression ratio is the key in mixer-rocket studies. For this reason, many models are developed in different combustion conditions. Marxman and Gilbert [3] consider that the optimal position of the flame should be in the top of the fuel surface, and the regression rate is the minimum in the turbulence layer of about 10-20%. Muzzy [4] also verify that the heat convection effect is very important in fuel consumption. Smoot and Price [5] indicated the fuel regression ratio is proportional to the oxidizer flow rate in 0.8 order in lower oxidizer flow rate. During the 1990s, there were lots of basic studies conducted. Greiner and Grederick [6] expressed the fuel regression ratio as proportional to the oxidizer flow rate, and the pressure fluctuation as decreasing in raising the mixed region length. Chiaverini et al. [7] indicated that the vapor temperature of the fuel surface is between 930K and 1190K according to several different HTPB composites. In order to investigate the ignition and combustion efficiency of a supersonic combustion ramjet and simplify the components, there is a 16 meters shock tube established as shown in Fig.1. The device consists of a long tube divided into a high pressure and a low pressure section by an aluminium diaphragm. When the diaphragm is rupturing in the high pressure driver section, a series of compression waves coalesce into a single shock front which compresses and heats the high pressure region test gas to low pressure region, and creates the supersonic gas flow condition. In the shock tube, there are lots of complex phenomena including the normal shock, contact surface, expansion wave etc. We investigate the flowfield of the supersonic flow through the plate-like HTPB solid fuel under this unsteady condition. The difficult problem, however, is that it is not easy to create a supersonic condition over a length of time. The best test period is about 10 ms. Therefore, we must be carefully in experiments and operation. There are lots of shock tube wind tunnels established for research from 1950, for example: Glass and Hall [8], Lukasiewicz [9], Nagamatsu [10], Bradley [11], Soloukhin [12], etc. In fact, the wind tunnel test is very important in classical aerodynamics. However, there is not a complete understanding of the full phenomena because of the limit of the experiment. The Computational Fluid Dynamics, CFD, is a good tool to deal with the problems. In this study, both of these two methods are used. Using CFD simulates supersonic flow through the HTPB slab, and compares with the experimental data.
2
Experimental apparatus
In Fig.1, the length of a shock tube is 16m. The high pressure region is higher than 147 psi, and low pressure region is below 1 psi. A HTPB slab, 15cm(length)×3cm(spread) ×0.5cm (thickness), is placed in 14.55m from the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
27
start point of the high pressure region. There are two pressure transducer placed in 14.55m (#1) and 14.65m (#2), separately. The initial tube temperature is 300K. To capture the reaction, a 10W pulse laser (t=50µs) and high speed CCD camera (t=200µs) is set up.
(a) high pressure section (length: 290 cm, diameter: 28.5cm)
(c) test section (window: 25cm×3cm)
(b) convergent nozzle (length: 10cm, internal diameter in divergent section: 28.5cm, internal diameter in convergent section: 9cm)
(d) dimension
Figure 1:
3
Shock tube dimension.
Numerical model
Algebraically spaced grids are used to cover the flowfield, and the stretching transformation clusters using the Roberts generalized stretching transformation technique are made near the boundary layer. The Shock tube is symmetrical about the centre-plane and, therefore, only the right half of the Shock tube and plate-like model needs to be modelled. The multi-block grid approach is used in the present study. The total number of cells is 2094750 with respect to the half 3D shock tube as shown in Fig.2. The instantaneous solution was obtained by WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
28 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII solving the time-dependent governing equations, and the residual is measured by the order of magnitude of the decay. The convergent solution was achieved when the residual had decayed by about 3 orders of magnitudes. Computation was performed on finer and coarser grids for a grid resolution steady; it was found that the total grid sizes, especially in the y direction, depend on the turbulence model used. According to present study, the average value of y+ closest to the surface is 0.2 with the exact solution for turbulence models [13]. The DELL OPTIPLX GX270 workstation is used for the computation.
Figure 2:
Longitudinal cut view of the grid system.
The numerical scheme, using the preconditioning finite volume method, is introduced to solve the governing flow equations. A 2nd-order scheme is initially applied, so the left and right states are chosen to be the cell average values on the left and right of the cell faces. In a high-resolution scheme, in order to raise the order of accuracy of upwind differencing, all one needs to do is to raise the order of accuracy of the initial-value interpolation that yields the zone-boundary data. Such schemes are labelled as high resolution schemes as opposed to Total Variation Diminishing (TVD) schemes, which completely eliminate any of those spurious oscillations when applied to one dimensional nonlinear hyperbolic conservation laws and linear hyperbolic systems. The van Leer kappa-scheme, in which the kappa number is one-third, was selected to obtain a high-resolution upwind differencing [14–16]. An optimal multi-stage scheme is used for the time integration, the multistage coefficients are modified by Tai et al [17] and redefined using the Courant number for multi-dimensional use. Also, a residual smoothing method is imposed to accelerate convergence and to improve numerical stability.
4
Results and discussion
4.1 Initial conditions In order to understand the velocity and temperature statute in a shock tube, 1-D shock tube theorem is applied to determine the shock speed, temperature, and action time as following:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
29
P4 147 ( psi ) = = 147 P1 1( psi ) 2γ
γ −1 P2 − 1 P P γ −1 P1 ∵ 1 = 1 1 − P4 P2 2γ γ + 1 P2 − 1 1+ 2γ P1
P2 = 7.0 P1
so,
from
normal
shock
table,
it
shows
M s = 2.48, and
hence
M 2 = 0.5149, T2 = 635.4 K . The history of the action time is shown in Fig.3. The main shock wave has reflected to the test model before the contact surface arrived. Therefore, the period of the test time is only 3.2 ms.
Figure 3: 1-D theorem determined result.
Figure 4:
Pressure and temperature profile at point #1& #2.
4.2 Full-scale shock tube simulation We can set the time step in unsteady simulation from the above 1-D theorem determined. In Fig.4, P1 and P2 are presented the position of the pressure transducer (#1 and #2) individually. The result shows the shock speed is 787.4 m/s in test section. The main shock arrived point #1 at t=11.08ms, and is faster by 2.32ms than theorem determined. The numerical model simulates the real case that the calibre is reduced to 1/3 when section is in the low pressure region from high pressure region. For this reason, the shock speed is rapidly increased. The calculation of the theory regards, in terms of the main straight tube as, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
30 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII neglects the heat effect and boundary layer effect, because their response time is relatively slow if comparing with the test event interval. Fig.5 and Fig.6 show pressure and temperature change in different time steps: (a) shows the initial state after the diaphragm broken; (b) and (c) show the incident shock wave propagation phenomena. Fig.6(b) shows the temperature distribution, and a contact surface can clearly find. Fig.6(d) and 6(e) show the detail of the reflection shock wave. Because the wind tunnel is a close type, the pressure is dropped naturally in the high pressure section after the main shock released as shown in Fig.5.
Figure 5: Snapshots of the pressure distribution in a tube.
Figure 6:
Snapshots of the temperature distribution in a tube.
4.3 Different fuel slab angle analysis After understanding the phenomena of a full scale shock tube, a fuel slab is placed in test section (X=14.55~14.70M), to investigate the physical phenomena of the fuel slab surface in different angles of attack (AOA=0°, 7°, and 10°). Figs 7–9 show the slab surface pressure, temperature, and Mach number. Due to the symmetric shape across the upper and lower area of the slab at AOA=0°, the distribution curves are merged as one line. But at AOA=7° and 10°, the temperature and pressure curve across the upper and lower surface show differently in Figs 7–9. In Fig. 10, at AOA=0°, the blunt shape of the leading edge causes the supersonic bow shock, and one more shock wave is followed to make the temperature rise once again near the leading edge afterwards. The channel flow seems to be through a convergent nozzle between the upper and lower passage because of the boundary layer effect. Also, because of the passage flow wall effect, the shock wave is reflected, which makes the speed rapidly reduced. Therefore, the Mach number is decreasing from 1.25 to M=0.5 when air flow attached a reflection shock at X/C=0.1. Following on, the flow speed is raised at X/C=0.15~0.4 because of the convergent passage that the boundary layer affects. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 7: Pressure profile of HTPB surface in different AOA.
31
Figure 8: Temp. profile of HTPB surface in different AOA.
(a) AOA=0 deg
(b) AOA=7 deg.
(c) AOA=10 deg.
Figure 9: Mach No. profile of HTPB surface in different AOA.
Figure 10:
Iso-density contour.
However, the energy after the reflecting shock wave is reduced too fast, so the Mach number tends towards stability after X/C=0.5. As 7 degrees of angles of attack, the impact effect on the upper surface increases so temperature is higher than 0 degrees case. The supersonic flow will reduce speed and raise pressure because of a geometric convergent passage. The shock wave which occurred in leading edge of upper surface will reattach at the trailing edge through the reflection shock. The main shock wave has the deflection characteristic due to the decline of the slab so the air flow oppresses the boundary layer. For this WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
32 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII reason, the temperature is increasing on the upper surface. The supersonic flow speed raised and pressure reduced when the air flow over the lower surface which is like in a divergent nozzle. Therefore, at AOA=7° and HTPB fuel is mounted on the upper surface of the slab; high temperature helps the gasification and ignition in HTPB plate. In Fig.9, we found the air flow speed still above M=1 either on upper or low surface in AOA=7°. Therefore, this situation can satisfy the ignition in supersonic flow. As AOA=10°, the average temperature is not so good as in AOA=7°, but the speed is still above M=1. Because of the reflection of the main shock wave in the leading edge, the pressure is reduced, the temperature is raised, and Mach number is reduced after the flow through the reflection shock (Fig.7 to 9, X/C=0.3). 4.4 Experiment visualization Fig.11 shows the time history snapshot of the shock wave using a CCD camera. The shock wave arrived to slab (AOA=7deg) at t=11.1 ms. The oblique shock has occurred because of the angle shape configuration. The secondary oblique shock wave is induced at t=11.7ms when the flow over the HTPB. Comparing with CFD results, in Fig.12, the flow speed behind the shock is kept in transonic on the upper side, and the speed of the lower side increased to M=2. Although the speed is reduced behind the oblique shock on the upper side, the temperature is also proportional to the length as shown in Fig.8. The reflection shock is induced in the trailing edge at t=14.1ms as shown in Fig.11(d). The period is about 3 ms between the shock arrived and reflection shock attached the test section. Fig.13 shows the time history of pressure transducer record at 14.55M (#1) and 14.65M (#2). Because the HTPB fuel is not burned, the change of pressure transducer record is not clear until the hit of main shock and reflection shock. We can find the pressure fluctuation after a rapid peak as shown in Fig.13, because of the interaction of shocks in the tube. The total pressure is not reduced until the pressure goes to stable after the peak value. It is observed that gasification exits when the shock wave goes across the HTPB. From the recovered fuel, there is a melt in the leading edge as shown in Fig.14. This region is a stagnation zone for a bow shock, where flow speed is slow and temperature is high. The temperature can reach 1100K as shown in Fig.8. The temperature has already been higher than the surface gasification temperature (930K 1190K) of HTPB, and there is enough time in the district for burning. The flow speed in other places is too fast, so the temperature has not reached the gasification criterion, and it is unable to burn.
5
Conclusion
From the numerical simulation result, the HTPB slab at an angle of attack of 7 degrees has a higher temperature and pressure in the upper surface than 0 degrees and 10 degrees, and the flow speed of the upper and lower surface keeps in supersonic flow and contributing to gasification ignition. According to the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
33
experimental data and numerical result, the test periods are both about 3 ms, and it had the melt in the leading edge of the tested HTPB slab. In other areas, although they reach the gasification criterion, it is unable to burn because the flow speed is too fast and the test time is limited by 3ms of shock tube facility.
(a) before event (t=0 sec) Figure 12:
Mach No. distribution.
Figure 13:
Pressure measurement (point#1).
(b) shock wave arrived (dir.:Î, t=11.1ms)
(c) shock wave through (dir.:Î, t=11.7ms)
(d) ref. Shock (dir.:Í, t=14.1ms)
Figure 11:
Snapshots of shock wave.
(a)
(b)
Figure 14: Comparison before and after the action: (a) without action, (b) with action.
Acknowledgement The authors are grateful to the National Science Council of the Republic of China for financial support under contract number NSC 93-2212-E- 013-007.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
34 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14]
[15] [16] [17]
Waltrup, P. J., White, M.E., Zarlingo, F., and Gravlin, E. S., “History of U.S. Navy Ramjet, Scramjet, and Mixed-Cycle Propulsion Development,” Journal of Propulsion and Power, Vol.18, No.1, pp.14-27, 2000. Jones, R. A. and Huber, P.W. “Toward Scramjet Aircraft,” AIAA Journal, Vol.16, pp.38-48, 1978. Marxman, C. A., and Gilbert, M., “Turbulent Boundary Layer Combustion in the Hybrid Rocket,” 9th International Symposium on Combustion, Academic Press, Inc., New York, 1963, pp.371-383. Muzzy, R. J., “Applied Hybrid Combustion Theory,” AIAA Paper No. 72 1143, 1972. Smoot, L. D., and Price, C. F., “Regression Rates of Nonmetalized Hybrid Fuel Systems,” AIAA Journal, Vol. 3, No. 8, August 1965, pp. 1408-1413. Greiner, B. and Grederick, R. A. Jr., “Results of Labscale Hybrid Rocket Motor Investigation,” AIAA Paper No. 92-3301, 1992. Chiaverini, M. J. et al., ”Fuel Decomposition and Boundary Layer Combustion Processes of Hybrid Rocket Motors,” AIAA Paper 95-2686, 1995. Glass, I. I., and Hall, J. G., “Shock Tubes, Handbook of Supersonic Aerodynamics,” NAVORD Report 1488, Vol. 6, Section 18. (1958) Lukasiewicz, J., “Shock Tube Theory and Application,” National Aeronautical Establishment, Rept. 15, Ottawa, Canada. (1952) Nagamatsu, H. T., “Shock Tube Technology and Design,” Fundamental Data Obtained From a Shock-Tube Experiments,” Edited by A. Feri, pp. 86-136, Pergamon Press. (1961) Bradley, J. N., “Shock Waves in Chemistry and Physics,” Methuen & Co. (London), J. Wiley & Sons (New York). (1962) Soloukhin, R. I., “Shock Waves and Detonation in Gases,” State Publishing House of Physical-Mathematical Literature, Moscow; English Translation Published by Mono Book Corp., Baltimore. (1966) Wilcox, D. C., “Comparison of Two-Equation Turbulence Models for Boundary Layers with Pressure Gradient”, J of AIAA, Vol.31, No.8, pp.1414-1421 (1993) Van Leer, B., "Upwind-Difference Methods for Aerodynamic Problems Governed by the Euler Equations, in Large-Scale Computations in Fluid Mechanics," Lectures in Applied Mathematics, Vol. 22, pp. 327336(1985). Roe, P. L., "Approximate Riemann Solvers, Parameter Vector, and Difference Schemes," Journal of Computational Physics, Vol. 43, pp.357372(1981). Edwards J.R. and Liou M. S. “Low-Diffusion Flux-Splitting Methods for Flows at All Speeds” AIAA J., Vol.36. No.9, 1610-1617, (1998). Tai, C. H., Sheu, J.H, and van Leer, B., "Optimally Multi-Stage Schemes for the Euler Equations with Residual Smoothing," Journal of AIAA, Vol.33, No.6, pp.1008-1016 (1995). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
35
Temperature field at the twin-roll casting of aluminium alloys: computational model and measurements H. Gjerkeš, S. Hartman, R. Vertnik & B. Šarler Laboratory for Multiphase Processes, University of Nova Gorica, Slovenia
Abstract Industrial twin-roll casting of aluminium alloys requires optimisation of connections between process parameters and product properties. To a large extent, the cast strip properties depend on the spatial and temporal characteristics of heat transfer from the cast strip, which needs estimation of the influence of process parameters on the temperature field and temperature gradients in a strip for various alloys, which are cast on an industrial machine. For this purpose, the recently developed meshless Local Radial Basis Function Collocation Method (LRBFCM) was used in the simulation of heat transfer from the strip. The solution of the nonlinear convection-diffusion equation is based on a mixture continuum formulation of the energy transport in solid-liquid phase change systems. Simulation results were compared with experimental values, which were obtained during the industrial production process. They were measured in situ by the specially designed apparatus with fast response thermocouples, which can measure the time-dependent temperature of the cast strip in several locations on the moving strip surface simultaneously. The time-dependent measurement was coupled with a digital camera recording to gather the spatial domain measurement of temperature. The differences between the numerical simulation and experimental results were smaller than 6 K. An explanation for the discrepancy is given. Keywords: twin-roll casting, aluminium alloys, measurements, surface temperature, meshless method, radial basis functions.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070041
36 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The twin-roll continuous casting is a promising commercial material processing technique, however it is extremely difficult to control [1]. Process modelling [2] has been introduced in order to improve quality, reduce production cost, and improve safety. Like most commercial material processes, the twin roll casting involves many interacting phenomena of great complexity, which makes it difficult to include them all in the model. The principal aim of the presented model is to predict the product properties as a function of the process parameters. A broad class of meshfree methods in development today are based on Radial Basis Functions (RBFs). The RBF collocation method or Kansa method is the simplest of them. This paper describes the numerical solution of the convectivediffusive solidification problem in twin-roll casting process by the recently developed meshless local radial basis function collocation approach [3–5]. The method is structured on multiquadrics radial basis functions. Instead of global, the collocation is made locally over a set of overlapping domains of influence and the time-stepping is performed in an explicit way. Only small systems of linear equations with the dimension of the number of nodes included in the domain of influence have to be solved for each node. The computational effort grows roughly linearly with the number of the nodes. The developed approach overcomes the principal large-scale problem bottleneck of the original Kansa method. Simulation results were compared with the measured temperatures on the cast strip surface after exiting the rolls. Presented experimental technique enables temperature measurements during the industrial continuous twin-roll casting without disturbing the production process. The technique is based on fast response thermocouples, mounted on the cast strip using the specially designed apparatus. The time-dependent temperature measurement on the moving cast strip was coupled with digital camera recording to obtain the measurement of surface temperature over a substantial part of the strip exiting the cooling rolls. Influence of the experimental set-up on the measurement results is considered. Based on experimental results, the improvements of the numerical model boundary conditions are proposed.
2
Model
The twin-roll casting process, fig. 1, consists of two oppositely rotating internally water cooled rolls which are independently driven. The molten metal is fed between the rolls through a pouring nozzle. The strip thickness is defined with the separation distance between rolls, which is typical few millimetres at strip width of a meter or more. The heat transfer in twin-roll casting can be reasonably represented in the framework of the mixture continuum formulation which assumes local thermodynamic equilibrium between the phases. This formulation can in solidification context involve quite complicated constitutive relations. Presented model focuses on a convective-diffusive heat transport as a first step. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
37
Twin-roll casting process.
2.1 Governing equations Consider a connected fixed domain Ω with boundary Γ occupied by a phase change material described with the temperature dependent density ρ℘ of the phase ℘ , temperature dependent specific heat at constant pressure c p , effective thermal conductivity k , and the specific latent heat of the solid-liquid phase change hm . The mixture continuum formulation of the enthalpy conservation for the assumed system is ∂ G G G G ( ρ h ) + ∇ ⋅ ( ρ vh ) = ∇ ⋅ ( k ∇T ) + ∇ ⋅ ( ρ vh − f SV ρ S vS hS − f LV ρ L vL hL ) (1) ∂t with subscripts S and L denoting the solid and the liquid phase, respectively. The mixture density is defined as ρ = f SV ρ S + f LV ρ L , the mixture velocity is G G G defined as ρ v = f SV ρ S vS + f LV ρ L vL , and the mixture enthalpy is defined as h = f SV hS + f LV hL . The constitutive mixture temperature - mixture enthalpy relationships are hS = ∫
T
Tref
cS dT , hL = hS (T ) + ∫
T
TS
( cL − cS )dT + hm
(2,3)
with Tref and TS standing for the reference temperature and solidus temperature, respectively. Thermal conductivity and specific heat of the phases can arbitrarily depend on temperature. The liquid volume fraction f LV is assumed to vary from 0 to 1 between solidus TS and liquidus temperature TL . We seek for mixture temperature at time t0 + ∆t by assuming known temperature and velocity fields at time t0 , and boundary conditions.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
38 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 2.2 Solution procedure The solution of the problem is demonstrated on the general transport equation defined on a fixed domain Ω with boundary Γ , standing for a reasonably broad spectra of mass, energy, momentum and species transfer problems (and includes also eqn. (1) as a special case): ∂ G (4) ρ C ( Φ ) + ∇ ⋅ ρ v C ( Φ ) = −∇ ⋅ ( − D∇Φ ) + S ∂t G with ρ , Φ, t , v , D, and S standing for density, transport variable, time, velocity, diffusion matrix and source, respectively. Scalar function C stands for possible more involved constitutive relations between conserved and diffused quantities. The solution of the governing equation for the transport variable at the final time t0 + ∆t is sought, where t0 represents the initial time and ∆t the positive time increment. The solution is constructed by the initial and boundary conditions that G follow. The initial value of the transport variable Φ ( p, t ) at point with position G vector p and time t0 is defined through the known function Φ 0 : G G Φ ( p, t ) = Φ 0 ( p ) ; p ∈ Ω + Γ . (5) The boundary Γ is divided into not necessarily connected parts Γ = Γ D ∪ Γ N ∪ Γ R with Dirichlet, Neumann and Robin type boundary G conditions, respectively. These boundary conditions are at the boundary point p G with normal nΓ and time t0 < t ≤ t0 + ∆t defined through known functions Φ ΓD , Φ ΓR , Φ ΓRref : ∂ ∂ G Φ = Φ ΓD ; p ∈ Γ D , Φ = Φ ΓR ( Φ − Φ ΓRref ) ; p ∈ Γ R . Φ = Φ ΓN ; p ∈ Γ N , ∂nΓ ∂nΓ
(6,7,8) The involved parameters of the governing equation and boundary conditions are assumed to depend on the transport variable, space and time. The solution procedure is in this paper based on the combined explicit-implicit scheme. The discretisation in time can be written as dC ρ C− ρ 0 C0 ρ C + ρ d Φ ( Φ − Φ ) − ρ 0 C 0 ∂ (9) ( ρ C ( Φ ) ) ≈ ∆t ≈ ∂t ∆t by using the two-level time discretisation and Taylor expansion of the function C ( Φ ) . The known quantities are denoted with overbar. The source term can be
expanded as dS ( Φ−Φ ) . dΦ The unknown Φ can be calculated from the equation S (Φ) ≈ S +
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(10)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
ρ0
G ρ dC dS Φ + ∇ ⋅ ( D0 ∇Φ 0 ) − ∇ ⋅ ( ρ0 v0 C0 ) + S − Φ ∆t d Φ d Φ . (11) ρ dC dS − ∆t d Φ d Φ The value of the transport variable Φ n is solved in as set of nodes G pn ; n = 1, 2,..., N of which N Ω belong to the domain and N Γ to the boundary. The iterations over one timestep are completed when the equation (12) is satisfied, and the steady-state is achieved when the eqn. (13) is achieved max Φ n − Φ n ≤ Φ itr , max Φ n − Φ 0 ≤ Φ ste . (12,13) G The value of the unknown derivatives of the variable Φ n in point pn is Φ = ∆t
C0 −
ρ
39
∆t
C+
approximated by the collocation method which uses the values of Φ i at I G G points pi ; i = 1, 2,..., I , situated in the vicinity of and including pn . One can write the following approximation of the function and its first and second order partial derivatives ∂ ∂ G G G K K G G G Φ ( p ) ≈ ∑ k =1 n α kψ k ( p − pn ) , ψ k ( p − pn ) (14,15) Φ ( p ) ≈ ∑ k =1 n α k ∂pς ∂pς ∂2 ∂2 K G G G ψ k ( p − pn ) ; Φ ( p ) ≈ ∑ k =1 n α k ∂pςξ ∂pςξ
ς , ξ = x, y .
(16)
The scaled multiquadrics are used for representation functions 1/ 2 G G G G 2 ψ k ( p − pn ) = ( p − pn ) − c 2 r02 (17) where r0 represents the maximum distance between points in a subdomain. Other details of the solution (particularly implementation of boundary conditions) are elaborated in [3–5]. 2.3 Model results The aluminium alloy composition and the nominal process parameters, used as simulation input parameters, are given in tables 1 and 2, respectively. Table 1: El. Wt [%]
Fe 0.85
Si 0.6
Mn 0.022
Table 2:
Aluminium alloy composition. Mg 0.05
Cu 0.05
Zn Ti 0.05 0.0375
Cr 0.002
Process and input parameters.
Casting Speed [m/min] Strip thickness [mm] Roll temperature [°C] Setback [mm] Heat transfer coefficient strip-cooling rolls [W/(m2K)] Convection heat transfer coefficient strip-air [W/(m2K)] WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
1.22 6.00 35.1 69.22 3600 10.7
B 0.01
40 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
Predicted temperature field in cast strip cross-section at nominal process parameters.
Fig. 2 shows prediction of the temperature field in cast aluminium alloy strip cross-section at the process parameters, which were used at the time of the measurements, presented below. More simulation results for temperature field in the cast strip as a function of various process parameters: casting speed, strip thickness, roll temperature, setback, etc., can be found in [3–5].
3
Experimental set up
A new measurement technique was developed for surface temperature measurements of twin-roll cast aluminium alloys. The fast response Omega CO1 Type K thermocouples with butt welded junction of thickness 0.013 mm were used. The thermocouple is embedded between two thin, glass reinforced high temperature polymer laminates for support and electrical insulation. The laminated sensor has dimensions 19 x 9.4 x 0.13 mm. Declared response time is between 10 and 20 ms, when grounded to surface. The sensor was installed on a small, 12 x 8 x 5 mm graphite block with a 2 mm thick layer of temperature resistant silicone putty. The latter was used to reduce the influence of the transient heat conduction in the thermocouple support on the dynamic temperature measurements, i.e. to improve the response of the sensor. Thermocouples were fastened via graphite blocks to a specially constructed holder. Gravity of the holder assured good contact between thermocouples and measured surface, whereby it could be placed down and removed from the strip surface without disturbing or influencing the production process. The detail of the thermocouple fixation and the set up, placed on the cast strip during the measurement are shown in fig. 3. Measurement procedure started with placing down the holder with thermocouples on the upper cast aluminium alloy strip surface as near as possible to the cast rolls, typically 100 mm from the rolls' outlet (point 0 in fig. 1). Thermocouples travelled together with cast strip without relative moving. The temperatures were sampled using the high-speed data acquisition system Agilent 34970A with multiplexer module 34902A. Simultaneously, the position of the thermocouples was recorded with a digital camera, whereby clocks in the camera, the data acquisition system and the process control system were synchronised. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
41
The set up during measurement (left bottom) and thermocouple installation detail (right top).
Information from digital camera recording enabled conversion of the timedependent into spatial-dependent measurement of the strip surface temperature. The specially designed apparatus gives possibility to measure strip surface temperature during the industrial continuous twin-roll casting of aluminium alloys, where no influences of the measurement procedure on the production process are allowed. On the other hand, the thermocouple installation on the graphite block deteriorates the sensor dynamic response because of the additional thermal inertia, which increases the delay time of the sensor. The influence of the thermocouple installation support was considered with the heat flow balance of the sensor: dT (TA − Tm )α Am A = ( ρ cV ) m m + Q1 (18) dt where TA is the surface temperature of the aluminium strip, Tm is the measured temperature, αAm is the coefficient describing the heat transfer between the aluminium surface and sensor, A is the sensor contact area, (ρcV)m is the thermal capacitance of the sensor, and Q1 is heat flow from the sensor to the silicone layer and graphite installation support. Defining the thermocouple time constant ( ρ cV ) m as t m = , eqn. (18) can be rearranged to express surface temperature α Am A measurement error: dT q (TA − Tm ) = t m m + 1 . (19) dt α Am Time derivatives of the measured temperature were calculated with the first order central difference scheme. The thermocouple time constant tm was determined in separated test runs to be 3 s and should be the same for the all measurement runs, as well as the fitting coefficient αAm. The heat flux from measurement sensor to the silicone layer q1 was calculated using the equations describing the response of a semi-infinite solid to a step input of heat flux q1 at the surface of the silicone layer [6]. Subtracting the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
42 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII temperature variation at the surface between the sensor and silicone layer from temperature variation at silicone layer depth lSl with temperature TG gives the expression for variation of q1: (Tm − TG ) k Si q1 = (20) 1 − τ 1 τ lSi 1 − e + erfc
π
τ
where TG is measured temperature at the back of the graphite support block with 4κ t the same kind of the thermocouple as Tm, τ = 2Sl is the dimensionless time for lSl the silicone layer of thickness lSl and of thermal diffusivity κ Sl =
k Sl
ρ Sl cSl
. ρSl, c Sl,
and V Sl are density, specific heat and volume of the silicone layer, respectively. 3.1 Experimental results The difference between the actual and measured temperature of the cast aluminium strip surface, TA-Tm, is calculated with eqn. (19) for four measurement runs at the same process parameters and shown in fig. 4 in dependence of the sensor installation support starting temperature (runs #30 and #32: 50°C; runs #31 and #33: 210 °C). At the beginning, the differences are the largest, from 10 to 22 K, and are falling to 2.5 K in all runs at the end of the measurement, which was limited to about 1.9 m or 90 s. In fig. 5, the measured, Tm, and the actual, TA, time dependent strip surface temperatures are shown for two runs. It is evident, that TA, calculated with eqn. (19), is independent of Tm starting temperature. 25 run #30 run #31 run #32 run #33
TA-Tm [K]
20
15
10
5
0 0
Figure 4:
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1 x [m]
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
Difference between measured and actual strip surface temperature, spatial coordinate.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
43
350 300
T [°C]
250 200 150
Tm run #32 Tm run #33 TA run #32
100
TA run #33
50 -20 -10
Figure 5:
0
10
20
30 40 t [s]
50
60
70
80
Measured and actual strip surface temperature, time coordinate. 350 run #30 run #31 run #32 run #33 model
340
T [°C]
330
320
310
300 0
Figure 6:
4
0.2
0.4
x [m]
0.6
0.8
1
Comparison of the simulated and measured strip surface temperature in four runs.
Experimental validation of the model
Results of the predicted temperature field of the cast aluminium strip crosssection were compared with the measured temperature on the upper side in the middle of the cast strip surface. Standard deviation of TA for all runs is 1.3 K. Fig. 6 shows good agreement between simulation and measurements with maximum discrepancy of 6 K near the cooling rolls. Comparison indicates overestimation of the convection heat transfer between strip and surrounding air, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
44 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII and need for the radiation heat transfer consideration between cold rolls and strip surface, which has large influence on strip cooling in the vicinity of the rolls.
5
Conclusion
The meshless Local Radial Basis Function Collocation Method (LRBFCM) was used for estimation of the process parameters influence on the temperature field in the industrial twin-roll continuous casting aluminium alloy strip in the simulation of heat transfer from the strip. The model can consider influence of various process parameters on the temperature of the cast strip, which determines its properties. Simulation results were in good agreement with in situ measurements during the production process with the developed measurement technique. In addition, the experimental results gave important information for the model improvement, especially at the definition of the boundary conditions. Mounting three or five temperature sensors in a row and positioning the thermocouples on the same spots on the upper and the lower cast strip surface will represent next steps in development of the presented measurement technique, which will enable measurement of the possible temperature gradient in the width and the transverse sections of the cast strip, which could be responsible for inhomogeneous material structure and consecutive, difficulties at further strip processing.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5]
[6]
D. G. Altenpohl, Aluminum: Technology, Applications, and Environment: a Profile of a Modern Metal, Aluminium Association & TMS, 1998. T. Saitoh, H. Hojo, H. Yaguchi and C.K. Kang, Two dimensional model for twin roll continuous casting”, Metallurgical Transactions, 20B, pp.381-390 1989. B. Šarler, R. Vertnik & S. Šaletić, Solution of the thermal model of the twin-roll casting process by the meshless local radial basis function collocation technique. Computational methods for coupled problems in science and engineering, eds. M. Papadrakakis, E. Onate & B. Schrefler, Barcelona: International Center for Numerical Methods in Engineering (CIMNE), 2005. B. Šarler & R. Vertnik, Meshfree explicit radial basis function collocation method for diffusion problems, Computers and Mathematics with Applications, 51, pp. 1269-1282, 2006. R. Vertnik & B. Šarler, Meshless local radial basis function collocation method for convective-diffusive solid-liquid phase change problems, International Journal of Numerical Methods for Heat and Fluid Flow, 16, pp. 617-640, 2006. B. Lawton & G. Klingerberg, Transient Temperature in Engineering and Science, Oxford University Press, 1996.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
45
A newly developed test rig for the study of thermal fatigue M. Fazarinc, R. Turk, G. Kugler & M. Terčelj Department of Materials and Metallurgy, Faculty of Natural Sciences and Engineering, University of Ljubljana, Aškerčeva cesta 12, 1000 Ljubljana, Slovenia
Abstract For simulation and better study of thermal fatigue, a new test rig has been developed. The rig has computer guided heating and quenching of the specimen that enables constant thermal loading and gathering of reliable experimental data. At the same maximal testing temperature it is possible to generate different and higher temperature gradients in comparison to other tests. The cooling rates that were measured were almost 4000 °C/s, which is considerably higher than the known rates so far measured (calculated) in cases of thermal fatigue cases (500– 1000 °C) and thus fewer cycles to crack nucleation were needed. Verification of the abilities of the rig was carried out with specimens (AISI H11 tool steel) which had different wall thicknesses (2.75–4 mm) and different surface qualities (heat treated and gas nitrided). The gas nitrided specimens exhibited lower thermal fatigue resistance. The shape of cracks was a grid, which is a typical characteristic of tools subjected to thermal fatigue (tools for hot forming of materials, etc.). Some specimens were additionally mechanically loaded and cracks that were at right-angles to the direction of the compression force were essentially detained; their nucleation and growth were suppressed. The measured temperatures in the surface layer were used to calculate the initial stress field using the Finite Element Method (FEM). The computed results matched well with the experimental data on the number of cycles needed for crack initiation. Keywords: test rig, thermal fatigue, tool steel AISI H11, FEM analysis.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070051
46 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Thermal shock and/or fatigue resistance are very important characteristics of a material. The laboratory test rig (equipment) for their evaluation must be capable of carrying out such tests at various temperatures and have the capability, at the same testing temperature, to generate various temperature (stress) fields in order to better evaluate the usage of materials for a specific application. The tests that can be found in the literature cannot fulfil the above mentioned tasks satisfactorily. Poor knowledge of the temperature field within the specimen and consequently also poor knowledge of the stress/strain field results in an inaccurate estimation of the influence of parameters that are responsible for the nucleation and growth of cracks. In the past years an increased demand for improvement experimental data for better numerical modelling of crack growth can be found in the literature. Quenching in water is a very popular method to measure of thermal shock or thermal fatigue resistance but it has some weaknesses due to the unknown (unstable) heat transfer coefficient as a consequence of the vaporisation of water in the vicinity of the tested specimen surface [1–4]. Some authors designed special nozzles in order to minimize the effect of water vaporisation [5]. Marsh [6], Amiabe et al. [4] and Hadder and Fissolo [7] applied the so-called SPLASH test that also utilises water quenching of samples to generate temperature fields. Although they made great progress in modelling of crack growth on the basis of the experimental data further experimental improvements in this research area are desired. Therefore the goal of this paper was to present a new test rig for better evaluation of thermal shock or thermal fatigue resistance of materials. This test rig enables generation of high thermal stress with well defined thermal boundary conditions which allows the study of the temperature and thermal stress distribution in order to better evaluate the thermal shock or fatigue resistance of the tested material. An especially desirable characteristic of the test should have be the ability to generate various stress fields in the tested sample at the same maximal temperature.
2
Experimental set-up
2.1 Test rig and testing parameters For obtaining reliable test date it is of a great importance that the test is computer controlled and thus highly repeatable. Thus it was found helpful to carry out the tests on a thermo-mechanical simulator of metallurgical states, the Gleeble 1500D, in order to utilize the possibility of computer guided resistance heating of specimens and movement of the working jaws, simultaneously. The main idea was that the specimens would be rapidly heated to the maximum holding temperature and then the surface would be quenched with water. It was estimated that the cracks would form earlier than in 1000 cycles (for tool steel); this would shorten the testing time of a given specimen.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
47
Circular and hollow shaped specimens were applied for testing (Figure 1). The thermocouple (type K) needed for temperature control and guidance was welded inside the specimen in the middle of its testing area, as shown on Figure 1. The outer testing part of the specimen was placed in a cooling chamber (Figure 2). The cooling and emptying process was optimized by a pair of magnetic computer controlled valves. One valve controlled the water quench and the other controlled the air compression to empty the cooling chamber. The valves were guided using the Gleeble 1500D control computer that was programmed simultaneously with the program for thermal and mechanical loading of the specimen.
Figure 1:
Figure 2:
Cross section of the testing specimen with welded wires.
The cooling chamber with water cooled clamps.
The setup of the test rig, without working jaws, is shown in Figure 3a and it’s positioning in the Gleeble load cell is shown in Figure 3b. For proving the test’s abilities of the test rig, nine different specimens (made from AISI H11 tool steel) with various characteristics given in Table 1 were tested. Two different types of specimens were compared, i.e. five were heat treated (I - IV and IX, initial microstructure on Figure 4a) and four were heat treated plus gas nitrided (V - VIII, initial microstructure on Figure 4b). Further, the specimens differed also in specimen thickness (2.75 - 4 mm). Two specimens of each mentioned types were also mechanically loaded during testing by applying a compression force (0-19kN) equal to 90% of the yield stress at 650°C corresponding to a value around 150MPa. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
48 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The program used for thermal and mechanical loading (see Figure 5 a-b) of the specimen was written in the applicative program QuickSim and was composed in following way: - resistance heating of the sample to the holding temperature of 650°C with increasing mechanical loading (0 to 19kN, see Figure 5 a-b), - water quenching (0-0.50s) during maintenance of the programmed temperature and mechanical loading, - interruption of heating and quenching (and mechanical unloading), - blowing of compressed air into the chamber (3s). After 500 cycles the tested surface was examined visually and after 1000 cycles the specimens were cut and metallographically prepared for microscopic analysis. Table 1: Surface treatment Specimen Thickness Tmax (°C) Fmax (kN)
a)
Characteristics of specimens (AISI H11) and loadings (thickness [mm]). Heat treated I II 2.75 3.25 650 0
Heat treated III IV 2.75 3.25 650 -19.0
H.T. + nitrided V VI 2.75 3.25 650 0
H.T. + nitrided VII VIII 2.75 3.25 650 -19.0
Heat treated IX 4 650 0
b)
Figure 3:
a)
a) Testing device with specimen, b) Inserted test rig in testing cell.
b)
Figure 4:
Microstructure a) Heat treated specimens, b) Nitrided specimens.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Temp. Force
600
-12
heating strat cycle period
400
700
-16 -14
quenching finish
500
-18
-10
300
-8
200
-6
100
-4
Temperature [°C]
Temperature [°C]
600
Force [kN]
Quenching start
700
49
TC1(C)
500 400 300 200 100
-2
0
0 0
180
185
190
195
200
205
Time [s]
a) Figure 5:
quench strart
600
800
1000
1200
1400
500
quench finish
1,0 mm
450 400 350
0,7 mm
300
0
Cooling rate [°C/s]
Temperature [°C]
400
Time [s]
0.3 mm 0.7 mm 1.0 mm 2.75 mm
600
2,75 mm
250 200
200
a) The thermal and mechanical loading in one cycle, b) 50 temperature cycles.
650
550
0
b)
0,3 mm
150
-1000
-2000
-3000
-4000
100 87.5
88.0
88.5
a)
89.0
89.5
90.0
90.5
91.0
91.5
92.0
Figure 6:
86
b)
Time [s]
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
Time [s]
a) Measured temperatures at different depths during the quenching sequence, b) Cooling rate at the depth of 0.30 mm. 700
500
Temperature gradient 600
Temperature [°C]
480
∆T [°C]
460
440
420
Temperature profile 500
400
300
200
400 100
0.1
0.2
a)
0.4
Quenching time [s]
Figure 7:
3
0.3
0.5
0.0
0.6
0.5
b)
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
Thickness [mm]
a) Measured minimal temperature (temperature profile) in various depths at quenching time of 0.5s, b) Measured temperature gradient in the specimen at various quenching times.
Results
3.1 Measurements of temperature in the specimen A typical example of a thermal and mechanical cycle is shown in Figure 5a. The simultaneous increasing of temperature and mechanical loading of the tested WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
50 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII specimen is visible, while during quenching both of them maintain the programmed (same) value. The repetitiveness of the testing cycles obtained is presented on Figure 5b. The temperature of the specimen was controlled by the thermocouple, as presented in Figure 1. In order to determine (measure) the temperature field on the tested surface, a specially made specimen was applied in which inside had welded three additional highly responsive thermocouples (wire diameter 0.2 mm, type K) on various distances (0.30 mm, 0.70 mm, 1 mm) bellow quenched surface, while the fourth thermocouple (Figure 1) served for computer guidance and control of temperature. Their measured values are shown in Figure 6a. It is apparent that the temperature of the fourth and computer guided thermocouple remained at the programmed value of 650 °C also during quenching. After the quenching period the temperature fall of the fourth thermocouple was higher in comparison to the third thermocouple, since the heat transfer on the outer surface in the hollow specimen is also higher. The highest temperature gradient was registered at the quenching time of 0.5s where the measured temperature difference between the first and the fourth thermocouple was 473°C. The cooling rate was determined by differentiating the temperature/time curve at the depth of 0.30 mm from the quenched surface. Using this technique the maximum cooling rate was determined (3918 °C/s, Figure 6b). At the specimen surface these rates were certainly higher. Thus with a combination of simultaneously controlled cooling and resistance heating of the specimen, greater thermal gradients in relatively thin specimen surface layer were achieved, while the remaining depth of the specimen kept approximately the same value (see Figures 5a and 6a). This reduced the number of cycles needed for crack nucleation and resulted in faster crack growth. For comparison Hadder and Fissolo [7] and Marsh [6] report cooling rates between 500 and 1000 °C/s. The minimal measured temperature for the first thermocouple and various quenching times (0.1 - 0.55 s) are shown in Figure 7a while Figure 7b shows the temperature profile (field) in the tested specimen at a quenching time of 0.5s. With the possibility of generation of various thermal gradient, the test can also simulate various thermal loading conditions in an applicative environment. 3.2 Estimation of initial stress field by FEM When the entire temperature profile was known the FEM was applied in order to estimate initial stress field (thermal stress) for different quenching times and specimen thicknesses. The MSC Super Forge 2005 code was used for this. The results of these analyses are shown in Figure 8 a-b. The analyses show that the maximum stresses are obtained after 0.5s of quenching and are roughly 140 MPa for a specimen thickness of 2.75 mm. At 0.12s of quench time the stresses reached the values around 125 MPa. This shows that the temperature and consequently the stress field can be varied by changing the quenching time. The stress obtained also depends on specimen thickness; thus they reached values of cca 160 MPa and 175 MPa for specimen thicknesses of 3.25 mm and 4 mm, respectively. Furthermore the temperature can be varied by changing the quenching liquid (nitrogen, air, etc) and changing its pressure. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
a)
51
b)
Figure 8:
Estimated stress field simulated by FEM method, a) t = 0.12 s, b) t = 0.5s; wall thickness 2.75 mm, T = 650 °C.
3.3 Appearance of surface cracking From the estimated stress field it could be predicted that cracks would appear in thicker specimens sooner than in thinner specimens. The next batch of pictures were taken by an optical microscope after 1000 cycles of testing. The results are given in sequences according to thickness. 3.3.1 Wall thickness 2.75 mm Estimated initial maximal stresses for the wall thickness of 2.75 mm were namely around 140 MPa that is lower as yield stress of AISI H11 tool steel at 650 °C (cca 150 MPa). This fact explain why on heat treated no cracks occurred but on contrary on gas nitrided specimens network of cracks was observed after 1000 cycles; the depth of obtained crack was in range 20 - 60 µm (Figure 9).
Figure 9:
Appearance of surfaces of nitrided specimens after 1000 cycles, axially unloaded specimen; quenching time 0.5s, thickness 2.55 mm, radial cross-section.
3.3.2 Wall thickness 3.25 mm The next batch of pictures was taken on nitrided specimens after 1000 cycles where the thickness of the specimens was 3.25mm. Estimated maximal stress using the FEM wall thickness of the specimen 3.25 mm amounted around WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
52 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 160MPa. Consequently the cracks appearing were deeper and denser. Figure 10a shows the surface of nitrided specimen after 1000 cycles. The cracks here are clearly visible and they are appearing in both directions (radial and axial). As expected, the axial loading of the specimen restricted the nucleation of cracks in the radial direction. The maximal compression force during cooling was 19 MN corresponding cca 140 MPa. Thus it means that maximal stresses in axial direction of the specimen were close to zero and consequently no cracks appeared in the radial direction (Figure 10b). The depths of the obtained cracks in the radial direction for an axially unloaded specimen are presented on Figure 11a and for an axially loaded specimen on Figure 11b. The crack depth obtained was cca 180 µm in the radial direction and cca 120 µm in the axial direction. The same phenomenon also occurred on heat treated specimen, only the depth of the cracks were lower (cca 20-30 µm).
a)
b)
Figure 10:
Appearance of surface of nitrided specimens after 1000 cycles, a) Axially unloaded specimen, b) Axially loaded, ← direction of axial loading; quenching time 0.3 s, and thickness 3.25 mm.
b)
a) Figure 11:
Cross-section of nitrided specimen of axially loaded nitrided specimens, a) Axial section, b) Radial section; quenching time 0.3s, wall thickness 3.25 mm.
3.3.3 Wall thickness 4 mm As was expected denser cracks were obtained in thicker specimen and at a quenching time of 0.5s since the estimated maximal stress (for the specimen thicknesses of 4.0 mm) amounted around 170 MPa. On Figure 12 a-b the cracks WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
53
network on heat treated specimen is visible. Mentioned cracks were visible still after 500 quenching cycles and after 1000 quenching cycles the crack net obtained was denser. The depth of the cracks was around 40 µm. 3.3.4 Discussion The test enables us to vary all important parameters which influence the experimental results. These are the heating rate, maximum specimen temperature, quenching time, quenching medium, pressure of the quenching medium, specimen wall thickness, and the external specimen loading (tensile compressive, cyclic - constant). The appearance of cracks on tested specimen was very similar to those obtained on a hot working surface of rolls as presented on Figure 13. Namely, after its contact with heated specimen the roll surface is subjected to rapid water cooling leading to surface cracking. In the literature we can find contradictory result regarding to the thermal fatigue resistance of some nitrided surfaces. Thus Pellizari et al. [8] claim that nitrided surfaces decreased the fatigue resistance on the contrary Spies et al. [9] claim that the nitrided surface increased fatigue resistance. The authors did not present the temperature field and consequently they also could not calculate (asses) the stress field (predominately tensile or compression stresses) on the tested specimens from which the reason for the appearance of cracks based. Therefore, different results should be carefully compared according to the specific test conditions.
a)
b)
Figure 12:
Appearance of the surface of heat treated specimens, a) After 500 cycles, b) After 1000; axially unloaded specimen, quenching time 0.5s, wall thickness 4 mm, heat treated.
Figure 13:
Appearance of cracks on the surface of hot roll.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
54 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
Conclusions
A new thermal fatigue test was developed for testing materials. It is based on computer guided heating and quenching of the specimen. The specific shape of the specimen and special execution of the program enables the achievement of very high temperature gradients that are greater than those found in the literature. This reduces the number of cycles needed for crack nucleation and enables shorter testing times. In combination with mechanical loading different stress states on specimens can be achieved (mechanical pre-loading of forging tools, etc.). The test can generate a wide range of conditions to which the real parts can be subjected. Calculation of the stress field using the FEM showed the highest stresses in the thicker walls of the specimen. Thus on specimens with thicker walls and longer cooling times, the cracks nucleated earlier and are denser. A comparison of two differently treated materials (heat treated or heat treated + gas nitrided) showed that the nitrided layer is brittle and rapidly cracks under tensile thermal stresses. The newly developed test with its proven characteristics will contribute to better understanding of crack nucleation and their growth. This is the basis for better modelling of the processes involved.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9]
A. Weroński, T. Hejwowski, Thermal fatigue of metals, Marcel Dekker 1991. N. Hadder, A. Fissolo, V. Maillot, Thermal fatigue crack networks: a computational study, International Journal of Solids and Structures 42 (2005) 771-788. A. Persson, S. Hogmark, J. Bergström, Simulation and evaluation of thermal fatigue cracking of hot work tool steel, International Journal of Fatigue 26 (2004) 1095-1107. S. Amiable, S. Chapuliot, A. Constantinescu, A. Fissolo, A comparison of life time prediction methods for a thermal fatigue experiment, International Journal of Fatigue, 28 (2006) 692-706. J. Absi, J.C. Glandus, Improved methods for severe thermal shocks testing of ceramics by water quenching, Journal of European Ceramic society 24 (2004) 2835-2838. D.J. Marsh, A thermal shock fatigue study of type 304 and 316 stainless steels, Fatigue of Engineering Materials and Structures, 4/2 (1981) 179195. N. Hadder, A. Fissolo, 2D simulation of the initiation and propagation of crack array under thermal fatigue, Nuclear Engineering and Design 235 (2005) 945-964. M. Pellizzari, A. Molinari, G. Straffelini, Thermal fatigue resistance of gas and plasma nitrided 41CrAlMo7 steel, Materials Science & Engineering A352 (2003) 186-194. H.J. Spies, F. Vogt, M. Svennson, Neue Hütte 8 (1983) 281-287.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
55
Numerical simulation with flow feature extraction of a propeller turbine unsteady rotor-stator interaction J.-M. Gagnon & C. Deschênes Hydraulic Machinery Laboratory, Laval University, Canada
Abstract We have seen many papers in the past few years reporting research on Francis hydraulic turbine flow. Interesting papers assessing the accuracy of the CFD numerical simulation were also presented for axial turbine draft tubes, as in the three Turbine 99 workshops. However, little knowledge is available on the flow taking place inside an axial turbine. This paper focuses on the unsteady rotor-stator interaction in a propeller axial turbine. The flow behaviour is analysed at different rotor and stator relative locations with numerical simulations using a commercial code and k-ε turbulence model. The main goal is to study unsteady flow phenomena such as wake, separation, forces and pressure fluctuations in the propeller turbine. This investigation will help to design a series of flow measurements used in turn to improve future CFD simulations with realistic velocity profiles as boundary conditions. Keywords: propeller turbine, numerical simulation, blade torque, partial load.
1
Introduction
Low head power plants are expected to be implemented increasingly in the future for economical, geographical and environmental purposes. Propeller turbines are well suited for these types of applications. They operate at higher flow rate, smaller head and faster rotational speed, thus being more compact than other types of machines. The US Department of Energy (DOE) is anticipating major growth for low head power plants [1] and studies such as Turbine 99 [2] or the work of Roussopoulos and Muntean [3, 4] show research trends on axial hydraulic machine. On a global perspective, optimization of size and weight WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070061
56 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII towards highly compact system has led researchers to seek for a better understanding of fluid dynamic and unsteady effects. In turbomachinery applications, the interaction of stationary guide vanes and rotating runner may be considered as the source of unsteady phenomena. Rotor-stator interactions taking place in turbines may be harmful for blades and surrounding systems as they induce pressure pulsations and torque variations on runner blades [5, 6]. Fluctuations of the velocity field between the rotating and stationary parts also contribute to unsteadiness. Extensive literature is available on this subject for Francis turbines, pumps and pump-turbines. In [7], Page et al. analyse the time-averaged relative velocity profile and pressure fluctuations on a pump impeller outlet and a Francis turbine. Vu and Nennemann [8] have shown a method to analyse unsteady interactions in a Francis turbine using torque fluctuations and pressure spectrum. The unsteady torque on guide vanes pitching axis of a pump turbine in pump mode was predicted by Lipej et al. [9]. Recently, blade cracking and power plant failure were reported and due to the high dynamic stress of wicket gates and runner interaction [10]. In numerical simulation, Ruprecht et al. [11, 12] showed parallel computation capabilities to simulate a complete Francis Turbine including rotor-stator unsteady hydrodynamic effect. Performance of an in-house code to study the flow in an axial turbine with unequal pitch ratio was also addressed. We can also gather great amounts of information on rotor-stator interaction and flow features inside axial turbines or compressors from the aerodynamic field. Basic phenomena such as separation, wake and secondary flows are similar when there is no shock and Mach number stay below 0.3. In this avenue, Zaccaria and Lakshminaryana [13] have exposed an extensive review of phenomena taking place in axial air turbine with an experimental investigation of the flow. The present paper focuses on 3-D Navier-Stokes simulations of the flow in a propeller turbine using the commercial code ANSYS CFX. Three operating regimes near the best efficiency point are studied. Numerical methods are first detailed and then results from both steady and unsteady computations are analysed. Relevant quantities as torque on blades and pressure fluctuations are investigated, as well as wake characteristics behind guide vanes. This research is carried out within the new Canadian Consortium in Axial Hydraulic Turbine taking place at Laval University, Quebec. Figure 1 illustrates a cut plane of the hydraulic propeller turbine along with future measurement access.
2
Experimental overview
Numerical simulations begin with the definition of different geometries of the domain and interfaces. This step allows us to look forward for the experimental setup that will be used to validate numerical results. Optical accesses for PIV and LDV measurements will be installed on critical regions, where the velocity and pressure fields need to be known to improve numerical simulations. CAD drawings are also used to help locating the calibration plate for PIV inside the distributor and for inter-blade PIV. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
57
Optical access 1
PIV/LDV
Optical access 2
Optical access 3,4
PIV/LDV Figure 1:
3
Cut plane of the hydraulic turbine with planned measurement concept.
Computational methods
We consider an incompressible unsteady 3-D turbulent flow in a single rotorstator passage of the model scale propeller turbine. RANS equations are used in combination with the k-ε turbulence model and scalable wall functions accounting for unequal wall cells sizes and y+ in the boundary layer calculation. The main advantage is to allow uses of coarser or finer mesh sizes and different turbulence models without having to remesh the whole boundary layer around runner blades and guide vanes. We use an advection scheme switching locally from a first order upwind differencing scheme to a second order scheme when necessary. Solver robustness is thus increased and convergence accelerated. 3.1 Interface definition and analysis Several interfaces were used to connect stationary and moving meshes for steady and unsteady calculations. First, we estimated mesh performance and torque on the runner blade with a steady simulation averaging the circumferential velocity at the interface (Stage simulation). Since the effect of circumferential velocity is filtered through the averaging operation, it makes possible the use of a partial stator passage having only one guide vane and one stay vane instead of four. Total numbers of blades and guide vanes is respectively 6 and 24 for the whole machine, giving even pitch ratios. Other types of simulations were performed using a Frozen rotor for steady calculations and a Transient Rotor-Stator interface for unsteady calculations. Frozen rotor simulation cases were used as initial conditions for unsteady calculations. Figure 2 below shows interfaces definition: on the left with a stator pitch angle of 15 degrees in the azimutal plane for stage calculation and on the right with 60 degrees rotor-stator passage.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
58 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 60
15q Rotor interface
60q rotor periodicity
60q
Stay vanes
Rotor blade
Guide vanes
Axis b)
a)
Simulation domain and interface a) 15° stator - 60° rotor b) 60° rotor/stator.
Figure 2:
coarser
+
+ coarse
Figure 3:
medium
+
fine
+
Torque in function of cells number (left), y+ distribution on blade and guide vanes walls (top and bottom right).
3.2 Mesh independence We performed a mesh independence test to evaluate what size of mesh is needed for the type of flow phenomena which is analysed. In our case, the runner blade torque is the quantity investigated since it is directly linked to unsteady pressure fluctuations. Four mesh sizes were compared against computed torque values to ensure mesh independence. Figure 3 shows normalized runner blade torque in WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
59
function of number of mesh elements (on left). Comparison of y+ distribution for different mesh sizes was also done on guide vanes and runner blade walls. The lowest blade normalized torque value of 1.05 corresponding to the coarse mesh computation gives the best computed torque compared to experimental data. However, having a look at the right figures, this mesh exceeds the recommended maximum y+ value of 200 on the runner blade. This may lead to poor boundary layer calculations. Therefore the medium grid of 1000k elements has been chosen for all calculations at peak, partial and overload conditions to fulfil the solver boundary requirement. Note that no calculations got closer to 5% of the experimental torque value, leaving place for numerical simulation improvement.
4
Rotor-Stator interaction analysis
Unsteady rotor-stator interactions may be attributed to instantaneous pressure fluctuations. Wakes building along the boundary layer of stay vanes and guide vanes of the distributor are other unsteady phenomena which may be considered. These flow phenomena are weaker in intensity and reflect higher harmonics on the frequency spectrum. Results from steady state simulation using a Frozen rotor interface are presented in this section for wake interaction. Dissipation of the wake is investigated with the following indicators: the turbulent kinetic energy, the vorticity and the velocity profile. Figure 4 shows contours of turbulent kinetic energy and vorticity in a blade-to-blade view for three operating regimes. Here, α* is the normalized opening guide vane angle equal to the ratio of the actual opening angle to the angle corresponding to the best efficiency point, α/αpeak. Note that the flow velocity, U∞, changes direction across interfaces accounting for rotation terms in N.-S. equations. Figure 4 presents two periodic profiles having a total of eight guide vanes and two runner blades. The blade-to-blade planes of cases shown in Figure 4a) are located at low span, near the shroud, to capture the small gap between guide vanes and runner blades. From the contours, we can distinguish a slight increase in k across the interface with increasing guide vane opening (from left to right, light grey contour). At overload condition (α* = 1.15, top right), the contour of k almost reaches the blades and may indicate the possibility of wake interaction with runner blades. The level of wake kinetic energy is low for all cases and around 0.03 m2/s2. In figure 4b), the slice is at mid span and one can see that wakes behind guide vanes and runner blades induces regions of high radial vorticity (dark contour). The vorticity intensity is kept high across the interface and propagates until it reaches runner blades surfaces for all cases. A further investigation of these steady state calculations gives insight about how far gradients of velocity are convected into the rotor domain. In Figure 5, one can see a typical case of how velocity profiles on circular lines in the rotor-stator passage are gradually dissipated. Velocity gradients are dissipated up to 99% before reaching the blade at peak condition.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
60 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII D* =0.94
D* = 1
D* = 1.15
Interface position
Blade
Interface position
a)
k increase
G.v.
Uf
Uf
Uf
b)
Z
Figure 4:
Z
Z
Blade-to-blade contours of a) turbulent kinetic energy b) radial vorticity.
Line 1
Line 2 Line 3 Line 4
Figure 5:
Meridional velocity profiles along different streamwise stations in the rotor-stator passage.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
61
Unsteady rotor-stator analysis
Unsteady interactions of runner blades with stationary guide vanes have been studied by looking at the frequency spectrum of instantaneous force, torque and pressure signals over time at various locations. Figure 6 illustrates the time and frequency signal of drag force on each of the four guide vanes in the distributor.
Figure 6:
Guide vanes force for α*=1 with signal in time (top) and frequency spectra (bottom).
Fluctuations of instantaneous forces on the guide vanes are about 5% of the average force. The peak on the frequency spectrum corresponds to the blade passing frequency, fb = Nb⋅ fω , where fω is the rotor frequency and Nb the number of blades. The phase shift between two adjacent force signals equals 2π/Ngv, where Ngv is the number of guide vanes. We investigated the instantaneous blade torque on the rotor side to assess the effect of transient interactions on the runner in the rotating frame of reference. In figure 7, the three operating regimes are shown with a FFT transform applied on the same amount of cycles for each torque signal. Amplitude peaks for all regimes correspond to the wicket gate passing frequency, fgv = Ngv⋅fω. Wake interactions have very small effects on the unsteady torque since there is no other peak at higher frequencies. Also, we see that the amplitude of the signal at overload condition (α* = 1.15) is higher than in the other cases confirming the fact that pressure fluctuations effects on blades and on other unsteady phenomena are increased as we move away from peak condition. Fluctuations of the torque are small and estimated about 0.3% of the time-averaged torque. To complete this analysis, we have evaluated the pressure signals from two points located very close to the interface at mid span. Figure 8 shows the time and frequency signals for these two points. Similar conclusions applied as for the torque and forces analysis and we see that pressure frequencies match with fb for the stator point and fgv for the rotor point. One can also find additional higher harmonics around 7 and 14 times fb (top axis, bottom left figure). These WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
62 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII harmonics are likely due to numerical noise rather than to unsteady interactions (wakes, von Karman vortices). Further investigations are needed to better understand the phenomenon. Pressure fluctuations around the time-averaged signals are about 2.4% and 0.5% respectively for the stator and the rotor points.
Figure 7:
Frequency spectra of torque on runner blades.
Higher harmonics
Figure 8:
6
Pressure time and frequency signal of two points situated close to the interface.
Conclusion
In this paper, we studied wakes and unsteady rotor-stator interactions for different operating regimes of a propeller turbine. The wake behind guide vanes is dissipating very fast. It is still unsure whether it has an effect on the rotorWIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
63
stator unsteady interactions since higher harmonics of the spectrum were not well defined. The main interaction is therefore attributed to the pressure field fluctuations. Peak amplitudes correlate with the runner frequency for all pressure related signals. Although it was found that unsteady forces, torque and pressure fluctuations were weak in amplitude compared to time-averaged values (below 5%), one must keep in mind that current computations were done at model scale. Same types of study on Francis turbine indicate that fluctuations might double at prototype scale. Finally, we are really looking forward the upcoming experimental phase to increase our knowledge and understanding of the propeller turbine flow.
Acknowledgements The authors would like to thank Hydro-Quebec and Alstom Hydro Canada Inc. for their financial and technical supports. Their contribution for turbine geometries and experimental model is of great importance to this research project. Richard Fraser, Maryse Page, Sebastien Houde and Michel Sabourin are also gratefully acknowledged for their time and devotion to the project.
References [1]
[2] [3]
[4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
Douglas, G. H., Kelly, S.R. (2006), Feasibility Assessment of the Water Energy Resources of the United States for New Low Power and Small Hydro Classes of Hydroelectric Plants, U.S. Department of Energy, DOEID-11263. Andersson U., Karlsson R. (1999), Quality aspects of the Turbine 99 draft tube experiments, Proceeding of Turbine 99 – workshop on draft tube flow, Technical report, Lulea University of Technology, Sweden. Roussopoulos K., Monkewitz P.A. (2000), Measurements of Tip Vortex Characteristics and the Effect of an Anti-Cavitation Lip on a Model Kaplan Turbine Blade, Flow, Turbulence and Combustion, Netherlands, vol. 64, p. 119-144. Muntean, S., Balint, D. (2006), Analytical representation of the swirling flow upstream the Kaplan turbine for variable guide vane opening, XXIII IAHR Symposium, Yokohama. Nennemann, B., Vu, T.C., Farhat, M. (2005), CFD prediction of unsteady wicket gate-runner interaction in Francis turbines: A new standard hydraulic procedure, Hydro 2005. Ciocan, G.D., Kueny, J.L. (2006), Experimental Analysis of Rotor-Stator Interaction in a Pump-Turbine, XXIII IAHR Symposium, Yokohama. Page, M. Théroux, E., Trépanier, J.-Y. (2004), Unsteady rotor-stator analysis of a Francis turbine, XXII IAHR Symposium on Hydraulic Machinery and System, Stockholm, Sweden. Vu, T.C., Nennemann, B. (2006), Modern trend of CFD application for hydraulic design procedure, XXIII IAHR Symposium, Yokohama.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
64 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Lipej, A., Jost, D., Meznar, P. (2006), Numerical analysis of rotor-stator interaction in a reversible pump-turbine – pump mode, XXIII IAHR Symposium, Yokohama. Coutu, A., Proulx, D., Coulson, S., Demers, A. (2004), Dynamic Assessment of Hydraulic Turbines, Proceedings of HydroVision 2004, Montreal, Quebec, Canada, August 16-20. Ruprecht, A., Heitele, M., Helmrich, T. (2000), Numerical Simulation of a Complete Francis Turbine including unsteady rotor/stator interactions, XX IAHR Symposium, Charlotte, North Carolina. Ruprecht, A., Bauer, C., Gentner, C., Lein, G. (1999), Parallel Computation of Stator-Rotor Interaction in an Axial Turbine, ASME PVP Conference, CFD Symposium, Boston. Zaccaria, M. and Lakshminarayana B. (1997), An experimental investigation of steady and unsteady flow field in an axial flow turbine, NASA contractor report; 4778, National Aeronautics and Space Administration.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
65
Computer and experimental study of the gate dielectric in a memory transistor R. Avichail-Bibi1, D. Fuks1, A. Kiv1 & Ya. Roizin2 1 2
Ben-Gurion University of the Negev, Israel Tower Semiconductor Ltd., Israel
Abstract We demonstrate a novel approach that enables combining microscopic studies of the behaviour of the injected charge (IC) in the gate dielectric (GD) of the memory transistor and the description of kinetics of memory device service parameters. To study the microscopic processes of the redistribution of the IC in the GD a special package of programs was developed that allows the modelling the migration of injected electrons and holes in the GD. The model accounts real properties of dielectric (spatial distribution of local centres and their characteristics, the dielectric constant and its changes on the microscopic distances, a complex composition of dielectric, temperature conditions and the geometry of the GD). The results of the computer simulation of microscopic characteristics of the IC were used as input data for the commercial Device simulation program "Medici". We found a correlation between microscopic characteristics of IC in GD and the service parameters of the memory device and realized the feedback procedure changing the GD characteristics in the simulation model. Keywords: memory transistor, gate dielectric, trapping mechanisms, molecular dynamics, computer simulation.
1
Introduction
The NROM (nitride read only memories) are non-volatile memories with local storage of charge at the edges of the memory transistor channel and a thick (>35 Å) bottom oxide (BOX) [1] that became popular in the nonvolatile semiconductor memory market. A ONO (SiO2-Si3N4-SiO2) stack with nontunnel bottom oxide is the GD in a two-bit per cell memory transistor. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070071
66 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Information is stored as the charges injected into the Nitride at the channel edges of the memory transistor. Programming is performed by channel hot electrons. Holes, created by band-to-band tunneling in the drain region erase the programmed bit [1–3]. The device is read out in the “reverse” direction compared to programming. These memories are free of the limited retention and high read disturb of the previous SONOS generations having thin (~20 Å) BOX. Properties of traps are especially important in NROM devices because the reliability performance of these memories is to a great extent determined by the lateral migration of the charge trapped in the silicon nitride layer [2]. Reliable values of trap parameters in silicon nitride, in particular the trap activation energy, can be found from device measurements, as well as the effects related to BOX can be distinguished from those connected with silicon nitride properties. Despite numerous experimental data on traps collected for different types of silicon nitride, the chemical nature of traps in a Si3N4 remains unclear. This is why the phenomenological description and computer simulation of trapping processes in Si3N4 stack is of great interest. In [4] a new approach in Molecular Dynamics (MD) simulation is described. It allowed the study of real physical processes in the GD of memory device and the prediction of its retentionendurance characteristics. Retention of microFLASH® memory transistors is characterized by the stability of the programmed and erased state threshold voltages (Vt). The Vt shift of the programmed state of the device after cycling (a series of programmingerase (P/E) operations) is experimentally controlled after high temperature bakes. The Vt shift of the programmed state is sometimes called a high temperature, HT Vt shift. The second type of Vt shift characterizes the erased state of the device after cycling. This shift has weak temperature dependence and is called room temperature, RT Vt shift. HT and RT Vt shifts determine the operation margins of the memory cell [5]. Analysis of time dependences of HT Vt shift (∆Vt) shows two stages in its kinetics: “fast” Vt shift and “slow” Vt shift. The “fast” Vt shift depends on the programming window ∆V = Vt high – Vt initial and is typically 50 mV – 300 mV for ∆V=1-3 V. At a temperature ~2000C the “fast” period of Vt decrease lasts several hours [14–16]. The “fast” relaxation period is followed by a “slow” Vt decrease process with high activation energy (~1.8eV) [6]. At the beginning of the relaxation process there is a limited decrease of Vt (~50-200 mV) even for the one-time programmed cell. Additional “fast” memory window loss (~250500mV) is observed after 1k-100k program-erase cycles [5–7]. It was found in [8] that at least for a small (<104) number of cycles the HT Vt shift is dominated by lateral spread of the charge carriers trapped in the nitride layer of ONO. For computer modelling of such processes we developed software that is suitable for the investigation of the following processes and phenomena: ♦
Migration of the carriers in the dielectric with different types of potential relief; WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
67
♦
Thermalization of hot carriers;
♦
Influence of internal and external fields on the migration of carriers;
♦
Influence of geometric factors on the redistribution of injected carriers in the GD.
♦
Influence of physical characteristics of the processes in the memory device on its service parameters.
The adequate physical model and a simulation approach are described in [4, 8]. In this paper we present additional considerations of the mechanisms of retention loss by memory devices.
2
Spreading of injected charge in ONO induced by Coulomb repulsion
2.1 Non-Gauss distribution of injected carriers in GD The original simulation program "Memory" [4, 8] was used to find real mechanisms of spreading of the IC in the GD. First, the diffusion profiles were studied for a wide range of the density of the IC and for a wide range of physical conditions in the GD. In these simulations the electrons or holes were injected from the bottom side into the horizontal ONO stack of ~150-200 Å length. The stack was divided into vertical slabs. The relative fraction of the IC with respect to their total number (n in %) was calculated in each slab that allowed construction of the distribution profile of IC. Dividing into thinner slabs gives possibility to visualize the fine structure of the distribution of the IC. We also varied the potential relief (PR) in dielectric, temperatures of carriers and of the ONO stack, types and spatial distribution of traps. Making use of the scaling down procedure for the IC profiles we were able to follow the behaviour of the IC in the spatial intervals on an atomic scale. The results displayed in Figs. 1 and 2 show that the distribution of carries is discontinuous. In Fig. 1b we observe sub-peaks located at difference distances from each other. The next significant fact is that the distance between the subpeaks does not depend on the temperature but depends on the density of the IC. The typical characteristic of IC profiles is the comparatively large charge droplets at some distances from the central peak. These charge clusters were named "parasitic peaks" (PP). Fig. 2 demonstrates the location of the profiles of the density distribution for the injected electrons and holes. Such a configuration of the density profiles for the injected charges corresponds to the erasing of the programmed state of the memory device. One can see in the right side of the distribution shown in Fig. 2 a separately located small sub-peak that corresponds to PP. Appearance of PP indicates clearly that the spreading of IC in the GD does not satisfy the Fick laws. We studied conditions of PP formation and found that they play a decisive role in mechanisms of retention loss by microFLASH® WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
68 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII memory transistors and determine the double-programming effect in the memory device [9]. Formation of PP allows also the explanation of the existence of two limits of scaling down of memory devices with high-k layers in the GD [10]. Fig. 2 demonstrates the situation when the spatial location of electron and hole distributions do not overlap. This leads to continuous accumulation of carriers in the injection region of the GD in conditions of cycling work of the device. The non-Gauss distribution of spreading IC decreases the efficiency of the erase processes because some PPs are located comparatively far form the IR. This is a source of the instability of the work of the device. Such a situation leads to the necessity to provide the optimal spatial and energy distribution of trapping and scattering centres in the GD and the optimal value of their density. The relation between densities of trapping and scattering centres is of crucial importance due to the important role of scattering centres in the thermalization of hot IC. 18
8
16 14
6
10
n, %
n, %
12
4
8 6
2
4 2 0
0 0
5
10
15
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
-1
80
90
100 110 120 130 140 150
b)
a) Figure 1:
70
d (Angstom)
d x 10 (Angstrom)
Two distribution profiles for injected electrons in the ONO stack of length 150 Å. The vertical slabs in ONO are of thickness a) 10 Å; b) 2 Å. d is the length in the ONO stack. 2.5
electrons holes
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0 0
20
40
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
200
d (Angstrom)
Figure 2:
The distribution profiles for injected electrons and holes in the ONO stack of length 200 Å.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
69
2.2 Kinetic features of spreading of injected carriers in ONO The dependence of charges that leave the IR during some time interval on the value of injected charges was determined using our simulation program Memory. A number of charges were put up in the IR. Then the time intervals (∆τi) between two nearest events of the IC leaving the IR were fixed. Simulation results show that the distribution of ∆τ is described by an exponential law. This means that elementary acts of the escape of the IC from the IR occur according to exponential kinetics. This allows one to assume that the number of spreading electrons ∆Q ~ Q, where Q is the number of injected electrons. Such a correlation determines the exponential dependence of Q on time, t. Proceeding from the obtained kinetics we used the correlation ∆Vt ~ Vt in the mathematical description of the kinetics of Vt shift in [8]. These correlations are confirmed by the results of device modelling using the program Medici [11] (See Fig. 3). In Fig. 3 the voltage-current (V-I) characteristics are shown for different values of charge injected into the GD. Analysis of these graphs shows the relation Q ~ Vt. Consequently, ∆Q is proportional to ∆Vt. The inclination of V-I characteristics decreases from the left to the right. The inclination dI/dV = 1/ ρ, where ρ is a specific resistance of the channel region of n-p-n transistor. Hence ρ increases in this direction. In this case the re-compensation of the channel region and the opening of the channel of the transistor demands larger Vt. Thus we see that from the one hand the simulation results obtained by our program Memory confirm the relation ∆Q ~ Q and from the other hand the Device simulation program Medici allows confirmation of the relation Q ~ Vt, and hence ∆Q ~ ∆Vt. These relations are used as a basis to derive the equation for the fast Vt shift in conditions of cycling [8, 12]. The results obtained by the program Medici are based on using the IC profiles obtained by the program Memory. Thus the non-Gauss profiles are accounted for in the device simulation by the program Medici. The device simulation results are consistent with experiment [13]. fresh cell Q=80 electrons Q=100 electrons Q=120 electrons Q=140 electrons Q=160 electrons Q=180 electrons
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
Gate voltage, Vg ( V)
Figure 3:
The voltage-current characteristics obtained with the program Medici for the fresh cell and for different numbers of IC.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
70 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Dependence of IC profiles on the features of potential relief in the GD
We performed simulation studies of the kinetics of spreading of the IC from the IR for different modifications of the potential relief (PR), in particular for different densities of traps in the GD. It was found that the activation energy for the carrier migration in the GD is an effective value and depends on the density of traps. This dependence becomes important for large densities of traps (more than 1020 traps/cm3 [14]. This is one reason that the results obtained by different authors in some cases do not coincide. The simulation study of the dependence of the activation energy on the density of traps up to 5·1021 traps/cm3 was performed. In the region of some critical density of traps N*traps ≈ 1020 traps/cm3 the PR sharply changes. The transformation of PR at Ntraps > N*traps was manifested by the significant increase of activation energy for carrier migration [15]. A strong dependence of the PR transformation on the degree of the overlapping of electron wave functions for the neighbor traps and on the value of potential wells of the individual traps was revealed. The overlapping of wave functions was modeled by changing the probability of tunneling between the nearest traps [4].
U=2.0eV U=2.5eV
0
1000
2000
3000
4000
Number of steps
Figure 4:
The kinetics of charge leaving the IR for the large number of traps: Ntraps > N*traps.
The increase of the depth of potential wells in PR of GD can be explained by formation of a strongly disordered PR as a result of the random overlapping of wave functions of neighboring trapped electrons. Thus we can suppose that in the case when Ntraps>N*traps the Anderson localization [16] occurs decreasing sharply the mobility of carriers. This effect leads to significant growth of the activation energy for carrier migration. Such a situation reveals itself in the fact that the kinetics of redistribution of the IC in the GD becomes independent on the activation energy of individual traps. Fig. 4 illustrates these results. One can WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
71
see that at the first steps of the simulation procedure the escape of some number of the IC from the IR occurs. After that we do not observe the redistribution of spreading IC. We see almost the same kinetics of the IC spreading for two different activation energies, U of individual traps (2 eV and 2.5 eV). These results show the way of the modification of the PR of the GD to achieve a stable distribution of the IC in the GD for a long time: it is necessary to create the disordered potential relief for electron migration with deep enough wells for Anderson localization. The next example of the influence of the features of PR on the kinetics of the IC in the GD is linked to the creation of high-k layers (HKL) in the boundary regions of the GD [10]. In the case of ONO with HKL at the late stage of baking (in simulation procedure after ~ 10000 steps) we observed a sharp increase of the fraction of spreading electrons that results in a large increase of Vt shift. At the interface between the HKL and the nitride a large density of traps exists. These local centres trap electrons that lead to formation of additional charge at the interface. The newly injected carriers scatter on these charges and begin to move in a lateral direction. Later the number of spreading electrons can decrease due to the effect of competition between the formation of located charges in PP and those in the interface traps of the nitride. In Fig. 5 we demonstrate the behaviour of retention parameters of the memory cell with HKL that hinders the penetration of 90% of the IC outward from the ONO stack. One can see that at the first stages the existence of HKL improved retention characteristics of the memory cell. At some stage of baking the non-monotonous behaviour of the retention characteristics of the ONO stack with HKL is seen. Analysis of simulation results leads to the conclusion that the properties of the traps in the bulk and in the interface region are really responsible for this effect. Consequently in the process of memory device exploitation the effect of the nonmonotonous kinetics of the retention characteristics of ONO memories with HKL can be expected. This effect depends also on the thickness of ONO (Fig. 6). with HKL without HKL
0
5000
10000
15000
20000
Number of steps
Figure 5:
Two kinetics of IC in ONO without HKL and with HKL.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
72 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The vertical axis in Fig. 6 presents the number of steps preceding the jump on the kinetic curve shown in Fig. 5 for the case of ONO with HKL. The number of steps that corresponds to an increase of charge loss from the IR for the given depth of the ONO stack is larger for the HKL with smaller "k". This means that two limits of scaling down a memory cell exist. The upper one is caused by intensive scattering of injected carriers on trapping centers located at the interface between HKL and the nitride. The lower one is linked to charge leakage caused by tunneling current. The problem that should be solved is how to decrease the interval between these two limits. The vertical axis in Fig. 6 presents the number of steps preceding the jump on the kinetic curve shown in Fig. 5 for the case of ONO with HKL. The number of steps that corresponds to an increase of charge loss from the IR for the given depth of ONO stack is larger for the HKL with smaller "k". This means that two limits of scaling down a memory cell exist. The upper one is caused by intensive scattering of injected carriers on trapping centers located at the interface between HKL and the nitride. The lower one is linked to charge leakage caused by the tunneling current. The problem that should be solved is how to decrease the interval between these two limits.
0000
1 2
8000
6000
4000
2000
0 80
100
120
140
160
Thikness of ONO stack (Angstrom)
Figure 6:
4
Influence of the quality of HKL on the possibility of scaling down of ONO stack. Graphs 1 and 2 correspond to HKL that hinders the ejection of 90% and 50% of IC from the ONO stack.
Conclusions
Novel software was used for simulation of physical processes responsible for Vt shift in a memory device. The proposed model of the GD accounts for both classical and quantum properties of the system. It was found that Coulomb repulsion determines the redistribution of the IC in the GD. As a result the nature of the Vt shift in cycled microFLASH® memory transistors is explained and the ways for improvement of their parameters are indicated. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
73
References [1] [2]
[3]
[4] [5]
[6] [7]
[8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14]
Eitan B., Pavan P., Bloom I., Aloni E., Frommer A. & Finzi D., NROM: A novel localized trapping, 2-bit nonvolatile memory cell IEEE Elec. Dev. Lett., 21, pp. 543-545, 2000. Roizin Y., Aloni E., Gutman M., Kairys V. & Zisman P., Retention characteristics of microFLASH® Memory, IEEE 2001 NVSMW, Monterey, CA, 2001. Gritsenko V. A., Svitasheva S. N., Petrenko I. P., Wong H., Xu J. B. & Wilson I. H., Study of Excess Silicon at Si3N4/Thermal SiO2 Interface Using EELS and Ellipsometric Measurements J. Electrochem. Soc. 146(2), pp. 780-785, 1999. Fuks D., Kiv A., Maximova T., Bibi R., Roizin Ya. & Gutman M., Computer model of the trapping media in microFLASH memory cells, Journal of Computer-Aided Materials Design, 9, pp. 21-32, 2002. Yen C., Tsai W. J. & Lu T. C., Novel operation Schemes to Improve Device Reliability in a Localized Trapping Storage SONOS-type FLASH Memory, Electron Devices Meeting, IEDM '03 Technical Digest. IEEE International, pp. 7.5.1-7.5.4, 2003. Roizin Y., Yankelevich A. & Netzer Y., Novel technique for data retention and Leff measurements in two bit microFLASH memory cells, AIP Proceedings, USA, pp. 181-185, 2001. Wang T., Tsai W. J., Gu S. H., Chan C. T., Yeh C. C., Zous N. K., Lu T. C., Pan S. & Lu C. Y., Reliability models of Data Retention and readDisturb in 2-bit Nitride Storage FLASH Memory Cells, Electron Devices Meeting, 2003, IEDM '03 Technical Digest. IEEE International, pp.7.4.17.4.4, 2003. Fuks D., Kiv A., Roizin Ya., Gutman M., Bibi R. & Maximova T., The nature of HT Vt shift in NROM memory transistors, IEEE Transactions on Electron Device, 53, pp. 304-313, 2006. Fuks D., Kiv A., Roizin Ya., & Gutman M., Computer simulation and experimental study of retention of SONOS device, Computational Electronics, 5, pp. 49-52, 2006. Avichail-Bibi R., Kiv A., Maximova T., Roizin Y. & Fuks D., Behavior of injected electrons in high-k dielectric layers, Materials Science in Semiconductor Processing, 9, pp. 985-988, 2006. MEDICI. User Guide, Version 2003.12. Synopsys, December 2003. Janai M., Data Retention, Endurance and Acceleration Factors of NROM Devices, IEEE International Reliability Physics Seminar, USA, pp. 502503, 2003. Zisman P., Roizin Ya. & Gutman M., Vt drift of cycled two bit per cell microFLASH cells, SSDM Proceedings, Tokyo, Japan, pp. 228-230, 2003. Rudnikov T., Ostrovsky N., Fuks D., Kiv A., Bibi R., Roizin Ya. & Gutman M., Behavior of injected charges in dielectric layers of memory devices. Proceedings of the 2nd International Conference on Information Technologies and Management, Riga, Latvia, pp.69-74, 2004. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
74 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [15]
[16]
Avichail-Bibi R., Fuks D., Kiv A., Roizin Y. Maximova T., Gouternakht A. & Shtermer V., Software for simulation of retention loss in memory transistor, Computer Modeling & New Technologies, 10(2), pp.30-39, 2006. Mott N. F. & Devis E. A., Electron processes in non-crystal materials, Clarendon Press, Oxford, 1979.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
75
Electron band structure and properties of disordered semiconductor compound alloys D. Alexandrov1, K. S. A. Butcher2 & T. L. Tansley2 1 2
Department of Electrical Engineering, Lakehead University, Canada Physics Department, Macquarie University, Australia
Abstract A new metric system called the electron metric system, having a basic metric constant, is introduced. The connection between the electron metric system and the external metric system is defined. The symmetry relationships of the multinary semiconductor compound alloys are defined according to the electron metric system. The basic metric constant is found on the basis of a diatomic tetrahedral cell. The electron wave vector in the new system is found and the electron energy states are determined. Correlation is shown between the electron energy and the electron wave vector in the multinary crystal. The LCAO electron band structures of InxAl1-xN are presented. The phenomenon tunnel optical absorption is investigated in InxAl1-xN, in InxGa1-xN, in InN containing oxygen and in non-stoichiometric InN. It is found the optical absorption edges begin in energies much lower than the energy band gaps due to this phenomenon. Existence of excitons of the structure is shown in these semiconductors and it is found that the peaks of the PL spectra correspond to annihilation energies of these excitons. Keywords: semiconductor compound alloys, optical properties.
1
Introduction
The relatively recent observation of 0.7 eV photoluminescence for InN, and of absorption features near this energy have been the subject of a number of recent papers [1–3]. It has been proposed that the low energy features indicate a 0.7 eV band-gap. However, the material had long been held to have a much higher band-gap of 1.9 eV. The large difference between these values is not presently understood. The Moss-Burstein effect does not explain the variation seen for WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070081
76 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII material of low carrier concentration, and Vegard’s law indicates that oxygen levels in the higher band-gap material are insufficient to account for the difference [4]. Sample inhomogeneity offers a strong possible explanation. The grown conditions are known to form non-stoichiometric indium nitride during the growth of nitride films. One now seeks to investigate the possibility that these low energy features arise as growth artifacts, due to an alloy formed by non-stoichiometric InN containing both single In substitutions on N sites and single N substitutions on In sites. A new metric system called the electron metric system is introduced in this paper. The connection between the electron metric system and the external metric system is defined. The symmetry relationships of the multinary semiconductor compound alloys are defined according to the electron metric system. The electron wave vector in the electron metric system is found and the electron energy states are determined. Correlation is shown between the electron energy and the electron wave vector in the multinary crystal. LCAO electron band structure of InxAl1-xN is presented. The phenomenon tunnel optical absorption is investigated in InxAl1-xN, in InxGa1-xN, in InN containing oxygen and in non-stoichiometric InN. It is found the optical absorption edges in these semiconductors begin in energies much lower than the energy band gaps due to this phenomenon. Existence of excitons of the structure is shown in these semiconductors and it is found that the peaks of the PL spectra correspond to annihilation energies of these excitons.
2
Metric system and symmetries in multinary crystal
The existing metric system in the solid state physics is defined on the basis of positions of the ions building the crystal lattice. One can call it the metric system of the external observer or simpler external metric system. It does not account for the electron interactions. We will define the metric system in the multinary crystal in terms of electron interaction because it is the basis of the determination of the electronic and optical properties of solid state. One can call it the electron metric system. The definition will be done on the basis of the following assumptions: i) Every quasi-elementary cell (defined in [5] for multinary crystal) is built by points, which are identical with the corresponding points in all other quasi-elementary cells of the multinary crystal in term of electron propagator (The quasi-elementary cell doesn’t contain any other points.); ii) The quasi-elementary cell is electro-neutral; iii) The atomic substitutions in multinary crystal save the valences of the corresponding atoms; iv) The electrical charges are of point type and they are concentrated exclusively in the nodes of the crystal lattice; v) One electron approximation has place. Weyl’s metric system will be used [6, 7], i.e. the length is defined by
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
l = l0 exp(α∫Φi dxi)
77 (1)
where l0 is metric constant, α is proportional factor, Φi is component of the electric field, and xi is the coordinate in the external metric system (i=1,2,3). The integration takes place between two points of the external system and l is the corresponding distance in the electron metric system. One will define the metric length in the multinary crystal in term of change of electron energy when the electron moves in the electrical field of the crystal lattice formed by the electrical fields of the nuclei, i.e. l = l0 exp(α∫Єi dxi)
(2)
where Єi = Єi(xi) is the corresponding component of the electrical field strength. The coordinate li (i = 1, 2, 3) in the electron metric system can be defined using (2). The integration in (2) between two nodes of the crystal lattice having equal electron charges is equal to zero, i.e. l = l0. Using this result one will define l0 to be the distance in the electron metric system between nearest neighbouring atoms of the crystal lattice having equal electron charges. Let us consider that we have tetrahedral quasi-elementary cell of a multinary semiconductor compound alloy and that this cell is built by two sorts of nuclei – cationic and anionic. Also let us consider at this point that the cationic sub-lattice is built by atoms of one chemical element, and to consider the same for anionic sub-lattice (however both cationic element and anionic element are different atoms). Due to the distribution of the valence electrons the cationic atom has charge +|Z|, and the charge of the anionic atom is -|Z|. According to the assumption iv) given above these charges are concentrated exclusively in the nodes of the corresponding sub-lattices. The tetrahedral quasi-elementary cell contains cationic atom having charge +|Z| and anionic atom having charge -|Z|. The determination of the metric constant l0 for this tetrahedral cell will be done and one-electron approximation will be considered (Fig.1). (Only part of the diatomic tetrahedral cell is given in Fig.1. However this part is enough to represent the interactions and the corresponding lengths due to the symmetry of the tetrahedral cell. The electro-neutrality of the tetrahedral cell is saved.) The one-electron Schrödinger equation is given by [-ћ2∆/2m + e2( |Z|2/(4 rAB ) - |Z|2/(2 rAC) -|Z|2/(2 rBC) - |Z|/(2 rA) - |Z|/(2 rB) + |Z|/rC)] ψ = E ψ (3) where e is electron charge, m is electron mass, ψ is wave function in one-electron approximation, and E is electron energy. This equation is invariant in term of the metric system. Let’s consider that the electron metric system takes place, i.e. rAB = l0 Because the following equality is valid
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
78 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII cationic nucleus A
cationic nucleus B
electron rAB
|Z|/2
|Z|/2 rB
rA rAC
rC
rBC
-|Z| anionic nucleus C Figure 1:
Part of the tetrahedral cell containing all possible distances. ξB
∫Є dξ = 0
(4)
ξA where ξA and ξB are the positions of the atoms A and B in the external metric system, and the integration in (4) takes place in the external metric system as well. Let’s consider the positions of the electron and of the atom C in the external metric system to be ξe and ξC respectively. One has found ξC rAC = l0 exp(α∫Є dξ) = l0 exp(-3αe|Z|/2) ξA Using (4) and (5) one has found rBC = l0 exp(3αe|Z|/2) Let’s designate
ξe
∫Є dξ = β ξA Using this designation and expressions (4) and (5) one has found rA = l0 exp(αβ) rB = l0 exp(-αβ) rC = l0 exp(-αβ) exp(-3αe|Z|/2) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
79
Considering the expressions for the distances found above the Schrödinger equation becomes {-ћ2∆/2m + e2 [ |Z|2/(4 l0) - |Z|2/(2 l0 exp(-3αe|Z|/2) ) - |Z|2/(2 l0 exp(3αe|Z|/2)) – |Z|/(2 l0 exp(αβ) ) - |Z|/(2 l0 exp(-αβ) ) + |Z|/ (l0 exp(-αβ) exp(-3αe|Z|/2) ) ]} ψ =Eψ (6) The metric constant l0 is found as solution of (6) in the electron metric system assuming that ψ is ortho-normal wave function l0 = e2 /(Emin – H0) [( |Z|2/4 - |Z|2/(2 exp(-3αe|Z|/2) ) - |Z|2/(2 exp(3αe|Z|/2) ) - |Z| H-β /2 - |Z| Hβ /2 + |Z| Hβ / ( exp(-3αe|Z|/2) )]
(7)
Where the matrix elements H0, H-β and Hβ are as follows H0 = <ψ|-ћ2∆/2m|ψ> H-β = <ψ| exp(-αβ) |ψ> and Hβ = <ψ| exp(αβ) |ψ>
(8)
It is important to mention that integration for finding β has a place in the external metric system, but the matrix elements are determined in the electron metric system. β has continuous values within the tetrahedral cell and these values are equivalent for all tetrahedral cells having equal |Z|, i.e. the matrix elements H-β and Hβ depend only on |Z|. Emin is the minimum of the electron energy in tetrahedral cell having |Z|. The authors believe there are other methods for determination of the metric constant l0. The distances between two nearest neighbouring cationic is l0, also the distances between two nearest neighbouring anionic is l0 as well. Important conclusions can be made: i) Tetrahedral cells containing two atoms and having the same values of |Z| have equal l0 or in a multinary semiconductor compound alloy the different quasielementary tetrahedral cells containing two atoms and having equal values of |Z| have equal values of l0, i.e. the lengths of the tetrahedral edges are equal in the electron metric system. ii) The electron wave function ψ(l) and the potential function U(l) of the multinary crystal have symmetry in the electron metric system that is the same as the symmetries of both the electron wave functions ψ(x) and the potential functions U(x) of the binary constituents in the external metric system if |Z| remains constant for every quasi-elementary tetrahedral cell. (The binary constituents are building the multinary crystal.) The binary alloys InN, GaN and AlN have values of |Z| - 1.56, 1.48 and 1.36 respectively. (The calculations are performed on the basis of the polarities of these alloys given in [8]). The average value is |Zav| = 1.47. It means that it can WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
80 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII be considered that |Z| = 1.47 for the quasi-elementary tetrahedral cells of InxGa1-xN, of InxAl1-xN and of GaxAl1-xN with error not greater than 7.5%, and the corresponding tetrahedral edge l0 in the electron metric system. However this conclusion is made on the basis of the independent binary alloys that are possible binary constituents. The authors assume that a detail investigation may give constant value of |Z| without theoretical error. The purpose of the electron metric system in this paper is to define the symmetry of the multinary crystal in term of crystal lattice and the corresponding symmetries of both the electron wave function and the potential function. Further development of this metric system and its application in the quantum mechanics of solids goes beyond the scope of this paper and it is subject of other author’s papers.
3
Electron wave vector and electron states in multinary crystal
The change of the metric system requires a new approach in the determination of the electron wave vector because the electron wave length has to be determined in the corresponding metric system. This problem will be solved on the basis of the following assumptions: i) The quasi-elementary tetrahedral cell is electro-neutral; ii) The electrons belonging to both the conduction band and the valence band have energies E greater than the potential energy U of the nuclei of certain quasi-elementary tetrahedral cell; Using these assumptions and the result in [9] one can write (kxi and kl are the electron wave vectors in the external metric system and in the electron metric system respectively, and n is positive integer number): - for the external metric system xB (1/ћ ) ∫ {2m [E – U(xi)]}1/2 dxi = |xB – xA| kxi = n π xA (|xB – xA| is tetrahedral edge) - for the electron metric system l0 (1/ћ ) ∫ {2m [E – U(l)]}1/2 d l = l0 kl = n π 0 The equations (9) and (10) give |xB – xA| kxi = l0 kl = n π
(9)
(10)
(11)
As a matter of fact the distance |xB – xA| determines the length of the tetrahedral edge of certain quasi-elementary cell in the external metric system (the tetrahedral edges of different quasi-elementary cells having |Z| have different lengths in the external metric system, and equal lengths in the electron metric system). The equalities (11) have important meaning – they are basis of the following conclusions: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
81
1) The electron wave length λl in the electron metric system stays unchanged when the electron is moving through different quasi-elementary tetrahedral cells and λl = 2 l0 / n
(12)
2) The electron wave length λxi in the external metric system changes when the electron is moving through different quasi-elementary tetrahedral cells. 3) The Bloch’s theorem is satisfied in the electron metric system. 4) The number of electron states remains unchanged in different metric systems. (It means one can determine the electron states in the electron metric system and they give the corresponding states in the external metric system.) 5) Considering that a sub-lattice of the multinary crystal is built by different sort of atoms one must expect that the electron energy corresponding to certain electron state depends on the quasi-elementary cell, i.e. the formula derived in [10] is valid. E(r) = ∑q δ (r – Rq) E(q)
(13)
where E(q) is electron energy in quasi-elementary cell having radius-vector Rq, and r is radius-vector. Both Rq and r can be determined in both metric systems, however the application of the electron metric system in calculation of the Hamiltonian matrix elements goes beyond the scope of this paper and the calculations of the corresponding matrix elements will be done in the external metric system furthermore according to the conclusion 4), which is given above, the determination of the electron states can be made in the electron metric system, and the calculation of the corresponding electron energies can be done in the external metric system (conclusion 5). Calculations of LCAO electron energies for the electron state k=0 (i.e. point Γ of the electron band structure) will be presented for InxAl1-xN. (Details of these calculations are given in [5, 10].) Each type of quasi-elementary cell forms sector υ of the corresponding electron band structure (υ = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5). In terms of both the optical absorption and the photoluminescence the energy band gap of InxAl1-xN has to be determined as energy differences between Γυc1 (the bottom of the conduction band of sector υ) and Γυv15 (the top of the valence band of sector υ). The results of the calculations are given in Fig.2 for InxAl1-xN. The energy levels Γυc1 and Γυv15 are determined by taking the energy of the vacuum as being equal to zero. The energy difference Eυg = (Γυc1 - Γυv15) gives the energy band gap of sector υ. The shifts of the boundaries of the energy band gaps in Fig.2, and the corresponding energy intervals are due to defects in the crystal lattices of InxAl1-xN. The nature of these shifts is different from the nature of the shifts of the boundaries of the energy band gap described in [11, 12]. The same approach is used for determination of the energy states in InxGa1-xN [10], in InOyN1-y [5] and in non-stoichiometric InN [13].
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
82 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Sector 5
Sector 4
Sector3
Sector2
Sector 1
*2c1 = -4.93
*1c1 = -4.92
*2v15 = -11.21
*1v15 = -11.22
Evac = 0
_f! *5c1 = -5.05
*5v15 = -7.04
*4c1 = -5.07
*4v15 = -7.02
_i!
Figure 2:
4
*3c1 = -5.43
*3v15 = -8.80
The energy band gap of InxAl1-xN. The energies Γυc1 and Γυv15 are shown (the sectors are υ=1, 2, 3, 4, 5). The shapes of parts of the electron wave functions corresponding to both the initial i > and final statef > are given and the allowed optical absorption transition is shown.
Electron and optical phenomena in semiconductor compound alloys related to InN
4.1 Excitons of the structure in InxAl1-xN, in InxGa1-xN, and in InOyN1-y An exciton of the structure in InxAl1-xN is formed by an electron occupying state Γ3c1 and a hole occupying state Γ4v15 (Fig.2). This exciton state Γ3c1 ↔ Γ4v15 is defined as the ground exciton state for this type of exciton in InxAl1-xN. Using the method given in [10] the hydrogen like energy level En for the ground state (n = 1) is found to depend on the ratio between neighbouring Al cationic and neighbouring In cationic surrounding the quasi-elementary cells of sectors 3 and 4 of Fig.2. It is found En varies in the interval 0.765 –0.778 eV and these energies are in agreement with the optical transitions corresponding to the experimental photoluminescence spectra of samples containing interface layers InxAl1-xN - ~ 0.77 eV reported in [2] and ~ 0.8 eV given in [3]. As a mater of fact En determines the optical transitions connected with photon radiation due to annihilations between the electrons and the holes belonging to the exciton Γ3c1 ↔ Γ4v15 in InxAl1-xN. Excitons of the structure in InxGa1-xN are investigated in WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
83
details in [10]. It is found that the hydrogen like energy level En varies over the interval 0.50 – 0.82 eV and these energies are close to the experimental results about the photoluminescence spectra of In-rich regions of InxGa1-xN reported in [14–16]. The same type of exciton in InOyN1-y is investigated in details in [5]. It is found that the hydrogen like energy level En varies over the interval 0.84 – 1.01 eV, and that it determines the optical transitions connected with photon radiation due to annihilations between the electrons and the holes belonging to these excitons in InOyN1-y. The photoluminescence rates in InxAl1-xN, in InxGa1-xN and in InOyN1-y depend on the concentration of the corresponding excitons of the structure, and this in turn depends on the technological circumstances forming this alloys. 4.2 Tunnel optical absorptions in semiconductors related to InN The tunnel optical absorption in InxAl1-xN, in InOyN1-y, in InxGa1-xN is investigated in details in [5]. The basis of this phenomenon is the overlapping between the electron wave function | i > of the initial electron state and the electron wave function of the final electron state | f > in term of optical transition. Part of the graphics of figure 2 provides the electron wave functions of the initial state i > and of the final state f > for InxAl1-xN (it is important to note that the state i > is an electron state, it is not a hole state). It is found [5] the lengths (in the one-dimensional case) of the regions where the matrix element of the optical absorption has non-zero values due to the penetrations of the electron wave functions into the barriers. The length for InxAl1-xN is determined to vary in the interval 4.70 – 4.72 Angstrom depending on the number of In and Al atoms surrounding the sectors 3 and 4 (Fig.2), the length for InxGa1-xN is determined to vary in the interval 4.61 – 4.64 Angstrom, and the length for InOyN1-y is found to vary in the interval 1.98 – 2.00 Angstrom. The conclusion is made [5] that the optical absorption transitions Γ4v15→ Γ3c1 for InxAl1-xN and Γ3v15→ Γ4c1 for InxGa1-xN are allowed and they give the optical absorption edges and the corresponding energy band gaps (for InxAl1-xN Eg=Γ3c1-Γ4v15 and for InxGa1-xN Eg=Γ4c1-Γ3v15). The similar conclusions are made for InOyN1-y as well. It is important to note that if the distances between the corresponding quasielementary cells (forming the sectors) are longer than the lengths of the regions determined above the optical absorption transitions given above will not be allowed). The optical absorption rates depend on the number of Γυv15→ Γξc1 pairs for InxAl1-xN, for InOyN1-y and for InxGa1-xN in the corresponding primitive super-cells that are connected with the technological circumstances (growth conditions) forming the layers InxAl1-xN, InOyN1-y and InxGa1-xN. The energy Eg for InxAl1-xN is found to vary in the interval 1.58 – 1.62 eV, the energy Eg for InOyN1-y is found to have a small variation around 1.19 eV, and the energy Eg for InxGa1-xN is found to vary in the interval 1.40 – 1.56 eV. These energies (especially the energy Eg ~ 1.19 eV for InOyN1-y) are close to the optical absorption edge that shows the optical transmission data for the Ioffe sample W431. The tunnel optical absorption in non-stoichiometric InN:In is investigated in details in [13]. It determines energy band gap Eg = 0.2 eV. (However the single substitutions In atom on N site do not reduce the energy band gap to zero.) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
84 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Conclusion
The development of the electron metric system and its application in calculations of the electron band structure of multinary crystal has an important impact over the investigation of the disordered atomic systems. In fact, the calculations of the Hamiltonian matrix elements can be done in this metric system and the authors believe these calculations to become easier and more accurate. The observed phenomena excitons of the structure and tunnel optical absorption can be used in design of semiconductor devices on InN and related alloys.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16]
K.S.A. Butcher, M. Wintrebert-Fouquet, K.E. Prince and T.L. Tansley, Materials Research Society Symposium Proceeding 743, 707 (2003). J. Wu, W. Walukiewicz, K. M. Yu, J. W. Ager III, E. E. Haller, H. Lu, W. J. Schaff, Y. Saito, Y. Nanishi, Applied Physics Letters 80, 3967 (2002). V. Yu. Davydov, A. A. Klochikhin, V. V. Emtsev, S. V. Ivanov, V. A. Vekchin, F. Bechsted, J. Furthmuller, J. Aderhold, J. Graul, A. V. Mudryi, H. Harima, A. Hashimoto, Y. Yamamoto, E. E. Haller, Physica Status Solidi. (b) 234, 787 (2002). T.L. Tansley, presentation at the First Internat. InN Workshop, Fremantle, Australia, Nov. 2003. D. Alexandrov, K.S.A. Butcher, M. Wintrebert-Fouquet, Journal of Crystal Growth 269, 77 (2004) F. London, Zeit. F. Phys. 42, 375 (1927) L. O’Raifeartaigh, The Dawning of Gauge Theory, (Princeton university press, Princeton, 1997), part I W.A. Harrison, Electronic Structure and the Properties of Solids, Dover Publ. Inc, (1989) A.S. Davydov, Quantum Mechanics (Pergamon press, Don Mills, 1965) D. Alexandrov, Journal of Crystal Growth, 246, 325 (2002) H. Fritzsche, Journal of Non-Crystal Solids, 6, 49 (1971) A. Efros, B. Shklovskii, Electronic Properties of Doped Semiconductors (Springer-Verlag, Berlin – Heidelberg 1984) D. Alexandrov, K.S.A. Butcher, T. Tansley, Journal of Crystal Growth 288, 261 (2006). V. Yu. Davydov, A. A. Klochikhin et al., Phys. Stat. Sol. (b), 229,1 (2002) V. Yu. Davydov, A. A. Klochikhin et al., Phys. Stat. Sol. (b), 230, 4 (2002) V. Yu. Davydov, A. A. Klochikhin et al., International Workshop on Nitride Semiconductors, 22 – 25 July 2002, Aachen, Germany, p.133 (2002)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
85
Fast calculation of the dimensioning factors of the railway power supply system L. Abrahamsson & L. S¨oder Electric Power Systems, Royal Institute of Technology (KTH), Sweden
Abstract Because of environmental and economical reasons, in Sweden and the rest of Europe, both personal and goods transports on railway are increasing. Therefore great railway infrastructure investments are expected to come. An important part of this infrastructure is the railway power supply system. Exactly how much, when and where the traffic will increase is not known for sure. This means investment planning for an uncertain future. The more uncertain parameters, such as traffic density and weight of trains, and the further future considered, the greater the inevitable amount of cases that have to be considered. When doing simulations concerning a tremendous amount of cases, each part of the simulation model has to be computationally fast – in real life this means approximations. The two most important issues to estimate given a certain power system configuration, when planning for an electric traction system, are the energy consumption of the grid and the train delays that a too weak system would cause. In this paper, some modeling suggestions of the energy consumption and the maximal train velocities are presented. Two linear, and one nonlinear model are presented and compared. The comparisons regard both computer speed and representability. The independent variables of these models are a selection of parameters describing the power system, i.e.: power system technology used on each section, and traffic intensity. Keywords: railway, traction system, power supply, energy consumption.
1 Introduction During the last decades, the railway has in many countries experienced a renaissance. The main reasons for the expansion of the railway are environmental and economical. This, in turn, has increased the interest in railway grid research. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070091
86 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1: Overview of the main purpose of the paper.
When making a decision about the future railway power supply system, possible under-investments or over-investments need to be estimated in an appropriate manner. The costs of over-investments are simply put: the price difference between the investment cost of the “too strong” and the “sufficiently strong” power system configurations. Costs that are related to under-dimensioning are somewhat more subtle, though. Some examples will be mentioned in the following. While a voltage drop in the ordinary power system would cause occasional disconnections of customers, it would in the power supply system of the railway simply cause the trains to run slower. The slowing down of trains do, however, immediately lead to costs – either by lower incomes due to reduced competitiveness on the transportation market – or for greater voltage drops, disturbed, or even modified time tables. With the trend of increasing energy prices in mind, power losses might be as important to study as delays caused by low voltage when looking into the future. Therefore, the initial focus on underinvestment costs will be set to train velocities limited by the power system, as well as differences in energy use – losses will vary, as also train power demand – between different power system solutions. The objective of this paper is to present an idea of how to pick out relevant information of the outputs of a basic simulation method (TTS), and by presenting the input variables to an approximator (TTSA) estimate these relevant outputs, see Figure 1 (Main results). Relevant outputs are here chosen to be the maximal train throughput velocity, as well as the corresponding energy consumption of the system, for a given train traffic and electric power supply system. The main ideas behind TTS, its model, as well as TTSA, and its accuracy and ability to generalize the results, are presented. A further developed TTSA (box C in Figure 1) approximating main results (box E) from TTS (box B), is planned to be used in a future investment planning tool. Planning will be done for several years ahead, allowing investments to be done stepwise. This planning tool should in the end be able to manage a huge amount of uncertain variables, such as: train types, train weights, locomotive types, energy prices, increasing or decreasing demand, taxes, the economical situation, and so forth. All the possible combinations of realizations of variables like these cannot be simulated (box B), because it would demand too much time. The aim is to use results from a limited number of TTS simulations to determine parameters for the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
87
TTSA model in box C. With this approach, the much faster TTSA model can be used for a large amount of scenarios.
2 Train traffic simulator (TTS) The aim of TTS is to, as accurate as possible, simulate a certain traffic and a certain infrastructure. 2.1 Modeling 2.1.1 Electrical and mechanical power, for each time step In this part of the paper, the system of equations to be solved for each time step is presented. A great part of the modeling is the same as in [1, 2], and therefore only additional and updated equations will be presented here. The maximal tractive force of an Rc locomotive is a function of the catenary voltage, U , and the velocity of the train that it is hauling, v. The function can be expressed as a polynomial Fmotor,max = c1 + c2 U + c3 v + c4 U v + c5 v 2 + c6 v 2 U + c7 v 3 + + c8 v 3 U + c9 v 4 + c10 v 4 U + c11 v 5 + c12 v 5 U + c13 U 2 + 2
2 3
(1)
2 4
+ c14 U v + c15 U v + c16 U v , where the parameters can be obtained from data sheets [3] using least squares fitting. The motor force can be modeled as Fmotor,max − KJ · 4 · a · (1 + ζ) if Braking = 0 Fmotor = (2) 0 if Braking = 0 where ζ is the slippage ratio [4], KJ is related to rotational inertia [4], a is the acceleration, and Braking is a variable that will be described in the method part. The adhesive tractive force between train and rail, madh,drive · g · 0.161 + 7.5 for dry rail 44+3.6v (3) Ftract,adh = 3.78 madh,drive · g · 23.6+v for wet rail where g is the gravitational constant, and madh,drive is the mass on the driving axles of the train [4]. The effective tractive force Ftract = min {Fmotor , Ftract,adh }
(4)
because it is indifferent how strong the engine is if there is no grip [4]. The train resistive force due to mechanical and air resistances, Fair,mech = A + B · v + C · v 2 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
88 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII where A, B, and C are train dependent [4]. The resistive force due to grades Fgrades = m · g · incl
(6)
where incl is the inclination of the track. The total resistive force is simply Fres = Fair,mech + Fgrades . And
a=
(7)
Ftract −Fres madh,drive +(m−madh,drive )(1+H)
if Braking = 0
abrake
if Braking = 0
(8)
where m is the total train mass [4], H is the relative factor accounting for rotational inertia of the unbraked wheel sets [4], and abrake will be described in the braking part. The mechanical power of the motor Pmotor = Fmotor · v · (1 + ζ)
(9)
[4]. The electrical power demand PD = Pmotor
(10)
which implicates an assumption of a lossless motor. The DC voltage of the motor, Udiα
= Emax · min 1,
v vbase
· min 1,
U
(11)
U14kV
which is a wiser modeling when allowing greater voltage drops [5]. In converter stations with several converters of the same kind, PG , QG , and Q50 (the total active, reactive, and 50 Hz side reactive power generations, respectively) can simply be divided by the number of converters, #conv , in order to give the proper U and ψ values [6]. G G Xqm · #Pconv Xqg · #Pconv 1 ψ = − arctan − arctan 2 2 3 (U m ) + Xqm · #Q50 (U g ) + Xqg · #QG conv
(12)
conv
Both Um and Ug are assumed to be at nominal voltage levels constantly. The phase shift on the 50 Hz side of the converter due to train power consumption is, according to [6], θ0 = θ50 −
X50 · PG 1 · arctan . m 3 (U )2 − X50 · Q50
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(13)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
89
2.1.2 The braking The problem would have grown tremendously if the driving behavior would have been subject for optimization with respect to time. In order to avoid the time dimension of the problem, the driver is assumed to be aggressive. When accelerating, he/she does it as hard as ever possible. Braking, on the other hand, demands a more sophisticated modeling in order to be able to stop at the train stations. In order to determine the shortest braking distance for a given initial velocity, a small optimization problem was set up. The braking acceleration was constrained to 0 a −0.85 m/s2 , while v was constrained to be nonnegative. The figure 0.85 m/s2 is due to comfortability reasons and according to [7], there is never any problem achieving that retardation level. The position, p, was constrained to lie within 0 p pstation . The remaining constraints were as follows pt = pt−1 + vt ∆t + at
∆2t 2
pt pt−1 pt − pstation −vt · M vstart + at ∆t , t = 1 vt = vt−1 + at ∆t , t ∈ {2, 3, ..., tmax } z= pstation − pt
(14)
∀t
where index t ∈ {1, 2, ..., tmax } is time step index, M is a large number (in this case 1000), and ∆t is the time step length. The value of tmax must like pstation be big enough for the train to have time and place to stop. The second constraint remedies the phenomenon in discretized time that the position might be reduced when traveling forward if the retardation turns bigger than suitable for the problem. The third constraint ensures that the train stops at the station. The objective z is minimized. This LP problem is solved for all integer velocities vstart between 61 and 160 km/h, 61 because it is the lowest that gives feasible solutions, 160 because Rc locomotives rarely go faster. The braking accelerations are stored as a discrete function abrake [vstart , t] to be used in TTS later on, paired with the critical braking distance, dbrake . However, these critical distances does not really form a smooth function of vstart because of the time discretization. Therefore, the trend is extracted by least squares fitting into a sixth grade polynomial of vstart . 2.2 The method The Newton Raphson method of [1, 2] did soon turn out to be too weak for these nonlinear models. In TTS, whose working idea is illustrated in Figure 2, Matlab mainly does the bookkeeping. GAMS is a powerful optimization program that is WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
90 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2: Main ideas of the work flow of TTS. used for solving the system of nonlinear equations for each time step. The objective function of the GAMS program is the sum of the squared two-norms of the power flow error vector and the reactive power flow error vector, but could be chosen differently. In order to reduce the computation complexity of the system of nonlinear equations, GAMS is programmed to use vt−1 , the prior time step velocity, rather than the in the presented models assumed vt . Since vt−1 is a parameter, and vt would, if introduced, be a variable depending on at that in turn depends intricately on several other variables, the simplification is obvious. Moreover, v will normally not change that much between two small consecutive time steps. Doing the same with, e.g., U would be harder to justify – especially for weak BT power systems. The consecutive time steps are thus connected by at = SOE (pt−1 , vt−1 ) vt = vt−1 + at ∆t ∆2 pt = pt−1 + vt ∆t + at t 2
(15)
where SOE denotes the system of equations in section 2.1.1. The TTS time table (unidirectional traffic intensity) remains as in [1, 2], i.e., a train is let loose in the start every nth minute, and once the entire track is filled up with trains the forthcoming train to let loose gets a label. When the labeled train reaches its final destination, the TTS simulation halts. The precalculated braking schedules that are described in the model section are used as follows. Before solving the equations, TTS checks if there is time to brake for any train. It is considered time to brake when 0 < pstation − pt < dbrake (vt ) + vt ∆t , where vt ∆t is a sort of insecurity factor due to the discrete time model. If there is time for a train to brake, then the parameter Braking = 0 is raised one step and vt is stored as vbrake . This is done for bookkeeping of train braking time and choosing an appropriate braking schedule. Matlab thereafter checks trains with parameter Braking > 0. The parameter is raised one step for the forthcoming time step. The braking acceleration is then determined by at =
1 (abrake [vbrake , Brakingt ] + abrake [vbrake , Brakingt ]) 2
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(16)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
91
Figure 3: The assumed dependencies of a piece of the railway grid.
because the braking schedules are only computed for integer velocities. Five minutes after that at has reached zero, Braking is set back to zero and the train can start accelerating, aiming for the next station on the track.
3 The approximator (TTSA) The aim of the TTSA is to construct a method of retrieving reliable results fast, much faster than would be possible in TTS. 3.1 The dependency models The inputs (Box A in Figure 1) chosen to be variables in this paper were: the catenary type (BT or AT [1, 2]), the option of having an HV transmission line (130 kV 2-phase line [1, 2]), and the traffic intensities quantified into three measures. The choice of catenary type, AT , as well as the HV line option, HV , are binary variables that tells whether the power supply system has AT catenaries or not, and HV transmission line or not, respectively. There is one such AT and HV pair for each section in the railway power system. The traffic intensity is described by ET (Et (vt,T )), the average velocity, and VT (Et (vt,T )), the variance of the mean velocities, both of them taken over all trains (subscript T ) during a certain time window (subscript t). The third traffic intensity measure is N oT r, the number of trains. There is one such E (v), V (v), and N oT r triplet for: each train type, each track section, and both traveling directions. Apart from the electromechanical properties, also the classification of trains as either “accelerating” or “speedmaintaining” is a train type demarcation. A train is classified as “accelerating” on a specific section if it is stopped on the section border before entering the section. This is indeed a crude measure, and a future TTSA should be able to handle trains stopping several times in each section. Track section borders are defined by the converter station locations in the non-HV cases, e.g., in Figure 4 there are two sections. In the simple example of this paper, mixed traffic is not studied, and all trains have the same Et (vt,T ) such that the variances can be neglected. Moreover, all trains are “accelerating” so no separation between “accelerating” and “speedWIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
92 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII maintaining” trains is needed. The general dependency model assumed for TTSA in this paper is illustrated in Figure 3. There are two kinds of outputs of TTSA, see Figure 3. First, the average energy consumption of the power system. Second, vmax , the maximal attainable velocity for each section, direction, and train type. In this paper, all outputs are assumed to depend on all inputs. Since the power flows are not local in the power system, especially not when using AT and/or HV, the energy consumption is hard to separate into section components. It is however tempting to, in a future improved TTSA, model at least the vmax s as functions merely of the traffic in the concerned section. Three different methods of modeling how the assumed outputs depend upon the assumed inputs are proposed. The input and output assumptions are illustrated
in Figure 3. The first model, M 1, assumes a linear dependency outi = bi + in w , where i is output index, k is input index, and w k i,k i,k and bi are k
i − parameters to be determined by minimizing the mean square of the error, out outi , in an optimization program. The second model, M 2, is also linear; with the same inputs, outputs, and parameters. In M 2, however, the parameters are determined by the Matlab Neural Network (NN) Toolbox algorithm trainb (batch learning). In other words, M 2 is a single layered neural network with inputs ink , outputs outi , and have |i| neurons with linear transfer functions. The third model, M 3, is a nonlinear NN with two layers. The first, “hidden”, layer has tanh transfer functions, and the second (output) layer has linear transfer functions. According to the theory [8, 9], this kind of network can be used as a general function approximator, given sufficient neurons in the hidden layer. The hidden layer was chosen to have 3 neurons, the linear (output) layer naturally has |i| neurons, and the network is trained using the trainbr (Bayesian regularization backpropagation) algorithm with an error goal of 10−5 . Both the ink and outi data are normalized to lie in the interval [−1, 1] before training and testing the approximators. Furthermore, the 128 TTS results are separated into one randomly chosen training set of size 32, and one remaining test set. The figure 128 comes from four different power system configurations and 32 different train departure periodicities n leaping from 6 to 20, from 21 by 1.5 to 30, and from 33 by 3 to 60 (minutes). The main difference by minimizing the mean square error (MSE) by an optimization algorithm compared to a NNs algorithm is that one can perform a fewer amount of iterations in a wiser way in the latter case. Of course, that leads to a non optimal MSE, but hopefully a model that better generalizes the behavior of the system studied.
4 Numerical example on a test system 4.1 System configuration The system that the TTS has simulated is a three city test system (Figure 4), mainly using the same ideas as in [1, 2]. In the test system the converters are of type WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
93
Q48/Q49 [10]. In the HV case, there are converter stations situated in City1 and City2 with 6 converters in each. In the non-HV case, there are three converter stations – one in each city – with 4 converters in each. In the test system, trains denoted “F1 Mixed” in [4] are used. ∆t was set to 0.1 minutes in TTS. The stretch “City Distance” was 50 km.
Figure 4: An illustration of the test system. The inclinations on the test system are inspired by the stretch between Lule˚a and Bastutr¨ask. The hight curve is measured from a graph [11] every 6.25th km whereafter the inclinations are calculated. The rail is assumed to be dry. The slippage ratio, ζ, is for simplicity set to be zero, and 4 · KJ is assumed to be 10750 N, a typical figure [4]. Moreover, the 50 Hz sides of the converters stations have no load angle θ50 = 0◦ like in [1, 2]. Finally, H is assumed to equal zero. 4.2 Results and conclusions In Figure 5 there are two plots of selected TTS data: one for the strongest system with the lightest load, and one for the weakest system with heaviest load simulated. The variables v, PD , QD , and U are shown for the labeled train while driving the first 100 km. v is a part of box E in Figure 1, the others of box D. v is normalized by 150 km/h, PD and QD are normalized by 5 MW/MVAr, and U by 16.5 kV. The inclination of the track (a part of box A) is included to show its influence, incl is scaled so that −1, 1 corresponds to −10, 10 per mill. The remainder of the section is devoted to TTSA. As one would have expected, the linear NN tends to coincide with the GAMS solution when training it for WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
94 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII AT=0,HV=0,n=6 1
0.8
0.8
0.6
v P
D
0.4
Q
D
U incl incl=0
0.2 0
0
20
40
60
80
100
normalized data
normalized data
AT=1,HV=1,n=60 1
0.6
v P
D
0.4
Q
D
U incl incl=0
0.2 0
0
20
40
km
60
80
100
km
Figure 5: A selection of TTS data. thousands of iterations and when the MSE goal is set small. The errors of the mean energy of such an approximator were about 10−5 for the training set and 10−4 for the test set. The errors of the maximal velocities were negligible compared to the approximation errors of the energy. For a less trained linear NN, the errors on the output vector are more equally spread and the generalization is slightly better. The approximation errors for the nonlinear NN are evenly spread, with norms similar to the linear cases. In a minor modification of the GAMS program, certain w and b were set to zero in order to determine whether the maximal velocity of a section could be modeled as depending only on the traffic on that very section. This assumption would be reasonable because of the voltage control on the section borders. Simulations shown just a slight decrease in approximator performance, so one could conclude that the traffic of neighboring sections do not affect each other much. The computation times for making one estimation might be of interest. Since it is unfair comparing different programs, the both NNs are compared. By the usage of tic and toc in Matlab, the approximation calculation times turned out to be less than 3 · 10−2 in the linear network and less than 1.6 · 10−2 seconds on average on an IBM X40 portable computer.
References [1] Abrahamsson L., Basic Modeling for Electric Traction Systems under Uncertainty, UPEC (Universities Power Engineering Conference) 2006, 2006. [2] Abrahamsson L., Operation Simulation of Traction Systems, to be published in the Comprail 2008 preceedings, presented orally at Comprail 2006, 2006. [3] Jansson, N., Electrical Data for the Locomotive Types Rc4 and Rc6 (original title in Swedish), TrainTech, Solna, 2004. [4] Lukaszewicz, P., Energy Consumption and Running Time for Trains, Ph.D. Thesis, Division of Railway Technology, KTH, Stockholm, 2001. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
95
¨ [5] Ostlund S., Personal communication, 2 February 2007, Professor at the division of Electrical Machines and Power Electronics, KTH, Stockholm. [6] Olofsson M., Optimal Operation of the Swedish Railway Electrical System, Ph.D. Thesis, Electric Power Systems, KTH, 1996. [7] Friman E., Personal communication, 10 January 2007, M.Sc. E.E. at the Swedish Railway Administration (Banverket), Borl¨ange. [8] Gurney, K., An Introduction to Neural Networks, CRC Press, p. 78, 2003. [9] Matlab online help, Neural Network Toolbox, www.mathworks.com / access / helpdesk / help / toolbox / nnet / backpro4.html, 9 March 2007. [10] Kols, H., Frequency Converters for Railway Feeding (original title in Swedish), BVH 543.17000, Banverket, 2004. [11] Banverket, Track profile Lule˚a-Borl¨ange (original title in Swedish), 2007.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
97
A formulation of a multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element K. Kazakov Department of Structural Mechanics, VSU “Luben Karavelov”, Sofia, Bulgaria
Abstract In this paper, a formulation of a multi-wave elastodynamic four and eight node infinite element is proposed. Such a kind of element is appropriate for multi-wave soil-structure interaction problems. The formulation follows the standard infinite element formulation steps which are the same as for the Finite element method after mapping the infinite element domain to a finite element domain. It is shown that if only one wave function is used (only one frequency) the proposed multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element is reduced to a singlewave elastodynamic infinite element. The mapping and the Lagrange isoparametric shape functions for a 2D axisymmetric four and eight node multi-wave elastodynamic quadrilateral infinite element are also given. The basic aspects of the continuity along the finite/infinite element (artificial boundary) line are discussed in brief. In this type of model such a line marks the boundary between the near and the far field of the model. The formulation is appropriate for wave propagation problems only. Keywords: wave propagation, infinite elements, finite element method, soil-structure interaction.
1
Introduction
This section is devoted to the review of the historical background of infinite elements from the original works to the latest contribution. Exterior domain scattering problems appear in many engineering fields such as electrodynamics, magnetics, fluid and thermal analyses and so on. Wave propagation in an elastic infinite media and scattering of waves on bodies in a fluid which extends WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070101
98 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII infinitely are of particular interest. The difficulty in such problems when numerical methods are used arises from the unbounded domain that has to be discretized. Many suggestions and ideas for the treatment of the exterior domain have been presented and discussed in a number of research papers for the period of three decades. The exterior (infinite) domain cannot be discretized with standard finite elements. A lot of efforts have been spent in the development of new infinite element formulations and techniques, based on the changes of the polynomial shape functions with trigonometric or exponential forms. In soil-structure interaction problems one possible approach is just to truncate the computational domain at some distance (line) away and to impose some “appropriate” boundary conditions. Such a line is called an “artificial” boundary. In this case viscous, absorbing or transmitting boundary conditions can be used. It is evident that the computational efficiency depends then on the localization of the “artificial” boundary and the type of the boundary conditions. In many cases such techniques give acceptable results. In soil-structure interaction problems that approach is known as the Substructural approach.
2
Earlier infinite element method works
The infinite element method was introduced about three decades ago in the original work of Bettess [5]. Then this method have been developed and refined in many works. Between them are the works of Pissanetzky on the magnetostatics and Kim on the magnetic field problems. The original Bettess formulation is similar to the finite element concept except the element domain. In this formulation the domain extends toward infinity in one direction. The corresponding shape functions are analytically integrable over the element. Such an infinite element is directly applicable to the Finite element method. The mapped infinite elements were developed by Zienkiewicz et al. [18]. These elements are based on polynomial shape functions, attenuating in the infinity. The mapping technique assures direct integration. A mathematically precise variational formulation of infinite elements has only recently been proposed [15].
3
Practical classification of infinite elements
From a practical point of view infinite elements can be classified into five classes: • classical infinite elements, • decay infinite elements, • mapped infinite elements, • elastodynamic infinite elements and • Wave envelope infinite elements. The origin of the idea and the development of every one of the above classes are difficult to be dated. The first class is based on the original so-called “classical” formulation of the infinite elements. In the decay, infinite element WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
99
decay functions from different mathematical types are used. The mapped infinite elements are developed by usage of mapping techniques. These techniques map the infinite domain of the element into a finite. The obtained element is similar to the classical finite element. The latest researches of infinite elements are devoted to the development of the elastodynamic infinite elements and the wave envelope infinite elements. In some cases the last two classes can be considered as a special combination of the mapped and decay infinite elements.
4
Multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element formulation
The displacement field in the multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element can be described in the standard form by a finite number of shape functions based on wave propagation functions [6] as n
m
u( x, z ,ω ) = ∑∑ N iq ( x, z ,ω )p iq (ω ) i =1 q =1
or
u(x, z, ω ) = N p (x, z, ω )p(ω )
(1)
where N iq ( x, z ,ω ) are the standard shape displacement functions, p iq (ω ) are the generalized coordinates associated with N iq ( x, z ,ω ) , n is the number of
nodes for the element and m is the number of wave functions included in the formulation of the infinite element. For horizontal wave propagation the shape displacement functions can be expressed as:
N iq (x, z, ω ) = L(η )Wq (ξ , ω ) where
(2)
Wq (ξ , ω ) are wave functions related to a horizontal propagation (in ξ
()
direction) and L η is a Lagrange polynomial. The infinite element domain is shown in fig.1. By taking into account only the real parts of the wave functions, the equations of the wave propagation can be written as
iω −αξ Re Wq (ξ , ω ) = cos ξ e cs or
iω −αξ Re Wq (ξ , ω ) = cos ξ e c p where c s and
c p are the velocities of the S-waves and P-waves respectively.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
100 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
z
η ξ Ωi
x Figure 1:
The infinite element domain.
If the number m is known these functions can be collected preliminary as
ReW (ξ ) =
iϖq −αξ 1 m ξ e Aq cos ∑ m q =1 cs
ReW (ξ ) =
iϖq −αξ 1 m Aq cos ξ e ∑ c m q =1 p
or
where
ϖ
is the lowest frequency and
ω = ϖq .
(4)
The coefficients Aq can be
written as:
Тq Aq =
∫ 0
iϖ q Re W (ξ , ω ) cos ξ dt c s
(5)
Now so-called united shape function can be written as
Ni (x, z ) =
m
∑
N iq (x, z, ω ) = L(η ) Re W (ξ )
q =1
(6)
Finally equation (1) can be expressed as n
u( x, z , t ) = ∑ N i ( x, z , t )p i (t )
(7)
i =1
or
u (x, z ) = N p (x, z )p WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(8)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
101
The procedure described by the equations (4)–(6) can be treated as a superposing procedure based on a finite number of terms, where the real components of the wave functions ReWq (ξ , ω ) are called “preliminary” shape functions. The coefficients
Aq are generalized coordinates with only one component,
corresponding to the node i. It is easy to be shown that in the case of only one wave function used in the computational model, only one frequency, the proposed multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element is reduced to a single-wave elastodynamic infinite element. It can be treated as a special case. Then or
5
N i (x, z ) = N iq (x, z, ω ) = L(η ) Re W (ξ , ω )
(9)
N i (x, z ) = Niq (x, z ) = L(η ) Re W (ξ ) .
(10)
Two dimensional mapped infinite element
The next step is to generate mapping to map the infinite element domain to a finite domain and vice versa. Mapping functions and the Lagrange isoparametric shape functions for a 2D axisymmetric four node quadrilateral mapping infinite element and for a 2D axisymmetric eight node quadrilateral mapping infinite element can be written as follows. 5.1 2D axisymmetric four node quadrilateral mapping infinite element 5.1.1 Mapping functions
x = xI
(1 −η )(− ξ ) + x (1 + η )(− ξ ) + 1 x (1 +η )(1 + ξ ) +
1− ξ 1 (1 −η )(1 + ξ ) + xL 2 1− ξ y = yI
1− ξ
J
2
K
1− ξ
(11)
(1 −η )(− ξ ) + y (1 + η )(− ξ ) + 1 y (1 + η )(1 + ξ ) +
1− ξ 1 (1 −η )(1 + ξ ) + yL 2 1− ξ
J
1−ξ
2
K
1− ξ
5.1.2 Lagrange isoparametric shape functions (displacement field) 1 1 u = u I (1 − η ) ξ 2 − ξ + u J (1 + η ) ξ 2 − ξ + 4 4 1 1 2 2 + u K (1 + η )1 − ξ + u L (1 − η )1 − ξ 4 4 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(12)
(13)
102 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 5.2 2D axisymmetric eight node quadrilateral mapping infinite element 5.2.1 Mapping functions
x = xI
(1 −η )(− 1 − ξ −η ) + 2x
y = yI
(1 −η )(− 1 − ξ −η ) + 2 y
(1 −η ) + x (1 +η )(−1 − ξ +η ) + 2
1− ξ 1− ξ ( )( ) (1 + η )(1 + ξ ) 1 1 +η 1 + ξ 1 + xM + xL 2 1− ξ 2 1−ξ J
1− ξ
K
(14)
(1 −η ) + y (1 +η )(−1 − ξ +η ) + 2
1− ξ 1−ξ (1 + η )(1 + ξ ) 1 (1 + η )(1 + ξ ) 1 + yL + yM 2 1−ξ 2 1− ξ J
1− ξ
K
(15)
5.2.2 Lagrange isoparametric shape functions (displacement field)
(
)
1 1 u = uI (1 −η )(1 − ξ )(− 1 − η − ξ ) + uJ 1 − η 2 (1 − ξ ) + 2 4 1 1 + uK (1 + η )(1 − ξ )(− 1 + η − ξ ) + uL (1 + η ) 1 − ξ 2 + 2 4 1 + uM (1 − η ) 1 − ξ 2 2
(
(
)
(16)
)
5.3 Mass and stiffness matrices The stiffness and mass matrices can be given in a standard of the Finite element method form as [k e ] = [B ]T [D ][B ]dΩ e [me ] = [N ]T [N ]dΩ e I and (17) Ωe Ω e
∫
∫
where [N ] are the shape functions and the vectors {Bi } in the matrix [B ] are written as
∂N i {Bi } = ∂∂Nx i ∂y
or
∂N i ∂ξ 1 Bi = [J ] ∂N i ∂η
{ }
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(18)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
103
[ ]1
where J is the Jacobian matrix which defines the geometrical mapping and can be written as
∂ξ [J ]1 = ∂∂ξx ∂y
∂η ∂x ∂η ∂y
(19)
The domain differential dΩe must also be written in terms of the local coordinates as
dΩe = dxdy = [J ]dηdξ
(20)
{Bi }
and dΩe , which involves the mapping functions, the element stiffness and mass matrices may not be computed with standard Gaussian procedure.
Subject to the evaluation of
6 Continuity through finite and infinite elements The continuity through finite and infinite elements can be enforced in exactly the same way as between two finite elements in the case they have the same degrees of freedom and the degree of approximation. A sketch of the boundary between finite and infinite elements is given in fig. 2.
ηf
ηi
Ω ie
ξi Ω
fe
Figure 2:
7
ξf Sketch of the boundary between finite and infinite elements.
Conclusion
This paper proposes a formulation of a multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element, appropriate for multi-wave soil-structure interaction problems. In the case of only one included wave function, the proposed multi-wave elastodynamic infinite element is reduced to a single-wave elastodynamic infinite element. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
104 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The formulation follows the standard infinite element formulation steps which are the same as in the Finite element method after the mapping the infinite domain to a finite domain of the element. Also the mapping and the Lagrange isoparametric shape functions for a 2D axisymmetric four node multi-wave elastodynamic quadrilateral infinite element and for a 2D axisymmetric eight node multi-wave elastodynamic quadrilateral infinite element are given.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9]
[10]
[11]
[12] [13] [14]
Wolf J.P, Song C, Finite-element modeling of unbounded media. Willey, 1996. Bathe K.J., Finite element procedures in engineering analysis. PrenticeHill, 1982. Bancov B. P., Palova J. B., “The Finite Element Method in Structural Mechanics”, UACG, 1996, (in Bulgarian). Ungless R.F., “Un infinite elements”, M.A. Sc. Dissertation, University of British Columbia, 1973. Bettess P., “Infinite elements”, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, 1978; 11:54-64. Yan Ch. B., Kim D.K., Kim J.N., “Analytical frequency-dependent infinite elements for soil-structure interaction analysis in two-dimensional medium”, Engineering Structures 22 (2000); 258-271. Wolf J.P., “Soil-Structure Interaction Analysis in Time Domain”, Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hill, 1988. Kazakov K, “A model of one-dimensional wave propagation in homogeneous media”, Journal Stroitelstvo, 6/2004, 12-14. (in Bulgarian) Kazakov K, “An adequate computational model of the infinite soil for Soil-Structure Interaction Problems”, Proceedings of X Congress of applied mechanics, Bulgarian Academy of Science, Varna, Bulgaria, 2005. Kazakov K, “On the model of elastodynamic infinite element for the far field in Soil-Structure Interaction problems”, Proceedings of National conference with international participation of VSU “Liuben Karavelov”, Sofia, 2005, (in Bulgarian). Kazakov K, “A model if FEM type elastodynamic infinite element for Soil-Structure Interaction”, Proceedings of the 4th International Conference on New trends in Static and Dynamics of structure 20-21 October 2005. Bratislava, Slovakia. Kazakov K., “Continuity between Finite and Infinite Elements, Along Artificial Boundary in Soil-Structure Interaction Problems”, Proceedings of the Jubilee Conference in UACG 2007, Sofia, Bulgaria Madabhushi S. P. G., “Modeling of deformations in Dynamic SoilStructure Interaction problems”, VELACS, 1996. Park K. L., Watanabe E., Utsunomiya T., “Development of 3D elastodynamic infinite elements for Soil-Structure Interaction Problems”, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[15] [16] [17] [18]
105
International Journal of Structural Stability and Dynamics, Vol. 4, No. 3 (2004) 423-441 Cecot W., Demkowicz L., Rachowicz W., “A three-dimensional infinite element for Maxwell’s equations”, TICAM Report 00.20 Gerdes K., “A review of Infinite Element Method”, Journal of Computational Acoustics Zhao Ch., Valliappan S., “A Dynamic Infinite Element for Threedimensional Infinite Domain Wave Problems”, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, Vol. 36, (1993), 2567-2580 Zienkievicz O. C., Bando K., Bettess P., Emson C., Chiam T. C., “Mapped Infinite Elements for Exterior Wave Problems”, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, Vol. 21, (1985), 12291251
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Section 2 Experimental and computational analysis
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
109
Influence of the collision speed and angle of a bullet: experimental reconstruction of bullet configuration and FE-analysis H. Sakamoto1, T. Hiwatashi1, T. Yamaguchi2 & M. Yamamoto3 1
Mechanical System Division, Graduate School of Science and Technology, Kumamoto University, Japan 2 Forensic Science Laboratory, Kumamoto Pref. Police H.Q., Japan 3 Faculty of Engineering, Kumamoto University, Japan
Abstract In this research, the bullet-firing test was carried out at different velocities and collision angles of the bullet. The influence of its velocity and angle on the deformation shape after firing was discussed by comparison with experiment and simulation. The velocity of the bullet was chosen in several kinds of speed ranges at 80m/s–250m/s. As for the angle of incidence with the collision object, four kinds of angles 90° (head-on collision), 45°, 30° and 60° were set. The deformation shape was measured by a 3D coordinate measurement machine and reconstructed with 3D-CAD based on the 3D digital data. The bullet hole and deformation of the polycarbonate board caused by the bullet's collision with the object was also examined. In addition, the collision simulation of the bullet was carried out using LS-DYNA, and these analytical results were compared with the 3D digital data of the bullet. The comparison of the FE-simulation analysis results of the experiment enabled the quantitative evaluation of the collision deformation. Keywords: collision, bullet, deformation analysis, LS-DYNA, 3D-CAD.
1
Introduction
Gun crime has been increasing year on year. Collecting the bullet after firing is needed to solve these affairs [1]. It is often that a bullet is the only evidence in the affair. Therefore, studies about a bullet deformed by a collision are very WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070111
110 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII important. For example, rifling marks on a bullet after firing give information about the type of gun used; in the same way, deformation of the target will indicate the firing position and firing angle. The purpose of this research is to clarify the influence of collision velocity and collision angle on deformed shapes of bullets and targets. In addition, we simulated the collision of the bullet by FEM (Finite Element Method) and attempted a comparison between experimental and simulated results.
2
Experiment
2.1 Materials Three types of bullet with full metal were used. The external appearances are shown in Figure 1. These are called “round nose bullet” and the lead core is coated with copper film. Bullets were shot with 38Auto and Wheel (S&W) gun (Figure 2) at a polycarbonate plate (PC), which was used as a shield. PC board of 10mm in thickness was used. 2.2 Experimental procedure The distance from gun to target was about 6.4m shown in Figure 3. The velocity of the bullet was measured by a laser ballistic chronograph. The bullet velocity was controlled by adjusting the amount of explosive powder in the cartridge case. The 25AUTO and 380AUTO shown in Figure 1 (b)(c) were used in headon collision tests. The 38SPL shown in Figure 1(a) was used in oblique collision tests. The collision angles are θ=30°, 45° and 60°to the target shown in Figure 4.
3
Results and discussion
Gun
3.1 Test firing The upper part in Figure 5 shows the bullet’s original shape and deformed shapes in the case of head-on collision after firing. The corresponding bullet holes of the target plate were shown in the lower part. These configurations were precisely measured by a 3D coordinate measurement machine and were reconstructed by using a 3D-CAD system as digital data as shown in Figure 6. The reconstructed models of the deformed bullet were done to compare experimental and analytical results quantitatively. Moreover, by using the digital data, the deformed bullet’s dimensions, for example, cross sectional areas and volumes, can be evaluated precisely. Figure 7 shows the relationship between the bullet velocity and deformation rate. This indicates that the deformation rate’s peak occurs at 150 m/s (corresponding to a kinetic energy of 100J). The reason comes from the fact that the compressive strength of the bullet overtakes the compressive strength of polycarbonate in the case of the low collision velocity (less than 150 m/s). The relationship between velocity and bullet hole are given in Table 1. The depth of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
111
11.35
11.25
17.3
the bullet hole becomes bigger with increasing collision velocity. The diameter of the bullet also shows a similar trend. The depth of the bullet hole is comparatively small due to energy absorption by bending deformation of the polycarbonate. However, in the case of high velocity (more over 150 m/s), the plastic deformation region was limited to the contact region only. Therefore, both bullet hole diameter and compressive plastic deformation of the bullet have been decreased at 251 m/s [2,3].
φ9
φ6.3
φ9
38SPL
25AUTO
380AUTO
Figure 1:
Geometry and dimension of bullets.
Figure 2: 38Auto and Wheel (S&W) gun.
Target
Laser ballistic chronograph Gun
Figure 3:
gun
Firing experimental layout.
Polycarbonate board
θ
center
Overhead view Figure 4:
Overhead view of firing experiment system.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
112 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Original 発 射前 shape
79.2
103.5
126.4
150.6
228.1
holes
250.9 m /s
Figure 5:
Bullet’s shapes and bullet’s 380AUTO,V=79.2~250.9m/s).
(head-on
collision,
Figure 6:
Reconstruction bullet shape by using 3D measurement and 3DCAD.
Deformation rate (%)
30
20
10 ● 380AUTO 0 0
Figure 7:
100 200 Velocity of bullet (m/s)
300
Relationship between bullet velocity and deformation rate (head-on collision).
3.2 Numerical simulation Finite Element models for the bullet and polycarbonate plate are shown in Figure 8. As analysis conditions, the collision velocities and the angles in experimental conditions were used. In addition, the spinning of the bullet, material’s strain rate WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
113
dependence, Mach number and friction were considered [3–6]. The main analytical constants of the material properties used in the simulation experiment are shown in table 2. Table 1:
The dimensions of bullet holes.
Collision velocity (m/s) 79 104 126 151 228 251
Type of bullet
380AUTO (head-on collision)
Diameter of bullet Depth of bullet hole hole (mm) (mm) 7.2 0 8.3 0.1 10.3 0.3 11.4 0.4 12.2 3.9 11.7 4.0
(a) Target model (polycarbonate board) Figure 8:
(b) Bullet model (380AUTO)
An example of the analysis model using an FEM simulation.
Table 2:
Analytical constants of material properties.
Cu 3
Mass density (kg/m ) Young’s modulus (GPa) Yield stress (MPa) Poisson’s ratio
8.93×10 132 196 0.34
Pb 3
11.337×10 17.2 60 0.44
PC 3
1.2×103 2.06 100 0.3
Comparison between analysis results and experimental ones in oblique collision (collision angle 30°) are shown in Figure 9. In the case of not considering the strain rate dependence, as the bullet deformation for high velocity is overestimated, the simulation was performed by using the strain-strain relation obtained under different velocity compression tests. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
114 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The deformation shapes obtained from simulation were in good agreement with experimental results for the collision angle of 30°. However, for the angle of 60-degrees, the calculated model and the experimental results were a little different. Although the contact between the bullet bottom part and PC-plate in the experiments was recognized, this contact mark on the PC plate was not observed in the simulation. The same tendency is observed for the collision angle of 45-degrees. This is probably caused by the definition of friction between the bullet and polycarbonate and the bonding condition between lead and copper of the bullet used in the simulation. Results of head-on collisions are not presented here, however experimental results and simulation results show very good correlation.
(a) Analysis results in collision angle 30° (V = 79~218m/s)
(b) Experiment results in angle 30° (V = 79~218m/s) Figure 9:
Comparison of analysis results with experiment ones (38SPL, collision angle: 30°).
Cracks on copper coated bullets were recognized in oblique collision experiments. These cracks caused by the rifling mark in spirals have little influence on the deformed shape of the bullets shown in Figure 9. However, the non-coated lead bullet breaks with cracks cased along rifling marks in the headon collision experiment (Figure 10). Figure 11 shows an example of the simulation result for the non-coated lead bullet [7,8]. From comparison with both figures, it is found that the deformation and fracture behaviour can be evaluated by simulation quantitatively.
4
Conclusion
The effect of collision velocity and collision angle on bullet deformation was discussed and performance of a protection board made of polycarbonate was estimated by experiment and FE Analysis. The results obtained are summarized as follows. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 10: Fracture under head-on collision for non-coated bullet.
115
Figure 11: Fracture analysis under head-on collision for noncoated bullet.
(1) For the low collision velocity region, polycarbonate plate undergoes bending deformation. In the case of high collision velocity, the plastic deformation region of polycarbonate plate was limited to the bullet’s contact region only. (2) For a collision angle smaller than 30o, the simulation results show good agreement with experimental ones under consideration of the train rate dependence. (3) When the collision angle is bigger than 45°, the simulation results and the experimental ones are a little different because of the friction between the bullet and polycarbonate, and the bonding condition between lead and copper. (4) In collision simulations, the rifling marks on full metal shield bullets of firing have little influence on the deformed shape of bullets. However, the crash and fracture phenomenon occur along the cracks ignited by the rifling marks.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
K. Kashiwatani, Forensic science for Investigation, 1983. N. Cristescu: Dynamic Plasticity, North-Holland Publishing Company, 1967. T. Borvik, O.S. Hopperstad, T. Berstad, M. Langseth, A computational model of viscoplasticity and suctile damage for impact and penetration, Eur. J. Mech. A/Solids 20, pp.685-712, 2001 T. Negishi, T. Ogura, T. Masumoto, T. Goto, K. Fukuoka, and J. Syono: Mat. Sci. 20,1985. R. Barauskas & A. Abraitiene, Computational analysis of impact of impact of a bullet against the multiplayer fabrics in LS-DYNA, International Journal of Impact Engineering, 2005 K. Sakino, Strain Rate Dependence of Dynamic Flow Stress of Aluminum Alloy 6061 at Very High Straom Rates, Original Paper, vol.54 No.12 pp.1301-1306 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
116 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [7] [8]
H. Kurtaran, M. Buyuk & A. Eskandarian, Ballistic impact simulation of GT model vehicle door using finite element method, Theoretical and Applied Fracture Mechanics 40,pp.113-121, 2003 P.A. Vityaz, V. Roman: Proc.13th Int. J. Mach. Tool Des. & Res., 1972.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
117
Influence of the cross-section shape on the lateral torsional buckling capacity D. Djurić-Mijović & M. Trajković Faculty of Civil Engineering and Architecture, University of Niš, Republic of Serbia
Abstract The bifurcation-load of a bending girder, the ideal lateral torsional buckling moment MKI, is of great importance for the verification of stability. The solutions in the literature exist almost exclusively for double-symmetrical cross sections. The whole problem considering the lateral torsional buckling is quite complex as the analytical solutions for determining the lateral torsional buckling strength exist in closed-form only for the most simple cases, e.g. for the case of a simply supported double symmetric beam of a constant cross-section under uniform moment. However, for most cases, in order to obtain the buckling load, numerical or approximate solutions are required. This article examines the problem of elastic lateral torsional bucking of simply supported, monosymmetric I and T-beams under two different transverse load cases. Correct and approximate Euro Code 3 (EC3) approaches for obtaining elastic lateral torsional buckling capacities of monosymmetric I and T-beams were investigated for each load case. Solutions were obtained in terms of the easily evaluated degree of beam monosymmetry, β f , beam parameter, K , and monosymmetry parameter, rz. The results obtained are graphically presented and compared. It was found that approximation formulae for rz given by Kitipornchai and Trahair are much more accurate compared to the correct formulae than the approximation formulae proposed by EC3. T-beams are considered as a special case of monosymmetric I cross sections. In conclusion, the authors recommend utilisation of different types of cross sections for different types of loading and length of the beams. The result can be significant savings in material as well as increased stability of the structure regarding lateral torsional buckling of monosymmetric cross section girders. Keywords: lateral torsional buckling, monosymmetric cross section, EC3, thinwalled open cross section, monosymmetry parameter. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070121
118 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Lateral torsional buckling
Lateral torsional buckling is a mode of structural failure in which one or more members (beams, trusses….) of a frame suddenly deflect and twist out of the plane of loading (Trahair [2]). If it is not prevented in the right way, lateral torsional buckling may reduce the load-carrying-capacity of the structure because members subjected to a flexure have much greater strength and stiffness in the plane of the loading (major principal axis) than in the minor principal axis. The implication is that structural members are subjected to a failure by lateral torsional buckling before they even reach their full in-plane capacity. This problem is frequent and it is perceived at slender members or structures, and so, of great importance in the design of steel structures. Also, it often occurs in the construction phase. This kind of structure deformation does not concern only individual members, but also occurs in rigid-jointed structures, where continuity of rotations between adjacent members causes them to interact during buckling. Lateral torsional buckling of a member, as a combination of lateral buckling and torsional buckling, is a case in which transverse displacements of a member, out-of-plane deflection v and in-plane deflection w, occur in combination with rotation ϑ, around its major axis.
Figure 1:
Elastic bending and buckling.
A beam, which is bent in its stiffer principal plane, may buckle out of that plane by deflecting laterally out-of-plane v and rotating (twisting) ϑ, as shown in the Figure 1(b). These deformations are interdependent. For example, a twist rotation ϑ of the beam will cause the in-plane bending moment My to have an out-plane component Myϑ as shown in Figure 2(a), which will cause lateral deflections v. Conversely, lateral deflections v will cause the moment My to have a torque component Myv' as shown in Figure 2(b), which will cause twist rotations ϑ. Lateral torsional buckling is resisted by combinations of the bending resistances EIzd2v/dx2 and -EIyd2w/dx2 and the torsional resistances GJtdϑ/dx and -EIwd3ϑ/dx3 (Trahair [2]). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
2
119
Interdependence of v and ϑ .
Buckling capacities of monosymmetric I-cross sections
2.1 Description of the system, boundary conditions and load cases In this paper the single span beams, simply supported in-plane ( w 0 = w L = 0 , w ′0 , w ′L ≠ 0 ,) and simply supported out-of-plane are considered. The ends of the beams, that are simply supported out-of-plane, are fixed against out-of-plane deflections and twist rotations v 0 = v L = ϑ 0 = ϑ L = 0 , but are unrestrained against minor axis rotations v ′0 , v ′L (so that v ′0′ = v ′L′ = 0 ) and against warping displacements proportional to ϑ′0 , ϑ′L (so that ϑ′0′ = ϑ′L′ = 0 ), Figure 3(c). The beams are assumed to be perfectly straight and untwisted before loading and are exposed to the loads that initially cause deflections only in the plane of loading. It is also assumed that the direction of the load remains unchanged during buckling. Within this paper the central concentrated load, Figure 3(a) and uniformly distributed load case, Figure 3(b) were examined.
(c) Figure 3:
System, boundary conditions and load cases.
2.2 Differential equations Differential equilibrium equations (Trahair [2]) for a simply supported beam with monosymmetric cross-section under a uniform moment induced by equal and opposite end moments M, are shown in Figure 4. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
120 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (EI z v′′)′′ + (M y ϑ)′′ = 0 (EI W ϑ′′) ′′ − (GI t ϑ′) ′ + M y v ′′ − (M y rz ϑ′) ′ = 0
with the boundary conditions: v 0,L = v′0′,L = ϑ 0,L = ϑ′0′, L = 0
Figure 4:
(1) (2) (3)
Simply supported beam under end moments.
Terms (M y rz ϑ′)′ are associated with the monosymmetry property rz, called the monosymmetry parameter of the cross section or “Wagner effect”, which is given by 1 z( y 2 + z 2 )dA − 2z S (4) rz = Iy
∫ A
zS is the distance between the centroid and shear centre and Iy is the major axis moment of inertia. Many authors have developed various approximate formulas for rz. One of them was developed by Trahair and Kitipornchai (Kitipornchai and Trahair [4]) rZ ≅ 0.9h S (2β f − 1)[1 − (I z / I y ) 2 ] (5) in which Iz/Iy is the ratio of the second moment of area of the section about minor and major axes respectively, hs is the distance between shear centres of the flanges. This formula has very good accuracy and is used for practical purposes. 2.3 Buckling capacities of monosymmetric I cross-sections In the case of double symmetric cross sections the tensile and compressive bending stresses are equal and the flanges are at the same distance from the shear centre. That leads to increasing buckling resistance caused by tensile stresses balanced by increasing buckling action caused by compressive stresses. However, this balance is upset in monosymmetric beams. When such a beam twists during buckling, the longitudinal bending stresses exert a torque around the axis of twist of the member. This torque causes an effective change in the torsional stiffness from GIt to (GIt+Myrz), in which My is the major axis moment and rz is the monosymmetry parameter. As a consequence, when the larger flange is in compression the buckling resistance is increased, and opposite (Anderson and Trahair [5]). The elastic critical moment, MKI, of the monosymmetric I-beam under uniform moment is a solution of eqns (1) and (2) and is given as: 2 rZ K 2 rZ K π + (6) M KI = EI Z GI t 1 + 4β f (1 − β f )K + h hS L S WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 5:
121
Monosymmetric I-cross sections.
where EIz is the minor axis flexural rigidity, GIt is the torsional rigidity, L is the length of the beam. The next parameters are K , the beam parameter, also called the torsion parameter and βf, the measure of monosymmetry or degree of monosymmetry: K=
π 2 EI Z h S 4GI t L2
2
;
βf =
I fc ; 0 ≤ β f ≤ 1.0 I fc + I ft
(7)
where hs is the distance between shear centres of the flanges. The values of K for practical beams are in the range between 0.1 and 2.5 with low values representing long beams and/or compact cross-sections and high values corresponding to short beams and/or slender cross-sections.
Various cross sections depending on βf.
Figure 6:
These two parameters, βf and K , enable easily visualization of the monosymmetric I-beam. 2.4 Euro Code 3 - buckling formulae The general formula according to Euro Code 3 for a beam of uniform cross section, elastic critical moment for lateral torsional buckling, MKI is given by M KI
π 2 EI Z k = C1 (kL)2 k W
I W (kL )2 GI t I + π 2 EI + C 2 z g − C 3 z j Z Z 2
(
)
2
1/ 2
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
− C 2 z g − C 3 z j (8)
(
)
122 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII in which C1,C2,C3 are factors depending on the loading and boundary conditions, k and kw are effective length factors and these coefficients are given in Annex F of Euro Code 3. 1 zg = za − zs ; z y 2 + z 2 dA (9) z j = zs − 2I y
∫(
)
A
where za is the coordinate of the load application point and zs is the coordinate of the shear centre. For an I-section with unequal flanges it is recommended to calculate the warping section constant, Iw by the following formula 2 I W = β f (1 − β f )I Z h S (10) where hs is the distance between the shear centres of the flanges. Using eqn (8) and zj calculated by eqn (9)2 the correct values of MKI were obtained. Also, the approximate formula for zj was proposed in Annex F of Euro Code 3, for βf >0.5 z j = 0.8(2β f − 1)h S / 2 (11) for βf <0.5
z j = 1.0(2β f − 1)h S / 2
(12)
Now using equation (8) and an approximate equation for zj (11) or (12) the approximate values of elastic critical moment MKI were obtained. It should be mentioned that the relation between the previously explained monosymmetry parameter rZ (eqn (4)) and zj is rz=2zj. For all examined load cases the coefficients k = kw =1.0. 2.5 Parametric investigation In the following the obtained results of the elastic critical moment for lateral torsional buckling MKI calculated by the previously explained approaches will be presented: • EC3 (correct formulae), • EC3 (approximate formulae) considering monosymmetric I-cross-sections with the following values of the monosymmetry degree βf = 0; 0.1; 0.2; 0.3; 0.4; 0.5; 0.6; 0.7; 0.8; 0.9; 1.0. Investigation was carried out on 9 cross-sections based on the following: IPB1 (HEA)140, IPB1(HEA)500, IPB1(HEA)900, IPB(HEB)140, IPB(HEB)500, IPB(HEB)900, IPE120, IPE330 and IPE550, but for each of these cross-sections investigation was carried out for eleven values of the monosymmetry degree βf, see Figure 6. For βf =0.5 the cross section actually have dimensions of HEA 500; for βf =0 it is an inverted T-cross sections with dimensions of the web and the flange as of HEA 500. For the wanted values of βf and for fixed dimensions of one flange it is easy to calculate the dimensions of the other flange. To obtain the cross-section properties (Iz, It, Iw, etc.), FEM software RUBSTAHL-KSTAB 2000 is used (Kindmann [7]). For each cross-section, investigations were done for loads applied at the top flange, shear centre and bottom flange, respectively, for each value of beam parameter, K ( K = 0.1; 0.5; 1.0; 1.5; 2.0 and 2.5) and for each degree of monosymmetry βf. All this was done for the two earlier explained load cases. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
123
To enable a comparison of results between monosymmetric I-cross sections with different degrees of monosymmetry, βf it was necessary to calculate the dimensionless elastic critical moment M KI [−] =
M KI [kNm] ⋅ L EI Z GI t
(13)
Considering the topic of load-carrying capacity for lateral torsional buckling of monosymmetric I-cross-sections, the following investigations have been done: • influence of monosymmetry degree, βf to lateral torsional capacity, MKI for different values of beam parameter, K (which means for different beam length), • deviations [%] of rz obtained by the approximate formulas (EC3 and Kitipornchai and Trahair formulae) from the correct formulae given by EC3. The results are given below.
3
Numerical results
For the central concentrated load case for all examined cross sections and a load applied at the top flange, shear centre and bottom flange it was found that the best capacities have highly monosymmetric cross sections with βf = 1.0 and 0.9. For the uniformly distributed load case, opposite to the previous load case where the distribution is smooth, the additional influence of beam parameter K has been noticed. Here, when the load is applied at the top flange, and K ≥1.5 the best capacities have cross sections with βf = 0.9; 0.8 ;1.0, respectively. But for K < 1.5, as well as in the case when the load is applied at the bottom flange, load capacity is distributed smoothly and the best capacities have cross sections with βf =1.0. When the load is applied at the shear centre the behaviour of the cross section concerning the lateral torsional buckling is different: for K ≥1.0 the best capacities have cross sections with βf = 0.8 followed by 0.7 and 0.9. It is interesting to mention that for shear centre loading and for K >1.5 even the double symmetric cross section (βf =0.5) has greater capacity than the T-beam (βf =1.0). Figure 7 shows elastic critical loads, MKI, of monosymmetric I beams under central concentrated load applied at top flange, shear centre and bottom flange. Figure 9 shows MKI of the monosymmetric I beams under uniformly distributed load applied at the top flange, shear centre and bottom flange. The Kitipornchai and Trahair approximate formulae for calculation of rz are reported to be of good accuracy in a range between 0.1 ≤ βf ≤ 0.9 (deviation from correct formulae up to 6%). In the case of highly monosymmetric cross sections for which β f approaches 0 or 1,0 the deviation is up to 18%, as opposed to the EC3 approximate formulae for which the deviation is up to 50%, Figure 8.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
124 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 35
Bf=0 Bf=0,1
30
Non-Dimensional Mk i
Bf=0,2 25
Bf=0,3 Bf=0,4
20
Bf=0,5 Bf=0,6
15
Bf=0,7 10
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
5
Bf=1,0 0 0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
35
Bf=0 Bf=0,1
30
Non-Dimensional Mki
Bf=0,2 25
Bf=0,3 Bf=0,4
20
Bf=0,5 Bf=0,6
15
Bf=0,7 10
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
5
Bf=1,0
0 0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
60
Bf=0 Bf=0,1 Bf=0,2 Bf=0,3
40
Bf=0,4 Bf=0,5
30
Bf=0,6 Bf=0,7
20
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
10
Bf=1,0
0 0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
K (Beam Parameter)
Figure 7:
Central concentrated load.
60 50 40 EC3 correct
30
EC3 app.
rz
Non-Dimensional Mki
50
20
Kitip.&Wang app.
10 0 0.0
-10
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
Bf
Figure 8:
Deviations [%] of rz.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
10
Bf=0
9
Non-Dimensional Mki
125
Bf=0,1
8
Bf=0,2
7
Bf=0,3 Bf=0,4
6
Bf=0,5
5
Bf=0.6
4
Bf=0,7
3
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
2
Bf=1,0
1 0 0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
10
Bf=0
Non-Dimensional Mki
9
Bf=0,1
8
Bf=0,2
7
Bf=0,3 Bf=0,4
6
Bf=0,5
5
Bf=0.6
4
Bf=0,7
3
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
2
Bf=1,0
1 0 0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
10
Bf=0
Non-Dimensional Mki
9
Bf=0,1
8
Bf=0,2
7
Bf=0,3 Bf=0,4
6
Bf=0,5
5
Bf=0.6
4
Bf=0,7
3
Bf=0,8 Bf=0,9
2
Bf=1,0
1 0 0.0
0.5
1.0
Figure 9:
4
1.5
2.0
2.5
Uniformly distributed load.
Conclusions
Influence of the monosymmetric cross section shape on lateral torsional buckling capacity has been investigated in this paper. These results based on EC3, where it was found that the best capacities have cross sections with βf =1.0 (0.9), are different in comparison with previously investigated approaches of RUBSTAHL-KSTAB 2000 (Djurić [1]) and Kitipornchai and Trahair (Kitipornchai and Trahair [4]) where for the same load cases the capacity of the T-beam is much lower then for beams with βf = 0.9 and 0.7.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
126 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Also it was found that the approximate formulae for the monosymmetry parameter rz given by Kitipornchai and Trahair is more accurate in comparison to the rz correct formulae than the EC3 approximation formulae. After this extensive theoretical and numerical research, it appears necessary to experimentally verify these approaches in order to determine which is the most accurate in describing the behaviour of real models. Using the approximation in respect to the accurate formula for calculation of rz, the calculation time would be significantly shortened, which would be very important for the design of demanding structures. It has been theoretically demonstrated that certain monosymmetric I cross sections possess higher bearing capacity to lateral torsional buckling than the double symmetrical I cross sections. Using the monosymmetric cross sections, considerable savings could be accomplished, and the steel structure weight would be reduced. This is very important for contemporary engineering practice. Experimental investigation is a present occupation of the authors.
Acknowledgement The support from the Ministry of Science and Environmental Protection, Republic of Serbia, through the projects ON144002 and ON144027 is gratefully acknowledged.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
Djurić D., Influence of the Cross-Section-Shape on the Bifurcation-Loads of Bending Girders, Master thesis, Ruhr University Bochum, Germany, 2002. Trahair, N.S., Flexural-Torsional Buckling of Structures, 1st edn, E&FN Spon (Chapman & Hall) London, 1993. Galambos T.V. Guide to Stability Design Criteria for Metal Structures. 4th edn, John Wiley and Sons, New York, 1988. Kitipornchai, S. and Trahair, N.S. Buckling properties of monosymmetric I-beams. Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, 106 (941-57), 1980. Anderson, J.M. and Trahair N.S. Stability of monosymmetric I-beams and cantilevers. Journal of Structural Division, ASCE, 98 (269-86), 1972 Wang, C.M. and Kitipornchai, S. Buckling capacities of monosymmetric Ibeams. Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE 112 (2373-91), 1986. R. Kindmann, Computed-oriented Design of Steel Structures. RuhrUniversity, Bochum, 2001.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
127
Computational fluid dynamic modelling and simulation evaluation of the plume evacuation device efficiencies F. Farshad1, H. Rieke1, L. C. LaHaye2 & S. C. Nulu1 1 2
University of Louisiana at Lafayette, USA Vision Pro LLC, USA
Abstract The purpose of our work has been to evaluate the fluid flow dynamics of distal and proximal handheld plume evacuation devices used during LASIK eye surgery using Computational Fluid Dynamic (CFD) Modelling. Fluid flow dynamics studies using CFD simulations were conducted on a proximal plume evacuator, LAHayeSIK™ surgical device, and on the VISX Star S3, which is a distal large volume plume evacuation device. The resulting data was compared and analyzed with experimental data. CFD results show that the proximal plume evacuation system generated a uniform laminar airflow velocity of 0.94 m/s across the corneal surface as compared to 1.3 m/s reported by the distal evacuation system. Flow profiles indicate high shear regions resulting in vortex formations, for the large volume distal evacuator. The CFD simulations conducted to determine the airflow profiles generated by the two surgical plume evacuation devices concur with data obtained from experiments. Flow patterns simulated by the CFD modeling, indicate that the proximal plume evacuation devices generate a gentle laminar airflow profiles over the stromal surface. On the other hand, the distal large volume plume evacuators generate multiple regions of varying air flow velocities contributing to ineffective plume capture. Keywords: computational fluid dynamics, fluent, LAHayeSIKTM, LASIK, plume evacuation, CFD simulation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070131
128 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
One of the ultimate goals in performing any surgical procedure is to minimize less than desirable outcomes arising from both infectious and noninfectious contaminants entering the surgical field (LaHaye et al., [1, 2]). Although not normally thought of as such, plume smoke is a by-product contaminate of excimer laser surgery. The complexities of plume formation and its rapid dynamic movements both vertically and laterally impose problems that present undesirable outcomes and present health related issues for the surgeon, patient, and nursing staff. In excimer refractive surgery a laser’s accuracy, effectiveness, and reproducibility can be directly affected by how well the surgical operating environment is managed. The authors emphasize that managing the microclimate of the stromal bed during the excimer refractive procedures is the only important avenue where substantial improvements can be made through advancements in design for better outcomes and fewer health risks. Air flow dynamics generated by plume evacuation systems can have direct and indirect influences on refractive outcome. A direct effect of LASIK plume smoke is the masking effect created as the plume hangs just over the ablating stromal bed, blocking subsequent excimer pulses which can cause a measurable difference in the resulting ablation (Duffey, [3]). Researchers contend that the plume particles falling back onto the on the ablating stromal bed creates additional beam masking (Noack et al., [4]) and may be a contributing factor to the “Sands of the Sahara” syndrome (Dell, [5]). Research has demonstrated that plume vapor condensation with precipitation contributes to visible fluid accumulation on the surface of the stromal bed during ablation. This additional regional accumulation of fluid can interfere with beam etching to cause a decrease in transmission of energy to the stroma through increased reflection and absorption of incident laser energy. This resulted in undesirable ablation, such as central islands, “hot and cold” spots, and under corrections (Oshika et al., [7]). Most corporate and physician-based nomograms are based on a certain portion of the excimer beam being blocked by plume particles (Maguen and Machat, [8], Duffey, [3]). Laser manufacturers add pulses to the nomograms based on outcome averages to “compensate” for plume masking attributes of their systems. The “blanket” method of re-mediating the numerous problems associated with plume appears to have little logic. The many potential problems associated with plume should direct one to solving the underlying issue by removing the cause and therefore the effect as opposed to simply adding additional laser pulses in an attempt to compensate. Since the adoption of excimer refractive procedures some 15 years ago, the industry has several alternatives for plume management. The options include; (1) no plume management; (2) operating room ventilation fan generated room air blown across the surgical field; (3) laser integrated distal plume evacuation; (4) laser integrated devices which combine blown air and distal plume evacuation; and (5) handheld proximal plume evacuation devices. Because of the potential health hazards associated with plume, we have chosen to compare systems that
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
129
are, in theory, designed to only remove plume. Experimental analysis and Computational Fluid Dynamics were used to comprehend the dynamics of the plume generated during the LASIK surgery. Two types of plume evacuation devices, the proximal plume evacuation device – LAHayeSIK™ Surgical System and the distal plume evacuation system – VISX Star S3 are compared for their effectiveness in design to remove plume generated during LASIK surgery. Our CFD results of this study emphasize modern computational techniques like CFD, which can be used with a great effect in determining the best design technique for medical equipment design.
2
CFD simulation of the proximal LAHayeSIK™ plume evacuation system
The flow domain for the proximal plume evacuation system is identified as the path inside and outside the handpiece in the vicinity of the stromal surface, where the plume particles travel under the influence of the plume evacuation force. Figure 1 shows the plume flow domain of the proximal plume evacuation system that is to be modeled.
Figure 1:
Solid model (domain) of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device.
The solid model of the domain is created in FLUENT’s GAMBIT using the basic geometrical tools such as edges, faces, and volumes. The design of the solid model incorporates all the nuances in the model and the exact measurements of angles and distances. The model is then meshed using various meshing strategies to come up with the best quality mesh. The mesh can be used by FLUENT to solve the numerical equations without any divergence problems. Figure 2 shows the meshed model of the plume evacuation function of the LAHayeSIKTM surgical device. The meshed model from GAMBIT is then set up inside the FLUENT console after performing a grid check for negative volumes and inconsistent meshing. Thus, the solution is setup with the required parameters and boundary conditions and is iterated for convergence with a constant monitoring of the solution using the residuals. The convergence criteria are set to be 10-6 and once the residuals reach this prescribed value, the solution is said to have converged and the data is post processed and the results analyzed. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
130 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
Meshed model of the plume evacuation flow domain of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device.
Figure 3:
Solid model of the plume evacuation flow domain of the distal plume evacuation surgical device.
3
CFD simulation of the distal VISX Star S3 plume evacuation system
The flow domain for the distal plume evacuation system is identified as the path in the vicinity of the stromal surface from the evacuation tube, where the plume particles travel under the influence of the suction force. Figure 3 presents the plume flow domain that has been modeled. To better capture the effects of facial features such as the nose, setting of the eyes, and the evacuation tube’s influence on the flow of room air. A modeled face is in the surgical position as the subject that under goes surgery. Notice the considerably sharp features of the nose and reasonably deep-set eyes in figure 3. The model is then meshed using various meshing strategies to come up with the best quality mesh, which can be used by FLUENT to solve the numerical equations without any divergence problems. The plume evacuation function of the VISX surgical device was constructed as a mesh model. The meshed model from GAMBIT is then exported to the solver, which is FLUENT in the present CFD analysis.
4 CFD simulation results The CFD results obtained in this simulation indicate some important flow aspects of the plume under the evacuation field generated by the plume WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
131
evacuation devices. The proximal plume evacuation system shows a more effective evacuation influence on the microclimate over the corneal surface and thus assists in the onsite plume removal without giving the plume particles a longer time of travel. It is noted that the longer the plume particles are in the vicinity of the corneal surface, the more chances for plume masking and other complications. The proximal plume evacuation technique allows a quick 360o on site plume removal technique along the circumference of the cornea with high velocity gradients created just above the corneal surface. The design of the ports is such that low and uniform velocity fields are generated over the corneal surface itself, thereby reducing the risk of over dehydrating the cornea.
Figure 4:
Flow path of the plume particles which are situated at height of the plume channel of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device. Simulation results show that all the plume is captured by the seven strategically placed ports.
Figure 4 shows the trajectories of the plume particles that are generated under the influence of the evacuation force of the LAHayeSIK™ plume evacuation function. The particles are created at a distance away from the corneal surface and the seven ports at a height of 2 cm from the corneal surface. The simulation shows that the entire plume is being captured by the seven strategically placed ports on the circumference of the handpiece. Simulating the particle paths to evaluate the velocity functions with a certain direction over the surface is a common practice to either create a set of points and plot their velocities or simulate the paths of the particle trajectories. In FLUENT, rakes are used to serve the same purpose. Rakes are a predetermined number of points between two specified endpoints. Figures 5 and 6 simulate the actual flow path of the plume particles that are generated during the actual surgery. These simulations show that not only the entire plume is effectively captured by the seven ports but also the flow paths indicate that there are no vortices or turbulent behavior during the plume travel. Contour maps show the velocity profiles over specified cross sections of a fluid domain (Figs. 7 and 8). These maps play an important role in indicating the change in velocities along the radial direction of the device. Figure 7 presents a contour map of simulated velocities generated by the plume evacuation function of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device at the corneal height. It shows low WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
132 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII velocities with uniform profiles, which is important to minimize uneven dehydration of the cornea. Figure 8 shows the contour map of simulated velocities generated by the plume evacuation function of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device at the plume channel height, which is about 3 cm from the cornea. This indicates that there is a high velocity field generated centimeters above the corneal surface that assists in the complete removal of the plume particles from the microclimate with no escape into the operating room, as shown by the particle paths. Figure 9 shows the plot of velocities on the rakes. This plot is an indication of the directional velocity changes as one goes away from the plume evacuation ports. The flatness of the curves indicates that there are minimal changes in the velocities in the radial direction and that an overall uniform evacuation is achieved by the combined effect of the seven evacuation ports.
Figure 5:
Flow path of the plume particles situated at different places on the cornea under the influence of the LAHayeSIK™ plume evacuation function.
Figure 6:
Flow path of the plume particles situated at different places on the cornea under the influence of the LAHayeSIK™ plume evacuation function. A complete capture is shown of all the plume particles generated at the corneal surface.
CFD simulations used the distal large volume VISX Star S3 plume evacuator to compare the CFD results with the experimental results and to delve deeper into the flow dynamics of distal plume evacuators. Figure 10 shows the velocity vectors generated over the facial contours by the VISX Star S3 plume evacuation WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
133
function achieved by employing the 22 mm diameter tube. The vector field indicates uneven velocity gradients with high and low velocity fields in the vertical plane, which create shear and cause vortices resulting in a high degree of turbulence. These vectors support the high turbulence and vortices observed during experiments with the artificial plume (Figure 11).
Figure 7:
Contour map of velocities generated by the plume evacuation function of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device at the corneal height.
Figure 8:
Contour map of velocities generated by the plume evacuation function of the LAHayeSIK™ surgical device at the plume channel height which is about 3 cm from the cornea.
Figure 9:
Plot of velocities with respect to position generated over the cornea in the direction of a rake.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
134 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 10:
Vector plot of the velocities generated by the VISX Star S3 distal plume evacuation device. The vertical plane of interest where the experimental velocities are measured.
Figure 11:
Photographs of the formation of vortices and plume escape in the field of a large volume distal plume evacuator documenting inefficient plume capture during LASIK surgery.
Figure 12:
Contour map of the velocity field generated by VISX Star S3 large volume plume evacuator in a plane perpendicular to corneal surface.
Figure 12 is the contour map of the velocities on the plane perpendicular to the corneal surface. These contour maps show similar profiles as obtained by WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
135
experimental studies, thereby validating the CFD simulation results. Figure 13 shows the trajectories of the plume particle paths under the influence of the distal plume evacuation velocity field generated by the distal large volume VISX Star S3 plume evacuator. The high shear generated by the high and low velocity fields in close proximity of the corneal surface cause turbulence and vortices. The non-uniform flow patterns cause escape of plume as shown in Figure 13.
Figure 13:
5
Path lines of trajectories of plume particles in the influence of the plume evacuation force field of the VISX Star S3 device.
Conclusions
Both the experimental and CFD simulation results indicate that the proximal plume evacuation systems are designed to better handle the plume evacuation as compared to the distal large volume plume evacuators. The proximal plume evacuators, owing to their proximity of the plume evacuation ports from the stromal surface have a greater effect in removing the generated plume. On the other hand, the particle trajectory simulations of the large volume evacuators indicate escape of particles and an inefficient plume removal. Also the presence of varying velocity fields just above the stromal surface results in high shear and thus there is a good possibility of vortex formations due to turbulence. This study concludes that the proximal plume evacuation systems such as LAHayeSIKTM are better designed to remove the plume generated during LASIK surgery as opposed to existing large volume evacuation technology.
References [1] [2]
LaHaye, L.C., Rieke, H.H., and Farshad, F.F., Is REFRACTIVE PROCEDURES Possible? Part Management, Oct 2005, pp. 97-99. LaHaye, L.C., Rieke, H.H., and Farshad, F.F., Is REFRACTIVE PROCEDURES Possible? Part Management, Jan 2006, pp. 45-46. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Cleaner EXCIMER I, Ophthalmology Cleaner EXCIMER 2, Ophthalmology
136 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
Duffey, R., Central Islands and Decentered Ablations After Excimer Refractive Procedures, International Ophthalmology Clinics 2000, 40, pp. 93-101. Noack et al., Influence of Ablation Plume Dynamics on the Formation of Islands in Excimer Laser Photorefractive Keratectomy, Ophthalmology 1997, 104(5), pp. 823-830. Dell, New System permits safe, more effective plume evacuation, Ophthalmology Times, April 2003. Charle, K., Effects of Laser Plume Evacuation on Laser in situ Keratomileusis Outcomes, Journal of Refractive Surgery, June 2002 (Suppl), pp. 340-341. Oshika et al., Corneal hydration and central islands after excimer laser photorefractive keratectomy, J Cataract Refractive Surgery, Dec 1998, 24, pp. 1575-1579. Maguen, E., Machat, J.J., Complications of photorefractive keratectomy, primarily with the VISX excimer laser, Corneal Laser Surgery 1995, pp. 143-158.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
137
Flow estimations through spillways under submerged tidal conditions P. D. Scarlatos1, M. Ansar2 & Z. Chen2 1
Department of Civil Engineering & Center for Intermodal Transportation Safety and Security, Florida Atlantic University, USA 2 Operations & Hydro Data Management Division, South Florida Water Management District, USA
Abstract The South Florida Water Management District (SFWMD), Florida, USA, operates and maintains about twenty-five coastal spillways that discharge excess runoff water directly into the environmentally sensitive area of Biscayne Bay, south of Miami. Over the past decade serious concerns have been raised regarding the large fluctuations of salinity levels in Biscayne Bay caused by the freshwater releases. At the SFWMD, discharges at gated spillways are computed from an instantaneous stage and operational control information by using basic formulas developed for the estimation of orifice and weir type of flows. However, the accuracy of discharge estimates is compromised whenever flow occurs under submerged conditions and particularly at tidally affected structures. This paper is focused on the estimation of discharges through gated spillways under tidal submerged flow conditions. Data are analyzed using dimensional analysis and an empirical model is developed based on data from two coastal spillways. The model relates the discharge as a function of the tail-water head and the low tide elevation during each tidal cycle. All of the other parameters are treated as constants and lumped into the empirical coefficients. Keywords: dimensional analysis, empirical formulas, flow measurements, spillways, submerged flows, tidal effects.
1
Introduction
The South Florida Water Management District (SFWMD) operates and maintains over four hundred hydraulic structures including spillways, weirs, culverts and pump stations. The main driving force for the development of water WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070141
138 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII controls in southern Florida is to maintain adequate water supplies for the rapidly growing population along the lower east coast, to sustain agricultural activities and to restore and protect the Everglades National Park and other delicate wetland and coastal ecosystems. Approximately one hundred and twenty of the hydraulic structures are gated spillways and about twenty-five of them are coastal spillways that discharge excess runoff water directly into the environmentally sensitive area of Biscayne Bay, south of the Miami-Dade metropolitan area. Over the past decade serious concerns have been raised regarding the large fluctuations of salinity levels in Biscayne Bay caused by the freshwater releases and the negative impact that they have on the quality and biodiversity of the native environment. Thus, for an effective and efficient management of the regional water resources system there is a substantial need for accurate estimates of those freshwater discharges. The purpose of this study is to improve the existing state-of-the-art for estimation of discharges at coastal spillways under tidally-affected and submerged flow conditions.
2
Spillway gate operations
Depending on the gate operating conditions and the water elevation on either side of the spillway flow at coastal spillways is classified into five different flow categories [1, 5]. More specifically those categories are: • Free orifice-flow (partially opened gate – i.e. gate is in the water) • Submerged orifice-flow (partially opened gate) • Free weir-flow (fully opened gate – i.e. gate is out of the water) • Submerged weir-flow (fully opened gate) • Submerged tidally-affected weir-flow (fully or partially opened gate) At the SFWMD flows at gated spillways are generally computed from instantaneous stage and operational control information using an in-house developed program based on orifice and weir type discharge formulas [6]. However, the accuracy of discharge estimates is compromised in cases where flow occurs under submerged tidal conditions. An improvement on the discharge calculations was done by using dimensional analysis and field measurements from coastal spillway S-26 [2]. That model incorporated tidal effects in lumped terms of the tidal range and period. This study improves the Ansar and Raymond model by incorporating and analyzing additional available data from spillway S21.
3
Submerged tidal spillway flows
Generally, there are many parameters that control flow through tidally-affected submerged spillways. Those parameters can be categorized as being related to flow, fluid and geometric features of the structure [3]. Traditionally submerged flow is estimated as [6]: Q = Cs BH t 2g(H − H t ) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(1)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
139
where B is the gate width, H is the upstream head, Ht is the tail-water elevation, g is the gravitational acceleration, and Cs is an empirical coefficient expressed as:
Ht H
β
Cs = α
(2)
where α and β are experimental constants [5]. Another formula proposed by Skogerboe and Hyatt [4] estimates submerged flow as:
Q=
α C1 (H - H t ) 1
Ht − log H + C 2
(3)
β1
where both exponents α1 and β1 are empirical constants. However, application of the above formulas may lead to substantial inaccuracies particularly when the head difference, H – Ht, is too small or even a negative number. In certain occasion flow estimations for spillway S-26 using the above formulas provided negative flows, while field measurements indicated a positive flow. In order to improve the discharge computational formulas under submerged tidal conditions, Ansar and Raymond [2] assumed that the flow rate, Q, at a tidal gate is a function of eight variables (fig. 1), i.e.
(
Q = f H t , Pw , B, g, µ, ρ, A, T
)
(4)
where Pw is the height of the spillway weir, µ is the dynamic viscosity, ρ is the water density, A is the tidal range and T is the tidal half-period (fig. 1). By applying dimensional analysis and π-theorem the eight variables are combined into four dimensional groups: 2 3 Q 2 1 B 3 g 3 Pw
H ρQ A , = Φ t , Pw T gPw µB
(5)
Due to the high turbulent flow regime, the last dimensionless group within the parenthesis (Reynolds Number) was dropped from further consideration since the viscous effects are negligible. Thus, the expression (5) was re-written as:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
140 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 2 Q3 2 1 B 3 g 3 Pw
=
H Yc A = Φ t , Pw Pw T gPw
(6)
By using actual data from a coastal spillway in Southeast Florida (Structure S26) the above relation was calibrated and verified as: 2 Q3
ξ
2 1 B 3 g 3 Pw
A 6 H = λ 10 t PW T gPw
ζ
(7)
The values of the calibration coefficients that satisfy data for spillway S-26 are different for the falling and rising tide (Table 1). Table 1:
Calibration coefficients for S-26 discharge formula.
Tidal Conditions Flood Ebb
ξ -0.44 -0.10
λ 2,179.35 111.77
ζ -2.38 -1.48
Gate
H-Ht Ht
L
P
H
Flow
Pw Lw LT
Figure 1:
Standard geometric features of spillways.
The fact that in equation (7) only the tail-water was included is justifiable due to the fact that under submerged flow conditions H is approximately equal to Ht.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
141
Data analysis and model development
The South Florida Water Management District (SFWMD) and the US Geological Survey (USGS) operate and maintain a number of Ultrasonic Velocity Meters (UVMs) upstream of various gated structures. UVMs are utilized to estimate flows through the structures. However, since UVMs are “point” instruments their discharge estimates are adjusted using flow data collected by Acoustic Doppler Current Profiler (ADCP) which integrates velocities throughout the entire cross-sectional area of the channel. Then the UVM and/or ADCP discharge data are used to calibrate the empirical formulas for discharge estimation which are based on real-time telemetry measurements of upstream and tail-water elevations at the gate. The Ansar and Raymond model was calibrated and verified using discharge and water elevation data obtained at structure S-26 [2]. In the present study, the proposed model utilizes data from spillway S-26 (events of June 1997 and February 1998) and also spillway S-21 (event of September 2005). 4.1 Discussion of the Ansar and Raymond model The Ansar and Raymond model was tested under a variety of different conditions using data from spillway S-26 and the following conclusions were derived: • The model is extremely sensitive to the value of the total weir height, Pw (fig. 1). By using instead the top weir height, P, flow estimations are improved, but in certain cases that height has still to be reduced in order to produce adequate discharge estimations. • Both the tidal range, A, and the half-tidal period, T, may slightly affect the discharge estimation but not as drastically as the weir height. • In cases that the upstream head, H, is noticeably different that the tail-water, Ht, discharge estimates improve by using H instead of Ht. • In certain occasions, the ebb cycle is estimated better by using the calibration coefficients obtained for flood flow conditions. • Adopting the value of P instead of Pw in the Ansar and Raymond model, the value of the parameter λ may be need to be reduced accordingly in order to improve flow calculations. 4.2 Critical review of the spillway S-26 and S-21 data Since the focus of this study was on submerged tidal flows, only those data sets that the upstream and downstream heads were almost equal were considered. The data were analyzed separately for the flood (rising tide) and the ebb (falling tide) cycles. 4.2.1 Flood tide All of the data regarding the flood part of the tidal cycle showed a distinct linear, inversely proportional correlation between the discharge, Q, and the tail-water head, Ht, (as measured from the MSL) (figs. 2a,b,c). Thus, during the rising tide WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
142 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII discharge decreased due to the decreasing energy gradient along the discharging canal. The slope of that linear relation remained almost constant for each discharge event and varied only slightly among different gate operation events. S-26 Flood Feb 98
S-26 Flood Sept 97 800
1050
700 Discharge (cfs)
Discharge (cfs)
950 850 750 650 550 450
500 400 300 200 100
350 250 0.50
600
1.00
1.50
2.00
0 0.00
2.50
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
Tailw ater MSL (ft)
Tailwater MSL (ft)
(a)
(b)
Discharge (cfs)
S-21 Flood Sept 05 4500 4000 3500 3000 2500 2000 1500 1000 500 0 -500 0
1
2
3
4
Tailwater MSL (ft)
(c) Figure 2:
Discharge versus tail-water elevation during rising tide.
Another interesting observation was that no identifiable correlation appeared to exist between the discharge and either the tidal range, A, or half-period, T, as defined in the Ansar and Raymond model [2]. On the other hand, from a close scrutiny of figs. 2a,b,c it is suggested that the discharge is correlated to the lowest tail-water stage, (Htmin) during each tidal cycle. The discharge increases exponentially for increasing minimum tail-water stage (fig. 3). The exponential correlation that matches the data for spillway S-26 is plotted also in figure 3. Q = 6.633 exp(3.623Htmin) + 675.1
(8)
where Q is in cubic feet per second (cfs) and Htmin is measured in feet (in reference to the mean sea level (MSL)). For very high values of the tail-water head (Ht > 2.5 ft) the discharge becomes negligible. This is an indication that due to the high tidal stage the energy gradient within the discharging canal is diminished.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
143
S-26 Discharge vs Minimum Tailwater Discharge (cfs)
1100 1000 900
Measured
800
Estimated
700 600 0.20
0.70
1.20
Minimum Tailwater (ft)
Figure 3:
Discharge versus low tail-water during each tidal cycle. S-26 Ebb June 97
S-26 Ebb Feb 98
1200
900 800 700 Discharge (cfs)
Discharge (cfs)
1000 800 600 400 200
600 500 400 300 200 100
0 0.00
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
0 0.00
3.00
0.50
Tailwater MSL (ft)
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
Tailwater MSL (ft)
(a)
(b) S-21 Ebb Sept 05 6000
Discharge (cfs)
5000 4000 3000 2000 1000 0 -1000 0
1
2
3
4
Tailwater MSL (ft)
(c) Figure 4:
Discharge versus tail-water elevation during falling tide.
4.2.2 Ebb tide The relationship between the discharge and tail-water for the falling water part of the tidal cycle is not linear. The discharge increases with the falling tail-water to a certain level but then before the end of the ebb cycle it levels or decreases even though the tide is still falling (fig. 4a,b,c). Since the high’s and low’s of tidal elevations are common points for both ebb and flood cycles the preceding remarks on the relationship between Htmin and Q, and diminishing Q for Ht > 2.5 ft are also observed. In addition, among the various expressions that were tried, the one that best fitted the nonlinear behavior for all of the data for spillway S-26 was a sinusoidal equation: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
144 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Q = 867 sin(Ht + 260) + 102
(9)
where Q is the discharge in cfs and Ht is the tail-water in ft (above MSL). The results are presented in fig. 5 (QF is the observed and QSIN are the simulated data). 1200
1100
1000
900
QF QSIN
800
700
600
500
400 11.4
11.6
11.8
12
12.2
12.4
12.6
12.8
XF
Tail-water (ft) Figure 5:
Measured versus simulated values of ebb tide discharges.
Once the trend (shape of the curve) was captured, the simulation was further improved by adjusting the discharge in terms of the minimum tidal water elevation, Htmin, as was demonstrated by equation 6.
5
Conclusions
Based on the analysis of this study involving data from spillways S-21 and S-26 the following conclusions were derived: • •
The weir height, Pw, (or the top weir height, P), do not have any direct significance in the discharge formula and can be treated as just another calibration constant. The variation in the tidal half-cycle period, T, in the Ansar Raymond model [2] is artificially introduced due to minor tailwater stage fluctuations and the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
•
•
•
•
•
•
145
15 minutes data recording step. In reality the tide is astronomically driven with a fixed semi-diurnal period of 12.6 hours. Therefore, T should be treated as a constant. From the recorded data the tidal range, A, varies from 1.27 ft to 1.97 ft. However, no correlation was found between the tidal range and the flow rate. The tidal range showed a periodicity ranging from 2 to 3 tidal cycles (i.e., approximately 24 to 36 hours). This may be due to astronomical diurnal tidal effects and some prevailing weather conditions during the recorded event. During rising tide (flood), the discharge, Q, is inversely proportional to the tailwater elevation, Ht. In addition, the rate of flow reduction due to increasing tailwater stage is almost constant (linear relationship). Some inaccuracies to the above rule may occur in the neighbourhood of high tailwater stages (Ht > 2.5 ft). During falling tide (ebb), the discharge, Q, decreases with increasing tailwater elevation. The relationship although not linear as in the case of the rising tide, it follows a distinct pattern that can be described with a sinusoidal curve. The maximum flow rate, Qmax, occurring during the minimum tailwater elevation, Htmin, depends on the Htmin. As Htmin increases, the maximum flow increases in an exponential manner. This explains the “overshooting” of the Ansar and Raymond model that was calibrated using the high values of Htmin (S-26 June 1997 data) and was verified for lower values of Htmin (S-26 February 1998 data). The discharge conditions approaching the minimum tailwater elevation are more close to “tidal-free” regime since the flow was moving unopposed during the entire ebb cycle. The energy gradient decreases with the rising tide until it reaches its minimum value at high tide. At that time the energy gradient is from one to three orders of magnitude less than the one during the low tide. The amount of energy gradient decrease appears to be correlated to the tidal range but no particular pattern was identifiable. The flow behaviour occurring under fully opened gate conditions (S-26) was very similar to that occurring under partially opened gates (S-21) as long as the upstream and tail-water stages were about the same.
Acknowledgement This study was made possible through the support of the Operations and Hydro Data Management Division, South Florida Water Management District, West Palm Beach, Florida, USA.
References [1]
Ansar, M., Alexis, A. & Damisse, E., 2002. “Atlas of Flow Computations at District Hydraulic Structures”, Technical Report, Hydrology and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
146 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[2] [3] [4] [5]
[6]
Hydraulics Division, South Florida Water Management District, West Palm Beach, Florida. Ansar, M. & Raymond J.H., 2003. “Tidal Flow Computations at a Coastal Prototype Spillway”, Submitted to Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE. Scarlatos, P.D., 2005. “Tidal Hydraulics at Coastal Spillways”, Report submitted to SFWMD, West Palm Beach, Florida. Skogerboe, G.V. & Hyatt, L., 1967. “Analysis of Submergence in Flow Measuring Flumes”, J. Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE, 93(HY4): 183-200. Tillis, G.M. & Swain, E.D., 1998. “Determining Discharge-Coefficient Ratings for Selected Coastal Control Structures in Broward and Palm Beach Counties, Florida”, US Geological Survey, Water-Resources Investigations Report 98-4007, Tallahassee, Florida. US Army Corps of Engineers, 1963. “Typical Spillway Structure for Central and Southern Florida Water-Control Project: Hydraulic Model Investigation”, Technical Report 2-633. Vicksburg, Mississippi.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
147
Analysis of the wave-flow interaction with submerged breakwaters A. C. Neves, F. Veloso Gomes & F. Taveira Pinto Institute of Hydraulics and Water Resources, Faculty of Engineering of the University of Porto, Porto, Portugal
Abstract The use of submerged breakwaters against coastal erosion problems has some advantages when compared, for example, with the use of similar emerged coastal protection structures and for that reason their use in coastal protection is becoming popular all over the world. Their effect in the wave field and especially in the wave-induced velocities has been analysed by several authors though there is still a lack of knowledge on the wave-flow interaction. The aim of this study was to analyse the behaviour of submerged breakwaters and especially the wave induced velocity field, which can have great impact in the stability of the structures and in the sediment circulation. Two-dimensional scaled physical tests were carried out in the Hydraulics Laboratory wave tank of the University of Porto, in order to understand with more accuracy the influence of the permeability and of the submergence of the breakwaters in the wave-structure interaction. For that reason, tests were performed with the same wave conditions (regular waves), with two different models with the same geometry, one with permeable and one with impermeable rough slopes, and with two water depths (leading to two different freeboards of the structure). Keywords: submerged breakwater, wave-flow interaction.
1
Introduction
Several investigations have been performed in relation to submerged breakwaters. Although much is already known in what concerns to the stability of these structures, it is believed that there is a lack of information about the hydrodynamics in their vicinity, namely in the velocity field. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070151
148 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Losada et al. [1], in DELOS research report, have referred that the knowledge of the velocity field in the immediacy of submerged breakwaters is essential in what respects to the stability of the blocks. The authors have developed a numerical model, calibrated by several experimental results, to the prediction of the behaviour of submerged breakwaters and their influence in the wave propagation and in the water particle velocities. A high degree of agreement between th numerical and experimental data relatively to the free surface displacement in the vicinity of the structure and the velocities in the seaward slope was found. Tirindelli and Lamberti [3], also analysed velocities in the proximity of the stones of the armour later of submerged breakwaters. Through Morrison-type equations, the authors have calculated the wave forces in armour stones. They also pointed out the importance of knowing the velocity and acceleration of the water particles in the proximity of the blocks, as the wave-induced force applied to an armour unit depends on them. Saitoh and Ishida [2] analysed the wave-flow interaction with submerged breakwaters, namely velocity field in their proximity. Experiments with an impermeable model using PIV measurements and Laser Dopper Anemometry have been performed with several wave conditions. It was found that the maximum velocity offshore occurred in the upper part of the slope. Mass transport velocity and acceleration, among other parameters were also calculated, once they were considered to strongly affect the stability of the blocks and erosion at the toe of these structures. Taveira-Pinto [4] also analysed the velocity field near submerged breakwaters, through experimental modelling. The author has found high values of the turbulence intensity near the bottom and near the surface, in sections where an inversion of the flow velocity occurred and where the flow was passing over the obstacle. This last observation could be explained by the flow constriction occurring due to the water depth reduction in this section. It is considered that much of the existent literature has not paid significant attention to the influence of the roughness and of the permeability of the submerged breakwaters in the velocity near and far field and, thus, the aim of this study was to analyse the behaviour of submerged breakwaters and, especially the wave induced velocities near them and the parameters influencing them
2
Experimental set-up
The experiments were conducted in the Hydraulics Laboratory of the Faculty of Engineering of the University of Porto. The wave tank is 12 m wide, 28 m long and has a maximum water depth of 0.6 m. A thin dividing wall was used to isolate the measuring section from the rest of the tank, avoiding threedimensional effects and wave diffraction during the tests. A gently inclined absorbing beach was also constructed, diminishing wave reflection by causing sufficient dissipation of wave energy. A piston-type wave maker was used.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
149
Two models of submerged breakwaters were used: a rough impermeable model and a rough permeable one, in order to analyse the effect of the permeability in the wave-velocity field. The models had similar cross-section, with a 0.30 m crest width, a 0.40 m crest height and 1/1 slopes. Figure 1 shows the rough impermeable model, where stones (Dn50=4.4 cm) were glued to a perspex base, simulating an armour layer. The permeable model had an armour layer of 2 Dn50 width and a nucleus.
Figure 1:
Rough impermeable model.
The velocity measurements were done in different vertical profiles, at different distances from the bottom and, successively nearer to the models, using Laser Doppler Anemometry technique. The optical system was formed by an Argon-Ion Laser, modular LDA optics based on a one-component fibre optic system and a 60 mm probe, working in a backscatter configuration. A capacitance wave probe was placed outside the testing section in order to verify the incident wave and in the vertical alignment where the velocity component was being measured. A Burst Spectrum Analyser allowed the simultaneous record of the analogical signals relative to the instantaneous water surface elevations and the Doppler signal relative to the velocity, in a way that each validated velocity corresponded to a water surface elevation value. The testes were performed with regular waves, with the same characteristics: H=0.065 m and T=1.5 s. Two water depths were tested, allowing the analysis of the effect of the submergence of the model in the velocity-field, 0.4 m and 0.45 m, which is equivalent to a 0 and a +5 cm freeboard.
3
Results and discussion
As referred before the velocity measurements were done in different vertical profiles, at different distances from the bottom. The location of the measured profiles is indicated in Figure 2. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
150 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Wave probe 17 19 21 23 25 27
18
15 16
13 14
11 12 10
20
(Hi, Ti)
9 8
7 6
22
5 4
24
3 2
26
Figure 2:
z/d=0.257
0.2
0.12
0.1
0.04
v (m/s)
u (m/s)
0
Location of the measured profiles.
z/d=0.257
0 -0.1
-0.04 -0.12
-0.2 0
0
60 120 180 240 300 360
60 120 180 240 300 360
Wave phase (º)
Wave phase (º)
z/d=0.561
z/d=0.561
0.2
0.12
0.1
0.04
v (m/s)
u (m/s)
1
0 -0.1
-0.04 -0.12
-0.2 0
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º)
rough impermeable model
Figure 3:
0
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º)
rough permeable model
Mean values of the horizontal (a) and vertical (b) component of the velocity (H=0.065m, T=1.5s, d=0.45 m, z/d=0.181 and z/d=0.257, profile 1).
Each one of the measured points generated a file, with the instantaneous water surface elevation and the respective velocity component values. A specific program was then used for the wave analysis and the calculation of the mean values of the variables for 50 different phases of the wave period. Figures 3 and 4 show some of the velocity measurement results. The results respect to the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
151
rough impermeable and the rough permeable model and were obtained in profile 1 and profile 27, for two of the measurement levels and for one of the water depths. z/d=0.333 0.12
0.06
0.06
v (m/s)
u (m/s)
z/d=0.333 0.12
0 -0.06
0 -0.06 -0.12
-0.12 0
0
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º)
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º)
z/d=0.409 0.12
0.06
0.06
v (m/s)
u (m/s)
z/d=0.409 0.12
0 -0.06 -0.12
-0.06 -0.12
0
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º) rough impermeable model
Figure 4:
0
0
60 120 180 240 300 360 Wave phase (º)
rough permeable model
Mean values of the horizontal (a) and vertical (b) component of the velocity (H=0.065m, T=1.5s, d=0.45 m, z/d=0.181 and z/d=0.257, profile 27)
The results proved that the horizontal component of the velocity is almost always greater than the vertical one. This fact is more obvious seaward of the model than in the leeward of the model, where the vertical velocity has more or less the same magnitude than the horizontal one. It can also be seen that the permeability induces in a greater attenuation of the velocities. Both velocity components were clearly attenuated by the obstacle, as it can be seen in the comparison between figures 3 and 4. A great area in the vicinity of the submerged breakwater models was covered and in total, 212 points were measured with the rough impermeable model and 169 points with the rough permeable one. Phase-averaged values of the velocities were calculated and analysed as a function of the relative distance to the bottom, allowing a global analysis of the velocity field.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
152 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3.1 Permeability effect
z/d
PC
z/d
1.2 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0.0 -0.45 -0.23
0.00
0.23
0.45
phase-averaged u (m/s)
1.2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.45 -0.225
PC
0
0.225 0.45
phase-averaged v (m/s)
1.2 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0.0 -0.12 -0.06
P27
z/d
z/d
Figure 5 illustrates some of the results, where the values obtained with the rough impermeable model and the permeable one were placed in the same graphic in order to easily compare the permeability effect in the wave-induced flow velocity field.
1.2 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0.0 -0.12 -0.06 0.00
P27
0.06
0.12
phase-averaged u (m/s)
0.06
0.12
phase-averaged v (m/s)
impermeable model
Figure 5:
0.00
permeable model
Variation along relative distance to the bottom of the mean, maximum and minimum values of both velocities components for permeable and impermeable models, profiles C and 27.
The graphics clearly illustrate that permeability has an important role in the attenuation of the flow velocities. In the permeable model, the water percolates inside the structure, which allows the dissipation of velocities through it, instead of concentrating them only in the surface, conducting the mean horizontal velocities in the permeable model to be most of the time lower than the ones obtained in the impermeable one, in profiles located seaward of the model or in the seaward slope. This can be explained by the effect of the structure’s permeability in the decreasing of the reflection properties of the breakwater model, which attenuates the seaward wave-induced velocities. On the other hand, it was found that the percolation of the flow through the structure caused an increment of the horizontal component of the velocity in the bottom region till the crest of the structure, as it can be seen in the graphic that respects to phaseaveraged horizontal velocity results calculated for profile 27. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
153
It was found that the most critical areas, in terms of velocities were located along the crown and in the upper part of the seaward slope. The upper part of the leeward slopes also revealed large mean horizontal velocities. The results proved that the permeable breakwater had greater impact in terms of wave energy dissipation than the other model, allowing a significant reduction of the horizontal velocities in the upper sections. 3.2 Freeboard of the structure effect
z/d
PC 1.2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.1
PC
z/d
1.2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.4
-0.2
0
0.2
0.4
phase-averaged u (m/s)
-0.05
0
0.05
phase-averaged v (m/s)
1.2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.4
P27
z/d
z/d
A similar analysis was performed for the results obtained with the two water depths. Figure 6 represents some of the results. The used water depths, 0.40 and 0.45 m conducted to submergences of 0 cm (mean water level coincident with the crest of the model) and 5 cm, respectively. In total, 169 points were measured with the 0.45 m water depth and 111 points with the 0.40m water depth.
0.1
1.2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.1
P27
-0.2
-0.05
0.2
0.4
0
0.05
0.1
phase-averaged v (m/s)
F=-5 cm Figure 6:
0
phase-averaged u (m/s)
F=0 cm
Comparison of phase-average velocities near submerged breakwaters, for different freeboards, profiles C and 27.
The results have proved that the submergence of the structure affects the wave-induced flow characteristics. The results obtained with the zero freeboard were almost always smaller than the ones found in the +5 cm submergence case. These differences were especially significant in the profiles located leeward of the model, in the sections above the structure, due to the (in)existence of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
154 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII overtopping. When d=0.45 m, for example, it can be observed the enlargement of the mean velocities in the leeward of the model, directed onshore, while for d=0. 40 m, the respective velocities are much closer to zero.
4
Conclusions and final remarks
Experimental tests were conducted with two models of submerged breakwaters with different permeability characteristics for the same wave conditions. The results have confirmed that permeability of these structures can strongly affect the wave-induced flow characteristics, seawards and leewards of the structure. Most of the time, the mean horizontal velocities registered in the permeable model were lower than the ones obtained in the impermeable model, due to the effect of the structure’s permeability that decreases the reflection properties of the breakwater model and consequentially attenuates the seaward flow velocities. Different structure’s freeboards were also tested and the results of the measurements proved that the level of the crest of structure in relation to the mean water level has great influence in the wave-induced velocities, as it influences the passage of water over the structure. It is intended to extend this analysis to other characteristics of the models, such as the roughness of the surface, in the wave-induced flow. Other wave conditions are also being tested, in other to investigate their influence in the flow field. Tests with irregular waves are also intended to perform in order to prove the validity of the conclusions.
References [1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Losada, I., Garcia, N., Lara, J., 2005. Report on turbulent flow velocities in the surface region of low-crested structures. DELOS (Environmental Design of Low Crested Coastal Defence Structures) Project, Deliverable 23 and 44. Saitoh, T., Ishida, H., 2001. Kinematics and Transformation of New Type Wave Front Breaker Over Submerged Breakwater. Proceedings of the 4th International Symposium Waves 2001, San Francisco, USA, ASCE, volume II, pp. 1032-1041, ISBN 0-7844-0604-9. Tirindelli, M., Lamberti, A., 2004. Wave-induced forces on Structural and Biotic Elements of Low Crested Structures, Proceedings of the 29th International Conference Coastal Engineering 2004, Lisbon, Portugal, pp. 4228-4239. Taveira-Pinto, F. 2001. Velocities Fields in the Vicinity of Submerged Breakwaters, PhD Thesis, Faculty of Engineering of University of Porto (in Portuguese), Porto, Portugal
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
155
An application of an edge effect based vacuum blower to a lyophilizer M. Kitamura, M. Tsutahara & H. Sasaki Graduate School of Science and Technology, Kobe University, Japan
Abstract In the rarefied gas, the edge effect flow is induced at a heated edge of a flat plate and its mechanism is well known. Usually edge effect flow is generated at both sides of the flat plate and the effects cancel each other out because the directions of the flows are completely opposite. By rounding the edge of a flat plate at one side we can obtain one-way flow and can use this flow for a vacuum blower. By confirming the characteristic of the effect of this edge effect flow we try to use this flow as an edge effect blower for lyophilizers. We confirmed that there is a pressure difference between the inlet and outlet of this blower caused by this edge effect flow and also this pressure difference is very obvious in the 200–400 Pa range of the surrounding pressure. We set this edge effect blower in a vacuum tank and examined whether this blower could promote the sublimation phenomenon of water. We confirmed that the sublimation was increased by using this blower. We also performed a numerical analysis using the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method to simulate the sublimation phenomena. Gas flows caused by evaporation and condensation phases are simulated. Keywords: rarefied gas, edge effect, lattice Boltzmann method, finite difference method, evaporation, condensation.
1
Introduction
We can usually consider the gas to be a continuum and describe a phenomenon by applying the Navier-Stokes equations as the governing equations. However, for low pressure gases, the Navier-Stokes equations and the no-slip boundary condition cannot be applied, because the mean free path of molecules cannot be neglected. We can describe such a gas phenomenon by the Boltzman equation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070161
156 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In the rarefied gas, the thermal transpiration flow is induced when a solid wall has a temperature gradient [1–3]. The edge effect flow is also induced at the edge of a flat plate and its mechanism is the same as thermal transpiration flow. As an engineering application of this edge effect flow, we take up the lyophilizer this time. There is no system of the ventilation effect in the current lyophilizers that is necessary for the sublimation process. By applying an edge effect flow for the ventilation of the lyophilizer the rise of water sublimation speed is examined by experiments. The effectiveness of numerical simulation by the FDLBM is also checked by comparing it with the results by a molecular gas dynamics based calculation.
2
Experiments
We made an edge effect based vacuum blower (edge effect blower) using the edge effect flow. The edge effect flow usually occurs at both edges of a plate and it is offsetting. But by rounding one edge we can obtain a flow only for one direction [4]. We confirmed the pressure at the outlet of the blower was raised. We also confirmed that this blower is effective for speeding up the process of l sublimation. 2.1 Experiments by edge effect blower 2.1.1 Experimental device and method We use the accumulation unit that incorporated edge plates in that unit. A schematic view of the experimental device is shown in Fig 1. The accumulation unit of edge effect blower is settled in a vacuum chamber. The pressure in the chamber and the accumulator are measured by Pirani gauges. Each edge plate is equipped with heaters to be heated.
Pirani gauge Accumulation chamber Edge plate
Edge flow
Heater
Figure 1:
Schematic view of the edge effect blower.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
157
The value of the vacuum gauge which is installed in a vacuum tank shows a back pressure of an edge effect blower, and a difference between a value in the edge effect blower and that of the vacuum tank is understood as a rise of pressure by an edge effect flow. After confirming at arrival the pressure in a vacuum tank at about 90Pa, the pressure measurement is started. 2.1.2 Test results and discussion The test results are shown in Fig. 2. The measurements are done in two cases. One case (case 1) is tested without heating the edge plate dotted square marks. The second case (case 2) is measured with heating the edge plate dotted diamond marks. We can confirm that the pressure rises in case 2 by heating an edge plate in the back pressure of 200–400 Pa region. It is thought that the edge effect is most effective in this region. Drops of pressure in case 2 around 400 Pa is caused by the characteristics of gauges.
Rising Pressure (Pa)
20 15 10 5 0 -5
0
100
200
300
400
500
600
Pressure of Chamber (Pa)
Figure 2:
Relation between pressure rise and back pressure in vacuum chamber.
2.2 An application of edge effect blower to a lyophilizer An edge effect blower is installed in a vacuum tank and the speeding up the process of the sublimation is examined. 2.2.1 Experimental device and method A view of an edge effect blower is shown in Fig 3. This blower consists of three plates bent at one end comprising heater in one row, and has two rows of plates. The experimental apparatus is shown in Fig. 4. The performance of an edge effect blower is tested by the sponge soaked with water and frozen up. The difference of quantity of water left in the sponge is measured by the following three cases. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
158 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
Edge effect blower.
Figure 4:
View of apparatus.
experimental
Water after Experiment(kg)e-3
Non-heater Edge effect fan
0.006
Non-edge effect fan
0.005 0.004 0.003 0.002 0.001 0 0.080
0.090
0.100
0.110
0.120
Water before experiment(kg)e-3 Figure 5:
Relation between contained water before and after experiment.
Case 1: Experiment with edge effect plate of no heat. Case 2: Experiment with edge effect plate of heat Case 3: Experiment without edge effect plate 2.2.2 Test results and discussion The test result is shown in Fig. 5 in the case of a start pressure 200 Pa in the vacuum chamber. It takes about 4 minutes before arriving at the experimental start pressure 200 Pa. During the experiment the pressure rises about 50Pa in the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
159
vacuum chamber. Some dispersion of the data is seen, but, as for the case without the source of heat, the quantity of water sublimation decreases as the pressure rises. Cases 1 and 3: The test results of case 3 (without edge effect plate), as the pressure rises, the quantity of water sublimation decreases as well as case 1 (without the heat). This cause is similar to the case without the source of heat. Case 2: In the case of the edge effect blower, quantity of water sublimation becomes greatest at the starting pressure 200 Pa in the vacuum chamber. Therefore, it seems that sublimation is promoted by the ventilation effect of the edge effect blower. Although the dispersion is rather large, it seems that a ventilation effect by the edge effect flow is effective on lyophilization in the range of 100 – 400 Pa.
3
Numerical analysis
The lattice Boltzmann method (LBM) is the computational tool to analyse the continuous thermal viscous fluid. The flow in the vacuum chamber is governed by the Navier-Stokes equations except the Knudsen layer near the sublimation surface. The LBM model is a strongly discretized version of the Boltzmann equation. Therefore the LBM can be considered to simulate the flow except the Knudsen layer without any special treatment for the boundary conditions. In this paper, the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method (FDLBM) is used. The two-dimensional thermal model (the D2Q21model) [5, 6] of FDLBM is presented briefly in section 3.1. The numerical analysis method is presented in section 3.2. 3.1 Finite difference lattice Boltzmann method The discrete BGK equation for the FDLBM is written as follows with the distribution function fi k (x, t ) having the particle velocity ci
where
φ
∂fi ∂f 1 + ci i = − fi − fi (0) ∂t ∂x φ
(1)
is the collision parameter (the relaxation time) and f i 0 is the local equilibrium distribution function chosen to satisfy the Navier-Stokes equation. The local equilibrium distribution function is defined as follows in the case of the thermal model. f i 0 = ω i ρ (1 − 2 Buα ci ,α + 2 B 2 (uα ci ,α ) 2 + Bu 2 (2) 4 − B 3 (uα ci ,α )3 − 2 B 2uα ci ,α u 2 ) 3 The macroscopic variables for continuous fluids are defined as
ρ = ∑ f i = ∑ f i (0) i
i
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
160 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
ρ u = ∑ fi ci = ∑ f i (0)ci i
(4)
i
1 2 1 1 ρu + ρe = ∑ f i ci 2 = ∑ f i ( 0) ci2 2 i 2 i 2
(5)
for the density, the momentum and energy, respectively, where e is the internal energy per unit mass. For the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method, the governing differential equation is discretized in finite difference schemes, and the following calculation procedures are employed. The time integration is performed by the second-order Runge-Kutta method and the third-order upwind scheme is employed for space differential. Evaporated area (eA ,ρA) X2 r
θ
X1
L Condensed area (eB ,ρB) (a) Parallel condensed phases Figure 6:
(b) Cylindrical condensed phase Schematic diagram.
3.2 Method of analysis 3.2.1 Evaporation and condensation between two parallel plates One-dimensional behaviours of gas between two parallel condensed phases is considered as shown in Fig. 6(a). Both condensed phases spread infinitely and are kept at different temperatures. We only consider the condensed gas. Evaporation occurs at the high temperature condensed phase and condensation in the low temperature condensed phase and flow of the gas occurs towards the low temperature side from the high temperature side. It is assumed that the temperature is TA (internal energy eA) at the high temperature side and TB (internal energy eB) at the low temperature side, and the saturated vapour pressure of gas at each side is given pA and pB. (Fig. 6(a)) The local equilibrium distribution functions defined by these temperatures and the pressures (densities), and the zero flow velocity are used. We compare the flows in the steady state to those given by the molecular dynamics based calculations. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
161
3.2.2 Evaporation from cylindrical condensed phase Two-dimensional evaporation from a cylindrical surface in an infinitely expanded domain as shown in Fig. 6(b) is also considered. We assume the temperature of the cylinder surface is Tw (internal energy e) and assume saturated vapour pressure of gas is pw. The temperature and the pressure at infinity are T∞ and p∞, respectively. The local equilibrium distribution function defined by the temperature, the pressure( density) and the zero flow velocity is used. 1.2
1
e/eB
0.8
0.6 0.4
pA/pB=10 pA/pB=3
0.2 0
X
(a) T/TB
12
10
pA/pB=10 pA/pB=3
p/pB
8
6
4
2
0 X (b) p/pB Figure 7: Temperature (internal energy) and pressure distributions in case of pA/pB =10, TA/TB =1.1 and pA/pB =3.0, TA/TB=1.1. Left side (A side) is the evaporation phase and right side (B side) is the condensation phase. (a) e/eB (T/TB): Temperature distribution as a function of X, distance from A for pA/pB=10 and pA/pB =3. (b) p/pB: Pressure distribution as a function of X for pA/pB =10 and pA/pB =3. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
162 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3.3 Results and discussion 3.3.1 Evaporation and condensation between two parallel plates The distributions of the temperature and the saturated pressure between both phases in case of pA/pB =3.0, TA/TB =1.1, and pA/pB =10.0, TA/TB =1.1 are shown in Fig. 7. The rapid changes of the pressure and the temperature in both cases arise near the condensation and the evaporation phases, but except for these layers the pressure and temperature are uniform. This shows the same tendency with the molecular gas dynamics result [7] based on the BGK equation with KnB=0. Comparing the results for pA/pB=10 with those for pA/pB=3, a temperature descent of the gas is more remarkable in the case of pA/pB=10 because the flow from the condensed side to the evaporated side becomes fast caused by the large difference of saturated vapour pressures. The reverse temperature incline phenomenon that appeared in the results of molecular gas dynamics is not detected. 1.00
T∞/ Tw
0.95
0.90
0.85
0.80 0.0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
p∞/ pw
Figure 8:
The temperature ratio versus the pressure ratio.
3.3.2 Evaporation from cylindrical condensed phase The relation of T∞/Tw vs. p∞/pw is shown in Fig. 8. The x marks show calculation results and the line shows the results by molecule gas dynamics. The calculation results by FDLBM become closer to the latter when p∞/pw approaches to unity. The pressure distributions p/pw for p∞/pw (0.82,0.70,0.61 and 0.55) are shown in figure 9. When the pressure ratio p∞/pw becomes smaller, the pressure profile p/pw near the cylinder surface becomes inclined and to be smaller. These results show the same tendency as those of the molecule gas dynamic results near KnB=0 [8]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
163
0.85 0.80
p∞/pw =0.82 p∞/pw =0.70 p∞/pw =0.61 p∞/pw =0.55
p/pw
0.75 0.70 0.65 0.60 0.55 0.50 1
2
3
6
11
19
34
62
111 200
r/L
Figure 9:
4
Distribution of non-dimensional pressure from the cylinder surface.
Conclusions
The experiment of applying an edge effect blower to lyophilization confirms that the sublimation is promoted by the presence of the edge effect blower in the pressure area of 200 ~ 400 Pa. However, in higher vacuum domain of 1~10Pa, the remarkable influence is not confirmed. We need more detailed experimental work around these pressure regions and have to confirm the usefulness of the edge effect blower to a lyophilizer. By the numerical analysis, comparison with a calculation result based on molecular gas dynamics gives a good agreement. It is confirmed that the FDLBM model (the D2Q21 model) for compressible fluid with boundary condition given by the local equilibrium distribution function is very useful for simulation of flows caused by the condensations and/or evaporations. This method is also powerful for complex shaped boundaries.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Y. Sone, K Aoki, Molecular Gas Dynamics, Asakura-syoten 1994,in Japanese Y. Sone, Y. Waniguchi, K. Aoki, One-way flow of rarefied gas induced in a channel with a periodic temperature distribution, Phys.Fluids, 8,pp22272235, 1996 Y Sone, Kinetic Theory and Fluid Dynamics, BIRKHAUSER 2002 M Tutahara, K Ogawa, T Kataoka, M Shoji, Y Sakai and M Kirimuro, Study on engineering application of the Knudsen pump in rarefied gas, Transactions of the Japan Society of Mechanical Engineers NO.044-1, 2004, in Japanese. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
164 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [5] [6]
[7]
[8]
M Tsutahara, N Takada and T Kataoka, Lattice gas and lattice Boltzmann methods, Corona-sha 1999; in Japanese. M. Tsutahara, T. Kataoka, K. Shikata, N. Takada, New Model and Scheme for Compressible Fluids of the Finite Difference Lattice Boltzmann Method and Direct Simulations of Aerodynamic Sound” Computers and Fluids, (to be published) Kazuo Aoki and Noboru Masukawa “Gas flows caused by evaporation and condensation on two parallel condensed phases and the negative temperature gradient: Numerical analysis by using a nonlinear kinetic equation” Phys. Fluids 6(3), p1379-1395 March 1994 Hiroshi Sugimoto, Yoshio Sone “Numerical analysis of steady flows of a gas evaporating from its cylindrical condensed phase on the basis of kinetic theory” Phys. Fluids A 4(2), p419-440 Feb.1992
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
165
The wavelength reconstruction from toroidal spectrometer image data J. Blazej1, M. Tamas1, L. Pina1, A. Jancarek1, S. Palinek1, P. Vrba2 & M. Vrbova1 1 2
Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic Institute of Plasma Physics, Academy of Science, Czech Republic
Abstract We are reporting spectroscopy studies of Nitrogen filled capillary discharge. The identification procedure of spectra was carried out with the use of an extreme ultraviolet grazing incidence spectrometer with toroidal grating. The source of radiation and the object under study is a pinching alumina capillary discharge in Nitrogen, where stimulated emission in the 13.4 nm wavelength region is expected. To simplify the alignment of the spectrometer during the experiment the off Rowland circle registration scheme is used. In this scheme, spectra are recorded in a single plane and thus exact focusing of the input slit takes place only for one single wavelength, which corresponds to the intersection of the plane of registration with the Rowland circle. Appropriate image processing must be applied to reconstruct the spectra profile and to calibrate wavelength positions. The cooled extreme ultraviolet sensitive CCD camera was used in the role of planar detector. It has a 512×512 elements matrix with 24 µm square pixels. The 16-bit dynamic range together with very low-noise provide a good data source for image post-processing. The experimental impossibility to record simultaneously zeroth order maximum and the first diffraction order spectrum was a crucial problem in the presented process. The presented methodology can be applied to any experiment using toroidal grating spectrometer. Keywords: spectrometer, image distortion, calibration.
1
Introduction
We are reporting spectroscopy studies of Nitrogen filled capillary discharge. The goal of our work is to create a technique for routine use of a spectrometer with WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070171
166 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII toroidal grating with relatively small image detector in the off Rowland circle registration scheme. The usual type of detector for this scheme is a linear CCD that allowing images simultaneously zeroth and first order maximum and that in principle eliminate geometrical distortion of lines aside the circle plane. Spectra acquired by a planar CCD are distorted by non-ideal imaging in the spectrograph and non-linear dispersion must be eliminated to reconstruct wavelength information. The first problem is that geometrical distortion of acquired spectra origins from imaging of input slit to a plane. In standard spectrograph configuration the output slit is used to overcome this problem. This is an on Rowland circle registration scheme. The other possibility is to use a line (linear) CCD without output slit in the plane of the Rowland circle. In this case the distortion is converted into modification of dispersion. To improve the signal to noise ratio and overcome experimental difficulties with low detection yield and energy budget we decided to use a planar CCD.
2
Distortion elimination
The spatial configuration of the spectrometer with toroidal grating is schematically drawn in figure 1. For the theoretical review see Haber [1]. The cross section of the screen with the Rowland circle defines on preferred wavelength. Its line is imaged without any astigmatism. All others line are distorted in correlation with the distance between the screen and the Rowland circle. φ0
O [0,0]
α D φ x F S
A
scree
n
R
C
Figure 1:
The spatial configuration of the spectrometer with toroidal grating. The input slit is imaging to the screen. The cross section of the screen with the Rowland circle defines on preferred wavelength. It is only one line imaged without any astigmatism. φ is the angle of virtual scanning line p, the coordinate origin is point O. R is the Rowland circle with diameter R, center C. The angle φ0 is the zeroth order angle, α is the screen angle. The origin of coordinates at the screen is the point F, the cross-section with the Rowland circle. The distance between grid and screen is called D = D-O.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
167
The analyzed radiation is coming from the left and is mirrored by the grating under grazing angle φ0. The zero order maximum angle φ0 is 4º and the angle of screen is 10º. The coordinate origin is the point O – the grid center. X axis is the grid tangent and y axis is going through point C – the center of the Rowland circle The screen is at distance D from the origin, containing the α angle from the x-axis. To eliminate geometrical distortion of spectra the following method is used. Several horizontal profiles (raw cuts) are taken on the image with good contrast line pattern. From the line pattern several well-defined lines are selected. Each horizontal profile is separately fitted by multiple Gaussian peaks at selected lines. Positions of their centers define a matrix of distortion. Each column of this matrix is fitted by a parabola. The radii of curvature of these parabolas are changing for different columns and this dependence has a minimum. The position of this minimum can be used for absolute calibration. The generated matrix can be used for distortion elimination after its smoothing by the parabola fit. For distortion elimination – image warping – we are using open source program xmorph [2] with sophisticated wavelet amplitude correction to ensure the photometric data from original spectra. The result of these steps is an image with parallel spectral lines over the entire screen, see figure 2.
a) Figure 2:
3
b)
The negative of the primary picture taken by CCD (a) and final warped image (b). All its lines are straight and parallel. Optionally the flat field and background correction can be applied to enhance the signal to noise ratio and recognize and eliminate the dead pixels.
Calibration
The spectrometer dispersion curve is well known, but the problems of calibration of exposed spectra are two: 1) in real experimental conditions it is impossible to determine the distance D 2) the origin of x axis on screen is unknown, the screen is too small to include zeroth order maximum
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
168 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Therefore the experiment has two degree of freedom from the absolute calibration point of view; the position of zeroth order maximum on detector plate and the distance of detector from grating center. Both are experimentally unattainable for us. The parameters for calibration can be derived from following sources: 3.1 Calibration filter For these wavelengths the L-edge of aluminium can be used. The problem is the absence of continuous source. Some experiment configuration generating a lot of lines can be used, but the final resolution of edge position identification depends on actual spectra. Nevertheless, only one parameter can be evaluated from one edge and filtered spectra were not included in a particular analyzed spectra set. 3.2 Width of spectral lines The width is proportional to focusing. The imaging of spectra to the Rowland circle can be modelled as an imaging by a lens with variable focus length. Assuming a hypothesis about the quasi-Gaussian character of the input signal, the model of dependence of line width on wavelength can be derived. But we are not succeeding to find any algorithm for a reliable line width calculation from spectra with unknown spectral line intensities. 3.3 Position of non-distorted spectral line on screen This invariant reduces the number of degrees of freedom to one defining a relation between searched parameters. The position of the non-distorted line can be estimated with a precision of 10 pixels. 3.4 Assignment of known wavelengths to bright lines The fourth source is the assignment of known wavelengths to bright lines. It is dependent on several presumptions about observed plasma source or on an independent spectral analysis of similar plasma source. 3.5 Solution We decide to use the fourth method. A spectrum identified in this work is generated by a capillary discharge in nitrogen pre-filled alumina capillary (nitrogen pre-fill pressure 0,49 torr), capillary dimensions were 297 mm long, 3.0 mm in diameter and the current form is damped sinus with quarter period t1=87.5 ns, damping time t2=600 ns and I0=22 kA. For comparison we have two independently calibrated spectra, see Vrbova et al. [3]. The first one is a spectrum of capillary discharge in nitrogen pre-filled alumina capillary (nitrogen pre-fill pressure 0.9 torr). Capillary dimensions were 56 mm length and 3 mm diameter, the current form is damped sinus with quarter period t1=150 ns, damping time t2=600 ns and I0=15.5 kA. And the second one is a spectrum of ablative capillary discharge in polyoxymethylene (POM) capillary. Capillary WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
169
dimensions were 56 mm length and 1.1 mm initial diameter, the current form is damped sinus with quarter period t1=65 ns, damping time t2=150 ns and I0=12 kA. We have identified a strong resemblance between three spectra. Considering that the only common element present in every discharge is oxygen, there is a strong indication to assign the most intense lines to oxygen ions. By comparing the database [4] and the simulated spectra of different ions made by Sapphire software [5] with measured values we decided to identify the most intense lines around 13 nm, 15 nm and 17.4 nm as lines belonging to helium like oxygen. Modifying the spectra accordingly we could further identify minor peaks from their absolute wavelength position. By assigning the most intense lines to oxygen ions a very good accordance of measurement with simulated lines of He-like oxygen (O VI) was found. Further very good accordance can be seen with simulated lines of He-like nitrogen (N V), especially in experiments with higher nitrogen pre-fill pressure.
4
Conclusion
The experimental impossibility to record simultaneously zeroth order maximum and the first diffraction order spectrum was a crucial problem in the presented process. We succeeded in eliminating an image distortion and verified its successful calibration. Spectral lines belonging to excited Nitrogen ions N4+ and N5+ were identified. We may note that we were not able to identify as many lines in the interval above 22 nm as we did in the interval 7-22 nm. This may be caused by lower resolution as we are far away off the Rowland circle. The presented methodology can be applied to any similar experiment using a toroidal grating spectrometer.
Acknowledgements This research has been supported by the research framework MSM6840770022, section 3 of Ministry of Education of Czech Republic and experimental data has been obtained thanks to support of grant 1P04LA235.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
Haber, H.: The Torus Grating, In: Journal of Optical Society of America vol. 40, number 3, Optical Society of America, Washington DC, USA, March 1950, pp. 153–165. Mennucci, A.C.G.: Xmorph, [online]
, 2004, compilation gtk2.2 July 17th 2004. Vrbova, M., Jancarek, A., Vrba, P., Fojtik, A., Scholzova, L., Havlikova, R., Palinek, S., Soft X-ray Emission from Nitrogen Capillary Discharge, ICXRL Peking 2004. NIST Atomic Spectra Database Lines Form, [online], . Sapphire professional, version 1.0.3.3 (Cavendish Instruments Ltd. 2003). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
171
Numerical noise in satellite laser ranging data processing J. Blazej & I. Prochazka Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract Satellite laser ranging is a highly accurate measuring technique providing the accurate range to the retroreflector equipped Earth satellites. It operates on a classical radar principle. Measuring the time interval between the pulse transmittal and reception, and considering the speed of light and the way of its propagation, the target distance may be evaluated. The picosecond laser pulses together with highly precise timing systems and optical detectors enable resolution and accuracy of the entire ranging system to an accuracy of several millimetres. To demonstrate the ultimate precision of satellite laser ranging two different and independent algorithms were used for ranging data processing. The internal consistency and the numerical noise of the data reduction, fitting and normal point forming procedure have been tested. The completed experiment demonstrates the ultimate normal point precision at the level of 2.5 picoseconds, that corresponds to 0.37 mm in the range of the retroreflector equipped satellite in space. The key contributor to this value is the interpolation used in the satellite orbit modelling procedure. Keywords: picosecond ranging, orbit modelling.
1
Introduction
The testing of precision limits of algorithms used is interesting for any technique whose precision during recent years is improving by technology reasons without changing of the data processing algorithm. One of these is the Satellite Laser Ranging (SLR). The SLR is a highly accurate measuring technique providing accurate range to retroreflector equipped Earth satellites. It operates on a classical radar principle. Measuring the time interval between the pulse transmission and reception and considering the speed of light and the way of its WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070181
172 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII propagation, the target distance may be evaluated. The picosecond laser pulses together with highly precise timing systems and optical detectors enable resolution and accuracy of the entire ranging system to a range of several millimetres. The results of SLR are used, among others, for the determination of terrestrial reference frame and the product of the universal gravitational constant and the Earth mass, which represent one of the fundamental constants in physics, for details see Pearlman et al [1]. In this view, the SLR serves as a fundamental technique to calibrate other measurements. That is why the precision and accuracy of the SLR data itself is a critical issue.
2
Data processing
The SLR is a technique developed over more than thirty years. One unpropitious consequence of this fact is the squeezing by standard data interchanging formats of a data processing algorithm. To reduce the requirements on data transfer and archiving, to simplify the data analysis procedures, and to simplify the data use, the individual (so-called single shot) SLR measurements are compressed into socalled normal points. The data time series are divided into time slots – time bins of common predefined size of 5÷300 seconds, depending on the satellite orbit altitude. The individual ranging data within one bin are fitted and averaged and at the end are represented by a single range called the normal point. The goal of this paper is to compare two independently implemented algorithms to help identify error source limitations of the normal point precision.
Figure 1:
The schematic diagram of SLR principle, time interval between laser pulse transmission and detection is measured together with time of measurement – epoch.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
173
Experiment
The main factors limiting the normal point precision are: the overall stability of the laser ranging chain and the precision of the data reduction and fitting procedure. The laser ranging hardware and its stability were characterized by means of the Portable Calibration Standard in numerous trials, see Hamal et al [2]. The best laser ranging stations achieve long term system bias stability of the order of picoseconds in time that corresponds to the 0.1 mm in range. The internal consistency and the numerical noise of the data reduction, fitting and normal point forming procedure were tested by the following experiment. The SLR raw ranging data were processed, fitted, and normal points were formed using two different and independent algorithms. 3.1 Graz SLR data reduction The orbit is modelled by a IRVINT Sinclair [3] integrator providing 1 minute x,y,z coordinates, 8-points Lagrange interpolation and topocentric conversion, and optional manual range and time bias tuning. The generated orbit is subtracted from range data and the residuum series is fitted by a polynomial fitting (standard scheme, degree 5-10, optionally 20) data screening and manual editing (validation). All interchange data files are in MERIT2 data format, i.e. with 1 picosecond granularity. 3.2 Portable Calibration Standard data reduction This software package, see Hamal et al [2], consists of orbit integration using the Herstmonceux RGO scheme providing 1 minute x,y,z coordinates, 8-points Lagrange interpolation and topocentric conversion, automated range bias, time bias, and device universal time tuning procedure. The generated orbit is subtracted from the range data and residua are iterative polynomial fitting with fully automated data editing. In this data reduction package, the processing consists of a sequence of individual programs, the data are passed from one program to another via a formatted data file with the least significant digit of 1 picosecond, and thus the rounding is implemented 3 to 5 times consequently. 3.3 Results The ranging data, described in Prochazka and Kirchner [4], from SLR station in Graz, Austria, were used. Segments of the ERS-2 satellite ranging with the data rate of about 750 echoes per second, acquired from October 2003 to January 2004 were selected. The echoes from the closest corner retroreflector were selected to eliminate the influence of the target completely from the process. The single shot precision achieved in the tested data series was 18 to 20 picoseconds rms, that corresponds to a 2.5 to 3.0 mm range precision of a single shot measurement.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
174 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The range residuals of individual ranges (single shot) were compared for all measurements. The difference between the computed ranging residuals on a shot by shot basis indicates the estimate of the data processing procedure. The computed differences have the characteristics displayed in figure 2. One can see a slowly varying component with a varying period of about 15 seconds and an amplitude of 2.0 picoseconds, and random spread within 1.5 picoseconds. The slowly varying component was attributed to the interpolation, the random component to the numerical noise of the computation and to the rounding process. The slowly varying component including absolute shift of the order of 2 picoseconds is the dominant contributor. 10
Range difference [ps]
5
0
-5 # points/pixel densitogram, 5 pixels/s -10 74770
Figure 2:
0
75
74780 74790 Time epoch, seconds in current day [s]
150 74800
Data residuals comparison of two described algorithms. The difference is computed for each shot, the integral value for 0.2 second is plotted.
From range residuals, results were calculated. The numerical experiments of Prochazka and Kirchner [4] showed the deviation from the ideal model in the case when about 75 individual range measurements are compressed into one normal point with the corresponding normal point precision of 2.5 ps. The second break point occurred when compressing more than 2000 points with the corresponding normal point precision of 1 ps. These two break points correspond perfectly to the two limiting factors identified as the interpolation and rounding errors.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
175
Conclusion
The completed experiment demonstrates the ultimate normal point precision at the level of 2.5 picoseconds, that corresponds to 0.37 mm in the range of the retroreflector equipped satellite in space. This limit value is negligible in comparison to the signatures of actually used satellites. The key contributor to this value is the interpolation used in the orbit modelling procedure. The last significant digit in order of one picosecond is acceptable in today’s SLR data processing formats.
Acknowledgements The authors are grateful to Georg Kirchner and Franz Koidl, Graz SLR station. This research was supported by the research framework MSM6840770015 of the Ministry of Education of the Czech Republic.
Reference [1] [2]
[3] [4]
Pearlman, M.R., Degnan, J.J., and Bosworth, J.M., "The International Laser Ranging Service", Advances in Space Research, Vol. 30, No. 2, pp. 135-143, July 2002. Hamal, K., Prochazka, I., Blazej, J., Kirchner, G., Schreiber, U., Riepl, S., Sperber, P., Gurtner, W., Appleby, G., Gibbs, P., Yang Fumin, Neubert, R., and Grunwaldt, L., Satelite Laser Ranging Portable Calibration Standard Missions 1997-2002, In Abstract Book 'Geophysical Research Abstracts' Volume 5, 2003, EGS - AGU - EUG Joint Assembly 2003, Nice, France, p. 243. Sinclair, A, TIRV Reference System, [online], [cit. 02/03/07], http://ilrs.gsfc.nasa.gov/products_formats_procedures/predictions/tirv.htm l. Prochazka, I., Kirchner, G., Numerical noise in satellite laser ranging data processing, Boletin ROA No. 4/2004, ed. J.M.Davila, San Fernando: Real Instituto Observatorion de la Armada, ISSN 1131-5040, 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
177
Expanding the definition of multivariate correlation W. Conley Departments of Mathematics and Business Administration, University of Wisconsin at Green Bay, USA
Abstract The complexities of large scale data analysis, in our computer age, invite the development of new sophisticated statistics to help in this task. One entry into this arena is the CTSP multivariate correlation statistic. A five variable 49 line spreadsheet of data was analyzed using CTSP by Conley and the relationship was found to be linear. Presented here is a much larger example involving nine variables and 89 lines of data, where CTSP reveals a correlation that is nonlinear (exponential in this case). Specifically, nine columns (representing nine variables) of 89 lines of data are being analyzed to see if the variables they represent are correlated in some fashion (linear or nonlinear). Therefore, the data is read into the CTSP statistical analysis simulation program which is adjusted for nine variables and 89 lines of data. Then, using a generalization of the Pythagorean distance measure to nine dimensions, a shortest route connecting the 89 points in a closed loop tour is calculated. Then several random data sets of 9 x 89 size (in similar ranges to the original data) are generated and the shortest routes are calculated for them. In this case, the actual data had a much shorter shortest route than the random data’s shortest routes. Therefore, statistically speaking it can be argued that the actual data is correlated in some fashion because it is following a pattern and hence the points are more compact (closer together in nine dimensional space) leading to a shorter shortest route. The relationship is exponential in this case. This expanded view of correlation (linear or nonlinear) can complement the standard linear analysis Anderson currently uses. Additionally, a second example involving eight variables is presented for comparison purposes. Keywords: multivariate correlation, CTSP statistic, shortest route statistical test, linear and nonlinear analysis. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070191
178 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The new CTSP correlation statistic was developed in 2002 to help discover multivariate relationships whether they be linear or nonlinear. The CTSP is short for (an acronym) correlation using the travelling salesman problem. The idea in two dimensions can be illustrated by thinking of X, Y pairs of points that are following the shape of a parabola when graphed. These points will have a shorter shortest route connecting them, than the shortest route connecting the same number of random points (in the same range as the parabola points). A three dimensional example would be X, Y, Z triples on a flat plane going through the points (0, 0, 0), (100, 100, 100), (100, 0, 100), and (0, 100, 0) in the region 0 to 100 for all three variables. The shortest route connecting these X, Y, Z triples (say 75 of them, for example) would be much shorter than the shortest route connecting 75 random triples (in the same range) that are not following a pattern. This can be exploited statistically to show a correlation (or lack thereof) when analyzing multivariate data. The name CTSP statistic comes from the mathematically famous TSP problems (so called travelling salesman problem) of finding a shortest route to connect n points in a closed loop tour. This analysis presented here uses the multi stage Monte Carlo optimization MSMCO TSP algorithm for the statistical analysis. Let us look at an example.
2
Numeric example one
Researches believe that the nine variables represented by the nine columns of data in Table 1 are correlated in a linear or nonlinear fashion. They think that the first eight variables are perhaps driving the ninth variable (X9 whose data is in Column 9). Therefore, to test the null hypothesis of no correlation between the nine variables (X1, X2…X9) versus the alternative hypothesis of correlation, the 89 lines of 9 columns of data are read into the MSMSCO TSP algorithm program adjusted for 89 lines of data and nine variables. The Pythagorean theorem distance measure is used after expanding it to nine dimensional distance calculations. A few seconds to a minute of computer run time (on a desktop PC) yielded a shortest route of total distance 5,776.308 (see Table 2 for the route read left to right) connecting the 89 nine dimensional points in a closed loop tour. Then four sets of 89 lines of nine columns of random data (in similar 0-100 ranges as the actual data) were read into the MSMCO TSP algorithm. Their shortest routes were calculated to be 6786.314, 6518.579, 6600.060 and 6410.455. Therefore, CTSP = A / B = 5776.308 /(6518.579 + 6600.060) / 2 = .88
(1)
where A is the shortest route distance for the actual data and B is the median of the four random data shortest routes. Now taking the 3 x 4 = 12 Ai/Bi quotients using all combinations of the four random shortest routes, we see that their range WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1: Point 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
X1 73 66 9 40 40 5 0 63 61 28 31 50 65 32 100 40 52 68 17 71 78 70 46 58 65 88 51 57 12 33 100 4 13 38 77 52 55 11 36 65 50 14 84
X2 12 5 17 41 70 51 50 99 56 70 100 60 23 13 10 94 20 89 90 48 56 47 0 39 61 90 28 74 77 3 97 19 23 26 57 63 19 41 20 66 58 79 44
X3 46 69 18 95 58 49 89 29 100 57 11 16 77 100 95 94 67 29 72 66 57 75 37 22 93 62 20 36 41 32 98 69 25 21 72 10 35 42 10 15 3 29 35
X4 59 49 58 91 36 44 77 13 14 30 99 79 39 90 60 30 14 2 40 71 44 25 70 97 5 90 77 71 72 63 32 33 42 100 19 18 41 89 87 23 23 88 21
179
The data. X5 41 94 85 8 8 37 83 27 91 86 73 11 65 18 24 70 3 62 16 36 62 100 88 68 31 86 75 100 63 88 45 100 27 1 97 22 32 46 4 0 100 56 24
X6 24 18 85 68 35 33 13 46 1 31 76 86 36 33 24 46 99 38 49 1 82 70 100 57 33 17 64 74 48 57 85 9 96 26 91 68 37 5 86 3 97 72 54
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
X7 95 100 62 18 30 72 64 30 25 47 5 100 51 38 33 65 41 92 40 99 39 20 34 42 29 69 29 57 36 81 0 63 21 40 91 100 35 35 58 16 73 34 2
X8 96 21 29 23 72 23 52 82 31 100 82 43 87 29 88 82 94 100 4 53 19 20 20 52 81 42 13 91 92 73 70 88 92 5 44 17 82 57 95 67 92 75 57
X9 3.6 4.9 3 3.6 2.7 2 5.1 3.7 3.4 6 7.5 5.8 5.7 2.8 5.3 10.7 3.8 7.7 2.3 5.8 5.5 5.1 5.4 5.4 4 12.9 2.9 14.6 5.7 5.2 11.2 3.6 2.5 1.3 13.3 2.7 2.4 2.3 3.9 1.3 8.8 5.9 2.2
180 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 1: Point 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
X1 28 51 51 56 35 83 40 90 33 55 45 43 96 13 60 18 29 57 43 57 29 81 41 93 45 7 31 11 95 62 66 88 8 66 31 62 29 35 17 44 1 2 98
X2 32 40 94 2 88 95 4 43 23 100 51 100 7 43 58 28 29 63 57 95 100 100 31 47 27 95 72 20 7 23 74 53 10 43 60 40 83 36 40 56 20 56 77
X3 44 100 2 31 5 27 85 73 53 9 3 31 13 37 14 6 15 75 60 50 45 1 33 79 70 77 51 19 31 3 60 46 92 81 79 100 24 9 81 46 100 0 100
X4 80 22 4 60 79 46 50 52 2 79 83 87 16 41 90 97 32 91 53 82 66 18 16 48 65 30 73 43 15 17 10 9 39 93 37 48 28 39 23 84 20 20 19
Continued. X5 88 79 6 74 1 32 56 76 61 70 48 31 81 19 93 1 60 81 90 35 92 99 13 100 79 12 88 82 26 71 41 65 37 39 33 91 56 49 36 91 34 15 48
X6 13 61 100 12 36 90 99 92 34 35 63 34 27 59 65 76 65 83 62 100 63 6 35 76 92 10 75 100 12 60 52 94 83 27 75 6 80 43 11 100 16 12 8
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
X7 21 74 27 37 98 40 85 74 74 0 49 25 66 77 75 22 64 86 90 90 78 90 90 60 56 56 82 95 51 42 46 82 55 21 46 55 77 28 55 19 2 35 35
X8 10 99 88 1 48 59 42 36 30 3 37 55 44 35 74 81 6 80 86 33 100 62 8 91 26 36 25 58 89 20 17 68 3 95 25 66 63 96 14 10 74 100 35
X9 2.1 11.2 3.3 1.5 3.8 7.2 6.6 12.1 2 2.7 3.4 4.3 2.7 2.2 11.4 2.3 1.8 22.9 12.6 12.7 16.3 6.4 1.4 19.2 6.6 2.2 8.8 5.1 2.3 1.8 3.1 9.4 2.3 6.8 3.6 7 5.6 2.4 1.5 6.1 1.4 1.1 4.8
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1: Point 87 88 89
X1 72 39 97
X2 56 4 16
X3 4 94 59
X4 39 98 100
Table 2: 43 29 76 12 1 47 67 72 41
17 42 78 63 20 44 89 37 75
33 11 19 70 88 38 61 81 35
39 55 69 26 7 34 62 85 51
59 53 82 79 32 4 30 40 21
181
Continued. X5 97 60 81
X6 15 2 95
X7 60 100 52
X8 8 74 89
X9 2.8 7.2 18.5
58 23 66 74 18 15 60 46 25
28 68 36 52 65 13 73 49 85
64 50 48 2 87 45 56 80 43
The route. 54 27 6 9 10 14 71 5 22
24 83 57 86 16 77 3 8 31
is 6410.455/6786.314 = .945 to 6786.314/6410.455 = 1.059. This range contains the vast majority of the sampling distribution of CTSP under the null hypothesis of no correlation. However, from eqn (1) our CTSP = .88, which is less than this range. Therefore, the null hypothesis of no correlation can be confidently rejected. The nine variables are correlated and the equation X 9 = .1666 exp(( X 1 + X 2 + X 3 + X 4 + X 5 + X 6 + X 7 + X 8 ) / 125)
(2)
fits the data fairly well. It should be noted that the range of the actual X9 variable values is somewhat smaller (0-25) rather than 0-100 for the other eight variables. However, if one evaluates eqn (2) with 100 for X1 through X8, X9 is 100. Therefore, the restricted range of X9 was a function of the correlation, so random sampling all nine ranges in the area 0-100 seems appropriate for the randomness comparison. However, if the researcher or engineer believes that there is scientific justification for having different ranges for the variables, they can be used for the random data sets generation and subsequent testing. The engineer or scientist will know what ranges are believable and appropriate for the application at hand. The central point is that a shorter shortest route (than randomly generated data’s shortest routes) will indicate that the data is following a pattern and is hence indicating that the variables are correlated.
3
Example two
Researchers studying the eight columns of n = 49 lines of data in Table 3 want to test the hypothesis of no correlation between the eight variables represented by the eight columns of data. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
182 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Therefore, the 8 x 49 array is read into the MSMCO TSP algorithm. A less than one minute computer run produces a shortest route of total distance A = 3571.170 (see Table 4) for analysis. Table 3: Point 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
X1 55 27 82 72 37 4 94 92 46 0 85 74 38 57 54 40 71 88 100 47 16 36 21 29 59 54 65 10 23 48 55 66 20 74 80 26 24 9 64
X2 10 38 98 74 30 100 50 99 100 18 61 70 84 22 26 52 56 57 37 8 45 63 100 51 85 72 40 45 65 15 42 7 8 63 64 58 40 54 88
X3 89 86 61 4 57 50 82 83 82 7 21 70 59 36 92 60 10 75 45 41 20 46 13 41 83 49 71 73 76 80 70 82 71 26 81 5 26 31 54
Example two data. X4 17 67 13 93 70 6 39 23 1 85 100 100 17 19 3 97 82 42 42 67 25 28 94 100 41 62 65 30 80 28 40 100 37 9 15 35 2 18 56
X5 33 50 51 100 15 3 19 21 4 24 100 100 98 2 26 38 79 2 55 36 71 67 22 39 27 32 69 49 5 80 28 98 7 33 99 56 90 33 61
X6 50 12 81 83 90 66 79 27 12 12 17 94 9 47 25 96 52 47 52 29 99 40 20 36 1 58 34 21 44 11 17 73 20 4 38 17 100 41 68
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
X7 100 43 27 12 86 47 84 77 38 64 23 57 11 49 19 20 22 56 26 59 53 61 21 75 79 55 3 98 6 84 56 80 55 44 72 21 3 49 69
X8 45 47 61 56 17 4 3 4 10 62 89 18 87 82 99 93 87 15 3 87 62 3 52 21 40 15 27 84 57 89 76 33 39 14 86 75 53 26 8
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 3: Point 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49
X1 78 32 61 89 61 98 32 100 85 13
X2 21 53 88 44 48 100 96 93 47 88
45 5 46 6 27
35 44 25 9 19
43 16 8 42 34
Continued.
X3 56 34 82 92 54 55 70 47 39 96
Table 4: 30 29 18 3 48
183
X4 37 39 10 48 100 29 87 73 25 98
X5 35 28 61 91 8 97 95 17 5 39
X6 86 29 61 6 88 1 0 75 14 88
X7 92 25 23 58 34 83 89 81 33 68
X8 92 99 7 83 44 62 8 17 71 37
Example two route. 28 23 7 37 14
31 11 47 21 15
20 17 26 40 13
10 4 39 1 41
24 12 22 33 36
49 32 38 2
Then four sets of random data of 8 x 49 are read into the MSMCO TSP algorithm. Their shortest routes turn out to be 3346.265, 3473.206, 3564.802 and 3363.000. Note that the real data shortest route distance (3571.170) is comparable to these and will not produce a relatively smaller CTSP. Therefore, the null hypothesis of no correlation between the variables cannot be rejected.
4 Expanded definition of correlation We are now prepared with the CTSP multivariate statistic (for the computer age) to expand our definition of multivariate correlation to the discovery of any type of pattern, whether it be linear, nonlinear and even non-functional (like a mathematical relation). Additionally, if one wishes to assume and/or test for various underlying distributions, CTSP can help in that accommodation also.
5
Conclusion
Much of the standard multivariate analysis used today assumes sampling from multivariate normal distributions and looking for linear relationships. However, with CTSP we can go beyond this and look for any type of relationship that is revealed by a relatively shorter shortest route through the k dimensional space (for k variables) when compared with similar random data. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
184 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The various TSP algorithms can help trucking companies and transportation entities in their deliveries to their valued customers. However, the TSP analysis when combined with the CTSP multivariate correlation statistic, can do much more than deliver products and services to customers. It can also deliver sophisticated multivariate statistical correlation analysis on spreadsheets of data that researcher and engineers encounter on an almost daily basis.
References [1] [2]
Conley, W.C., Multi stage Monte Carlo optimization applied to systems of integral equations. Proc. of the 15th Int. Conf. on Boundary Element Technology, ed. C.A. Brebbia-WIT Press, Southampton, pp 75-86, 2003. Anderson, T.W. Multivariate Statistical Analysis, 3rd edition, John Wiley Inc, New York, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
185
3D analysis of solid reinforced concrete beams subjected to combined load of bending, torsion and shear A. S. Alnuaimi Civil and Architectural Engineering, Sultan Qaboos University, Sultanate of Oman
Abstract This paper presents a comparison between experimental and an in house 3-D finite element analysis results of three reinforced concrete solid beams subjected to combined loadings of bending, shear and torsion. The finite element program adopted was based on a 20 node isoparametric element. A non-linear elastic isotropic model, proposed by Kotsovos, was used to model concrete behaviour, while steel was modelled as an embedded element exhibiting elastic-perfectly plastic response. Allowance was made for shear retention and for tension stiffening in concrete after cracking. Only fixed direction, smeared cracking modelling was adopted. The beam dimensions were 300x300mm cross section, 3800mm length. Experimental results were compared with the non-linear predictions. The comparison was judged by load displacement relationship, steel strain, and load and mode of failure. Good agreement was observed between predicted ultimate and experimentally measured loads. It was concluded that the present program can confidently be used to predict the behaviour and failure load of reinforced concrete solid beams subjected to combined load of bending, torsion and shear. Keywords: beam, solid beam, bending, shear, torsion, direct design, concrete, reinforced concrete, stress analysis, combined loading.
1
Introduction
The behaviour of solid beams when subjected to combined loading is very complex. A detailed analysis would normally require a three-dimensional finite element model. Rahal and Collins [1] developed a three-dimensional analytical WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070201
186 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII model capable of analysing rectangular sections subjected to combined loading of biaxial bending, biaxial shear, torsion and axial load. The model takes into account the shear-torsion interaction and concrete spalling. It idealizes the rectangular cross-section resisting shear and torsion as made of four transversely reinforced walls with varying thickness and varying angle of principal compressive strains. The vertical shear stress due to shear force is uniformly resisted by the vertical walls and the lateral shear stress is resisted by the horizontal walls. They tested their model and concluded that the model predicts very close results to experimental behavioural and ultimate load results. Ibell et al [2] used an upper-bound plasticity analysis in a 2D model for the assessment of shear in reinforced concrete beams. The results from this model were compared with experimental results. It was recommended that the 2D analysis to be extended to more general 3D collapse analysis. Rabczuk and Eibl [3] presented a model using a mesh free 2D Galerkin/ finite element approach. The concrete was modelled with particles and reinforcement with beam element. For steel, an elastoplastic constitutive law with isotropic hardening and tension cut-off was used. The concrete was modelled via a continuum damage model, where an anisotropic tensile damage variable was used to capture the behaviour of concrete in tension. They used a displacement controlled approach for testing their model. They compared the results from their model with experimental results from one rectangular and one I-section pre-stressed beams. They concluded that a full 3D simulation would be more appropriate. In this research an in-house 3-D finite element program was used for nonlinear analysis of this computational study. The program was developed by ElNuonu [4] using Kotsovs’ concrete model. This model was based on experimental data obtained at Imperial College London from tests on the behaviour of concrete under complex stress states (Kotsovos and Newman [5] and Kotsovos [6]). The testing techniques used to obtain this data were validated by comparing them with those obtained in an international co-operative programme of research into the effect of different test methods on the behaviour of concrete. This model is capable of describing the behaviour of concrete under uniaxial, biaxial and triaxial stress conditions. It requires only the concrete cube compressive strength f cu to define the behaviour of concrete under different stress states. More information about this model is given in Kotsovos and Pavlovic [7].
2
A 3D finite element program
In the 3D program, a 150x150x150mm iso-parametric solid element with twenty node and twenty seven Gauss points was used. The concrete cylinder '
compressive strength f c is taken as f’c= 0.8fcu N/mm2, the Young’s modulus ' ' ' f c N/mm2, the split cylinder tensile strength f t = 0.54 f c N/mm2 and the Poisson’s ratio was set at a constant value of 0.15. Before cracking or crushing, the concrete behaviour is assumed to be non-linear elastic isotropic.
Ec = 5000
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
187
Crushing occurs at a point when all the three principal stresses are compressive and the state of stress is on the ‘yield’ surface. In the case of concrete crushing, complete loss of strength is assumed i.e. no compression softening is allowed for. When the concrete cracks in any direction, concrete ceases to be isotropic and cracking can occur if the minimum principal strain (compressive) reaches a value taken as equal to 0.003. After cracking, smeared crack approach with simple tension stiffening and shear retention equations are employed to represent the post cracking behaviour of concrete. Cracks are assumed to be orthogonal and once formed remain in their direction. The stress-strain relationship in '
tension was assumed to be linear up to f t and immediately after cracking the '
tensile stress f t is reduced to 0.8 f t . Thereafter, f t decreases linearly with strain and is zero at the maximum strain of 0.003 which roughly corresponds to yield strain of steel of 0.0025. Transfer of shear stresses across cracks is modelled by means of the 'shear retention' factor β which defines the shear modulus of cracked concrete as βG, where G is the elastic shear modulus of the un-cracked concrete. The shear retention factor β= 1.0 if εn ≤ εcr and β = 0.25 εcr/εn if εn > εcr, where εcr = cracking strain ( ε cr = f t ' Ec ) and εn = average of the three principal strains at any cracked point ( ε n = (ε1 + ε 2 + ε 3 ) 3 ). The reinforcement is modelled as one dimensional element embedded in the solid concrete elements. Elastic-plastic stress-strain behaviour without strain hardening was used in this research. Only uniaxial resistance is considered with no provision for kinking or dowel action of bars. Standard incremental-iterative procedure was adopted for solution. The load increments were equal to 10% of the design load for the first three increments and 5% for the remaining increments. The maximum number of increments was 50 and the maximum number of iterations in each increment was 200. The convergence being deemed satisfactory if the ratio of the square roots of the sum of the squares of the residual forces to that of the applied loads did not exceed 5%. The stresses in the cross-section nearest to mid-span were analysed. The stress distribution at the last converged increment was used for the analysis. In deciding on the predicted mode of failure, the load-deflection relationship, steel strain and ultimate load were taken into consideration. The program was extensively used by Bhatt and Lim for the analysis of slabs, internal column-flat slab junctions and punching shear failure of flat slabs (Bhatt and Lim [8,9]). Good agreement between predicted and experimental results was found.
3
Tested beams
Three reinforced concrete beams tested by Alnuaimi and Bhatt [10] were analysed. All beams were 300x300mm cross section and 3.8m length. They were subjected to combined load of bending, torsion and shear (Table 1). The main variables studied were the ratio of the shear stress due to torsion to shear stress
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
188 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII due to shear force τtor/τshr which varied between 0.69 and 3.04 and the ratio of the torsion to bending moment Td/Md which varied between 0.26 and 1.19. The concrete mix consisted of cement, uncrushed 10mm gravel and sand with water/ cement ratio of 0.55. Three cubes, 100x100x100mm, and six cylinders, 150x300mm, for each beam were cast from the same concrete used for casting each beam. The specimen and the samples were kept under damp Hessian for about four days and then under room condition. The samples were tested on the day the beam was tested to determine the cube and cylinder compressive strengths and split cylinder tensile strength of concrete. Table 1: Beam No. BTV13 BTV14 BTV15
Td
Md
kNm 26 13 39
kNm 50.89 50.89 32.89
Load combination. Vd
τtor
kN 61.08 61.08 41.08
τshr 2
2
N/mm 4.16 2.08 6.24
N/mm 3.00 3.00 2.05
Td/Md
τtor / τshr
Ratio 0.51 0.26 1.19
Ratio 1.39 0.69 3.04
Table 2 shows the average yield strengths of reinforcement and compressive and tensile strengths of concrete. The concrete cube and cylinder compressive strengths shown for each beam in Table 2 are the measured average strengths of the three cubes and three cylinders respectively and the concrete tensile strength shown is the measured average strength of three cylinders tested for split test. All results were obtained from samples cured along side each beam. Table 2: Beam No. BTV13 BTV14 BTV15
fcu
Average material properties. f'c
2
f’t 2
fy 2
fyv 2
N/mm
N/mm
N/mm
N/mm
N/mm2
40 37 61
28.5 25.7 38.2
3.45 2.92 4.38
500 500 500
500 500 500
Figure 1 shows the provided reinforcement and arrangement of longitudinal bars for each beam. The solid circles in Figure 1 represent the longitudinal bars in which strain was measured nearest to mid-span. Strains in the stirrups nearest to mid-span are also reported. 2Y8
2Y8
2Y8
2Y8
2Y8 2Y10 4Y12
2Y10 4Y12
BTV13
2Y10 4Y12
BTV15
Y8@120 mm
BTV14
Figure 1:
Provided reinforcement at test-span.
Y8@170 mm
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Y8@82 mm
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
189
Test setup and instrumentation
Figure 2 shows a testing rig with typical beam installed. The test rig is a threedimensional frame designed to allow application of torsion, bending moment and shear force. The model was mounted on two steel stools fixed to the concrete floor at a distance of 1.8m a part. The test span was 1.2m long centred at midspan. The beam was simply supported by a set of two perpendicular rollers at each support and a system of pin-and-roller at the mid-span of the top face. At the support, the lower roller allows axial displacement and the upper one allows rotation about a horizontal axis at the soffit level of the beam. Torsion was applied by means of a torsion arm fixed to each end of the beam while bending moment and shear force were a result of applied load at mid-span across the beam width at the top face. This support and loading arrangement allowed full rotation about the centre line of the beam soffit and displacement in the beam axial direction. It produced constant torsional shear stress over the entire length of the beam and maximum normal stress due to bending and shear stress due to shear force occurred near the mid-span. The load was measured using a data logger for data acquisition. Linear voltage displacement transducers (LVDT) were used to measure the vertical displacement at the bottom face of the beam. To measure strain in the bars, a pair of strain gauges, 6mm long, was fixed on directly opposite faces of the bar and connected to a data logger. Accordingly, the axial strain recorded at each load stage was taken as the average reading of both gauges. Crack width and crack development were measured by means of a crack width measuring microscope.
Figure 2:
Test rig with a typical beam installation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
190 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Comparison between experimental and computational results
5.1 Load displacement relationship Figure 3 shows the vertical measured and computed displacements at the centre of the bottom face of each beam. It is clear from this figure that, good agreement was achieved between experimental and computational results for beam BTV14. In the case of beams BTV13 the program predicted stiffer behaviour than the measured. The predicted and measured values from beams BTV15 were small and difficult to judge. The measured and computed displacements of beams BTV13 and BTV14 with bending dominance (Td/Md<1) reached the displacement limit of span/250. Beam BTV15 with torsion dominance (Td/Md>1) experienced measured and computed relatively smaller displacements and did not reach the span/250 limit. BTV13 1.2 1
L.F.
0.8 0.6
EXP
0.4
Comput
0.2 0 -0.2
0.0
2.0
4.0
6.0
8.0
Disp.(m m )
BTV14 1.4 1.2 1
L.F.
0.8 0.6 0.4
EXP
0.2
Comput.
0 -0.2 0.0
2.0
4.0
6.0
8.0
Disp.(m m )
BTV15 1 0.8
L.F.
0.6 0.4
EXP
0.2 0 -0.1 -0.2
Comput 0.1
0.3
0.5
0.7
0.9
1.1
1.3
1.5
1.7
1.9
Disp.(m m )
Figure 3:
Vertical displacement at mid-span.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
191
5.2 Strain in the longitudinal steel Figure 4 shows good agreement between the measured and computed strain ratios in the longitudinal steel. In beams BTV13 and BTV14 with Td/Md<1, the longitudinal steel yielded or reached yield strain while slightly less strain was recorded in beam BTV15 with Td/Md>1. 5.3 Strain in the transverse steel Figure 5 shows strain ratios in the transverse steel; in general, a very good agreement between measured and computed results was achieved. The transverse steel yielded or reached near yield strain. Longitudinal steel BTV13 1.2 1
L.F.
0.8 0.6
EXP
0.4
Comput
0.2 0 -0.2 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
ε/ εy
Longitudinal steel BTV14 1.4 1.2 1
L.F.
0.8 0.6 0.4
EXP
0.2
Comput
0 -0.2 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.2
ε/ εy
Longitudinal steel BTV15
1 0.8
L.F.
0.6 0.4 EXP
0.2
Comput
0 -0.2
-0.2
0
Figure 4:
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
ε/ εy
Strain ratios in the longitudinal steel.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
1
192 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Stirrup BTV13 1.2 1
L.F.
0.8 0.6
EXP
0.4
Comput
0.2 0 -0.2 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
ε/ εy
Stirrup BTV14 1.4 1.2 1 L.F.
0.8 0.6
-0.1
0.4
EXP
0.2
Comput
0 -0.2 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
ε/ εy
Stirrups BTV15
1 0.8
L.F.
0.6 0.4
EXP
0.2
Comput
0 -0.2
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
ε/ εy
Figure 5:
Strain ratios in the transverse steel.
5.4 Failure load and mode of failure Column 4 of Table 3 shows very good agreement between the measured Le and computed Lc failure loads. All beams failed near their design loads. Both the computed and measured results showed that in the case of beams in which bending was dominant (Td/Md<1) almost vertical cracks started in the bottom face and at the lower half of the front and rear sides. These cracks were followed by inclined cracks in succeeding load increments until they first appear in the top face at about 80% of failure load. In the beams where torsion was dominant (Td/Md>1), inclined cracks extended into the bottom face one increment after they were formed in the front and rear sides. In both groups, the smaller the ratio Td/Md, the closer is the angle of crack to vertical. In beams WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
193
BTV13, BTV14 the mode of failure was mostly flexural where the beam experienced relatively large displacement and the flexural steel yielded. A small number of large cracks caused failure at the time of flexural steel yielding. Beam BTV15 failed by diagonal cracking due to high torsional shear stress and the failure mode was less ductile with small displacement, less longitudinal steel strain and larger transverse steel strain than the bending dominant beams. Table 3: 1
BTV13
2 Td/Md Ratio 0.51
3 τtor/τshr Ratio 1.39
4 Le/Lc Ratio 0.98
BTV14
0.26
0.69
0.96
BTV15
1.19
3.04
0.93
Beam No.
6
Ratios of measured and predicted failure loads.
Conclusion
From the results presented in this paper it can be concluded that the 3-D finite element program was shown to be in a good agreement with the experimental results and therefore, proven to be a good tool for the prediction of beam behaviour and ultimate load of solid reinforced concrete beams subjected to combined load of bending, torsion and shear.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5] [6] [7]
Rahal K. N. and Collins M. P., Analysis of Sections Subjected to Combined Shear and Torsion – A Theoretical Model. ACI Structural Journal, Vol. 92, No. 4, July-August 1995, pp. 459-469. Ibell T. J., Morley C.T. and Middleton C.R., An Upper-bound Plastic Analysis for Shear. Magazine of Concrete Research, 50, No.1, March 1998, pp. 67-73. Rabczuk T. and Eibl J., Numerical analysis of prestressed concrete beams using a coupled element free Galerkin/finite approach, International Journal of Solid and Structures, v.41, n.3-4, February 2004, pp 10611080. El-Nuonu G. F. R., Design of Shear Wall-Floor Slab Connections. Ph.D. thesis, University of Glasgow, 1985. Kotsovos M. D. and Newman J. B., A mathematical Description of the Deformation Behaviour of Concrete under Complex Loading. Magazine of Concrete Research, Vol. 31, No. 107, June 1979, pp.77-90. Kotsovos M. D., A Mathematical Description of the Strength Properties of Concrete under Generalized Stress. Magazine of Concrete Research, Vol. 31, No. 108, Sep. 1979, pp. 151-158. Kotsovos M. D. and Pavlovic M. N., Structural Concrete, Finite element analysis for limit-state design, Thomas Telford Publications, 1 Heron Quey, London E14 4JD, 1995. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
194 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [8]
[9]
[10]
Bhatt P. and Lim B. T., Flat Slab-Column Junctions with Shear and Moment Transfer: A Comparison between Finite Element Predictions and Experiments. Proc. of 7th ACME Conference, University of Durham, (Ed. Bettes, P.) pp. 11 – 14, 1999. Bhatt P. and Lim B. T., Punching Shear Capacity of Internal Column-Flat Slab Junction with In-Plane Restraint: A Comparison between Finite Element Predictions and Experiments. Developments in Analysis and Design Using Finite Element Methods, Civil-Comp Press, (Ed. B.H.V. Topping), pp. 141 – 147, 1999. Alnuaimi A. S. and Bhatt P., Design of Reinforced Concrete Solid Beams, Structures and Buildings Journal, Thomas Telford Limited, v.159, n.4, August 2006, pp 197-216.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
195
Use of correlation of iron loss and copper loss for improving the efficiency of three phase squirrel cage induction motors B. B. Saanane, A. H. Nzali & D. J. Chambega Department of Electrical Power Engineering, University of Dares Salaam, Tanzania
Abstract So far computation of iron (core) losses in induction motors cannot be performed through exact analytical methods but is dependent mainly on empirical formulae and experience of motor designers and manufacturers. In comparison to copper losses, which are to a larger extent easier to calculate, iron losses are mostly associated with some practical parameters, for example the type of material and manufacturing conditions. This paper proposes a new correlation between these two losses with the aim of getting minimized total machine loss in order to improve the efficiency. A total loss prediction model is developed on a matlab 6.5 platform such that the optimal airgap magnetic flux density and airgap length points are established which offer minimized total loss, min(Pfe + Pcu). These points are then used to reconfigure a new motor geometry with a minimized total loss. The new motor design approach was simulated on a 2D-FEM to analyse the new motor response. Experimental results which agree with the results of the design show an improvement of motor efficiency. Also, empirical formulae are developed and validated which can greatly assist motor designers. Keywords: total loss model, optimization, analysis, design formulae, motor efficiency.
1
Introduction
Electrical motors in general, and industry’s “workhorse ” AC induction motors in particular, represent a great potential and realizable energy savings. Motors account for approximately 64% of electricity consumption in the US, at a yearly WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070211
196 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII cost of US $ 112 billion. Every 1% reduction in motor demand therefore cuts 0.64 % or US $ 716, 800,000 off the industry-wide bill [1]. Motors lose energy in several ways. The difference between the power input and power output make up the motor losses, which are generally defined as noload and load-dependent losses. The no-load losses consist of the friction and windage loss which come from bearing friction and air resistance of the spinning fan/rotor respectively. Also, included are the iron losses which are a result of a combination of hysteresis and eddy current effects due to the changing magnetic fields in the motor’s steel core. The load dependent losses consist of the stator losses (product of stator input current squared and stator resistance at operating temperature), the rotor losses (product of induced rotor current squared and rotor resistance) and stray losses which come from additional harmonics due to the supply and circulating current losses in the magnetic steel and windings.
2
Statement of the problem
All losses with the exception of the core losses, can be expressed analytically. But core losses can only be expressed through empirical formulae, as many authors until to-date have found out [2]. This situation is due to the fact that the material used for magnetic circuits of the machines is non-linear. So in reality, it has not been possible to get analytical expressions to fully describe the phenomena of hysteresis and eddy currents in the machine cores. Therefore, in three phase induction motors, about 16% of total losses are core losses, while about 48% are copper losses. Hence, it is still important to continue finding how to reduce iron and copper losses so as to raise the motor efficiency. This paper proposes a new correlation between these two losses with the aim of getting minimized total machine loss in order to improve the efficiency.
3
The employed methodology
The parameters of any motor frame including its geometry form the initial data for developing the total loss optimization model. Through the developed model, the airgap magnetic flux density B δ and airgap diameter (stator bore) D are both varied. As a consequence, also varies the geometry of the stator and rotor teeth, slots and backs so as to achieve minimized total loss min(Pfe + Pcu) in the same motor frame. From this procedure, it is then possible to locate the optimal points of B and D respectively, for the airgap magnetic flux density and airgap diameter. Using these optimal points a new motor geometry is reconfigured which assures a minimized total loss of the motor. This approach is summarized in a flowchart which is given in Figure 1. The new motor design according to the above approach is simulated on a twodimensional finite element method (2D-FEM) to analyze the new motor response. Experimental results are also compared with the results of the design in
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
197
order to check for any improvement of motor efficiency. Also, empirical formulae are developed and validated which can greatly assist motor designers.
4
Motor prediction model
The optimisation was carried out through a model incorporating also, the complete stator and rotor geometry. The model was then implemented on a matlab 6.5 platform. 4.1 Assumptions for the approximate iron loss prediction model Prediction and subsequent optimisation of iron loss and copper loss was achieved by minimizing the losses in different sections of the core through minimization of their magnetic flux densities by influencing on the air gap flux density. The limit of the air gap flux density B for a given maximum induction in the stator and rotor teeth and backs, depended on the thickness of the teeth and the backs. In this model, the parasitic effects were not considered, with the exception of the surface and teeth reluctance losses in the rotor. Hence, for a given motor geometry and by varying the air gap induction B and air gap diameter D, the motor loss prediction model was developed with consideration of the following assumptions: (1) The non-linear magnetic behaviour of the iron material was taken into consideration by allocating a maximum flux density in different iron regions of the machine; (2) The leakage fluxes in the air gap and slots were neglected, such that, all magnetic flux crossing the air gap was assumed to flow radially through the teeth; (3) The overhang effects were neglected; (4) Stray losses were not included in the model; (5) A sinusoidally distributed air gap flux density was assumed; and (6) The current loadings in the stator and rotor were determined by the cooling capacity and the available slot areas in the motor cross-section. 4.2 Flowchart of optimization for the approximate iron loss prediction model The flowchart as shown in Figure1 for the approximate motor loss prediction model was developed on the basis of the motor geometry including the simple thermal model of a motor and the empirical iron loss formulae. The initial conditions were considered to be the nominal values of the original motor frame type 160 L-4 for 15 kW. The idea therefore, was to try the motor loss optimisation method on this original motor geometry, in order to get a new geometry with lowered total loss. So, this therefore, could lead to efficiency improvement of the same motor frame size, but with a re-configured geometry. ^
The iteration was conducted on varying the air gap induction, B δ and air gap diameter, D and also through the logic loops for the model to be able to compute the minimized value of motor loss, Ptot ( B, D ) , of the motor.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
198 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Start
No
Srtop(n,m) > = Sr(n,m)
Set initial motor parameters
Yes
Set maximum values of flux densities in stator and rotor sections
Srtop(n,m) > = Sr(n,m) Vary the air gap diameter (bore), D(n) : n = n+1
Compute stator and rotor winding copper loss:Psw, Prw, Pcu(n,m)=Psw+Prw
Vary the air gap induction, B(m): m = m+1
Compute maximum torque, maxTq(n,m) Compute geometrical stator and rotor dimensions No
maxTq(n,m) > Tr rated torque
Compute stator and rotor available slot area and current loadings
Yes Tq(n,m)=Tr
Compute Iron loss components in the stator and rotor
No
Tq(n,m) =Tr and modulus Pcu(n,m) Yes
Minimize sum, min(Pfe(n,m)+Pcu(n,m) as function of D and B
3-D plot, Ptot(B,D) and minPtot
Get optD and optB from minPtot(n,m)
Compute new geometry for stator and rotor with optD and optB for minPfe
END
Figure 1: Flowchart of optimisation for the motor loss prediction model. 4.3 Optimization of motor loss prediction model In this approximate motor loss prediction model, optimization of motor loss was achieved by minimizing the losses in different sections of the core by influencing the airgap flux density Bˆ δ and air gap diameter D. The limit of the air gap WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
199
induction Bˆ δ for a given maximum induction in the stator and rotor teeth and back depended on the thickness of the teeth bts, btr and backs hrs, hrr. These geometrical dimensions depended also on the airgap diameter D. Therefore, by increasing Bˆ δ the available space areas for slots A ss , A sr decreased and as a consequence also, the current loadings S rs , S rr decreased. Conversely, by increasing the current loadings brought about an increase in the slot areas and a reduction in the widths of the teeth and the backs. As a result, the airgap induction Bˆ δ decreased. Also, the iron losses were considered together with the copper losses as in a real motor. Implementation of the model was done on the matlab 6.5 platform on the basis of the flowchart shown in Figure 1. Thereafter, the motor loss curve as a function of Bˆ δ and D was minimized as shown in Figure 3. In this model, however, the motor for every shaft power was dimensioned by maintaining the same nominal (rated) torque, the same outer diameter of the stator core and the same airgap thickness. This was done so in order to keep the same frame size. Through minimization of Ptot (B , D ) the optimal point was located and the corresponding values for B and D were determined as optB and optD. These new values optB and optD, then facilitated to compute the new motor geometry for stator and rotor cores with a result of reduced motor losses.
Ptot, Total Loss (Watts)
1500 1000 500 0
-500 0.4 1.5
0.3 0.2 A irgap Diam eter, (m eters )
Figure 2:
0.1
1 A irgap Induc tion, B , (Tes la) 0.5
Motor Loss, Ptot, (Watts) for a 15kW motor type M3AP 160 L-4 as a function of Air gap Induction, B, and Air gap Diameter, D.
4.4 Optimization of motor loss prediction model The developed approximate motor loss prediction model was applied to the frame size of a three phase squirrel cage motor, 15 kW 4-pole. The iron loss correction factors were introduced in the iron loss empirical expressions, in order to account for other loss making mechanisms, like the stray losses which were WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
200 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII not included in the model. This motor loss prediction model was able to give theoretical results as shown in Figure 3 and Figure 4. From Figure 3, it was possible to locate the point with minimum motor loss, minPtot, and the corresponding values, optB and optD. Then, values of randomly selected seventeen options around the optimal points optB and optD were computed and plotted as shown in Figure 4. They were generated through various combinations of peak values of magnetic flux densities in different motor sections for both stator and rotor. Through this procedure could generate a new motor geometry inside the same frame with minimized total loss min(Pfe+Pcu).
min(Pf e+Pcu), [ W]
1200 1100 1000 900 800 I
IV
VII
X
XIII XVI
Option Nos. I-XVII
Figure 3:
Seventeen options for motor loss optimization on a 15 kW, 160 L-4 motor.
4.5 Formulation of the correlation empirical formula between the iron loss and copper loss The statistical analysis of the model results was performed using a software [3]. So, the optimised parameters B, D, Pcu and Pfe were then statistically analysed. Empirical correlation relationships were therefore formulated as given in Equations (1), (2), (3) and the curve relationship shown in Figure 5: Following below are the developed novel empirical formulae: (1) D = a + b B + c B 2 + d B 3 , where: a = 4 .8 1 2 1 0 5 1, b = − 2 2 .1 1 2 4 7 6 , c = 3 1 .9 3 5 4 5 5 , d = − 1 8 .7 7 3 0 3 5 ; D[m] and B[T]. The limits are: 0 . 5700 < B < 0 . 6900 T and 0 . 1580 < D < 0 . 1760 m . 2 3 , (2) P fe = a + bB + cB + dB where: a = 1 8 6 3 6 3 .0 5 , b = − 8 3 4 4 5 6 .0 3 , c = 1 2 4 8 9 1 2 .5 , d = − 6 2 2 9 8 4 .3 9
;
and P fe [W] and B[T]. The limits are: 0 .6 3 0 0 < B < 0 .6 9 0 0
P
c u
T
=
and
5 3 9 .9 3 0 0 < P
a + b P
fe
+ c P
2 fe
fe
< 5 7 3 .8 0 0
+ d P
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
3 fe
,
W
. (3)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
201
where: a = −4049416.8, b = 22282.868, c = −40.851615, d = 0.024954481; and P cu [W] and P fe [W]. The limits are: 5 3 6 .1 1 0 0 < P
fe
< 5 4 6 .1 5 0 0
W
a nd
3 8 2 .5 0 0 < Pcu < 4 5 1 .5 5 0 0
W
.
4 .5 8 e + 0 0 2
Y Ax is (P cu, W)
4 .4 5 e + 0 0 2
4 .3 1 e + 0 0 2
4 .1 7 e + 0 0 2
4 .0 3 e + 0 0 2
3 .8 9 e + 0 0 2
3 .7 6 e + 0 052.4 e + 0 0 2
5 .4 e + 0 0 2
5 .4 e + 0 0 2
5 .4 e + 0 0 2
5 .4 e + 0 0 2
5 .5 e + 0 0 2
5 .5 e + 0 0 2
X A x is (P fe , W )
Figure 4:
Relationship Pcu vs. Pfe for 15 kW motor M3AP 160 L-4.
Figure 5: Air gap flux density and the higher harmonics present including the fundamental one.
Figure 6:
Chart of magnetic field lines for no-load motor operation.
4.6 The Finite Element Method Analysis of new motor geometry The evaluation of electromagnetic field in all the simulations was based on the finite element computation of the unknown represented by the magnetic vector potential, a vector normally oriented to the computation domain, [5]. Two magneto-harmonic models of no-load operation for rated source voltage and frequency were employed: (1) simulation with a value lower than the rated WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
202 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII slip; and (2) simulation with rated slip and with a value of rotor bar resistivity 5 much larger than the real value; a value 10 times greater was used. Both options could give practically the same results, which are shown in Figure 5 and Figure 6. The main numerical results of no-load simulation were: (1) the value of no-load current for each phase was, I10 = 18.7A, 19A, 20.9A; (2) stator and rotor iron loss was 343 W. Table 1: Motor type for ABB frames
Computed data from original geometry
Simulated data for new geometry with developed model
Simulated data for new geometry with FEM
Experimental data on original motor
M3AP 160 L-4
A) At unity iron loss correction factors: Kbts=1, Kbrs=1, Kbtr=1, Kbrr=1 Pcu=346.74 W Pfet=68.18 W, Pfer=170.35 W Ptar=5.87 W Pytr=77.65 W Pexc=0.71 W Pfe=322.76 W Ptot=669.50 W
A) At unity iron loss correction factors: Kbts=1, Kbrs=1, Kbtr=1,
A) At unity iron loss correction factors: Kbts=1, Kbrs=1, Kbtr=1,
A) Standard efficiency type Pcu=325.24 W
B) At non-unity iron loss correction factors: Kbts=1.51, Kbrs=2.234 Kbrr=1.52, Kbtr=1.20 Pcu=346.74 W Pfet=102.95 W Pfer=380.55 W Ptar=7.05 W Pytr=118.03 W Pexc=0.71 W Pfe=609.29 W Ptot=956.03 W
5
Comparison of results.
Kbrr=1 Pcu=383.48 W Pfet=57.86 W Pfer=139.06 W Ptar=10.72 W Pytr=46.47 W Pexc=0.58 W Pfe=254.68 W Ptot=638.16 W B) At non-unity ironloss correction factors: Kbts=1.51, Kbrs=2.234 Kbrr=1.52, Kbtr=1.20 Pcu=383.48 W Pfet=87.37 W Pfer=310.66 W Ptar=12.86 W Pytr=70.63 W Pexc=0.58 W Pfe=482.09 W Ptot=928.65 W
Kbrr=1 Stator iron loss , 207.20 W Rotor iron loss, 136 W Total iron loss, 343.2 W
Pfet=57.9 W Pfer=180.4 W Ptar=4.60 W Pytr=45.9 W Field factor=1.08 Pfe=337.09 W Ptot=662.33 W No load Iron loss Calculated=310 W Tested=262 W B) High Efficiency type (Eff.1) Pcu=325.24 W Pfet=55.1 W Pfer=171.6 W Ptar=2.00 W Pytr=18.8 W Field factor=2.15 Pfe=532.05 W Ptot= 857.29 W
Discussion of results
The winding materials are assumed to be copper for the stator winding and aluminium for the rotor winding and the steel sheet material is used for the magnetic circuit. For a given airgap induction and maximum flux densities in the teeth and backs, the copper loss is calculated using the formulae according to Chandur [2]. Through the methodology outlined in sec.3, the developed total loss prediction model made possible to initially locate the optimal points of airgap magnetic induction, airgap diameter and the minimized total loss, min(Pfe+Pcu).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
203
With these points, a new motor geometry was re-configured and verified its performance including comparison with experimental results. The analytical and experimental results are summarized in Table 1.
6
Conclusion
In comparing the analytical model results with the experimental data there is a good and acceptable agreement. The model gives a lower value of the total loss than with the results from the original motor frame. So through this motor loss model the motor efficiency can be improved. Therefore, this model and the developed empirical formulae given as equations (1), (2) and (3) are very useful tools to motor designers.
List of symbols Ass
=
Asr
= available space area for rotor slots,
available space area for stator slots,
B, Bˆ δ = airgap magnetic flux density, bts = width of stator teeth, btr = width of rotor teeth, D= airgap diameter or bore of stator core, hrs = thickness of back of stator core, hrr = thickness of back of rotor core, n = matrix row in iteration of a model parameter, m = matrix column in iteration of a model parameter, S rs = stator current loading,
S rr =
rotor current loading,
Srtop = the biggest value between the two current loadings, Tq = computed developed torque by the motor, Tr = rated motor torque, optB= optimal point of airgap magnetic flux density, optD= optimal point of airgap diameter, Psw = stator winding copper loss, Prw = rotor winding copper loss, Pcu = total copper loss, Pfet = stator teeth loss, Pfer = stator back loss, Ptar = rotor teeth reluctance loss, Pytr = rotor surface reluctance loss, Pexc = excess or anomalous loss of stator back, Pfe = total iron loss, Ptot = total motor loss, minPtot= minimized total motor loss.
References [1]
Application Note, “An In-Depth Examination of an Energy Efficiency Technology”, Pacific Gas and Electric Company May 1997. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
204 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2]
[3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
[8]
Chandur, S. “Electrical machine design and analysis of induction and permanent magnet motors”, Department of Electric Power Engineering, Electrical Machines and Power Electronics, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, August 2000. Chapra S. & Canale R. “Numerical Methods for Engineers”, McGraw 1998. Electrical Technology, “http://www.very last page of the internet.com/elctromagnetic dv/muller/electrical_gene…16/1/02”. Masato E. and Kenji O. “Designing a low-loss induction motor considering the vector magnetic properties”, IEEE Transactions on Magnetics, Vol.38, No.2, pp 877-880, March 2002. Oriano B., Aldo C., Mario C. and Maurizio R. “Iron losses in Electrical Machines: Influence of different material models”, IEEE Transactions on Magnetics, Vol.38, No.2, pp 805-808, March 2002. Saanane B.B, Nzali A.H and Chambega D.J. “Design Approach of Squirrel Cage Induction Motors by Use of Iron Loss Optimization Method for Improving Efficiency”, Electrocomp 2005, Wessex Institute of Technology, WIT Transactions on Modeling and Simulation, Vol. 41, pp 621-629, © 2005 WIT Press, UK, March 2005 Stumberger B., Gorican V., Stumberger G., Hamler A., Trlep M. and Jesenik M. “Accuracy of iron loss calculation in electrical machines by using different iron loss models”, Journal of Magnetism and Magnetic Materials, pp 254-255, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
205
Effect of Zr addition on the fatigue strength of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloy M. Goto1, S.-Z. Han2, C.-J. Kim2 & N. Kawagoishi3 1
Department of Mechanical Engineering, Oita University, Japan Korea Institute of Machinery & Materials, Korea 3 Department of Mechanical Engineering, Kagoshima University, Japan 2
Abstract Fatigue tests of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloy smooth specimens were carried out to clarify the effect of trace Zr on the fatigue strength. The growth behaviour of a major crack, which led to the final fracture of the specimen, was monitored to study the physical basis of fatigue damage. When stress amplitude was less than σa = 350 MPa, the fatigue life of Zr-containing alloys was about two times larger than that of alloys without Zr. When σa > 350 MPa, increments of fatigue life due to Zr decrease with an increase in σa and the increments were negligible at σa = 400 MPa. Increased fatigue life due to Zr addition resulted from an increase in crack initiation life and microcrack growth life. The growth rate of a small crack was determined by a term, σanl, independent of Zr addition. The effects of trace Zr on fatigue strength were discussed with relation to the initiation and propagation behaviour of a major crack. Keywords: fatigue strength, small crack, crack growth rate, plastic replication technique, Cu-Ni-Sn alloy systems.
1
Introduction
The substitutes for Cu-Be alloys with a high production cost have been developed. Cu-Ni-Sn alloy systems have been regarded as potential substitutes for Cu-Be alloys. Among the Cu-Ni-Sn alloy systems, Cu-9Ni-6Sn alloys [1–4] are considered to have the best strength/ductility combination. When hot rolling is applied to produce sheet products, hot cracking problems occur [5] as a result of Sn-rich segregates formed during the solidification in castings. Cu-6Ni-2MnWIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070221
206 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 2Sn-2Al alloys with a lower production cost and improved hot workability [6] have been recently developed as possible substitutes for Cu-9Ni-6Sn alloys. Mn is isomorphous compared to Cu and can partially replace the high-cost Ni which is beneficial to castability and tensile strength. The low Sn content makes it possible to be hot-rolled to produce sheet products. The addition of Al, which is a strong solid solution strengthener in Cu, gives this alloy a proper tensile strength without sacrificing the tensile ductility. The normal cast process for alloy production gives low production cost. Thus, Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloys are applicable for various components in the electrical industry. However, further increase in the strength of alloys is required. It is known that the strength of pure copper is improved by the addition of a small amount of Zr, e.g., the precipitation hardening due to aging tends to saturate with the addition of only 0.15 % Zr. This indicates that the effects of small amounts of Zr addition to Cu6Ni-2Mn- 2Sn-2Al alloys on the strength should be studied. On the other hand, when alloys are used for their actual components, it is important to estimate the fatigue damage of the material. To estimate fatigue damage precisely, the physical basis of fatigue damage must be clarified. However, there are only a few studies on fatigue of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Al alloys [7]. In the present study, fatigue tests of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Al alloys without and with Zr (0.1 and 0.3 %) have been carried out. The physical basis of fatigue damage and the effects of Zr addition on fatigue strength were discussed based on the initiation and growth behaviour of a crack monitored by the plastic replication technique.
Figure 1:
2
Microstructure of the materials; (a) NZ, (b) Z1 and (c) Z3.
Experimental procedures
Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloys without and with Zr (0.1 and 0.3 %) were prepared using a vertical continuous casting of high purity elemental Cu, Ni, Mn, Sn, Al and Zr in air. After casting, solution treatment was conducted at 850 oC for 1 h, followed by swaging with a total swaging amount of 80 %. The diameter of swaged bars was 11 mm. Prior to machining the specimens, materials were aged at 400 oC for 3 h. From here on, alloys without Zr, alloys with 0.1 and 0.3 % Zr are referred to NZ, Z1 and Z3, respectively. Fig.1 shows the microstructure of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
207
the materials. Mechanical properties after aging were 876, 915 and 902 MPa tensile strength, 6.0, 7.0 and 6.3 % elongation, and 275, 288 and 287 Vickers hardness (load: 9.81 N) for NZ, Z1 and Z3, respectively. Fig. 2 shows the shape and dimensions of the specimen. The round bar specimens with 5 mm diameter were machined from the bars. Although the specimens have a shallow circumferential notch (depth: t = 0.25 mm, radius: ρ = 20 mm), the strength reduction factor for this geometry is close to unity, so that the specimens can be considered as plain specimens. Before testing, all specimens were electro-polished to remove about 20 µm from the surface layer, in order to facilitate changes in the surface state. All tests were carried out using a rotating bending fatigue machine with a constant bending moment type of a capacity of 14.7 Nm operating at 50 Hz. Specimens were fatigued at ambient air under constant stress amplitudes. The observation of surface fatigue damage and the measurements of crack length were made via plastic replicas using an optical microscope at a magnification of x 400. The stress value used in the present study is that of the nominal stress amplitude, σa, at the minimal cross section. The crack length, l, is the length along the circumferential direction on the surface.
Figure 2:
Shape of the specimen.
3 Experimental results and discussion 3.1 Mechanical properties and S-N curve Fig. 3 shows the S-N curve. The S-N curve of the Zr-containing alloys shifted toward the long life field, and showed a change in slope at around σa = 350 MPa. Namely, when stress amplitude is less than σa = 350 MPa, fatigue life of Zrcontaining alloys is about 2 times larger than without Zr. When σa > 350 MPa, differences in fatigue life between alloys with and without Zr decrease with an increase in stress amplitude, and no increase in fatigue life at σa = 400 MPa is observed. In addition, the value of fatigue limit stress at 107 cycles, σw, was about 5 % larger in alloys with Zr than in alloys without Zr. With regard to the differences in Zr content between Z1 and Z3, Zr effects on fatigue strength were negligibly small.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
208 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
Figure 4:
S-N curve.
Typical growth paths of a major crack.
3.2 Crack initiation and growth behaviour Fig. 4 illustrates the typical growth paths of a major crack, which led to the final fracture of the specimen. The initiation site of a major crack was studied from the direct observation of surface etched after the detection of a 0.2mm length crack [7]. The results showed that, at σa = 300 and 350 MPa, the crack initiation site of NZ was grain boundaries (GBs), whereas the sites of Z1 and Z3 were the slip bands inside the grains. At σa = 400 MPa, both the GBs and slip bands were the initiation site of major cracks independent of the existence of Zr. With regard to other small cracks initiated after the major crack initiation, the initiation sites of those cracks were both the GBs and slip bands independent of stress amplitude and Zr addition. Crack growth behaviour was monitored successively by the plastic replication technique, showing that, after initiation of a crack from GBs in NZ alloy, although the crack propagated along the initiation direction for a small WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
209
distance, it changed growth direction and propagated with a shear mode along the slip orientation within the adjacent grains. In Zr-containing alloys, a shearmode crack from slip bands propagated along a slip orientation to GBs. A change in propagation direction occurred at GBs, followed by crack growth with shear-mode within the adjacent grains. In all alloys without and with Zr, when adjacent grains did not have suitable slip orientations for shear crack growth, crack growth with tensile mode was observed. Although growth behaviour of a small crack is influenced by the inhomogeneity of its microstructure, the influence of the microstructure on growth behaviour can be negligible for cracks larger than 0.3 mm. The propagation of relatively large cracks (l > 0.3 mm) was principally controlled by tensile mode. Similar growth behaviours have been observed in other cyclic-softening alloys such as age-hardened aluminium alloys [8–10]. As for the differences in Zr content, there were no significant differences in crack initiation and growth behaviour between the Z1 and Z3 alloys. Fig. 5 shows the growth curve, the lnl versus N relation, of a major crack. At σa = 300 and 350 MPa, the relation shifted toward the long life field due to the existence of Zr, but negligible effects of Zr addition on the growth curve were observed at σa = 400 MPa. Namely, at σa = 400 MPa, no significant differences in both the initiation life of a grain size order crack (e.g., l ≑ 30 µm) and the slope of crack growth curves were observed. Conversely, at σa = 300 and 350 MPa, addition of Zr increases the crack initiation life and makes the slope of the growth curves decrease. Strictly speaking, at σa = 350 MPa, crack growth behaviour in the range l < 0.1 mm is strongly retarded due to Zr addition. For l > 0.1 mm, although the slope of the growth curve for Zr-containing alloys tends to be slightly smaller than in alloys without Zr, its effect on growth life is practically negligible. Thus, Zr addition affects the behaviour of a crack propagating with low driving force (in other words, the smaller the crack length and stress amplitude, the larger the retardation of crack growth). Retardation of a 10
σa = 400M P a
Crack length l mm
350M P a
300M P a
1
0.1
0.01 0.0
○,●:N Z △,▲:Z1 □,■:Z3
5.0x105
1.0x106
1.5x106
2.0x106
2.5x106
Number of cycles N
Figure 5: Crack growth curve (the lnl, logarithm of crack length, vs. N relation).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
210 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII crack growth may be related to the strengthening of the matrix due to Zr addition. Since strengthening of the matrix is not relatively large (an increase in Vickers hardness was about 5 %), significant retardation of growth behaviour might occur for a small crack propagating under a low stress amplitude. On the other hand, the effects of difference in Zr content on crack initiation and crack growth behaviour are not clear. Fig. 6 illustrates σa versus Ni and Ni→f. Ni and Ni→f refer to the initiation life of a 0.05 mm crack and to the crack growth life from l = 0.05 mm to the fracture, respectively. When σa ≲ 350 MPa, Ni for Z1 and Z3 is about 2 to 3 times larger than NZ. However, at σa = 400 MPa, a negligibly small increase in Ni due to Zr addition is observed. On the other hand, increments of Ni→f due to Zr addition gradually decrease with an increase in σa, and there is no difference in Ni→f at σa = 400 MPa. It has been shown in the previous report [7] that the significant large enhancement of crack initiation life in Zr-containing alloys was resulted from the strengthened GBs caused by the participation of Zr compounds. In order to determine the compositions of Zr compounds precipitated at GB regions, energy-dispersive X-ray diffractometry (EDX) was used. However, accurate analysis failed because of the too small compound sizes. From the binary phase diagram, Zr never exists, taking the form of single particles in CuNi-Mn-Sn-Al alloys because Zr tends to form compounds in Cu alloys. Table 1
Figure 6:
Effects of Zr on crack initiation life, Ni, and crack growth life, Ni→f.
Table 1:
Enthalpy of formation (∆Hfor) of the binary zirconium compounds. Compound ∆ H for Cu9 Zr2 -34 Ni3 Zr2 -73 Mn5 Zr3 -23 SnZr -86 AlZr -83 ∆Η for : kJ/mole of atoms
Element Cu Ni Mn Sn Al
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
211
shows the formation enthalpy of Zr-related compounds. SnZr and AlZr compounds show large formation enthalpy, while Al tends to solute in Cu matrix. Moreover, Sn tends to segregate at the GB regions when alloys were cast. Thus, we concluded that particles precipitated at GB regions are SnZr compounds. 3.3 Effect of Zr on the growth rate of a small crack
Crack growth rate dl/dN mm/cycle
Fig.7 shows the dl/dN versus l relation of major cracks at σa = 300 MPa. Here, the crack growth rate dl/dN is calculated from the growth curve approximated by a smoothed curve. The range of crack length specified by "SMCG" indicates a crack propagating with shear mode. When the crack length was small (e.g., l < 0.2 mm), a crack tended to propagate with shear mode. For the crack length in excess of 0.2 mm, the propagation mechanism was principally dominant by tensile mode, and dl/dN is nearly proportional to l. Since a shear microcrack is strongly influenced by the inhomogeneity of its microstructure [11–15], the fluctuation of dl/dN is relatively larger than that of large crack propagating with tensile mode. In addition, the growth rate of SMCG is higher than that of a tensile-mode crack with corresponding crack length, evaluated from the relation holds for l > 0.3 mm.
10-5
σa = 300M P a
○:N Z △:Z1 □:Z3
1
10-6
10-7
SM C G
1
S M C G :S hear m ode crack grow th
SM C G
0.1
1
Crack length l mm Figure 7:
dl/dN versus l relation (σa = 300 MPa).
The growth rate of fatigue crack was usually evaluated in terms of a stress intensity factor range ∆K. Here, ∆K is the effective parameter describing the stress field in the vicinity of a crack when the condition of small scale yielding at a crack tip is satisfied. The value of ∆K for an infinite plate with a through thickness crack is given by the equation ∆K = ∆σ (πa)1/2. This equation indicates that the stress range has to be higher for a small crack in order to get the same WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
212 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII growth rate as for a large crack. However, when a sufficiently small crack propagates at finite growth rate (e.g., 10-6 - 10-3 mm/cycle), the condition of small scale yielding is not usually satisfied. Thus, the growth rate of a small surface crack cannot be determined uniquely by ∆K. Nisitani and Goto [16–20] have studied small crack growth behaviour using carbon steels, low alloy steels, aluminium alloys, Ni-base superalloys and indicated that the growth rate of a small crack in which the condition of small scale yielding does not hold can be uniquely determined by a term σanl, but, not by the stress intensity factor range, i.e. (1)
1
dl/dN mm/cycle
(a)
NZ l = 0.3 - 1.5 mm n = 8.0
Crack growth rate
Crack growth rate
dl/dN mm/cycle
In eqn (1), C1 and n are material constants. Furthermore, they have proposed a convenient method for predicting the fatigue life based on the small crack growth law. The validity of the method has been confirmed by its application to the other researchers fatigue data [18]. The expression σanl (n = 3) was first proposed by Frost and Dugdale [21]. They applied it to comparatively large cracks in which the condition of small scale yielding nearly holds.σa3l can be considered as an application for ∆K, whereas σanl in the present study is a parameter for crack propagating under large scale yielding. Fig. 7 suggested that the dl/dN is proportional to l for a crack larger than l = 0.3 mm under the constant stress amplitude. The dependency of dl/dN on stress amplitude was also investigated and it was found that the dl/dN was proportional to σan for a constant crack length. The value of n for the present alloys was 8.0 independent of Zr addition. Putting these results together, we obtained the small crack growth law, eqn (1) with n = 8. Fig. 8 shows the dl/dN vs. σa8l relation. The growth rate of a small crack (l > 0.3 mm) can be uniquely determined by eqn (1). With regard to the effect of Zr, trace Zr makes the growth rate slightly decrease.
10-5
1
10-6 1019
σanl
1020
(MPa)nmm
1021
(b)
▲: Z1 ■: Z3
10-5
NZ
1 -6
10
1019
1
σanl
l = 0.3 - 1.5 mm n = 8.0
1020
(MPa)nmm
1021
Figure 8: Crack growth data (dl/dN vs. σanl relation); (a) relation for NZ alloy, (b) relation for Zr-containing alloys and comparison of the relation between non-Zr and Zr-containing alloys. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
213
Conclusions
In order to study the fatigue behaviour of Cu-6Ni-2Mn-2Sn-2Al alloys without Zr, or with 0.1 and 0.3 % Zr, rotating bending fatigue tests of smooth specimens have been carried out. The plastic replication technique was used for monitoring crack initiation and growth behaviour. Here, alloys with no Zr, or containing 0.1 % Zr and 0.3% Zr were identified by the terms NZ, Z1 and Z3, respectively. The main conclusions can be summarized as follows: (1) When the stress amplitude is less than σa = 350 MPa, fatigue life of Z1 and Z3 is about 2 to 2.5 times larger than that of NZ. When σa > 350 MPa, increments of fatigue life due to Zr addition decrease with an increase in σa and the increments are negligible at σa = 400 MPa. Thus, the S-N curve for Z1 and Z3 alloys shows a change in slope at around σa = 350 MPa. The increase in fatigue life in the range of σa ≲ 350 MPa results from increases in crack initiation life and micro-crack growth life. With regard to differences in Zr content between Z1 and Z3, their effects on fatigue strength are negligibly small. (2) The preferential initiation sites of a major crack, which led to the final fracture of specimens, in the range of σa ≲ 350 MPa are grain boundaries (GBs) and slip bands for alloys with and without Zr, respectively. At σa = 400 MPa, both GBs and slip bands are initiation sites of the major cracks independent of the existence of Zr. (3) Zr addition generated strengthened GBs resulting from precipitation of SnZr compounds. Strengthened GBs contributed to the increase in crack initiation life. (4) The increase in microcrack growth life is related to the strengthening of matrix due to Zr addition. However, since the strengthening of the matrix is not large (e.g., the increase in HV is about 5 %), significant retardation of growth behaviour can occur for a small crack propagating under a low stress amplitude less than σa = 350 MPa. (5) Growth rate of a small crack can be determined by a term σanl. n is a material constant. The value of n was about 8 independent of Zr addition.
Acknowledgement This research was partially supported by a grant (code #: 06K1501-00230) from 'Center for Nanostructured Materials Technology' under '21st Century Frontier R&D Programs' of the Ministry of Science and Technology, Korea.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Plewes, J.T., Metal Trans., 6A, pp. 537-544, 1975. Lefevre, B.G., Dannessa, A.T., Kalish, D., Metall. Trans., 9A, pp. 577586, 1978. Ray, R.K. & Narayanan, S.C., Metall. Trans., 13A, pp. 565-570, 1982. Sato, A., Katsuta, S. & Kato, M., Acta Metall Trans., 13A, pp. 633-640, 1988. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
214 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19] [20] [21]
Han, S.Z., Kim, H.I, Lee, J.M. & Kim, C.J., J. Kor. Inst. Machinery Mater., 37, pp. 882-886, 1999. Rhu, C.J., Kim, S.S., Han, S.Z, Jung, Y.C. & Kim, C.J, Scripta Mater., 42 pp. 83-89, 2000. Goto, M., Han, S.Z., Kim, C.J. & Kawagoishi, N., Mater. Letters, to be published, 2007. Goto, M., Nisitani, H., Kawagoishi, N., Miyagawa, H. & Chujoh, N., Trans. Jpn Soc. Mech. Eng. (in Japanese), A-59, pp. 205-211, 1993. Goto, M., Kawagoishi, N., J. Soc. Mater. Sci. Jpn (in Japanese), 45, pp. 675-680, 1996. Goto, M. & DuQuesnay, D.L., SAE Technical Paper Series, No.970703, Soc. Automotive Engng-USA, pp. 1-7, 1997. Suh, C.M., Yuuki, R. & Kitagawa, H., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 8, pp.193-203, 1985. Ochi, Y., Ishii, A. & Sasaki, S.K., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 8, pp. 327-339, 1985. Goto, M., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 14, pp. 833-845, 1991. Goto, M., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 16, pp. 795-809, 1993. Goto, M., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 17, pp. 635-649, 1994. Nisitani, H. & Goto, M., The Behaviour of Short Cracks, EGF 1, eds. K.J. Miller & E.R. de los Rios, Mech. Eng. Publications, London. pp.461-478, 1987. Goto, M. & Nisitani, H., Trans. Jpn. Soc. Mech. Eng. (in Japanese), A-56, pp.1938-1944, 1990. Nisitani, H., Goto, M. & Kawagoishi, N., Eng. Fract. Mech., 41, pp. 499513, 1992. Goto, M., Fatigue Fract. Engng Mater. Struct., 17, pp. 171-185, 1994. Goto, M. & Knowles, D.M., Eng. Fract. Mech., 60, pp. 1-18, 1998. Frost, N.E. & Dugdale, D.S., J. Mech. Phys. Solids, 6, pp. 92-110, 1958.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
215
An analysis of superplastic free forming at constant pressure G. Giuliano & S. Franchitti Department of Industrial Engineering, Cassino University, Italy
Abstract Superplastic materials are characterised by very low strength during forming and by large plastic deformations. Superplasticity is observed in some metal alloys when deformed under particular conditions, namely: • very fine grain size (10µm); • high temperature (greater than about one-half the absolute melting point); • a controlled strain rate (10-4–10-2 s-1). In recent years, there has been a considerable interest in the aircraft and automotive industries using superplastic forming to obtain complex parts. In these industrial sectors superplastic forming (SPF) of sheet metal has been used to produce, with a low number of mechanical steps, several sheet metal components that are lighter and stronger than conventional components. The increasing spread of superplastic forming processes has focussed the attention of technologists onto problems of optimising process parameters. The design of these processes is more difficult than conventional manufacturing operations. In fact, to successfully produce an SPF component it is essential to control a variety of different parameters during the forming process: temperature, material grain size, strain-rate distribution due to the pressure forming and the final distribution of thicknesses. In this study the superplastic behaviour of PbSn60, an alloy that is superplastic at room temperature, is evaluated during constant pressure free bulging. A set of experimental tests were carried out in order to determine the characteristic parameters of the PbSn60. Keywords: superplastic forming, constitutive equation, finite element method.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070231
216 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
An ever-increasing number of fields in mechanical industry need to be able to produce light parts of complex shape and elevated mechanical strength. In particular, the automotive and aeronautical industries require innovatory technologies in the field of sheet metal forming processes: being able to have materials and technological processes capable of obtaining elevated plastic strain, is very attractive to designers. A decisive innovation in the field of sheet metal forming processes, was the discovery of some metallic alloys that in given microstructural conditions of temperature and strain rate, exhibit a behaviour called superplasticity. This is characterised by an extraordinary ductility, as can be seen from percentage elongations that are one or two orders of magnitudes greater than those observed for conventional metals and alloys [1,2]. The superplastic materials of industrial interest are aluminium, titanium and magnesium-based alloys. The need to master process parameters (particularly the pressure-time load curve) during superplastic forming requires more and more sophisticated simulation techniques. Nowadays, the finite element method represents the most common tool for planning sheet metal forming processes [3–13]. The starting point for a reliable simulation of the process is to know the characteristics of the material. Being able to accurately model the deformation conditions is critical in superplasticity; in fact the constitutive equation, used to define the relationship in a superplastic material between the flow stress σ, the strain ε and the strain rate, ε , considers the effect of multiple factors, namely temperature, grain size, fraction of cavities, strain hardening/softening and strain-rate. Various researchers have proposed equations to describe the behaviour of superplastic materials using models based on three different levels: macrocospic, mesoscopic and atomic levels [14]. On the basis of the phenomenological aspects of superplastic behaviour it is possible to note a strong correlation between the flow stress and the strain rate and a weak one with the strain and the grain size: The equation can be written as: σ = Kε m ε n d p (1) Often the dependence of the flow stress on the grain size is neglected, and hence the constitutive equation is simplified: (2) σ = Kε m ε n The method usually used to characterise superplastic material is the tensile test in which the specimen is subjected to monoaxial stress. It has been noted, however, that the free forming tests enable the characteristic parameters to be determined more reliably since the material is subject to stress conditions (biaxial stress) closer to those of the real forming process [15]. This study analyses the free forming process, at constant pressure, of PbSn60 an alloy that is superplastic at room temperature. It aims to verify whether eqn WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
217
(2) is easy to implement in a computational model and whether it represents the behaviour of superplastic material to a good degree of accuracy.
2
Experimental work
The constant pressure free forming experiments were performed using the equipment designed by the authors and shown in Figure 1 [16]. TRANSDUCER OF PRESSURE
PROPORTIONAL VALVE
COMPARATOR VIDEOCAMERA
FORMING DIE
Figure 1:
AIR COMPRESSOR
VOLTAGE GENERATOR
The equipment used to carry out the experimental tests.
It comprises a compressor that sends pressurised air to a proportional valve whose function is to regulate the pressure within the circuit; a pressure transducer; and an open die that includes the upper and lower parts, both of which made of steel. The upper plate measures 180x100x100 mm and it has a 60mm diameter central hole of through which the sheet is formed and four holes for linking it up to the lower plate. The latter is of similar dimensions to the former and has a central hole too to allow the compressed air to be fed through (figure 2). The material used for SPF was 0.3mm thick Pb/Sn alloy composed of (in wt. %) 60%Pb and 40%Sn (non eutectic composition). This material displays superplastic characteristics at room temperature and it therefore does not require the use of a furnace and expensive apparatus. The superplastic PbSn60 alloy has mechanical properties that are too poor to be used to produce real industrial components, but it proves to be advantageous for laboratory activity. This material is commercially available in the form of PbSn60 welding bars; in order to drastically reduce grain size, and therefore to respect one of the conditions necessary for exhibiting superplastic behaviour, it is subjected to bending and rolling cycles [16]. Two series of tests were carried out: the first at a forming pressure of 0.10MPa and the second at a pressure of 0.18MPa. For each single pressure value 5 tests were carried out for a total of 10 tests, and the time step taken for the sheet to pass through the normalized height H=0 to H=1 was measured for each single test. The normalized height is defined as H=h/a, where h is the polar dome height and a is the die radius.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
218 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
Shape of the die.
Since it was not possible by means of an analogic comparator to memorize the heights reached by the sheet, the trend of height versus time was obtained using a video camera. The videos of the forming test were uploaded to a PC by means of an image acquisition system, thereby enabling the data to be read. Figure 3 shows the results obtained. The bars showing the mean standard deviation are highlighted. The results obtained were analysed using the Grubbs test to check for the presence or not of anomalous values. The tests predict that for each value of H, a shift in the time measured compared to the mean value is determined. The measured shift in relation to the standard deviation of the population under examination is compared to a critical value linked to the distribution of the measured data. The constant of the material m was determined as shown by various authors [17], by means of the expression: ln(p 2 / p1 ) (3) m= ln(t1 / t 2 ) where, in this paper, t1 and t2 are the forming time values necessary to produce the same dome geometry (that is the same value of H) at constant pressures p1 and p2, respectively. Table 1 summarizes the m values measured during the forming process. Figure 4 shows how this parameter is dependent on the deformation obtained (H). In particular it proves to decrease slightly during deformation. A means value of m between H=0.2 and H=1 will be considered for the numerical analysis. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
400
219
p=0.10MPa
350 300
t[s]
250 200 150 100 50 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.2
0.8
1
1.2
H
p=0.18MPa
120 100
t[s]
80 60 40 20 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6 H
Figure 3:
3
Experimental results.
Numerical analysis
Using commercial finite element software, a constant pressure free bulging process of the superplastic PbSn60 alloy was simulated. The element type used in the analysis is a four-node, isoparametric, arbitrary quadrilateral written for axisymmetric applications [18]. Due to the symmetry of the geometry, load and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
220 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII constraint conditions, only half of the cross-section of the sheet metal was analysed. Moreover, it was necessary to impose constraint conditions on the periphery of the sheet, in order to simulate the action of a blank holder. The die has a circular geometry with an aperture diameter of 60.0 mm and a die entry radius of 2.0 mm. Rigid-plastic flow formulation was applied to the superplastic forming analysis [19]. Table 1:
Experimental values of the strain-rate sensitivity index. H
m
0.200 0.267 0.333 0.400 0.467 0.500 0.533 0.600 0.667 0.733 0.800 0.867 0.933 1.000
0.467 0.482 0.481 0.478 0.476 0.473 0.470 0.468 0.465 0.462 0.458 0.454 0.449 0.467
1 0.8
m
0.6 0.4 0.2 0 0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
H
Figure 4:
Experimental trend of m value.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
1.0
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
400
221
p=0.10MPa
350 300
t[s]
250 200 150 100 50 0 0.0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
0.80
1.00
1.20
H
p=0.18MPa
120 100
t[s]
80 60 40 20 0 0.00
0.20
0.40
0.60 H
Figure 5:
Comparison between the numerical and experimental results.
The constants of the material, introduced in the code, for the process simulation, were determined starting from an original characterisation methodology proposed by authors in [17]. The material constants were determined as: m=0.468 n=-0.029 K=146.515 MPa*s WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
222 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII From the results of the numerical analysis it is possible to plot the trend of time versus the normalized polar height H. It can be seen that this curve lies between the bars of the standard deviation of the mean experimentally obtained results (figure 5).
4
Conclusions
This study analysed the behaviour of the superplastic Pb-Sn60 alloy as it underwent a superplastic free forming process at a constant pressure. A comparison between the experimental results and the ones from a numerical analysis of the forming process justifies the approximation introduced to determine the constant m. In fact to consider a simplified constitutive equation (eq.2), the numerical analysis uses a mean value of m in relation to the deformation (H).
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
[7]
[8]
[9]
Hamilton C.H. and Ghosh A.K., Superplastic sheet forming, Metals Handbook, 1988. Pilling J. and Ridley N., Superplasticity in Crystalline Solids, The Institute of Metals, London, 1989. Sadeghi R. and Pursell Z., Finite element modeling of superplastic forming with precise dies, Superplasticity and Superplastic Forming, The Minerals, Metals & Materials Society, Warrendale, 1995. Chandra N., 1988, Analysis of superplastic metal forming by a finite element method, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, vol. 26, pp. 1925–1944. Chandra N. and Rama S.C., 1992, Application of finite element method to the design of superplastic forming processes, Journal of Engineering for Industry, vol. 114, pp. 452–458. Bonet J., Bhargava P. and Wood R.D., 1997, Finite element analysis of the superplastic forming of thick sheet using the incremental flow formulation, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, vol. 40, n°17, pp. 3205–3228. Bellet M., Massoni E. and Chenot J.L., 1987, A viscoplastic membrane formulation for the 3-D analysis of superplastic forming of thin sheet, Proceedings of the International Conference on Computational Plasticity, pp. 917–926. Huh H., Han S.S., Lee J.S. and Hong S.S., 1995, Experimental verification of superplastic sheet-metal forming analysis by the finiteelement method, Journal of Materials Processing Technology, vol. 49, pp. 355–369. Kim Yong H., Hong S.S., Lee J.S. and Wagoner R.H., 1996, Analysis of superplastic forming processes using a finite-element method, Journal of Materials Processing Technology vol. 62, pp. 90–99.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[10] [11] [12]
[13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19]
223
Xing H.L. and Wang Z.R., 1997, Finite-element analysis and design of thin sheet superplastic forming, Journal of Materials Processing Technology, vol. 68, pp. 1–7. Doltsinis J. St., Loginsland J. and Nolting S., 1987, Some developments in the numerical simulation of metal forming processes, Proceedings of the International Conference on Computational Plasticity, Barcelona. Carrino L., Giuliano G. and Napolitano G., 2003, A posteriori optimisation of the forming pressure in superplastic forming processes by the finite element method, Finite Elements in Analysis and Design, vol. 39, n° 11, pp. 1083–1093. Carrino L., Giuliano G. and Palmieri C., 2003, On the optimization of superplastic forming processes by the finite element method, Journal of Materials Processing Technology, vol. 143–144, pp. 373–377. Chandra N., 2002, Constitutive behavior of superplastic materials, International Journal of Non-Linear Mechanics, vol. 37, pp. 461–484. Carrino L., Giuliano G. and Polini W., 2003, A method to characterise superplastic materials in comparison with alternative methods, Journal of Materials Processing Technology, vol. 138, pp. 417–422. Carrino L. and Giuliano G., 1999, Finite element modelling and the experimental verification of superplastic forming, Advanced Performance Materials, vol. 6, n° 2, pp. 159–169. Giuliano G. and Franchitti S., 2006, On the Evaluation of Superplastic Characteristics using the Finite Element Method, International Journal of Machine Tools and Manufacture, vol. 47, pp. 471–476. MSC. Marc 2005 Vol. B, Element library. Zienkiewicz O.C., Flow formulation for numerical solution of forming processes, Numerical Analysis of Forming Processes, Wiley, New York, 1984.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
225
A mathematical model approach to a glycerolysis reaction for monoacylglycerol production B. Cheirsilp & A. H-Kittikul Department of Industrial Biotechnology, Faculty of Agro-Industry, Prince of Songkla University, Hat Yai, Thailand
Abstract Monoacylglycerol emulsifiers commonly employed in the food, cosmetic and pharmaceutical industries can be produced by a glycerolysis reaction using lipase. The concentrations of two substrates (palm olein and glycerol) in the glycerolysis reaction were strictly interdependent. Therefore, it was impossible to perform a classic kinetic study by fixing the concentration of one substrate and changing the concentration of the other substrate. Here, a mathematical model approach is a useful tool to independently assess the effects of hypothetical changes in the concentrations of each. In essence, this analysis permits one to examine various aspects associated with the dynamics and equilibrium of the glycerolysis reaction that cannot be investigated experimentally. In this study a mathematical model, taking into account the mechanism of the glycerolysis reaction for monoacylglycerol production using immobilized lipase, has been developed. From the proposed model, the effects of varying the initial concentrations of substrates on the initial production rate and yield of monoacylglycerol were simulated. The most significant finding from simulation was that an increase in the initial concentration of triacylglycerol leads to an increase in the initial production rate of monoacylglycerol, but there is a limit beyond which increasing the initial concentration of triacylglycerol results in a low yield of monoacylglycerol. The simulation results show that mostly glycerol reacts with fatty acid of triacylglycerol to produce monoacylglycerol in a glycerolysis reaction. From a thermodynamic standpoint, a greater incorporation of glycerol is expected because a higher concentration of this acyl acceptor should shift the equilibrium towards a greater glycerolysis reaction. Keywords: glycerolysis, lipase, mathematical model, monoacylglycerol. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070241
226 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The applications of glycerolysis reaction using lipase have been carried out to produce monoacylglycerol due to its mild reaction conditions and position specific products [1–3]. The concentrations of two substrates, triacylglycerol and glycerol, in glycerolysis reaction were strictly interdependent. To identify the optimal conditions for lipase catalyzed glycerolysis reaction, it is essential to understand the kinetics of this reaction. Until now all kinetic mechanisms on lipase catalytic reactions are only based on hydrolysis of triacylglycerol [4,5] or esterification of fatty acid [6,7]. Only a limited number of kinetic studies for glycerolysis using glycerol as acyl acceptor have been found in literature [1]. However, the reported model is rather complicated and narrow range of application. Here, in this paper the kinetics of glycerolysis of palm olein for monoacylglycerol production was studied. First, a simple model based on PingPong Bi Bi was proposed to describe the kinetics of hydrolysis and esterification steps involved in glycerolysis reaction. Then, the mathematical model for glycerolysis reaction was considered. The effects of enzyme, water, glycerol and palm olein concentrations on monoacylglycerol production were contributed in the model. The constructed model was used to obtain a better understanding of the effects of two substrates, triacylglycerol and glycerol in glycerolysis reaction. Finally, optimal condition was determined by simulation study using the model.
2
Materials and methods
2.1 Materials Lipase PS (Pseudomonas sp.) was a gift from Amano Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd., Japan. Microporous polypropylene powder; Accurel EP-100 (particle size 200400 µm) was a gift from Akzo Nobel (Obermburg, Germany). Palm olein was purchased from Morakot Industry Co. Ltd., Thailand. All other chemicals were analytical grade reagents obtained from commercial sources. 2.2 Immobilization To immobilize lipase, Accurel EP-100 (10g) was added to 100 ml of 0.1 M phosphate buffer (pH 7) containing lipase PS approximately 100 U/ml and the reaction mixture was stirred with a magnetic bar at 100 rpm for 30 min. Afterward, 100 ml of 0.1 M phosphate buffer (pH 7) was added and the suspension was filtered through a filter paper by vacuum. The immobilized lipase PS on Accurel EP-100 (330 U/g) was stored at 4 °C for further studies. 2.3 Glycerolysis reaction The glycerolysis experiments were carried out in batch system. The reaction mixture consisted of various enzyme, water, glycerol and palm olein concentrations in organic solvent (acetone/isooctane mixture 3:1, v/v). The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
227
temperature was controlled at 45 °C. The reaction mixture was mixed by magnetic stirrer at 300 rpm. Samples of the reaction mixture were centrifuged to remove immobilized lipase before analysis. 2.4 Analytical method The components of oil phase were analyzed for triacylglycerol (TAG), diacylglycerol (DAG), monoacylglycerol (MAG) and fatty acid (FA) using a thin-layer chromatography with flame ionization detection (TLC/FID) (IATROSCAN MK5, Iatron Laboratories Inc. Tokyo, Japan). In this experiment, percent of peak area was assumed as percent content of the corresponding compound. Activity of lipase was determined by the modified cupric acetate method. One unit of hydrolytic activity was defined as the amount of the enzyme, which liberates 1 µmol equivalent of palmitic acid from palm olein in 1 min at 30 °C. Ordinary differential equations were solved by the Runge-Kutta single-step fourth-order method [8]. The programs were coded in the Visual Basic program ver. 6.0 (Microsoft Inc., USA). (a) W
DAG
G
ExTAGxW
ExDAGxFA
ExFAxG
W
MAG
G
ExDAGxW
ExMAGxFA
Ex FAxG
TAG E (b) DAG E
Figure 1:
3
W MAG E W MAG E
Schematic diagram of Ping Pong Bi Bi mechanisms for glycerolysis reaction of triacylglycerol (a) and diacylglycerol (b). TAG, DAG, MAG, W, G and E denote triacylglycerol, diacylglycerol, monoacylglycerol, water, glycerol and enzyme, respectively. ExTAGxW, ExDAGxW, Ex DAGxFA, ExMAGxFA and ExFAxG are different complexes between enzyme and the species defined above.
Results and discussion
3.1 Modeling of glycerolysis reaction Mechanisms of glycerolysis reaction for monoacylglycerol production were interesterifications of tri- or di-acylglycerol with excess glycerol. The interesterification reaction involves sequential execution of the hydrolysis and reesterification steps, and thus requires multiple entrances and exits of reactant and product species in such a manner as to render the overall mechanism of the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
228 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Ping-Pong type as in Fig. 1. Theoretically glycerolysis of one mole of triacylglycerol and two moles of glycerol could produce 3 moles of monoacylglycerol, however the yields of monoacylglycerol depend on flavored equilibrium in various conditions [9]. In kinetic study of immobilized enzyme, the reaction rate might be controlled by an internal mass transfer. However, it was also reported that mass transfer limitation in porous supports could be neglected [10,11]. Therefore, to describe a simple mathematical model for glycerolysis reaction, mass transfer limitation in reaction system was first neglected. The appearance rates of triacylglycerol (TAG), diacylglycerol (DAG), monoacylglycerol (MAG), glycerol (G), fatty acid (FA) and water (W) from hydrolysis and reesterification steps were derived as in Table 1. Table 1:
A mathematical model of glycerolysis reaction.
Differential equations d [TAG ] dt
=
( −VmDAG [TAG ][W ] + VrDAG [ DAG ][ FA]) ET ([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA]
d [ DAG] (VmDAG [TAG][W ] + VrMAG [MAG][FA] − VmMAG [DAG][W ] −VrDAG [DAG][FA]) ET = dt ([W ] + KmDAG [DAG] + KmMAG [MAG] + KmG [G])[FA] d [ MAG ] (VmMAG [ DAG ][W ] + VrG [G ][ FA] − VmG [ MAG ][W ] − VrMAG [ MAG ][ FA]) ET = dt ([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA] d [G ] VmG [MAG][W ] − VrG [G][ FA]) ET ( = dt ([W ] + KmDAG [ DAG] + KmMAG [MAG] + KmG [G])[ FA] d [ FA] (VmDAG [TAG ][W ] + VmMAG [ DAG ][W ] + VmG [ MAG ][W ]) ET = ([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA] dt (V [ DAG ][ FA] + VrMAG [ MAG ][ FA] + VrG [G ][ FA]) ET − rDAG ([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA]
d [W ] (VrDAG [ DAG ][ FA] + VrMAG [ MAG ][ FA] + VrG [G ][ FA]) ET = dt ([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA] −
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
(6)
(VmDAG [TAG ][W ] + VmMAG [ DAG ][W ] + VmG [ MAG ][W ]) ET
([W ] + K mDAG [ DAG ] + K mMAG [ MAG ] + K mG [G ])[ FA] FA: fatty acid concentration, W: water concentration, ET: total enzyme concentration. VmDAG and VrDAG are maximum initial reaction rates for hydrolysis of TAG and reesterification of DAG defined as: k1k3 and k 4 k6 , respectively. KmDAG, KmMAG and KmG are equilibrium constants
VmDAG =
k 2 + k3
VrDAG =
k 4 + k5
k5 , k , respectively. VmMAG and k and K mG = 17 K mMAG = 11 k6 k12 k18 VrMAG are maximum initial reaction rates for hydrolysis of DAG (production of MAG) and k k , respectively. VmG and VrG reesterification of MAG defined as: k k and VrMAG = 10 12 VmMAG = 7 9 k10 + k11 k8 + k 9 are maximum initial reaction rates for hydrolysis of MAG (production of G) and reesterification of G k k , respectively. k k defined as: and VrG = 16 18 VmG = 13 15 k16 + k17 k14 + k15 for DAG, MAG and G defined as:
K mDAG =
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
229
The concentrations of triacylglycerol, diacylglycerol, monoacylglycerol and fatty acid at different times were obtained experimentally when the substrate concentration of triacylglycerol and glycerol were 7.16 and 19.14 mM, respectively. The concentrations of enzyme and water were 0.6 g and 9.89 mM, respectively. The nonlinear curve fitting by Simplex’s method [12] was used for fitting the system of differential equations (1-6) (Table 1) into the experimental data. By fitting the above differential equations to the experimental data, the rate constants were estimated and listed in Table 2. Base upon the obtained rate constants and the kinetic scheme, the concentrations of each composition at different reactions could be calculated. Comparison between calculated and experimental data was presented in Fig. 2 and a good agreement was obtained. In terms of the reaction rate constants in Table 2, the forward reaction rate constants in the first and second reactions (VmDAG = 0.115 mM-1g-1h-1, VmMAG = 0.151 mM-1g-1h-1) were much lower than that in the third forward reactions (VmG = 0.811 mM-1g-1h-1). The results indicated that the first and second hydrolysis reactions (TAG to DAG and DAG to MAG) were the limiting steps during the overall reactions. The production rate of MAG by glycerolysis reaction (VrG = 1.23 mM-1g-1h-1) was higher than the production rate by hydrolysis reaction of DAG (VmMAG = 0.151 mM-1g-1h-1). These rate constants show that the intermediates (G and FA) were easily converted to MAG by glycerolysis reaction. The experimental results also showed that the concentration of the measurable intermediate (FA) was low during time course of glycerolysis (Fig. 2). Table 2: Maximum initial reaction rates (mM-1g-1h-1) VmDAG VmMAG VmG VrDAG VrMAG VrG
Rate constants in the model of glycerolysis reaction. Value
Equilibrium constants (mM-2)
0.115 0.151 0.811 0.109 0.320 1.23
KmDAG KmMAG KmG
Value 1.09 × 10-4 3.20 × 10-4 1.23 × 10-3
3.2 Effect of triacylglycerol and glycerol The effects of varying the initial concentrations of triacylglycerol and glycerol on the initial production rate and yield of monoacylglycerol were also simulated. Simulation of glycerolysis system under a variety of initial conditions provides a more complete picture of the dynamics and equilibrium behavior of this system (Fig. 3). Two of the most significant findings were (1) an increase in the initial
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
230 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Concentration (mM)
12 10 8 6 4 2 0 0
5
10
15
20
25
Time (h) TAG MAG
Figure 2:
DAG FA
Comparison between calculated (lines) and experimental results (symbols) of glycerolysis reaction. Triacylglycerol 7.16 mM; glycerol 19.14 mM; water 9.89 mM; immobilized lipase 0.6 g.
1
0.40 0.35 0.30 0.25 0.20 0.15 0.10 0.05 0.00 11
Figure 3:
0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 Yield
rMAG
0.50 0.45
14 19 Glyc erol
21
25 1
2
5
7
10
G TA
12
0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 11
14 19 Gl yc erol
21
25 1
2
5
7
10
12
G TA
Simulation results of effects of triacylglycerol (TAG) and glycerol concentrations on the initial production rate (rMAG) and yield of monoacylglycerol.
concentration of triacylglycerol leads to an increase in the initial production rate of monoacylglycerol, but there is a limit beyond which increasing the initial concentration of triacylglycerol results low yield of monoacylglycerol at each glycerol concentration and (2) increasing in glycerol concentration more than WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
231
19.14 mM the effect becomes less pronounced in initial production rate and yield of monoacylglycerol at equilibrium. The former result is expected from a thermodynamic standpoint, because a higher concentration of triacylglycerol should enhance the greater production rate of monoacylglycerol. The latter result might be due to the limitation of equilibrium comes from limited enzyme concentration. Therefore, it was concluded that glycerol concentration of 19.14 mM was the optimal concentration for glycerolysis reaction with enzyme concentration of 0.6 g. From all of the above, in the case of high reaction rate and acceptable yield of monoacylglycerol are set as target in process optimization, the glycerolysis reaction with high concentrations of triacylglycerol and glycerol are suitable to be carried out. On the other hand, in the case of high yield of monoacylglycerol is set as target in process optimization, low concentration of triacylglycerol and excess concentration of glycerol are suitable.
4
Conclusion
The kinetics of lipase-catalyzed glycerolysis reaction between triacylglycerol and glycerol were successfully modeled using rate expressions requiring adjustable parameters. The present model was effective for prediction the synergic effect of two substrates (triacylglycerol and glycerol) in glycerolysis reaction. The simulation results showed that mostly glycerol reacted with fatty acid of triacylglycerol to produce monoacylglycerol in glycerolysis reaction. From a thermodynamic standpoint, a greater incorporation of glycerol is expected because a higher concentration of this acyl acceptor should shift the equilibrium toward greater glycerolysis reaction. Another important observation was that the behavior of high triacylglycerol concentrations showed high initial production rates but low yields of monoacylglycerol.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
Tan, T. & Yin, C., The mechanism and kinetic model for glycerolysis by 1,3 position specific lipase from Rhizopus arrhizus. Biochemical Engineering Journal, 25, pp. 39-45, 2005. McNeill, G.P., Shimizu, S. & Yamane, T., High-yield enzymatic glycerolysis of fats and oils. Journal American Oil Chemical Society, 68(1), pp. 1-5, 1991. McNeill, G.P. & Yamane, T., Further improvements in the yield of monoglycerides during enzymatic glycerolysis of fats and oils. Journal American Oil Chemical Society, 68(1), pp. 6-10, 1991. Taylor, F., Kurantz, M.J. & Craig, J.C., Kinetics of continuous hydrolysis of tallow in a multi-layered flat-plate immobilized-lipase reactor. Journal American Oil Chemical Society, 69(6), pp. 591-594, 1992. Padmini, P., Rakshit, S.K. & Baradarajan, A., Kinetics of enzymatic hydrolysis of rice bran oil in organic system. Enzyme and Microbial Technology, 16, pp. 432-435, 1994. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
232 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [6]
[7]
[8] [9] [10] [11] [12]
Zhang, T., Yang, L., Zhu, Z. & Wu, J., The kinetic study on lipasecatalyzed transesterification of α-cyano-3-phenoxybenzyl alcohol in organic media. Journal of Molecular Catalysis B: Enzymatic, 18, pp. 315323, 2002. Xu, Y., Du, X. & Liu, D., Study on the kinetics of enzymatic interesterification of triglycerides for biodiesel production with methyl acetate as the acyl acceptor. Journal of Molecular Catalysis B: Enzymatic, 32, pp. 241-245, 2005. Danby, J.M.A., Computer modeling, Willmann-Bell Inc Richmond Va 1997. Reyes H.R., Kinetic modeling of interesterification reactions catalyzed by immobilized lipase. Biotechnology and Bioengineering, 43, pp. 171-182, 1994. Chen, J.P. & Wang, H.Y., Improved properties of bilirubin oxidase by entrapment in alginate-silicate sol-gel matrix. Biotechnology Techniques, 12(11), pp. 851-853, 1998. Romero, M.D., Calvo, L., Alba, C. & Daneshfar, A., A kinetic study of isoamyl acetate synthesis by immobilized lipase-catalyzed acetylation in n-hexane. Journal of Biotechnology, 127, pp. 269–277, 2007. Nelder, J.A. & Mead, R., A simplex method for function minimization. Computational Journal, 7, pp. 308-313, 1964.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
233
Evaluation of experimental procedures for confined concrete columns using 3D finite element analyses H. O. Köksal1, C. Karakoç2, Z. Polat1, T. Turgay1 & Ş. Akgün1 1 2
Civil Engineering Faculty, Yıldız Technical University, Turkey Civil Engineering Department, Boğaziçi University, Turkey
Abstract This paper presents the results of the early stages of both a continuing experimental work on the square confined concrete columns and their 3D finite element modeling based on the isotropic damage theory in order to establish a realistic approach for the confinement pressure. Based on the axial behavior of four RC columns with a 200 mm square cross section tested under concentric loading, existing experimental data and procedures in the literature are evaluated. As demonstrated from the comparison of the FE analysis and the test results, obtaining a uniform axial loading and deformation state is questionable. Keywords: confinement pressure, reinforced concrete column, finite element, isotropic damage theory, geometrical defects.
1
Introduction
The compressive strength of RC columns increase with increasing confining pressure. The confinement mechanisms are transverse reinforcements such as stirrups or spirals, FRP wraps, and steel jackets, etc. extensive research on the axial behavior of confined concrete has been carried out since the pioneering study of Richardt et al. [1]. The constitutive model for confined concrete based on the experimental findings plays an important role in the pushover analysis of RC structures. There are some frequently cited models (Hognestad [2], Kent and Park [3], Sheikh and Uzumeri [4], Mander et al. [5], Saatcioglu and Razvi [6]) to predict the peak stress or the stress–strain curve of confined concrete. Only the latest two WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070251
234 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII recommends a relation for finding the confining pressure. Mainly two experimental works conducted by Sheikh and Uzumeri [7], Mander et al. [8], are employed mainly for derivation of these relations. Techniques for measuring longitudinal deformations and the effects of possible small defects on the cross-section of the columns during the production of the specimens to the experimental results are evaluated.
2
Experimental work
The square specimens in the test program have 200x200 mm cross-section dimensions and 1000 mm height. The columns tested in the structural laboratory of Yıldız Technical University, are a first part of a Ph.D. study about confined RC columns. Fig. 1 shows the details of test setup and instrumentation.
Figure 1:
Test setup and the details of test specimens.
There is only one type of concrete mix for all test columns. C1, C2, and C3 type columns are tested respectively at 30 days, 60 days and 90 days. All longitudinal bars are 10mm in diameter and L4 and L8 shows the number of the bars in the cross-section of a column. The tie spacing is 100mm and the S8 and S12 represent tie diameters. In this paper, the results of the C1 type-columns are presented. For measurement of axial strains, four linear variable displacement transducers (LVDTs) are placed over the central 400mm gage length at each side of a column in a similar way used to assess any eccentricity of the applied load WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
235
as recommended in the study of Shrive et al. [9]. A pre-loading up to the onefourth of the predicted axial capacity is applied to maintain similar displacement readings at LVDTs so that in the linear elastic stage of the overall behavior any eccentricity can be eliminated. Similar procedures have been used for measuring the axial shortening in the literature. In the experimental study of Sheikh and Uzumeri [7], the load versus deformation behavior of the test region of the columns was recorded using two linear variable displacement transducers (LVDT), one on the west, and the other on the east side of the column. Strain curves were averaged along the strain axis to obtain the mean load versus average strain characteristics of the test region. Mander et al. [8] took several readings of longitudinal strains over the central 450mm gage length of each column using four linear potentiometers. The average of the four potentiometers around the circumference was used prior to reaching maximum load. After this load level, some critical potentiometers were defined by establishing that the failure region occurred wholly within the gage length of the potentiometers instead of averaging the readings of four potentiometers. 1000 C1L8S8
Axial load (kN)
800 600 400
LVDT LVDT LVDT LVDT
200
#2 #3 #4 #7
0 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
Axial shortening (mm)
Figure 2:
Four separate LVDT readings of axial load-shortening curves for the column specimen C1L8S8.
Although the LVDT readings were provided very close to each other, next to the maximum axial load there can be a significant variation between the minimum and maximum values of shortening reaching very high values.
3
3D Finite element modeling of RC columns
The concrete elements are modeled using eight-noded isoparametric solid continuum elements. Vertical and lateral reinforcements are meshed using twonoded 3D bar elements. Taking the advantage of symmetry and uniform loading WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
236 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII of system, 3D model of the concentrically loaded RC columns is created using one-fourth of the cross-sectional symmetry. The bottom surface is fully restrained while the lateral translations are only restricted in the top surface [10]. The Oliver’s damage model [11] primarily developed for concrete elements and now available within the LUSAS software package [12], are employed for the material modeling of concrete. There are initially three parameters, which have to be defined before the analysis: 1) The initial threshold, τ*, can be given as f τ* = t (1) E0 CEB-FIB [13] Equation is adopted for the initial elasticity modulus of elasticity, E0: 1/ 3
f E = α ∗ 21500 ∗ c (2) 10 in which fc is the cylindrical compressive strength of concrete at 28 days. ft is taken as
f t = 0.35
fc
(3)
2) A material parameter, A, is a limiting factor of the maximum size of the element that used for a mesh size choice and is given by [11] G f E0 1 − ≥0 (4) A= hf2 2 t in which h is the characteristic length of the finite element and Gf is the fracture energy of concrete. A simple analytical relation, derived from a semitheoretical approach [14] is used for the fracture energy of concrete: f2 (5) G f = 15.5 d max t E0 in which dmax is the maximum aggregate size in the concrete mix. A final form of A can be obtained as in a previous study [15] h (6) A= 310 Eq (6) clearly reflects only the mesh size effect into the analysis. A representative mesh size for nonlinear FEA can be used in this study as recommended by Bazant and Oh [16]: h= 3 h x h y hz
(7)
where hx, hy, and hz are sizes of an eight-noded solid element. An ideal elasto-plastic behavior is adopted with a Von Misses type of stress potential for steel elements. 3D-bar elements are used for the reinforcing steel bars and ties. 3) A damage ratio is the ratio of the stresses that cause initial damage in tension and compression. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
237
Model verification and evaluation of experimental results
3D-Finite element analyses of four RC columns tested in the structural laboratory of Yıldız Technical University are performed in this study. As shown in fig.3 and fig.4, the mesh sizes chosen for concrete elements are optimum sizes since the expression for material parameter A in eq (6) is derived for representative concrete meshes having approximately a size of three times the maximum aggregate diameter [16–18].
Figure 3:
(a) Cross-sectional dimensions and (b) FE meshing of RC columns with and without any defects.
Figure 4:
(a) Test setup; (b) Failure of a RC column.
It is important to model the confining action of the stirrups properly. If only the bar elements are used for ties, there is no possibility to reflect the confining action of ties between two nodes. Therefore, springs, acting on the lateral surface of concrete element are defined and the total spring stiffness acts on the nodes as shown in fig.3. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
238 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Axial load (kN)
1200 C1L4S8 800 Average reading 0.01 h defect 0.005 h defect Ideal column
400 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
Axial shortening (mm)
Axial load (kN)
1200 C1L4S12 800 Average reading 0.01 h defect 0.005 h defect Ideal column
400 0 0
0.2
0.4 Axial shortening (mm)
0.6
0.8
Axial load (kN)
1000 C1L8S8 500
Average reading 0.01 h defect 0.005 h defect Ideal column
0 0
0.2 0.4 Axial shortening (mm)
0.6
Axial load (kN)
1200 C1L8S12 800 Average reading 0.01 h defect 0.005 h defect Ideal column
400 0 0
Figure 5:
0.2
0.4 Axial shortening (mm)
0.6
0.8
Influence of geometrical defects on axial load-shortening curves of finite element analysis and comparison with the experimental results obtained from averaging the readings of three LVDT’s.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
239
Axial load (kN)
1000 C1L4S8
800 600 400
LVDT #2 Ideal column
200 0 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
Axial shortening (mm)
Axial load (kN)
1200 1000 800 600 400 200 0
C1L4S12
LVDT #2 Ideal column 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
Axial shortening (mm)
Axial load (kN)
1000 C1L8S8
800 600 400
LVDT #7
200
Ideal column
0
Axial load (kN)
0
0.1
1200 1000 800 600 400 200 0
0.4
0.5
C1L8S12
LVDT #7 Ideal column 0
Figure 6:
0.2 0.3 Axial shortening (mm)
0.1
0.2
0.3 0.4 0.5 Axial shortening (mm)
0.6
0.7
Comparison of the readings of the critical LVDT located on the heavily damaged region and the results of FEA of an ideal column.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
240 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The assumption of existing of some specific geometrical defects is initially imposed on the cross-section of the column as shown in fig. 3(b). A perfect flat top surface is modified to a deformed one by imposing a height difference of 10mm (0.01h) and 5mm (0.005h) respectively to one edge of the column. These deformations are really small values, which cannot be observed easily. As can be seen in fig.5, the results obtained from finite element analysis of deformed specimens for the axial load-shortening curves get closer to the curve drawn averaging readings of three LVDTs. It is clearly stated that there is no ideal column subjected to a perfect concentric loading up to the failure load. Especially, when the plastic deformations are getting larger at approximately 75% of the maximum load, the cracks begin to grow unstably and macro-cracks arise pointing out the localization of the damage. The readings obtained from the critical LVDT and shown in fig.6 are also close to the results of the 3D finite element analysis of an ideal RC column. The critical LVDT represents the readings belonging to the heavily deformed side of the column, even the differential settlement of this side due to the localized damage can be observed by naked eye. While the test column continues to consolidate near to the failure load, volumetric expansion occurs by the opening of macro cracks on the adjacent side of the column as shown in fig.7. A similar approach is adopted by Mander et al. [8] defining some critical potentiometers on the failure region within the gage length of the potentiometers instead of averaging the readings of four potentiometers. However, it is clear that there is an uncertainty about the exact place of the localized damage region on which the critical LVDT to be placed for obtaining the maximum shortening values of the column.
Figure 7:
(a) Heavily consolidated side; (b) macro-crack at neighbouring side.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
241
Conclusion
This paper has been concerned with the evaluation of the experimental techniques for obtaining the axial load-shortening curves of RC columns subjected to concentric loading. Comparing the experimental data and 3D finite element analyses of four RC columns tested in the structural laboratory of Yıldız Technical University, some uncertainties measuring the axial deformation is studied. For this purpose, while the average of LVDTs can be used near to the failure load, the critical LVDT readings showing the accumulated damage on heavily consolidated side of the column should be preferred after the beginning of the unstable crack propagation approximately taken as 75% of the failure load. The FEA results and experimental data show good agreement for this case. On the other hand, there is some uncertainty about the exact place for the replacement of the critical LVDT on the failure region. Alternative places for the LVDT on this damaged side of the column may be schemed for measuring the consolidation of the column. Thus, a need for a definition for the replacement of the critical LVDT to measure the axial deformations of RC columns is apparent. Even it is possible to use some averaging values for the determination of the axial shortening. If a very small height difference between two opposite sides on the top surface of the specimen is imposed on the 3D modelling of columns, the results of FEA and the average of LVDTs are close to each other. This kind of defects is possible during the preparation stage of the specimens and should be carefully checked.
Acknowledgement The support of B.U. Research Fund (ref: research project 05A403) for this paper is gratefully acknowledged.
References [1]
[2] [3] [4]
Richart, F.E., Bradtzaeg, A. & Brown, R. L., A study of the Failure of Concrete under Combined Compressive Stresses, Bulletin Np. 185, Engineering experimental station University of Illinois, Urbana, pp. 104, 1928. Hognestad, E., A Study of Combined Bending and Axial Load in Reinforced Concrete Members, Bulletin Series No.399, University of Illinois Eng. Exp. Station, Urbana. 1951. Kent, D.C. & Park, R., Flexural Members with Confined Concrete, Journal of the Structural Division, Proc. of the American Society of Civil Engineers, 97(ST7), pp.1969-1990, 1971. Sheikh, S.A. & Uzumeri, S.M., Analytical Model for Concrete Confinement in Tied Columns, Journal of the Structural Division, Proc. of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
242 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10]
[11]
[12] [13] [14] [15]
[16] [17] [18]
the American Society of Civil Engineers, 108(ST12), pp. 2703-2722, 1982. Mander, J.B., Priestly, M.J.N. & Park, R., Theoretical Stress-Strain Model for Confined Concrete, Journal of the Structural Engineering, ASCE, 114(8), pp.1804-1826, 1988. Saatcioglu, M. & Razvi, S.R., Strength and Ductility of Confined Concrete, Journal of the Structural Engineering, ASCE, 118(6), pp.1590-1607, 1992. Sheikh, S.A. & Uzumeri, S.M., Strength and Ductility of Tied Concrete Columns, Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, 106(ST5), pp.10791102, 1980. Mander, J.B., Priestly, M.J.N. & Park, R., Observed Stress-Strain Behavior of Confined Concrete, Journal of the Structural Engineering, ASCE, 114(8), pp.1827-1849, 1988. Shrive, P.L., Azarnejad, A., Tadros, G., McWhinnie, C. & Shrive, N.G, Strength of Concrete Columns with Carbon Fibre Reinforcement Wrap, Canadian Journal of Civil Engineering, Volume 30, pp. 543-554, 2003. Karakoç, C., Köksal, H.O., & Özsoy, A.E., The Behaviour of Reinforced Block Masonry Columns Under Axial Compression, Earthquake Resistant Engineering Structures IV, WIT Press, Southampton, U.K., pp. 371-379, 2003. Oliver, J., Cervera, M., Oller, S. & Lubliner, J., Isotropic Damage Models and Smeared Crack Analysis of Concrete, In N. Bićanić et al. (ed) Proc. SCI-C Computer Aided Analysis and Design of Concrete Structures, pp. 945-957, 1990. LUSAS Modeller (v13.6) User Manual v13, FEA ltd., UK CEB-FIB. 1990 Model Code. Comité Euro-International du Béton (CEB), Lausanne, Switzerland. Köksal, H.O., Modelling of Concrete Fracture, Ph.D. thesis, Division of Civil Engineering, Boğaziçi University, İstanbul, Turkey, 1998. Köksal, H.O., Doran, B., Özsoy, A.E. & Alacali, S.N., Nonlinear Modeling of Concentrically Loaded Reinforced Blockwork Masonry Columns, Canadian Journal of Civil Engineering, Volume 31, Number 6, pp.1012-1023, 2004. Bažant, Z.P. & Oh, B., Crack Band Theory for Fracture of Concrete, Materiaux et Constructions, 16, 93, pp.155-177, 1983. Bedard, C. & Kostovos, M.D., Fracture Process of Concrete for NLFEA Methods, ASCE Journal of Structural Engineering, 112, 3, 573-586, 1986. Köksal, H.O. & Arslan, G., Damage Analysis of RC Beams without Web Reinforcement, Magazine of Concrete Research, Volume: 56, pp.231-241, 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
243
Geometrically nonlinear static analysis of 3D trusses using the arc-length method G. A. Hrinda NASA Langley Research Center, Hampton, Virginia, USA
Abstract Rigorous analysis of geometrically nonlinear structures demands the creation of mathematical models that accurately include loading and support conditions and, more importantly, model the stiffness and response of the structure. Nonlinear geometric structures often contain critical points with snap-through behavior during the response to large loads. Studying the post buckling behavior during a portion of a structure's unstable load history may be necessary. Primary structures made from ductile materials will stretch enough prior to failure for loads to redistribute producing sudden and often catastrophic collapses that are difficult to predict. The responses and redistribution of the internal loads during collapses and possible sharp snap-back of structures have frequently caused numerical difficulties in analysis procedures. The presence of critical stability points and unstable equilibrium paths are major difficulties that numerical solutions must pass to fully capture the nonlinear response. Some hurdles still exist in finding nonlinear responses of structures under large geometric changes. Predicting snap-through and snap-back of certain structures has been difficult and time consuming. Also difficult is finding how much load a structure may still carry safely. Highly geometrically nonlinear responses of structures exhibiting complex snap-back behavior are presented and analyzed with a finite element approach. The arc-length method will be reviewed and shown to predict the proper response and follow the nonlinear equilibrium path through limit points. Keywords: nonlinear, truss, arc-length, finite element, snap-back, Crisfield, tangent stiffness, equilibrium path, Nastran, bifurcation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070261
244 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Three-dimensional space trusses may experience loading conditions that cause large displacements that significantly change the geometry of the structure and require the equations of equilibrium to be formulated for the deformed structure. The large deflections are described by nonlinear differential equations that can be solved using incremental techniques. In nonlinear analysis the tangent stiffness matrix replaces the stiffness matrix used in linear analysis. Iterative time stepping is used to apply small incremental loads to the structure and find the corresponding incremental displacements. A plot of the results defines a curve of the equilibrium path of the structure under the applied loading. A truss structure undergoing large changes in geometry often exhibits critical points with an unstable snapping response during a static collapse. The solution to these structural instabilities is difficult to find with common nonlinear equation solvers such as the Newton-Raphson method. These methods often fail whenever snap-back behavior occurs along the loading path and they may not correctly define the response immediately after snap-through. Large gaps in the equilibrium path will occur with artificial results being plotted. Researchers have continually investigated these shortcomings and have offered improvements to the process that have been gradually introduced into commercial finite element analysis (FEA) programs. The techniques investigated bring the above FEA problems into focus. Geometric nonlinear FEA may be challenged to find all possible responses during large loading. A finite element computer program was created and tested by means of a number of examples exhibiting geometric nonlinearity. The sophistication of the finite element program presented in this work is measured by the path-following techniques enabling the fundamental path to be followed after bifurcation. The results are compared with nonlinear Nastran solutions and Crisfield [1,2].
2
Geometrically nonlinear finite element static analysis by the Riks-Wempner arc-length method
Passing through critical points during the geometrically nonlinear response is challenging. Two critical points encountered during this type of behavior are: load limit points that are reached whenever the response path has a local snapthrough; and control limit points that define a local snap-back. At a control limit point the loading may reverse as the deflections change directions and a local maximum is passed. An important family of nonlinear equations solvers called the arc-length method as developed by Riks-Wempner [6] can overcome the difficulties of passing critical points. The technique resembles the Newton-Raphson method described in Riks [5] except the applied load increment becomes an additional unknown. The Riks-Wempner method computes load magnitudes as part of the solution. The length of a vector tangent to the equilibrium path is used to find a new point that is the intersection of the plane normal to the tangent. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
245
A user-supplied load will estimate magnitudes of the initial load increment for a step. Termination of the method is done by the user specifying a maximum load proportionality factor or a maximum nodal displacement. The process also ends when the maximum number of increments for a step is reached. 2.1 Derivations of arc-length formulas The Riks-Wempner arc-length method traces the nonlinear equilibrium path using an iterative process that begins with computing initial displacements due to a user defined load increment. The method proceeds to find the next equilibrium point from the initial point i as shown in fig. 2 and detailed by Crisfield [1,2], Owen and Hinton [3], Owen et al [4] and Riks [6]. The figure shows the loaddisplacement curve for a single-degree-of-freedom system. A vector tangent to the curve at i can be drawn and written as G ti =
G
∆qi ∆λ i
(1) G
where ∆λi is the incremental applied load at i and ∆qi is the incremental displacement vector found from computing
G G K T ∆qi = ∆λi Q
(2)
i
G The normal vector, ni , is also shown in fig. 2 and can be written as G ∆qk G ni = −∆λk
(3)
The tangent stiffness matrix, KT , is assembled using the nonlinear truss shown i
in fig. 1 and derived in [1]. Trusses undergoing large deflections must be analyzed for the deformed geometry of the structure. The linear equations G G F = [K ] u (4) G
that relates the applied forces F with the truss element stiffness [ K ] and G displacements u must be modified to account for changes in nodal geometry as the load is applied. The sum of the linear elastic and nonlinear matrices produce the global tangent stiffness at point i along the load-displacement path of the single-degree-of-freedom system. The standard elastic stiffness matrix [ K ]E will be modified to give the tangent stiffness:
(
)
3 (ux 2 −ux1 ) 2 1 + ( 3(ux 2 −ux1 ) ) + ( 3(uy 2 −uy1 ) ) + ( 3(uz 2 −uz1 ) ) + + (5) xl xl xl 2 xl 2 EA KT = xl 2 2 3 (uz 2 −uz1 ) 3 (uy 2 −uy1 ) + 2 2 2 xl 2 xl
(
) (
)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
246 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
Figure 2:
Nonlinear 3d Truss variables.
Riks-Wempner arc-length method on a normal plane for a singledegree-of-freedom system.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
247
Start of Riks-Wempner normal to a plane method.
At the start of the Riks-Wempner arc-length method an initial load increment, G ∆λ0 , is used to compute the first displacement vector, ∆q0 , and the length of the
G
first tangent vector t0 . The variables are shown in the load displacement plot in G fig. 3. Similar triangles are used to find the initial displacements, ∆q0 . During this initial increment the tangent stiffness is the same as the linear stiffness. The load increment is a user-defined value that divides the total applied load into even increments. A given load increment starts the process and finds the displacements ∆q0 using the tangent stiffness matrix KT . The initial 0
displacements ∆q0 are found using ∆λ0 λ G = G ∆q0 ∆qtot
(6)
where λ = 1 and ∆qtot is found from the expression KT ∆qtot = λ Q (7) G The length of the tangent vector t0 along the equilibrium path can be calculated 0
as ∆s0 = t 0 ⋅ t 0 =
GT GT 2 ∆λ + ∆ q 0 ∆ q
(8)
Throughout the rest of the iterations the arc-length is constant or can be scaled by the user input into the following 1
I 2 ∆si = ∆si − 1 des I i −1
(9)
The user decides on the required number of iterations, I i −1 , and on the number of desired iterations, I des . WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
248 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The internal forces in the truss element are required for the tangent stiffness and will be defined using matrix notation. The element strain formulation uses a constant cross sectional area and assumes the length/area of the truss will remain large. The strain energy or work done is 1/2 the nodal forces multiplied by the corresponding deflections. The internal force in the truss will now be defined to include nonlinear effects. The force is axially directed and is needed in updating the nonlinear stiffness matrix. Now using the strain equation
ε
2
=
xli − xl
2 xl
the matrix notation can be written as GT G ε = x21 p21 +
2
(10)
2
1 2
GT G p 21 p21
(11)
( ux2 − ux1 ) GT G G 2 where p21 = ( uy 2 − uy1 ) and xl = x21 x21 ( uz2
− uz1 )
The first term on the right-hand side of (11) represents the linear strain and the second term is the nonlinear contribution. The internal force in the truss is then: AN = EAε (12)
3
Verification models
The proposed finite element program was tested and verified using several examples found in literature with nonlinear Nastran solutions. Of particular interest was the ability to reproduce snap-through and snap-back behavior found in some structures. The examples were chosen as a robust test of this unstable behavior and bring confidence to the computer coding and numerical techniques. 3.1 Single-degree-of-freedom nonlinear example The following single-degree-of-freedom example uses a truss that follows the National Agency of Finite Elements (NAFEMS) benchmark tests. The problem is used in [1] and by others. Fig. 4 shows the problem with the variables used in expressing the exact response equation.
Figure 4:
Single-degree-of-freedom truss snap through problem.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
249
The exact load-displacement path is given in [1] as: 2
qG =
EA0 Z (2 Zw − w )
(13)
3
2lo
where Z = ( z + w) and E =Young's modulus, A0 =area The truss in fig. 4 was solved using the exact eq. (13), performing a nonlinear Nastran FEA and using the proposed Hrinda FEA computer program for static nonlinear trusses presented in this work. Letting EA0 = 5.e 7 , x = 2500. ,
Displacement (inches)
z = 25. , q1 = 1.0 , then the following plot of the solution points are: 60
Nastran
50
Hrinda
40
Exact
30 20 10 0 -0.2
-0.1
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
Load ( x 1e7 lbs.) Load/Deflections for Crisfield Sdof Figure 5:
Single-degree-of-freedom load/deflection plot.
3.2 Star dome truss The Crisfield shallow star dome model was taken from [2] and has been studied by others to demonstrate a complex equilibrium path. The 24 member 3d truss model, shown in fig. 6, has one concentrated load at the center and is solved in the arc-length computer program with results compared to a Nastran model. The load increment vs. vertical displacements of the center node are plotted in fig. 7 and compared. This model introduced a major difficulty following the load path at snap points. The proposed Hrinda FEA program was able to accurately follow the Nastran results through several snap-through and snap-back points. The structure snaps through just before -13" of vertical displacement and then snaps back to -3.7". The loading is reversed as shown by the horizontal axis in fig. 7. The maximum negative load increment is reached at -.443 and the displacements continue to increase.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
250 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6:
Crisfield three-dimensional star dome. -25
Displacement (inches)
-20
Nastran -15
Hrinda
-10
-5 -1
-0.5
0
0.5
1
1.5
0
5
Load (x 1.e6 lbs.)
Load/Deflections for Star Dom e at Center Figure 7:
Star dome load increment vs. vertical displacement.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
251
3.3 Crisfield arch truss The model is taken from [2] and tests multiple snap-through and snap-back behavior. The model has 101 elements with 42 nodes with a total of 126 degrees-of-freedom. Fig. 8 shows the test model and the applied load at the apex. Fig. 9 displays the Nastran results and the predicted response of the Hrinda arc-length FEA computer program. The first snap-through, shown in figure 9, occurs at a load increment of -.1 and -29.2 inches. A snap-back occurs at a load increment of .29 with a displacement of -3.33 inches. A second snapthrough begins and continues with increasing loads. The arc-length FEA program closely follows the equilibrium path found by a nonlinear Nastran solution.
Figure 8:
Crisfield large circular arch. -35
Displacement (inches)
-30
-25
N astran
H rinda -20
-15
-10
-5 -0.5
-0.4
-0.3
-0.2
-0.1
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0
Load ( x 1e7 lbs. ) Load/D eflections for C risfield Arch @ Apex Figure 9:
Arch load deflection apex comparisons of Nastran vs. Hrinda.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
252 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 10:
4
Arch deflections at snap-through and snap-back.
Conclusion and future work
The arc-length method was used in a finite element program created to properly find the equilibrium path of highly geometrically nonlinear truss structures. Critical points along the path were found and passed to show snap-through and snap-back behavior of the truss structures. Future work will include the Newark method for solving nonlinear transient problems. The Hrinda finite element program for the nonlinear static load case will be revised to include nonlinear dynamics.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
Crisfield, M. A., Non-Linear Finite Element Analysis of Solids and Structures: Volume I Essentials, John Wiley & Sons 1991. Crisfield, M. A., Non-Linear Finite Element Analysis of Solids and Structures: Volume 2 Advanced Topics, John Wiley & Sons 1997. Owen, D. R. J., Hinton, E., Finite Elements in Plasticity: Theory and Practice, Pineridge Press Ltd., 1980. Owen, D. R. J., Hinton, E., Taylor, C., Numerical Methods for Non-Linear Problems, Volume 1, Pineridge Press, 1980. Riks, E., The Application of Newton's Methods to the Problem of Elastic Stability, Journal of Applied Mechanics, Vol. 39 (1060-1065), 1972. Riks, E., An Incremental Approach to the Solution of Snapping and Buckling Problems, International Journal of Solids and Structures, Vol. 15 (529-551), 1979.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 3 Fluid flow
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
255
On the accuracy of integral representation of differential operators in Lagrangian blob mesh-less methods C. Golia & B. Buonomo Department of Aerospace and Mechanical Engineering, Second University of Naples, Italy
Abstract We explore novel ideas to improve the accuracy of the integral approximation of differential operators (Gradient and Laplacian) in the simulation of thermal viscous problems with Lagrangian Blob mesh-less methods. Basically we investigate and develop a novel convolution integral discretization of the differential operators by using 2D-Taylor series expansions and a Gaussian like kernel function defined on a compact support around the blob centre of a given particle. This allows us to overtake: • deficiency of cells in the compact domain due to irregular distribution of the particles around the given blob, • deficiency of cells in the compact domain caused by the presence of a boundary cutting the support of a nearby blob. The accuracy and order of approximation of such a discretization are determined in regular and randomly distorted grids of various sizes, and compared with the widely used PSE (Particle Strength Exchange) formulation. Results obtained in the solution of thermal buoyant problems at realistic values of the Grashoff number demonstrate validity and benefits of the novel findings. Keywords: integral definition of differential operators, lagrangian mesh-less methods, vortex/thermal blobs, thermal buoyant problems.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070271
256 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Mesh-less methods (both 2 and 3 D) are of growing interest in the simulation of viscous unsteady fluid-dynamic problems. In particular, we focus on the analysis of the particle based Lagrangian approach to the Helmholtz formulation of the complete Navier-Stokes equations. Such analysis is made using individual discrete particles, blobs, that, as computational elements, transport (with the velocity induced by the vorticity field) momentum/vorticity and energy. In the regularized vortex blob method, the discretization of the equations is made by considering N-blobs problems where vorticity/energy is represented, for a general particle located in (x, t), by convolution integrals with kernel radial functions, W(r), r = |x|, satisfying given normalization properties. The accuracy of the solution depends on the approximation of the differential operators of the equations. Usually diffusive Laplacian operators are discretized according to the Particle Strength Exchange (PSE) method proposed by Degond and Mas-Gallic [1] and Gradient operators (needed in the buoyant term and in the 3D vorticity equation stretching term) according to a similar method proposed by Eldredge et al [2]. Both such discretizations are defined by convolution integrals with kernel radial functions derived according to the specific kernel function, W(r), used. The discretization of each term is substituted in the equations and integrated over the volume around each blob particle: this will result in a time integration of N-body problem. The discretization of the differential operators is quite accurate for blobs regularly distributed in the field and away from boundaries/discontinuities. Usually, to avoid inaccuracy due to distorted particle field, a regrid is used, after a number of integration steps, to project the field on a regular mesh. The interest of the authors lay in the modeling of Unsteady Free Convection Buoyant Flows (Helmholtz formulation) characterized by strong unsteady start up phenomena (usually mushroom rising domes) and by a timely growing convective field that requires vanishing asymptotic boundary conditions (pressure closure). Since regrid of the actual blob field on a regular symmetric grid will result in a somewhat viscous step, the authors are willing to search for formulations of the differential operators that are accurate also for distorted blob fields.
2
Taylor convolution formulation
We consider a function f(x) = f(x,y), on a 2D field, represented by blobs located on a non regular grid and we are looking to compute the values of Gradient and Laplacian of the field at a given blob located at xo = (xo,yo) by a convolution integral strategy on a compact domain around the blob, by using a kernel function W(x-x o, h). Following an idea developed by Liu and Lui [3], we consider a Taylor expansion of f(x,y) around the given point (xo,yo) truncated at the 3rd order:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
257
f (x, y) = f (x o , yo ) + ∆x f x o + ∆y f y + 12 ∆x 2 f xx o + ∆x ∆y f xy + 12 ∆y 2 f yy + ... (1) o
o
o
where: ∆x = x - xo, ∆y = y - yo. We consider a kernel function W(x-xo,h) that is compact on a domain Ω of radius k times the grid size, h, around xo. The kernel vanish on the boundary of Ω and has unitary zero-order moment, whereas all other n-th order moments are zero: M 0 ≡ ∫ W ( x − x o , h ) dx = 1
(2)
Ω
M n ≡ ∫ ( x − x o ) W ( x − x o , h ) dx = 0 ∀n ≠ 0 n
Ω
Moreover we assume that the first partial derivatives of the kernel, Wx(x-xo, h) and Wy(x-xo, h), vanish on the boundary and have unitary first-order moments whereas all others vanish: M1 ≡ ∫ ( x − x o ) Wa ( x − x o , h ) dx = −1
(3)
Ω
M n ≡ ∫ ( x − x o ) Wa ( x − x o , h ) dx = 0 ; ∀n ≠ 1, a = ( x, y ) n
Ω
Finally we assume also that all second partial derivatives of the kernel, Wxx(x-xo, h), Wxy(x-xo, h) and Wyy(x-xo, h) vanish on the boundary and have unitary second-order moments whereas all others vanish: M 2 ≡ ∫ ( x − x o ) Wab ( x − x o , h ) dx = 2 2
(4)
Ω
M n ≡ ∫ ( x − x o ) Wab ( x − x o , h ) dx = 0 ; ∀n ≠ 2, ab = ( x, y ) ⊗ ( x, y ) n
Ω
Since we are looking for a convolution representation of operators, we multiply eq. (1), truncated to 2nd order, alternatively, by the two first partial derivatives of the kernel function W(x-xo, h) and integrate on the compact domain. We obtain then a system of two linear equations: f x f x
0
∫ ∆x W dΩ + f ∫ ∆y W dΩ ≈ ∫ [f − f ] W dΩ x
Ω
y 0
∆x Wy dΩ + f y 0 ∫ Ω
0
x
Ω
o
x
Ω
(5)
∫ ∆y Wy dΩ ≈ ∫ [f − fo ] WydΩ
Ω
Ω
where: f = f(x), f o = f( x o ). The solution of eq. (5) furnishes the representation of the components of the field gradient, fx fy, at xo. Similarly by multiplying alternatively eq. (1) by the three second partial derivatives of the kernel function W(x-xo, h), by truncating the expansion to the 3rd order and by integrating on the compact domain Ω, we can obtain the representation of the second derivatives needed for the Laplacian (fxx , fyy) by solving the system of 3 linear equations: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
258 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII f xx f xx f xx
1 o 2 1 o 2 1 o 2
∫ ∆x W
dΩ + f xy
∫ ∆x W
dΩ + f xy
∫ ∆x W
dΩ + f xy
2
xx
Ω
2
xy
Ω
2
yy
Ω
o
o
o
∫ ∆x∆yW
dΩ + f yy
∫ ∆x∆yW
dΩ + f yy
∫ ∆x∆yW
dΩ + f yy
xx
Ω
xy
Ω
yy
Ω
1 o 2 1 o 2 1 o 2
∫ ∆y W
dΩ ≈ ∫ ∆fWxx dΩ − f x o ∫ ∆xWxx dΩ − f y
o
∫ ∆y W
dΩ ≈ ∫ ∆fWxy dΩ − f x o ∫ ∆xWxy dΩ − f y
o
∫ ∆y W
dΩ ≈ ∫ ∆fWyy dΩ − f x o ∫ ∆xWyy dΩ − f y
o
2
xx
Ω
2
xy
Ω
2
yy
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
∫ ∆yW
dΩ
∫ ∆yW
dΩ
∫ ∆yW
dΩ
xx
Ω
xy
Ω
yy
Ω
(6) It is worthy to note that in case of symmetrical grid, many of the convolution integrals will vanish, and a much simple representations will result: for the Gradient:
∫ ∆f W dΩ x
fx o ≈
Ω
∫ ∆x W dΩ
∫ ∆f W dΩ
(7)
y
;
fy ≈ o
x
Ω
Ω
∫ ∆y W dΩ y
v
for the Laplacian:
∫ ∆f W
xx
f xx o ≈
1 2
Ω
∫ ∆x
2
Ω
f yy ≈ o
1 2
∫ ∆x
dΩ * ∫ ∆y 2 Wyy dΩ − ∫ ∆f Wyy dΩ * ∫ ∆y 2 Wxx dΩ Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Wxx dΩ * ∫ ∆y 2 Wyy dΩ − ∫ ∆x 2 Wyy dΩ * ∫ ∆y 2 Wxx dΩ 2
Ω
(8)
Ω
Wxx dΩ *∫ ∆f Wyy dΩ − ∫ ∆y 2 Wyy dΩ * ∫ ∆f Wxx dΩ Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
Ω
2 2 2 2 ∫ ∆x Wxx dΩ * ∫ ∆y Wyy dΩ − ∫ ∆x Wyy dΩ * ∫ ∆y Wxx dΩ
Ω
Ω
In the following we shall denote the representations given by eqs. (5) and (6) as “TCFC” and the representations given by eqs. (7) and (8) as “TCFP”.
3
Kernel function
The kernel used is a modified (2D) Gaussian: W(x, y, h) =
(
4 x 2 + y2 4 1 − exp π h2 h2
)
(9)
It can be shown that such kernel, with its derivatives, satisfy the Moment closures as per eqs. (2)–(4). The kernel of eq. (9) is compact on r/h ≤ 2 with an approximation of 1.5E-7; its first derivatives are compact with an approximation of 1.5E-6, the second derivatives are compact with an approximation of 1.5E-5.
4
Strategy of the performance analysis
We assume a given known field on a regular or perturbed grid over a region and we proceed to compute the values of Gradient and Laplacian on a number of collocation points. Thereafter, we do compare the values computed with various methods with the exact ones and determine the statistics of the errors. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
259
Among others used, we report the analysis for the field: f(x,y) = cos(2πx) sin(2πy) / (2π) (x,y)∈[0,1]x[0,1]
(10)
that represents the pressure field of a well known test case for benchmarking of Navier Stokes equations [4].
1 0
0
1
0.25 0
0.5
0.2 0.4
Y
X
0.75
0.6 0.8 1
1
Figure 1. Grid Comparison: Igrid= 0 ; NRandom=0.5 1 0.8
Y
0.6 0.4 0.2 0 0
0.25
0.5
X
0.75
1
REGULAR GRID COLLOCATION POINTS DISTORTED GRID
Figure 2. We note that this field implies homogeneous Neumann conditions on the boundaries x=0 and x=1, and homogeneous Dirichlet conditions on the boundaries y=0 and y=1. The reference grid is regular or perturbed according to the value of a random parameter Nrandom. For Nrandom=0 the reference grid is symmetric.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
260 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The grid of the collocation points, where we are computing the values of the Gradient and Laplacian, is located in the mid points of the original regular grid. For various grid size and values of Nrandom, we will compare the performances of the methods: TCFC, TCFP, and PSE, in terms of: •
Field survey comparison maps,
•
Map of the error in the field.
•
Global RMS error,
For each formulation, the trend of the Global RMS error in terms of the grid size, h, will give the real value of the order of approximation of the methods. 4.1 Field survey comparison maps We show the Laplacian maps obtained with TCFC, TCFP, PSE, compared to the exact one for the case: Nx*Ny =21·21, h=0.05, Nrandom=0 in Figure 3. We note that all the three methods catch the general behavior of the Laplacian field, but the PSE lacks for magnitude, and the TCFP locally suffers the Dirichlet boundary conditions on y=0 and y=1. T.C.F.Complete 0.9
0.8
0.8
0.7
0.7
0.6
0.6
Yr
Yr
Exact 0.9
0.5
0.5 0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2
LAPLACIAN Maps Nx * Ny = 21 *21 h = 0.05 Nrandom = 0.0
0.1 0.25
0.5
Xr
0.75
1
0.1 0.25
0.5
0.75
Xr
1
P.S.E.
T.C.F.Partial 1 0.9
0.9 0.8
0.8 0.7
0.7
0.6
Yr
Yr
0.6 0.5
0.5
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2
0.1
0.1
0.5
Xr
0.2
1
0.4
Xr
0.6
0.8
1
Figure 3. The same case, obtained with a strongly distorted grid denoted by Nrandom=0.5, results in the maps in Figure 4. It can be seen that TCFC is still able to give quantitative and qualitative satisfactory results, it suffers only the intersection zones with change of sign. For the other two maps, TCFP is clearly failing and PSE is clearly unsatisfactory. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII T.C.F. Complete
0.9
0.9
0.8
0.8
0.7
0.7
0.6
0.6
Yr
Yr
Exact
0.5
0.5
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2 0.1
0.1 0.25
0.5
0.75
Xr
0.25
1
0.5
LAPLACIAN Maps Nx * NY = 21*21
T.C.F. Partial 1 0.9 0.8
0.75
Xr
1
P.S.E.
h = 0.5
0.9
Nrandom = 0.50
0.8 0.7
0.7
0.6
Yr
0.6
Yr
261
0.5
0.5
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2
0.1
0.1
0.5
0.2
1
Xr
0.4
Xr
0.6
0.8
1
Figure 4. 4.2 Field maps of the error For conciseness we report solely the error maps for TCFC and PSE corresponding to the case Nx*Ny =41*11, h=0.025, Nrandom=0.25 in Figure 5. % Error Map on Laplacian: T.C.F. Complete Method Nx*Ny = 41*41; NRandon = 0.25
-85.7143
-42.85 71
-71. 4286
29 -57. 14
-57.14 -42.8571 -28.5714 -8529 .7143
-57.1429 -14.2857
-71.42 86
71 -42.85
28 6
1.4
-7
-71. 4286
-71. 4286
-2 5
Y
5 -7 50
Y
-25
-71.42 86
-5 7.1
-85.714
7
-57.1429
71
.2085 -14
85
42 9
3-100-71.428
6
0
25 -25 10 0
0.25
-71.4286
-57.1429
-100
3
0
0
-57.1429 -100 -85.7143
-71.4286
-42.
-100
14
10
25
7 85 -100 .2 14 14 .57 28
5.7
5
0.1
9 42
-8
-75
-2
0.1
6
7.1
29 -57.14
42 9
28
1 57 2.8 0 -4 -14.2857
-100
0.2
1.4
PSE-Lap 100 85.7143 71.4286 57.1429 42.8571 28.5714 14.2857 0 -14.2857 -28.5714 -42.8571 -57.1429 -71.4286 -85.7143 -100
7
-5
-57.1429 -71.42 86
-57.1429
-100 -71.4286 -5 7.1
85
-57.1429
-7
143 -57.1429
4.2
86 42 -71. 9 42 7.1
-85.7
0.3
0.2
0
0.5 0.4
0.3
-85.7143
-1
9 42 7.1 -5
-71. 4286
-100
25
00
-42.8571 -71.42 -71.428 6 86
-100
-1 00
0.6
1 -42.857 57 -14.28
0
0.4
50 50 75
5
-100 -57.1429
-85.7143 -71. 4286
1429 -57.
-100 -2
-1
10
0.5
0.7
8571 -42. 29 .14 -57
-25
-25
-25
0.8
6 1.4 28 -7-57.1429
0.7
0.9
-5
-2 5
Comp-Lap 100 75 50 25 -25 -50 -75 -100
0.8
-57.1429 -85.7143
-85.7143
25
00 -1
0.9
0.6
% Error Map on Laplacian: P.S.E. Nx*Ny = 41*41; NRandom=0.25.
1 00
50
-1
75
-5 0
1
0
5000 1
0.5
X
0.75
1
0.25
0.5
X
0.75
1
Figure 5. These maps confirm what said in the previous paragraph. It is clear the much better accuracy of the TCFC. 4.3 Error versus grid size We consider the error on the RMS norm of Gradient and Laplacian with varying grid size and distortion of the grid. Since we realize that such norms are affected by strong local errors nearby boundaries, we report the norm for the computations of the operators in collocation points within one grid size step away from the boundaries, that we call Inner grid. We consider firstly the Gradient of the three methods. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
262 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Integral Computation of the Gradient Operator Distorted Grid: NRandom = 0.25
Integral Computation of the Gradient Operator Symmetric INNER Grid 1
1
O(h2)
0.1
0.01
Gradient RMS Error Norm
Gradient RMS Error Norm
O(h) 0.1
O(h2)
0.01
0.001
Partial Complete P.S.E.
0.001 0.01
h (grid size)
0.0001 0.01
h (grid size)
0.1
0.1
Figure 6. Integral Computation of the Laplace Operator Distorted INNER Grid, NRandom=0.25
Integral Computation of the Laplace Operator Symmetric INNER Grid Laplacian Operator RMS Error Norm
Laplacian Operator RMS Error Norm
1
O(h2)
0.1
0.01
Partial Complete P.S.E.
0.001 0.01
h (grid size)
0.1
10
O(h2)
1
0.1
Partial Complete P.S.E.
0.01
0.001 0.01
h (grid size)
0.1
Figure 7. The trends clearly show that TCFC and TCFP are almost equivalent, of 2nd order, and practically not sensible to grid distortion. PSE is almost zero order. TCFC and clearly inadequate. A comparison for the Laplacian shows that TCFC and TCFP are equivalent for symmetrical grid and 2nd order. For distorted grid TCFC maintains roughly the 2nd order accuracy, whereas TCFP and PSE are not well performing. In conclusion, the TCFC perform much better of the other formulations both for Laplacian and for Gradients, and it is second order.
5
Buoyant problem test
We are going to compare the results of running the same 2D code with PSE and TCFC formulations of Gradients and Laplacians. The code, detailed elsewhere in [5–7], is based upon Lagrangian particles (vortex and heat, independently treated) that, as computational elements, transport (with the velocity induced by the vorticity field) momentum/vorticity and energy. Vorticity is produced by the thermal gradient present in the flow field, in the context of validity of Boussinesq hypothesis. Heat is generated by the Thermal Boundary/Initial Conditions. Both vorticity and heat diffuse according to their transport coefficients and Laplacian terms. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
263
The formulation is based on a splitting technique of the convective and diffusive terms: it considers an hyperbolic equation for the trajectory of the blobs, and 2 parabolic equations for the diffusive processes, of thermal energy and vorticity, along the characteristics curves (trajectories). The evaluation of the velocity from the vorticity field, needed to integrate the trajectories of the N blobs, is a classical N-Body problem that requires O(N2) operations. The code uses a Fast Multipole Method (FMM) that is a O(N) algorithm, capable of self organize in order to warrant an imposed error level on the calculation of the velocity field. The resulting methodology has strong advantages, among the others: it is intrinsically unsteady, continuity is satisfied by definition, blobs move where they are needed (loci of strong gradients), asymptotic conditions are automatically satisfied, generates very robust codes (CFL condition removed). This will allow, with modern workstations and reasonable computing time, to simulate thermal free convection problems of engineering interest at realistic values of the Grashoff number. The code is organized to perform, after a given number of computational steps, a regrid process, i.e. project the field on a regular grid. At time of the regrid the code automatically creates if it is the case, new blob particles to take into account the natural evolution of the flow. T.C.F.Complete Gr=.454E8, Re=1. Regrid Steps=5
time =
P.S.E. Gr=.454E8, Re=1. Regrid Steps=5
1.000
0.6
0.4
0.4
1.000
Y
Y
0.6
time =
0.2
0.2
0
0
-0.2
-0.2 -0.2
0
X
0.2
-0.2
Figure 8. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
0
X
0.2
264 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Since regrid steps result in a somewhat viscous step, object of this analysis is to compare the capacity of use a value of “Regrid Steps” as high as possible still preserving the main characteristics of the solutions. First we use the same low Regrid Steps=5, for both cases, with a low resolution grid. The figure shows the isotherm maps. We note that the solutions are very similar at initial stages, PSE slightly more varying at late times. This is caused, perhaps by the smoothing effect of the regrid processes. Then we run the same case, low resolution grid, with larger Regrid steps =20. The figure below shows isothermal maps and velocity plots. We can note that for the PSE, at late times the velocities grow with untidiness and this cause an abnormal break up of the mushroom rising cup and of its stem. Further analysis with a much finer grid reveals indeed shapes and mushroom rising cup very similar to the ones given by the TCFC. TCFC - Regrid steps = 20
time =
1.000
PSE - Regrid steps = 20
0.6
0.5
0.5
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2
1.000
Y
Y
0.6
time =
0.1
0.1
0
0
-0.1
-0.1
-0.2
-0.2 -0.2
-0.1
0
X
0.1
0.2
-0.2
-0.1
0
X
0.1
0.2
Figure 9.
6
Conclusions
Analysis and comparisons made in this paper confirm definitely the superiority of the TCFC for the representation of differential operators in blob mesh less methods. Preliminary tests with 3-D problems fully confirm such findings; details are reported in a companion paper [8].
References [1] [2]
Degond, P. and Mas-Gallic, S., 1989, “The weighted Particle method for Convection-Diffusion Equations, part1: the case of an isotropic viscosity” Maths of Computation 53 (188), pp. 485-507 Eldredge, J.D., Leonard, A. and Colonius, T., 2002, “A General Deterministic Treatment of Derivatives in Particle Methods”, J. Comp. Phys. 180, pp. 686-709 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
265
Liu, G.R. and Liu, M.B., 2003, “Smoothed Particle Hydrodynamics”, World Scientific Pub. Co. Ross Ethier, C. and Streinman, D.A., 1994, ”Exact fully 3D Navier-Stokes solutions for benchmarking”, Int. J. Num. Meth. in Fluids 19, pp. 369375. Golia, C., Buonomo, B., Manca, O., and Viviani, A., 2004, “A VortexThermal Blobs Method For Unsteady Buoyancy Driven Flows”, ASMEIMECE. Anaheim, California. Golia, C., and Buonomo, B., 2005, “An Effective Blob Approach to Unsteady Thermal Buoyant Flows”, CMEM 2005, Malta Golia, C., and Buonomo, B., 2005, “Numerical Simulation of Unsteady Natural Convection by Blobs Methods “, 60th ATI Congress, Rome, Italy Golia, C., Buonomo, B., and Viviani, A., 2007, “A corrected Vortex Blob Method for 3D Thermal Buoyan Flows”, ICTEA Amman, Jordan
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
267
Construction of a non-Newtonian fluid model based on the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method S. Tajiri & M. Tsutahara Graduate School of Science and Technology, Kobe University, Japan
Abstract A model of the lattice Boltzmann method for non-Newtonian fluids was constructed. The shear stress of purely viscous but non-elastic non-Newtonian fluid is a function of shear rate only. For the power-law model, only two constant parameters can cover shear-thinning and shear-thickening fluids. Two power-law models are introduced to the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method. One is a model in which the collision parameter (the relaxation time) is determined as a function of the shear rate, and then the viscosity changes point by point according to the shear rate. For the other model, the effect of the variable viscosity is introduced as an external force which is determined by the local shear rate. Two-dimensional channel flow between two parallel plates was calculated by using the above two models. Both models are shown to give satisfactory results. However, some discontinuity appears in the calculation by the former model that is due to instability of the calculation. For the latter model, smooth velocity distributions are always obtained. The shear rate is estimated by the second order and fourth order central finite difference scheme, but the accuracy of the velocity distribution is to first order. A model in which the normal stress can be introduced by the shear is being constructed in the same manner. The normal stress was given by introducing the single mode Giesekus constitutive model to the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method. Keywords: finite difference lattice Boltzmann method (FDLBM), non-Newtonian fluids, power-law model, Giesekus model.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070281
268 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The lattice Boltzmann method (LBM) is a computational tool to analyze a thermal viscous fluid [1–4]. In particular, calculations of the flow within complicated porous media and the multi-phase flow are effective [5]. Recently, some models of LBM for purely viscous but non-elastic non-Newtonian fluid are proposed. The flow between parallel plates and open cavity flow were analyzed by Gabbanelli et al. [6] with the constructed LB model for the non-Newtonian fluid, and the examination about the calculation accuracy of the model was performed. Sullivan et al. [7] analyzed the detailed behaviour of the nonNewtonian fluid in three-dimensional complicated porous media. Their LB models gave the viscosity locally by determining the collision parameter (the relaxation time). The collision parameter was determined according to the shear rate. However, the relaxation time has a direct relation to the calculation stability, and the stability of the calculation is not enough. Yoshino et al. [8] presented the LB model for a non-Newtonian fluid using the Lattice Kinetic Scheme (LKS), in order to improve the problem. They analyzed the Darcy law of a two-dimensional porous media, and obtained the appropriate result. In this paper, the non-Newtonian model of the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method (FDLBM) is presented. The viscosity of the non-Newtonian fluid was given using the relaxation time and the external force. The channel flow between two parallel plates was calculated by using the constructed models. Normal stress plays an important role in the non-Newtonian viscoelastic fluid. The model which can generate the normal stress was also constructed in the same manner using the external force.
2
Numerical method
The original two-dimensional and three-dimensional isothermal models (the D2Q9 and D3Q15 model [9]) are presented briefly in section 2.1. The introduced non-Newtonian model is presented in section 2.2. The power-law model is introduced for the non-Newtonian purely viscous fluid. The power-law model has only two constant parameters, and can cover shear-thinning and shearthickening fluids [10]. The single mode Giesekus constitutive model is used for the viscoelastic fluid [11, 12]. The Giesekus model is a popular choice for several flows [13, 14]. For example, it is known that the Giesekus model is useful for describing processing flows of polymer solutions. 2.1 Finite difference lattice Boltzmann method (multi particle model) A discrete BGK equation for the FDLBM is written as follows with the distribution function fi k (x, t ) having the particle velocity ci
∂fi k 1 k + ci ∇fi k = − f − fi eqk φ i ∂t
(
)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(1)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
269
φ
is the collision parameter (the relaxation time) and f i eqk is the local equilibrium distribution function chosen to satisfy the Navier-Stokes equation (refer to [9]). Macroscopic variables on each lattice site are defined as
where
ρ k = ∑ fi k = ∑ fi eqk i ,k
∑ρ k
k
(2)
i ,k
u = ∑ f i k ci = ∑ f i eqk ci i ,k
(3)
i ,k
for, respectively, the density, the momentum. For the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method, the governing equation is discretized, so the corresponding calculation procedures are given as follows. The time integration is performed by the second-order Runge-Kutta method and the third-order upwind scheme is employed for space dispersion of ci ∇f i . 2.2 Non-Newtonian model 2.2.1 Power-law model The constitutive equation of the viscosity of the power-law model is given as
η = η0 γ
n −1
(4)
η0 and n are the parameters of the power-law fluid. n = 1 corresponds to the Newtonian fluid in eqn. (4). Then, η0 is the coefficient of the Newtonian where
viscosity. n > 1 corresponds to the shear-thickening fluid. n < 1 corresponds to the shear-thinning fluid which decreases the viscosity coefficient when the shear rate becomes larger. The shear rate γ has a relation to the symmetrical rate of strain tensor Dαβ as follows
γ = Dαβ Dαβ
(5)
∂u 1 ∂u Dαβ = β + α 2 ∂xα ∂xβ
(6)
where the subscript α and β represent the Descartes coordinates and follow the summation convention. The velocity gradient ∂uα ∂xβ was derived by using the second order central difference scheme. The power-law model is introduced to the collision parameter φ and the external force Fαpower −law as follows
φ = 3η
( D2Q9 ) ,
3 2
φ= η
( D3Q15)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(7)
270 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Fαpower −law = −
η1
∂ ∂xβ
∂u η1 α ∂xβ
∂ + ∂xβ
∂ uα η ∂xβ
(8)
is the original viscosity as the Newtonian fluid in eqn. (8). The above force is
introduced to the local equilibrium distribution function in eqn. (3) by replacing
∑ρ k
k
uα → ∑ ρ k ( uα + φ Fα )
(9)
k
2.2.2 Single mode Giesekus constitutive model Here the viscoelastic fluid model proposed by Giesekus is shown briefly. The constitutive equation is ∇
τ αβ + λτ αβ + α
λ τ τ = 2η0 Dαβ η0 αχ χβ
(10)
where τ αβ represents the stress tensor. The non-linear term τ αχτ χβ is a key role in the Giesekus model.
α
is the mobility factor ( 0 ≤ α ≤ 1) .
λ
is the relaxation
∇
time of the viscoelastc fluid. τ αβ represents the upper convected derivative as ∇
τ αβ =
∂τ αβ ∂t
+ uχ
∂τ iαβ ∂xχ
−
∂u ∂ui τ χβ − τ αχ χ ∂xχ ∂xβ
(11)
The above equations correspond to the Giesekus model with non-considering the infinitesimal viscosity in the shear rate γ → 0 . The Giesekus stress is introduced to the external force in the same manner with section 2.2.1. The total stress σ αβ of the Giesekus fluid is σ αβ = − Pδ αβ + τ αβ . Hence, the external force can be written as follows:
Fαgiesekus
3
=−
∂ ∂xβ
∂u − Pδαβ + η1 α ∂xβ
∂σ αβ + ∂xβ
(12)
Result and discussion
3.1 Channel flow between two parallel plates The channel flow between two parallel plates was calculated by using the two introduced power-law models. The exact solution of normalized velocity WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Normalized Velocity u/umean
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
271
0.5
0.4 0.3
n=0.50
0.2
exact solution Δy=1/20 (CP) Δy=1/40 (CP) Δy=1/80 (CP) Δy=1/20 (EF) Δy=1/40 (EF) Δy=1/80 (EF)
0.1
0 0
0.02
0.04
0.06
0.08
0.1
Normalized Distance x/L Figure 1:
Normalized velocity profile near one of two parallel plates. The power-law exponent of the fluid is n=0.50 (shear thinning). Full symbols correspond to the external force (EF) model, and blank symbols correspond to the collision parameter (CP) model not giving the extrapolation of non-equilibrium distribution functions on the plate boundary.
* uexa = uexa ( x ) uexa _ mean is written in eqn. (13). uexa _ mean represents the mean
velocity between two plates. n +1 n L−x 2n + 1 2 * uexa − + 1 ( x) = n +1 L 2
(13)
where L represents the distance between two parallel plates. The external force model could give us the satisfactory velocity distribution, but the collision parameter model made a discontinuity of the velocity distribution near boundary in fig.1. The velocity discontinuity on boundary is the conventional characteristic of the FDLBM. This problem is improved by the below-mentioned technique. The distribution functions fi k (x) on the plate boundary are given the extrapolation of non-equilibrium distribution functions as f i k (x) = f i keq (x) + 2 f i kneq ( x + ∆x) − f i kneq (x + 2∆x)
(14)
The calculation result with the above technique agreed with the exact solution even if using the collision parameter model (fig.2). The evaluation about the external force model is described below. The satisfied velocity distribution was obtained in the parameter n changed from 0.5 (shear-thinning fluid) to 1.5 (shear-thickening fluid) as shown in fig.3. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Normalized Velocity u/umean
272 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1.5
1
n=0.50
0.5
exact solution Δx=1/80 (CP) Δx=1/80 (EF)
0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
Normalized Distance x/L Figure 2:
Normalized velocity profiles between two parallel plates. The power-law exponent of the fluid is n=0.50 (shear thinning). Full symbols correspond to the external force (EF) model, and blank symbols correspond to the collision parameter (CP) model. The distribution functions on the plate boundary are given the extrapolation of non-equilibrium distribution functions.
The accuracy of the velocity distribution was checked. The error norm in the steady flow (the velocity fluctuation become smaller than 10-8) was defined as
∑ u ( x) − u ( x) error = ×100 ∑ u ( x) *
* exa
x
* exa
(15)
[%]
x
where u* ( x ) is the velocity normalized by the mean velocity. The shear rate is estimated by the second order and also fourth order central finite difference scheme. The error norm in the highest resolution of lattice was about 0.02%, but the accuracy of the velocity distribution is the first order as shown in fig.4. 3.2 Shear flow of two component fluids on gravity field The shear flow with the free surface is simulated by using the introduced Giesekus model. The moderate diffusion scheme proposed by Latva-Kokko and Rothman [15, 16] was introduced to the FDLBM in order to simulate the behaviour of two immiscible phases. The governing equation (1) becomes
∂fi k 1 k + ci ∇f i k = − f − f i eqk + f i k − fi ′k ∂t φ i
(
) (
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
)
(16)
Normalized Velocity u/umean
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
273
2
1
exact solutions n=0.50 n=0.75 n=1.00 n=1.50
0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
Normalized Distance x/L Normalized velocity profiles between parallel plates for different power indices by the external force model of the power-law fluid. The solid lines represent exact solutions.
Relative error [%]
Figure 3:
Figure 4:
101 nd
: 2th order center difference : 4 order center difference
th
4 order rd
3 order
0
10
2nd order
10-1 st
1 order
10-2 -2 10
Grid size ⊿x
10-1
Error norms of the channel flow between parallel plates with ∆x=1/20, 1/40, 1/80 by the external force model. ∆ represent results of the 2nd order central finite difference scheme for estimating the shear rate. ● represent results of the 4th order central finite difference scheme. The grey solid lines indicate inclines of the order.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
274 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII where f i ′k is the re- distribution function as follows: f i ′G = fi′N =
ρG
ρG ρ N f eqG (0) + f i eqN (0) ) cos ϕ 2 ( i ( ρG + ρ N )
i
ρN ( f G + fi N ) − κ ρ ρG+ρρN 2 ( fi eqG (0) + fi eqN (0) ) cos ϕ ρG + ρ N i ( G N)
i
ρG + ρ N
(f
G i
)
+ fi N + κ
(17)
where subscript N and G represent the components of the fluid. The parameter κ controls the thickness of interface. f i eqk (0) is the zero-vector local equilibrium
distribution function. ϕ represents the angle between the particle direction and normal direction of the interface. The angle was determined as follows:
cos ϕ i =
G ⋅ ci G ⋅ ci
G ( x ) = ∑ ci ρ G ( x + ci ) − ρ N ( x + ci )
(18) (19)
i
Fig.5 shows the three-dimensional calculation domain. The calculation grid was 9×31×31. The periodic boundary was employed in the x-direction, and the other boundaries were non-slip condition. The right side boundary in fig.5 moved at the velocity U0=0.05. Fig.6(a) is the pressure profile at the parameter α=1.0 and λ=10000. It is shown that the pressure near a right-hand side boundary becomes large by the normal stress produced by the shear. Such pressure distribution in the Newtonian fluid is not seen (fig.6(b)). When the calculation time passed, the calculation became unstable.
4
Conclusion
The model of the finite difference lattice Boltzmann method for non-Newtonian fluids was presented. For purely viscous fluids, the power-law model is introduced to the collision parameter and the external force. Some discontinuity of velocity distributions appeared by using the collision parameter model in the two-dimensional channel flow between parallel plates. The stability of calculation was not enough. The external force model allowed us to obtain smooth velocity distributions. The single mode Giesekus constitutive model for viscoelastic fluids was also introduced in the same manner as the external force model. The normal stress appeared in the shear flow on the gravity field. However, the calculation was unstable. In the future work, the infinitesimal viscosity of the Giesekus model will have to be considered for improving the stability of calculation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
275
Newtonian fluid
g z
y
U0
Giesekus fluid
x Figure 5:
Calculation domain (grid number 9×31×31). The boundary condition of x-direction is the periodic. The other boundaries are non-slip solid walls. The velocity U0=0.05. The Giesekus fluid is given the gravity force g=0.0001.
Newtonian fluid
Giesekus fluid
(a) Giesekus-Newtonian Figure 6:
Newtonian fluid
Newtonian fluid
(b) Newtonian-Newtonian
Comparison of the pressure fields between the Giesekus fluid and the Newtonian fluid. The parameter α=1.0, λ=10000.
References [1] [2] [3]
Qian, Y. H., Succi, S. & Orszag, S. A., Recent Advances in Lattice Boltzmann Computing, Ann. Rev. of Comp. Phy. (D. Stauffer ed.), World Scientific, pp. 195-242, 1995. Rothman, D. H. & Zalenski, S., Lattice-Gas Celluar Automata, Cambridge U. P., pp. 73-90, 1997. Chen, S. & Doolen, G. D., Lattice Boltzmann Method for Fluid Flows, Ann. Rev. Fluid Mech., Ann. Rev. Inc, pp. 329-364, 1998. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
276 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16]
S. Succi, The lattice Boltzmann Equation for Fluid Dynamics and Beyond, Oxford, pp. 51-123, 2001. Inamuro, T., Ogata, T., Tajima, S. & Konishi, N., A lattice Boltzmann method for incompressible two-phase flows with large density differences, J. Computational Physics, 198, pp. 628-644, 2004 Gabbanelli, S., Drazer, G. & Koplik, J., Lattice Boltzmann Method for Non-Newtonian (Power-law) Fluids, Phys. Rev. E, 72, 2005. Sullivan, S. P., Gladden, L. F. & Johns, M. L., Simulation of Power-Law Fluid Flow through Porous Media using Lattice Boltzmann Techniques, J. Non-Newton. Fluid Mech., 133, pp.91-98, 2006. Yoshino, M., Hotta, Y., Hirozane, T. & Endo, M., A Lattice Boltzmann Method for Non-Newtonian Fluid Flows, Japan Society for Computational Methods in Engineering, 6(2), 2006. Tsutahara, M., Takada, N. & Kataoka, T., Lattice Gas Method & Lattice Boltzmann Method, Corona-sya, pp.101-112, 1999; in Japanese. Nakamura, K., Non-Newtonian Fluid Mechanics. Corona-sya, pp.68-71, 1997; in Japanese Giesekus, H., A Simple Constitutive Equation for Polymer Fluids Based on the Concept of Deformation-dependent Tensorial Mobility, J. NonNewton. Fluid Mech., 11, pp.69-109, 1982. Giesekus, H., Stressing behaviour in simple shear flow as predicted by a new constitutive model for polymer fluids, J. Non-Newton. Fluid Mech., 12, pp.376-374, 1983. Yoo, J. Y. & Choi, H. Ch., On the steady simple shear flows of the onemode Giesekus fluid, Rheologica Acta, 28, pp.13-24, 1989. Mostafaiyan, M., Khodabandehlou, K. & Sharif, F., Analysis of a viscoelastic fluid in an annulus using Giesekus model, J. Non-Newton. Fluid Mech., 118, pp.49-55, 2004. Latva-Kokko, M. & Rothman, D. H., Diffusion properties of gradientbased lattice Boltzmann models of immiscible fluids, Phys. Rev. E, 71, 2005. Latva-Kokko, M. & Rothman, D. H., Static contact angle in lattice Boltzmann models of immiscible fluids, Phys. Rev. E, 72, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
277
Experimental measurements for the control of a vortex shaft theoretical model G. Ciaravino, L. Ciaravino & G. Pulci Doria Department of Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering, “G. Ippolito”, University of Naples Federico II, Italy
Abstract With reference to the hydrodynamic working of a dropshaft fitted with a vortex inlet, there are still two problems that are open to debate: the actual distribution of velocities at the inlet and the pressure distribution along the radius in the first cross section of the shaft. The majority of researchers assume that the velocity distribution is both irrotational and axially symmetrical, although some forty years ago Viparelli experimentally showed that such an assumption is actually incorrect, hypothesizing that the flow is symmetrical but not irrotational. Moreover, the determination of pressure distribution in the different proposed theories remains a debatable issue, with some claiming that the distribution of pressure is equal to zero while others maintain it is positive. In the present paper, two series of experimental measurements concerning the above-mentioned problems are analyzed. A first series of experimental tests performed with a Laser Doppler Anemometer confirms a different velocity distribution hypothesis: irrotational but not entirely symmetrical. A second series of experimental tests deals with pressure measurements made in the vertical shaft inlet. Contrary to what has been hypothesized by other researchers, these measurements indicate negative pressure values. Keywords: dropshaft, vortex flow, mathematical model, experimental measurements, Laser-Doppler Anemometer.
1
Introduction
Inflow in a dropshaft with vortex inlet is a rather complex phenomenon which still presents certain issues that have not been fully clarified. In spite of this such device is of great interest because of its undeniable technical importance. Its WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070291
278 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII inventor Drioli [1], and increasing numbers of authors thereafter (i.e. [2–9]) have investigated the vortex inlet with seemingly different procedures that can, however, be traced back to a single template. Nevertheless, the definition of the actual velocity distribution in the inlet chamber and the pressure distribution along the radius r in the first cross section of the shaft remain controversial issues. In particular the characteristic quantities of Drioli’s inlet are as follows (see fig. 1): - ∆: distance between the two axes of inflow channel and of vertical dropshaft; - h: stream depth in the inflow channel; - H: total energy (head) in the inflow channel; - b: width of the inflow channel; - δ: characteristic dimension of the inlet; - R: radius of the shaft; - ro: internal radius of the vortex in section 0-0 (see fig. 1); - Vt(r): tangential velocity in the section 0-0; - A or C: kinetic constant; - p(r): pressure in the section 0-0; - Q: flow rate discharged. A
Sec. A-A b
ro P1 h P4
P2
0
P3
P1
0
P3
R A
Figure 1: Typical Drioli vortex-flow inlet. Furthermore, the equations considered by the various authors are as follows: 1) Bernoulli’s equation for the definition of total head H; 2) the equation of flow rate:
(
)
Q = 2π 2g ∫r H − (p / γ ) − Vt2 / 2g ⋅ r ⋅ dr ; o R
(1)
in which Vt and the integral are determined in the section 0-0 while r is the generic radius in that section; WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
279
3) the equation needed for the calculation of ro determined either by means of experimental data or by means of the principle maximum flow rate which provides (i.e. Knapp [5]): ro = A / 2gH ;
(2)
4) the equation of continuity or the equation of momentum; the latter leads (i.e. Viparelli [3]) to the determination of the following formula: A=
Q∆ ; bh
(3)
5) the distribution of tangential velocity provided either by: Vt (r ) = C ;
(4)
which represents a constant distribution, or by: Vt (r ) = A r ;
(5)
which represents an irrotational distribution; 6) distribution of pressure p(r) along the radius ro in the section 0-0 provided either by: p( r ) γ = 0 ;
(6)
or by:
(
)(
)
p(r ) γ = A 2 2g ⋅ 1 ro2 − 1 r 2 .
(7)
As far as the velocity distribution is concerned, the overwhelming majority of authors hypothesizes that motion is irrotatational throughout the field and therefore assumes the characteristic expression of irrotatational flow shown in eqn. (5). Adopting eqn. (4) would contradict the hypothesis of irrotational flow. In actual fact, the velocity distribution in the curve of type Vt = constant mentioned by Ramponi [10] refers to secondary motion arising in the curve when the velocity before the curve is no longer constant in the straight section as a result of friction with the channel walls and, therefore, the motion is already no longer irrotataional. Viparelli [3] bases his reasoning both on eqn. (4) and on eqn. (5): even if Viparelli assumes eqn. (4) nevertheless continues to refer to the validity of Bernoulli’s equation which requires motion to be irrotational. Furthermore, the tangential velocity distribution of eqn. (5) combined with the equation of momentum (3) provides Viparelli with values of A that are so high as to make the flow rate expression imaginary, forcing Viparelli to arbitrarily WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
280 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII reduce the value of A (thus effectively negating the validity of the momentum equation). Nor it is possible to share Knapp’s hypothesis [5] which introduces ∆+b/2 instead of ∆ into eqn. (3). Given the uncertainty of the hypothesis, Pica [7] suggests using eqn. (4) as it makes the process simpler to deal with. As regards the pressure distribution along the radius in the first cross section of the shaft, the authors investigating this issue fall into two broad groups. On the basis of experimental measurements, Viparelli [3], Knapp [5] and Pica [7] hold eqn. (6) to be valid, theoretically justifying this position with the hypothesis of a balancing of the outward centrifugal forces (caused by the curvature of the trajectories in the horizontal plane 0-0, reported in fig.1) with the inward centrifugal forces (caused by the curvature of the trajectories in vertical planes). Binnie and Hookings [2], Ackers and Crump [4] and Adami [6], on the other hand, believe that only the curvature in the horizontal plane should be taken into account and, therefore, although different schemes are considered, they hypothesize a pressure distribution reported in eqn. (7).
2
Velocity distribution analysis
Almost all the models assume motion to be irrotataional and symmetrical to the vertical axis of the vortex shaft. Only Viparelli [3] and Pica [7] assume there is symmetry with respect to the so-called core of the vortex (the free space in the proximity of the shaft axis through which a continual supply of air is known to pass, thus preventing the closure of the vortex) whose axis turns out in their tests not to perfectly match the vertical axis of the shaft. The hypothesized symmetry generally requires the values of the three velocity components Vr, Vθ and Vz (in cylindrical coordinates r, θ and z, where the z axis is shared with the vertical axis of the vortex) to be constant along circumferences lying on horizontal planes or on arcs of these circumferences up to the point where they meet the solid wall: this makes it possible to define a symmetrical behaviour also for a system that is geometrically non-symmetrical. The three components of the rotation vector Ω along the three axes z, r, and t (the latter normal to z and r in the considered point) can be written as follows: Ωr =
1 ∂Vz ∂Vt − ; ∂z r ∂θ
(8)
∂Vz ∂Vr + ; ∂r ∂z
(9)
Ωt = −
Ωz =
∂Vt 1 ∂Vr Vt − + . ∂r r r ∂θ
(10)
If the hypotheses of symmetry and irrotationality are assumed to be simultaneously verified, then it must be true that:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
281
∂Vt =0; ∂z
(11)
∂Vz ∂Vr = ; ∂r ∂z
(12)
∂Vt V =− t . ∂r r
(13)
The first of these relations tells us that Vt must be constant along every vertical. Since, by symmetry, Vt must be constant along every circumference (r=constant, z=constant) it follows that Vt must be constant along every cylinder of axis z. Furthermore, the third relation makes it possible to determine the law of velocity distribution of eqn. (5) by means of simple integration. However, the experimental measurements of Viparelli (who moreover did not take precise velocity measurements) do not verify this velocity distribution. From his observations, Viparelli therefore has inferred that a law of eqn. (5) could not be verified and Viparelli has completed his model after abandoning the hypothesis of irrotationality. Relinquishing the hypothesis of irrotational flow moreover seems to be a solution requiring suitable analyses as no other author (except, as already mentioned, Pica) has gone down this road. In actual fact, the other authors have assumed a velocity distribution of eqn. (5) leaving the contradiction of experimental data highlighted by Viparelli still unsolved. In their studies directed to formulate a new mathematical model on the hydraulic working of vortex shaft, Ciaravino et al. [8] have examined a different velocity distribution based on the renunciation to the symmetry hypothesis rather than on the renunciation to the irrotationality hypothesis. If the symmetry hypothesis is abandoned also the following position is abandoned: ∂Vr =0. ∂θ
(14)
Therefore a relation of the following type can be hypothesized in the whole flow field: ∂Vr = k ⋅ VΑ = cos t ≠ 0 ; ∂θ
(15)
where VA is the velocity in the inlet channel. Starting from the irrotational flow condition, eqn. (13) becomes: ∂Vt V 1 ∂Vr =− t + . ∂r r r ∂θ
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(16)
282 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Taking eqn. (15) into account, after the integration it is simple process to obtain: Vt =
A A + k ⋅ VΑ = + B . r r
(17)
It is interesting to observe that eqn. (17) is also obtained by Viparelli, not starting from eqn. (15) but by assuming non-irrotatational flow. In actual fact, Viparelli sees the term kVA as representing the motion rotation value rather than the contribution of Vr which contrasts the rotationality generated by Vt. Moreover, it is possible to hypothesize the existence of a second type of asymmetry on the basis of the fact that the inlet chamber wall gradually draws closer to the shaft axis: this determines ever smaller sections for the passage of the annular flow. This appears to bring about rises in the free surface (measured experimentally) and an increase in velocity, even when there is a decrease in the flow rate determined by the centripetal flow entering the shaft. The assumed increase in tangential velocity can be taken into account (in a first approximation) by adding a linear term in θ to the velocity distribution shown in eqn. (17), so that the tangential velocity Vt is expressed by: Vt =
A + B+ kθ ⋅θ . r
(18)
The decision to assume either the tangential velocity distribution of eqn. (5) or that of eqn. (18) requires considerable differences also in the definition of the distribution of radial velocity Vr. Thus introducing eqn. (5) or eqn. (18) into eqn. (17) yields, in the two different cases, by integrating with respect to Vr: Vr = Vro (r ) ; Vr = Vro (r ) + B ⋅ θ + k θ
(19) θ2 . 2
(20)
In the first case a symmetrical radial velocity distribution is verified (the θ terms are missing) dependent on r; in the second case, in addition to the dependence on r there are two extra θ terms, one linear and the other quadratic, which introduce the presumed asymmetry of motion. In order to verify which of these two velocity distributions is closer to reality, a series of preliminary experimental measurements of velocity have been taken inside the vortex (measurements which, as already mentioned, Viparelli did not have). Velocity measurements have been taken using a Laser Doppler Anemometer (LDA) on the experimental installation available at the Department of Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering of the University of Naples Federico II [9]. These tests have been conducted with a flow rate of 0.049 m3/s and with two alignments (orthogonal to the axis of the inlet channel) placed in a horizontal plane at a height of 0.06 m from the bottom of the shaft. This position WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
283
has made it possible to achieve measurement points with conditions of movement that have been disturbance free both on the bottom and on the free surface. The distance from the shaft axis of the two alignments has been 0.115 m (for the inner one) and 0.150m (for the outer one). The first of these two distances has allowed the first alignment to be taken as close as possible to the shaft axis without interfering with the free surface. The second distance has allowed the second alignment to be tangential to the vertical cylinder that is the ideal continuation of the vertical shaft receiving the flow. Therefore, velocity measurements have been taken in different points of each of the two alignments. Under these conditions the measured velocity component is a combination of the Vr and Vt as a function of the considered alignment point. The measured component V(θ) (indicated by the value θ of the angular coordinate) is orthogonal at that point to the alignment and therefore: V(θ) = Vt sin θ − Vr cos θ .
(21)
For negative values of the angle θ it is alternatively possible to write: V(−θ) = − Vt sin θ − Vr cos θ .
(22)
Consistently with Viparelli’s observations [3], the simultaneous hypotheses of symmetry and irrotationality have given rise to incongruences in the interpretation of the results obtained from the experimental velocity measurements. In actual fact, introducing the expressions of Vt and Vr derived from eqn. (5) and eqn. (19) (valid for the simultaneous hypotheses of symmetry and irrotationality) into eqn. (21) and eqn. (22) yields: V(θ) =
A sin θ − Vro (r ) cos θ ; r
V(− θ ) = −
A sin θ − Vro (r ) cos θ . r
(23)
(24)
Adding these relations member by member, it is a simple process to obtain: Vro (r ) = −
V(θ) + V(−θ) . 2 cos θ
(25)
The latter expression makes it possible to determine the distribution of the radial velocity component orthogonally to the considered alignment. The results of the calculations performed with eqn. (25) turn out to be incongruent as – in the field where the two adopted alignments overlap – they return substantially different and non-matching radial velocity values that are such as to put in crisis the hypothesis of simultaneous symmetry and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
284 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII irrotationality. If, on the other hand, the validity is assumed of eqns (18) and (20), which abandon the symmetry hypothesis, then the same methodology used above provides: θ2 A cos θ ; V(θ) = + B + k θ ⋅ θ sin θ − Vro (r ) + B ⋅ θ + k θ 2 r
(26)
θ 2 A V(− θ ) = − + B − k θ ⋅ θ sin θ − Vro (r ) − B ⋅ θ + k θ cos θ ; 2 r
(27)
Vro (r ) = −
V(θ) + V(− θ ) θ2 + k ⋅ θ ⋅ tgθ − 2 cos θ 2
.
(28)
The results of the calculations made using eqn. (28), with k = 0.236, point to a good coincidence of the radial velocity component values calculated in the field where the two chosen alignments overlap. At this level of investigation it therefore seems reasonable to assume a velocity distribution represented by eqns (18) and (20).
3
Pressure distribution analysis
Viparelli’s experimental measurements [3] indicate zero pressure values in the section 0-0 (fig.1) thus justifying eqn. (6) (as Knapp [5] and Pica [7] do), while the measurements of Binnie and Hookings [2] return positive values, thus justifying eqn. (7) (as Ackers and Crump [4] do). In order to account for this difference, it can be assumed that Viparelli’s section 0-0 does not match that of Binnie and Hookings. Viparelli’s section is probably very close to the edge of the inlet with the result that the curvatures in the vertical planes acquire greater value while the pressure can be evaluated using eqn. (6) only in that part of the shaft in which the radius of the vortex core no longer changes, i.e. just below the inlet channel (moreover, in this case the value of H to be inserted into the equations should be slightly higher than the one supplied by eqn. (1)). Moreover, as far as Adami [6], the distinction between eqn. (6) and eqn. (7) refers only to the theory for flow rates beyond critical value. The criteria adopted with eqn. (6) (i.e. Knapp [5]) result in the calculated flow rate values being systematically and significantly lower than the experimental ones. On the other hand, the adoption of eqn. (7) leads to even smaller flow rate values which are therefore even further from the experimental data. Then it has been considered that the section 0-0 (in which the edge effect must be felt) has a negative pressure distribution. Such pressure distribution results in even higher velocity values. Therefore, if the values of the tangential velocity components Vt WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
285
are fixed in the computation model, the increase in the vertical components Vz results in an increase in the calculated flow rate. Adequate negative pressure values can therefore account for the flow values measured experimentally. In particular, it has been decided to use a pressure distribution law which, when inserted into eqn. (2), facilitates its integration. In effect the trajectories are curved both in the plane of section 0-0 and in vertical planes: the two curvatures determine centrifugal forces which are opposing and, therefore, they have an opposite effect on the pressure value in the section 0-0. The experimental data (table 1) can be interpreted to show that the influence of curvatures in vertical planes can be prevalent and, therefore, negative pressure can be verified (even if not along the entire perimeter with the higher flow values). Consequently it has been assumed, in alternative to eqn. (6) or eqn. (7), that: p B2 = γ 2g
1 1 − ; r 2 ro2
(29)
where B is a constant value which has to be determined. In actual fact, if r = ro, eqn. (29) yields that p/γ is zero; if r > ro, p/γ is negative. In conclusion, it can also be noted that the pressure measurements (taken at the four points P indicated in fig. 1 and reported in table 1 in water column) constantly show a tendency towards an eminently asymmetrical distribution. Table 1: Q (m3/s) 0.0010 0.0052 0.0160 0.0260 0.0380 0.0490 0.0580 0.0690 0.0790
4
P1 (m) -0.0030 -0-0028 -0.0027 -0.0027 -0.0025 -0.0020 -0.0016 -0.0010 -0.0005
Experimental tests. P2 (m) - 0.0003 - 0.0012 - 0.0013 - 0.0014 - 0.0015 - 0.0017 - 0.0018 - 0.0024 - 0.0025
P3 (m) -0.0015 -0.0006 -0.0015 0.0005 0.0012 0.0021 0.0027 0.0041 0.0048
P4 (m) -0.0008 -0.0003 0.0000 0.0002 0.0004 0.0005 0.0010 0.0015 0.0018
Conclusions
The theoretical analysis, performed using experimental tests, shows how the flow in a vortex shaft, contrary to the hypotheses made by all the other authors, is asymmetrical and has negative pressures in the inlet section. Above all in the initial part of the vortex flow (which is the one examined with the reported preliminary tests), the tangential velocities are accelerated, a characteristic which is reflected in particular trends of radial velocities which are once again nonWIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
286 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII symmetrical. The asymmetry of the vortex motion and the negative pressure in the inlet section are able to justify certain experimental incongruences reported by some of the cited authors and make it possible to formulate a theory of hydraulic working (on the basis only of the geometric data of the outlet device and the water depth in the inflow channel) which leads to determine flow rates and discharge coefficients that are consistent and in good agreement with the experimental measurements. The results obtained through the analysis of a limited number of experimental tests certainly need to be verified by extending the measurements to the entire flow field and to a larger number of measurements regarding the pressure distribution in the inlet section. It can nevertheless be concluded that an increased accuracy in the quantitative assessment of current theoretical models on the hydraulic working of vortex shafts can only be assured by taking the asymmetry hypothesis into account.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9]
[10]
Drioli, C.,Su un particolare tipo di imbocco per pozzi di scaricoScaricatore idraulico a vortice, L’Energia Elettrica, pp. 447-463, ottobre 1947. Binnie, A.M. & Hookings, G.A., Laboratory experiments on whirlpools, Proc. Roy. Soc., Series A, Vol.194, London, 1948. Viparelli, M., Su un particolare tipo di imbocco e sull’efflusso con vortice, L’Energia Elettrica, Vol. XXVII(10), pp. 610-621, October 1950. Ackers, P. & Crump, E.S., The vortex drop, Institution of Civil Engineers, Vol.16 (4), pp. 433-442, august 1960. Knapp, F.H., Aufluss, Uberfall und Durchfluss im Wasserbau, Verlag G. Braun, pp. 502-517, Karlsruhe, 1960. Adami, A., Analisi del moto in uno scaricatore a vortice, L’Energia Elettrica, Vol. XLIV (7), pp. 406-410, luglio 1967. Pica, M., Scaricatori a vortice, L’Energia Elettrica, Vol XLVII (4), pp 217-234, aprile 1970. Ciaravino, G., Galasso, V., Mancini, P. & Pulci Doria, G., A mathematic model for vortex shaft. Theory and experimental control, Congress IAHRAIRH, Lausanne, 1987. Ciaravino, G. & Pulci Doria, G., Rilievi iniziali con LDA delle distribuzioni di velocità in un pozzo a vortice, II Simposio sull’anemometria Laser Doppler nella sperimentazione idraulica, Napoli, 28-29 marzo 1988. Ramponi, F., Sul moto dell’acqua nei canali aperti ad asse curvilineo, L’Energia Elettrica, aprile 1940.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
287
Stability of stratified spin-up flows S. A. Smirnov Mechanical Engineering Department, Texas Tech University, USA
Abstract The stability of stratified rotating flows is investigated by means of laboratory experiments in axisymmetric cylindrical and annular containers with both horizontal and sloping bottoms. The baroclinic current is initiated via incremental spin-up/down of a linearly stratified fluid by an abrupt change in the rotation rate of the system (from Ω ± ∆Ω to Ω). The flow stability depends on the characteristic values of the Rossby number, ε = ∆Ω/Ω, and the Burger number, Bu = NH/fR, where f = 2Ω is the Coriolis parameter, R is the characteristic horizontal length scale of the flow, H is the depth of the fluid layer, and N is the buoyancy frequency. Particular attention is given to the nonlinear flow regime (finite Rossby numbers). It is found that axisymmetric spin-up current loses its azimuthal symmetry when Bu < 1, and breaks into a system of large-scale cyclonic and anticyclonic vortices with a predominantly vertical axis of rotation. The eddies always develop at the density fronts formed by the corner regions adjacent to the sidewalls of the container. The corner regions reach a quasi-equilibrium state at the characteristic time scale E-1/2Ω-1 (where E = ν/ΩH2 is the Ekman number and ν is the kinematic viscosity), which is also observed for homogenous fluids. It is also shown that the stability of the spin-up flow is affected by the bottom slope. In the presence of the latter the bottom boundary layer experiences a qualitatively different behavior. While the density field demonstrates a smooth monotonic behavior in the case of stratified spin-up at all times, it reveals high-frequency fluctuations in the spin-down case, suggesting the turbulent nature of the bottom boundary layer. The results of observations may be found useful in interpreting in-situ measurements of upwelling- and downwelling-favorable oceanic currents in the littoral zones. Keywords: geophysical systems, rotating stratified flows, spin-up, flow instability.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070301
288 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Dynamics of the spin-up flow initiated by a sudden acceleration/deceleration of the fluid container presents a fundamental interest from the point of view of the flow stability. Spin-up problem addresses an important question of how the torque exerted by the sidewalls of the fluid container is transmitted throughout the bulk of the rotating fluid. Although, the final condition of the fluid system is obvious – a new solid-body rotation state – it is far less clear what “routes” lead to this state. Spin-up in a homogeneous fluid has been extensively studied in the past (e.g., Greenspan [1], Duck and Foster [2]). It was shown that flow dynamics depends on the relative value of the Rossby number, ε = ∆Ω/Ω. The flow evolution is governed by the Ekman layers formed on the top and bottom of the container. They initially convey the fluid towards the sidewalls into the Stewartson boundary layers. Passing through the boundary layers, fluid parcels roughly attain a new angular velocity of the container before moving into the interior. This secondary circulation is responsible for global spin-up of the fluid which is achieved at the homogeneous spin-up time scale E-1/2Ω-1. In a stratified fluid gravity force limits the vertical fluid velocity and influences the secondary circulation. Flow dynamics is characterized by an additional parameter, the Burger number, Bu = NH/fR. The initial phase of stratified spin-up is similar to that of homogeneous spin-up (Benton and Clark [3], Buzyna and Veronis [4], Holton [5], Pedlosky [6]). Near-bottom heavy fluid is transported radially outward causing a strong deformation of isopycnals (surfaces of constant density) near the outer wall. This process is called upwelling. Stratified spin-up problem has been examined for different flow regimes in ε-Bu parameter space, but the flow instability that breaks the axial symmetry was observed only for incremental spin-down (Hewitt et al [7, 8]) or highly nonlinear spin-up from rest, when ε = 1 (Flor et al [9, 10]). Nonaxisymmetric stage of incremental spin-up of a stratified fluid received special attention only recently (Kanda [11], Smirnov et al [12]). The formation of largescale eddies through the development of non-axisymmetric instabilities provides an alternative “route” in a stratified fluid for the transport of angular momentum from solid boundaries to the bulk of the fluid. This mechanism reduces the spinup time making it significantly less compared to the viscous time scale E-1Ω-1. In the present paper we report on the cases of flow instability during incremental stratified spin-up and the conditions under which a sloping bottom topography may serve to stabilize the flow. Analysis of the boundary layer formed by an upwelling-favorable flow shows that buoyancy forces are always important unless Bu = 0 (MacCready and Rhines [13]). In the presence of a sloping bottom buoyancy inhibits the cross-slope transport. The density field redistribution in the horizontal plane due to the cross-slope transport establishes vertical shear through the thermal-wind balance. The decrease of the upslope transport prevents the heavier fluid from reaching the corner regions and closing the secondary meridional circulation. Buoyancy forces weaken the stress at the bottom boundary (free-slip boundary condition) and, therefore, affect the spin-up characteristics. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
289
Experimental arrangements
Laboratory experiments were conducted in a cylindrical tank (radius R = 91 cm) positioned on a rotating table whose angular velocity was set within the frequency range (0.1 ≤ f ≤ 1.0 s-1) by a computer-controlled motor. The annular geometry was created by adding the second cylinder (radius R1 = 55 cm) concentric with the outer cylinder. The bottom slope topography was modeled by an inverted cone (slope angle α = 100), which was centered inside a cylindrical container. The tank was stratified by salt using the standard two-bucket technique, so that the buoyancy frequency varied in the range, 0.5 ≤ N ≤ 2.0 s-1. The tank was covered with a transparent screen in order to reduce shear stress exerted by the air on the water free surface. The actual values of the stratification (N) and rotation (f) parameters were chosen to satisfy the condition Wf/N > H, i.e. the height of a vertically sheared baroclinic current always exceeds the depth of the fluid layer at a given location. Continuous stratification in the conical geometry was produced by two different methods. One method employed five fluid layers with uniform density increments. In this case the tank was stratified whilst at rest. The initial density profile always had a staircase shape, which was transformed into a linear one after three-four experimental runs. The second method employed a standard twobucket technique with a constant rate of filling, so that the tank can be stratified whilst rotating to reduce mixing. Measurements of the vertical density profiles were conducted prior to the beginning of spin-up in the center of the cone and at r/R = 0.54 in order to estimate the effect of a sloping boundary on the background density profile (fig. 1). These two density profiles were almost identical from the free surface to the bottom of the cone at r/R = 0.54. The density profile in the center of the cone preserved the same gradient over the next few centimeters and then started deviating sharply towards a constant-density profile (see almost flat curve in fig. 1) at the apex. The flow was visualized using a neutrally buoyant dye-tracer (thymol blue pH indicator). Its evolution was recorded from above with a camera rotating with the tank. Particle tracking velocimetry (PTV) technique was employed to collect the quantitative data on the fluid velocity at different vertical levels. Small (mean diameter 100 microns) neutrally buoyant polystyrene particles were used as the flow tracers. They were distributed uniformly at various depths and illuminated with a light source from the side. The resulting motion was recorded from above and processed using DigImage software. The change in the rotation rate of the tank was performed during a five-second-time interval, ∆t, and may be considered as impulsive (∆t << 2πΩ-1). The flow evolution was monitored for more than one hundred rotation periods. Conductivity measurements were conducted using several four-electrode micro-scale conductivity probes. The data was collected using a computercontrolled acquisition system with a frequency of 10 Hz. The voltage recordings were instantly reproduced in a graphical format and converted into salinity (density) values using the calibration curves. Finally, salinity values can be recalculated into the isopycnal displacements, η. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
290 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 0.9 0.85
1
0.8
V, volts
0.75 0.7 0.65 0.6 0.55 0.5
2
0.45 0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
z, cm
Figure 1:
Dependence of the conductivity signal, V, on the vertical coordinate, z. Lines 1 and 2 represent the background vertical salinity profiles in the center of the cone (r/R = 0) and at r/R = 0.54 respectively. The water free surface is at z = 15 cm.
The accuracy of isopycnal displacement measurements was in the range ±0.1 cm. The probes were located at various depths and radial positions from the center of the tank, which allowed one to investigate the vertical and horizontal density structure of the flow. Estimates of the wavelength of the instability (number of eddies in the system) were obtained by positioning two probes at the same radial distance from the center of the cylinder and separated by a known distance in the azimuthal direction. Knowing the frequency of each signal as well as the phase shift between them, one can estimate the propagation speed and the wavelength of the instability.
3
Results
A typical unstable flow pattern formed during stratified spin-up in the annulus with a flat bottom is shown in fig. 2. The mean current is initiated in the clockwise direction. The dye tracer (dark bands) was introduced in the vicinity of both the outer and inner walls. The nature of the flow development in the annular region was found to be qualitatively similar to that in the cylinder. The dye streaks preserve their circular shape until t/T ≈ 30. After about forty-five revolutions of the tank the flow becomes unstable as evidenced by the formation of eddies (fig. 2b). Cyclones and anticyclones originate independently near the outer and inner walls respectively advecting with the mean flow. Their growth is limited by the width of the annular channel. Two systems of eddies finally interconnect and form one “vortex street” (fig. 2c). Eventually, the system has spun up to the new solid-body rotation state and the flow pattern consisting of eddies of opposite signs remains visible for several hours (fig. 2d). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Figure 2:
291
Stratified spin-up in the annulus. Top view. Parameters: ε = 0.12, Bu = 1.08. Dimensionless time: t/T = (a) 23.5, (b) 46.2, (c) 68.6, and (d) 111.8.
C A
Figure 3:
Magnified top-view image of the cyclonic (C) and anticyclonic (A) eddies formed during stratified spin-up in the annulus.
In fig. 3 a zoomed in image of the developed system of cyclones and aticyclones is shown with respect to the inner and outer sidewalls of the annulus which are located at the bottom and top parts of the image respectively. The direction of the spin-up current is again from left to right (ε = 0.167, Bu = 0.58, t/T = 37.5). Flow instability, when it occurs, is irreversible and has an explosive character. The growth of eddies continues until the whole flow field is occupied by a series of vortices with alternating signs. Their configuration sometimes has a peculiar form, like the one shown in fig. 3, where a large cyclone has a “tail” WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
292 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII attached to the outer sidewall and composed of two smaller vortices of opposite signs. This “tail” slides along the sidewall without separation following the cyclone. Non-axisymmetric instability is also clearly recognizable in PTV images. A typical example is shown in fig. 4.
Figure 4:
Velocity vector field and vorticity colour map representing stratified spin-up in the annulus. Top view. X and Y axes correspond to the azimuthal and radial directions respectively. The direction of the mean spin-up current is from right to left. Dark gray colour regions represent the negative (anticyclonic) vorticity. Parameters: ε = 0.107, Bu = 0.55, t/T = 48.1.
The orientation of the velocity vectors changes throughout the image deviating significantly from the purely azimuthal direction. This explains the “patchiness” of the vorticity field. Analysis of the density field evolution (not presented here) showed that eddies develop at the density front formed by the corner regions near the sidewalls. At this location the isopycnals experience the largest deformations as a result of the Ekman meridional transport. The latter makes the corner regions grow during the transient time E-1/2Ω-1, if Bu < 1, or Bu-1TS, if Bu > 1, until they reach a quasi-equilibrium height determined by the relative values of ε and Bu. The density structure of the corner regions was found to be the key factor in determining the stability of stratified spin-up flows. The evolution of the isopycnal displacements at a given location is shown in fig. 5 for the annular geometry. The tracking of the conductivity signal was conducted at three different depths and at the same distance form the center of rotation. Because all probes were located approximately in the middle of the channel, there is no pronounced increase or decrease of the density at early times. Undulations of the signals correspond to the developing instability. The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
293
instability develops in the form of eddies, which are represented by regular lowfrequency (about 0.1f) oscillations in fig. 5. Note that oscillations at different levels are practically in phase and the largest isopycnal deformation is registered closer to the bottom of the annulus, while its manifestation close to the free surface is relatively weak.
2
t/T 1 η/H
3
Figure 5:
Time evolution of the normalized isopycnal displacements during stratified spin-up in the annulus. Conductivity probes are distributed vertically at z = (1) 2.5, (2) 6, and (3) 10 cm from the bottom of the annulus (H = 12.5 cm is the total depth of the fluid layer) and positioned at r = 74 cm from the center of rotation. Time t = 0 represents the beginning of measurements, while the end of the flat region corresponds to the initiation of spin-up. Parameters: ε = 0.12, Bu = 0.7.
Stratified spin-up/down in a conical geometry appeared to be fundamentally different from the above cases. The flow evolution visualized with a passive dye tracer is shown in fig. 6a (stable regime) and 6b (unstable regime). The absolute values of the flow regime parameters, ε and Bu, were kept the same in both cases. The passive dye tracer, introduced near the bottom, follows the boundary-layer current. The difference in the flow patterns becomes clear after a few rotation periods. A system of relatively small and densely packed anticyclonic eddies spawns out of the initially chaotic distribution of the dye tracer. These eddies merge and finally form a system of much larger anticyclonic vortices (fig. 6b). Contrary to that, in the spin-up case the dye tracer dispersed by the shear flow preserves its axisymmetry even at very late times of the flow evolution (fig. 6a). The observations suggest that stratified spin-up flows remain stable at all times. A comparison of the vertical density profiles for positive (spin-up) and negative (spin-down) Rossby numbers shows that in the former case the density gradient decreases (compared to the background value) in the upper part of the fluid column and increases near the bottom, while in the latter case this tendency is reversed. This observation indicates to the existence of intensive mixing regions localized in the vicinity of the bottom boundary in the spin-down case. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
294 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (a)
(b)
Figure 6:
Stratified spin-up/down in the axisymmetric conical geometry. Top view. The block arrow shows the direction of the mean current. The radial distance between two concentric rings is 30 cm. Parameters: (a) spin-up ε = 0.3, Bu = 0.42, t/T = 41.5, (b) spin-down ε = − 0.3, Bu = 0.42, t/T = 22.6.
Figure 7:
Dye visualization of stratified spin-up in the shallow part of the conical geometry. Parameters: ε = 0.3, Bu = 0.46, t/T = 102. The distance between two marks along the radius is 3 cm. The dark band in the left bottom corner corresponds to the outer edge of the cone. The free surface intersects the sloping bottom at the location shown by the broken line.
The differences between spin-up and spin-down flow patterns may also be delineated through measurements of instantaneous vertical salinity profiles. It was found that the fundamental difference between stratified spin-up and spindown is manifested in the way the boundary layer behaves shortly after the change in the rotation rate of the container. In the case of spin-up the conductivity probe positioned inside the boundary layer registered a smooth and monotonic increase in density, while in the case of spin-down the registered signal experienced a large number of random high-frequency oscillations shortly after the beginning of spin-down. This observation suggests that the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
295
downwelling boundary-layer current becomes unstable and turbulent relatively fast, while upwelling boundary-layer remains stable at all times. This, in turn, leads to qualitatively different boundary conditions for the interior flow. The segment of the conical geometry shown in fig. 6 represents the mid-depth region of the flow domain, with the lower and upper circles being at 30 cm and 60 cm respectively from the center of the cone measured along the bottom of the tank. In general, the flow evolution is expected to be different in the deep and shallow parts of the flow domain and, therefore, the flow region where the sloping bottom intersects the free surface needs special attention as a potential source of flow instability. Experiments conducted with the dye tracer being introduced in the vicinity of the outer edge of the tank (fig. 7) showed that even after one hundred revolutions the stratified spin-up flow remains axisymmetric in this part of the conical geometry, which means that it is globally stable. It is also interesting to note, that in the case of spin-down the eddies do not form close to the outer rim of the cone, where the fluid reaches a new solid-body rotation relatively quickly because of the small depth of the fluid layer, but rather in the mid-depth section of the tank shown in fig. 6.
4
Conclusions
It was demonstrated that spin-up flows of rotating, continuously stratified fluid in axisymmetric geometries may become unstable at late times (several tens of rotation periods). The instability and formation of cyclonic/anticyclonic eddies may be suppressed by increasing Bu and decreasing ε. The eddy formation time decreases for larger ε and is independent of Bu (for the range of parameters investigated). Unquestionably the bottom topography plays a crucial role in setting up the density stratification and vertical shear in the bottom boundary layer that influences both the development of non-axisymmetric instabilities and global spin-up. If the characteristic “shutdown” time is relatively small, the heavier fluid may never reach the corner regions and the formation of the “corner jets”, which close the meridional circulation, does not occur. Thus, the slippery boundary condition should affect the global spin-up time of the interior fluid.
Acknowledgements The author is grateful to Professors H.J.S. Fernando and D.L. Boyer for the support of this research under ONR grant N00014-0-1-0626 and NSF grant OCE-0137197.
References [1] [2]
Greenspan, H.P., The Theory of Rotating Fluids, Cambridge Univ. Press: London and New York, 1968. Duck, P.W. & Foster, M.R., Spin-up of homogeneous and stratified fluids. Ann. Rev. Fluid Mech., 33, pp. 231, 2001. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
296 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Benton, E.R. & Clark, A., Spin-up. Ann. Rev. Fluid Mech., 6, pp. 257, 1974. Buzyna, G. & Veronis, G., Spin-up of a stratified fluid: theory and experiment. J. Fluid Mech., 50, pp. 579, 1971. Holton, J.R., The influence of viscous boundary layers on transient motions in a stratified rotating fluid: Part I. J. Atmos. Sci., 22, pp. 402, 1965. Pedlosky, J., The spin up of a stratified fluid. J. Fluid Mech., 28, pp. 463, 1967. Hewitt, R.E., Davies, P.A., Duck, P.W. & Foster, M.R., Spin-up of stratified rotating flows at large Schmidt number: experiment and theory. J. Fluid Mech., 389, pp. 169, 1999. Hewitt, R.E., Foster, M.R. & Davies, P.A., Spin-up of a two-layer rotating stratified fluid in a variable-depth container. J. Fluid Mech., 438, pp. 379, 2001. Flor, J.B., Ungarish, M. & Bush, J.W.M., Spin-up from rest in a stratified fluid: boundary flows. J. Fluid Mech., 472, pp. 51, 2002. Flor, J.B., Bush, J.W.M. & Ungarish, M., An experimental investigation of spin-up from rest of a stratified fluid. Geophys. Astrophys. Fluid Dyn., 98, pp. 277, 2004. Kanda, I., A laboratory study of columnar baroclinic vortices in a continuously stratified fluid. Dyn. Atmos. Oceans, 38, pp. 69, 2004. Smirnov, S.A., Baines, P.G., Boyer, D.L., Voropayev, S.I. & SrdicMitrovic, A.N., Long-time evolution of linearly stratified spin-up flows in axisymmetric geometries. Phys. Fluids, 17, 016601, 2005. MacCready, P. & Rhines, P., Buoyant inhibition of Ekman transport on a slope and its effect on stratified spin-up. J. Fluid Mech., 223, pp. 631, 1991.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
297
On the relation between geometric and flow properties of a miniaturized fluid oscillator J. O. Sotero-Esteva1, R. Furlan2 & J. J. Santiago-Avilés3 1
Department of Mathematics, University of Puerto Rico at Humacao, Puerto Rico 2 Department of Physics and Electronics, University of Puerto Rico at Humacao, Puerto Rico 3 University of Pennsylvania, Philadelphia, USA
Abstract A miniaturized fluid oscillator with no movable parts composed by a switching cavity, one inlet, two outlets and two feedback channels was studied. Examples of these devices have been built before and had shown oscillation of fluid flows ranging from tens of Hz for liquids to thousand of Hz for gases. The present work consists of a study of the flow within the device by means of a computer model. The computer model was built using COMSOL 3.3. It uses conventional Navier-Stokes equations numerically solved by Finite Element Methods. A new level of detail of the qualitative description of the flow within the device is achieved which allows for a better understanding of why some geometries produce better devices than others. It shows that homogeneous oscillation, not only depend on the direct force exerted by the feedback flow on the inlet stream, but also on the disruption of the Coanda's effect that diverts the stream towards one of the output channels. On the other hand, the quantitative part of the study serves to validate the simulation as well as a basis for proposing new empirical models. The quantitative measurements are consistent with a previously known mathematical model that describes the relation between frequency, input velocity and geometrical and physical properties. Ongoing testing with actual devices also supports the proposed operating mechanisms and models. Keywords: fluidic, flow control, flow meter, fluidic oscillator, finite element method, computer simulation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070311
298 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The miniaturized oscillator studied here is a structure without movable parts composed of cavities and channels. It can be used for flow control, flow measurement, and substance identification. They find applications in the areas of medicine, aeronautics and automotive industries among others. The use of macro sensors and actuators based on several designs of these oscillators can be traced back to 1960 when the demands for reliable controls for space and marine environments stimulated research in this area. A patent for a substance identification device using oscillators very similar to the one studied here was filled in 1963 and issued in 1966 [9]. The use of oscillators for the mentioned applications depend on relating their frequency response to factors such as the composition of the fluid, temperature, volumetric flow and variations in geometrical and other physical properties of the device. Most of the characterizations of fluidic devices found in the literature are based on experimental methods where actual devices are made and tested by varying the desired parameters. Most frequently the factors that are studied are those that require building one or a few devices for all tests. To study of the effect of geometry variations in the laboratory gets complicated by the fact that the researcher would have to build and test dozens, or perhaps hundreds, of devices. Up until recently computational testing methods were difficult to use as well. Limited software tools for numerical computations and visualization, lack of processor speed, and limitations in the mathematical modeling severely restricted the use of the computer for the study of these devices. Software libraries and simulation environments for solving systems of differential equations based on Finite Element Methods (FEM) such as FreeFem, ANSYS and COMSOL, among others, are now mature enough for such complex simulations. They have excellent visualization capabilities, automatic initial and adaptive meshing, scripting for automatic geometry design and graphical user interface (GUI) generation, and even parallel processing capabilities. In a "V" shaped device without feedback arms in which the inlet is placed at the junction and the outlets at the end of the upper arms the fluid flow tends to stick to one of the lateral walls due to the Coanda's effect. Fluid emerging from the inlet creates a partial vacuum just after entering to the switching chamber. A fluid vortex is formed in this low pressure region. The miniaturized fluid oscillator with no movable parts studied in this work is composed by a switching cavity, one inlet, two outlets and two feedback channels (see figure 1). The feedback channels divert part of the flow back to the junction, switching the flow to the other arm where the same event is repeated, thus creating the oscillations. Experimental results indicate that the operation of this type of fluid oscillator is a direct function of the length of the feedback loops and of the velocity inside of the interaction region. The main oscillation frequency modes range from tens of Hz for liquids (water, isopropyl alcohol and
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
299
A feedback fluid oscillator with one inlet nozzle, two feedback loops and two output channels.
acetone) to thousand of Hz for gases (nitrogen, argon, and carbon dioxide) [7]. Experimental evidence of internal flow oscillation with operation with water has also been reported in [5]. Simões et al. [8] analyzed a feedback oscillator numerically using ANSYS 5.7. They studied variations in fluid properties and proved the viability of using FEM based numerical methods for the simulation of fluid flow in these devices. This work is a computational study on how the positions and width of the feedback arms affect the oscillation patterns when water flows through the channels at low input speeds (< 200mm/s). All other geometry parameters are kept constant.
2
Analytical modelling
For subsonic or transonic flow, associated with quasi-laminar or turbulent regime, the frequency of oscillation is determined by: the time of interaction of the fluid in the feedback loop (τf), by the amplifier switching dynamics (τs), and by the flow-rate (u). In this case, the typical feedback oscillator can be designed to give a long linear range of frequency against velocity characteristics. The total oscillation time is described as in [8] as T = 2(τf + τs). The feedback transmission time is τf = l / c where, c is the wave propagation speed, l is the feedback loop length. The switching time is τS = ξ R / u where u is the jet velocity, R is the nozzle to splitter distance, and ξ is an empirical constant. If the duct is not small, the speed of wave propagation tends to the speed of sound. For liquids the speed of wave propagation is two to four orders of magnitude higher than the jet velocity in the nozzle-to-splitter path. Therefore, for a fixed geometry the following linear relation between frequency and input fluid speed holds:
f=
1 ξ = u. 2τ S 2 R
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(1)
300 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The oscillator frequency increases linearly with increasing volume flow. This behavior allows using of the feedback fluid oscillator for the measurement of the flow of Newtonian fluids. A feedback oscillator may exhibit many oscillation frequency modes. The conditions under which a device exhibits few modes is crucial for many applications. In this work the term properly designed device refers to a device in which the number of dominant oscillatory modes is low. Ideally, an oscillator should have only one dominant mode. Equation (1) describes a system with only one oscillation frequency; it implicitly assumes a properly designed device. Since the apparent flow in the switching cavity is far more complex than in the feedback arms, closely studying what happens inside the switching chamber is a crucial step in the design of properly crafted oscillators.
3
Simulation procedure
In order to simplify the computational effort a two dimensional model was used. The validity of the simplification is justified by the aspect ratio used in actual devices. The computer model was built using COMSOL 3.3 running on a Silicon Graphics Altix 350 with eight Itanium2 processors. Navier-Stokes equations were numerically solved by Finite Element Methods. 3.1 Mathematical model The incompressible Navier-Stokes equations [1, 11],
ρ
[
(
)]
∂u T + ρu ⋅ ∇u = ∇ ⋅ − pI + η ∇u + (∇u ) , ∂t ∇ ⋅u = 0 ,
where used. The density and the dynamic viscosity were set to ρ = 1000 kg/m³ and η = 0.001 kg/ms respectively, p is pleasure and I is the identity matrix. These are values commonly used in simulations of water when variations due to temperature and other factors are not to be considered. No force field and noslip boundaries were used. Zero pressure was initially set at the output boundaries and inward velocity uin at the input boundary. 3.2 Geometry The geometries are designed to resemble those used at previous experiments with actual devices (figure 2). The feedback channels have a constriction at the return joint that varies from 0.04mm to 2mm. The separation from the base of the switching chamber varies from 0mm to 4mm in 1mm increments. The rest of the dimensions are kept fixed. The input, output and feedback channels have a width of 2mm.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
301
Geometry, measurements, and distribution of triangles throughout the mesh.
The mesh used was generated by COMSOL 3.3. It is a triangular mesh with higher density of vertices around borders with high curvature. The distribution of vertices is neither uniform nor symmetric. The maximum length of a triangle edge in the mesh varied. A maximum of 1mm (shown in figure 2) was used for smaller flow rates. Denser meshes were used for higher flow rates. A Delaunay triangulation was adopted. 3.3 Simulation parameters A series of test runs were performed with a duration of three seconds of simulated time. From those tests it was determined that all devices that showed oscillations after one second were most likely to continue oscillating until the end of the test run. It was inferred that when a test case pass this point it is most likely to exhibit persistent oscillations, that is, it will keep oscillating during an arbitrary long period of time. It was also observed in the test runs that oscillatory behavior usually stabilized before that moment and that 1.5s of simulated time gives sufficient data to capture the main oscillation modes of the device. Simulated data was produced for 25 different geometries. Input fluid speed ranged from 50mm/s to 300mm/s in 50mm/s increases for a total of 150 runs of the simulation. The maximum fluid speed at the end of the output channels was measured every 0.05s. The transient analysis was performed using a default element type Lagrange P2P1, the state of the system is stored every 0.05s of simulated time. 3.4 Post-processing Two graphs were produced for each simulation. The first one is a plot of time versus the differences between maximal output fluid velocities at the end of the output channels at that time. The second was the Fourier Transform of the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
302 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII previous graph that gives information of the different oscillations modes of the device. The frequencies of the three most conspicuous peaks of this graph were registered. 3.5 Computational tools COMSOL Script was adopted in order to speed up the simulation process, allowing a more complete analysis of the influence of geometry of the device. Modules for geometry generation, definition of the model, automatic calling of meshing functions, setting of the model, time-dependent simulation functions and post-processing were written (see [9] for details). Those scripts were also useful for batch processing. A Graphical User Interface (GUI) was built on top of the modules (figure 3). The GUI integrates all previous functions and made possible a faster setup and manipulation of the simulation, especially for closer inspection of interesting geometries. .
Figure 3:
4
A Graphical User Interface (GUI) for feedback oscillator simulations and analysis.
Results and discussion
The discussion of results is organized in order of increasing detail. Each section considers a subset of the cases of the previous section. 4.1 Persistent oscillations All geometries exhibited persistent oscillations at the lowest volumetric flow tests (50mm/s). No persistent oscillations were found for input speeds over 200mm/s. In all cases in which the simulation stopped before the 1.5s mark a small and highly turbulent region that caused excessive numerical instability appeared when the simulation stopped. The position of that region does not seem to follow a pattern. Attempts were made to extend the simulation time on those cases for longer periods by refining and/or adapting the mesh but were WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
303
unsuccessful. A mathematical model that accounts for turbulence, such as the κε turbulence model, could produce longer simulations. But turbulence and patterns sometimes appear together in the same physical system [3], sometimes do not. The failure to converge in some cases may also reflect that there exist some combinations of properties that separate the devices in which both turbulence (oscillation) and pattern (persistence) appear from those where they do not appear The count of cases that showed persistent oscillations shown in table 1 is evidence against designing devices with a combination of wide feedback channel close to the inlet channel. Table 1:
Number of devices with persistent oscillations.
separation feedback width (mm) (mm) 0.4 0.8 1.2 1.6 2 1 1 1 1 0 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 2 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 2 2 2 total 14 8 8 10 10
(a) Figure 4:
total 7 7 9 15 12 50
(b)
Oscillations and frequency analysis of a (a) non-persistent oscillator device and a (b) device classified as properly designed.
4.2 Oscillation frequency modes A variety of oscillation patterns were observed in cases with persistent oscillations (figure 4). For each case, the six highest values of discrete Fourier transform amplitudes and their corresponding frequencies were tabulated. The main oscillation frequency was determined by selecting the frequency corresponding to the highest amplitude after discarding very low frequency modes (less than 5Hz). Averages over all the different geometries were WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
304 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII calculated for each input velocity. The graph of input velocity versus frequency (figure 5) shows an excellent agreement with the linear model in eqn (1) and the experimental observations. The variance in the data captures experimental noise as well as small variations produced by the changes in geometric measures. 50
frequency (Hz)
40 30 20 10 0 50
100
150
200
input speed (mm/s)
Figure 5:
The average frequency in all devices with persistent oscillations. The bars cover one standard deviation from the averages.
Table 2:
Properly designed devices by feedback separation and width.
separation (mm) 0 1 2 3 4 totals
0.4 0 2 0 0 0 2
0.8 0 0 0 1 0 1
feedback width (mm) 1.2 1.6 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2 2 1 1 0 2 3 2
totals 0 2 0 6 2 10
4.3 Proper designs As stated earlier, we define properly designed oscillator as an oscillator that has few dominant oscillatory modes; ideally only one such as the one in figure 4(b). The quantitative criterion used for classifying a geometry as a proper design was as follows: the value of the frequency for which the second highest discrete Fourier transform is less than half of the most dominant one. Ten devices satisfied the criterion (table 2) 4.4 Analysis of vorticity A closer inspection of the vorticity plots in the switching chamber reveals details of the physical mechanisms that determine why some combinations of geometries and input velocities perform better than others. As seen in figure 6, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
305
when the feedback arms are positioned where the eddy responsible for the Coanda's effect is located, the feedback flow not only exerts a force on the inlet stream but also disrupts the effect that keeps the jet attached to that wall.
5
Conclusions
From the analyses presented above the following conclusions are drawn about a feedback fluid oscillator. Proper positioning and width of the feedback channel are important in the design of the devices. The proper adjustment of these parameters leads to devices with a well defined oscillating framework. Homogeneous oscillations, not only depend on the direct force exerted by the feedback flow on the inlet stream, but also on the disruption of the Coanda's effect. Linear dependence between frequency and volumetric flow was confirmed for simulated water.
Figure 6:
Vorticity in the switching chamber of a properly designed feedback oscillator. Light shades indicate counter-clockwise rotation, darker shades indicate clockwise rotation. The arrows show the direction and magnitude of the velocity of the fluid at the middle of the feedback arm when entering the switching chamber.
Acknowledgements This work was supported by the US National Science Foundation through the Penn-UPR Partnership for Research and Education in Materials project (NSFDMR-353730) and by the US National Security Agency through the Humacao Undergraduate Research in Mathematics to Promote Academic Achievement program (NSA-H98230-04-C-0486).
References [1] [2]
Chorin, A.J. & Marsden, J.E., A Mathematical Introduction to Fluid Dynamics, Second Edition, Springer-Verlag: New York, 1990. COMSOL 3.3 User’s Guide and Introduction, Comsol AB, Sweden, 2006. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
306 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] [4] [5]
[6] [7]
[8]
[9] [10] [11]
Field, M, & Golubitsky, M., Symmetry in Chaos, A search for Pattern in Mathematics, Art and Nature, Oxford University Press: Oxford, 1992. Gebhardy, U., Hein, H. & Schmidt, U., Numerical investigation of fluidic micro-oscillators, J. Micromech. Microeng. 6 (1996) 115–117. Rogerio Furlan, Maria Lucia Pereira da Silva, Eliphas Wagner Simoes, Roberto Eduardo Bruzetti Leminski, Jorge J. Santiago Aviles, Visualization of internal liquid flow interactions in meso planar structures, Flow Measurement and Instrumentation, Vol. 17, No. 5, pp. 298-302, 2006. Gregory, J.W., Sullivan, J. P., Raman, G. & Raghu, S., Characterization of a micro fluidic oscillator for flow control, 2nd AIAA Flow Control Conference, Portland Oregon, June 28 – July 1, 2004, paper 2692. Simões, E.W., Furlan, R., Pereira, M.T., Numerical analysis of a microfluidic oscillator flowmeter operating with gases or liquids, Technical Proceedings of the Fifth International Conference on Modelling and Simulation of Microsystems, MSM 2002, ISBN: 0-9708275-7-1, pp. 36–39, 2002. Simoes, E.W., Furlan, R., Leminski, E.B., Gongora-Rubio, M.R., Pereira, M.P., Morimoto, N.I. & Santiago-Aviles, J. J., Microfluidic oscillator for gas flow control and measurement, Flow Measurement and Instrumentation, Vol. 16, Issue 1, pp. 7–12, 2005. Sotero Esteva, J.O., Furlan, R., Santiago Avilés & J.J., Simulation of miniaturized fluidic oscillators using COMSOL Script, Proceedings of the COMSOL Users Conference 2006, Boston, 2006. Testerman, M.K., McLeod Jr., P. C., Fluid oscillator analyzer and method, US Patent Office, patent #3273377, 1966. Zienkiewicz, O.C., Taylor, R.L. & Nithiarasu, P., The Finite Element Method for Fluid Dynamics, 6th edition, Elsevier Ed., Oxford, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
307
On-stream floodplain storage: experimental research G. De Martino, F. De Paola, G. Marini & A. Ranucci University of Naples Federico II, Department of Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering G. Ippolito, Italy
Abstract In order to achieve a reduction of flood wave peak discharge in a stream plain zone, it is often possible to take advantage of structural active measures consisting of flood plain storage which can be on-stream or off-stream, whose task is the temporary storage of water flood volumes with the consequent outflow of a discharge that is compatible with the hydraulic characteristic of a stream. For preliminary sizing of these measures, the hypothesis of uniform storage is made, and it is also possible to show it in the technical literature. In order to verify the reliability of the simplified hypothesis of uniform storage, in the Laboratory of the Department of Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering G. Ippolito of the University of Naples Federico II, the experimental prototype of on-stream floodplain storage has been installed and the tests have been carried out, by using a suitable electrical level probe in the inflow and outflow hydrograph reconstruction. The tests, managed by both varying the dimension of the free bottom outlet of the floodplain storage and its surface, have confirmed the reliability of the uniform storage hypothesis. Tests in the presence of obstacles, made of synthetic grass, on the bottom of the floodplain zone, are in progress to simulate the presence of vegetation, and therefore the possible influence of hydraulic resistances on the reliability still of the uniform storage hypothesis. Keywords: hydraulic risk mitigation, structural measures, floodplain storage.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070321
308 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The floodplain storage represents a structural active measure for the reduction of the flood wave peak discharge [1, 10, 16]. The storage and drainage phenomena of these infrastructures are of two-dimensional type and are, moreover, influenced by a lot of momentum exchanges that take place between the current in the main river bed and that in the expansion areas, as well as by the presence of possible obstacles and unevenness that induce localized resistances to the motion [21]. For a first hydraulic sizing of the floodplain storage, the uniform storage hypothesis is generally adopted, taking into account that the water surface maintains itself horizontal and parallel to the bottom [21, 17], without, therefore, considering the two-dimensional model. Such an assumption allows one to define a procedure of hydraulic sizing of the floodplain storage, based on the hypothesis of establishing in advance the hydrograph that try the storage [2, 8, 12, 18, 20, 22], and also on the use of a transformation inflows-outflows model for the definition of the critical rain duration. If the water level maintains itself horizontally during the filling of the floodplain storage it allows a meaningful simplification of the calculations, with the possibility to define sizing nomographs for a quick preliminary evaluation of the volume to assign for a fixed lamination of the flood. In a previous work [15], the Authors have reported the first results of test experiences run on a physical prototype of an on-stream floodplain storage with a surface of approximately 8 m2 and subsequently of approximately 30 m2, and it has been observed that, at least for a first dimensioning of the structure, the uniform storage hypothesis can be reliable. In the same job, besides, it was suggested to plan further experiences finalized to the evaluation of possible influence of marked resistances and patchiness on the storage-drainage phenomena. The possible presence of important resistances to motion and/or patchiness can in fact be present in a real situation because of the floodplain storage are infrastructures that don’t have a continuous functioning but these are tried by big water volumes just in a few occasions during their life. This means that we can have longer or shorter periods, but, however, in terms of years, in which the area destined to be invaded by water is the centre of morphologic transformations mainly due to the vegetation growth that can also be of high stem plants. The tendency of the last years, in fact, [24] is to realize the floodplain storages integrating themselves in the economic and social life of the area in which they are built; the huge areas destined to the flooding can be used for the most of their life for other purposes (cultivation, pasture, free time etc.). The next experimental research that will be presented in this paper is exactly aimed to verify the reliability of the uniform storage hypothesis in presence of marked obstacles due to the greater dimensions of the flooding surface and to the presence of important resistances.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
309
The presence of the vegetation involves essentially two problems: - a difference between the geometric storage volume and the useful volume to be invaded; - an obstacle to the water outflow that moves in the storage zones. The effect of the resistances to the motion, in general, when the water speeds are low in the river bed, is negligible, but the effect on the reduction of the geometric volume is no doubt to be taken into account [21]. When the areas to be invaded are affected by the movement of the water in a lengthwise direction to the bottom, the vegetation does offer resistance to the motion that can be evaluated with various procedures [4–6, 21, 23] that could invalidate the uniform storage hypothesis used in the dimensioning models.
2
Experimental installation
The prototype of the on-stream floodplain storage has been realized in the Laboratory of the Department of Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering "G. Ippolito" of the University of the Studies of Naples Federico II, and it is shown in detail in fig. 1. Such prototypes allow one to reproduce the hydraulic behaviour of an on stream floodplain storage equipped with a support structure made of a floodgate: in such a way the outflow of the flows to the inside of the channel occurs undisturbed until the water level gets almost to the bottom side of the floodgate, while the further increase of the discharge causes a sudden rise of the water surface, with the transition to pouring outflow, that allows the filling of the floodplain storage with contemporary reduction of the flood wave peak discharge. Upstream resistive probe Tank charge
Downstream resistive probe (configuration 2) Weir outflow coefficient µb=0.465
Downstream resistive probe (configuration 1 and 3) Flood gate (configuration 1 and 3) outflow hole height: 0.05 m outflow coefficient µb=0.612
Quiet wall Gate valve
a Channel width: 0.45 m height: 0.30 m
b
Floodpalin storage Configuration 1 and 3: flooding area: 69.20 m² Configuration 2: flooding area: 29.12 m²
Flood gate (configuration 2) outflow hole height: 0.05 m outflow coefficient µb=0.640
Figure 1:
Experimental installation scheme.
The installation (fig. 1) is made of a little charge tank in which the capacity needed for the tests is conveyed by a steel pipe and is regulated by a gate valve; from this tank, through a calibrated weir (µs= 0.465), the water comes in to the channel with rectangular section along which there is the obstruction with a floodgate that leaves a free outflow on the bottom, calibrated as well (µb= 0.640; 0,612). The presence of the floodgate induces a pouring of the flows and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
310 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII consequently the progressive storage of the water volumes in a properly embanked area. For the water level measurement, two resistive level probes are installed one in the tank charge and another one upstream of the floodgate. Further clarifications about the prototype description can be found in the previous work [15].
3
Experimental research
The tests dealt with the reconstruction of incoming and outgoing hydrographs from the storage floodplain, starting from the water levels measured by resistive level probes. The knowledge of the incoming flow to the system has also allowed an estimation of water levels, assuming the uniform storage hypothesis that have been subsequently compared to experimental values. The proposed numerical model for the estimation of flooding event is based on integration of the differential equation (1):
[
dh 1 = Qi − µblb 2 g (h − s 2) dt S ( h)
]
(1)
where S(h) is the flooding surface which is a function of water levels h reached in the storage area (uniform storage curve), lb and s are respectively the width and the height of the outflow in correspondence of the gate, g is the gravitational acceleration, Qi is the incoming flow calculated in the prototype by measuring water level up-flow the calibrated weir crest (with outflow coefficient µs). The first tests run on such prototype [15] show that the gap between experimentally measured water levels and the ones calculated with the proposed numerical model, based on integration of (1), are modest and therefore the uniform storage hypothesis seems reliable. The present note refers to the follow up of experimental studies on the same prototype described in paragraph 2 but modified in order to obtain three further configurations aimed to assign, possibly, a greater generality to the conclusions drawn previously: - configuration 1- The physical prototype is the one of fig. 1b essentially characterized by a flooding area (69,20 m2) more than twice the one used in the previous tests; - configuration 2- The physical prototype is the one of fig.1a with a flooding area of 29.12 m2 covered by synthetic grass to simulate the presence of vegetation on the flooding surface. - configuration 3- The physical prototype is the one of configuration 1 with the surface covered by synthetic grass. The configurations are numbered and shown following a logical and not chronological order, in fact: the first configuration is aimed to gain an understanding, in particular, which is the effect on flooding and draining events of the area, the second one, those due to the presence of high roughness and in the third configuration the two effects are concomitants. Hereafter we report the results about the examined configurations. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
311
3.1 Configuration 1 (the effect of the flooded area on the flooding and draining phenomena) To verify the possible influence, on the reliability of the uniform storage hypothesis, of the storage surface area on the modalities of flooding, some modifications were applied to the first experimental installation (fig. 1a) in order to increase, by repositioning some boundary banks, the flooding surface (fig.1b). Also, in this case the tests carried out have shown a good agreement among the experimental values and the ones obtained by numerical integration of (1); for example in figs 2 and 3 the results of one of numerous tests, in terms of hydrographs and water levels upstream of the floodgate, are shown. In the diagram of hydrographs is shown: with continuous line the incoming hydrograph to the storage (Qi), with broken line the outcoming one measured during the tests (Qu) and with dotted line the last one obtained by the numerical model proposed (Qu,num). In the water levels diagram the comparison is done between measured levels upstream the floodgate (hu) displayed with continuous line and the calculated with the numerical model one (hu, num) in broken line. The phase of filling is important for the sizing of the volume of the storage floodplain; but the emptying one is useless for understanding the flooding and draining events. The numerical model of uniform storage based on the integration of the (1) represents very well the filling phase of the box, but not the emptying one. Such a gap between numerical and experimental data in the final phase is to be referred to the increase of the surface plain-highness irregularities of the storage floodplain in comparison to the configuration of Fig. 1a.
Q [l/s]
80 70
Qi
60
Qu
50
Qu,num
40 30 20 10 0 0
100
Figure 2:
200
300
t [s]
400
500
600
Configuration 1: Incoming and outgoing hydrographs.
Such irregularities imply the formation of "backwater areas": a part of the water in the storage is held back and therefore the volume of water that flows to the prototype’s channel is reduced in comparison to the one actually held; this implies a more rapid decrement of the water levels in the channel with the final effect, that does not actually occur, of a more rapid emptying of the storage: in reality the floodplain storage, until the measurements can be acquired, is not completely empty but it keeps a certain amount of water in the "backwater WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
312 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII areas", that can be estimated with good approximation by the hydrographs integrating the inclusive area between the numerical curve and the experimental one considered in phase of draining. 50 hu hu,num
h[cm]
40
30
20 0
100
Figure 3:
200
300
t [s]
400
500
600
Configuration 1: water levels upstream the floodgate.
3.2 Configuration 2 (effect of the presence of vegetation on flooding and draining phenomena) In order to clarify the hydraulic aspects related to the presence of vegetation, tests have been carried out to estimate the effects of the same one on the modalities of filling the storage, aimed to verify if the hypothesis of uniform storage can be still reliable. The presence of the vegetation inside of the floodplain storage has been simulated by putting some synthetic grass, characterized by flexible leaves made of 100% poliolefine, type of fiber B-SOFT, height 55 mm, total height 57 mm, points/m2 11250, total weight 2665 g/ m2. In fig. 4 an overview of the prototype with covered surface and a detail of the synthetic grass used for the cover is shown.
Figure 4:
Overview of surface and particular of synthetic grass.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
313
As an example we report the results only in terms of water course level upstream the floodgate (fig. 5) about one of the many tests carried out. In the phase of filling, the presence of the vegetation induces a modest increment of water level in the channel in the case of absence of grass; this is due to the need that the water mass has to exceed the obstacle represented by the grass and to fill the storage. This involves a small gap between the experimental curve (hu) and the numerical one (hu,num) obtained by the model that does not consider the presence of the vegetation. In the phase of draining, the presence of vegetation involves a slower draining because of two concomitant effects: - the first, and marginal one, is due to the obstacle represented by the presence of the grass to the motion of the water: the measured water level in the channel are reduced with respect to the ones estimated by the numerical method by integrating the (1) that does not considered the presence of the grass; such an event, by itself does not justify the remarkable gap between experimental curve and numerical one; - the second one is due to the formation of “backwater areas”: part of the stored water is held back and therefore the water volume that flows to the channel is reduced with respect to the one actually stored; this implies a quicker decrease of water level in the channel with the final effect, not actually occurring, of a quicker draining of the storage: in reality the storage, until the measurements can be acquired, is not completely empty but it maintains a water part in the “backwater areas”. The withheld volume is estimable with good approximation starting from the diagrams of the hydrographs integrating the area included between the numerical curve and the experimental one considered in phase of draining. The final phase of the draining is interpretable applying the theory of the storage, probably not linear. In fig. 5 two significant points are shown, found during the tests: first (A), represents the moment in which the water it begins to submerge the grass, second (B) represent the first moment in which all the grass is submerged. The positioning on the curve of water level of these two points allows one to define three flooding phases: the first included between the initial point and the point A; the second one, included between the point A and the point B, is the starting phase of filling of the storage in which progressively the grass is submerged; the third, that goes from the point B to the beginning of the drain, is the one in which the storage is flooded, with the grass completely submerged. The increment of water level in time (the gradient of the curve) in the first phase is greater in comparison to the one of following phases because the surface of the channel is much lower than that one of the storage; the two following phases have a gradient much similar, and this allows one to guess that the hydraulic behaviour in the two cases is the same one. In the final phase of the flooding, in fact, the vegetation is completely submerged and therefore the motion is mostly developed without interacting with it. In phase A-B the motion happens evidently interacting with the grass, but, however, by observing section A-B we do not find differences regarding the following section; this is justified WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
314 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII by the fact that also in this case the resistances to the motion applied by the grass are definitely negligible because the speeds with which the water moves in the storage are modest. 3.3 Configuration 3 (effect of area influence and vegetation presence) Also the prototype flooding surface with a bigger area (fig 1b) was covered by synthetic grass (fig. 4), as described in the former paragraph, in order to obtain a configuration which could take into account the combined influence of the surface widening and vegetation presence. The results of one of the many tests run are shown in fig. 6. In the filling phase we found a similar behaviour to the one related to configuration 2 tests: the numerical – experimental gap between water level curves is due to the presence of the grass, the draining hydrographs matching is still good. In the draining phase the behaviour is similar to the one related to the previous configurations and, in particular, it is still present the phenomena of “backwater areas” caused by some irregularities linked to the widening of flooding surface and to the presence of grass. Dealing with the considerations related to the flooding phase which can be read on a water level diagram by applying the points A and B, what we said in the previous paragraph about configuration 2 is still valid. 50 hu
45
hu,num
B (43,6 cm)
h[cm]
40 35
A (35,5 cm)
30 25 20 0
50
Figure 5:
100
150
200 t [s]
250
300
350
400
Configuration 2: water levels upstream the floodgate.
55
hu
50
h[cm]
45
hu,num
B (44,3 cm)
40 35
A (32,2 cm)
30 25 20 0
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
t [s]
Figure 6:
Configuration 3: water levels upstream the floodgate.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
800
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
315
Conclusions
In a previous paper [15] the result was explained of an experimental research carried out on the physical prototype represented here in fig. 1a. In this paper it was emphasized of the good correspondence between experimental and numerical data obtained by the model based on the hypothesis of uniform storage and considering the flooding surface S of the storage not constant but function of water level h in the storage. The tests run dealt with three further different configurations: the first one in which the flooding surface of the storage is increased (fig.1b) with respect to the previous cases, the second one covered by synthetic grass to simulate the presence of vegetation on the surface of the storage and the last one in which the widening of the area and the presence of grass are concomitant. In the configuration with widened area and absence of grass the proposed numerical model approximates very well the experimental measures them during the phase of filling, not equally the phase of draining; in this last one, in fact, a marked theoretical-experimental gap is found that is explained by the creation of “backwater areas” in which the water temporary is hold back and then is given back slowly. In the configuration with small area and grassy covering the gap between the theoretical behaviour (based on the hypothesis of uniform storage) and that effective (experimental measures) is justified by two things: the obstacle created by the presence of the vegetation to the motion of the water and the presence of “backwater areas”. The first one justifies the modest mismatch that there is in phase of filling, the second, similar to what said before, is introduced in phase of draining. In the configuration with widened area and presence of grass, the deductions drawn for the other configurations were confirmed. In the cases with grass presence it is allowed to conclude that given the low speeds with which the water moves inside the storage, the existing hydraulic resistance to the motion produced by the vegetation is completely negligible: the hydraulic behaviour in the phase of filling in which the water progressively submerges the grass is very similar to what is developed in the case of completely submerged grass. In a few words, the filling of the storage is simulated by the numerical model with a higher precision rate in the configurations with absence of grass. This means that the numerical method, that considers the flooding surface S variable (stored curve), simulates well the presence of the patchiness in phase of filling; in fact the numerical-experimental correspondence is smaller in the configurations in which the stored curve is not enough to considered also the vegetation presence. In phase of draining, where the presence of or patchiness or vegetation is not contemplated by the stored curve, the numerical-experimental correspondence is lowered because of the macroscopic effect of the “backwater areas”. In conclusion the uniform storage hypothesis, on which the proposed numerical model is based, at least in the experimentations carried out, can be WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
316 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII used for the dimensioning of the storage since it allows one estimate values of the useful volume of the storage much closer than the effective ones.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11]
[12]
[13] [14]
[15]
Adami, “Casse di espansione fluviali - Aspetti idraulici” Atti del Corso di Aggiornamento del Politecnico di Milano: La difesa idraulica dei territori fortemente antropizzati, Milano, 1997. Editoriale Bios, (1998) A. O. Akan, “Detention pond sizing for multiple return periods”, ASCE J. of Hydr. Engrg., 115 (5), (1989), pp. 650-664 A. O. Akan, “Single outlet detention-pond analysis and design”, ASCE J. Irrig. and Drain Engrg., 115 (5), (1990), pp. 527-536 Armanini A.: Principi di idraulica fluviale. BIOS editore – Cosenza, 1999 Armanini A. Righetti M., Flow resistance in compound vegetated channel, ICHE 98 Advances in Hydro-Science and engineering, Cottbus, Berlin, Germany Sept. 1988 Armanini A. Righetti M., Flow resistance in open channel flows with sparsely distributed bushes, Journal of Hydrology, 2002, v. 269, p. 55-64 Armanini A. Righetti M. Grisenti P., Direct measurement of vegetation resistance in prototype scale, Journal of hydraulic research, 2005, v. 43, n. 5, p. 481-487 H. A. Basha, “Non linear reservoir routing: a particular analytical solution”, ASCE J. of Hydr. Engrg., 120 (5), (1994), pp. 624-632 H. A. Basha, “Routing Equations for Detention Reservoirs”, ASCE J. of Hydr. Engrg., 121 (12), (1995), pp. 885-888 L. Da Deppo, “Laminazione delle piene con casse di espansione”, Tecniche per la difesa dall’inquinamento, Ed. Bios, (1998) G. De Martino, D. Pianese, F. De Paola, N. Fontana, M. Giugni, “Considerazioni sulla redazione dei piani stralcio per la tutela del territorio dal rischio idrogeologico”, La difesa idraulica del territorio, Atti delle giornate di studio, Trieste, 1999 G. De Martino, F. De Paola, N. Fontana, M. Giugni, “Hydraulic design of on stream floodplain storages”, New Trends in Water and Environmental Engineering for Safety and Life, Maione, Majone Lehto & Monti (eds), Balkema, Rotterdam, (2000) G. De Martino, F. De Paola, N. Fontana, M. Giugni, “Sul dimensionamento di casse di espansione in linea”, 28° Convegno di Idraulica e Costruzioni Idrauliche, Potenza, (2004) F. De Paola, N. Fontana, “Alcune considerazioni sul dimensionamento idraulico di casse di espansione in linea”, L’efficienza e la vulnerabilità delle opere ed infrastrutture fluviali a seguito di eventi idrologici estremi, Attività svolta nell'ambito del PRIN 2000-2002, Castorani e De Martino (eds), (2005) F. De Paola, N. Fontana, A. Ranucci “Indagine sperimentale per la verifica del comportamento idraulico di casse di espansione in linea”, XXX Convegno di Idraulica e Costruzioni Idrauliche, Roma 2006 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[16]
[17] [18] [19] [20] [21] [22] [23] [24]
317
V. Ferro, M. Santoro, “Fondamenti teorici e recenti acquisizioni nel settore delle sistemazioni dei bacini idrografici” Università di Palermo – Dipartimento di Ingegneria e Tecnologie Agro-Forestali, Dipartimento di Ingegneria Idraulica e Applicazioni Ambientali, (1999) U. Maione, “Le casse di espansione”, Linee guida per la progettazione delle casse di laminazione. Autorità di Bacino del Fiume Arno, (2000) B. M. McEnroe, “Preliminary sizing of detention reservoirs to reduce peak discharges”, ASCE J. Hydr. Engrg., 118(11), (1992), 1540-1549 V. Marone, “Calcolo di massima di un serbatoio di laminazione”, L’Energia Elettrica, 9, (1971) V. Marone, “Calcolo di massima dell’effetto di laminazione di un serbatoio sulle piene”, L’Energia Elettrica, 10, (1964) A. Paoletti, “Resistenze al moto e processi di laminazione nei corsi d'acqua”, Atti del Corso di Aggiornamento del Politecnico di Milano: La difesa idraulica del territorio, Milano, 1996. Editoriale Bios, (1997) D. Pianese e F. Rossi, “Curve di possibilità di laminazione delle piene”, L'Energia Elettrica, 2, (1986), pp. 131-149 G. Pulci Doria, P. Gualtieri, R. Catapano, “Experimental observations through LDA of a current with almost rigid submerged vegetation”, IAHR, Venezia, (2007) E. Paris, Rischio idraulico: interventi per la protezione idraulica del territorio le casse di espansione. International centre for mechanical sciences monografie CISM. Udine, 2004
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
319
Analytical and hydraulic model study of highway culvert sand-blockages M. Kamaka1, E. Cheng2, M. Teng2 & C. Matsuda3 1
KFC Airport, Inc., Honolulu, HI, USA Department of Civil and Environmental Engineering, University of Hawaii at Manoa, Honolulu, HI, USA 3 Hawaii State Department of Transportation, Kapolei, HI, USA 2
Abstract Culverts are essential elements of a highway system. Currently, many hydraulic engineers are facing problems of sand-blockage inside culverts along coastal highways. To establish design criteria and a maintenance policy for Hawaii coastal highways, a research program is being carried out at the Department of Civil and Environmental Engineering, University of Hawaii at Manoa, USA. In establishing the design criteria for coastal culverts, we use overland flow theory to consider the design storm, drainage area, detention basin and culvert size as a system. A computational scheme is thus created. For predicting whether a sand-blocked culvert that may be opened by floodwater or it may need manual cleaning, we built hydraulic models for two existing culverts on the Island of Oahu, Hawaii in our Fluid Mechanics Laboratory. The preliminary results of our computer model and hydraulic model are very encouraging. Keywords: highway culverts, send-blockage, simulation model, direct runoff hydrograph, hydraulic model.
1
Introduction
Coastal highway flooding or “overtopping” by surface runoff is the concern. Mitigation measures considered herein are two-fold. The first management measure to minimize overtopping is attributed to the routine maintenance of a culvert, where the culvert is maintained free of debris to facilitate unimpeded surface runoff through a culvert. The second management measure is to assess the adequate nature of the existing culvert and detention pond combination as the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070331
320 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII drainage area and design storm changes. It is important to recognize that maintaining an open or clear culvert does not necessarily ensure adequate drainage from surface runoff that may occur. In addition to maintaining an open culvert, minimizing overtopping by surface runoff over a roadway is also managed by a combination of culvert size and storage capacity of a detention pond. Various combinations of the culvert size and the storage capacity of the detention pond may be appropriate to facilitate proper drainage of surface runoff. To minimize overtopping of roadways for a given design storm, (a) the ability to keep drainage culverts clear of debris and/or sand blockage; and (b) having an adequate combination of culvert size and detention pond storage capacity for a specific drainage basin, are two key criteria for long-term management. In order to establish the management criteria, two tasks are undertaken. The first task is to create a flood routing based computational scheme. This simulation model considers the design storm, drainage area, detention pond, and culvert size as a system. For predicting whether a sand-blocked culvert may be opened by floodwater or it may require manual cleaning, the second task is to build hydraulic models for existing culverts on Windward Oahu, Hawaii in the Fluid Mechanics Laboratory at the University of Hawaii at Manoa. Therefore, physical phenomena may be observed from these models.
2
The simulation model
The computer simulation model developed in this study is a flood routing based computational scheme, which considers design storm, drainage area, detention pond and culvert size as an interactive system. As indicated in fig. 1, for the drainage area, a direct runoff hydrograph may be synthesized for a given design storm. This synthesized direct runoff hydrograph from the defined drainage area is actually the inflow hydrograph to the detention pond. The dynamic routing of the inflow hydrograph through the detention pond and culvert system will result in an outflow hydrograph. This routing process is carried off by using PondPack [1]. 2.1 Design storm In accordance with Hawaii Department of Transportation’s Design Criteria for Highway Drainage [2], this study uses an one-hour 50-year rainstorms or sixhour 50-year rainstorms for drainage areas less than 200 acres and drainage areas equal to or greater than 200 acres, respectively. 2.2 Synthesizing direct runoff hydrograph Direct runoff from a drainage basin may be simulated by the Nash-Muskingum method if one assumes that inflow to the basin is a known design storm; and the drainage basin storage may be represented by one or more reservoir type storage. The Nash-Muskingum method is used to compute direct runoff of the drainage basin given the area, rainfall intensity for a 50-year recurrence interval, and the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
321
recession constant. The direct runoff hydrograph from the drainage basin is the inflow hydrograph to the detention pond. The outflow hydrograph of the drainage basin is calculated by the following relationship:
O2 = Co I 2 + C1I1 + C 2 I 2
(1)
Where O2, O1 are the outflow rates; I2, I1 are the inflow rates for time intervals 2 and 1 respectively; and C0, C1, and C2 are:
C2 = e
− dt
(
)
(
)
K ; C = K * 1 − C − C ; C = − K * 1 − C + 1 1 dt 2 2 0 2 dt
The Muskingum coefficient, K, is considered as a function of recession constant, K1, of a watershed [3]. 2.3 Inflow hydrograph rationale and assumptions The inflow hydrograph used in the generalized simulation model is actually the time-dependent outflow from the drainage basin for a given design storm. For drainage areas less than 200 acres, the 50-year 1-hour design storm is used. Detention Pond Drainage Area
Main stream Drainage Culvert Roadway Figure 1:
Conceptual simulation model.
2.4 Detention pond rationale and assumptions Three different conceptual detention ponds were considered in this study (fig. 2). An average slope of 1%, 2% or 3% of a detention basin was used to estimate the storage capacity prior to flood routing process through a culvert. As indicated in WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
322 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII fig. 3, the detention basin is assumed to be half of a cylindrical cone, where the center of the cone is the projection of the culvert, headwall, and roadway. The average slope represents the slope of the right cone.
Drainage Culvert
Figure 2:
Details of a culvert.
Culvert barrel
Detention pond
Culvert barrel
Figure 3:
3
Schematic diagram of a detention pond-culvert system.
Punaluu and Hauula culverts
The Punaluu and Hauula drainage areas on the windward of Oahu, Hawaii were selected for the study by using GIS software [4] and topological maps [5]. The watershed areas Punaluu and Hauula are estimated at 262 acres and 167.3 acres, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
323
respectively. Hydraulic models of the Punaluu circular culvert and Hauula box culvert were fabricated in the Fluid Mechanics laboratory of the University of Hawaii at Manoa. The purpose of the model study is to observe the time for a culvert to self-open under various completely sand blocked conditions. The scaled models were blocked with beach sand, and experiments were conducted to evaluate the time the culvert would open as a function of water depths. 3.1 Laboratory culvert model and dynamic similitude The model scale was calculated using the concept of dynamic similitude for open channel flow. Dynamic similitude will provide a relationship between the laboratory results and actual conditions expected in the field. For free surface flow the parameter in dynamic similitude between the model and prototype is the Froude Number, Fr. By definition: V (2) Fr = g*y where V is the velocity; g is the gravitational constant; and y is the depth of the flow. Therefore, for free surface flow models, the dynamic similitude between the model and the prototype is: Frm = Frp Vp Vm (3) = ym yp where Vm and Vp are model velocity and prototype velocity, respectively; and ym and yp are the flow depths in the model and prototype. 1 1 2 2 Vm y m Since, = =L (4) yp r Vp or,
lm Vm t m or, = Vp lp t p Therefore,
where the model scale L r =
tp Vm = L r Vp tm
y
(5)
m , and l and l are length dimensions in model m p y p
and prototype, respectively.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
324 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Substituting eqn. 4 into eqn. 5 yields: t m = t p * Lr
(6)
where tm = model time for culvert to self-open; and tp = actual time for the culvert to self-open. 3.2 Description of Laboratory Experiment The culverts were “packed” with beach sand to simulate complete blockages. The sand was placed in the model culvert with various compaction efforts. A constant volume of sand was placed in the model culvert for all experimental trails. The slope of the culverts was placed at 0 % for both the 9-inch by 12-inch model box culvert (fig. 4) and 6-in model circular culvert. The sand was placed in the middle of the model culvert barrel, simulating actual conditions along the coast of Windward Oahu, Hawaii.
Sluice Gate Water Tank
Box Culvert
Sand Blockage
Figure 4:
Photograph of model box culvert experiment for Hauula.
4 Results and discussions A block diagram of model runs is summarized in fig. 5. This figure indicates that a total of 12 series of model runs were performed. Forty different sizes of box culverts and fifteen different sizes of circular pipe culverts were modeled for each of the three different conceptual detention ponds of 1%, 2% or 3% slopes (fig. 2) under 17 different inflow hydrograph scenarios. Laboratory observations from model study of both the box culvert as wall as the circular culvert indicate that the time for the culvert to open varies as a function of the soil moisture and the degree of “compactness” of the sand in the model culvert. The time for the model box culvert to self-open ranged from 15 seconds to 8 minutes 39 seconds. The time for the circular culvert to self-open WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
325
Maximum Head Water Elevation
Inflow Hydrograph Watershed Area > 200 acres 50-year , 6-hour storm
Figure 5: Table 1:
Circular Culvert
Detention Basin 3% slope
Box Culvert
Detention Basin 2% slope
Circular Culvert
Circular Culvert
Detention Basin 1% slope
Box Culvert
Circular Culvert
Detention Basin 3% slope
Box Culvert
Circular Culvert
Detention Basin 2% slope
Box Culvert
Circular Culvert
Box Culvert
Detention Basin 1% slope
Box Culvert
Inflow Hydrograph Watershed Area < 200 acres 50-year , 1-hour storm
Block diagram of model runs.
Values for inflow hydrograph for <200 acres with 3% average sloped detention pond.
Notes: D,W: Height and Width of a box culvert, respectively. Col. (1): Time to reach the maximum allowable HW elevation, when culvert is completely blocked, for a given detention pond with inflow generated from a given area of a drainage basin. Col. (2): Time to reach the peak discharge specified in Col. (3), when the culvert is fully open, in a specified detention pond. Col. (3): Peak discharge for a fully open culvert. Col (4): Maximum water surface elevation when the peak discharge in Col. (3) is reached. Col. (5): The volume of the detention pond for the time and peak discharge specified in Col. (2) and Col. (3). Col. (6): The detention pond surface area for volume specified in Col. (5).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
326 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII ranged from instantaneous to 4 minutes and 5 seconds. As an example, consider the Hauula 6-ft by 8-ft box culvert described in Section 3. The storage capacity of its existing detention pond is 0.053 ac-ft and its inflow produced drainage area is 162.7 acres. The same size box culvert, with a drainage basin of 175 acres, and a 3% slope detention pond is summarized in table 1. For a 163-acre drainage basin, the system response may be conservatively estimated with 175 acres condition in table 1. This table indicates that a detention pond with an average gradient of 3% requires a minimum of storage capacity of volume of 2.764 ac-ft, and yield a maximum surface water elevation of 5.92 ft above the culvert invert, if the box culvert is fully open. Therefore, the highway will not be overtopped. However, the completely blocked culvert would take approximately 0.47 hours (Col.1 of table 1), or 28 minutes and 12 seconds, to open before overtopping occurs at a maximum allowable headwater elevation of 7.2 ft. The range of observed time in the laboratory for the Lr = ⅛ Hauula model box culvert to self-open is between 15 seconds and 8 minutes and 36 seconds. By means of eqn. 6, the model time is converted to prototype time of 24 minutes and 18 seconds. This result implies that if the 6-ft by 8-ft box culvert at Hauula is completely blocked by sand, it will self-open before the detention pond is overflowed, provided the minimum storage capacity of the pond is 2.764 ac-ft. However, the existing storage capacity at the Hauula culvert system is 0.053 ac-ft, therefore, under the 1-hour 50-year design storm, the highway will be overtopped. Furthermore, the peak discharge and its surface elevation for the Hauula box culvert system with existing storage capacity under fully open conditions, were 280.22 cfs and 5.74-ft respectively. The corresponding values in table 1 are 278.77 cfs and 5.92-ft. This example illustrates the effectiveness of the simulated results. The results summarized in fig. 5 are intended for guiding decision makers in prioritizing available resources in management of existing drainage culverts along coastal highway on Windward Oahu, Hawaii.
5
Conclusions
A generalized simulation model has been demonstrated in establishing the management criteria for clearing and maintenance of culverts along the coastal highway throughout Windward Oahu, Hawaii. Results obtained from this study provide a screening tool in which decision makers are able to identify the frequency of culvert clearing, or to identify the need to study existing drainage culverts or detention ponds to minimize overtopping of the roadway for a given drainage area. The screening of an existing culvert and detention pond is intended to provide a qualitative measure for a drainage culvert. The generalized simulation model presented herein, do not reflect or simulate actual conditions of any particular drainage basin.
References [1]
Bentley PondPack 10.0, Users manual, Bentley Systems, Inc. New York, N. Y., 2006. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[2] [3]
[4] [5]
327
State of Hawaii, Design criteria for highway drainage, Department of Transportation, Honolulu, HI, U.S.A., 2006. Wu, I. P., Flood hydrology of small watersheds: evaluation of time parameters and determination of peak discharge. Transactions of American Society of Agricultural Engineers, Vol. 12, No. 5, pp. 655-663, 1969. ARC-INFO, Users manual, Environmental Systems Research Institute, Redland, CA, U. S. A., 2006 U. S. Geological Survey, Digital topographic maps for Oahu, Hawaii, Honolulu, HI, U.S.A.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
329
Incorporating computational fluid dynamics in the design/build of a single family residence J. Chang & N. Rosemann School of Architecture and Urban Design, University of Kansas, USA
Abstract This paper discusses the design, development, and construction of a single family residence approximately 112 m2 (1200 ft2) in size that was designed and constructed by a team of graduate and undergraduate architecture students within a single semester. The project involved the implementation of computational fluid dynamics (CFD) during the design development stage of the project to achieve appropriate mechanical distribution of conditioned air. The computer simulated analysis of the environment focused on the ventilation effectiveness and temperature distribution of the home’s mechanical system. The paper also discusses the results of a comparative analysis of the simulated data and that of the experimental data taken of the building after the completion of construction prior to occupancy. The findings of this project provide insight into how CFD can be better incorporated into future studio design/build projects. Keywords: design-build, design studio, computational fluid dynamics, prefabrication, modular design, computer simulation, temperature distribution, architectural education, residential architecture, environmental analysis.
1
Introduction
When it comes to design/build projects in architecture schools, more often than not the projects are executed with insufficient analysis of the design’s environmental performance. This oversight can become more evident as the project increases in scope while maintaining the same time frame of one semester. As with any project dealing with the built environment, attention should be given to its environmental performance to better provide occupants a healthy, effective, and efficient environment.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070341
330 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII One means of increasing the ability to deliver an effective built environment is to conduct environmental performance analyses during the design development stage of a project. Using analysis tools such as computational fluid dynamics (CFD) software can provide performance feedback on a design within a short period of time. Such feedback can provide the design team with the necessary information to make appropriate design changes that help improve a project’s environmental performance.
2
Design process and design analysis
At the University of Kansas School of Architecture and Urban Design, for the past eight years a group of about twenty graduate and undergraduate architecture students in Studio 804 have embarked on a semester long design/build project that takes them from design and construction to occupancy of a single family residence within about four months. Under the guidance of Professor Rockhill, the latest group of students designed and constructed modular3, a 112 m2 (1200 ft2) single family prefabricated modular home for a Kansas City neighborhood. This project utilized CFD for part of the design development of the house. Working with a very tight schedule, students had approximately four weeks at the start of the semester to design and complete construction documents of the house. This left about two weeks to work on the design during which time continuous analysis of the mechanical system was performed using a commercially available CFD package. Under the supervision of a CFD instructor the simulations were conducted by one of the studio’s graduate student who had prior, albeit limited, experience with CFD. Although extensive analysis was conducted during the two weeks of design development investigating natural and mechanical distribution of air, a change in site location just prior to the scheduled construction date negated the design and CFD analysis of the original modular3, fig. 1.
Figure 1:
Exterior and interior computer renderings of original modular3 design. This design was discarded with a change in building site.
With a new building site in place, the original modular3 was completely redesigned within two weeks to meet the new site conditions and revised construction start date. The revised schedule allowed just a few days to run WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
331
simulations and provide design feedback to the group. Although far from desirable, those few days provided beneficial information in regards to the layout of supply and return vents. Approximately ten weeks later construction was completed and modular3 was ready for occupancy, fig. 2, fig. 3, and fig. 4.
Figure 2:
Floor plan of redesigned modular3 to fit new site conditions.
Figure 3:
Images of redesigned modular3 under construction.
2.1 Pre-construction analysis Given the very short time frame to redesign the house, simulations were started after the new design was fairly established. Although this limited the degree to which the CFD simulations could impact the overall design, it focused attention on the distribution and layout of the supply and return air vents. The initial simulations revealed areas in need of improvement in terms of temperature distribution and local mean age of air (LMA). As shown in fig. 5, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
332 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII temperature difference between the living room and bedrooms varied by as much as 4.5oC (8oF). Uneven air circulation is illustrated in fig. 6 with particularly poor conditions in the bedrooms. Based on these findings, several adjustments were made to improve airflow. Each bedroom received an additional supply vent and the living room and kitchen added a total of four additional supply vents. Furthermore, the return vent was divided in two and placed in two different locations, perpendicular to the original location. The modifications resulted in a more uniform temperature distribution as shown in fig. 7, with temperature differences varying by about 2.25oC (4oF). CFD simulation based on these changes also illustrate an improvement in airflow over the initial configuration of supply and return vents, fig. 8.
Figure 4:
Figure 5:
Finished exterior and interior images of redesigned modular3.
Temperature distribution of initial supply and return air vent configuration.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
333
Figure 6:
LMA distribution of initial supply and return air vent configuration.
Figure 7:
Temperature distribution of revised supply and return air vent configuration.
Figure 8:
LMA distribution of revised supply and return air vent configuration.
3
Results: comparing simulated and actual data
After the completion of construction, air temperature and air velocity were measured at various locations in modular3 to compare the actual performance to simulated data. Once the actual performance data were collected, a new simulation was run based on those findings. Unfortunately, long term datalogging of environmental variables was not possible due to the house being occupied. The results from that simulation are shown in fig. 9 and fig. 10. The temperature difference between the actual measurements and simulated results based on those measurements were on average about 1.4oC (2.5oF) for the same locations. The actual temperature measurements were all higher than their simulated data points. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
334 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Based on the small but consistent difference in temperature data between the actual and simulated data points and the consistently lower temperature readings from the simulation, it is assumed that the simulations show a fair representation of the temperature and conditioned air distribution in modular3. Unfortunately, the simulation output for both temperature and LMA distribution based on the actual performance data were not as evenly distributed as those resulting from the pre-construction simulation as shown in fig. 7 and fig. 8 above. This was primarily a result of the installed mechanical system and ductwork performing differently than originally anticipated during the design development stage. Although the actual total supply air volume 755 L/s (1600 CFM) was consistent with the simulated data, the volume of supply air from each vent varied an average of 8.8 L/s (18.7 CFM). With proper control of the supply air volume from each supply vent, it would be possible to achieve a more uniform LMA and temperature distribution pattern in line with the preconstruction simulation results.
Figure 9:
Temperature distribution measurements.
Figure 10:
4
of
modular3
based
on
field
LMA distribution of modular3 based on field measurements.
Conclusion and future directions
Having integrated CFD, though limited in scope, into the design process of a fast paced design/build project, the future integration of CFD analysis and design development of the built environment appear to be promising areas of future research and teaching in architectural education. This experience strongly suggests that CFD can be used as an effective tool in aiding the design WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
335
development of student design/build projects, both simple and complex in scope. Even a brief analysis of a design’s environmental performance, as such was the project described here, can yield data that can potentially serve to improve the design process and final outcome. The more ongoing analysis that can be conducted during the design stage, the greater the potential positive impact on the performance of the built environment. However, integration of CFD in the design process is not without difficulty. Because of the long learning curve associated with CFD programs, a student would not be able to effectively carry forward a performance analysis on a complex and fast paced design/build project without at least a semester of prior CFD experience and a good understanding of building environmental systems (Chang [1]). Also, because of the length of time some simulations take, depending on the scope of the project, it can be difficult to perform an analysis of multiple design scenarios within a short period of time. Therefore it would be beneficial to allow sufficient time in the design stages to study the various design schemes.
References [1]
Chang, J., Incorporating CFD into the Design Process of Architectural Education, Proceedings of the ARCC/EAAE 2006 International Conference, 2006.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Section 4 Salts in porous materials (Special session organised by Professor R. Černý)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
339
Mathematical modeling of water and salt transport in porous materials R. Černý Department of Building Materials, Faculty of Civil Engineering, Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract Most models applied in current research practice for the description of salt transport in porous materials are very simple. These employ Fick's diffusion equation for the salt concentration with a constant diffusion coefficient and constant initial and boundary conditions. Another extreme in this sense presents a consideration of fully coupled heat, moisture and chemical compound transport phenomena. A possible way out from the problems arising due to either oversimplification or too high complexity is to choose a reasonable compromise, i.e., a model that is somewhere in between these two extremes. Unfortunately, such models are still rarely used both in the research and technical practice. In this paper, a modification of the diffusion-advection model which takes into account not only the influence of water flow on salt transport but also the effect of salt bonding on pore walls is identified as the most promising for practical applications. Keywords: water transport, salt transport, modelling, diffusion, advection, salt bonding.
1
Introduction
Porous materials applied in building structures often contain significant amount of various salts. They can originate from several sources. One of them is underground soil with water-soluble salts. In some building structures, particularly older buildings horizontal water-proof insulation is missing, so that salt solutions can be transported into materials of load bearing structures by capillary forces. Another source of salts in masonry is sodium and calcium chlorides used for winter maintenance of pavements and footways. They can WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070351
340 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII diffuse either into underground soil or directly into the masonry. Salts can also be formed by reactions of acid-forming gases in the air with basic components of building materials. Some salts can be formed by actions of living organisms and microorganisms. Water-soluble salts in the form of hydrated ions capable of transport in the porous system can also be presented in masonry materials themselves. If salts are presented in porous system of masonry materials in the form of solution, they are mostly not dangerous. The harmful effects of such salts consist in the fact that after possible water evaporation salt crystals and crystal-hydrates are formed that often have crystallization pressures higher than the strength of the particular material. The pressure exerted on pore walls can then lead to material destruction. The damage assessment of porous materials of building structures due to the effect of salts can be performed in simplest way by taking specimens from damaged walls and analyzing them in laboratory. This provides information on water content and on the type and amount of ions in material which is very useful for appreciation of the current state. The possible reasons for the presence of the particular ions can also be estimated on the basis of these analyses. However, it is very difficult to make reliable predictions of further damage on the basis of these data. This requires years or even decades of on site measurements, aside from the fact that the extent of such analyses is logically restricted by the amount of material which can be taken from a particular building. Prediction of water and salt movement in the walls of building structures can be done effectively by means of mathematical and computational modeling. In this way, the time development of water and salt concentration fields can be obtained which is crucial for a proper assessment of possible future damage. However, the accuracy of simulated water and salt concentration fields critically depends on the availability of all input parameters. There are two types of these parameters which have to be known in advance. The first are initial and boundary conditions. Initial conditions can be determined using on site analysis of water and salt concentration fields in the walls. Boundary conditions are of two types. The first of them are meteorological data for temperatures, relative humidities, rainfall and solar radiation, possibly also concentration of acid-forming gases in the atmosphere. This type of data can be obtained from meteorologists in the form of so-called TRY (Test Reference Year) data which present certain average values over a sufficiently long time period. The second type of boundary conditions involves water content and salt concentration in the underground soil close to the studied building. These data can be obtained again by on site analysis. The second type of input parameters are water and salt transport and storage parameters of the materials of the wall which appear in water and salt mass balance equations. These parameters can be determined by common laboratory methods. Samples for the determination of water and salt transport and storage parameters can be obtained most easily from the walls of the analyzed building. If this is not possible, samples of building materials can be obtained from the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
341
original sources which are usually known for a particular building or, in worst case, similar materials available at the market can be used. The type and amount of material parameters necessary as input parameters of computational models of water and salt transport depend primarily on the type of physical model which was chosen for the description of transport processes taking place in a material. This choice should be done taking into account two basic contradictory requirements. First, the model is supposed to describe all the principal phenomena related to the transport and storage of water and salt in the porous space with a sufficient accuracy, as omitting any principal effect would lead to a significant departure from the reality. On the other hand, the number of parameters which are to be obtained from the experiments should not be too high; it has to reflect the feasibility of the necessary experiments in reasonable time. Therefore, some compromises in the choice of the model are always to be done. In this paper, an analysis of current models of water and salt transport in porous materials used in both scientific and technical practice is performed and perspective models having good potential for common practical applications are identified.
2
Basic diffusion model
The basic diffusion model of salt transport in porous materials is very simple, and employs 1-D Fick's diffusion equation for the salt concentration with constant diffusion coefficient and constant initial and boundary conditions, ∂ 2C ∂C (1) =D 2 ∂t ∂x (2) C (0, t ) = C 0
C ( ∞, t ) = 0 C ( x ,0 ) = 0 ,
(3) (4) where D is the diffusion coefficient, C the salt concentration, C0 the salt concentration at the exposed boundary, x the distance from the exposed boundary, t the time. The problem (1)–(4) has a very simple mathematical solution (e.g., [1]): x . (5) C ( x, t ) = C 0 1 − erf 2 Dt Therefore, the diffusion coefficient can be identified from the measured concentration profiles using very simple methods, for instance the common Newton iteration formula. This is certainly the main reason for the high application frequency of this model which was employed for instance by Tuutti [2], Funahashi [3], Cady and Weyers [4], Weyers [5], Zemajtis et al. [6], Costa and Appleton [7] and many others. Some of the authors, for example Zemajtis et al. [6], assumed the surface concentration as a function of the square root of time, or in more general form (e.g., Costa and Appleton [7]) as a power function of time, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
342 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (6) C 0 (t ) = C1 t n , where C1 is the surface chloride concentration after one year, t is expressed in years, and n is an empirical coefficient. The model (1)–(4), which can be considered as the simplest choice ever in modeling salt transport contains several serious flaws that have to be taken into account in any practical application of it. The main problems with the model consist in the assumption of constant diffusion coefficient and in the fact that it neglects the influence of water transport on the transport of salts. As a consequence, a single value of the diffusion coefficient can never be obtained from the analysis of measured concentration profiles, particularly if the measurements are performed over longer time periods. The diffusion coefficient then appears as a function of time and usually is assumed to have the form (7) D(t ) = D1t − m where D1 is the diffusion coefficient at one year, t is expressed in years and m is an empirical coefficient. Nevertheless, this model proved to be useful in many practical applications because the calculated diffusion coefficients have at least a relative value, i.e., it is possible to compare diffusion coefficients in different types of materials and different environments.
3
Improved diffusion models
The simplest and most straightforward improvement to the description of salt transport in porous materials given in the previous Section is the replacement of the linear diffusion problem (1)–(4) by a nonlinear one which means an assumption of the diffusion coefficient to depend on the salt concentration. Eq. (1) can then be written as ∂C ∂ ∂C (8) = D(C ) ∂t ∂x ∂x However, this assumption leads to a necessity to apply some more sophisticated methods for the analysis of measured salt concentration profiles than using just the solution in the form (5). A classical Boltzmann-Matano analysis seems to be an appropriate first-choice solution to this problem (see, e.g., [8] for details). Another possibility for the improvement of the classical diffusion model (1)–(4) consists in a formal inclusion of water transport into the salt transport problem using the concept of apparent transport parameters [9]. The main difference between the apparent parameters and the thermodynamically “pure” parameters of the coupled water and salt transport is that the apparent parameters do not express “pure” effects, but combined effects. So, the apparent salt diffusion coefficients include not only the free salt diffusion in the porous space but also for instance the effect of salts bonding on the pore walls and the effect of salt transport due to the water movement. The notion of apparent moisture diffusivity then means that it is related not to the water itself, but to the salt-in-water solution, i.e. the whole liquid phase. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
343
Under these simplifying assumptions, the same parabolic differential equations and the same boundary and initial conditions for both water transport and salt transport can be formally obtained, namely ∂C (9) = div ( D (C ) grad C ) ∂t (10) C (0, t ) = C1 (11) C (∞, t ) = C 2 (12) C ( x ,0 ) = C 2 , where C is either water concentration or chloride concentration, D is either the apparent moisture diffusivity or the apparent salt diffusion coefficient. Therefore, the calculation of concentration-dependent diffusion coefficients from the measured salt concentration profiles could be done using basically the same inverse methods as those for the determination of moisture-dependent moisture diffusivity or temperature-dependent thermal conductivity (see [8]). The main flaw of this treatment is that the apparent parameters are in fact not any objectively defined physical quantities. So, the concept of apparent transport coefficients can be useful in the solution of a class of case studies only where the same initial and boundary conditions are valid. In other cases, it is useless.
4
Diffusion-advection models
Diffusion-advection models present further substantial improvement to the physical description of salt transport in porous materials. It consists mainly in taking the influence of moisture flow on the salt transport into account. Another effect usually considered in the diffusion-advection models (in addition to those appearing in diffusion-type models) is the salt bonding on the pore walls. This type of model of salt solution transport in porous media was probably first described by Bear and Bachmat [10] who expressed the salt mass balance by the relation
∂ ( wC f ) ∂t
G ∂C = div ( wD gradC f ) − div (C f v ) − b ∂t
(13)
where Cf is the concentration of free salts in water [kg/m3], Cb the concentration of bonded salts in the whole porous body, [kg/m3], w the volumetric moisture G content [m3/m3], D the salt diffusion coefficient, [m2/s], v the Darcy’s velocity [m/s], G (14) v = −k grad h k is the hydraulic conductivity [m/s] and h the hydraulic head [m]. The water mass balance was in the model from [10] expressed as
G ∂w (15) = −div v . ∂t As follows from Eqs. (13)–(15), a convective (mechanistic) type of model of water transport which is common for instance in soil science was used in the Bear and Bachmat model [10]. This type of model is, however, not common in building physics where diffusion types of models of water transport are mostly preferred WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
344 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (see, e.g., [8] for a detailed analysis). Therefore, Pel et al. [11] in modeling the transport of NaCl solution in calcium silicate brick modified the Bear and Bachmat diffusion-advection model [10] by expressing the Darcy’s velocity in terms of moisture diffusivity κ [m2/s], G (16) ν = −κ gradw , and substituting it in Eqs. (13) and (15) instead of Eq. (14). Their final model had then the following form:
∂ ( wC f ) ∂t
= div ( wD gradC f ) + div (C f κ gradw) −
∂C b ∂t
(17)
∂w (18) = div (κ gradw) . ∂t The salt solution transport model (17), (18) presents a system of two parabolic partially coupled differential equations with two principal material parameters, D and κ, and three field variables, Cf, Cb, w. The third necessary equation to achieve a unique solution to the system of Eqs. (17), (18) is the ion binding isotherm Cb= Cb(Cf) which is to be determined experimentally and then substituted in an analytical form in Eq. (17). The principal problem with the determination of material parameters within the framework of the model (17), (18) consists in the fact that in Eq. (17) appear both D and κ. This leads to a necessity to solve together the inverse problems to both (17) and (18), in general. However, solving inverse problems of parabolic problems is not an easy task even in the case of one equation (see [8] for a more detailed analysis and a survey of methods). So, it is quite logical that most researchers try to avoid this problem. One of the possibilities how to deal with the solution of the inverse problem for D and κ in coupled water and salt transport is to neglect D as it was done in [11]. However, this idea did not appear as particularly useful even in the original paper because after solving the inverse problem in this way and performing the subsequent forward analysis the agreement between the experimental and computational Na+ ions concentration profiles was not very good. Another method was proposed in [12] where two simple experiments were assumed for the identification of moisture diffusivity and salt diffusion coefficient. In the first experiment, the moisture diffusivity κ was determined in common way using inverse analysis of moisture profiles measured during the penetration of distilled water into a dry sample. As a result, a κ(w) function was obtained. In the second experiment, the salt solution of a chosen concentration penetrated into a water-saturated sample and the salt diffusion coefficient D was determined using inverse analysis of measured salt concentration profiles. In this way, a D(C) function was determined. However, neither the concept of D and κ identification presented in [12] can be considered a general solution of the problem (17), (18); its application has some limitations. First, it can be applied for dilute solutions only because otherwise the moisture diffusivity would also be function of salt concentration. Second, its application is limited to low-bonding salts for the particular material because the analysis does not include the ion-binding isotherm. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
345
The first limitation is rather critical. For concentrated solutions it would not even be sufficient to measure moisture diffusivity as function of the concentration of penetrating solution in a series of the above experiments. Such moisture diffusivities could not be successfully applied in any general coupled water and salt transport problems as the salt concentration is mainly function of position. On the other hand, the second limitation of the method would be relatively easy to cure. With the measured ion binding isotherm, Cb=Cb(Cf), the salt diffusion coefficient in the second proposed experiment could be calculated using the solution of the inverse problem to the equation ∂C (19) 1 + 1 ∂Cb f = div ( D gradC f ) , w ∂C ∂t sat f which is only slightly different from the solution of the problem (9)–(12). All the above mentioned methods for the identification of the moisture diffusivity and salt diffusion coefficient from moisture and salt concentration profiles used simplifications leading to the solution of inverse problems to one parabolic equation in 1-D approximation which was a logical procedure because the unknown solution of a more complicated problem was converted to the solutions of simpler, well known problems in this way. This quite a standard treatment is, however, in the particular case of the system of Eqs. (17), (18) not absolutely necessary. Theoretically, the system of equations (17), (18) can be subjected to an inverse analysis in a similar way as for one parabolic equation, provided the initial and boundary conditions are simple enough. The material parameters D and κ can then be identified as functions of water content and salt concentration. The simplest possibility of such an inverse analysis is an extension of the Boltzmann-Matano treatment (see [8] for details of the original procedure) under the same assumptions of 1-D approximation, constant initial conditions and Dirichlet boundary conditions on both ends of the specimen for both moisture content and salt concentration where one of the Dirichlet boundary conditions is equal to the initial condition. The Boltzmann transformation
η=
x t
(20)
then leads to the system of equations
2
dC d (wC f ) dC b dC f dw d d Dw f + η +η = 0 (21) C f κ + 2 dη dη dη dη dη dC f dη d dw dw (22) κ + η 2 =0. dη dη dη
Performing the second transformation providing that in the known time t = t0, w(x, t0), Cf(x, t0) and Cb(x, t0) are known, (23) z = η ⋅ t0 , WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
346 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII we have
2
dC f z d ( wC f ) z dC b dC f d dw d + ⋅ + ⋅ ⋅ = 0 (24) + 2 Dw wC f κ dz dz dz dz t 0 dz t 0 dC f dz dw z dw d (25) 2 κ ( z) = 0. + dz t 0 dz dz
From equation (25) we can determine ∞
1 dw (26) dz z dw z∫0 dz 2t 0 dz z0 where κ(z0) = κ(w0, Cf0), w0 = w(z0, t0), Cf0 = Cf(z0, t0). The analysis of equation (24) leads to the following formula for calculation of salt diffusion coefficient dw C f ( z 0 )κ ( z 0 ) dz z0 D( z 0 ) = − + dC f w( z 0 ) dz z
κ ( z0 ) =
0
+
1 dC f 2t 0 ⋅ w( z 0 ) ⋅ dz
d ( wC f ) dC b dC f z ∫z dz + dC f dz dz , 0 ∞
z0
(27)
where D(z0) = D(w0, Cf0) and the value of κ(z0) = κ(w0, Cf0), is obtained from equation (26).
5
Fully coupled models
Fully coupled heat, moisture and chemical compound transport models present another extreme to the simplest Fick’s model (1)–(4), in describing salt transport in porous materials. Among the most advanced models of this type, the model by Grunewald [13] belongs to very promising (see, e.g., the comments in [8] for more details). From the theoretical point of view, this type of models presents an ideal solution to the problem of salt transport in porous materials because the description of transport phenomena in these models is definitely closer to the physical reality than in the case of diffusion or diffusion-advection models. However, the main problem with the fully coupled models consists just in their complexity and particularly in the fact that they require too many parameters to be determined in advance. The measurements of some of them are very time consuming so that for instance determination of liquid convection coefficients can take several months if static methods are used. In addition, all coefficients should be measured as functions of all state variables; this means at least a
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
347
dependence on temperature, moisture content and salt concentration. Therefore, fully coupled models can be reasonably used only in the case that a database of necessary material parameters is already available.
6
Conclusions
The analysis of models of salt transport in porous materials in this paper revealed that an application of both too simple and too complex models is in the current scientific and technical practice not very desirable. Oversimplified models, such as the linear diffusion model of salt transport assuming just the salt concentration gradient as the only driving force of salt transport, can lead to an unacceptable distortion of physical reality. On the other hand, very complex models can face almost irresolvable problems with the accuracy of input parameters which may lead to similar distortions, which are maybe even more dangerous than in the case of oversimplified models because many researchers tend to consider this type of models mainly from the point of view of their theoretical qualities. Therefore, a reasonable compromise between these two extremes seems to be necessary. Taking into account the current state of knowledge of the modeling of salt transport in porous materials and the feasibility of the experiments for the determination of input parameters of computational models, a modification of the diffusion-advection model which takes into account not only the influence of water flow on salt transport but also the effect of salt bonding on pore walls can be considered as the most promising for practical applications.
Acknowledgments This research was supported partially by the Ministry of Education, Youth and Sports of Czech Republic, under grant No MSM: 6840770031, and partially by Czech Science Foundation, under grant No 103/06/0031.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
[5]
Carslaw, H.S. & Jaeger, J.C., Conduction of Heat in Solids, Clarendon Press: Oxford, 1959. Tuuti, K., Corrosion of Steel in Concrete, Swedish Cement and Concrete Research Institute: Stockholm, 1982. Funahashi, M., Predicting corrosion-free service life of a concrete structure in a chloride environment. ACI Material Journal, 87, pp. 581587, 1982. Cady, P.D. & Weyers, R.E., Predicting service life of concrete bridge decks subject to reinforcement corrosion. Corrosion Forms and Control for Infrastructure, ASTM STP, 1137, American Society for Testing and Materials, pp. 328-338, 1992. Weyers, R.E., Service life model for concrete structures in chloride laden environments. ACI Materials Journal, 95, pp. 445-453, 1998. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
348 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [6]
[7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Zemajtis, J, Weyers, R.E. & Sprinkel, M.M., Corrosion protection service life of low-permeable concretes and low-permeable concrete with a corrosion inhibitor. Transportation Research Report 1642, National Research Council: Washington, pp. 51-59, 1998. Costa, A. & Appleton, J., Chloride penetration into concrete in marine environment – Part II: Prediction of long term chloride penetration. Materials and Structures, 32, pp. 354-359, 1999. Černý, R. & Rovnaníková P., Transport Processes in Concrete, Spon Press: London, 2002. Černý, R., Pavlík, Z. & Rovnaníková, P., Experimental analysis of coupled water and chloride transport in cement mortar. Cement and Concrete Composites, 26, pp. 705-715, 2004. Bear, J. & Bachmat, Y., Introduction to Modelling of Transport Phenomena in Porous Media, Vol 4, Kluwer: Dordrecht, 1990. Pel, L., Kopinga, K., & Kaasschieter, E. F., Saline absorption in calciumsilicate brick observed by NMR scanning. J. Phys. D: Appl. Phys, 33, pp. 1380–1385, 2000. Pavlík, Z., Tesárek, P., Maděra, J., Rovnaníková, P. & Černý, R., Determination of moisture diffusivity and salt diffusion coefficient of building materials. Acta Agrophysica, 6, pp. 773-783, 2005. Grunewald, J., DELPHIN 4.1 - Documentation, Theoretical Fundamentals, TU Dresden: Dresden, 2000.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
349
Determination of water and salt transport parameters of porous materials using methods of inverse modelling L. Fiala, Z. Pavlík, M. Pavlíková & R. Černý Department of Building Materials, Faculty of Civil Engineering, Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract A computational assessment of water and salt transport parameters describing the coupled moisture and chloride transport in porous media is presented in this paper. The experimentally determined moisture profiles, chloride concentration profiles and chloride binding isotherm are subjected to inverse analysis where three different modes of salt solution transport are assumed. On the basis of this analysis, moisture dependent moisture diffusivity and salt concentration dependent chloride diffusion coefficient are calculated. The obtained results can find use in computational modelling of salt transport in porous building materials which is currently a very important topic, particularly from the point of view of durability of building materials and service life of building structures exposed to salt attack. Keywords: moisture diffusivity, salt diffusion coefficient, chloride binding isotherm.
1
Introduction
The durability and service life assessment of building materials and structures due to the effect of salts can be done most effectively by means of mathematical and computational modelling. In this way, the time development of water and salt concentration fields can be obtained which is crucial for prediction of possible future damage related to the salt crystallization and efflorescence. However, the accuracy of simulated water and salt concentration fields critically depends on the availability of all input parameters. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070361
350 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII There are two types of input parameters of computational models of water and salt transport which have to be known in advance. The first are initial and boundary conditions which can be obtained relatively easily using on site analysis of water and salt concentration fields in the walls and in subsoil, and meteorological data for relative humidity, temperature and rain. The second type of input parameters are water and salt transport and storage parameters of building materials which appear in water and salt mass balance equations. In this work, the main attention is paid to the determination of water and salt transport parameters on the basis of inverse analysis of experimentally determined salt concentration and moisture profiles.
2 Mathematical models of salt transport Identification of parameters describing the salt transport is based on the assumed mode of this transport. In this work, three different approaches for determination of salt transport parameters were used. At first, simple Fick’s diffusion equation with constant salt diffusion coefficient and constant initial and boundary conditions was employed. In this model, only diffusion transport of salts is taken into account. The Fick’s diffusion equation has a very simple mathematical solution in the following form [1, 2]
x , C ( x , t ) = C 0 1 − erf 2 Dt
(1)
where C [kg/m3] is salt concentration, D [m2s-1] salt diffusion coefficient, Co [kg/m3] salt concentration on the end of the sample exposed to the salt solution, x [m] the distance from the exposed end of the sample, t [s] time. The main disadvantage of this model is the assumption of constant diffusion coefficient and neglect of the influence of water transport on salt transport. However, this model is very simple; so it is frequently used by many authors for some rough estimation of the salt transport velocity. The second type of applied model was based on diffusion mechanism of salt solution transport as well. Compared to Fick’s diffusion equation, the dependence of salt diffusion coefficient D on salt concentration C was involved,
∂C = div ( D (C ) grad C ) , ∂t
(2)
where C [kg/kg] is salt concentration in kg per kg of the dry porous body, D [m2s-1] the apparent salt diffusion coefficient. In this way the salt solution transport is formally described by the same parabolic equation with the same boundary and initial conditions usually used for description of water transport. Therefore, the calculation of concentration-dependent diffusion coefficients from the measured salt concentration profiles could be done using basically the same WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
351
inverse methods as those for the determination of moisture-dependent moisture diffusivity or temperature-dependent thermal conductivity. In this paper, this type of model was employed for determination of both D(C) and κ(w) functions. In the inverse analysis, the Matano method which is the most frequently used method in the inverse analysis of moisture profiles was employed [3, 4]. Application of Matano method gives the following final solution for salt diffusion coefficient
D (C 0 ) =
∞ dC 1 dz , ∫z dC dz 2t0 ( ) z = z0 z0 dz
(3)
and for moisture diffusivity
κ ( w0 ) =
1 dκ 2t 0 ( ) z = z0 dz
∞
∫z
z0
dκ dz , dz
(4)
where C0 = C(z0, t0) is salt concentration in the position z0 and time t0, w0 = w(z0, t0) the corresponding moisture content and z space variable. The integral in Eqs. (3) and (4) is solved by common numerical methods, such as Simpson’s rule. The most advanced model applied in this paper for identification of the D(C) function was the Bear and Bachmat diffusion-advection model [5, 6] taking into account (in addition to salt diffusion in the liquid phase) the influence of moisture flow on salt transport and also the effect of bound salt on pore walls. This model employs for description of coupled salt and water transport the system of parabolic equations ∂ ( wC f ) ∂C f ∂C b , ∂ ∂w ∂ (5) ( wD )+ (C f κ )− = ∂x ∂x ∂x ∂t ∂x ∂t
∂w ∂ ∂w , = κ ∂t ∂x ∂x
(6)
where Cf [kgm-3] is the concentration of free salts in water, Cb [kgm-3] the concentration of bound salts in the whole porous body and w [m3m-3] the volumetric moisture content. This system of equations can be subjected to an inverse analysis in a similar way as for one parabolic equation, provided the initial and boundary conditions are simple enough, and the material parameters D and κ can be identified as functions of water content and salt concentration. The simplest possibility of such an inverse analysis is again an extension of the Boltzmann-Matano treatment under the same assumptions of constant initial conditions and Dirichlet boundary conditions on both ends of the specimen for both moisture content and salt concentration where one of the Dirichlet boundary conditions is equal to the initial condition. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
352 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Experimental
In the experimental part of this work, ceramic brick having bulk density ρb = 2044 kgm-3 and matrix density ρmat = 2666 kgm-3 was studied. The arrangement of the experiment for determination of moisture and salt concentration profiles was analogous to standard water suction experiments. The samples with the dimensions of 20 x 40 x 160 mm were first dried at 80 °C and 0.1 mbar at vacuum drier and water and vapour-proof insulated by epoxy resin on all lateral sides. Then, they were exposed by their 40 x 20 mm face to the penetrating 1M-NaCl solution (ρ1M-NaCl = 1041 kgm-3 at 21 °C). Duration of the experiment was 30, 60 and 120 minutes for three different groups of samples. After this time, the samples were cut into 8 pieces and in each piece water content and chloride concentration were measured. Moisture content was determined by the gravimetric method using weighing the moist and dried specimens. In the determination of chloride concentration, the particular samples were after drying first ground by a vibration mill so that grains smaller than 0.063 mm were obtained. Then the ground samples were overflowed by 80 °C warm distilled water and leached. The chloride contents in particular leaches were determined using an ion selective electrode. For the determination of ion binding isotherm as the main salt storage parameter, a modification of the Tang and Nilsson adsorption method [7] was chosen. The modification of the Tang and Nilsson method applied in our measurements consisted in using the specimens of more realistic dimensions (40/40/10 mm) instead of crushed specimens. The main reason for this was that the original method presents certain idealization of the binding problem assuming that salts can get in direct contact with every small grain of the measured material. However, in a real specimen the interior pore surface where the material is accessible to the salts is certainly smaller than the total surface of a crushed specimen. The salt binding capacity can be then affected by many other factors such as the change in the porous structure and pore distribution due to the presence of various admixtures, etc. Therefore, the result obtained by the adsorption method in its original form can be considered as a certain upper limit to the real salt binding capacity. On the basis of the measured ion binding isotherm of NaCl, Cb = f(Cf), the profiles of bound and free chlorides were determined.
4
Results and discussion
The experimentally determined moisture and salt concentration profiles are presented in Figs. 1 and 2. For approximation of measured data which is necessary for computer data processing, the linear filtration method was used. In Figs. 1 and 2, the smoothed data for approximation parameter α = 1.9 are shown as well to illustrate the quality of smoothing procedure. The chloride binding isotherm measured by modified Tang and Nilsson adsorption method is shown in Fig. 3. The obtained binding isotherm gives clear evidence about the high chloride binding capacity of the studied material. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
353
3
3
Volumetric moisture content [m /m ]
0.45 0.40 0.35 Smoothed data (α=1,9) Measured data
0.30 0.25 0.20 0.15 0.10 0.05 0.00 0.0000
0.0002
0.0004
0.0006
0.0008
0.0010
0.0012
1/2
x/√t [m/s ]
Volumetric moisture content for 1M-NaCl solution transport.
10.00
3
Concentration of chlorides Ct [kg/m ] sample
Figure 1:
8.00 Smoothed data (α=1,9) Measured data
6.00
4.00
2.00
0.00 0.0000
0.0002
0.0004
0.0006
0.0008
0.0010
0.0012
1/2
x/√t [m/s ]
Figure 2:
Total salt concentration.
Fig. 4 shows the moisture diffusivity of investigated ceramic brick as a function of moisture content calculated using the inverse analysis described before. We can see that the moisture diffusivity values for the penetration of pure distilled water were systematically higher than those obtained for salt solution penetration. This result is not surprising and is in accordance with higher WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
354 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII viscosity of salt solution as compared to water. The upper curve of moisture diffusivity function corresponds to the inverse analysis neglecting the effect of diffusion (dispersion) in salt solution transport. The results give evidence that the diffusion (dispersion) mechanism is quite important in the solution transport. 500 450
Cb [kg/m3(sample)]
400 350 300 250 200 150 100 50 0 0
50
100
150 3
Cf [kg/m
Figure 3:
200
(solution)]
Chloride binding isotherm of ceramic brick.
1.0E-05
Moisture diffusivity κ [m2/s]
Transport of water Transport of salt and water - full model Transport of salt and water (D=0) 1.0E-06
1.0E-07
1.0E-08 0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
0.30 3
0.35 3
Volumetric moisture content [m /m ]
Figure 4:
Moisture diffusivity of ceramic brick.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
0.40
0.45
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
355
The chloride diffusion coefficient of ceramic brick calculated in dependence on free ion concentration by three different methods of inverse analysis is shown in Fig. 5. We can see that from the quantitative point of view, the calculated dispersion coefficient is quite high, about three orders of magnitude higher than the diffusion coefficients of most ions in free water. Therefore, the common diffusion mechanism was probably not the only driving force for the chloride transport within the liquid phase and some other driving forces were taking place here. The acceleration of chloride transport can be attributed most easily to surface diffusion on pore walls or to some preferential paths of salt solution transport. It should be noted, however, that this is a formal explanation only and an exact physico-chemical analysis is still needed. The diffusion coefficient determined using the diffusion-advection concept was one to two orders of magnitude higher than both diffusion-model based coefficients. This means that the advection mechanism was quite significant in the process of salt transport. This feature we have already observed for other studied common building materials as sandstone or calcium silicate. 1.0E-04 Full transport model Error function Kappa - salt solution
2
D [m /s]
1.0E-05
1.0E-06
1.0E-07
1.0E-08 0.00
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00 Cf
Figure 5:
5
2.50
3.00
3.50
4.00
4.50
[kg/m3(solution)]
Chloride diffusion coefficient of ceramic brick.
Conclusions
Theoretical and experimental studies of coupled water and salt transport belong still to actual topics in describing transport phenomena in building materials because such descriptions are not yet very frequent in building science. In this paper, an attempt towards better understanding of mechanisms driving the coupled water and chloride transport in porous media was done. This analysis has clearly shown that description of salt transport in building materials should always be done in a combination with water transport. It also confirmed that an WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
356 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII application of ion binding isotherms in mathematical models of water and salt transport is an unavoidable condition for a realistic description of processes taking place in the porous medium. Neglecting the effects of water transport in the porous material and ion absorption on the pore walls that is common in the simplest diffusion models using solely salt diffusion coefficients can lead to ambiguous results in inverse analysis of salt concentration profiles, and consequently to a departure from the reality. If such oversimplified models are used anyway, their application should always be done for relative purposes only and bearing in mind that some very important factors were neglected. This paper contributed to both theoretical and practical description of coupled water and salt transport in porous materials. From the practical point of view, two main parameters describing the capability of ceramic brick to transport salt and moisture were accessed. From the point of view of explanation of mechanisms of coupled water and salt transport in porous materials, the presented experiments and calculations revealed the necessity to implement some other effects (e.g., surface diffusion, preferential transport paths) into the diffusion-advection model.
Acknowledgement This research was supported by the Ministry of Education, Youth and Sports of Czech Republic, under grant No. MSM: 6840770031.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
Carslaw, H.S. & Jaeger, J.C., Conduction of Heat in Solids, Clarendon Press: Oxford, 1959. Weyers, R.E., Service life model for concrete structures in chloride laden environments. ACI Materials Journal, 95, pp. 445-453, 1998. Matano, C., On the relation between the diffusion coefficient and concentration of solid metals. Jap. J. Phys., 8, pp. 109-115, 1933. Černý, R., Pavlík, Z. & Rovnaníková, P., Experimental analysis of coupled water and chloride transport in cement mortar. Cement and Concrete Composites, 26, pp. 705-715, 2004. Bear, J. & Bachmat, Y., Introduction to Modelling of Transport Phenomena in Porous Media, Vol 4, Kluwer: Dordrecht, 1990. Pel, L., Kopinga, K., & Kaasschieter, E. F., Saline absorption in calciumsilicate brick observed by NMR scanning. J. Phys. D: Appl. Phys, 33, pp. 1380–1385, 2000. Jiřičková, M. & Černý, R., Chloride Binding in Building Materials, Journal of Building Physics, 29, 189-200, 2006.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
357
Effect of metakaolin on chloride binding in lime-based composites R. Pernicová, M. Pavlíková & R. Černý Department of Building Materials, Faculty of Civil Engineering, Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract The determination of chloride binding isotherms for two different types of limebased composite materials containing metakaolin is presented in this paper. The experiments are performed on small specimens with defined shape so that the effect of the porous structure is respected. Also, the experiment with crushed samples as in the original procedure by Tang and Nilsson is done for the sake of comparison and the differences analyzed. It is concluded that the chloride binding capacity of lime-based materials depends critically on the size of the sample. Therefore, the result obtained by the original Tang and Nilsson method can be considered as a certain upper limit to the real chloride binding capacity. Keywords: chloride binding isotherm, metakaolin, lime-based composites.
1
Introduction
Today’s trend in building renovation and preservation is to use materials with defined properties and known behaviour. The demands of conservators who take care of historical monuments are that the materials for repair or innovation of plasters could have similar composition as the historical materials and they have to be applicable by the original methods, it means coated layers number and structure, the way of plaster surface treatment by striking, indentation or making it smooth. As the chemical analyses of many plasters from historical buildings show, the past centuries external plasters that are preserved until today contain products formed by lime reaction with pozzolanic or hydraulic admixtures. In the work presented in this paper, metakaolin is used as the pozzolanic admixture in limepozzolana plaster. Application of metakaolin in lime mortars for restoration of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070371
358 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII renders of historical buildings is not in a contradiction with the historical reality because burnt clay containing more or less kaolinite was used in Rome and Greece 2000 years ago, as well as in further historical periods. The addition of metakaolin to lime plasters was frequently analyzed until now (e.g. [1–4]) and considered mostly a prospective way of improvement of mechanical properties. Metakaolin is kaolinite burnt at temperatures between 500 – 850°C, i.e. above the temperature of kaolinite dehydration. Quality of pozzolanic activity of particular types of metakaolin is based on the sort of raw materials used for their production, method of calcination and on granulometry of the final product. The mechanism of pozzolanic activity of metakaolin, similarly as with other pozzolanic materials, is based especially on the ability to react with calcium hydroxide. The products of this chemical reaction are CSH gels and crystallization products. The developed compounds implicate then higher strengths of lime plasters with pozzolana addition compared to pure lime plasters. These compounds are the cause of the plaster resistance against environmental conditions and in this way of the durability of these plasters. The deterioration of porous building materials is caused in many cases by water-soluble salts. They can come into building structures from following sources: 1) Salts can be present in original building material, or they can be formed there by chemical reactions. 2) Salts come from materials used during reconstruction or renovation of building facades, for example low quality cements, impregnations etc. 3) Typical source of salts in building structures is intrusion of salty water from the grounds of buildings or capillary action of ground moisture. 4) Use of huge amounts of de-icing salts on roads and pavements in urban areas during winter period can cause metals corrosion and destroy building materials as chloride concentration in facades and masonries may be very high. 5) Due to animal excrements and microbiological organisms’ activities also nitrates can be found in building structures. 6) Water-soluble salts are often transported to masonry from the soil by capillary rise of ground water. Chlorides are potentially very dangerous for most porous building materials including renders due to their high crystallization pressures. Chloride binding capacity belongs to the most important parameters which can indicate the extent of this danger. Therefore, in this paper the main attention is paid to the chloride binding capacity of lime-metakaolin plasters as an instrument for estimating their durability.
2
Methods for determination of ion binding isotherms
In modelling ion transport in a porous medium, the two basic phases, namely the free phase and the bound phase, should be distinguished. Therefore, ion binding isotherms have to be determined, which express the equilibrium relation between the amount of free ions in the solution and the amount of bound ions (by both
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
359
physisorption and chemisorption) on the pore walls in the porous medium. A simple nonlinear equilibrium ion binding isotherm was suggested by Freundlich [5]
C b = K ⋅ C fm
(1)
where Cb is the bound ion concentration, Cf the free ion concentration, and K and m are empirical parameters determined experimentally. Another simple twoparametric function was proposed by Langmuir,
1 1 1 1 = ⋅ + C b kC bm C f C bm
(2)
where k is the adsorption constant, and Cbm the bound chloride content at saturated monolayer adsorption. The common method of determining the chloride binding capacity, and therefore also the chloride binding isotherms, involves dissociating the free chloride fraction from the total chloride content by analysing the pore solution squeezed out from the porous material under high pressure [6]. The total chloride content may be determined using acid-soluble extraction [7]. Tang and Nilsson [8] proposed a method for the determination of chloride adsorption isotherms based on the adsorption from solution. They calculated bound chloride content Cb (in mg/g) from the equation
Cb =
M Cl V (C 0 − C1 ) W
(3)
where MCl is the molar mass of chlorine, V the volume of the solution (in ml), C0, C1 the initial and equilibrium concentrations, respectively, of chloride solution (in mol/l), and W the mass of the dry sample. The free chloride content Cf (in mol/l), corresponding to the value of Cb, is equal to C1. By performing the experiment with different values of the initial salt concentration C0, a point-wise function Cb=Cb(Cf) can be obtained, which is the ion binding isotherm. In fact, the method of Tang and Nilsson is certain idealization of the binding problem assuming that chlorides can get in direct contact with every small grain material. However, in a real specimen the interior pore surface where the material matrix is accessible to the chlorides is certainly smaller than the total surface of a crushed specimen. The chloride binding capacity can be then affected by many other factors such as the change in the porous structure and pore distribution. Therefore, the result obtained by the Tang and Nilsson method can be considered as a certain upper limit to the real chloride binding capacity.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
360 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In this paper we have chosen a slight modification of the Tang and Nilsson method and used the specimens of more realistic dimensions. The crushed specimens were prepared as well for the sake of comparison.
3
Materials, samples and technology of measurement
In this paper, two lime-based plasters were studied, the first one was with metakaolin addition, VOM, and the second one was pure lime plaster for comparative purposes, VO. The mixture composition is given in Tab. 1. The amounts of particular substances are in kg per batch. Table 1: Type of Mixture VO VOM
Composition of plasters’ mixtures.
Lime CL 90 4.80 4.80
Sand 0/2 mm Bratčice 14.40 14.40
Metakaolin Mefisto K 05 1.20
Water 4.80 5.50
The lime CL 90 was produced by limekiln “Mokrá”, Czech Republic. The silica aggregates of fraction 0/2 mm were delivered by Heidelberg Cement Group, Brněnské písky Inc., affiliate Bratčice. Metakaolin MEFISTO K 05 was produced by “České lupkové závody Inc.”, Nové Strašecí. It is a highly active pozzolanic material on metakaolinite basis. MEFISTO is supposed to be used first of all as an alternative silicate binder. It can replace 5-15% of cement by weight at concrete production where it can be used instead of microsilica. It can also be utilized in the production of geopolymers. The reason for using MEFISTO in the mentioned applications is the supposed increase of compressive and flexural strength and frost resistance, decrease of water absorption and reduction of the occurrence of efflorescence. Average particle size of metakaolin is in the interval of 3 to 5 µm. The samples for the measurements of chloride binding isotherms were cut from the standard prisms. Two basic forms of specimens were prepared for the sake of comparison: specimens with a size of 40x40x10 mm and specimens crushed in a mill into 0.06 mm particles. The dry samples were placed into the cups with 200 ml chloride solution. Then they were stored in climatic chamber at 23±1°C to reach equilibrium. The inside solutions were analysed after six months. The concentration of chlorides was determined using the pH/ION 740 device with ion selective electrodes (ISE) to obtain the bound chloride content. The most important step is to calibrate chloride selective electrodes with different known chlorides concentrations diluted from standard solution. The amount of chloride ions in liquid samples can be then easily and rapidly determined using chloride selective electrodes. The ISE cell is immersed into measured solution and chloride concentration in mg/l solution is shown on the display of the pH/Ion measuring device. From the obtained data the bound chloride content was calculated and chloride binding isotherms were plotted.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
361
The chloride contents in the measured materials themselves were obtained by leaching granulated gravel in boiling water. Chloride content measured in this way using the chloride selective electrode was 0.2 mg/l in both cases.
4 Experimental results and discussion Firstly, bulk density, as a fundamental physical characteristic of the material, was determined on the vacuum saturation principle using Archimedes’ weight. Bulk densities of tested materials were 1 650 kg m-3 in the case of lime plaster and 1 670 kg m-3 for lime plaster with metakaolin addition. Fig. 1 shows chloride binding isotherms of lime plaster, VO, and lime plaster with metakaolin addition, VOM, measured by modified Tang and Nilsson adsorption method, i.e., for samples with defined shape. Clearly, the chloride binding capacity of both studied materials was quite high. The addition of metakaolin caused up to 30% increase of chloride binding capacity which was due to the formation of CSH structures. 800
600
3
Bound chlorides [kg/m -sample]
VOM VO
400
200
0 0
50
100
150
200
Free chlorides [kg/m3-solution]
Figure 1:
Chloride binding isotherms of lime-based composites measured by modified adsorption method.
Fig. 2 presents chloride binding isotherms measured with crushed particles of both studied lime-based composites as in the original Tang and Nilsson [8] procedure. Metakaolin addition led to higher binding capacity in this case as well. Figs. 3 and 4 compare chloride binding isotherms measured for finitedimension samples and crushed particles. The differences were for both tested materials mostly (except for one measuring point) not very high, up to 15% only.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
362 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 800
600
3
Bound chlorides [kg/m -sample]
VOM VO
400
200
0 0
50
100
150
200
3
Free chlorides [kg/m -solution]
Figure 2:
Chloride binding isotherms of lime-based composites measured for crushed particles.
800
600
3
Bound chlorides [kg/m -sample]
VOM samples VOM crushed particles
400
200
0 0
50
100
150
200
3
Free chlorides [kg/m -solution]
Figure 3:
Comparison of chloride binding isotherms of finite-dimension samples and crushed particles for lime-based plaster with metakaolin addition.
Fig. 5 presents a comparison of chloride binding isotherm of lime plaster with that of gypsum. The data for bound chlorides are recalculated to mg of chlorides per g of sample to exclude the effect of different bulk densities. The measured WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
363
results show that lime-based composites can bind much higher amount of chlorides than even gypsum which already possesses relatively high chloride binding capacity. 800
600
3
Bound chlorides [kg/m -sample]
VO samples VO crushed particles
400
200
0 0
50
100
150
200
3
Free chlorides [kg/m -solution]
Figure 4:
Comparison of chloride binding isotherms of finite-dimension samples and crushed particles for lime plaster.
Bound chlorides [mg/g-sample]
300 VO GP 240
180
120
60
0 0
50000
100000
150000
200000
Free chlorides [mg/l-solution]
Figure 5:
Comparison between chloride binding isotherm of gypsum and lime plaster.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
364 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In an analysis of the uncertainty of measurements in this paper, it should be noted first that achieving equilibrium for even rather small but not crushed samples is a long-term problem and the experiment takes usually several months. The measuring conditions during this time are supposed to remain stable. The measuring error in the determination of chloride concentration can be considered in our experiments as 10% or less because no interference effects of other present ions in measured solutions appeared.
5
Conclusions
The chloride binding isotherms of two different types of lime-based plasters were determined in the paper. The materials were tested in the form of samples with realistic dimensions and crushed particles. Experimental results showed that lime plaster with metakaolin addition had up to 30% higher chloride binding capacity than reference lime plaster which itself was quite high, much higher than for instance of gypsum. This may lead to relatively fast filling of the pore space of lime-based plasters by chlorides they are exposed to. On one hand this may be advantageous because for instance chlorides can be extracted from the underlying structure and transported to the render; for historical building this feature can be quite useful. On the other, the hygric properties of plasters with higher amount of bound chlorides can be changed significantly. In particular, there is an open question how the water vapour diffusion capability of the plaster will be affected. Another question is how the high amount of bound chlorides will affect the freeze/thaw resistance. These issues will be subject of further investigations.
Acknowledgement This research was supported by the Czech Science Foundation, under project No. 103/06/0031.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Cabrera, J., Rojas, M. F., Mechanism of hydration of the metakaolin-lime water system, the hydration phases of metakaolin-lime-water systems, Cement and Cement and Concrete Research, 31, pp. 177-182, 2001. Rojas, M. F., Cabrera, J., The effect of temperature on the hydration rate and stability of the hydration phases of metakaolin-lime-water systems, Cement and Concrete Research, 32, pp. 133-138, 2002. Rojas, M. F., Sánchez de Rojas, M. I., The effect of high curing temperature on the reaction kinetics in MK-lime and MK-blended cement matrices at 60 °C, Cement and Concrete Research, 33, pp. 643-649, 2003. Schwarzmann A., The effect of dehydroxylation/amorphization degree on pozzolanic activity of kaolinite, Cement and Concrete Research, 33, pp. 405-416, 2003. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[5] [6] [7]
[8]
365
Freundlich, C.G.L., Colloid and Capillary Chemistry. Metheun, London 1926. Dhir, R.K., Jones, M.R., Ahmed, H.E.H., Determination of total and soluble chlorides in concrete. Cement and Concrete Research, 20, pp. 579590, 1990. Glass, G.K., Buenfeld, N.R., The determination of chloride binding relationships. In: Proceedings of the RILEM International Workshop Chloride Penetration into Concrete, edited by Nilsson, L.O. and Ollivier, J.P. RILEM, St-Remy-les-Chevreuse, 1997, pp. 3-9. Tang, L., Nilsson, L.O., Chloride binding capacity and binding isotherms of OPC pastes and mortars. Cement and Concrete Research, 23, pp. 247253, 1993.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
367
Computational simulation of the effect of crystallization inhibitors on salt transport and crystallization in porous materials J. Kelnar, J. Maděra & R. Černý Department of Building Materials, Faculty of Civil Engineering, Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract Computational simulation of salt transport and crystallization in limestone depending on the presence of crystallization inhibitor in the dissolved salt is presented. The diffusion-advection model is used for the basic description of coupled water and salt transport, taking into account both water movement due to the moisture gradient and diffusion and dispersion effects within the liquid phase due to the concentration gradient. Salt crystallization in the porous body is modelled using an equilibrium model, taking into account the effect of crystallization inhibition. The effect of salt bonding on the pore walls is taken into account as well. The results of numerical simulations using a well calibrated computational model give evidence that in the analyzed case the use of crystallization inhibitors leads to the slowing down of both water and salt transport. Keywords: salt, moisture, transport, crystallization, computer simulation.
1
Introduction
The mathematical analysis of experimentally determined salt concentration profiles depends on the assumed mode of salt transport in the porous material. If purely diffusion transport is assumed, common methods for solving the inverse problems for parabolic equations can be used. The simplest method makes the assumption that the diffusion coefficient is constant, the domain under solution is semi-infinite, and the boundary condition on the remaining side of a
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070381
368 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII one-dimensional arrangement is Dirichlet type. The diffusion coefficient can be identified using the simple analytical solution of the parabolic problem with error function (e.g. [1]). The dependence of the diffusion coefficient on salt concentration can be found if some more sophisticated methods for the analysis of measured salt profiles are used. One of the methods that can be potentially used to determine concentration dependent salt diffusion coefficients in an analogous way as moisture diffusivity or thermal conductivity is a classical Boltzmann-Matano analysis [2]. In this paper, the diffusion-advection mechanism of salt solution transport (see, e.g., [3, 4]) is adopted, taking into account the influence of moisture flow on salt transport. The original model [3] is subject of some modifications tending to the improvement of model capabilities, particularly concerning the description of drying processes.
2
Computational model
In the diffusion-advection model of coupled water and salt transport described in [3, 4], the salt mass balance is expressed as ∂( wC f ) ∂t
G ∂C = div( wD gradC f ) − div(C f v ) − b , ∂t
(1)
where Cf is the concentration of free salts in water [kg/m3], Cb the concentration of bonded salts in the whole porous body, [kg/m3], D the salt diffusion G coefficient, [m2/s], v the Darcy’s velocity [m/s], and w the volumetric moisture content [m3/m3]. The water mass balance is expressed in the following way ∂w = div(κ gradw), ∂t
(2)
where κ is the moisture diffusivity [m2/s]. Expressing Darcy’s velocity in terms of moisture diffusivity,
G
ν = −κ gradw,
(3)
the salt solution transport can be described by a system of two parabolic partially coupled differential equations with two principal material parameters, D and κ, and three input variables, Cf, Cb, w that must be determined experimentally. In this paper, in addition to the effects taken into account in the original model, salt crystallization and water vapor transport are introduced as well, in order to facilitate modeling of drying experiments. The modified mathematical model can be then formulated as follows:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
∂ (wC f ) ∂t
H (C f , sat − C f ) =
[
∂C ∂ ∂ ∂w ∂Cb ∂Cc wD f + C f κ − − ∂x ∂x ∂x ∂x ∂t ∂t
]
∂Cc ∂ w(C f − C f , sat ) H (C f − C f , sat ) = ∂t ∂t ∂w ∂ ∂w ∂ δ ∂pv = κ + ∂t ∂x ∂x ∂x ρ w ∂x
369
(4)
(5) (6)
where Cc is the amount of crystallized salt (in kg/m3 of the sample), Cf,sat is the saturated free salt concentration (in kg/m3 of the solution), H is the Heaviside step unit function, H(x.0)=1, H(x<0)=0, δ the water vapor diffusion permeability (in s), pv the partial pressure of water vapor (Pa), and ρw the density of water (in kg/m3). The computational implementation of the mathematical model of coupled moisture and salt transport (4)-(6) was then performed using the Galerkin finite element method, and a computer code was written.
3
Simulated drying experiment and the parameter identification process
In the drying experiment (performed by L. Pel at TU Eindhoven, see [5] for details), limestone samples were saturated first by 3M-NaCl solution either without or with 0.001M Na4Fe(CN)6·10H2O as crystallization inhibitor. Then the drying process was started in an environment with a relative humidity close to 0%. Moisture and free chloride concentration profiles were measured every two hours using the NMR technique. The parameter identification process in the drying problem is more difficult than in the wetting experiment. The storage parameters can be measured using basically the same methods as in the wetting process, only the initial conditions are different because desorption is taking place during drying. However, the determination of transport parameters cannot be done in a similar way as in the case of wetting. The main problem is with the boundary conditions in the drying process where contrary to the wetting process the Newton conditions are to be used. This leads to a necessity to identify another unknown parameter, which is the moisture transfer coefficient between the specimen surface and the surroundings. If the moisture diffusivity and salt diffusion coefficient in the drying phase could be considered the same as in the wetting phase, than the fitting procedure to find the moisture transfer coefficient might be relatively easy although this parameter is supposedly a function of moisture content. Unfortunately, both moisture diffusivity and salt diffusion coefficient appear to depend on the orientation of the process similarly as the moisture and salt storage parameters. As a consequence, for the determination of three unknown parameters (which, in addition, are the functions of field variables of an WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
370 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII unknown type) we have only two sets of measured profiles. In such a case the solution of the inverse problem can only be roughly estimated using a computational fitting procedure and this estimate cannot be considered as a unique solution. Nevertheless, even this rough estimate can be useful for an improvement of the accuracy of computer simulated data in the coupled water and salt transport process.
4
Computational results
In the computational simulations, moisture diffusivity, chloride diffusion coefficient and moisture transfer coefficient were the free parameters which were supposed to be fitted according to the experimental data. The least square method was used for the assessment of simulated data in the particular cases. Fig. 1 shows a comparison of moisture transfer coefficients α calculated for the process of drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution with and without inhibitor. The presence of inhibitor in the solution has led to a significant decrease of moisture transfer coefficient, in certain moisture ranges even to almost one half when compared to the solution without inhibitor. In other words, the inhibitor caused the evaporation rate from the specimen surface to decrease.
α[s/m]
1.4E-06 1.2E-06
w ithout inhibitor
1.0E-06
w ith inhibitor
8.0E-07 6.0E-07 4.0E-07 2.0E-07 0.0E+00 0
0.05
0.1
0.15 3
0.2
0.25
3
w[m /m ]
Figure 1:
Final moisture transfer coefficient.
Fig. 2 gives evidence that liquid moisture transport in limestone was slowed down quite remarkably when inhibitor was added to the NaCl solution. The differences in moisture diffusivity were as high as one to two orders of magnitude. This seems to be a surprising result. Taking into account that the porous matrix should be basically unaffected by the presence of inhibitor which is not supposed to react with it or to promote its chemical reaction with NaCl, the most probable reason for the decrease of moisture diffusivity was an increase in viscosity of the solution. However, this is not an expected behaviour of crystallization inhibitor in salt solution. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
371
1.00E-06
1.00E-07 κ[m 2/s]
w ithout inhibitor w ith inhibitor
1.00E-08
1.00E-09 0
0.1
0.2 w[m 3/m 3]
Figure 2:
Final moisture diffusivity. t=36000s calculated
0.22
t=43200s calculated
w [m 3/m 3]
0.21
t=50400s calculated t=57600s calculated
0.2
t=64800s calculated t=36000s measured
0.19
t=43200s measured
0.18
t=50400s measured t=57600s measured
0.17 0
10
20
30
t=64800s measured
Distance [mm]
Figure 3:
Comparison of calculated and experimental moisture profiles for drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution without inhibitor.
Figs. 3 and 4 present examples of the comparison of calculated and experimental moisture profiles for drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution with and without inhibitor. The differences between computational and measured data are for both experiments clearly in reasonable limits, taking into account the irregularities in the material which are well visible on experimental curves. Fig. 5 shows that the chloride binding capacity of limestone decreased due to the presence of inhibitor over almost whole the range of free chloride WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
372 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII concentrations. However, the differences in the amounts of bound chlorides were not very high, only 5% in maximum, so that the trend could not be evidenced definitely. The chloride diffusion coefficient in limestone was affected by the crystallization inhibitor in a significant way only in the range of lower concentrations (typically, up to 170 kgm-3) where it decreased by one to two orders of magnitude as it is documented in Fig. 6. This may be related to an increased viscosity of the solution, or, possibly, also to a decreased interface tension on the pore walls. 0.30 t=0s calculated
w [m 3/m 3]
0.28
t=7200s calculated
0.26
t=14400s calculated t=21600s calculated
0.24
t=28800s calculated
0.22
t=0s measured
0.20
t=7200s measured
t=14400s measured
0.18 0
5
10
15
20
t=21600s measured
25
t=28800s measured
Distance [mm]
Figure 4:
Comparison of calculated and experimental moisture profiles for drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution with inhibitor. 210
3
C b[kg/m ]
205 200 w ithout inhibitor
195
w ith inhibitor
190 90
140
190 Cf[kg/m 3]
Figure 5:
Final chloride binding isotherms.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
240
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
373
1.0E-07 w ithout inhibitor w ith inhibitor
D[m 2/s]
1.0E-08
1.0E-09
1.0E-10 100
150
200
250
Cf[kg/m 3]
Figure 6:
Final chloride diffusion coefficients. t=144000s calculated
220
t=151200s calculated
Cf [kg/m 3]
200
t=158400s calculated
180
t=165600s calculated
160
t=172800s calculated
140
t=144000s measured
120
t=151200s measured
100
t=158400s measured
0
10
20
30
40
Distance [mm]
Figure 7:
t=165600s measured t=172800s measured
Comparison of calculated and experimental free NaCl concentration profiles for drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution without inhibitor.
Figs. 7 and 8 present examples of the comparison of calculated and experimental free chloride concentration profiles for NaCl solutions with and without inhibitor. Similarly as with the moisture profiles, the differences between measured and computer simulated data were within reasonable limits so that the model could be considered as applicable for the prediction of moisture and salt concentration profiles.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
374 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII t=72000s calculated
210
t=79200s calculated
C f [kg/m 3]
190
t=86400s calculated
170
t=93600s calculated
150
t=100800s calculated
130
t=72000s measured
110
t=79200s measured
90
t=86400s measured
0
10
20
30
40
Distance [mm]
Figure 8:
t=93600s measured
t=100800s measured
Comparison of calculated and experimental free NaCl concentration profiles for drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution with inhibitor.
5 Conclusions Computational simulations of coupled water and salt transport in this paper have shown that in the process of drying of limestone saturated with 3-M NaCl solution both water transport and chloride transport were slowed down due to the addition of 0.001-M Na4Fe(CN)6·10H2O as crystallization inhibitor. The explanation of this finding may lie in the increase of viscosity of the chloride solution and/or decrease of interface tension on the pore walls. This statement is, however, just a hypothesis at the moment which should be verified by further experimental work.
Acknowledgement This research was supported by Czech Science Foundation, under grant No. 103/06/0031.
References [1] [2] [3]
Carslaw H.S., Jaeger J.C. Conduction of Heat in Solids. Clarendon Press, Oxford, 1959. Matano, C. On the relation between the diffusion coefficient and concentration of solids metals. Jap. J. Phys. 8, pp.109-115, 1933. Bear, J., Bachmat, Y. Introduction to Modeling of Transport Phenomena in Porous Media. Vol. 4, Kluwer, Dordrecht 1990.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[4] [5]
375
Pel L., Kopinga K., Kaasschieter E. F. Saline absorption in calciumsilicate brick observed by NMR scanning. J. Phys. D: Appl. Phys, 33, 1380–1385, 2000. Pel L., Černý R., Pavlík Z. Moisture and Ion Transport. WP5 2-Years Report of the EU 6th Program Project SSPI-CT-2003-501571. TU Eindhoven, Eindhoven 2006.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
377
Desalination of historical masonry using hydrophilic mineral wool boards P. Michálek, V. Tydlitát, M. Jerman & R. Černý Department of Building Materials, Faculty of Civil Engineering, Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract In the desalination measures hydrophilic mineral wool can be considered as a possible alternative to the commonly used cellulose. Contrary to cellulose, it can be used repeatedly, and its effectiveness is higher because of the dominant mode of water transport along the hydrophilic fibers. In this paper, experimental investigation of desalination potential of several different types of hydrophilic mineral wools is performed. The obtained results show that high-density materials are the most effective for this type of application. Keywords: desalination, hydrophilic mineral wool, water transport, salt solution transport.
1
Introduction
Avoiding water penetration into components of building structures is a fundamental principle for their maintenance. The most important mitigation method is prevention through the physical separation of building materials from soil moisture and salts with the traditional damp-proof course. This is typically an impermeable barrier such as plastic, glazed brick, bitumen. Using such protection measures in historical masonry is, however, mostly not feasible. Therefore, it is necessary to deal with consequences of salt penetration into the structural elements and use repeatedly desalination techniques. In existing salt-laden structures salts can be removed through poulticing and in some cases the affected masonry may be replaced. However, in the past few decades the cost of such replacement has led to increasing use of chemical dampproof courses in the form of injected siloxane. Hydrophilic mineral wool seems to be a perspective material for desalination purposes. Hydrophilic admixtures in mineral wool accelerate liquid moisture WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070391
378 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII transport, and thus make new applications possible for mineral wool products. Apart from the interior thermal insulation where the usefulness of hydrophilic fiber treatment has already been proven in couple of cases, desalination or dehumidification of historical masonry can be considered as typical examples where one can take advantage of the superior water transport capability of this type of materials. In this paper, basic material parameter data of several hydrophilic mineral wool materials are presented which can serve as input parameters for computational models of service life prediction analyses, namely the water vapour-, water- and salt solution transport parameters. Also, two typical experiments for demonstrating the dehumidification and desalination potential of hydrophilic mineral wool are described.
2 Experimental methods 2.1 Basic material parameters As fundamental physical material characteristics, bulk density ρb [kgm-3], vacuum saturation moisture content wsat [kgm-3], porosity [Vol.-%] and matrix density ρm [kgm-3] were determined. They were obtained using the gravimetric method and the water vacuum saturation method. The vacuum saturation moisture content was calculated according to the equation
wsat = ρ w
msat − m0 = ρ wψ , msat − ma
(1)
where ρw is the water density [kg m-3], m0, msat and ma are the mass of dry sample, water- saturated sample and mass of the immersed water - saturated sample [kg], respectively, and ψ is the open porosity, which is defined as the ratio of the volume of open pores in material to its total volume. Matrix density was calculated as
ρ mat =
m0 , V (1 −ψ )
(2)
where V is sample volume [m3]. The measurement of basic parameters took place in a conditioned laboratory at the temperature of 22±1 ˚C and 25-30% relative humidity. Each result represents the average value from four to five measured values. 2.2 Water vapour-, water- and salt solution transport parameters Two versions of the common cup method were employed in the measurements of the water vapor diffusion coefficient [1]. In the first one the sealed cup containing silica gel (5% relative humidity) was placed in a controlled climatic WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
379
chamber with 97% relative humidity and weighed periodically. In the second one the cup containing the saturated solution of K2SO4 (97% relative humidity) was placed in 25% relative humidity environment. The measurements were done at 20°C in a period of one week. The steady state values of mass gain or loss were determined by linear regression for the last three readings. The water vapor diffusion coefficient D [m2s-1] was calculated from the measured data according to the equation
D=
∆m ⋅ d ⋅ R ⋅ T S ⋅ τ ⋅ M ⋅ ∆p p
,
(3)
where ∆m the amount of water vapor diffused through the sample [kg], d the sample thickness [m], S the specimen surface [m2], τ the period of time corresponding to the transport of mass of water vapor ∆m [s], ∆pp the difference between partial water vapor pressure in the air under and above specific specimen surface [Pa], R the universal gas constant, M the molar mass of water, T the absolute temperature [K]. On the basis of the diffusion coefficient D, the water vapor diffusion resistance factor µ was determined,
µ=
Da D
(4)
,
where Da is the diffusion coefficient of water vapor in the air. The water and salt solution sorptivity was measured using a standard experimental setup. The specimen was water and vapor-proof insulated on four lateral sides and the face side was immersed 1-2 mm in the water or salt solution. The automatic balance allowed recording the increase of mass. The water absorption coefficient A [kgm-2s-1/2] was then calculated using the formula
i = A⋅ t ,
(5)
where i is the cumulative water or salt solution absorption [kg/m2], t is the time from the beginning of the suction experiment. The water or salt solution absorption coefficient was then employed for the calculation of the apparent moisture diffusivity in the form [2] 2
κ app
A , ≈ w − c w0
(6)
where wc is the saturated moisture content [kgm-3] and w0 the initial moisture content [kgm-3]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
380 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In the experimental work, the following samples for each material and fiber orientation were used: water vapor diffusion coefficient – 9 cylinders with the diameter 105 mm and thickness 20 mm, water sorptivity - 5 specimens 50 x 50 x 25-50 mm according the thickness of the layer cut from the insulation board. 2.3 Drying experiment Water transport from porous building material saturated with water through different kinds of hydrophilic mineral wool materials was investigated. In the experiments brick, sandstone or autoclaved aerated concrete (AAC) samples with dimensions 60x60x30(65) mm were water and water vapour proof insulated with epoxy resin on four lateral and one frontal sides (one side remained uninsulated), and these samples were immersed into water until they were entirely saturated with water. Then dried samples of hydrophilic mineral wool were prepared and insulated with silicon rubber on four lateral sides. Next step was connecting the brick, sandstone or AAC samples and hydrophilic mineral wool samples uninsulated sides together in order not to prevent evaporation from one uninsulated side of the mineral wool sample to the laboratory environment (21 ± 1°C, 20 % relative humidity). The junction between brick, sandstone or AAC and mineral wool was insulated from the outside with sanitary silicone. The brick or sandstone samples and mineral wool samples were mechanically stuck together with a simple construction (see Fig. 1).
Figure 1:
Drying experiment.
Two saturated brick, sandstone or AAC samples were not equipped with mineral wool layer and were left drying from their one uninsulated front side as reference samples for the sake of drying velocity comparison. The fiber orientation in mineral wool samples was perpendicular to moisture transport WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
381
direction (except for PRG, which fiber orientation was parallel to moisture transport direction). This experiment performance respects fiber orientation in supplied insulation boards in order to simulate moisture transport within these boards applied on the masonry. All samples were periodically weighted and weight losses caused by drying were recorded. Time dependent history of moisture content in the porous material samples was calculated from these data. 2.4 Desalination experiment Salt solution transport from porous building material (brick, sandstone) to a water saturated hydrophilic mineral wool layer DR was studied in this experiment. The porous building material samples were water and water vapour proof insulated on five sides with epoxy resin (one side remained uninsulated) and put into desiccator with 1-M sodium chloride solution in order to saturate them with the solution. Afterwards, hydrophilic mineral wool samples were prepared and water and water vapour proof insulated with silicone rubber on four lateral sides and left for one day in sealed desiccator filled with distilled water. Then the porous building material samples and mineral wool DR samples were stuck together in the same way as at the drying experiment (see Fig. 2).
Figure 2:
Desalination experiment.
After chosen time (1 hour, 1 day, 1 week) the appropriate couples of hydrophilic mineral wool samples were separated from porous building material samples and dried out at 100 °C. Finally, the chloride ions concentration in distilled water leach from these samples in mg/l was measured. The desalination experiments differed from each other as for the porous building material type (brick or sandstone) and thickness (30, 60, 120 mm) and the mineral wool sample thickness (25, 50, 100 mm).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
382 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Hydrophilic mineral wool materials
Several hydrophilic mineral wool materials manufactured by Rockwool CZ and potentially applicable for desalination purposes were analyzed. The first of them was two-layered material DD consisting of soft low-density layer DDS and hard high-density layer DDH. The second was ultra-low-density board PRG and the last one the high-density board DR which was designed specifically for ultra-fast water transport. All materials had the fiber orientation parallel to the board surface, except for the PRG boards which had the fibers parallel to the water flow.
4 Experimental results and discussion The results of basic material parameter measurements are presented in Table 1. The matrix density of studied materials is within possible production range. Porosity of all materials is higher than 90 %, which is typical for this type of material, the matrix density corresponds with typical values for basalt. Table 1:
Basic material parameters. Bulk
Material
density [kg/m3]
Porosity
Matrix density
[Vol.-%] [kg/m3]
DDS
90
96.4
2540
DDH
210
91.9
2540
PRG
60
96.5
2697
DR
164
93.1
2644
Table 2 presents water vapour properties of studied materials. All materials exhibit quite similar values of water vapour diffusion resistance factor. It is obvious, that bulk density for this type of material does not affect diffusion resistance in a significant way. Water and salt solution transport properties are presented in Table 3. Highest values are reached by material DR, which was specially designed for very fast liquid moisture transport. The example of the course of the drying process of porous building material samples through a hydrophilic mineral wool layer is presented in Fig. 3 for AAC. The fastest drying occurs for samples without hydrophilic mineral wool layer which is obviously caused by the diffusion resistance of mineral wool being
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
383
approximately two to four times higher that diffusion resistance of the air. Among the experimental setups with mineral wool layers the fastest drying was observed for DDH. The other hydrophilic mineral wool materials exhibited very similar drying rates. Table 2:
Water vapour diffusion properties.
Water vapour diffusion coefficient Material
97/25%
5/25%
Water vapour diffusion resistance factor
5/87%
97/25 %
5/25%
D [m2s-1]
5/87 %
µ [-]
DDS
1.2 E-5
6.25 E-6
6.2 E-6
1.9
3.7
3.8
DDH
1.4 E-5
6.3 E-6
7.3 E-5
1.8
3.9
3.2
PRG
1.6 E-5
5.5 E-6
5.3 E-6
1.4
4.2
4.3
DR
1.3 E-5
7.0 E-6
7.2 E-6
1.8
3.3
3.2
Table 3:
Water and salt solution transport parameters.
Water absorption coefficient A [kg m-2s-1/2] Material water
0,1 M NaCl
0,2 M NaCl
0,5 M NaCl
0,8 M NaCl
1M NaCl
DDH
5.66
5.86
5.50
5.80
5.13
5.23
DDS
3.63
2.38
2.63
1.91
1.43
1.28
PRG
3.70
3.60
3.41
3.22
3.44
3.36
DR
5.13
-
-
4.91
-
5.43
Figure 4 presents results of the desalination experiment: time dependent NaCl transport process from ordinary brick into hydrophilic mineral wool. It is evident, that while thickness of joined mineral wool samples remains the same, the smaller is the brick sample thickness the higher is the amount of transported NaCl solution into mineral wool samples within the same time intervals.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
384 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
100
progress of drying [%]
90 without min.wool without min.wool DDH DDH
80 70 60 50
DDS DDS PRG PRG DR
40 30 20 10
DR
0 0
240
480
720
time [h]
Figure 3:
Drying of AAC specimens through hydrophilic mineral wool layer.
70 brick desalination (%)
60 50 40 30 20
brick 30 mm, DR 100 mm
10
brick 60 mm, DR 100 mm
0 0
50
100
150
200
time (h)
Figure 4:
NaCl solution transport from brick specimen into hydrophilic mineral wool layer.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
385
Conclusions
Experimental work presented in this paper confirmed that hydrophilic mineral wool possesses good prerequisites for utilization in the building industry in cases where fast moisture and salt transport is required. Liquid moisture and salt solution transport in this type of material is significantly faster than in most other building materials, water vapour diffusion resistance factor differs from ordinary mineral wool only in the range of measurement error. As for the presumed application purpose, hydrophilic mineral wool cannot be used for simultaneous drying and salt transport, but only for one purpose in selected time, i.e., either for water transport or for salt transport. This is a consequence of the fact that for moisture removal from a porous building material the hydrophilic mineral wool layer has to be dry, but it has to be water saturated for the purpose of desalination use. The hydrophilic mineral wool utilization for desalination is also restricted to the seasons without frost. On the other hand, it is possible to use this material for drying purposes also in winter period, because it can protect historic masonry from frost in the form of exterior thermal insulation, and thus continue in the water removal from the masonry also in these quite unfavourable conditions. However, in the subsequent summer period it is more appropriate to remove the insulation boards from the drying structure because natural drying of the masonry depends on outside temperature and in summer it is faster with an open material surface than through hydrophilic mineral wool layer.
Acknowledgement This research was supported by the Ministry of Education, Youth and Sports of Czech Republic, under project No MSM: 6840770031.
References [1]
[2]
S. Roels, J. Carmeliet, H. Hens, O. Adan, H. Brocken, R. Černý, Z. Pavlík, C. Hall, K. Kumaran, L. Pel, R. Plagge, Interlaboratory Comparison of Hygric Properties of Porous Building Materials. Journal of Thermal Envelope and Building Science 27(2004), 307-325. R. Černý, J. Poděbradská, J. Drchalová, Water and water vapor penetration through coatings. Journal of Thermal Envelope and Building Science 26(2002), 165-177.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Section 5 Heat transfer
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
389
Numerical investigation on natural convection in asymmetric channel-chimney systems A. Andreozzi1 , B. Buonomo2 & O. Manca2 1 DETEC,
2 DIAM,
Universit`a di Napoli FEDERICO II, Napoli, Italy Seconda Universit`a di Napoli, Aversa (CE), Italy
Abstract A numerical investigation on two-dimensional transient natural convection in a vertical channel-chimney system with the channel heated asymmetrically and the chimney geometrically asymmetric is carried out. The heated channel wall is at uniform heat flux and the other one is assumed to be adiabatic. The chimney walls are adiabatic. Results are obtained for different expansion and extension ratios of the channel-chimney system and Rayleigh number equal to 104 and 106 . They are presented in terms of maximum heated wall temperatures and average Nusselt number as a function of time and stream function fields for some time values. Optimal thermal configurations in terms of minimum value of maximum heated wall temperature and maximum average Nusselt numbers are evaluated. Complex flow structures in the channel-chimney system are detected. Keywords: natural convection, numerical investigation, asymmetric channelchimney systems.
1 Introduction More recent trends in natural convection research are to find new configurations to improve the heat transfer parameters or to analyze standard configurations to carry out optimal geometrical parameters for a higher heat transfer rate and the transient behavior for a suitable thermal design. A very simple method, which allows to improve the chimney effect and consequently heat transfer rate in vertical channels and other configurations, is to place parallel adiabatic extensions downstream heated configurations [1, 2]. A first research on the chimney effects was obtained by Haaland and Sparrow [2]. A vertical channel with point source or distributed heat source situated at WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070401
390 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII channel inlet was investigated. A numerical study on the natural convection in an isothermal vertical parallel-plates with straight adiabatic downstream extensions was carried out in [3]. A numerical investigation on unheated chimney attached to a vertical isothermal tube was accomplished in [4]. A numerical study on isoflux channels using the elliptic form of the governing equations was conducted in [5]. A composite I-shaped computational domain was employed in order to obtain a more realistic model. A numerical simulation of a channel-chimney system was carried out in [6]. How and why the “chimney effect” worsens was emphasized. It was connected to the cold inflow at the outlet section and this effect was more stressed at higher Rayleigh number. Numerical and experimental flow visualizations were carried out in [7]. Results were presented in terms of stream function and temperature fields for different expansion and extension ratios. An experimental investigation on air natural convection in a vertical channel asymmetrically heated at uniform heat flux, with downstream unheated parallel extensions, was carried out in [8]. One extension was coplanar to the unheated channel wall and the distance between the extensions was equal to or greater than the channel gap. Optimal configurations of the system with asymmetrical chimney were detected. It seems that numerical investigations on transient natural convection in vertical channels have been carried out only for simple channel configurations [9–12] and vertical symmetrical channel-chimney system with the channel heated symmetrically [13]. Then, there is a lack of investigations on transient natural convection in vertical asymmetrical channel-chimney system heated asymmetrically. In this paper a numerical simulation for two-dimensional, laminar and transient regime is carried out in an asymmetric channel-chimney system. The computational domain is made up of the physical configuration and two reservoirs placed upstream and downstream the channel-chimney system. The numerical analysis is obtained by means of the commercial Fluent code. Results are obtained for different expansion and extension ratios of the channel-chimney system and Rayleigh number. They are presented in terms of stream function fields for some times, maximum heated wall temperatures and average Nusselt number as a function of time.
2 Mathematical description and numerical procedure The aim of this paper is the transient numerical analysis of natural convection in air in an asymmetric channel-chimney system. The investigated geometry is depicted in Fig. 1(a). It is made up of a vertical channel with two parallel plates, one plate is heated with uniform heat flux q˙ and the other one is adiabatic; the height of the heated plate is Lh whereas the channel gap is b. On the top of the channel, there is a chimney made up of two insulated parallel and vertical plates; their height is L−Lh and the distance between them is B. An enlarged computational domain has been chosen. It is made up of the previously described geometry and of two reservoirs of height Lx and width Ly , which are placed upstream of the channel and downstream WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
391 I
H
B
Lx
G
b
F D
E
L
M
B
g
b
L
Lh
L
Lh
x
q&
C
B
y
N
O
Lx
x
A
(a)
P
Ly
(b)
Figure 1: Sketch of the system: (a) physical domain; (b) computational domain.
of the chimney. The employed computational domain is shown in Fig. 1(b). All thermophysical properties of the fluid are assumed to be constant with temperature except for the density, as suggested by the Boussinesq approximation. With the above assumptions, the governing equations are in dimensionless form: ∂V ∂U + =0 ∂X ∂Y
(1)
2 ∂ U ∂U ∂U 2 ∂ (U V ) ∂P ∂2U + + =− + + ∂τ ∂X ∂Y ∂X ∂X 2 ∂Y 2
(2)
2 ∂ V ∂V ∂ (U V ) ∂V 2 ∂P ∂2V + + =− + + + Grθ ∂τ ∂X ∂Y ∂Y ∂X 2 ∂Y 2
(3)
∂ (U θ) ∂ (V θ) 1 ∂2θ ∂2θ ∂θ + + = + ∂τ ∂X ∂Y Pr ∂X 2 ∂Y 2
(4)
where the dimensionless variables are defined as: X = x/b,
Y = y/b,
U = ub/ν,
V = vb/ν,
P = (p − p∞ ) b2 /(ρ ν 2 ), Gr = g β q˙ b4 /(k ν 2 ),
τ = (tν)/b2 ,
θ = (T − T∞ ) k/(q˙ b),
P r = ν/a,
Ra = Gr P r
(5)
In Eq.(4) the terms of viscous dissipation and of pressure work are neglected. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
392 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 1: Boundary conditions. Zone
Boundary conditions
AB, OP, PA
Pressure Inlet
GH, HI, IL
Pressure Outlet ∂θ = −1 No slip condition, ∂Y ∂θ =0 No slip condition, ∂X ∂θ =0 No slip condition, ∂Y
CD BC, DE, FG, LM, NO EF, MN
The average Nusselt number is defined as: b Nu = Lh
L h /b
0
dX θw (X)
(6)
With reference to Fig. 1(b), the imposed boundary conditions are reported in Table 1. The commercial Fluent CFD code was employed to solve the governing equations. The SIMPLE scheme was chosen to couple pressure and velocity. The converging criteria were 10−6 for the residuals of the velocity components and 10−8 for the residuals of the energy. The time at which steady state or quasi steady state conditions are assumed is denoted as τss . A preliminary study has been performed to determine an adequate grid to ensure grid independence of the main variables such as the average Nusselt number, N u. Computations have been made for the flow corresponding to Ra = 104 , a time step equal to ∆τ = 10−3 , for a channel aspect ratio Lh /b equal to 10, L/Lh = 1.5 and B/b = 4.0 on a grid consisting of 35 × 11, 71 × 21, 141 × 41 and 281 × 81 grid points inside the vertical channel. The percentage discrepancy between the average Nusselt number value on a grid consisting of 71 × 21 and an asymptotic value obtained by means of the Richardson extrapolation is less than 1.5%. So, the results reported in this paper have been obtained with a 71 × 21 grid which ensured a good compromise between the computational time and accuracy. A comparison among the N u values for four different time steps, ∆τ = 10−2 , 10−3 , 10−4 and 10−5 , has been carried out for the 71 × 21 mesh for the configuration with Lh /b = 10, L/Lh = 1.5 and B/b = 4.0 at different Rayleigh number values. The time step in the transient calculations is fixed at ∆τ = 10−3 for Ra in the range [102 − 104 ], with a maximum percentage discrepancy equal to 0.1%, and ∆τ = 10−4 for Ra = 105 and 106 , with a maximum percentage discrepancy equal to 0.5%. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
0.3
0.8
Ra=10 6 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=1.5
0.55 0.50 0.45
θw,max
0.2
0.3
0.4
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0 0
2
τ
0.20 0.19 0.18 0.17 0.03
0.2
0.5
0.4
0.2
0.21
θw,max
Ra=10 4 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=1.5
0.6
0
393
0
0.05
0.06
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0
0.1
4
0.04
0
0.2
(a)
τ
0.4
0.6
(b)
Figure 2: Maximum heated wall temperature as a function of time at different expansion ratio values, Lh /b = 10 and L/Lh = 1.5 for: (a) Ra = 104 and (b) Ra = 106 .
An analogous analysis has been carried out to set the optimal reservoirs dimensions, Lx and Ly . A reservoir horizontal dimension, Ly , equal to eleven times b and a reservoir vertical dimension, Lx , equal to the heated plate length Lh have been chosen.
3 Results and discussion In the following results are presented for air, for a channel aspect ratio Lh /b = 10, for an extension ratio L/Lh = 1.5 and 2.0 and for an expansion ratio B/b = 1.0, 1.5, 2.0, 3.0 and 4.0. In the following comparison with data related to simple channel are given. All data are in dimensionless form and the results are showed for Ra = 104 and 106 . Maximum heated wall temperature as a function of the time for Ra = 104 and 106 and B/b = 1.0, 1.5, 2.0, 3.0 and 4.0 and the simple channel is reported in Figs. 2 and 3 for L/Lh = 1.5 and 2.0, respectively. In all cases, maximum wall temperature increases as the time increases up to a maximum value, which is attained at smaller time value as larger the Ra value is. When the maximum wall temperature profile has attained the maximum with respect to the time, its value decreases and the maximum temporal value is an overshoot. The overshoot in wall temperature profile is typical of the natural convection problem in configuration with walls heated at assigned heat flux. For simple channel the maximum wall temperature at steady state is the greatest value among the different cases for different B/b values, resulting the most critical configuration at the steady state condition, according with [6]. However, it is interesting to observe that for WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
394 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII L/Lh = 1.5 and Ra = 104 , in Fig. 2(a), the maximum value for B/b = 1.0 is the greatest whereas the simple channel presents the overshoot almost equal to the other configurations. This result for asymmetric geometrical and heated channelchimney system is in agreement with the results for symmetric geometrical and heated channel-chimney system [13]. For Ra = 104 , in Figs. 2(a) and 3(a), after the overshoot the temperature value decreases until it attains a minimum value, except for the simple channel. Moreover, the best configuration at the steady state, in terms of minimum value of the maximum wall temperature, is obtained for B/b = 1.5. For L/Lh = 2.0 the configuration with B/b = 4.0 presents some oscillations due to the downflow or cold inflow of the fluid in the channel-chimney system which allows the penetration of cold air from the outlet section of the system in the chimney. The cold inflow determines a periodic flow for this configuration. This is in agreement with [14]. For Ra = 106 heated wall temperature profiles, in Figs. 2(b) and 3(b), after the first overshoot and undershoot, show damped oscillations for the simple channel and B/b ≤ 3.0. For B/b = 4.0 the oscillations are almost constant in the time but the average profiles is constant, i. e., the profile oscillates around a quasi steady state value of the maximum wall temperature. For this Ra value equal to 106 , the best configuration at steady or quasi-steady state is obtained for B/b = 4.0. This means that at steady or quasi-steady state for Ra = 106 , in the range of the considered expansion ratio, a greater cold inflow in an asymmetric heated channel-chimney system allows an enhancement of the heat transfer in the channel whereas for the symmetric heated channel-chimney system the cold inflow determines a decrease of the mass flow rate and consequently of the heat transfer in the channel [14]. In Figs. 2 and 3 it is observed that increasing the extension ratio, L/Lh , the maximum heated wall temperature values at steady or quasi-steady state decrease according with the increase of the mass flow rate due to the greater buoyancy force. In Fig. 4 the Nusselt number as a function of time is reported for Ra = 106 and L/Lh = 1.5 and 2.0. The trends of the profiles confirm the oscillations for this Rayleigh number value. The configurations for B/b = 4.0 present the highest Nusselt number values among the considered configurations for both the extension ratios. They correspond to the best configurations also in terms of the heat transfer coefficients. Moreover, the percent increase of the Nusselt number between L/Lh = 1.5 and L/Lh = 2.0 for B/b = 4.0 at quasi-steady state is about 25%. Stream function fields for Ra = 106 , L/Lh = 2.0 and B/b = 2.0 and 4.0 at some times are given in Figs. 5 and 6. For the smaller considered B/b at τ = τss /50, in Fig. 5(a), the fluid flows inside the channel adjacent to the heated wall whereas close to the opposite adiabatic wall, the shroud, a sort of vortex cell is present. This cell is extended in the chimney up to half height of the chimney. For τ ≥ τss /5, in Figs. 5(b)-5(d), the fluid enters in the channel and the vortex is moved completely in the chimney. For τ = τss /5, in Fig. 5(b), a cold inflow coming from the outlet section of the chimney goes in the chimney and a vortex cell is present close to the adiabatic wall in the upper part of the chimney. The vortex cell for τ = τss /2, in Fig. 5(c), expands inside the chimney and there is WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
0.3
0.8
Ra=10 4 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=2.0
0.6
0.55
0.45 0.40 0.3
0.4
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0 0
2
4
τ
6
8
0.18 0.16 0.02
0.2
0.5
0.4
0.0
0.20
θw,max
θw,max
0.2
0.2
0.22
Ra=10 6 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=2.0
0.50
0.0 0.0
0.04
0.06
0.08
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0
0.1
10
395
0.2
0.4
(a)
τ
0.6
0.8
1.0
(b)
Figure 3: Maximum heated wall temperature as a function of time at different expansion ratio values, Lh /b = 10 and L/Lh = 2.0 for: (a) Ra = 104 and (b) Ra = 106 .
12
12
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0
Nu 8
6
Simple channel B/b=1.0 B/b=1.5 B/b=2.0 B/b=3.0 B/b=4.0
6
10
Nu
Ra=10 6 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=1.5
10
Ra=10 Lh/b=10 L/Lh=2.0
8
0
0.4
τ
0.8
1.2
6 0.0
0.2
(a)
0.4
τ
0.6
0.8
1.0
(b)
Figure 4: Average Nusselt number as a function of time at different expansion ratio values, Ra = 106 and Lh /b = 10 for: (a) L/Lh = 1.5 and (b) L/Lh = 2.0. not cold inflow. For τ = τss = 0.8, in Fig. 5(d), the cold inflow is extended in the greater part of the chimney and it penetrates in the channel. The vortex cell is squashed on the higher part of the shroud. For B/b = 4.0 at τ = τss /50, in Fig. 6(a), two cells are present, one in the channel and one in the lower part of the chimney close to the channel outlet section on the heated wall side. Increasing the time, Figs. 6(b)-6(d), the cell in the channel disappears whereas vortices are present in the lower corner of the chimney and adjacent to the adiabatic shroud. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
396 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
30
30
25
48
44
4
0
375
20
20
15
25 419
790
X
X
X
5
5
0
0
0
-10
46
5
44
-2
677 0
0
-10
2
Y (a)
0
-10
2
Y
904
5 0
901 999
-5
-2
481
20
10
564
-5
1442
15
10
5
484
749
15
10
-5
25
250
1249
20
15
10
30 1499
113
25
X
30
-2
0
-10
2
Y
(b)
1202
1067
-5
(c)
1107 -2
0
2
Y (d)
6
Figure 5: Stream function fields for Ra = 10 , L/Lh = 2.0 and B/b = 2.0 at: (a) τ = τss /50, (b) τ = τss /5, (c) τ = τss /2 and (d) τ = τss .
30
30
30
25
25
30
72 1092
54
20
20 15
15
10 5
5
5
0
0
0
109
54
-10 -4
-2
Y
0
614
918
72
90 -5
(a)
-10 -4
10 5
876
64
-5
-5
2
322 15
643
10
10
-2
(b)
Y
0
2
-10 -4
1434 943
20
X
614
X
X
15
25 1179
20
0 3
-5
707 -2
Y
0
2
(c)
-10 -4
472
707
599
90
X
25
-2
Y
0
2
(d)
6
Figure 6: Stream function fields for Ra = 10 , L/Lh = 2.0 and B/b = 4.0 at: (a) τ = τss /50, (b) τ = τss /5, (c) τ = τss /2 and (d) τ = τss .
4 Conclusions Transient natural convection in air in a vertical asymmetrical channel-chimney system asymmetrically heated was numerically investigated. The channel heated wall was considered at uniform heat flux and results allowed to detect the different fluid dynamic and thermal behaviors for different expansion and extension ratios. The effect of two Rayleigh number (104 and 106 ) was accomplished in order to detect the complex flow structures in the channel-chimney system. For highest Ra and expansion ratio, heated wall temperature profiles as a function of time oscillated. The quasi-steady state of the maximum wall temperature was the lowest WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
397
for the highest expansion ratio (B/b = 4.0) whereas for Ra = 104 the minimum value of the maximum heated wall temperature was attained for B/b = 2.0. The same results were obtained also for the average Nusselt numbers. Stream function fields allowed to visualize the flow structures inside the channel and the chimney. A cold inflow was detected together with some vortex cells inside the chimney.
Nomenclature a b B g Gr k L Lh Lx Ly Nu p P Pr q˙ Ra t T u, v U, V x, y X, Y
thermal diffusivity, m2 /s channel gap, m chimney gap, m acceleration due to gravity, m/s2 Grashof number, Eq.(5) thermal conductivity, W/mK system height, m channel height, m height of reservoir, m width of reservoir, m average Nusselt number, Eq.(6) pressure, P a dimensionless pressure, Eq.(5) Prandtl number, Eq.(5) heat flux, W/m2 Rayleigh number, Eq.(5) time, s temperature, K velocity components, m/s dimensionless velocity components, Eq.(5) Cartesian coordinates, m dimensionless Cartesian coordinates, Eq.(5)
Greek symbols β ν θ ρ τ
volumetric coefficient of expansion, 1/K kinematic viscosity, m2 /s dimensionless temperature, Eq.(5) density, kg/m3 dimensionless time, Eq.(5)
Subscripts ∞ max ss w
free stream condition maximum value steady state wall
Acknowledgements This work was supported by MIUR with a 2005 PRIN grant. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
398 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1] Manca, O., Morrone, B., Nardini, S. & Naso, V., Computational Analysis of Convection Heat Transfer, WIT Press: Southampton, Boston, chapter Natural Convection in Open Channels, 2000. [2] Haaland, S.E. & Sparrow, E.M., Solutions for the Channel Plume and the Parallel-Walled Chimney. Numerical Heat Transfer, 6, pp. 155–172, 1983. [3] Oosthuizen, P.H., A Numerical Study of Laminar Free Convective Flow through a Vertical Open Partially Heated Plane Duct. ASME HTD – Fundamentals of Natural Convection – Electronic Equipment Cooling, 32, pp. 41–48, 1984. [4] Asako, Y., Nakamura, H. & Faghri, M., Natural Convection in a Vertical Heated Tube Attached to a Thermally Insulated Chimney of a Different Diameter. ASME Journal of Heat Transfer, 112, pp. 790–795, 1990. [5] Campo, A., Manca, O. & Morrone, B., Numerical Analysis of Partially Heated Vertical Parallel Plates in Natural Convective Cooling. Numerical Heat Transfer, Part A, 36, pp. 129–151, 1999. [6] Andreozzi, A., Buonomo, B. & Manca, O., Numerical study of natural convection in vertical channels with adiabatic extensions downstream. Numerical Heat Transfer, Part A, 47, pp. 1–22, 2005. [7] Andreozzi, A., Buonomo, B., Manca, O. & Musto, M., Flow Visualization of Natural Convection in Asymmetric Channel - Chimney Systems. Proc. of Seventh Triennal International Symposium on Fluid Control, Measurement and Visualization - FLUCOME, paper ID-127, Sorrento, Italy, 2003. [8] Manca, O., Musto, M. & Naso, V., Experimental investigation of natural convection in an asymmetrically heated vertical channel with an asymmetric chimney. ASME Journal of Heat Transfer, 127, pp. 888–896, 2005. [9] Joshi, H.M., Transient Effects in Natural Convection Cooling of Vertical Parallel Plates. Int Communications in Heat and Mass Transfer, 15 (2), pp. 227–238, 1988. [10] Chang, B. & Lin, K., Transient Buoyancy-Induced Flow through a Heated, Vertical Channel of Finite Height. Numerical Heat Transfer, Part A, 16, pp. 15–35, 1989. [11] Chang, K.P. & Hung, Y.H., Transient natural convection between vertical finite length heated plates. Journal of Thermophysics and Heat Transfer, 11 (2), pp. 203–211, 1997. [12] Andreozzi, A., Buonomo, B. & Manca, O., Numerical study of transient natural convection in vertical asymmetrically heated channels. Atti del 61◦ Congresso ATI, Perugia, Italy, 1, pp. 459–464, 2006. [13] Andreozzi, A., Buonomo, B. & Manca, O., Numerical simulation of transient natural convection in a channel-chimney system. Proc. HT2005, paper HT2005-72628, San Francisco, California, USA, 2005. [14] Fisher, T.S. & Torrance, K.E., Experiments on Chimney-Enhanced Free Convection. ASME Journal of Heat Transfer, 121, pp. 607–608, 1999.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
399
Plate distance effect on mixed convection in horizontal channels heated from below G. Foglia, O. Manca & S. Nardini DIAM, Seconda Università degli Studi di Napoli, Aversa (CE), Italy
Abstract Mixed convection in air in a horizontal channel with the lower wall heated at uniform heat flux is investigated experimentally. The study is accomplished for several heat fluxes, forced air velocities and two distances between the horizontal plates, b=20 mm and b=40 mm. The Reynolds numbers are investigated between 5.0 and 250, these being in the laminar regime. The Richardson number Ri=Gr/Re2 holds values in the range 3.0–7.4x104. The effect of the channel gap is investigated by flow visualization and wall temperature distribution. Keywords: mixed convection, electronic cooling, thermal control, experimental investigation.
1
Introduction
Recently great attention has been focused on mixed convection in open-ended cavities for their wide use, such as thermal control of electronic equipments, chemical vapour deposition (CVD) of solid layer and solar collectors. Buoyancy force due to the heating of the lower cavity wall induces secondary flows hence the local heat transfer increases. The onset point of the secondary flows is important because it delineates the region after which the twodimensional laminar flow becomes three-dimensional. Understanding, manipulating and controlling the secondary motions in openended cavities are important. There is a need for further numerical and experimental investigations on three-dimensional mixed convection in cavities and particularly in horizontal channels. The relevant literature on mixed convection in horizontal channels heated from below has been recently reviewed in [1, 2].
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070411
400 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII A bibliographical review on the mixed convection flows in horizontal rectangular ducts uniformly heated from below was presented by Nicolas [1]. A detailed synthesis of the recently discovered complex thermo-convective patterns was presented. An experimental study on flow patterns and heat transfer characteristics in a channel with heated bottom and the side walls was conducted by Zhang et al. [3]. It was to simulate finned heat sinks used in densely packed electronic enclosures. The bottom and side walls were heated and the top of the channel was cooled. The mixed convection of gas through a bottom heated horizontal plane channel was reviewed by Lin [2]. Results from theoretical, experimental and numerical explorations were examined in order to describe the various vortex flow patterns and the associated thermal characteristics in mixed convection at low Reynolds number. An investigation on the flow in mixed convection phenomenon of water in a horizontal rectangular duct, uniformly heated from below was accomplished experimentally and numerically by Bonnefoi et al. [4]. Many experiments were carried out for a wide range of fluid velocities and heat fluxes supplied to the wall in order to describe and to analyse the thermo-convective instabilities. An experimental investigation on mixed convection of air in a bottom heated horizontal flat duct by the top plate heating was carried out by Tseng et al. [5] to study the possible stabilization and elimination of the buoyancy driven unstable longitudinal, transverse and mixed vortex flow in mixed convection of air in a bottom heated horizontal flat duct by the top plate heating. An experimental investigation on mixed convection in air in inclined rectangular channels was presented by Ozsunar et al. [6]. Chen et al. [7] accomplished an investigation on mixed convection of air in a bottom heated horizontal flat duct by top plate heating experimentally, to study the possible stabilization and elimination of the buoyancy driven unstable longitudinal, transverse and mixed vortex flow. Experiments for the onset and development of the buoyancy driven secondary air flow and enhancement of heat transfer in a horizontal convergent and a divergent channel were carried out by Liu and Gau [8]. A study on mixed convection in a horizontal channel with the lower wall heated at uniform heat flux was carried out by Manca et al. [9]. Flow visualization was performed to detect the flow patterns into the channel. Results showed that the separation from the lower heated plate strongly depended on the buoyancy force and forced velocity. Chen et al. [10] accomplished an experimental flow visualization combined with transient temperature measurement to explore the possible stabilization of the buoyancy drive vortex flow in mixed convection of air in a bottom heated horizontal flat duct by placing a rectangular solid block on the duct bottom. Recently numerical and theoretical investigations were carried out on horizontal channels. Three-dimensional conjugate heat transfer in a rectangular duct with two discrete flush-mounted heat sources was studied numerically in the context of cooling of electronic equipments by Wang and Jaluria [11]. The magnitudes of the conduction and the convection transport were compared for different parametric combinations. Stability analysis for horizontal rectangular channels was carried out in [12, 13]. A numerical study on mixed convection in a WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
401
horizontal channel with the lower wall heated at uniform heat flux was carried out in transient regime, Buonomo et al. [14]. For high Reynolds numbers, if the upper channel wall was conductive, secondary motions were observed in terms of vortexes with longitudinal axes whereas conductive lower wall gave less marked secondary motions. In this paper mixed convection in a horizontal channel, with the lower wall heated at uniform heat flux, is experimentally investigated. The upper parallel plate is unheated and made of glass. The present paper extends the investigation reported in [9] in order to examine the effect of the longitudinal channel aspect ratio. Flow visualization is performed to detect the flow patterns in the cavity. Wall temperature profiles along the axial coordinate are also presented.
Glass
y
Upper plate
g Glass z
b
x L
Figure 1:
2
Lower plate
W
(a)
View of the heated part of the channel, the test section.
Experimental apparatus
The experimental test section was made up of a horizontal, uniformly heated wall and a parallel wall above, as reported in Fig.1. Each wall was made of two 400x530 mm2 sandwiched phenolic fibreboard plates. The upper wall was a glass flat plate with a thickness of 3 mm. The side walls of the channel were made of glass with a thickness of 3 mm, which were machined to an accuracy of ±0.3 mm, in order to take pictures of the flow motion. The heated channel was 400 mm long and 498 mm wide. The distance between the horizontal walls ranged from 20 mm to 40 mm. The lower wall was made of two plates, the plate facing the channel was 3.2 mm thick and its surface adjacent to the internal air was coated with a 35 µm thick nickel plated copper layer. The low emissivity of nickel (0.05) minimized radiation effects on heat transfer. The rear plate was 1.6 mm thick. Its back surface was coated with a 17.5 µm thick copper layer, which also served as the heater. This is an electrical resistance obtained by cutting the copper layer in a serpentine shape. Its runs were 19.6 mm wide with a gap of nearly 0.5 mm between each one, giving the heater a total length of 9.0 m. Its electrical current through the heater. In order to reduce conductive heat expected electrical resistance was 0.50 Ω. The lower wall was heated by passing a direct losses, a 150 mm Polystyrene block was affixed to the rear face of each principal WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
402 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII wall. The narrow gaps between the runs, together with the relatively high thickness (4.8 mm) of the resulting low-conductive fibreglass were suitable to maintain a nearly uniform heat flux at the plate surface. Direct electrical current through the heaters was accomplished by using a Hewlett-Packard 6260B DC power supply. The supplied electrical power was evaluated by measuring the voltage drop across the plate and the current passing through it. An HP-3465A digital multi-meter was used to measure the voltage drop, whereas the current was calculated by the measured voltage drop across a reference resistance. The dissipated heat flux was evaluated to an accuracy of ±2%. The walls of the channel extensions were made of wood. A blower attached to the channel through a nozzle provided a variable mass flow rate. The entire apparatus was placed within a room in order to have a controlled ambient temperature. The experimental apparatus is schematically shown in Fig. 2.
Figure 2:
Layout of the experimental apparatus, dimensions in mm.
Wall temperatures were measured by 0.50 mm OD ungrounded ironconstantan thermocouples embedded in each fibreboard plate and in contact with the outer layer. They were placed at twelve longitudinal stations at three different z values. A Kaye instrument K170 ice point was used as a reference for thermocouples junctions. Calibration of the temperature measuring system showed an estimated precision of the thermocouple-readout system of ±0.1 °C. Mass flow rate was calculated by measuring the velocity with a hot wire anemometer Dantec Mini CTA 54T30 with a 55P11 probe. The sensor was located at 2500 mm from the inlet section of a circular duct, with a diameter of 40 mm, in order to have a fully developed laminar flow, Fig. 2. The range of velocity in this section, corresponding to the Reynolds number range between 5 and 1000, varies between 0.042 m/s and 8.6 m/s. The hot wire probe was calibrated at 15°C, 20°C and 25°C in the above velocity range. The maximum uncertainty in this range was about 4%, the uncertainty on the measurement of the duct diameter was 1% and the uncertainty of the location of the sensor was 2%. Smoke for visualization was generated by a fog oil generator. The smoke was passed into a plenum and its temperature was controlled with a thermocouple and its value was not more than 1°C of the incoming air temperature, before entering into the channel. Then it was driven into the test WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
403
section through a small slot situated along the lower edge of the inlet channel. The visualization was made possible by means of a laser sheet, generated by a He-Ne laser source. The laser sheet was produced by placing a mirror near the end of the test section at an angle of 45° with respect to the direction of the main flow, after which a cylindrical lens was placed to enlarge the beam as desired. A still digital camera Nikon D-100 was used to take pictures.
3 Data reduction The Grashof, Reynolds and Richardson numbers are defined as: Gr =
gβq c b 4 ub Gr , Re = i , Ri = ν ν2k Re 2
(1)
where qc is the average convective heat flux: L
qc =
1 q c ( x )dx L0
∫
(2)
the thermophysical properties were evaluated at the reference temperature Tr =
Tw + T0 2
with: L
1 Tw ( x )dx Tw = L0
∫
(3)
where Tw is the average wall temperature along the heated lower plate. Local convective heat flux, qc(x), was not uniform because of radiation and conduction heat losses. Experimental data were reduced by first introducing, in the equations presented above, the local convective heat flux q c (x) = q Ω (x) − q k (x) − q r (x)
(4)
where qΩ(x) is the local heat flux due to Ohmic dissipation, assumed uniform along x, qk(x) is the local conduction heat losses from the plate and qr(x) is the local radiative heat flux from the plate. For each run, the terms qk(x) were calculated by means of a numerical procedure, a three-dimensional distribution of the temperature being assumed in the Polystyrene. Therefore, qk on the wall was a function of both x and z coordinates, and its values were averaged along z. The predicted temperatures for some configurations of the system were previously compared with those measured by thermocouples embedded in the Polystyrene insulation and the relationship was very good, the maximum WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
404 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII deviation being 3%. A two-dimensional radiative cavity was made of the two plates, considered as diffuse-grey surfaces and two black edge sections at room temperature. In all cases, the radiative heat losses were not greater than 2% of the Ohmic dissipated power. The qr(x) terms were calculated for each temperature distribution of the wall, ambient temperature and plate spacing, by dividing each plate into sixteen strips along its length. Each strip was assumed at the spanwise average temperature. The uncertainty in the calculated quantities was determined according to the standard single sample analysis recommended by Moffat [15]. The uncertainty of the Rayleigh, Reynolds and the average Nusselt numbers were 7%, 8% and 4% respectively.
4
Results and discussion
The experiments were carried out for 5.0≤Re≤250 and 1.86x104≤Ra≤1.85x106 with corresponding Richardson number values from 3.00 to 7.4x104. The longitudinal aspect ratios were 10 and 20, whereas the transversal aspect ratio was 12.45. In Fig. 3, photos of flow visualization along a longitudinal section at z=0, are shown. For b=40 mm, Ra=9.20x105 and 1.85x106 and for several Re, it is observed that the increasing of forced motion, determines the movement of the flow separation point downstream, because inertial forces prevail on buoyancy forces for high Reynolds numbers. Whereas the separation point, xcr occurs as nearer the inlet section as higher the Ra value. For both Rayleigh number values, a backflow is observed, this is due to the low pressure area close to the upper wall. The fluid flow along the lower heated wall is laminar until it separates, after this point, the flow splits in two main currents; one going out the exit of the channel and another one comes back to the inlet section, both adjacent to the upper wall. At the lowest considered Reynolds number, downstream the flow separation point, the secondary motions are much more developed, whereas for highest Rayleigh numbers, Fig. 3b, the fluid flow seems chaotic. In Fig. 4, for b=20 mm, and for the same heat flux of the previous case but for different Ra numbers, the separation point varies significantly and it is very close to the end of the heated channel, because inertial forces prevail on buoyancy forces as well as viscous forces prevail on inertial and buoyancy ones because b is lower; so picture for Re=200 is not shown because no flow separation is observed. As shown in Fig. 4b, the increase of heat flux determines the movement of the flow separation point upstream as expected. For low Re numbers, is still possible observed secondary motions while from Re=100 to Re=250 forced flow prevails. In Fig. 5a, flow visualizations along a top view, at y=2 mm, 20 mm and 38 mm, for Ra=9.20x105, b=40 mm and Re=50 are given. The fluid motion is almost laminar as shown at y=2 mm and according to the photos at y=20 mm, the recirculation zone and unstable motion are noted. At y=38 mm, fluid flow is adjacent to the upper wall. For Ra=1.85x106, Re=50 and at y=2 mm, Fig. 5b, the fluid motion along the heated wall is laminar along axis up to about 100 mm WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
405
where the separation starts. Smoke is not uniform due to velocity component along vertical direction that causes a cluster between streamlines. For y=20 mm, the secondary motions are observed and photo at y=38 mm shows that, secondary motions are more irregular.
Re =50, Ra=9.20x105
Re =100, Ra=9.20x105
Re =150, Ra=9.20x105
Re =200, Ra=9.20x105 a)
Re =25, Ra=1.85x106
Re =50, Ra=1.85x106
Re =10,0 Ra=1.85x106
Re =250, Ra=1.85x106 b) Figure 3:
Visualization of flow patterns at the longitudinal section z=0 for b=40 mm, different Reynolds numbers and: a) Ra=9.20x105, b) Ra=1.85x106.
The same top views photos are shown for b=20 mm, Fig. 6. For Ra=1.86x104, Fig.6a, the flow is adjacent to the lower heated wall at y=2 mm and some effects of secondary motions are on the upper part of boundary layer, y=10 mm. The smoke close to the upper wall, y=18 mm indicates that secondary motions are developing and plumes are present along the transversal sections, furthermore WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
406 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII some mushrooms-like structures begin to appear and than they becomes roller vortexes. For Ra=9.72x104, Fig. 6b, the trend is the same but secondary motion are clearly marked. In Fig. 7, wall temperature rise to the ambient temperature on the heated wall are reported as a function of the x coordinate for two Rayleigh number values and b=40 mm. Wall temperature decreases for high Reynolds numbers as expected. Figure 7b shows that wall temperature profiles, for high Rayleigh numbers, are very similar to the ones observed at low Rayleigh numbers up to Re=100, whereas an almost uniform profile in the centre and a maximum temperature value close to x=300 mm for Re=250 is noticed. For b=20 mm, Fig. 8, temperature are low due to the smaller channel gap that causes a better external heat transfer on the upper wall.
Re =50, Ra=4.86x104
Re =100, Ra=4.86x104
Re =150, Ra=4.86x104 a)
Re =25, Ra=9.72x104
Re =50, Ra=9.72x104
Re =100, Ra=9.72x104
Re =250, Ra=9.72x104 b) Figure 4:
Visualization of flow patterns at the longitudinal section z=0 for b=20 mm, different Reynolds numbers and: Ra=4.86x104, b) Ra=9.72x104.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Plane xz y=2mm
Plane xz y=20mm a) Ra=9.20x105
Plane xz y=38mm
Plane xz y=2mm
Plane xz y=20mm b) Ra=1.85x106
Plane xz y=38mm
Figure 5:
Visualization of flow patterns in xz plane for b=40 mm, Re=50 and: a) Ra=9.20x105, b) Ra=1.85x106.
Plane xz y=2mm
Plane xz y=10mm a) Ra=4.86x104
Plane xz y=18mm
Plane xz y=2mm
Plane xz y=10mm b) Ra=9.72x104
Plane xz y=18mm
Figure 6:
407
Visualization of flow patterns in xz plane for b=40 mm, Re=50 and: a) Ra=9.20x105, b) Ra=1.85x106.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
408 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 30
50
25 40
Tw - T0 [K]
Tw - T0 [K]
20
15
10
Re=50 Re=100 Re=150 Re=200
qΩ = 100 W/m 2 Ra = 9.20x105
5
0
100
qΩ = 200 W/m 2 Ra = 1.85x106 10
200
300
0
400
(b)
0
100
x [mm]
Figure 7:
Re=25 Re=50 Re=100 Re=250
20
(a)
0
30
200
300
400
x [mm]
Wall temperature profiles for b=40 mm, different Reynolds numbers and: a) Ra=9.20x105, b) Ra=1.85x106.
30
50
25
Tw - T0 [K]
Tw - T0 [K ]
40 20
15
10
qΩ = 100 W/m
0
Re=50 Re=100 Re=150
100
200
300
400
0
(b)
0
100
x [mm]
Figure 8:
5
re=25 re=50 re=100 re=250
2
Ra = 9.72x104
10
(a)
0
qΩ = 200 W/m
20
2
Ra = 4.86x104 5
30
200
300
400
x [mm]
Wall temperature profiles for b=20 mm, different Reynolds numbers and: a) Ra=4.86x104, b) Ra=9.72x104.
Conclusions
An experimental investigation on mixed convection in air, in a horizontal channel, with the lower wall heated at uniform heat flux was carried out. The upper wall was unheated and heat transfer with the external ambient was allowed. Results of flow visualization highlighted the effect of secondary motions along the heated part of the channel and the separation from the lower heated plate strongly depended on the buoyancy force and forced velocity. For b=20 mm configuration, the separation point varies significantly and it is very close to the end of the heated channel, because inertial forces prevail on buoyancy forces as well as viscous forces prevail on inertial and buoyancy ones. Furthermore the reduction of the channel gap causes a better external heat transfer on the upper wall and low temperature values on the heated one.
Acknowledgement This work was supported by MIUR with a 2005 PRIN grant.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
409
Nomenclature b g Gr h k L Pr q Ra Re Ri T ui
x
channel spacing, m acceleration due to the gravity, ms-2 Grashof number, Eq.(1) heat transfer coefficient, W m-2 K-1 thermal conductivity, Wm1 -1 K length of the plate, m Prandtl number heat flux, Wm-2 Rayleigh number, = Gr Pr Reynolds number, Eq.(1) Richardson number, Eq.(1) temperature, K average velocity at inlet section of the channel, ms-1 horizontal coordinate distance, m
xcr y z W
coordinate of separation point, m vertical coordinate distance, m coordinate along the width of the plates, m width of the plate, m
Greek symbols β
volumetric coefficient of expansion, K-1
ν
kinematic viscosity, m2s-1
Subscript c k i 0 r w Ω
convective conductive inflow ambient air radiative wall Ohmic dissipation
References [1]
[2]
[3] [4] [5]
Nicolas, X., Revue bibliographique sur les écoulements de Poiseuille– Rayleigh–Bénard: écoulements de convection mixte en conduites rectangulaires horizontales chauffées par le bas. International Journal of Thermal Sciences, 41, pp. 961–1016, 2002. Lin, T. F., Buoyancy driven vortex flow and thermal structures in a very low Reynolds number mixed convective gas flow through a horizontal channel. International Journal of Heat and Fluid Flow, 24, pp. 299–309, 2003. Zhang, H., Huang, X. Y., Li, H. S., Chua, L. P., Flow patterns and heat transfer enhancement in low-Reynolds–Rayleigh-number channel flow. Applied Thermal Engineering, 22, pp. 1277–1288, 2002. Bonnefoi, C., Abid, C., Medale, M., Papini, F., Poiseuille–Benard instability in a horizontal rectangular duct water flow. International Journal of Thermal Sciences, 43, pp. 791–796, 2004. Tseng, W. S., Lin, W. L., Yin, C. P., Lin, C. L., Lin, T. F., Stabilization of Buoyancy-Driven Unstable Vortex Flow in Mixed Convection of Air in a
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
410 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[6] [7]
[8] [9]
[10]
[11] [12]
[13] [14] [15]
Rectangular Duct by Tapering Its Top Plate, ASME J. Heat Transfer, 122, pp.58-65, 2000. Ozsunar, A., Baakaya, Sivrioglu, M., Experimental investigation of mixed convection heat transfer in a horizontal and inclined rectangular channel, Heat Mass Transfer, 38, pp.271-278, 2002. Chen, S. W., Chang, C. Y., Lir, J. T., Lin, T. F., Stabilization and elimination of transient unstable mixed convective vortex flow of air in a bottom heated horizontal flat duct by top plate heating, Int. J. Heat Mass Transfer, 47, pp. 4137–4152, 2004. Liu, C. W., Gau, C., Onset of secondary flow and enhancement of heat transfer in horizontal convergent and divergent channels heated from below, Int. J. Heat Mass Transfer, 47, pp. 5427–5438, 2004. Manca, O., Nardini, S., Naso, V., Experimental investigation on mixed convection in a horizontal channel heated from below, Proc. 12th Int. Conf. Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements, pp. 705714, Malta, 20-22 Giugno 2005. Chen, S.W., Shu, D.S., Lir, J.T., Lin, T.F., Buoyancy driven vortex flow and its stability in mixed convection of air through a blocked horizontal flat duct heated from below, Int. J. Heat Mass Transfer, 49, pp.3655– 3669, 2006. Wang, Q., Jaluria, Y, Instability and heat transfer in mixed convection flow in a horizontal duct with discrete heat sources, Numer. Heat Transfer Part A, 42, pp.445-463, 2002. Park, J. H., Chung, T. J., Yun, E. S., Kim, M. C., Choi, C. K. The onset of longitudinal vortex rolls in the thermal entrance region of plane Poiseuille flow heated with a constant heat flux, Int. J. Heat Mass Transfer, 49, pp.3708–3716, 2006. Xin, S., Nicolas X., Le Quéré, P., Stability analyses of longitudinal rolls of Poiseuille-Rayleigh-Bénard flows in air-filled channels of finite transversal extension, Numer. Heat Transfer Part A, pp.467-490, 2006. Buonomo, B., Foglia, G., Manca, O., Nardini, S., Mixed Convection in a Horizontal Channel with Heated Bottom Wall and External Heat Transfer on Upper Wall, Proc. ASME-ATI Conf., Milan 14-17 May, 2006. Moffat, R. J., Describing the Uncertainties in Experimental Results, Experimental Thermal and Fluid Science, 1, pp. 3-17, 1988.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
411
Numerical analysis of mixed convection in air in an inclined channel with a moving plate A. Andreozzi, N. Bianco, G. Lacasa & V. Naso DETEC, Universit`a di Napoli FEDERICO II, Napoli, Italy
Abstract A numerical investigation of mixed convection in air due to the interaction between a buoyancy flow and a moving plate induced flow in an inclined channel is presented. The moving plate has a constant velocity and is unheated whereas the other channel wall is stationary and heated at uniform heat flux. The numerical analysis is obtained by means of the commercial Fluent code. The effects of the inclination angle, channel spacing, heat flux and moving plate velocity are investigated and results in terms of the heated channel wall and moving plate temperatures are given. Keywords: mixed convection, numerical analysis, inclined channel, moving plate.
1 Introduction Mixed convection due to moving surfaces is very important in a wide variety of materials processing systems, such as soldering, welding, extrusion of plastics and other polymeric materials, hot rolling, cooling and/or drying of paper and textiles, Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD), composite materials manufacturing, as reviewed in [1–4] . Mixed convection as a result of buoyancy and motion of one of the channel walls has received little research attention and few guidelines are available for choosing the best performing channel configuration. A study on this topic is presented in [5], where the conjugate mixed convection and conduction heat transfer due to a continuous moving plate in a parallel channel flow was numerically investigated. Results showed that the effect of thermal buoyancy was stronger when the plate moved vertically than when it moved horizontally. The plate velocity affected the overall heat transfer significantly.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070421
412 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII A numerical investigation of mixed convection in air due to the interaction between a buoyancy flow and a moving plate induced flow in a vertical channel was carried out in [6]. The moving plate had a constant velocity and moved along the buoyancy force direction whereas the principal walls of the channel were heated at uniform heat flux. Results showed that the moving plate effects were more significant when the channel gap was lower, for lower moving plate velocity values. For higher moving plate velocity values these effects were more considerable for all channel gap values and for lower heat flux values. In [7] the authors studied the same configuration with the moving plate moved in the opposite direction with respect to the buoyancy force. The wall temperature profiles allowed to observe different behaviors of the flow motion inside the channel, a buoyancy flow, a forced flow and a transition flow related to the velocity of moving plate. An experimental analysis of mixed convection in air in a vertical channel was presented in [8]. One of the channel walls was unheated and moved at a constant velocity, whereas the other one was heated at a uniform heat flux. Two configurations were investigated: Assisting, where the effect of the moving wall superposed to natural convection and Opposing, where the effect of the moving wall opposed natural convection. A numerical investigation of mixed convection in air in horizontal parallel walled channels with moving lower plate was carried out in [9]. The moving lower plate had a constant velocity and it was adiabatic, whereas the upper one was heated at uniform heat flux. For stationary condition of lower plate, a typical C-loop inside the horizontal channel was detected. Different flow motions were observed in the analyzed configuration, depending on the heat flux values and the distance between the heated upper stationary plate and the lower adiabatic moving plate. It seems that there is a lack of information in the open literature on mixed convection in parallel plate channels with a continuous moving plate in spite of its importance in heat treatment processes. In the present study a numerical investigation of mixed convection in air due to the interaction between the buoyancy flow and the forced flow induced by a moving plate in an inclined channel is carried out. The moving plate is unheated and it moves at a constant velocity whereas the other wall of the channel is stationary and heated at a uniform heat flux. The effect of radiative heat transfer is neglected. The effects of the inclination angle, channel spacing, heat flux and moving plate velocity are investigated and results in terms of the heated channel wall and moving plate temperatures are given.
2 Mathematical description and numerical procedure The investigated system consists of an inclined channel made up of a moving plate and a stationary plate. The moving plate, in the following also called “belt”, moves at a constant velocity, it is unheated and it is assumed to be zero thickness. The stationary channel wall is conductive and heated at a uniform heat flux, qw , and its thickness is s. The length of the channel is Lp and its spacing is b. The working fluid is air. Mixed convective flow in the inclined channel is assumed WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Ly
I
Lx
413
M
H Lp
s
G
F
Vb
qw F* Lx
C D E
B
x y
b g E*
j A
Figure 1: Computational domain.
to be incompressible. Moreover the system is assumed to be wide enough along the third coordinate to allow a 2D approximation. All thermophysical properties of the fluid are assumed to be constant, except for the dependence of density on the temperature (Boussinesq approximation). The thermophysical properties of the fluid are evaluated at the ambient temperature, T0 , which is assumed to be 300 K in all cases. The governing equations for the fluid region in steady state and turbulent regime are time-averaged mass, Navier-Stokes and energy equations. A two-dimensional conduction model in the heated wall is employed whereas the transport equations for k and ε are formulated using the RNG k − ε model. An enlarged computational domain has been chosen and it is shown in Fig. 1. It is made up of the inclined channel and of two reservoirs of dimensions Lx and Ly , downstream and upstream of it, that simulate the free-stream conditions of the flow far away from the region thermally disturbed by the heated channel wall. The moving plate extends from the lower to the upper reservoir and its height is Lb = Lp + 2Lx . The imposed boundary conditions are: • uniform heat flux and no-slip condition on the stationary channel wall; • adiabatic wall and no-slip condition on the other solid walls; • pressure inlet or pressure outlet conditions on the open-boundaries; • continuity of the heat flux on the wall EF, FG and ED. The commercial Fluent CFD code was employed to solve the governing equations. The SIMPLE scheme was chosen to couple pressure and velocity. The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
414 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII converging criteria were 10−5 for the residuals of the velocity components, 10−8 for the residuals of the energy and 10−6 for the residuals of k and ε. Preliminary results showed that the chosen turbulent model was suitable also for laminar flow. Several preliminary tests were carried out to take into appropriate account the effects of turbulence parameters, k and ε, at the inlet. Assuming that the fluid comes from a quiescent zone, the distributions of k and ε were taken as uniform and equal to 10−6 . Moreover, the static pressure upstream and downstream of the channel is set equal to the ambient pressure far away from the region of the thermal disturbance induced by the heated channel wall [10]. In order to analyze the grid independence of the numerical solution, different grid sizes were employed. The domain discretization was performed in such a way as to have a larger number of nodes in the channel region where the highest gradients were expected. A uniform grid was employed along the AE ∗ , E ∗ F ∗ , EE ∗ and DE sides, whereas an exponential law was used along CD. In this case the subinterval length decreased toward the channel. Preliminary tests were carried out to evaluate the dependence of the solution on the employed grid. An analogous analysis has been carried out to set the optimal reservoirs dimensions; Lx = 0.400 m and Ly = 4b + s have been chosen.
3 Results and discussion In the following results are presented for air, for a heated plate length Lp = 0.406 m, for channel spacings b = 10 and 20 mm, for wall heat fluxes qw = 30 and 120 W/m2 , for inclination angles in the range 0◦ − 90◦ and for belt velocities Vb = ±0.1 and ±1 m/s. The thickness of the heated wall is 3.2 mm. Temperature profiles of the heated wall and the unheated moving plate, referred to the ambient temperature, as a function of the coordinate along the channel, at different inclination angles, channel spacings, wall heat fluxes, belt velocities are presented in the following. Two configurations have been investigated: Assisting, where the vertical component of the belt velocity is opposed to the acceleration due to the gravity, and Opposing, where the afore mentioned component has the same direction as that of the acceleration due to the gravity. In the Opposing configuration two different flow patterns can occur, according to the ratio between the buoyancy force from the heated wall and the drag force from the moving unheated plate. When the former prevails upon the latter, the air in the channel flows upward in the main, in the other case air flows downward in the main. Even though in many cases air flows neither upward nor downward everywhere in the channel, one can notice that in the Opposing configuration there is a critical value of the belt velocity, named transition velocity, at which some stagnation of the air flow occurs in the channel and, as a result, maximum wall temperatures are attained. Heated wall temperature profiles, referred to an ambient temperature equal to 300 K, for different values of the channel spacing, the wall heat flux, the velocity of the unheated moving plate and the inclination angle of the channel, both for the Assisting and the Opposing configurations, are presented in Figs. 2-4. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
415
Figure 2: Heated wall temperature profiles vs axial coordinate for different inclination angles, b = 10 mm and qw = 30 W/m2 : (a) Vb = 0.1 m/s; (b) Vb = −0.1 m/s; (c) Vb = 1 m/s; (d) Vb = −1 m/s.
Figure 2(a), for a 10 mm channel gap, a 30 W/m2 wall heat flux, a 0.1 m/s belt velocity in the Assisting mode, shows that the larger the axial coordinate the larger the wall temperature, whichever the inclination angle. As a consequence, an ascending air flow occurs in all inclined channels whereas air flows from the left end section of the horizontal channel. Figure 2(a) points out that the larger the inclination angle the larger the wall temperature, since the larger the angle the smaller the contribution of the buoyancy force to the ascending air flow and, therefore, the higher the wall temperature. We can notice that differences in wall temperatures profiles at ϕ = 0◦ and ϕ = 30◦ (nearly 1 K) are smaller than those at ϕ = 60◦ and ϕ = 90◦ (up to 8 K), the maximum temperature of the heated wall above the ambient temperature being nearly 20 K. Figure 2(b) refers to the same parameters as those in the previous figure apart from the Opposing configuration and shows that in inclined channels the velocity of the air is smaller than the transition velocity, since the continuous increase in wall temperatures from the inlet to the exit section of the channels indicates a WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
416 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII prevailing upward flow of the air. It is plain that, in the horizontal channel, wall temperature profiles both in the Assisting and Opposing mode are symmetric as a result of the geometric and thermal symmetry in a horizontal channel. Like in the Assisting mode also in the Opposing one the larger the tilting angle the larger the wall temperature, because of the decrease in the component of the buoyancy force along the channel axis. Observing Figs. 2(a) and 2(b) allows to remark that wall temperatures are larger in the Opposing mode than in the Assisting one, apart at ϕ = 90◦ , since the descending belt motion slows up the ascending air flow. The dependence of wall temperatures on the inclination angle in the Opposing mode is more marked than in the Assisting mode. As a matter of fact, larger wall temperatures increase the role of buoyancy flow versus forced flow and, therefore, the effect of the tilting angle. In the Opposing configuration at any combinations of investigated parameters there is an inclination angle at which buoyancy forces equal the forced flow and the belt moves at the transition velocity. In the investigated case the afore mentioned tilting angle falls in the ϕ = 60◦ − 90◦ range. Below the inclination angle at which the belt velocity equals the transition velocity the larger the angle the larger the wall temperature whereas for larger tilting angles increasing the angle decreases wall temperatures. Predictions for a larger belt velocity are presented in Figs. 2(c) and 2(d) for the Assisting and the Opposing configurations, respectively. Both figures point out a poor effect of the inclination angle on the wall temperature since the forced flow is anyway prevailing. In fact the belt velocity is at all angles larger than the transition velocity. Figures 2(c) and 2(d), for |Vb | = 1 m/s, exhibit also wall temperatures lower than those in Figs. 2(a) and 2(b), for |Vb | = 0.1 m/s, as a result of the larger velocity of the air, determined by the stronger flow dragged by the moving plate. A less marked effect of the belt velocity is to be expected when the channel spacing is larger (b = 20 mm), for which predictions are presented in Fig. 3. Figure 3(a) shows, for the Assisting mode, lower heated wall temperatures than in the channel with b = 10 mm, because of the larger air flow rate dragged in the channel through its larger inlet section. Figure 3(b) points out that, also in the larger channel, wall temperatures in the Opposing mode are larger than those in the Assisting one, since the buoyancy air flow is slowed up by the opposing belt velocity. Figures 3(c) and 3(d) show that also for b = 20 mm the effect of the tilting angle almost vanishes passing from |Vb | = 0.1 m/s to |Vb | = 1 m/s in both configurations. The comparison of Figs. 3(c) and 3(d) to Figs. 2(c) and 2(d) points out slightly larger wall temperatures in the larger channel as a result of the larger distance of the belt from the heated wall. Predictions for the case with a larger wall heat flux, qw = 120 W/m2 , all other quantities being the same, are presented in Fig. 4. Buoyancy forces and, as a consequence, also the tilting angle, are expected to play a major role than in the afore presented cases. Figure 4(a) shows a fair dependence of heated wall temperatures on the inclination angle in the ϕ = 0◦ − 30◦ range, a nearly 5 K maximum temperature increase passing to ϕ = 60◦ , whereas it is about 40 K in WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
417
Figure 3: Heated wall temperature profiles vs axial coordinate for different inclination angles, b = 20 mm and qw = 30 W/m2 : (a) Vb = 0.1 m/s; (b) Vb = −0.1 m/s; (c) Vb = 1 m/s; (d) Vb = −1 m/s.
the horizontal channel. The comparison between Figs. 4(a) and 4(b) for inclined channels points out practically coincident wall temperature profiles that turn out to be independent of the direction of the belt velocity, since the contribution of the buoyancy forces is far larger than that of the forced flow when the unheated plate moves at low velocity (|Vb | = 0.1 m/s), that is lower than the transition velocity. Figures 4(c) and 4(d) exhibit a stronger dependence of wall temperature on the angle than in previous cases with |Vb | = 1 m/s, thus indicating that the larger wall heat flux allows buoyancy forces to play a significant role. Figure 4(c) points out that the larger the angle the larger the wall temperature, though the effect is less marked than in cases with |Vb | = 0.1 m/s. Figure 4(d) shows that in the Opposing configuration air flows upward in the channel for ϕ = 0◦ and ϕ = 30◦ and this indicates that in these cases the transition velocity is larger than the belt velocity. On the contrary, air flows downward for ϕ = 60◦ and this allows to conclude that a −1 m/s transition velocity occurs for an inclination angle between 30◦ and 60◦ . It is worth noticing that, once the transition occurred, the larger the angle the lower WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
418 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 4: Heated wall temperature profiles vs axial coordinate for different inclination angles, b = 20 mm and qw = 120 W/m2 : (a) Vb = 0.1 m/s; (b) Vb = −0.1 m/s; (c) Vb = 1 m/s; (d) Vb = −1 m/s. the heated wall temperature. In fact, when forced flow overcomes the buoyancy forces and the air flow is descending, an increase in the inclination angle decreases the latter forces and increases the fluid velocity, thus lowering wall temperatures. We can conclude that, all other parameters being the same, the inclination angle at which the belt velocity equals the transition velocity decreases at increasing wall heat fluxes and at decreasing channel gaps. Moving plate temperature profiles, referred to an ambient temperature equal to 300 K, for the same values of the investigated quantities and directions of the belt velocity as those in Figs. 2–4, are presented in Figs. 5 and 6. Comparing Figs. 2– 4 and 5–6 for the same conditions one can notice that, as it was to be expected, belt temperatures are in all cases lower than heated wall temperatures. It is worth remembering that the effect of radiative heat transfer is neglected and, therefore, the temperature of the unheated plate is affected only by the temperature of the flowing air that, in its turn, depends on the temperature of the heated wall. Figure 5(a) shows that, in the Assisting configuration, in an inclined channel the larger the angle the warmer the unheated moving plate, like it occurs on the heated WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
419
Figure 5: Belt temperature profiles vs axial coordinate for different inclination angles, |Vb | = 0.1 m/s and qw = 30 W/m2 : (a)−(b) b = 10 mm; (c)−(d) b = 20 mm.
wall. We can remark that the temperature rise of the belt starts in the proximity of the entrance section of the channel (x = 0) and that the starting point shifts toward x = 0 at increasing ϕ values. One can also notice that the belt temperature increase continues downstream of the channel, since warm air still flows past the belt also downstream of its exit section. On the contrary, in a horizontal channel the belt cooling starts just in the exit section since the hot air leaving the channel moves upward and, consequently, the cooler ambient air flows past the belt immediately downward of the exit section. As far as the Opposing mode is concerned, Fig. 5(b) shows that for ϕ = 0◦ and ϕ = 30◦ air flow close to the belt is ascending since the larger x the larger the belt temperature. In this case the increase in the belt temperature begins at the inlet section of the channel. The temperature profile in a 60◦ inclined channel is nearly symmetric with reference to the mid-height section of the channel and this indicates a descending air flow and a belt velocity close to the transition velocity. Maximum belt temperature is attained for ϕ = 60◦ , just like it occurs at the heated wall temperature. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
420 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6: Belt temperature profiles vs axial coordinate for different inclination angles, b = 20 mm and qw = 120 W/m2 : (a) Vb = 0.1 m/s; (b) Vb = −0.1 m/s; (c) Vb = 1 m/s; (d) Vb = −1 m/s.
The comparison of Figs. 5(a) and 5(b) to Figs. 5(c) and 5(d) shows that increasing the channel spacing strongly decreases belt temperatures. Still comparing Figs. 5(a) and 5(c), we can notice that in the Assisting mode in inclined channels increasing the channel spacing increases both the x coordinate where the heating of the moving plate begins and that where the maximum temperature of the belt is attained. The shift of the section where in the larger channel the belt temperature starts to increase is likely due to the larger distance between the inlet section of the channel and the section where the boundary layer fills it. Figure 5(d) points out that, in the Opposing mode, in inclined channels air flows upward in the main. Observing Figs. 5(b) and 5(d) one can remark that in the 60◦ inclined channel the difference between the belt velocity and the transition velocity for b = 20 mm is larger than that for b = 10 mm, since the effect of drag forces is lower in the larger channel. Unheated moving plate temperature profiles, referred to an ambient air temperature of 300 K, for b = 20 mm, qw = 120 W/m2 , |Vb | = 0.1 m/s WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
421
and |Vb | = 1 m/s, ϕ = 0◦ , 30◦ , 60◦ , 90◦ , are presented in Fig. 6. Figure 6(a) exhibits a marked increase in the belt temperature downstream of the exit section of an inclined channel. This indicates that the temperature of the air leaving the channel is still warmer enough than that of the ambient air. Like already noticed previously, this does not occur in the horizontal channel. Figures 6(c) and 6(d), compared to Figs. 6(a) and 6(b), show a stronger dependence of belt temperature profiles on the inclination angle in the Opposing than in the Assisting configuration. Let us notice that for Vb = −1 m/s the maximum belt temperature is attained for ϕ = 30◦ and that in this case the belt temperature profile is nearly symmetric with reference to the mid-height section of the channel. This means that the velocity of the air close to the moving plate is very low and the transition nearly occurs. In fact far lower belt temperatures exhibited at ϕ = 60◦ indicate that transition is already occurred.
4 Conclusions A numerical investigation of mixed convection in air due to the interaction between the buoyancy flow and the forced flow induced by a moving plate in an inclined channel was carried out. The moving plate had a constant velocity and was unheated, whereas the other plate was stationary and heated at a uniform heat flux. The numerical solution was obtained by means of the commercial Fluent CFD code. Two configurations were analyzed: Assisting, where the vertical component of the belt velocity is opposed to the acceleration due to the gravity, and Opposing, where the afore mentioned component has the same direction as that of the acceleration due to the gravity. In the Opposing configuration the air in the channel flowed upward when the buoyancy forces prevailed on the drag forces whereas it moved downward when the drag forces prevailed on the buoyancy ones. The velocity at which the effects of the two kind of forces are quite the same was called transition velocity. Results showed that for the Assisting configuration the larger the inclination angle the larger the heated wall temperature, since the larger the inclination angle the smaller the contribution of the buoyancy force to the ascending air flow. This effect was more marked for 30◦ ≤ ϕ ≤ 60◦ than for 0◦ ≤ ϕ ≤ 30◦ . As far as the Opposing configuration is concerned, the air flow in the channel was ascending for Vb = −0.1 m/s and 0◦ ≤ ϕ ≤ 60◦ , thus indicating that for these configurations the transition velocity was larger than the belt velocity. The analysis of results for Vb = −1 m/s shows that the inclination angle at which the belt velocity became equal to the transition one decreased at increasing wall heat fluxes and at decreasing channel gaps.
Nomenclature b g k
channel spacing, m acceleration due to the gravity, m/s2 kinetic energy of turbulence, m2 /s2 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
422 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII L qw s T Vb x, y
length, m wall heat flux, W/m2 heated plate thickness, m temperature, K belt velocity, m/s Cartesian coordinates, m
Greek symbols ε ϕ
dissipation rate of turbulent kinetic energy, m2 /s3 inclination angle, degree
Subscripts 0 b p w x, y
ambient belt (moving plate) plate wall along the Cartesian coordinates
Acknowledgement This work was supported by MIUR with a 2005 PRIN grant.
References [1] Jaluria, Y., Transport from continuously moving materials undergoing thermal processing (Chapter 4). Annual Review of Heat Transfer, ed. C.L. Tien, Hemisphere Publ. Co.: New York, pp. 187–245, 1992. [2] Viskanta, R. & Bergman, T. L., Heat transfer in materials processing. Handbook of Heat Transfer, McGraw-Hill: New York, 3rd edition, 1998. [3] Jaluria, Y., Fluid flow phenomena in material processing. Journal of Fluid Engineering, 123, pp. 173–210, 2001. [4] Jaluria, Y., Thermal processing of materials: from basic research to engineering. Journal of Heat Transfer, 125 (6), pp. 957–979, 2003. [5] Jaluria, Y. & Kang, B. H., Heat transfer from continuously moving material in channel flow for thermal processing. Journal of Thermophysics and Heat Transfer, 8 (3), pp. 546–554, 1994. [6] Andreozzi, A., Bianco, N., Manca, O. & Naso, V., Mixed Convection Heat Transfer in a Vertical Channel with a Moving Plate. Proceedings of 12th International Conference of Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements, pp.695-704, 2005. [7] Andreozzi, A., Bianco, N., Manca, O. & Naso, V., Numerical Analysis of Opposing Mixed Convection in Air in a Vertical Channel with a Moving Plate. Proceedings of International Mechanical Engineering Congress and Exposition (ASME-IMECE), paper n.IMECE2005-82983, 2005. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
423
[8] Andreozzi, A., Bianco, N., Lacasa, G. & Naso, V., Experimental Analysis of Mixed Convection in Vertical Channels with a Moving Plate. Proceedings of Energy: Production, Distribution and Conservation ASME ATI Conference, II pp. 833-842, 2006. [9] Andreozzi, A., Manca, O. & Naso, V., Thermal and Fluid Dynamic Behavior of a Horizontal Channel with Adiabatic Moving Lower Plate. Proceedings of International Mechanical Engineering Congress and Exposition (ASMEIMECE), paper n.IMECE2005-82259, 2005. [10] Fluent Incorporated, Fluent 6.1, User Manual, Lebanon, NH, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
425
A numerical method for studying impulsively generated convection from heated tubes S. J. D. D’Alessio Department of Applied Mathematics, University of Waterloo, Canada
Abstract This study presents a numerical method for solving the two-dimensional unsteady problem of laminar free convection from a heated tube in an otherwise quiescent fluid. The governing Navier–Stokes and energy equations are formulated in terms of the streamfunction and vorticity. The numerical scheme is designed to handle a large range of Grashof numbers and to capture the physical behaviour inherent in the initial flow. To numerically solve the governing equations a spectral finitedifference method is proposed. The temperature and vorticity are advanced in time using an implicit scheme of Crank-Nicholson type. The streamfunction, on the other hand, is expanded in a truncated Fourier series. To determine the surface vorticity exact integral conditions are derived and incorporated into the numerical method. The numerical results have been verified against derived analytical solutions which are valid for small times and large Grashof numbers. The numerical and analytical results are found to be in good agreement. Keywords: unsteady, laminar, viscous, incompressible, Boussinesq, spectral finitedifference scheme.
1 Introduction Free convection from a horizontal two-dimensional body is a fundamental thermalfluid problem. It has received numerous numerical, experimental and theoretical studies over the years. This paper deals with the unsteady behaviour of laminar, two-dimensional flow caused by free convection from a heated elliptic cylinder emitting a constant surface heat flux into the surrounding fluid which is initially at rest. This problem is of interest for both theoretical and practical reasons since it has important applications in engineering such as heat transfer from heated tubes, hot wire anemometry, thermal pollution and even in the design of heat exchangers. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070431
426 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The present work differs from previous studies (summarized in [1]) in several respects. First, the majority of the previous studies have focussed on circular cylinders which is much simpler. Second, a new numerical approach based on a different scaling of the equations is proposed. Third, an approximate analytical solution is provided and used to validate the numerical solution for small times and large Grashof numbers.
2 Governing equations The equations governing the motion of a viscous incompressible fluid are the Navier–Stokes and energy equations. The fluid is characterized by properties which include: ν the kinematic viscosity, κ the thermal diffusivity, α the thermal expansion coefficient, and k the thermal conductivity. While these fluid properties are assumed to be constant, the fluid density, ρ, is allowed to vary with temperature, T , in the usual fashion ρ(T ) = ρ0 [1 − α(T − T0 )] , where ρ0 refers to a reference density and T0 a reference temperature. The flow setup is illustrated in Figure 1. To render the equations in dimensionless form the √ chosen length scale is the semi-focal length of the ellipse, c = a2 − b2 , the time scale is c/U where U is the velocity scale (soon to be specified) and the temperature scale ∆T is related to the surface heat flux, Q, through ∆T = cQ/k. The velocity scale is taken to be U = (αg∆T c)1/2 where g is the acceleration due to gravity. Since the flow is assumed to remain two-dimensional it is beneficial to work in terms of a streamfunction and vorticity. Also, because of the geometry of the problem it is worthwhile to work with the modified polar coordinates (ξ, θ) which are related to the Cartesian coordinates (x, y) through the conformal transformation x + iy = cosh[(ξ + ξ0 ) + iθ] . The advantage of this is that the contour of the cylinder is transformed to ξ = 0 while the infinite region exterior to the cylinder is mapped to the semi-infinite rectangular strip 0 < ξ < ∞ , −π ≤ θ ≤ π. The constant ξ0 is defined by tanh ξ0 = r where r = b/a is the ellipse aspect ratio equal to the ratio of the semi-minor to semi-major axis lengths. The above mapping holds for all elliptic cylinders having 0 < r < 1 with r = 0 denoting a flat plate and r = 1 a circular cylinder. Another important feature associated with this transformation is that length scales close to the cylinder remain unchanged while those far away get contracted. This is helpful from a numerical point of view since the flow field is compressed. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
y I @ @
r
.............................................. ............ ..... .......... ... ......... ... ....... . . . . ... . . ..... . . . .. . . .. .... . . . . . .... .. . . . . .. .... . . . . . . . ... . . . . . ... .... .... ... .... .. .... .. . . . . . ... ... ... ... ... ... ... ... .... . . .... .. .. .... .. .... .. .... ... .... . . ... . .... ... ..... .. ...... ... ....... ... ....... . . . . . . . ... ..... .... ........ ....... ......... ........... ............. ..................................
@ r @ b @ @r
a
.... .... .... .... .... ... ... ... ... ... ... ... ... ... .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
427
x
I
η
g ?
Q
Figure 1: The flow setup. In terms of the coordinates (ξ, θ) the dimensionless unsteady Navier–Stokes and energy equations for a viscous, incompressible fluid in terms of the streamfunction, ψ, vorticity, ζ, and temperature, φ, then become ∂2ψ ∂2ψ + = M 2ζ , (1) ∂ξ 2 ∂θ2 2 ∂ζ ∂ ζ 1 ∂ψ ∂ζ ∂ψ ∂ζ 1 ∂φ ∂2ζ ∂φ = 2 − +√ −B + 2 +A , (2) ∂t M ∂θ ∂ξ ∂ξ ∂θ ∂θ ∂ξ ∂θ Gr ∂ξ 2 2 ∂ φ ∂2φ 1 ∂ψ ∂φ ∂ψ ∂φ 1 ∂φ = 2 − +√ + , (3) ∂t M ∂θ ∂ξ ∂ξ ∂θ ∂θ2 GrP r ∂ξ 2 where
1 [cosh(2(ξ + ξ0 )) − cos(2θ)] , 2 A = sinh(ξ + ξ0 ) cos(η) cos(θ) − cosh(ξ + ξ0 ) sin(η) sin(θ) , M2 =
B = cosh(ξ + ξ0 ) cos(η) sin(θ) + sinh(ξ + ξ0 ) sin(η) cos(θ) . The problem as posed is completely specified by the following dimensionless parameters: the Grashof number, Gr = αgc3 ∆T /ν 2 , the inclination, η, the Prandtl number, P r = ν/κ, and the ellipse parameter, r. The dimensionless temperature, φ, is related to the dimensional temperature, T , through φ = (T − ˜ ˜ ) and ζ = cζ/U with the tilde denoting a T0 )/∆T . Similarly, ψ = ψ/(cU dimensional quantity. Lastly, in arriving at the above equations we have made the Boussinesq approximation to describe the buoyancy force and have omitted viscous dissipation. We assume that at t = 0 an impulsive heat flux is applied to the cylinder surface and that both the cylinder surface and surrounding fluid have an initial temperature WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
428 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII of T0 . Equations (1)-(3) are to be solved subject to the no-slip and constant flux conditions on the surface given by ψ=
∂ψ 1 ∂φ = 0 and = −1 ∂ξ M ∂ξ
on ξ = 0 .
Inspecting these conditions we observe that two conditions for the streamfunction are given while none for the vorticity is provided. Later we will discuss a method to prescribe the surface vorticity. In [2], the vorticity field is shown to satisfy integral constraints. These can be derived from the no-slip boundary conditions using Green’s second identity and are given by: ∞ π e−nξ M 2 ζ sin(nθ)dθdξ = 0 , n = 1, 2, · · · ,
0
0
∞
−π π
−π
e−nξ M 2 ζ cos(nθ)dθdξ = 0 , n = 0, 1, · · · .
At large distances we impose ψ, ζ, φ → 0 as ξ → ∞ , which correspond to a quiescent far-field flow. Lastly, we need to specify initial conditions. Since the fluid initially has a uniform temperature and the motion starts from rest, the initial conditions are simply ψ(ξ, θ, t = 0) = ζ(ξ, θ, t = 0) = φ(ξ, θ, t = 0) = 0 . To better resolve the early stages of the flow following the impulsive startup at t = 0, the boundary-layer coordinate, z, defined by 4t , (4) ξ = λz , λ = √ Gr is used. Essentially, this change of variable stretches the thermal-boundary layer. In terms of the coordinate z equations (1)-(3) get transformed to ∂2ψ ∂2ψ + λ2 2 = λ2 M 2 ζ , 2 ∂z ∂θ
(5)
∂ζ λ2 ∂ 2 ζ 1 ∂2ζ ∂ζ = 4t − 2 2 + 2z 2 2 M ∂z ∂z ∂t M ∂θ ∂ψ ∂ζ 4t ∂ψ ∂ζ 4tA ∂φ 4tB ∂φ − + 2 , (6) + − λM 2 ∂z ∂θ ∂θ ∂z λM 2 ∂z M ∂θ ∂ψ ∂φ ∂ψ ∂φ 1 ∂2φ ∂φ λ2 ∂ 2 φ ∂φ 4t = 4t − − + 2z + . (7) P rM 2 ∂z 2 ∂z ∂t P rM 2 ∂θ2 λM 2 ∂z ∂θ ∂θ ∂z As a final note we emphasize that although the boundary-layer coordinate z is utilized, the fully nonlinear Navier–Stokes and energy equations are to be solved and not the simplified boundary-layer equations. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
429
3 Numerical solution procedure As previously mentioned the early stages of the flow are to be computed using equations (5)-(7) involving the boundary-layer coordinate z. Once the boundary layer thickens appreciably one can switch back to the original coordinate ξ and solve equations (1)-(3). However, for large Gr it is more practical to work entirely in the boundary-layer coordinate z. In the numerical scheme outlined below only the procedure for solving equations (5)-(7) will be discussed for the sake of brevity. The procedure for solving (1)-(3) will be very similar. We begin by discretizing the computational domain bounded by 0 ≤ z ≤ z∞ and −π ≤ θ ≤ π into a uniform network of K × L grid points located at zi = ihz , i = 0, 1, . . . , K where hz =
z∞ K
and θj = −π + jhθ , j = 0, 1, . . . , L where hθ =
2π , L
with z∞ denoting the outer boundary approximating infinity. The streamfunction is solved by expanding it into a truncated Fourier series ψ(z, θ, t) =
N 1 F0 (z, t) + [Fn (z, t) cos(nθ) + fn (z, t) sin(nθ)] . 2 n=1
where the Fourier coefficients satisfy ∂ 2 Fn − n2 λ2 Fn = λ2 sn (z, t) , n = 0, 1, · · · ∂z 2
(8)
∂ 2 fn − n2 λ2 fn = λ2 rn (z, t); , n = 1, · · · ∂z 2
(9)
with
1 sn (z, t) = π 1 rn (z, t) = π
π
−π
π
−π
M 2 ζ cos(nθ)dθ , M 2 ζ sin(nθ)dθ .
Boundary conditions for the Fourier components can easily be determined from those for the streamfunction. Further conditions satisfied by the functions rn (z, t) and sn (z, t) follow from the integral conditions and are given by ∞ e−nλz sn (z, t)dz = 0 , n = 0, 1, 2, · · · 0
∞ 0
e−nλz rn (z, t)dz = 0 , n = 1, 2, · · · .
The above play an important role in determining the surface vorticity. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
430 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Equations (8)-(9) at a fixed time are of the form
h (z) − β 2 h(z) = g(z) , where β = nλ and the prime refers to differentiation with respect to z. These ordinary differential equations can be integrated using step-by-step formulae. The important point to note here is that the particular marching algorithm to be used is dependent on the parameter β. Two sets of step-by-step methods were utilized: one for β < 0.5 while another one for β ≥ 0.5. The specific schemes used can be found in [3]. To discuss the numerical method used to solve equations (6)-(7) we begin by rewriting them in the generic form t
∂χ = q(z, θ, t) . ∂t
The scheme used to discretize this equation is very similar to the Crank-Nicholson implicit procedure. Assuming the solution at time t is known, we advance the solution to time t + ∆t by integrating the above. Integration by parts yields χτ |t+∆t t
−
t+∆t t
χdτ =
t
t+∆t
qdτ
where ∆t is the time increment. Approximating the integrals using the trapezoidal rule results in the expression χ(z, θ, t + ∆t) = χ(z, θ, t) + (
∆t )[q(z, θ, t + ∆t) + q(z, θ, t)] . 2t + ∆t
Since q(z, θ, t + ∆t) depends on χ(z, θ, t + ∆t) and its spacial derivatives the scheme is implicit. This equation is solved iteratively using a Gauss–Seidel procedure. All spatial derivatives appearing in the function q are approximated using central-differences; thus the scheme given is second order accurate in both space and time. The boundary conditions used in solving the energy equation are straightforward and require no explanation. For the vorticity transport equation, on the other hand, careful attention must be given to determine the surface vorticity. The surface vorticity can be determined by inverting the expressions for rn and sn and leads to the truncated Fourier series ζ(0, θ, t) =
N 1 1 s { (0, t) + [rn (0, t) sin(nθ) + sn (0, t) cos(nθ)]} , 0 M02 2 n=1
where M02 = M 2 (z = 0, θ). The quantities sn (0, t) and rn (0, t) are computed by enforcing the integral conditions; that is, off the cylinder surface rn and sn can be computed using the most recent guess for ζ. Then, sn (0, t) and rn (0, t) are computed by numerically satisfying the integral constraints. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
431
We summarize the numerical method by listing the steps involved in the procedure. Assuming all quantities are known at time t and wish to advance the solution to a time t + ∆t, we perform the following steps (p denotes the iteration counter ): 1. solve for φ(p) (z, θ, t + ∆t), 2. solve for ζ (p) (z, θ, t + ∆t) everywhere except on the cylinder surface (z = 0), (p) (p) 3. compute rn (z, t + ∆t), sn (z, t + ∆t) for z = 0, (p) (p) 4. calculate rn (0, t + ∆t), sn (0, t + ∆t) by enforcing the integral conditions (p) and hence compute ζ (0, θ, t + ∆t), (p) (p) 5. solve for fn (z, t + ∆t), Fn (z, t + ∆t) and thus obtain ψ (p) (z, θ, t + ∆t), 6. repeat above steps till convergence is reached and increment p by 1 after each complete iteration. Step (4) indicates how the integral conditions are used in determining the surface vorticity. It may also be necessary to subject the surface vorticity to underrelaxation in order to obtain convergence. Convergence is reached when the difference between two successive iterates of the surface vorticity falls below some specified tolerance .
4 Results and discussion After performing numerous numerical experiments, the following computational parameters were chosen: N = 25, = 10−6 , z∞ = 10. A typical grid size used was K × L = 200 × 120. Because of the impulsive start, small time steps of ∆t = 10−3 were used initially. As time increased the time step was gradually increased to ∆t = 0.05. Results were obtained for parameter values of r = 0.5, η = 45◦ , P r = 0.7 (corresponding to air) with Gr = 102 and Gr = 104 . Shown in Figures 2(a), (b) are isotherm plots at times t = 2.5, 100, respectively, for the case Gr = 102 . In all isotherm plots to be presented the outermost contour corresponds to φ = 0.05 and the spacing between consecutive contours was set to ∆φ = 0.05. For this case computations were carried out in the boundary-layer coordinate up to t = 2.5 and then switched back to the original coordinate. At t = 2.5 the parameter λ = 1 and thus is a convenient time to switch coordinates. The isotherms portrayed in Figure 2(a) appear to form concentric rings. For small times this is to expected as this corresponds to the conduction regime. For large times, as depicted in Figure 2(b), a well developed thermal plume forms. Next we present some results for the case Gr = 104 . For this large Grashof number computations were carried out entirely in the boundary-layer coordinate. Displayed in Figure 3 is an isotherm plot at t = 20. Witnessed in this diagram is the formation of a well defined plume. It is interesting to note that for large Gr the plume develops much earlier in time due to the enhanced buoyancy force. Surface temperature and vorticity distributions are plotted in Figures 4, 5, respectively, at various times for the case Gr = 104 . As time advances both distributions reveal a prominent maximum evolving.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
432 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3
2
1
0
−1
−2
−3 −3
−2
−1
0
1
2
3
(a) 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 −5 −20
−15
−10
−5
0
5
10
15
20
(b) Figure 2: (a) Isotherms at t = 2.5 for Gr = 102 , (b) isotherms at t = 100 for Gr = 102 .
The numerical scheme was verified against a derived analytical solution which is valid for small t and large Gr. If Gr is large and t is small, then λ is also small, and it is possible to expand the flow variables in a double series in terms of λ and t. First, each flow variable χ is expanded in a series of the form χ = χ0 + λχ1 + λ2 χ2 + · · · . Then each χn , n = 0, 1, 2, · · · , is further expanded in a series of the form χn (z, θ, t) = χn0 (z, θ) + tχn1 (z, θ) + · · · . WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
433
6 5 4 3 2 1 0 −1 −5
−4
−3
−2
−1
0
1
2
3
4
5
Figure 3: Isotherms at t = 20 for Gr = 104 . 0.55 t=5 t=10 t=15 t=25
0.5
Surface Temperature
0.45
0.4
0.35
0.3
0.25
0.2
0
50
100
150
θ
200
250
300
350
Figure 4: Surface temperature distributions at various times for Gr = 104 .
Following this procedure, the leading-order term in the solution for the temperature can be shown to be √ √ √ 2 t −P rM02 z 2 φ(z, θ, t) ∼ − πP rM0 zerfc( P rM0 z)) , √ (e πP r Gr
where
2 erfc(x) = 1 − √ π
0
x
2
e−w dw .
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(10)
434 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 10 t=5 t=10 t=15 t=25
8
Surface Vorticity
6 4 2 0 −2 −4 −6 0
50
100
150
θ
200
250
300
350
Figure 5: Surface vorticity distributions at various times for Gr = 104 .
0.45 Analytical Numerical
Average Surface Temperature
0.4 0.35 0.3 0.25 0.2 0.15 0.1 0.05 0
0
5
10
15
20
25
t
Figure 6: Comparison between analytical and numerical solutions for Gr = 104 .
Contrasted in Figure 6 are the analytical and numerical solutions for Gr = 104 . As expected, for small t the two solutions are in good agreement and as time progresses the agreement worsens. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
435
5 Concluding remarks Discussed in this paper is a numerical procedure to solve the problem of impulsively generated free convection from a heated tube. Although the details were only presented for the case of an elliptic cylinder, other cylinder cross sections can easily be handled by simply changing the metric, M 2 , in equations (1)-(3). A numerical technique involving both finite difference and spectral methods was described and was successful in computing the unsteady flow for a large range of Grashof numbers. Future work involves continuing the analytical solution procedure and determining more terms in the expansion. In addition, it is desirable to make connections with the recent experimental results of Elsayed et al. [4] to demonstrate that the proposed numerical method can realistically mimic the physical problem in the laminar regime.
Acknowledgement Financial support for this research was provided by the Natural Sciences and Engineering Research Council of Canada.
References [1] Saitoh, T., Sajiki, T.& Maruhara, K., Bench mark solutions to natural convection heat transfer problem around a horizontal circular cylinder, International Journal of Heat and Mass Transfer 36, pp. 1251-1259, 1993. [2] Dennis, S.C.R. & Quartapelle, L., Some uses of Green’s theorem in solving the Navier–Stokes equations, International Journal of Numerical Methods in Fluids 9, pp. 871-890, 1989. [3] Staniforth, A.N., Studies of symmetrical and asymmetrical viscous flows past impulsively started cylinders, Ph.D. thesis, University of Western Ontario, London, Canada, 1972. [4] Elsayed, A.O., Ibrahim, E.Z.& Elsayed, S.A., Free convection from a constant heat flux elliptic tube, Energy Conversion and Management 44, pp. 24452453, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
437
Heat transfer in a ribbed square duct by Large-Eddy-Simulation O. Labbé ONERA, Châtillon, France
Abstract Large-eddy simulation is used to understand the flow in a square ribbed duct representative of systems designed for internal cooling of turbine blades. The presence of ribs increases turbulence levels and enhances heat transfer. The objective of the present LES study is to solve three-dimensional Navier-Stokes equations for a compressible flow to enable simulations for which the temperature variation within the flow is very significant. This simulation allows us to deal with a fully developed turbulent flow and heat transfer in a ribbed channel with a high blockage ratio, whose parameters are chosen to reproduce the experiments of Casarsa et al. “Characterization of the velocity and heat transfer fields in an internal cooling channel with high blockage ratio.” Proceedings of ASME TURBO EXPO 2002 June 3-6, Amsterdam, The Netherlands, 2002. The simulation is restricted to one pitch length and periodic conditions are applied in the streamwise direction. Mean and turbulent quantities are presented, together with the heat transfer. Keywords: LES, turbulence, heat transfer, rib, compressible flow.
1
Introduction
The efficient design of the internal ducts in gas turbine blades requires a detailed knowledge of the flow and heat phenomena occurring inside these passages. In ducts, ribs are used to disturb the boundary layers, thereby promoting turbulence and enhancing heat transfer. The presence of the ribs leads to a complex velocity field with regions of flow separation upstream and downstream of the ribs and contributes to the level of mixing of the cooler part of the air stream with the warmer air close to the walls. A large number of experimental investigations are available in the literature on aerodynamics and heat transfer performance of internal cooling channels with WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070441
438 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII ribs. Among them one may cite Casarsa et al. [1], who dealt with a detailed aero/thermal investigation of the turbulent flow in an internal cooling channel with high blockage ratio. A large amount of numerical studies by DNS or LES investigations has been devoted to the analysis of the flow and heat transfer in a ribbed channel. The flow is affected by the sidewall and a three-dimensional representation is needed. Among the studies, which consider 3D flow, one may list: Murata and Mochizuki [2], Watanabe and Takahashi [3], Tafti [4], the large-eddy simulations carried out by Lohász et al. [5–7] reproduce the experiments of Casarsa et al. [1] without taking into account the heat transfer. All of the papers mentioned above solve the Navier-Stokes equations for an incompressible flow and a temperature equation which acts like a passive scalar. The objective of the present LES study is to solve three-dimensional NavierStokes equations for a compressible flow to enable simulations for which the temperature variation within the flow is very significant. These simulations allow us to deal with a fully developed turbulent flow and heat transfer in a ribbed channel with high blockage ratio, whose parameters are chosen to reproduce the experiments of Casarsa et al. [1].
2
Periodic square ribbed channel
The present contribution concerns the simulation of the flow in a square duct where successive ribs of square cross section are mounted on the lower wall perpendicularly to the stream direction. Casarsa et al. [1] have experimentally found that for such a configuration the flow starts to repeat itself in every pitch length after the fourth rib. This situation allows us to confine the numerical simulation to investigate around a single rib and to use periodic conditions in the streamwise (X) direction. The numerical results will be compared with those obtained experimentally between the fourth and fifth ribs. The channel is characterized by a square cross section (Y, Z) 0.1x0.1 m2. The rib cross section (hxh) is 0.03x0.03 m2, providing a blockage ratio of 30%. The pitch-to-height ratio (P/h) is equal to 10. The Reynolds number of the mean flow based on the hydraulic diameter Dh and the bulk velocity is equal to 4.104. The duct walls as well as the three faces of the rib exposed to the main flow are heated by imposing a constant temperature Tw in order to represent the constant heat flux qw prescribed in the experiments. Fig. 1 shows a schematic of the channel with a transverse rib located on the bottom wall of the duct.
3
Governing equations and computational model
The time-accurate resolution method of complex flows, which present separating /reattaching shear layers and secondary flows is based on the large-eddy simulation. LES, by solving the energy containing eddies, reduces the complexity of Direct Numerical Simulation (DNS) by several orders of magnitude. Two approaches are commonly used to perform LES: explicit subgrid stress models are used to represent the effect of unresolved scales of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
439
motion on the large scales and the second method consists in using the Monotonic Integrated Large-Eddy Simulations (MILES) proposed by Boris et al. [8]. This latter is based on the assumption that the intrinsic dissipation of an upwind scheme is able to mimic the dissipative behaviour of the unresolved turbulent scales, and that when using such a scheme, the subgrid viscosity has to be set to zero. The MILES approach has been used in the present study. The governing equations for LES are the grid-filtered mass, momentum and total energy equations for compressible flow. In order to simplify the resulting set of ~ equations, a mass-weighted change of variable (Favre) is defined as: ρ f = ρ f
∂ ∂ρ (ρ u~ j ) = 0 + ∂t ∂x j
~ ∂ ~ ∂ ∂ p ∂σij − (ρ ui ) + (ρ u~i u~j ) + = −α δi1 ∂t ∂x j ∂xi ∂x j
^ ~ ∂ ^ ∂ ρE ~ ∂ (σ ~ ij u~ ) + ∂q j = −α u~ − ρ u~ β + (ρE + p)u j − i 1 1 ∂x j ∂x j ∂t ∂x j
where the total energy is written as follows: ^
ρE =
~ is defined as: The stress tensor σ ij
1 p + ρ u~ j u~ j γ −1 2
~ ~ ~ ~ = µ(T~ )( ∂ui + ∂u j − 2 ∂uk δ ) . σ ij ij ∂x j ∂xi 3 ∂xk
The heat flux vector q~ j is given by: q~j = −
~ ~ µ(T ) ∂T . ( γ − 1) Re Pr M 2 ∂x j
Due to the periodicity of the simulation the term α is the mean pressure gradient to balance the wall-shear stress on the walls, it is imposed in the streamwise direction to maintain a constant flow rate and δi1 takes the value of one when i=1. A mean enthalpy gradient β is added in order to balance the global energy due to the heated walls, β = q w S w / m P where qw is the heat flux at the walls, Sw the total surface of the heated walls, m the flow rate and P is the pitch distance. To close the set of equations, the following filtered equation of ~ -1 -1 state is used: ~ p / ρ = rT with r =287 J kg K . The viscosity dependence on temperature is modelled using the Sutherland’s law. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
440 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1: Computational domain of the square ribbed channel.
4 Numerical schemes and boundary conditions The governing equations for mass, momentum and energy are discretised with a conservative finite-volume formulation. The spatial discretisation method is based on the cell-centred finite volume methodology. An upwind biased, with a third-order MUSCL interpolation scheme of AUSM+(P) family without any shock capturing feature is used for the convective scheme. An explicit time integration is carried out by means of a third-order compact Runge-Kutta scheme. Details of the method can be found in Péchier et al. [9] and in Larchevêque et al. [10]. Periodic boundary conditions are imposed in the streamwise (X) direction. No-slip boundary conditions and wall temperature are applied at the top, bottom and lateral walls of the channel and at the top and lateral walls of the rib.
5
Simulation characteristics
Mesh density is relatively high in the vicinity of the rib and the duct surfaces to resolve the boundary /shear layers, which is crucial to the accurate prediction of turbulence and heat transfer. The computational domain consists in about 1.15 million grid points, which are distributed as follows: 201 and 61 grid points respectively in the streamwise and spanwise directions. In the vertical direction 101 (61 above the rib) grid points are used. The size of the first cell is 0.003Dh near walls. In wall units the distance from the wall of the first point is y+=5 based a posteriori on the mean wall shear velocity. The time step is set to 10–5Dh/U0 corresponding to an average CFL value of 0.1 over the whole domain. The initialization of the field is achieved assuming an initial bulk velocity corresponding to the experiments and the calculations are integrated on time WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
441
until the flow rate adjusts to balance between internal losses and the specified pressure gradient. Once the flow has reached a stationary state (30 time units), sampling to obtain mean and turbulent quantities is carried out for 120 time units. All the results are normalized by the bulk flow velocity (U0) in order to compare them with previous experimental and/or numerical works.
6
Results and discussion
The flow is strongly three-dimensional, but in the centre plane Z/h=0, the flow is essentially two-dimensional. The presence of the high spanwise velocity regions upstream of the rib is due to the blockage effect of the rib. As a matter of fact the blockage forces the flow in front of the rib to swirl toward the lateral walls in an upward motion over the rib which is noticeable in Fig. 2. In this latter, the streamlines started from a line upstream from the rib, are spiralling in front of it, forming a surface trapped in the upstream corner. This forces the flow to swirl towards the walls above the rib and to finally escape downstream in the channel corner.
Figure 2: Global view of the flow. Considering the mean flow in the centre plane Z/h=0., streamlines of Fig. 3 reveal four distinct zones associated with the ribs. A wide recirculation bubble occurs downstream from the rib due to the sudden expansion of the flow, accompanied by a small counter rotating vortex V1 at the lower corner behind the rib. After the flow reattachment line, a new boundary layer develops and impinges on the next rib forming an upstream vortex V3. Another recirculation zone V2 is formed on the rib top as the sharp front edge of the rib deflects the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
442 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII flow. The sizes of the different recirculation zones are compared with measurements of Casarsa et al. [1] and with the LES results of Lohász et al. [6] and summarized in Table 1. The comparison shows a good agreement with experimental measurements except for the vortex V1, which is larger for both LES simulations.
Figure 3: Flow structures in Z/h=0. Table 1:
Comparison of the different recirculation zones.
Reattachment V1 V2 V3 4.26<X/h<4.34 0.255 <∆X/h 0.6<∆X/h<0.9 1.04<∆X/h<1.5 <0.28 ∆X/h =0.5 ∆X/h =0.91 ∆X/h =0.66 LES (Lohász et ∆X/h =3.85 al.) [6] Present LES ∆X/h =4.4 ∆X/h =0.6 ∆X/h =0.7 ∆X/h =1.3 Casarsa et al. [1]
Figure 4:
Mean streamwise (top) and normal (bottom) velocity profiles at Z/h=0.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
443
The mean streamwise and normal velocity profiles are compared in Fig. 4 on the centre plane Z/h=0. The LES of Lohász et al. [7] in a red dashed line. The experimental results plotted with black squares and the present simulation in black dotted/dashed line show a very good agreement. The rib reduces the cross section and consequently accelerates the flow, and high velocity gradients are found in the upstream top corner of the rib. The sudden expansion downstream from it leads to a large recirculation region associated with a strong shear layer. All the planes shifted from the wall (0.05) in Fig. 5 are coloured by mean streamwise velocity. On three transverse sections: X/h=0 (on the rib), X/h=4 (reattachment line) and X/h=9.45 (in front of the rib), surface streamlines are plotted and allow us to understand the flow complexity. Above the rib, the flow is characterized by an acceleration of the fluid and the streamline patterns clearly indicate how it moves towards the lateral walls. Counter-rotating structures compensate the downward current. Two other counter-rotating structures appear and develop in the upper corners of the transverse sections. Moreover volume streamrods are plotted to follow the flow through the computational domain, one of them passes over the rib and then is trapped in the main recirculation region, another spirals on the top of the rib toward the lateral wall.
Figure 5:
Secondary flow patterns and volume streamrods.
Figure 6 shows contours of resolved Urms, Vrms (normalized by U0) and resolved turbulent shear stresses U’V’ (normalized by U02) at the centre plane Z/h=0. The LES results (right) are in good agreement with those obtained experimentally by Casarsa et al. [1] (left). The streamwise fluctuations Urms reach their maximum value in the separated shear layer at the leading edge of the rib. They are lowest above the rib and in the recirculation region immediately behind the rib. The vertical fluctuations Vrms reach their maximum in front of the rib as well as in the separated shear layer downstream from the rib and they are low behind the rib in the stagnation region. The maximum of turbulent shear stress U’V’ occurs in a very small region at the leading edge of the rib in the separated shear layer. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
444 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6:
Urms, Vrms and U’V’ in Z/h=0, present LES (right), Casarsa et al. (left).
Figure 7:
Distribution of Nusselt number on ribbed wall, lateral wall and rib.
The heat transfer results are presented in terms of an enhancement factor which corresponds to the ratio between Nusselt number Nu of the flow at the wall ( Nu = qw Dh / λ (θ w − θ ref ) ) and Nu0 obtained from Dittus-Boelter correlation: Nu0= 0.023 Re0.8 Pr0.4. The results are plotted on Fig. 7 on the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
445
different walls. On the rib itself, the heat transfer is maximum at the top leading edge as a result of the strong fluid acceleration, and in the reattachment region of the structure V2. On the lateral wall, the highest values of Nu/Nu0 are found in a region arched over the top front corner of the rib, due to the upward motion described previously with streamlines in Fig. 5. In front of the rib on the ribbed wall, the heat transfer is high as the result of highly unsteady secondary eddies produced in this region. However, it drops on moving closer to the lateral walls. Immediately downstream from the rib, the heat transfer is minimum. Further downstream in the main recirculation region the Nusselt number increases, but does not reach the peaks previously described. Compared to the experimental results of Casarsa et al. [1], the predicted heat transfer is found at the same places, but is underestimated. In the LES simulation a mean enthalpy gradient is added due to the periodic condition in the streamwise direction, but this term does not accurately balance the energy increase due to the heated walls, and globally the temperature is increasing in the flow and the heat transfer is reducing at the walls. A wall temperature is a priori imposed in order to assume the heat flux imposed in the experiments, but as the whole flow heats, the correct heat flux is not obtained a posteriori.
7
Conclusion
LES has been performed in a ribbed square duct with a rib height to hydraulic diameter ratio of .3 and a rib pitch to rib height ratio of 10 for a bulk Reynolds number of 40,000. The simulation reproduces the major flow structures measured experimentally with a very good agreement, namely a recirculation zone formed on the top of the rib and behind the rib, the lateral impingement of the flow on the side walls. After the flow reattachment, the boundary layer grows up and impinges on the rib forming another vortex. The three-dimensional nature of the flow is very evident. It is observed that the rib induces a flow swirling towards the sidewalls before passing away on top of the rib. A comparison of mean flow with experiments by Casarsa and LES of Lohász shows excellent agreement. Moreover the contour plots turbulence intensity in the centre plane are in good agreement with those obtained experimentally by Casarsa. The sidewalls have a strong influence on the heat transfer distribution. The streamlines connecting bottom wall upstream the rib and a region over the top corner of the rib are well correlated to the high values of heat transfer. While the heat transfer on the ribbed wall is enhanced due to the streamwise flow, the secondary flow plays a major role in the heat transfer on the side walls. Immediately behind the rib, a secondary recirculation is trapped between the wall and the primary recirculation zone, which prevents the fluid from efficiently mixing with the fluid in the channel core, but increases the heat transfer on the downstream rib side. The heat transfer locations of LES results compare well with experimental results, however their levels are under-predicted, due to an unsuitable enthalpy gradient, inefficient to maintain an imposed heat flux at the walls.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
446 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1]
[2]
[3]
[4] [5]
[6] [7]
[8] [9] [10]
Casarsa, L. Çakan, M. & Arts, T., Characterization of the velocity and heat transfer fields in an internal cooling channel with high blockage ratio. Proceedings of ASME TURBO EXPO 2002 June 3-6, Amsterdam, The Netherlands, 2002. Murata, A. & Mochizuki, S., Large eddy simulation with a dynamic subgrid-scale model of turbulent heat transfer in an orthogonally rotating rectangular duct with transverse rib turbulators, Int. J. Heat and Mass Transfer 43, pp. 1243-1259, 2000. Watanabe, K. & Takahashi, T., LES simulation and experimental measurement of fully developed ribbed channel flow and heat transfer, Proceedings of ASME TURBO EXPO June 3-6, Amsterdam, The Netherlands, 2002. Tafti, D.K., Evaluating the role of subgrid stress modelling in a ribbed duct for the internal cooling of turbine blades, Int. J. Heat and Fluid Flow 26, pp. 92-104, 2005. Lohász, M.M., Rambaud, P. & Benocci, C., LES simulation of ribbed square duct flow with FLUENT and comparison with PIV data, Conference on Modelling Fluid Flow (CMFF’03), The 12th International Conference on Fluid Flow Technologies, Budapest, Hungary, September 3-6, 2003. Lohász, M.M., Rambaud, P. & Benocci, C., MILES flow inside a square section ribbed duct, RTO Meeting, AVT-120 Workshop on “ Urban Dispersion Modelling” April 1-2, Rhode Saint Genèse, Belgium, 2004. Lohász, M.M., Rambaud, P. & Benocci, C., Flow features in a fully developed ribbed duct flow as a result of LES, Proceedings of the ERCOFTAC International Symposium on Engineering Turbulence Modelling and Measurements ETMM6 Sardinia, Italy, 23-25 May, 2005. Boris, J.P., Grinstein, F.F., Oran, E.S. & Kolbe, R.L., New insights into large eddy simulation. Fluid dynamics research, 10, pp. 199-228, 1992. Péchier, M., Guillen, Ph. & Cayzac, R., Magnus effect over finned projectiles, J. of Spacecraft and Rockets, 38(4), pp. 542-549, 2001. Larchevêque, L., Sagaut, P., Mary, I., Labbé, O. & Comte, P., Large-eddy simulation of a compressible flow past a deep cavity. Phys. of Fluids 15(1), pp. 193-210, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
447
Effect of thermal boundary conditions on conjugate natural convection flow in vertical eccentric annuli A. Jamal1, M. A. I. El-Shaarawi2 & E. M. A. Mokheimer2 1
Department of Aerospace Engineering, King Fahd University of Petroleum and Minerals, Saudi Arabia 2 Department of Mechanical Engineering, King Fahd University of Petroleum and Minerals, Saudi Arabia
Abstract The effect of thermal boundary conditions on conjugate laminar natural convection heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli is numerically investigated using the finite-difference technique. Numerical results are presented for a Newtonian fluid of Prandtl number 0.7 in an eccentric annulus. The variation of induced flow rate and total heat absorbed in the annulus are studied for two sets of boundary conditions at different values of geometry parameters (dimensionless annulus eccentricity and radius ratio). In both sets of boundary conditions, one wall is heated isothermally. The other wall is kept at the inlet fluid temperature for the first set of boundary conditions and adiabatic for the second set. The effect of interchanging the wall thermal conditions for each set is also considered. Analysis reveals that heating the outer cylinder wall or keeping one of the annulus walls insulated is more useful for inducing flow (thermosiphons). Keywords: natural convection, heat transfer, eccentric annuli, thermal boundary conditions, finite difference method, Newtonian fluid.
1
Introduction
The study of steady laminar induced flow in vertical eccentric annuli with conjugate heat transfer is of great importance because of its many engineering applications in electrical, nuclear, solar and thermal storage fields. In the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070451
448 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII electrical field, in vertical electric motors and generators, the heat generated by irreversible electrical and mechanical processes is transferred through the air gap between the rotor and the stator by natural convection. The transfer of heat by free convection is always a factor in the cooling of such machines and may be the sole means of cooling small types of these devices. Considerable work has been done to study the problem of flow and conjugate heat transfer in various geometries and annuli, both concentric and eccentric. Anand and Tree [1] studied the effect of axial conduction in a tube wall on the steady-state laminar convective heat transfer. Using finite-difference technique, El-Shaarawi and Negm [2] solved the laminar conjugate natural convection problem in vertical open-ended concentric annuli. Similarly, in spite of the many studies reported in the literature for the conventional case of convection in eccentric annuli [3–5], the only work available for the conjugate case is that of El-Shaarawi and Haider [6] for forced convection. They presented results for a fluid of Prandtl number Pr=0.7 flowing in an annulus of radius ratio NR2=0.5 with eccentricity E=0.1, 0.3, 0.5, and 0.7. Moreover, in a recent paper ElShaarawi et al [7] presented some results for the conjugate heat transfer in the free convection regime. The literature survey summarized above revealed that conjugate natural convection heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli is still in its infancy stage. The present paper presents a boundary layer model for the problem of developing steady laminar conjugate natural convection heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli. A numerical algorithm, employing finite difference technique, is developed to solve the obtained model. Numerical results are presented to show the effects of thermal boundary conditions on the conjugate natural convection flow and heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli at different values of geometry parameters (dimensionless annulus eccentricity (E) and radius ratio (NR2)). Two sets of boundary conditions are considered in the present analysis. In both sets of boundary conditions, one wall is heated isothermally. The other wall is kept at inlet fluid temperature for the first set of boundary conditions and adiabatic for the second set. Furthermore, the effect of switching the walls thermal conditions for each set is also analyzed.
2
Problem formulation
The vertical eccentric annulus of finite height and thickness, as shown in fig. 1, is open at both ends and is immersed in a stagnant Newtonian fluid maintained at constant temperature (To). Free convection flow is induced inside this annular channel as a result of heating one of the channel walls isothermally while keeping the other wall at inlet fluid temperature (case 1) or adiabatic (case 2). In both cases, ‘I’ refers to the case when the heat transfer wall is the inner cylinder wall and ‘O’ vice versa. Thus, case (1.I) corresponds to the thermal boundary condition having the inner cylinder wall isothermally heated while the outer wall kept at inlet fluid temperature. It is evident from fig. 1 that the eccentric annular geometry is symmetric about line AB, therefore, only the half symmetric section is taken for the analysis. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
449
Axis of the outer cylinder
Axis of the inner cylinder
Height (L)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Fluid Annulus Mesh Inner Cylinder Mesh Outer Cylinder Mesh
A
Figure 1:
E
B
Elevation and numerical mesh of the eccentric annulus.
The flow is steady, laminar, enters the eccentric annulus with a uniform velocity distribution (Uo). Body forces in other than the vertical direction, viscous dissipation (Φ), internal heat generation ( Q ′′′ ) and radiation heat transfer are absent. The governing equations describing flow and heat transfer through the eccentric annulus are the conservation equations of mass, momentum and energy given in a general orthogonal curvilinear coordinate system by Hughes and Gaylord [8]. The bipolar coordinate system is more suitable to express the partial differential equations describing the flow and heat transfer through the vertical eccentric annulus, shown in fig. 1. On the other hand, the cylinder walls have uniform thickness. Hence, the cylindrical coordinate system is more appropriate for the solid walls. Some parabolic-flow assumptions by El-Shaarawi and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
450 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Mokheimer [9] will be used to simplify the governing equations. The assumptions include: the pressure is a function of the axial coordinate only ∂p ∂p ( = 0 ), the axial diffusions of momentum and energy are neglected = ∂η ∂ξ ∂2
= 0 ), and the η-velocity component (v) is much smaller than the ξ and z∂z 2 velocity components (w and u). Introducing the dimensionless parameters given in the nomenclature, carrying out an order of magnitude analysis and taking into consideration that the latter assumption results in dropping the η-momentum equation, the governing equations are:
(
Continuity equation ∂ UH 2 ∂ (HW ) ∂ (HV ) + 4(1 − NR 2 )2 =0 + ∂η ∂Z ∂ξ
(
)
(1)
Momentum equation in Z-direction W ∂U V ∂U ∂U θ ∂P 1 + + 4(1 − NR 2 )2 U = − + H ∂ξ H ∂η ∂Z 4(1 − NR 2 )2 4(1 − NR 2 )2 ∂Z 1 ∂ 2U ∂ 2U + H 2 ∂η 2 ∂ξ 2
(2)
Momentum equation in ξ-direction
W ∂W V ∂(HW ) Gr2 ∂P ∂W V 2 ∂H + 2 + 4(1 − NR2 )2U − 2 =− + H ∂ξ H H ∂ξ ∂η ∂Z H ∂ξ 1 ∂2 (HW ) ∂2 (HW ) 1 ∂2 (HW ) − + + ∂ξ 2 HGr2 ∂Z 2 H 3 ∂η2
(3)
2 ∂(HW ) ∂(HV ) ∂H 8(1 − NR2 )2 ∂H ∂U − + ∂ξ ∂η ∂ξ ∂Z H 4 ∂η H2 Energy equation for fluid ∂θ f W ∂θ f V ∂θ f 1 = + 4(1 − NR 2 )2 U + ∂Z H ∂ξ H ∂η Pr H 2
∂ 2θ f ∂ 2θ f + ∂η 2 ∂ξ 2
(4)
Energy equation for solid ∂ 2θ s ∂R 2
+
2 1 ∂θ s 1 ∂ θs + 2 =0 R ∂R R ∂φ 2
The thermal boundary conditions considered in this investigation are: For outer cylinder, θs = θso & R vary from NR3=1 to NR4 For inner cylinder, θs = θsi & R vary from NR1 to NR2
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
451
Integral form of the continuity equation 8(1 − NR 2 ) U = π (1 + NR 2 )
π ηI
∫ η∫ UH 0
2
dηdξ
(6)
O
Having the governing equations for the fluid in bipolar coordinates and the energy equations for the solid walls in cylindrical coordinates generates unmatched grid points on both the interfaces. Therefore, these points are linked to determine the temperatures at the two interfaces by applying the principles of continuity of temperature and continuity of heat flux at these interfaces. Equations (1-6), subject to boundary conditions, have been numerically solved as indicated in [7].
3
Results and discussion
Numerical results have been obtained for cases (1.I), (1.O), (2.I), and (2.O) for dimensionless eccentricities, E=0.1, 0.3, 0.5, and 0.7 and radius ratios, NR2=0.1, 0.3, 0.5, and 0.7 at given solid-fluid conductivity ratio (KR=10), cylinder wall thicknesses (δi and δo= 0.1 and 0.2), and Prandtl number (Pr=0.7). In the present analysis, a grid of 25 segments in each η and ξ directions in the fluid annulus whereas 20 and 10 segments in the r-direction in the outer and inner cylinder walls, respectively, and 25 segments in φ-direction in each of the cylinder walls are used (Jamal [10]). To check the adequacy of the present computer code, special runs were carried out simulating the two different limiting cases of conventional and conjugate convection for the given eccentric annuli. The results of these special computer code experimentations are as follows. First, a special computer run simulating the conventional natural convection case was done. The obtained results for the channel height required to suck specific flow rates for case (1.I) are compared in fig. 2 with the corresponding results of El-Shaarawi and Mokheimer [9]. The maximum error never exceeded 2.87%. 0.008
[9]
0.0075
Present code
0.007 0.0065 0.006
F 0.0055 0.005 0.0045 0.004 0.0035 0.003 0
0.001
0.002
0.003
0.004
0.005
Channel Height (L)
Figure 2:
Comparison of F versus L as reported by El-Shaarawi and Mokheimer [9] and the corresponding results by a special computer run simulating conventional free convection.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
452 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Secondly, the present computer code was validated for the conjugate forced convection case in eccentric annuli by comparing the results obtained from a pertaining special run with the corresponding developing and fully developed temperature profiles across the widest gap (Ψ=0) of El-Shaarawi and Haider [6]; excellent agreement was observed as the maximum deviation between the obtained results and those of [6] never exceeded 0.23%. Owing to the space limitations, only a representative sample of the results will be presented. Figure 3 presents the variation of induced flow rate (F) with the channel height (L) for cases (1.I) and (1.O) at different values of dimensionless eccentricity (E). It can be seen from the comparison that at a given L and E, F is greater for case (1.O) than that for case (1.I). This can be attributed to the larger heated surface area for case (1.O) than for case (1.I) that enables more amount of heat to flow into the fluid annulus and causes higher mean fluid temperature and buoyancy force in the annulus, hence resulting in higher values of F. In the figure, the dominant effect of heating the outer wall is observed. 0.014
Case 1.I 0.7
Case 1.O
0.012
0.5
0.01
0.3 E=0.1
0.008
0.7 0.5 0.3 E=0.1
F 0.006 0.004 0.002 0 0
0.001
0.002
0.003
0.004
0.005
0.006
Channel Height (L)
Figure 3:
Comparison of flow rate with channel height for different values of eccentricity among cases (1.I) and (1.O).
Relative comparison of F versus L is presented for cases (1.O) and (2.O) at different values of radius ratio (NR2) in fig. 4. Due to the presence of one insulated wall in case (2.O), heat finds no way to flow through other than the fluid. This allows more amount of heat to be absorbed by the fluid thus raising the mean fluid temperature and leading to a higher value of F than for case (1.O). Similar behavior has been observed in other comparisons between the two boundary conditions (1 & 2) at different values of E and NR2. Figure 5 shows the variation of total heat absorbed ( Q ) versus L for cases (1.I) and (2.I) at different values of E. Similar plot is obtained for cases (1.I) and (1.O) at different values of NR2 as shown in fig. 6. Since Q is directly related to F through the relation, Q = Fθ m, ex , therefore, behavior similar to figs. 3 and 4 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
453
has been observed, i.e., case (O) of both the boundary conditions (1 & 2) shows higher values of Q than case (I) and boundary condition (2) (I & O) shows higher values of Q than boundary condition (1), at any given L, E, and NR2. 0.035
Case 1.O Case 2.O
0.03
0.7
0.025 0.7
0.02
0.5
F 0.015
0.5
0.3
0.01
0.3 NR 2=0.1
0.005
NR 2=0.1
0 0
0.005
0.01
0.015
0.02
Channel Height (L)
Figure 4:
Comparison of flow rate with channel height for different values of radius ratio among cases (1.O) and (2.O). 0.014
Q
0.7
Case 1.I
0.5
Case 2.I
0.012
0.3
0.01
E=0.1
0.008 0.006 0.004
0.5
0.7
0.002
0.3
E=0.1
0 0
0.002
0.004
0.006
0.008
0.01
0.012
0.014
Channel Height (L)
Figure 5:
4
Comparison of total heat absorbed for different values of eccentricity among cases (1.I) and (3.I).
Conclusions
Combined conduction-laminar free convection heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli has been numerically investigated. A finite-difference algorithm has been developed to solve the bipolar model equations. Numerical results are presented for a fluid of Prandtl number, Pr=0.7 in an eccentric annulus. The effect of boundary conditions on the variations of the induced flow rate (F) and the heat absorbed ( Q ) in the eccentric annulus has been investigated at different values of eccentricity (E) and radius ratio (NR2). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
454 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 0.003 Case 1.I
0.0025
Q
0.3
Case 1.O
0.002 0.0015
NR2=0.1
0.001 0.3
0.0005 NR2=0.1
0 0
0.001 0.002 0.003 0.004 0.005 0.006 0.007 0.008 0.009
Channel Height (L)
0.03 Case 1.I
0.025
Case 1.O
Q
0.7
0.02 0.7
0.015 0.01 NR 2=0.5
0.005
NR2=0.5
0 0
0.002
0.004
0.006
0.008
0.01
0.012
0.014
0.016
Channel Height (L)
Figure 6:
Comparison of total heat absorbed for different values of eccentricity among cases (1.I) and (2.I).
The results of the present work have revealed that cases such as (1.O) and (2.O) have higher values of F and Q than cases (1.I) and (2.I), respectively. Similarly, the values of F and Q are higher for cases (2.I) and (2.O) than for cases (1.I) and (1.O), respectively. Hence it can be inferred from the results that the heat transfer is more pronounced for case (O) and boundary condition (2) and heating the outer cylinder wall or keeping one of the annulus walls insulated is more useful for inducing flow (thermo-siphons).
Nomenclature Dh
Hydraulic or equivalent diameter of annulus, m
Gr*
Modified Grashof number
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
H M N NR1
NR2
NR3
NR4
P rii roi rio roo R
Tw
Dimensionless coordinate transformation scale factor No. of intervals in each of the ξ & φ-directions Number of intervals in the ηdirection Ratio between inner radius of inner cylinder and inner r radius of outer cylinder, ii rio Ratio between outer radius of inner cylinder and inner radius of outer cylinder (Fluid annulus radius ratio), roi rio Dimensionless inner radius r of outer cylinder, io = 1 rio Ratio between outer radius of outer cylinder and inner r radius of outer cylinder, oo rio Dimensionless Pressure defect of fluid inside the channel at any cross section Inner radius of inner cylinder, m Outer radius of inner cylinder, m Inner radius of outer cylinder, m Outer radius of outer cylinder, m Dimensionless radial r coordinate, rio Isothermal temperature of heated wall, K
455
U
Dimensionless axial velocity
V
urio 2 lγGr ∗ Velocity vector or dimensionless η-velocity νD h component,
at any point,
γ
W
Dimensionless ξ-velocity wD h component,
γ
Z
Dimensionless axial coordinate in both the Cartesian and bipolar coordinate systems, z
lGr ∗ Greek Letters η First transverse bi-polar coordinate θ Dimensionless temperature, (T − To ) for isothermal (Tw − To ) walls case θf Value of θ in the fluid annulus θm,ex Mean fluid temperature at channel exit θsi Value of θ in the inner solid wall θso Value of θ in the outer solid wall. δi Dimensionless thickness of inner cylinder wall, NR2-NR1 Dimensionless thickness of δo outer cylinder wall, NR4-NR3 φ Angle along the cylinder walls ξ Second transverse bi-polar point.
Ψ
Normalized value of ξ,
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
ξ π
456 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Acknowledgement The support of King Fahd University of Petroleum and Minerals to carry out this investigation is gratefully acknowledged.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5] [6] [7]
[8] [9] [10]
Anand, N. K. & Tree, D. R., Some studies of the effects of axial conduction in a tube wall on the steady-state laminar convective heat transfer. Journal of Heat Transfer, 109, pp. 1025-1028, 1987. El-Shaarawi, M.A.I. and Negm, A. A. A., Transient combined natural convection-conduction in open-ended vertical concentric annuli. Heat and Mass Transfer, 35, pp. 133-141, 1999. Feldman, E.E., Hornbeck, R.W. and Osterle, J. F., A numerical solution of temperature for laminar developing flow in eccentric annular ducts. International Journal of Heat and Mass Transfer, 25 (2), pp. 243-253, 1982. El-Shaarawi, M.A.I., Mokheimer, E. M.A., Free convection in vertical eccentric annuli with a uniformly heated boundary. International Journal of Numerical Methods for Heat and Fluid Flow, 8 (5), pp. 488-503, 1998. Kumar, D.S., Laxminarayana, B. and Balaji, C., Laminar natural convection in cylindrical annuli filled with a low Prandtl number fluid. Heat and Technology, 20 (2), pp. 67-74, 2002. El-Shaarawi, M.A.I. and Haider, S. A., Critical conductivity ratio for conjugate heat transfer in eccentric annuli. International Journal of Numerical Methods for Heat and Fluid Flow, 11 (2), pp. 255-277, 2001. El-Shaarawi, M.A.I., Mokheimer, E. M. A. and Jamal, A., Conjugate effects on steady laminar natural convection heat transfer in vertical eccentric annuli. International Journal for Computational Methods in Engineering Science and Mechanics, 6, pp. 235-250, 2005. Hughes, W.F. and Gaylord, E.W., Basic Equations of Engineering Science, Schaum Outline Series, pp. 150-151, 1964. El-Shaarawi, M.A.I., Mokheimer, E. M.A., Developing free convection in open ended vertical eccentric annuli with isothermal boundaries. Journal of Heat Transfer, Transaction ASME, 121 (1), pp. 63-72, 1999. Jamal, A., Conjugate Free Convection Heat Transfer in Vertical Eccentric Annuli, MS Thesis, Mechanical Engineering Department, King Fahd University of Petroleum and Minerals (KFUPM): Dhahran, Saudi Arabia, pp. 52-57, 2002.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
457
Foam flow turn influence on the in-line tube bundle heat transfer intensity J. Gylys1, S. Sinkunas2, T. Zdankus1, V. Giedraitis2 & A. Balcius2 1
Energy Technology Institute, Kaunas University of Technology, Lithuania 2 Department of Thermal and Nuclear Energy, Kaunas University of Technology, Lithuania
Abstract An experimental investigation of heat transfer from the tubes to the two-phase foam system was performed. Statically stable gas–liquid foam flow was used as a coolant. An investigation was performed on the experimental laboratory set-up consisting of the foam generator, an experimental channel and tube bundles. Two different geometries of in-line tube bundles were used for the experiments. Regularities of heat transfer of the tube bundles to the foam flow under the 180˚ degree turn were analysed in the work. The results of the investigation showed that heat transfer intensity is much higher than that for the one-phase airflow under the same conditions. The heat transfer character of frontal and further tubes to downward foam flow is different in comparison with the one-phase coolant flow. After the turn, local void fraction of the foam is less on the inner side of the foam flow. Therefore heat transfer intensity of the inner side-line tubes is higher than for other tubes of the bundle. The results of the investigation were generalized by criterion equations, which can be used for the calculation and design of the statically stable gas–liquid foam heat exchangers with the in-line tube bundles. Keywords: statically stable foam, foam flow, flow turn, heat transfer, in-line tube bundle.
1
Introduction
One-phase coolants are usually used for heat and mass transfer processes in heat exchangers. Smaller coolant mass flow rate, relatively large heat transfer rate, low energy consumption required for coolant delivery to the heat transfer place WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070461
458 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII may be achieved by usage of two-phase gas–liquid foam flow as a coolant. Nevertheless some problems appear in that case. First of all, heat transfer of different tube bundles to one-phase fluids was investigated [1, 2], but practically there aren't data related to the tube bundle heat transfer to the foam flow. Another problem is that a structure of the foam may not significantly vary while it passes different obstacles (turnings, tube bundles and so on), especially during the heat transfer process. Statically stable foam (one type of gas–liquid foam) keeps its initial structure and bubbles' dimension within broad limits of a long time interval even after termination of the foam generation and therefore is available for heat transfer purposes [3]. This type of foam can be generated from the solutions, which have less than pure liquid surface tension. However a number of foam peculiarities, drainage of liquid from foam [4, 5], diffusive transfer of gas between bubbles [6], division and collapse of foam bubbles [5], complicates an application of the analytical methods for heat transfer investigation. Therefore an experimental method of investigation was selected in our work as the most suitable. Typical heat exchangers usually consist of several vertical parts in which coolant changes its direction from vertical upward to vertical downward and vice versa. Tube bundles of different types and geometry may be used in heat exchangers also. Therefore we performed an investigation of staggered [7, 8] and in-line [9] tube bundle heat transfer to vertical upward and downward after turning foam flow. The main task of this work was to investigate experimentally and compare heat transfer intensity of two in-line tube bundles to vertical downward after 180º degree turning foam flow. The results of our experimental investigation are presented and discussed in this paper.
2
Experimental set-up
Two in-line tube bundles were used during the experimental investigation. A schematic view of the experimental channel with tube bundles is shown in Fig. 1. The in-line tube bundle No. 1 consisted of five vertical rows with six tubes in each (Figure 1a). Spacing between centres of the tubes was s1=s2=0.03 m. The in-line tube bundle No. 2 consisted of five vertical rows with three tubes in each (Figure 1b). Spacing between centres of the tubes across the experimental channel was s1=0.03 m and spacing along the channel was s2=0.06 m. External diameter of all the tubes was equal to 0.02 m. An electrically heated tube calorimeter had an external diameter equal to 0.02 m also. During the experiments the calorimeter replaced one tube of the bundle. An electric current value of the heated tube was measured by an ammeter and the voltage by a voltmeter. The temperature of the calorimeter surface was measured by eight calibrated thermocouples: six of them were placed around the central part of the tube and two of them were placed in both sides of the tube at a distance of 50 mm from the central part. The temperature of the foam flow was measured by two calibrated thermocouples: one in front of the bundle and one behind it.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
459
The experimental set-up consisted of the following main parts: experimental channel, tube bundle, gas and liquid control valves, gas and liquid flow meters, liquid storage reservoir, liquid level control reservoir, air fan, electric current transformer and stabilizer [7–9]. The cross section of the experimental channel had dimensions 0.14 x 0.14 m2; the height of it was 1.8 m. The radius (R) of the channel turning was equal to 0.17 m. Statically stable foam flow was used for an experimental investigation. This type of foam was generated from water solution of detergents. Concentration of detergents was kept constant and was equal to 0.5%. Foam flow was produced during gas and liquid contact on the riddle, which was installed at the bottom of the experimental channel. Liquid was delivered from the reservoir to the riddle from the upper side; gas was supplied to the riddle from below. Measurement accuracies for flows, temperatures and heat fluxes were in the ranges 1.5%, 0.15÷0.20% and 0.6÷6.0% correspondingly.
b)
B1
C1
A2
B2
C2
A3
B3
C3
A4
B4
C4
A5
B5
C5
A6
B6
C6
s1
D1
E1
F1
D2
E2
F2
D3
E3
F3
d
d
A1
s2
s1
s2
a)
Foam Figure 1:
Foam
In-line tube bundle No. 1 (a) and No. 2 (b) in downward foam flow.
During the experimental investigation a relationship was obtained between an average heat transfer coefficient h from one side and foam flow volumetric void fraction β and gas flow Reynolds number Reg from the other side: Nu f = f ( β , Re g ) . (1) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
460 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The Nusselt number was computed by the formula hd Nu f =
λf
(2)
where λf is the thermal conductivity of the statically stable foam flow, W/(m·K), computed by the equation λ f = βλ g + (1 − β )λl . (3) An average heat transfer coefficient was calculated as q h= w . ∆T The gas Reynolds number of foam flow was computed by the formula Gg d Re g = . Aν g
(4)
(5)
Foam flow volumetric void fraction can be expressed by the equation Gg β= . (6) G g + Gl Experiments were performed within Reynolds number diapason for gas (Reg): 190÷440 (laminar flow regime) and foam volumetric void fraction (β): 0.996÷0.998. Gas velocity for foam flow was changed from 0.14 to 0.32 m/s.
3
Results
After statically stable foam generation on the riddle the foam flow was directed vertically upward then made a 180° degree turn (radius of the turn was equal to 0.17 m) and moved downward crossing the tube bundle. Initially an experiments with in-line tube bundle No. 1 was performed; then the tube bundle No. 2 was placed instead of the previous bundle and experiments followed. Three main parameters of the foam flow influence the heat transfer intensity of different tubes of the bundles: foam structure, distribution of local flow velocity and distribution of local foam void fraction across and along the experimental channel. The liquid drainage process influence the distribution of the foam local void fraction and accordingly the heat transfer intensity of the tubes. Liquid drainage from foam phenomena depends on gravity and capillary. In a vertical direction these forces are acting together. In a horizontal direction the influence of gravity forces is negligible and the influence of capillary forces is dominating. Influence of the electrostatic and molecular forces on drainage is insignificant. Gravity forces act along the upward and downward foam flow. While foam flow makes a turn the gravity forces act across and along the foam flow. Liquid drains down from the upper channel wall and the local void fraction increases (foam becomes drier) here as well. After the turn, the local void fraction of foam is less (foam is wetter) on the inner-left side of the cross-section (tubes A and D, Fig. 1). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
461
Investigation with one-phase flow [1, 2] and our previous investigation with foam flow showed that heat transfer of the bundles’ third and further tubes varies insignificantly [7–9]. Comparison of heat transfer intensity of the A3, B3, C3 and D3, E3, F3 tubes of the in-line bundles to downward after turning foam flow at the volumetric void fraction β=0.997 is shown in Fig. 2. The heat transfer intensity of the third tubes of the in-line bundle No. 2 is higher than that of bundle No. 1. Increasing foam flow gas Reynolds number (Reg) from 190 to 440, heat transfer intensity (Nuf) of the tube A3 increases by 1.9 times (from 488 to 904), by 2.1 times (from 366 to 783) of the tube B3, and by 2.1 times (from 231 to 496) of the tube C3 for foam volumetric void fraction β=0.997. The heat transfer intensity of the tubes D3 for the same Reg increases by 1.8 times (from 637 to 1118), by 2.2 times (from 373 to 825) of the tube E3, and by 2.4 (from 252 to 617) of the tube F3 for β=0.997. When Reg=440 the heat transfer intensity of the A3 tube is higher than that of the tube C3 and the heat transfer intensity of the D3 tube is higher than that of the tube F3 by 1.8 times. The heat transfer intensity of the tube D3 is higher than that of the tube A3 on average by 26%, the heat transfer of the tube E3 is higher than that of the tube B3 on average by 4%, and the heat transfer of the tube F3 is higher than that of the tube C3 on average by 20% for β=0.997 and Reg=190÷440.
Nu f
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 F3
1000 800 600 400 200 0 150
Figure 2:
200
250
300
350
400
Re g
Heat transfer of the tubes A3, B3, C3 and D3, E3, F3 in downward foam flow, β=0.997.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
462 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Nu f 0.996 (No. 1) 0.997 (No. 1) 0.998 (No. 1) 0.996 (No. 2) 0.997 (No. 2) 0.998 (No. 2)
1200 1000 800 600 400 200 0 150
Figure 3:
200
250
300
350
400
Re g
Average heat transfer of the tubes of the in line bundle No. 1 and No. 2 to downward foam flow: β=0.996, 0.997 and 0.998.
An average heat transfer rate was calculated in order to analyse and compare the experimental results of different in-line tube bundles. The average heat transfer intensity of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 1 and No. 2 to downward after turning foam flow is shown in Fig. 3. The effect of a “shadow” takes place in the case of the in-line bundle No. 1 and the average heat transfer intensity of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 2 is higher than that of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 1 for the whole interval of Reg (Reg=190÷440). Changing Reg from 190 to 440, the average heat transfer intensity of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 1 to downward foam flow increases by 2.1 times for β=0.996; twice for β=0.997, and by 1.7 times for β=0.998; and that for the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 2 is by 2.4 times for β=0.996; by 2.1 times for β=0.997, and by 1.8 times for β=0.998. The average heat transfer intensity of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 2 is higher than that of the tubes of the in-line bundle No. 1 on average by 21% for β=0.996, by 23% for β =0.997 and by 27% for β=0.998 to downward foam flow for the whole interval of Reg (Reg=190÷440). Experimental results of investigation of heat transfer of the in-line tube bundles to downward after 180º turning statically stable foam flow were generalized by the criterion equation using the dependence between the Nusselt number Nuf and the gas Reynolds Reg number. This dependence within the interval 190
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII n
m
Nu f = cβ Re g .
463 (7)
On average, for the whole in-line tube bundle No. 1 (s1=s2=0.03 m) in the downward foam flow c=12.7, n=334, m=114.6(1.004–β). On average, for the whole in-line tube bundle No. 2 (s1=0.03 and s2=0.06 m) in the downward foam flow c=22.4, n=675, m=167.8(1.002–β).
4
Conclusions
Heat transfer of two in-line tube bundles with different geometry to vertical laminar downward statically stable foam flow was investigated experimentally. The liquid drainage process significantly transforms the “cross-sectional” distribution of the local void fraction of the downward foam flow and acts on the heat transfer intensity of the tubes. Therefore, the heat transfer intensity of the left (A and D) side-line tubes is higher than that of the middle (B and E) and right (C and F) side-line tubes. The effect of a “shadow” is slight and heat transfer is higher for the tubes of the in-line tube bundle with more spacing between the tube centres along the bundle. Results of the investigation were generalized by criterion equations, which can be used for the calculation and design of the statically stable foam heat exchangers with in-line tube bundles.
Nomenclature A – cross section area of experimental channel, m2; c, m, n – coefficients; d – outside diameter of tube, m; G – volumetric flow rate, m3/s; Nu– Nusselt number; q – heat flux density, W/m2; Re – Reynolds number; T – average temperature, K; h – average coefficient of heat transfer, W/(m2⋅K); β – volumetric void fraction; λ – thermal conductivity, W/(m⋅K); ν – kinematic viscosity, m2/s.
Indexes f –foam; g – gas; l – liquid; w – wall of heated tube.
References [1] [2]
Zukauskas A., Convectional Heat Transfer in Heat Exchangers, Nauka: Moscow, p. 472, 1982. Hewitt, G. F., Heat exchanger design handbook 2002, York, Begell House, 2002. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
464 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
[8]
[9]
Gylys, J., Hydrodynamics and Heat Transfer Under the Cellular Foam Systems, Technologija: Kaunas, 1998. Fournel B., Lemonnier H., Pouvreau J., Foam Drainage Characterization by Using Impedance Methods, 3rd Int. Symp. on Two-Phase Flow Modelling and Experimentation, Pisa, Italy, p. [1–7], 2004. Sadoc, J. F., Rivier, N., Foams and Emulsions, Nato ASI Series, 1997. Tichomirov V., Foams. Theory and Practice of Foam Generation and Destruction, Chimija: Moscow, 1983. Gylys J., Miliauskas G., Sinkunas S., Zdankus T., Influence of vertical foam flow liquid drainage on tube bundle heat transfer intensity, The Fourth International Conference on Heat Transfer, Fluid Mechanics and Thermodynamics, Cairo, Egypt, p. [1–6], 2005. Gylys J., Sinkunas S. and Zdankus T., Experimental Study of Staggered Tube Bundle Heat Transfer in Foam Flow, 5th International Symposium on Multiphase Flow, Heat Mass Transfer and Energy Conversion, Xi’an, China, p.[1–6], 2005. Gylys J., Giedraitis V., Sinkunas S., Zdankus T. and Gylys M., Study of in-line tube bundle heat transfer in upward vertical foam flow, Energy: production, distribution and conservation ASME conference, Milan, Italy, pp. 643-650, 2006.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
465
Importance of experimental measurements and simulations for “sludge-to-energy” systems L. Houdkova, J. Boran, T. Elsäßer & P. Stehlik Institute of Process and Environmental Engineering, Brno University of Technology (UPEI VUT), Czech Republic
Abstract It has recently been found that sewage sludge is a suitable and widely applicable alternative energy source which belongs to renewables. Several options for “sludge-to-energy” exploitation in sludge treatment sections of waste-water-treatment plants (WWTP) can be considered. Among the key factors influencing the choice of sludge treatment technology are the sludge heating value, its composition and specifically, the fraction of organic compounds. A crucial parameter in evaluation of mass and energy fluxes is the level of attainable de-watering, which depends on several factors which should be investigated. Thermal properties of sewage sludge belong among the most important input data for a calculation of characteristic parameters of a heat exchanger for sludge preheating. Results of measurements, performed in order to obtain the necessary data, are presented in this paper. Temperature dependences of the following sludge properties have been measured: dynamic viscosity, density and specific heat capacity for temperature range from 20°C to 50°C. Sludge samples were taken from two sewage plants which differ in the type of inlet waste water. The results of measurement are presented in diagrams. Temperature dependences of the above-mentioned quantities were measured for digested, mixed-raw and pasteurized sludge. Acquired data were used for preliminary assessment of heat exchanger “water-sludge”. This novel type of heat exchanger will be used for determining the influence of temperature on the degree of sewage sludge dewatering. For this specific task, a “made-to-measure” heat exchanger had to be designed. From the evaluated alternatives choices, a conception of a helical plate heat exchanger has been selected. The application of this heat exchanger and dependence of heat exchanger design on sludge properties are discussed. Keywords: sludge, heat capacity, density, dynamic viscosity. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070471
466 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
“Sludge-to-Energy” utilization
Sludge is created as a spin-off product during waste water clarification. After the sludge thickening stage at the waste water treatment plant the dry matter content of mixed raw sludge ranges from 5 % to 8 %. Figure 1: shows the layout of a typical waste water treatment plant. inlet
Preliminary Treatment Rain Spillway Basin
Activation Tank
Primary Settling Tank
Secondary Settling Tank
outlet
recycle sludge
primary sludge
excess sludge
mixed raw sludge
Figure 1:
Sludge Treatment
Sludge Utilisation
Flowsheet of waste water treatment plant (WWTP).
LHV [MJ/kg]
The most commonly used sludge treatment is stabilization in digesters and afterwards sludge dewatering. Using conventional means of dewatering, the dry matter content of digested sludge of about 25 % to 35 % is achieved. During digestion energy contained in the organic part of the sludge is converted into biogas. This leads to a reduction of lower heating value. Another possibility is to use dewatered mixed raw sludge for direct combustion. During this process not only the sludge stabilization, but also complete energy utilization is achieved. The most important parameter, as far as energy efficient sludge combustion is concerned, is the heating value which depends on the water content and the composition of the sludge respectively. In Figure 2: the dependence of a lower heating value on dry matter content of mixed raw sludge is shown. From this figure it is obvious that in order to increase a lower heating value the amount of water in the sludge needs to be reduced. 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 2 0 10
Figure 2:
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
Dry Matter Content [%]
Lower heating value vs. dry matter content for mixed raw sludge.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
467
In order to achieve the goal of sludge incineration without auxiliary fuel e.g. natural gas, advanced sludge treatment has to be carried out in order to raise the amount of dry matter content and thus to decrease the water content. Thus a selfreliant combustion as shown in Figure 4: is more likely to be performed and an improvement of its CO2 balance will come along with it. In case of self-reliant combustion, auxiliary fuel is necessary only to start up the combustion plant. To produce self-reliant combusting sludge, a dry matter content of 35% to 45% for mixed raw sludge and 45% to 55% for digested sludge has to be achieved by means of dewatering and potentially drying. It depends on the water distribution in the sludge and the kind of dewatering whether drying is necessary or not. In this connection it is necessary to be aware of the water distribution in the sludge. According to [1], the following types of water can be differed: • interspace water (can be removed by gravity thickening), • capillar water (can be removed by pressure filter or centrifuge), • adsorption and inner water (can be removed by thermal energy). Adsorption Water Inner Water
Interspace Water
Capillar Water
Figure 3:
Water distribution in sludge [1].
Removal of interspace and capillar water can be achieved by simple and cheap dewatering. The maximum degree of dewatering however depends on the amount of adsorption and inner water. Thus, to raise the dry matter content, treatment technique has to be selected that reduces the amount of adsorption and inner water. One possibility to increase the efficiency of the dewatering process and making drying dispensable is thermal disintegration which takes place before dewatering. Thermal disintegration can be categorized into three groups: • frozen conditioning below freezing point (no implementation known), • low thermal disintegration between 60°C and 80°C, • high thermal disintegration between 180°C and 230°C. Since high thermal disintegration is said to cause inhibitors, which could stop reactions within the waste water cleaning process [2], the low thermal disintegration was selected. In order to realize this process, in the first step a “made-to-measure” heat exchanger was designed which will preheat the sludge by means of hot water. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
468 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In recent measurements at a big WWTP a dry matter content of about 33% was achieved by dewatering of mixed raw sludge. This value is very close to the range of the dry matter content at which a self reliant combustion can be expected. Therefore a process with improved dewatering was designed, where the sludge is heated up, dewatered and afterwards combusted.
Figure 4:
Design of improved sludge combustion process.
This process could be situated directly at the waste water treatment plant where mixed raw sludge is heated up to approximately 55°C, centrifuged and afterwards combusted in a fluidized bed reactor or rotary kiln.
2
Measurements of thermophysical sludge properties
Physical properties of municipal sludge belong among the most important input data for design calculation of sludge preheater. Unfortunately, access to them in the open literature sources is not common. Municipal sludge physical properties, namely rheological properties, were previously discussed in several publications, but usually these works mentioned only digested (anaerobically stabilised) and/or activated sludge. Only very few studies, e.g. [3] deal with rheologic behaviour of primary waste water sludge, but none described the properties of mixed raw sludge. Also the temperature range, in which data were available, was insufficient. For these reasons, measurements of: • dynamic viscosity, • specific heat capacity, • density were carried out for temperatures from 20°C to 50°C. The sludge samples were taken from two different sewage plants with dissimilar characters of clarified waste water. The first one is a WWTP belonging to a city with population of approximately half a million inhabitants (WWTP 1). Further samples were taken WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
469
Shear Stress [N / m²]
from the WWTP which is operated to satisfy the demand of city with approximately 5% less inhabitants compared to the previous one (WWTP 2). In Figure 5: and 6 rheograms of mixed raw sludge from the above mentioned waste water treatment plants are shown. The comparison of these two figures outlines that sludge properties from different waste water treatment plants are not comparable. The shear stress of sludge has a big dependence on the temperature where as the shear stress decreases while temperature increases. Further, the viscosity of sludge is much higher than water and cannot be compared with water because sludge cannot be considered as Newtonian liquid. The specific heat capacity hardly depends on the temperature and can be compared with water in the first approach. Sludge density decreases with temperature. In comparison with water, sludge density is slightly higher and shows a bigger dependence on the temperature. More information about the measurement equipment, measurement procedure and more detailed values can be found in [4].
30
Temp=20.5°C DM=4.59%
25
Temp=30.2°C DM=4.31% Temp=39.0°C DM=4.58%
20
Temp=50.0°C DM=4.54%
15
10
5
0 0
200
400
600
800
1000
1200
-1
Shear Rate [s ]
Figure 5:
Shear stress vs. shear rate (sludge from WWTP 1). Temp=21.0°C DM=3.00% Temp=30.2°C DM=3.00% Temp=40.0°C DM=2.95%
14
Shear Stress [N / m²]
12 10
Temp=50.0°C DM=2.94%
8 6 4 2 0 0
Figure 6:
200
400
600
800
-1
Shear Rate [s ]
1000
1200
Shear stress vs. shear rate (sludge from WWTP 2).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
470 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Description of heat exchanger design
The “made-to-measure” heat exchanger had to meet the following requirements: • small built-up area, • large heat transfer area, • easy maintenance, • easy to clean on the sludge side. Sludge from municipal waste water treatment plants is a non-Newtonian, adhesive suspension and treatment of sludge in a heat exchanger is problematic. For this reason emphasis was made on the easy maintenance and cleaning on the sludge side. To meet the requirements, a helical plate heat exchanger was designed. Figure 7 shows a heat exchange surface of a helical plate heat exchanger. It is a doublethreaded helix with a rectangular profile. The helix is wound around the central pipe and is divided into an open and closed part. The bending shape of the canal has a positive influence on its self-cleaning abilities. Through the close part of the helix, water is pumped bottom-up. In order to reduce the gravimetric part of pressure drop, sludge flows top-down. Since the sludge flows through the open part of the helix, the helix can be taken out of the exchanger shell and the area of heat exchange on the side of the sludge can be easily cleaned.
Figure 7:
Novel design of “water-sludge” heat exchanger.
The course of development of a heat exchanger for “water-sludge” applications started with analytic calculations. General equations for heat balancing and heat transfer are used similarly as in the design of any other heat exchanger. However, the novel geometry required new equations for heat transfer coefficient (α) and pressure drop (∆p) calculations. Suitable equations have not been found in the literature and so it was necessary to consider geometric and hydraulic similarity with other, mostly conventional heat exchanger types. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
471
The derivation of model equations for the new helical plate heat exchanger was based on the fact that both media flow through rectangular cross-sections as in plate-type heat exchangers, but with curvature, which is known from helical tubes. Therefore, model equations for the following heat exchangers have been considered: A heat exchanger with helical tubes [5] (instead of pipe diameter d was used hydraulic diameter dh); plate-type heat exchanger with smooth plates – expression derived using data published in [6]; plate-type heat exchanger with smooth plates and correction for curvature [7]. The derivation of model equations was done using several simplifying assumptions. These included the following: sludge was considered to be a Newtonian fluid, leakage stream of sludge between the exchanger shell and the water channel is negligible (the small dilatation gap is assumed blocked by highly viscous sludge), and width (radial dimension) of both channels is assumed equal. In the first step, the properties of sludge were only theoretically determined by amending properties of water. The values were amended to be less advantageous for heat exchanger operation. After taking into account the measured properties of sludge (specific heat capacity, dynamic viscosity and density) the laminar flow in the sludge duct was identified and consequently had a very low heat transfer coefficient. In order to obtain the necessary outlet sludge temperature, the area of heat exchange had to be increased. For this reason the calculated height of the heat exchanger became practically unfeasible. The preliminary model equations derived for the thermal and hydraulic calculation of the new helical plate heat exchanger and their detailed description may be found in [8]. After the dimension modifications a technically and economically feasible model was found. This model is shown in Figure 8:. The main modification of heat exchanger design was made in diameter of the central tube. The diameter was increased as well as the heat exchange surface. In order to evaluate the accuracy of the obtained model, the next task was to analyze the model in CFD [9]. Thus the helix of the heat exchanger was modeled in FLUENT V6 and the accuracy of the mathematical model was verified for fluid velocities, pressure drop and temperature distribution. Flow field analysis led to the conclusion that in the hot stream (water) turbulent flow takes place compared to the cold stream (sludge), where the flow is laminar. The thermal and hydraulic analysis of the heat exchanger required design calculation without including the effects of fouling. This has not been considered in the detailed CFD model. The temperature difference between the sludge outlet and inlet temperatures and water inlet and outlet temperatures was 41 °C and 11 °C, respectively, provided fouling was neglected. The CFD model predicted a temperature difference between sludge outlet and inlet temperatures and water inlet and outlet temperatures that was 48 °C and 13 °C, respectively. The disagreement can be readily explained as follows. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
472 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 8:
Figure 9:
Improved design of water-sludge heat exchanger.
Thermal and hydraulic analysis of the heat exchanger.
Due to the water stream being fully turbulent and sludge stream laminar, even a small error in Nusselt number value for the sludge stream has a strong influence on the overall heat transfer rate (and on the outlet temperatures). Pressure drops were also compared, and a large difference between analytical equations and the CFD models was observed. It is expected that the CFD predictions are more realistic due to a detailed description of flow, but no attempt to modify the equations for pressure drop calculation has been done with
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
473
a view to the results obtained for the finest grid in the preliminary study. It is probable that pressure drop predicted using the standard wall function approach is less reliable than the results of the two-layer approach. It is vitally important to measure all parameters including pressure drop on a pilot-scale facility which will be available in the near future. Measured data will be used for validation of a CFD model as well as for introducing correction factors into thermal and hydraulic calculations.
4
Conclusion
The analytical model was based on commonly used equations for heat exchanger calculations. Expressions for Nusselt number and friction factor were adopted considering similarity with other heat exchanger types. Sludge properties (composition, thermo physical properties) are the most important input data for novel heat exchanger design calculations as well as for preparing heat balance of sludge incineration. The properties of sludge from a certain plant can be quite different compared to those coming from another. Knowledge of thermophysical sludge properties is essential for the basic design of a heat exchanger. Therefore, measurements of specific heat capacity, density and dynamic viscosity of the sludge are necessary from specific waste water treatment plants. The analytical model for design calculations of the heat exchanger was compared with numerical simulation using CFD. Analysis of results shows relatively good agreement of the design model with CFD computations. Based on the comparison, a correction for Nusselt number in the sludge stream was proposed. Pressure drops predicted by the analytical model using non-validated equations are significantly higher (almost twice) than those, predicted by CFD. Due to lower reliability of the pressure drops prediction by CFD (demonstrated on a very fine grid in the tests), it was concluded that corresponding correction of the design equations is not desirable. In order to outline these results, measurements on a pilot-scale heat exchanger will provide real data which will be compared with the calculation results. Based on this comparison the analytic expressions will be corrected and used for further heat exchanger design.
Acknowledgement We gratefully acknowledge financial support of the Ministry of Education, youth and sports of the Czech Republic within the framework of research plan No. MSM 0021630502 "Waste and Biomass Utilization focused on Environment Protection and Energy Generation".
References [1]
Batel W.; Menge und Verhalten der Zwischenraumflüssigkeit in körnigen Stoffen; Chemie-Ingenier-Technik 1961 Nr. 3 WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
474 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
[9] [10] [11] [12]
[13] [14] [15] [16] [17]
Dritter Arbeitsbericht der ATV/DVWK Arbeitsgruppe “Klärschlammdisintegration“ Bhattacharya S. N., 1981, Flow characteristics of primary and digested sewage sludge, Rheologica Acta 20, pp. 288-298. Elsäßer, T.; et al.; Thermal dependences of physical aspects of sewage sludge; proceeding on CD-Rom, PRES 2006, Prague Verein Deutscher Ingenieure, Wärmeatlas, VDI – Verlag GmbH, Düsseldorf (1987) Kays W. M., London A. L., Compact Heat Exchangers, McGraw-Hill Book Company, New York (1984) Chapman A.J., 1989, Heat Transfer, Macmillan Publishing Company, New York Kilkovský, B.; et al.; Research and Development of Heat Exchangers “Water-Sludge”, 9th Conference on Process Integration, Modelling and Optimisation for Energy Saving and Pollution Reduction Pres 2006, Proceedings on CD-ROM, Prague, Czech Republic Piskovsky, M.; Analysis of helical heat Exchange water–sludge by CFD; Heat SET 2007; Accepted for publication Houdkova, L.; et al.; Impact of Sewage Sludge Dewatering on Economic and Environmental Balance of High Capacity Waste Water Treatment Plant; PRES 2006 Boráň J., Houdková L., Stehlík P., 2005a, Waste as alternative fuel. First International Conference on Thermal Treatment and Resource Utilization of Wastes. Beijing, China, pp. 179-185. Boráň J., Houdková L., Ucekaj V., Šťasta P., Stehlík P., 2005b, The Analysis of Energy Utilization in Processes for Sewage Sludge Treatment. 8th Conference on Process Integration, Modelling and Optimisation for Energy Saving and Pollution Reduction. Milano, Italy: AIDIC, pp. 139144. ISBN: 88-900775-8-1. FLUENT 6.3.26, 2006, User`s Guide, Fluent Inc., Lebanon, USA Hewit G.F. (ed.), 1998, Heat Exchanger Design Handbook, Begell House, Inc., New York Hewit G.F. (ed.), Heat Exchanger Design Handbook 1998, Begell House, Inc., New York (1998) Smith E. M., Thermal Design of Heat Exchangers, John Wiley & Sons, Chichester (1997) Stulir R., Stehlik P. and Oral J., 2003, Efficient Equipment with Special Heat Exchanger for Thermal Treatment of Polluted Air – Experiments, Computations, Applications, Heat Transfer Engineering, 24, pp. 60 – 69
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
475
Simulation of thermal barrier coating behaviour during dynamic thermal loading by the Exodus method J. Sroub, M. Honner & Z. Vesely Department of Physics, University of West Bohemia, Univerzitni 22, 306 14 Plzen, Czech Republic
Abstract This paper deals with the application of the stochastic Exodus method in simulation of the heat transfer processes in the multi-layer structure of thermal barrier coating. A 2D computer simulation model of thermal barrier behaviour during its dynamic thermal loading is presented. The Exodus stochastic simulation method has been applied to solve the indirect thermal problem in order to determine TBC surface temperature and heat flux from the temperatures measured inside the sample. Comparison of the computer results with the result of the thermography measurement is presented to show capabilities of the simulation model. Keywords: Exodus simulation method, computer modelling, thermal barrier coatings, thermography measurement.
1
Introduction
Thermal barriers protect material of machine parts against high temperatures and thermal shocks. Thermal barriers usually represent a heterogeneous multilayer coating deposited on the surface of thermally loaded machine parts those temperature should be decreased. The Exodus method [1], which is a modification of the Monte Carlo method [2], has been used, in order to determine the transient state distribution of barrier dynamic behaviour during thermal shocks in this paper. From the physical point of view, it concerns the problem of a non-stationary heat distribution in a structured system involving several thin layers of thermal barrier [3] and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070481
476 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII substrate. Thermal barrier usually consists of the top ceramic layer, the additional layer and the bond coat. Thermal properties of these layers are essentially different. Dynamical loadings of TBCs [4] by a thermal spray gun hot exhaust gases to simulate periodic short-term thermal shocks belong to TBC performance tests. Temperature inside the sample is measured by thermocouples, surface temperature distribution is measured by IR thermography. The problem of heat transfer in the thin layer structure of thermal barrier has been solved by means of various methods [5, 6]. So far, no attention has been paid to the practical possibilities of solving the problem by the application of probabilistic methods. Nevertheless the stochastic methods have some advantages in determination of surface temperatures and heat fluxes as a measure of TBC quality. As direct measurement of surface temperature and heat flux during the TBC tests is difficult, an indirect thermal problem is solved based on the temperatures measured inside the sample volume.
2
Thermal barriers and their tests
2.1 Thermal barrier coatings The thermal barrier structure [6] is given by the technological and operational requirements. The top ceramic layer, usually ZrO2, must have high thermal resistivity, sufficient reflectance for infrared radiation and must satisfy stress and strain conditions. The thickness of the ceramic layer usually ranges from 100 to 500 µm. The bond coat must offer fair tolerance against high temperature corrosion and oxidation. Further, the bond coat helps binding the ceramic layer to the substrate and helps accommodating the mechanical deformation caused by different coefficients of thermal expansion and modulus of elasticity for the ceramic layer and the substrate. The bond coat thickness ranges from 100 to 300 µm. The additional layer, made of Al2O3, has usually the thickness roughly from 1 to 5 µm. This layer represents a diffusion barrier that decreases oxidation of the bond coat and the underlaying substrate. The thermal conductivity of the ceramic layer is usually about one order lower than of the substrate representing high thermal resistance on the surface. The high thermal resistance decreases the effect of high temperatures and temperatures shocks on the surface. The effect of thickness, porosity and thermomechanical properties of each layer to the dynamic behaviour of the thermal barrier are the important questions to be solved during the TBC design. The dynamic behaviour is characterized by the temperature, temperature gradient, heat flux, thermally induced stress and strain, especially at the interface between the individual layers. 2.2 TBC dynamic tests and measurement The thermal barrier sample has been thermally loaded by cyclic passing of torch over the surface (fig. 1). Torch-sample distance 120 mm and torch velocity 3.0 m min-1 have been used. Torch passed over the sample in its centre. During WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
477
some part of the cycle time period the torch moves over the sample surface (heating time) and during the rest of the cycle it moves away from the sample to the dead point (cooling time). The number of 40 cycles has been used.
Figure 1:
Experimental setup of TBC dynamic thermal loading tests. Zr2O3 Nim 90 TC1 TS1
TC2 TS2 TTC2
TC3 TS3 TTC3
TTC1
TC4 TS4 TTC4
TC5 TS5
TC6 TS6 TTC-7
TTC5
TTC6 Steel 15330
Figure 2:
Position of measured and computed temperatures inside the sample.
Temperatures inside the sample have been measured by the built-in thermocouples. Six thermocouples (TC1 – TC6) were in the substrate in various depths under the surface and one (TC7) was on barrier-substrate interface (fig. 2). The process of the sample thermal loading has been monitored by a digital infra-red camera. The recorded data have been used for the analysis of sample surface temperature distribution during the torch motion. Table 1:
Real thickness of thermal barrier layers. Layer Steel 15330 ZrO2 Nim 90
Thickness 20 mm 0.192 mm 0.162 mm
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
478 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 2:
Real depth of thermocouples under surface.
Thermocouples TC1 TC2 TC3 TC4 TC5 TC6
Depth 3.7 mm 2.0 mm 0.8 mm 1.4 mm 2.7 mm 4.3 mm
3 Theory 3.1 Mathematical model The model has been designed to simulate reaction of the TBC-substrate structure during thermal shock. Perfect contact between individual layers of the thermal barrier and substrate is supposed. Non-stationary heat conduction in individual layers of the thermal barrier and the substrate is assumed by the heat transfer equation. Thermal loading effect of the moving torch is simulated as a heat flux boundary condition on the TBC surface. 3.2 The Application of the Exodus method The theoretical background for the Exodus method [1] is presented in [7, 8]. We specifically apply the method to the heat transfer equation in rectangular solution region. We use a 2D simulation model.
Obtain the random walk probabilities
Figure 3:
Calculating the transitional probabilities
Determine the temperatures
Scheme of solving a problem by the Exodus method.
To apply the Exodus method in finding the solution it usually involves the following three steps [9] as we can see in fig. 3: 1) First, the random walk probabilities are obtained from the finite difference equivalent of the partial differential equation describing the problem. 2) Second, the Exodus method is used along with the random walk probabilities in calculating the transition probabilities. 3) Finally, the temperature at the point of interest is determined from the transition probabilities and the boundary conditions. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII part of surface
479
measuring point
barrier
Figure 4:
Computing mesh with distinguished input nodes and parts of surface.
The Exodus method solving indirect problem can determine only the same number of unknown temperature evolutions as the number of input temperature evolutions. Thus we split the surface to parts, corresponding to measuring points (fig. 4). Temperature and heat flux are evaluated for each part of surface. 3.2.1 Determining heat flux Heat flux on the surface is determined from the temperature difference on the surface and in some depth δ, for example 10-5 m, below the surface. First, temperature is set on the normal mesh and further on the mesh, where the surface nodes are shifted as we can view on fig. 5. Tp(t)
Tδ(t)
x
δ
Figure 5:
Schema of computing heat flux.
Heat flux is computed from this equation
q = (Tp (t ) − Tδ (t ) )⋅ λ ⋅ δ −1
.
(1)
3.3 Computer simulation The presented computer simulation model is built to solve the indirect problem of the determination of temperature and heat flux intensities on the surface of the coated material. Inputs of the model there are the time evolution of temperature measured in six internal nodes and initial temperature, as outputs there are time evolution of surface temperature and surface heat flux. The original measured WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
480 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII temperatures are processed in order to remove noise because during solving the indirect problem a small signal noise causes a big noise in the output. The input temperature time evolutions can be seen in fig. 6. 120 110
TTC1
TTC2
TTC3
100
TTC4
TTC5
TTC6
90
TTC7
T (° C)
80 70 60 50 40 30 20
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
t (s)
Figure 6:
Input temperature time evolutions from thermocouples.
Thermophysical material properties and thickness of layers used in calculation are listed in Table 1 and Table 3. Sample is embedded thermocouples in various depths. The real depths of thermocouples are shown in table 2. Table 3:
Material properties of thermal barrier layers.
Thermal conductivity (W m-1 K-1) Thermal capacity (J kg-1 K-1) Density (kg m-3)
ZrO2
Nim 90
Steel 15330
1.6067
12.5148
40.0475
488.9739 5645
278.3659 8254.4
430.9387 7806.9
The temperature time evolutions determined by the Exodus method as the result of the inverse problem are used as the boundary condition in the FEM model based on the COSMOS/M system. Then we solve direct problem of heat propagation in multilayer TBC. Results of this model are compared with the measured temperatures.
4
Results
4.1 Simulations of TBC behaviour The Exodus stochastic simulation method has been used to determine the intensity of heat transfer to surface during the first pass of the torch over the sample surface. The corresponding temperature evolution from embedded thermocouples at various depths under the substrate surface is shown in figure 6. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
481
TC2
TC3
TC4
qC2
qC3
qC4
130
0.0
120
-0.5
110
-1.0
100
-1.5
90
-2.0 -2.5
70
5
T (° C)
80
-3.0
60 50
-3.5
40
-4.0
30
-4.5
20
-2
coating surface
q ( x 10 W.m )
The resultant values of temperatures on the TBC surface and heat fluxes to the barrier are shown on fig. 7. Temperature time evolution on coatings-substrate boundary and heat transfer intensity to the substrate are plotted in fig. 8.
-5.0 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
t (s)
Time evolutions of temperatures and heat fluxes on TBC surface. TS3
TS4
qS2
qS3
qS4
80
0.0
75
-0.5
70
-1.0
65
-1.5
60
-2.0
55
-2.5
50
-3.0
45
-3.5
40
-4.0
35
-4.5
-2
TS2
5
T (° C)
substrate surface
q ( x 10 W.m )
Figure 7:
30
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
-5.0
t (s)
Figure 8:
Time evolutions of temperatures and heat fluxes on coatingssubstrate interface.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
482 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Maximum temperature 120 °C was reached in the first pass on the coating surface, which is the increase about 88 °C above the initial temperature 32 °C. The maximum heat flux to the thermal barrier surface is 4.5·105 W m-2. The maximum temperature on the coating-substrate boundary is 80 °C in the first pass. The maximum heat flux to the substrate is 4.2·105 W m-2. The maximum of heat flux is reached before the maximum of temperature. The value of heat flux to the substrate is slightly smaller then to the coating, because a fraction of heat applied to heating up the TBC material. The maximum of temperature on the coating-substrate interface is smaller then on the coating surface, about two-thirds of the value on the coating surface. 4.2 Comparison with measurement Comparison of the computed time evolution of temperature on the TBC surface with the measurement provided by IR camera is shown in fig. 9. There is a good agreement considering the temperature between peaks. Differences can be found in peaks where the maximum of measured temperatures is greater than computing one. This difference is caused either especially caused by a 2D model geometry which neglects the heat transfer to the lateral sides and either by the measurement error (effect of torch combustion gas radiation, about a quarter of the difference). The second comparison confronts the temperature time evolution on the barrier-substrate interface with the measured temperature from TC7. The maximum temperature of TTC7 was 80.5 °C. The temperature on the barriersubstrate interface computed by the Exodus method achieved maximum from 75 to 80 °C. thermo
exodus:
195
200
TC2
TC3
TC4
650
T (° C)
600 550 500 450 400 190
205
210
215
220
t (s)
Figure 9:
Comparison of computed temperature time evolutions on surface with thermography measurement by IR camera.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
483
4.3 Comparison with FEM model Results provided by the Exodus method have been also compared with results obtained by the finite element method. The FEM model based on the COSMOS/M FEA system used the results of the inverse problem computed by the Exodus method as the boundary conditions. Heat propagation in the multilayer sample is solved as a direct problem and temperature time evolutions in measured points are compared with the original measured temperature evolutions. The comparison can be seen in Fig. 10, the differences between the measured and computed temperature in maximum are less then 5 °C in the first pass. 110 meas. TTC2
comp. T2
90
TTC3
T3
80
TTC4
T4
100
T (° C)
70 60 50 40 30 20
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
t (s)
Figure 10:
5
Comparison of measured temperature time evolutions with computed temperatures by FEM model.
Conclusion
The simulation model of the thermal barrier sample has been created. The experimentally obtained temperature evolutions at various depths and locations in the sample were used to find the heat transfer to the surface during thermal loading. The Exodus method provides a relatively straightforward means of solving indirect problems. The method has been illustrated with typical problem of heat transfer in inhomogeneous solution region.
Acknowledgement This paper is based upon work sponsored by the Ministry of Education, Youth and Sports of Czech Republic under research project no. MSM 4977751302. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
484 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
[5] [6]
[7] [8] [9]
Emery, A.F. & Carson, W. W., A Modification to the Monte Carlo Method – The Exodus Method, Journal of Heat Transfer, 90, pp. 328– 332, 1968. Haji-Sheikh, A., The Monte Carlo method, Handbook of Numerical Heat Transfer, eds. Minkowycz, W. J., Sparrow, E. M., Schneider, G. E. & Pletcher, R. H., pp. 673−722, 1988. Kunes, J. & Vesely, Z., Numerical solution of the thermomechanical processes in the thin layer structure of thermal barrier. Computer Assisted Mechanics and Engineering Sciences, 7(2), pp.207–218, 2000. Vesely, Z., Kunes, J., Honner, M. & Martan, J., TB dynamic behaviour during thermal shocks - simulation and experiment, Advanced Computational Methods in Heat Transfer – Heat Transfer VII, WIT Press, pp. 503–512, 2002. Kunes, J., Vesely, Z. & Honner, M., Tepelne bariery. Academia, Praha, 2003. Vesely, Z., Honner, M. & Kunes, J., Analyses of thermal barrier dynamic behaviour. Thermal Stresses, proceedings of the 5th International Congress on Thermal Stresses and Related Topics, TS2003, 8-11 June 2003, Blacksburn, VA. Honner, M., Vesely, Z. & Svantner, M., Exodus stochastic method application in the continuous reheating furnace control system. Scandinavian Journal of Metallurgy. 2004, 33(6), pp. 328–337. Sroub, J. & Honner, M., Solution of Inverse Transient Heat Transfer Problem by the Exodus Method, Inverse Problem (submitted). Sadiku, M. N. O. & Hunt, D. T., Solution of Dirichlet Problems by the Exodus Method, IEEE Transactions on microwave theory and techniques, 40(1), January, 1992.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
485
Forced convection in a variable section axisymmetric channel with different porous layers and heat generation E. Pilevne & A. Misirlioglu Faculty of Aeronautics and Astronautics, Istanbul Technical University, Maslak, 34469, Istanbul, Turkey
Abstract In the present study, the forced convection in an axisymmetric channel has been investigated numerically. The channel, which contains different porous layers, has variable cross sectional areas along the axis. The governing equations for non-Darcy porous media are solved for the uniform inlet velocity profile and uniform inlet temperature. The walls are kept at a constant temperature. The porous medium at the middle of the channel has internal heat generation. This kind of solution domain is aimed to model the phenomena in the porous burners. The finite element method is employed to solve the governing equations. First, the code is compared for the fully developed flow in the parallel channel. For this purpose the maximum velocities at the channel axis and the Nusselt numbers at the wall are compared with the literature. Having obtained the validated results for the code, it is applied to the problem described above. The results will be presented in terms of velocity and temperature profiles. Keywords: porous layers, forced convection, FEM.
1
Introduction
Applications of porous media in engineering have constantly been growing in last two decades. In particular, the heat transfer characteristics of the porous medium is of high importance due to the applications in, for example, heat exchangers, transport of heated or cooled fluids, micro-electronic cooling, chemical processing equipment, and porous burners, etc. Apart from the conventional burners, porous media burners provide many advantages in especially industrial applications. Within this technology it is able to build more WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070491
486 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII basic combustion chamber configurations and the size of the porous burner can be diminished by approximately 10% compared to burners with conventional shapes. In addition, low emission rates and constitution of stable combustion have lately been making this technology more desirable. The porous burners consist of three porous layers with different Péclet numbers. The main purpose of using different layers is to control the heat transfer. The aim of the first porous layer is having a uniform velocity profile before the ignition phase. The ignition process is carried out by the second layer. Within the third layer flame propagation is established. Research and development on combustion in porous media started to grow in last two decades. Trimis [1] showed that porous media can be very useful within many applications in energy and heat-engineering. Bassam and Abu-Hijleh [2] studied heat transfer from a 2D backward facing step with different porous segments and also they analyzed the effect of these layers on local and overall Nusselt numbers. Furthermore, Nield et al. [3] examined the interaction of two porous layers with the same porosity and permeability but different thermal conductivity effects in forced convection. Nemoda et al. [4] simulated a porous burner and surface burner numerically with different heat conductivity and power of burners. Another studies are the effects of material and radiative properties on flame stabilization in a porous burners [5, 6]. Mishra et al. analyzed the heat transfer of a radiant porous burner [7]. The main purpose of this paper is to investigate the effect of Peclet number and permeability on the heat transfer in forced convection. The geometry is designed as having variable cross sections and axisymmetric. The wall is kept at constant temperatures. The numerical model is obtained using Navier-Stokes with modified Darcy’s law. The Galerkin Finite Elements method is applied to solve the governing equations. A source term is added into the energy equation in order to simulate the heat generation in the porous layer.
2 Formulation The solution domain and the boundary conditions are shown in Figure 1, where the uniform flow enters into the axisymmetric duct with variable section radius, and with different properties. The inlet and expansion regions are considered as filled with clear fluid. Then the flow passes thru porous layers of 3 different permeabilities. The middle porous section has heat generation inside. The governing equations written in terms of the volume averaged intrinsic velocities, for uniform property distribution in each section, are [8]: Continuity ∇⋅u = 0 (1) Momentum Du 1 2 ε (2) = −∇p + ∇ u− u Dt Re ReDa i Energy Dθ 1 (3) = ∇ 2θ + λ Dt Pe i
[
]
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
487
Solution domain and boundary conditions.
The derivative operators in these equations are evaluated in polar coordinates. The following parameters are used to obtain the above dimensionless governing equations: u = u /U∞ x=x/R y= y/R t = (U ∞ / R ) t
θ = (T − TW ) / ∆T
∆T = q m' ' ' R 2 / k m
where TW is wall temperature, R is the channel radius at inlet, U∞ is the inlet velocity. In these equations, Dai and Pei are the Darcy and Peclet numbers of the clear fluid and porous insert regions defined as K Da i = 2i Pe i = Re Pri i = 1, number of regions R where Ki’s are the permeabilities of each porous insert, Re is the Reynolds number based on the uniform inlet velocity and the inlet radius, Pri’s are the Prandtl numbers for each region. λ takes the value of 1 if there is heat source in the region, otherwise zero. The flow in the channel is driven by the uniform inlet velocity profile. At the exit of the channel the flow is assumed to be parallel, and at the duct wall no−slip condition is applied. The temperatures are assumed to be equal at the inlet and the duct wall. Symmetry and exit conditions are imposed on the proper boundaries.
3
Numerical treatment
Galerkin Finite Element method is employed to solve the governing equations (1)–(3) subjected to the given boundary conditions. The Fractional Step method is used for the time integration and for the calculation of pressure, based on the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
488 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII technique suggested by Kovacs and Kawahara [11]. The solution domain of 4 different types of region is evaluated as a single domain. Property changes for the regions are included at the element level and the interface nodes are interpolated as other properties by the finite element method itself. By doing this, there is no need to impose any compatibility boundary condition on the interfaces of neighbouring regions. The temperature distribution is observed at consecutive time steps to check if the solution has reached to the steady state or not.
4
Results
Nu
There are four different types of region and each of them has been defined in calculations with different Péclet and Darcy numbers. The Reynolds number is taken as 100. The Péclet number is held in the first porous layer 50. For the following layers it is taken 65 and 70. There are 4000 points in the solution domain. The grid size varies 0.02 near the walls and expands to 0.1 in the midsection of the channel. Time step is chosen 0.001 to satisfy a stable solution. The code used in the present study is validated with the results of Vafai and Kim [10] for fully developed flow in parallel channel in terms of velocity profile and with Kaviany [8] for the Nusselt numbers. As seen in Figure 2, the results are in perfect agreement with the literature.
Figure 2:
Comparison of the velocity profile (left) for Da=10-2 and Nusselt numbers (right) obtained for a parallel channel.
Obtaining validated results the code is employed to the problem specified before for 3 different cases. • •
Case 1: the duct is filled with clear fluid, no porous region exists Case 2: the duct has clear fluid region at the entrance and expansion regions, and the rest of the duct is filled with porous media with the same permeability for Darcy number of 10-4.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
•
489
Case 3: the porous media in Case 3 has been divided into 3 regions with different permeabilities corresponding to Darcy numbers which are 10−3, 10−4, 10−5 in order.
The results for these cases are presented in exit velocity and temperature profiles (Figure 3), and temperature at the axis (Figure 4), streamlines (Figure 5), and temperature contours (Figure 6).
Figure 3:
Velocity (left) and temperature (right) profiles at the exit for all cases.
Figure 4:
Temperature along the axis of the duct.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
490 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 5:
Streamlines for all cases.
In Figure 3 the effect of the porous media is clearly seen by the uniformity of the velocity distribution at the exit. This also affects the temperature distribution at the exit, and makes it more uniform. For Cases 2 and 3 although there is a negligible difference in the velocity profiles, the difference in temperature profiles is much clearer. Using different permeabilities provide more heat to discharge from the domain. Another aspect is the increment of the temperature along the symmetry axis, as seen in Figure 4. The porous media in Cases 2 and 3 provides higher temperature increments.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
491
The main reason of differences between Case 1 and Cases 2 and 3 can be clearly seen in the flow and thermal fields in Figures 5 and 6. As seen in Figure 5 the flow in Case 1 separates after the expansion region, and makes a big bubble. This bubble prevents the heat generated in the duct to convect downstream. Thus a hot spot is formed in the duct as seen in Figure 6. But this kind of structure is not seen in the Cases 2 and 3. Prevention of flow separation provides better thermal distribution in the channel. The separation bubbles in case 2 and 3 have been formed in the expansion region, where no heat generation exists, and no separation region reaches to the porous layers.
Figure 6:
Temperature contours for all cases.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
492 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Conclusion
The flow and heat character of an axisymmetric channel with variable cross sections has been investigated numerically. The effect of the porous media has been shown in terms of temperature and flow field variables. The porous medium has a stabilizing effect on the thermal structure, which results in more heat being discharged from the duct. When there is no porous medium in the channel the separation prevents the heat from to convecting in the channel. This effect can easily be removed by aerodynamic improvement of the channel inlet and expansion regions. For uniform permeability distribution (Case 2) in the channel and variable permeability distribution there is little change in the channel in terms of flow characteristics. However the thermal character changes and Case 3 provides better temperature distribution.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
[6] [7]
[8] [9]
Trimis D., Stabilized Combustion in Porus-Media-Applications of the Porous Burner Technology in Energy- and Heat-Engineering, Fluids 2000 Conference and Exhibit, Denver Bassam A., K. Abu-Hijleh, Heat transfer from a 2D backward facing step with isotropic porous floor segments, Int. J. Heat and Mass Transfer, 43, pp. 2727-2737, 2000. Nield, D.A., Kuznetsov, A.V., Xiong, M., Effect of heterogeneity in forced convection in a porous medium: parallel plate channel or circular duct, Int. J. Heat and Mass Transfer, 43, pp. 4119−4134, 2000. Stevan Nemoda, Dimosthenis Trimis, Goran Zivkovic, Numerical Simulation Of Porous Burners And Hole Plate Surface Burners, Thermal Science: 8(1), pp. 3-17, 2004 Amanda J. Barraa, Guillaume Diepvensa, Janet L. Ellzeya, Michael R. Henneke, Numerical study of the effects of material properties on flame stabilization in a porous burner, Combustion and Flame 134, pp. 369–379, 2003. Isabel Malico, Jose Carlos F. Pereira, Numerical Study on the Influence of Radiative Properties in Porous Media Combustion, Journal of Heat Transfer, Vol. 123, pp. 951−957 S.C. Mishra, M. Steven, S. Nemoda, P. Talukdar, D. Trimis, F. Durst, Heat transfer analysis of a two-dimensional rectangular porous radiant burner, International Communications in Heat and Mass Transfer 33, pp. 467–474, 2006 Kaviany, M., Laminar flow through a porous channel bounded by isothermal parallel plates, Int. J. Heat and Mass Transfer, 28, pp. 851−858, 1985. Saeid H. N., Analysis of mixed convection in a vertical porous layer using non-equilibrium model, Int. J. Heat and Mass Transfer, 47, pp. 56195627, 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[10] [11]
493
Vafai K., Kim S.J., Forced Convection in a channel filled with a porous medium: An exact solution, Journal of Heat Transfer, 111, pp. 11031106, 1989 A. Kovacs, M. Kawahara, A Finite element scheme based on the velocity correction method for the solution of the time-dependent incompressible Navier−Stokes equations, Int. J. Numer. Methods Fluids, 13, pp. 403−423, 1991.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
495
Comparison of h-, p- and hp-adaptation for convective heat transfer D. W. Pepper & X. Wang Nevada Center for Advanced Computational Methods, University of Nevada Las Vegas, USA
Abstract Three adaptive FEM algorithms based on mesh refinement (h-adaptation), mesh enrichment (p-adaptation) and the combination of both (hp-adaptation) are employed to solve incompressible fluid flow problems including convective heat transfer effects. Test cases of natural convection in a square cavity with different Rayleigh numbers are solved using primitive variables in a modified finite element approach employing the three adaptive strategies. Results show excellent agreement among benchmark data available in the literature. Keywords: h-, p-, hp- adaptation, FEM, natural convection.
1
Introduction
The finite element method (FEM) is a popular numerical tool used in many heat transfer and fluid flow simulations. The FEM is capable of easily dealing with irregular geometries and has the ability to implement enhanced accuracy using general-purpose algorithms. Adaptive FEM is especially attractive since it can dynamically control mesh characteristics to obtain desired accuracy. Following early work using h-adaptive FEM to accurately capture shock waves in compressible flow [1], the adaptive FEM has become an active research area over the past decade. Generally, there are four categories of adaptation: (1) h-adaptation, where the element sizes vary while the order of the shape functions are constant; (2) padaptation, where the order of the shape functions vary while the element sizes are constant; (3) r-adaptation, where the nodes are redistributed in an existing mesh in the process of adaptation while the total element and node number are
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070501
496 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII constant; (4) hp-adaptation, which is a combination of both h- and p- method. hp-adaptive schemes are among the best mesh based schemes with the potential payoff of achieving exponential converge rate [2, 3]. In this paper, three adaptive FEM algorithms based on mesh refinement (hadaptation), mesh enrichment (p-adaptation) and the combination of both (hpadaptation) are employed to solve incompressible fluid flow problems with convective heat transfer. Results are compared for different algorithms along with a brief discussion of computational efficiency.
2 Governing equations and solution procedure The non-dimensional governing equations for incompressible laminar viscous fluid in a Boussinesq and constant property are written in the forms: Continuity equation: ∇iV = 0 (1) Conservation of Momentum ∂V + V i∇V = −∇p + Pr ∇ 2V + CgravT (2) ∂t for the x-direction, Cgrav = 0 ; for the y-direction, Cgrav = Ra Pr . The energy equation can be written as Energy equation ∂T 1 2 + V i∇T = ∇ T +Q (3) Pe ∂t The following non-dimensional parameters are used to derive the above equations. T * − Tc X* V* p* t* ,V = ,p= , = , = (4) X = t T α/L ρα 2 / L2 L L2 / α Th − Tc with the Rayleigh number, Prandtl number, and Peclet number defined as gβ ( Th − Tc ) L3 ν Ra = , Pr = , Pe = ReiPr (5) αν α where β is the thermal expansion coefficient, α is the thermal diffusivity, ν is
the kinematic viscosity, Th and Tc are for hot and cold wall temperature respectively. A projection method, also known as a fractional step method, is used for the flow solver. This method is based on the Helmholtz-Hodge Decomposition Theorem (Chorin [4]), and detailed description of employment of projection method can be found in the work of Ramaswamy et al. [5].
3
Finite element formulations
Quadrilateral elements are used to discretize the problem domains. The Galerkin weighted residual method is used. The variables V and T can be replaced by using the trial functions: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII n
V ( x, t ) = ∑ N i ( x ) Vi ( t )
497 (6)
i =1 n
T ( x, t ) = ∑ N i ( x ) Ti ( t )
(7)
i =1
where x is the computational domain, i is the degree of freedom (DOF) index and n is the number of DOFs. Under projection algorithms, the weighted residual forms of the momentum and energy equations can be written as (summation convention is implied) Momentum: ∂N j i ∂N i ∂N j ∫ N i N j d Ω Vi + ∫ N i ( N kVk ) ∂x d Ω {Vi } + ∫ Pr ∂x ∂x d Ω {Vi } j i j Ω Ω Ω (8) ∂N j − ∫ f ( xi ) N i d Ω − ∫ Cvisc N i {Vi } ni d Γ = 0 ∂x j Ω Ω where Ω denotes (x) and Γ represents the boundaries of the computational domain. For the vertical component (y) with natural convective effects: f ( xi ) = Cgrav {Ti } = Ra Pr {Ti } Energy: ∂N i ∂N j ∂N j i ∫ N i N j d Ω Ti + ∫ N i ( N kVk ) ∂x d Ω {Ti } + ∫ ∂x ∂x d Ω {Ti } j j Ω Ω Ω i
(9)
− ∫ QN i d Ω − ∫ N i qΓd Γ = 0 Ω
Ω
Equations (8) and (9) can be written in matrix form as [M]{V} + ([K v ] + [A(V)]){V} = {FV }
(10)
i
[M]{T} + ([K T ] + [A(V)]){T} = {FT } (11) where the over dot refers to time differentiation. The matrix coefficients are defined as: (12) [ M ] = ∫ Ni N j d Ω Ω
A (V ) = ∫ N i ( N kVk ) Ω
[ KV ] = ∫ Pr Ω
[ KT ] = ∫
Ω
∂N j ∂x j
∂N i ∂N j ∂xi ∂x j
∂N i ∂N j ∂xi ∂x j
dΩ
dΩ
Γ
(14)
dΩ
{Fv } = ∫ Ni f ( xi ) d Ω + ∫ Pr Ni ni Ω
(13)
(15) ∂V j ∂x j
dΓ
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(16)
498 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
{FT } = ∫ Ni Qd Ω + ∫ Ni qd Γ Ω
(17)
Γ
A Petrov-Galerkin scheme is employed to weight the advection terms in the governing equations. The altered weighting function skews the interpolation function in the upwind direction so that the dispersion and added diffusion introduced by the standard Galerkin formulation are minimized, i.e. αˆ h (18) Wi = Ni + e V ⋅∇N i 2V
αˆ = coth
γ
−
2
(19) 2 γ where αˆ is the Petrov-Galerkin weighting factor, he is the characteristic element length and γ is the Petrov-Galerkin stability parameter. For flow with natural convection, γ = V he Ra Pr . Mass lumping is used in order to obtain a fully explicit time marching scheme, i.e.
[ M ]−1 = 1/ mi 4
(20)
Adaptation methodology
4.1 Error estimator
Various error estimators exist that can be used in adaptation, e.g., the element residual method, interpolation methods, subdomain-residual methods, and projection method. The right chosen error estimator is the basis for a successful adaptation procedure. Detailed descriptions of different error estimators can be found in [6–9]. In this study, an error estimator was chosen based on an extension of the work by Zienkiewicz and Zhu [7] due to its reasonable accuracy, simplicity and ease of implementation. The errors in a finite element solution are the difference between the exact and approximate solutions, which can be expressed in certain norms such as the “Energy” norm or L2 norm. In this simulation, the L2 norm is adopted. The corresponding stress error measure can be written as 1/ 2
eσ = ∫ eσT eσ d Ω Ω and all element errors are typically defined as: eσ
2
m
2
i =1
i
= ∑ eσ
(21)
(22)
where m stands for the total number of elements. The error indices η = ησ in the form of error percentage defined as:
ησ = eσ
2
(
/ σ*
2
+ eσ
2
)
1/ 2
× 100%
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(23)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
499
The error index η is used to guide the adaptation procedure. Temperature is set for the key adaptation variable in our paper. 4.2 Adaptation rules 4.2.1 Unstructured meshes, anisotropic and 1-irregular mesh adaptation rule for h-adaptation An unstructured, anisotropic mesh is allowed which is an efficient, directional refined mesh where refinement in one directional is needed. The 1-Irregular mesh refinement rule allows an element to be refined only if its neighbors are at the same or higher level (1-Irregular mesh). By following this rule, multiple constrained nodes (parent node themselves are constraint nodes) can be avoided. 4.2.2 Minimum rule for p-adaptation Hierarchical shape functions employed in p-adaptation can be categorized as: node functions, edge functions, face functions (for 3D cases) and bubble functions. The minimum rule states that the order for an edge common for two elements never exceeds orders of the neighboring middle nodes. For quadrilateral elements in 2D, both the horizontal and vertical orders must be considered. 4.2.3 hp constraints are employed to meet continuity requirements As a combination of h- and p- adaptation, hp-adaptation can be either refined (unrefined) or enriched (unenriched) whenever necessary. The adaptation rules for h- and p- are combined in hp-adaptation. In addition, to maintain continuity of global basis function, constraints at the interface of elements supporting edge functions of different order are employed. The constraint represents a generalization of the hp-constraints, which is discussed in Demkowicz et al [10]. 4.3 Adaptation strategy
An acceptable solution is reached when global and local error conditions are met. A global error condition states that the global percentage error should not be greater than a maximum specified percentage error: η ≤ η max . If η > η max , a new iteration is performed. The local error condition states that local relative percentage error of any single element eσ i should not be greater than the averaged error eavg among all the elements in the domain. The average element error is defined as:
(
)
1/ 2
2 2 eavg = ηmax σ * + eσ / m (24) A local element refinement indicator ξi = e i / eavg is defined to decide if a
local refinement for an element is needed: when ξi > 1 , the element is refined; when ξi < 1 the element is unrefined. In an h-adaptive process, the new element size is calculated using: h new = h old / ξ1/i p (25) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
500 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII In a p-adaptive process, the new shape function order is calculated using: pnew = pold ξi1/ p (26) The hp-adaptive strategy used in this study employs a “L2” norm error estimator, which is an extension from the “three-step hp-adaptive strategy” developed by Oden et al. [11]. In the hp-adaptive procedure, a sequence of refinement steps is employed. Three consecutive hp-adaptive meshes are constructed for solving the system in order to reach a preset target error: initial mesh, the intermediate h-adaptive mesh, and the final hp- adaptive mesh obtained by applying p-adaptive enrichments on the intermediate mesh. The padaptation is carried out when the problem solution is pre-asymptotic.
5
Numerical results
5.1 Problem definition
Natural convection in a differentially heated cavity has been studied extensively for over 30 years (differentially heated vertical walls - hot left and cold right; adiabatic horizontal walls – top and bottom). Numerical simulation results are generally compared with the accurate benchmark solutions obtained by De Vahl Davis [12], who used a FDM with a stream function - vorticity formulation. In this study, the problem was solved using h-, p- and hp-adaptive FEM with Pr = 0.71, Ra = 103 – 106. 5.2 Simulation results
Results were obtained for Ra = 103 – 106. Excellent agreement was observed over the range of Ra numbers with data available in literatures [12]. Results from the lower Ra number computations are essentially duplicative with results found in the literature. Results for Ra =105 and 106 are presented. Final adapted meshes and results for h-adaptation are shown in Figure 1. 3-level h-adaptation was employed and produced 2503 elements with 2542 DOFs for Ra=105. Final adapted meshes and results for p-adaptation are shown in Figure 2. Only 3-level p-adaptation was used and created 400 elements with 1184 DOFs for Ra=105.
(a) Figure 1:
(b)
h-adaptive results for Ra=105 (a) final (b) streamlines, and (c) temperature contours.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(c) adapted
mesh,
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(a) Figure 2:
p-adaptive results for Ra=105 (a) final (b) streamlines, and (c) temperature contours.
(a) Figure 3:
(b)
hp-adaptive results for Ra=105 (a) final (b) streamlines, and (c) temperature contours.
(a) Figure 4:
(b)
(b)
hp-adaptive results for Ra=106 (a) final (b) streamlines, and (c) temperature contours.
501
(c) adapted
mesh,
(c) adapted
mesh,
(c) adapted
mesh,
Final adapted meshes and results for hp-adaptation are shown in Figures 3 and 5. In these simulations, both 3-level h- and p-adaptations were used resulting in 1368 elements and 6897 DOFs for Ra=105. The test case for Ra=106 produced a final mesh consisting of 1372 elements and 6529 DOFs, which is shown in Figure 4. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
502 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII All the adaptive results agree well with benchmark data available in the literature for both flow and thermal patterns [12]. Quantitative studies were also conducted for the hp-adaptive algorithm with Ra=106. Comparisons with [12] were made for the maximum horizontal and vertical velocities together with their locations on the vertical and horizontal midplane; Nu0, the average Nusselt number on the heated wall; and the maximum and minimum values of local Nusselt number on the heated side together with their locations. Results of the comparison study are shown in Table 1.
6
Discussion
The adaptive algorithms change element size and shape function order dynamically. The adaptations are based on key variable gradients of the error distribution, subsequently producing highly accurate values with a minimum of computational cost. All three adaptive schemes are efficient in reducing overall computational time. This is particularly true for h-adaptation compared with a global uniformly refined algorithm. The p-adaptive algorithm is also effective when compared with a uniformly enriched algorithm. The hp-adaptive algorithm is the best of the three adaptive schemes, and has been shown to be exponentially convergent compared with uniformly refined and enriched techniques [13]. Table 1:
Comparison of hp-FEM results with benchmark data (Ra=106). [12] results umax y (x=0.5) vmax x (y=0.5) Nu0 Numax y (x=0) Numin y (x=0)
64.63 0.850 219.36 0.0379 8.817 17.925 0.037 0.989 1
hp-FEM results 64.97 0.890 221.40 0.0381 8.672 18.147 0.042 0.872 1
A globally uniform h-refined and p-enriched mesh (uniformly refined up to 3levels and enriched up to 3rd order) and the hp-adaptive algorithm (adaptively refined up to 3-levels and enriched up to 3rd order) were analyzed for Ra = 105. The initial mesh for the hp-adaptive algorithm was 10 x 10. Results showed that using a globally h-refined and a p-enriched algorithm consumed nearly 18X more CPU time (projected) than the hp- adaptive algorithm, as shown in Table 2. The choice of using a particularly type of adaptive algorithm and selection of key variables depends on various problem constraints and properties desired by the user. For example, a simple rectangular domain with simple boundary condition constraints can be solved without adaptation using conventional numerical methods. On the other hand, complex geometries and regions where WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
503
high gradients can occur are best handled using dynamic adaptive techniques – and eliminate the burden on the user of having to remesh the problem. A list of the advantages and disadvantages for each adaptive scheme is shown in Table 3. Table 2:
CPU time comparison between uniform refined and enriched algorithm and hp-adaptive algorithm.
Compare Cases
# of element Initial Final
# of DOF Initial Final
Total CPU Time
Per DOF CPU time
# of iteration
9.62 (sec/ DOF) 5.59 (sec/ DOF)
34500
Uniform h and p
1600
1600
14641
14641
140,884 (sec)
hpadaptive algorithm
100
436
121
1385
7741 (sec)
Table 3:
element size DOF (degrees of freedom) shape function advantages
disadvantages
7
35519
Comparison of h-, p-, r- and hp- adaptive algorithm. hadaptation various various
padaptation constant various
radaptation various constant
hpadaptation various various
constant elements will not become overly distorted difficulty in dealing with constraint nodes
various relative coarse mesh may be sufficient coding complexity
constant no new nodes added
various exponential convergence rate
elements may become overly distorted
difficulty in dealing with constraint nodes and coding complexity
Conclusions
Three adaptive algorithms now being used in the finite element method have been developed to solve for fluid flow and heat transfer. Natural convection within a differentially heated enclosure was solved using h-, p- and hp-adaptive algorithms. Similar flow and thermal patterns were observed in all three adaptive solutions for 103 ≤ Ra ≤ 106. Excellent agreement was obtained for all three methods compared with benchmark data available in the literature. Characteristics for the different adaptive algorithms are discussed. The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
504 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII computational efficiency for the hp-adaptive algorithm showed an 18X decrease in CPU time compared to using a uniformly refined and enriched FEM algorithm. Adaptive algorithms are especially promising in dealing with problems where solution and error distributions are hard to predict.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
[9] [10]
[11]
[12] [13]
Peraire J., Vahdati M., Morgan K., Zienkiewicz O.C., Adaptive Remeshing for Compressible Flows, J. Comput. Physics, 72 (2), pp26-37, 1987 Guo, B. and Babuska, I., The h-p Version of the Finite Element Method, Parts 1 and 2, Comp. Mech., Vol. 1, pp. 21-21 and pp. 203-220, 1986. Gui, W. and Babuska, I., The h, p and h-p Version of the Finite Element Method in One Dimension, Parts 1 and 2, Numerische Mathematik Vol. 49, pp.577-683, 1986. Chorin, A. J., Numerical Solution of the Navier-Stokes Equations, Math. Comp., Vol. 22, pp.745-762., 1968. Ramaswamy, B., Jie, T. C. and Akin, J. E., Semi-Implicit and Explicit Finite Element Schemes for Coupled Fluid/Thermal Problems, Int. J. Num. Meth. Engng., Vol. 34, pp.675-696., 1992. P. Nithiarasu and O. C. Zienkiewicz, Adaptive mesh generation for fluid mechanics problems, Int. J. Num. Meth. Engng. 47, pp. 629-662, 2000. Zienkiewicz O. C. and Zhu R. J. Z., A Simple Error Estimator and Adaptive Procedure for Practical Engineering Analysis, Int. J. Num. Meth. Engng., Vol. 24, pp.337-357, 1987. Oden, J. T., Demkowicz, L. Rachowicz, W. and Westermann T. A., Toward a Universal h-p Adaptive Finite Element Strategy, Part 2. A Posteriori Error Estimation, Comp. Meth. Appl. Mech. and Engng., Vol. 77, pp.113-180, 1989. Ainsworth, M. and Oden, J. T., A Posteriori Error Estimation in Finite Element Analysis, Pure and Applied Mathematics, A Wiley-Interscience Series of Texts, Monographs and Tracts, 2000. Demkowicz, L, Oden, J. T., Rachowicz, W and Hardy, O, Toward a Universal h-p Adaptive Finite Element Strategy, Part 1. Constrained Approximation and Data Structures, Comp. Meth. Appl. Mech. and Engng, Vol. 77, pp.79-112, 1989. Oden, J. T., Wu, W. and Ainsworth, W., Three-Step h-p Adaptive Strategy for the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations, Modeling, Mesh Generation, and Adaptive Numerical Methods for Partial Differential Equations, Springer-Verlag, pp. 347-366, 1995. De Vahl Davis, G., Natural Convection of Air in a Square Cavity: A Bench Mark Numerical Solution, Int. J. Numerical Methods in Fluids, Vol. 3, 249-264, 1983. Wang, X. and Pepper, D. W., Application of an hp-adaptive technique for heat, mass and momentum transport, ASME Int. Mech. Engng. Cong. and Exp., Nov.5-11, 2005 Orlando, Florida. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
505
Modified spherical harmonics method for one-speed transport equation with anisotropic scattering M. S. Li & B. Yang Institute of Applied Physics and Computational Mathematics, Beijing, People’s Republic of China
Abstract The criticality type eigenvalues of the one-speed transport equation in a homogeneous slab with anisotropic scattering and Marshak boundary conditions have been studied. The scattering function is assumed to be a combination of linearly anisotropic and strongly forward-backward scattering. When the forward and backward scattering completely dominate over the ‘ordinary’ scattering, or the thickness of the slab approaches zero, the highly peaked angular flux at the central point of the slab was expressed by finite width delta functions. Using the finite width delta functions to analyse the high-order truncation error of the angular flux we could accurately obtain results with a low-order approximation. Numerical results for critical eigenvalues are obtained and tabulated for different scattering parameters including the extreme cases, while the standard spherical harmonics method gets a singularity. Keywords: spherical harmonics method, anisotropic scattering, finite width delta functions.
1
Introduction
Criticality type eigenvalues are needed for a variety of applications in reactor physics. The problem of anisotropy and its effects on the size of the system is one of the most important problems of transport theory. Many methods for computing transport equations have been proposed, such as the spherical harmonics ( PN ) method [1,2] and the discrete ordinates ( S N ) method [3, 4, 5]. When the forward and backward scattering completely dominate over the ‘ordinary’ scattering (the extreme case) or the thickness of the slab approaches to WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070511
506 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII zero, the angular distribution is very strongly peaked along the direction parallel to the slab surface, one has to take high-order functions into account for the highly peaked angular flux. The standard PN method is thus inadequate for this type of problem [1, 6]. D. C. Sahni has solved the problem by combining the S N method, integral equation method and eigenvalue method [6]. To the best knowledge of the present author there is currently no article on completely calculating various combinations of the scattering parameters including the extreme case. This work is to propose an easy-to-use comprehensive modified spherical harmonics method for computing transport equations in this situation. We have derived the asymptotic solution of transport equations and expressed the angular flux at the central point of the slab by finite width delta functions. Using the finite width delta functions to analyse the high-order truncation error of the angular flux we could accurately obtain results with low-order approximation. In this article we introduce our opinion in physics at first, then discuss the computational method, at last give results on several typical models and compare our results with the results calculated by the integral equation method.
2
Transport equation
With conventional notation [6], the starting linear transport equation for neutrons of one speed can be written as Ω ⋅∇ψ (r , Ω) + Σtψ (r , Ω) = cΣt ∫ ψ (r , Ω) f (Ω '⋅ Ω)d Ω '.
(1)
The scattering kernel is assumed to be of the form 1−α − β α β (1 + 3b1Ω '⋅ Ω) + δ (Ω '⋅ Ω − 1) + δ (Ω '⋅ Ω + 1) (2) 4π 2π 2π here 0 ≤ α , β ≤ 1, α + β ≤ 1 ,and | b1 |≤ 1/ 3 . In the present investigation we apply the theory to a source free, symmetric homogeneous infinite slab of thickness 2a . When this scattering function is inserted into eqn (1) we obtain the transport equation f (Ω '⋅ Ω) =
∂ψ ( x, µ ) + (1 − α c)ψ ( x, µ ) ∂x (3) 1 c = (1 − α − β ) ∫ (1 + 3b1 µµ ')ψ ( x, µ ')d µ ' + β cψ ( x, − µ ). −1 2 Here x is the spatial variable measure in mean-free path, µ is the direction cosine of the angle between the positive x axis and the neutrons velocity vector Ω . The boundary conditions are that no neutrons enter the slab from the outside, i.e.
µ
ψ (a, µ ) = 0 µ < 0; ψ (− a, µ ) = 0 µ > 0.
When α , β ,b1 and c are specified we can solve critical thickness 2a . WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(4)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
507
Asymptotic analytic method and integral method
Following Inonu [7], we divide the ordinary part of the scattering function into one symmetric and one antisymmetric part. We make the substitutions [6] 1−αc − γ κ ( x , µ ) = ψ ( x, µ ) − ψ ( x, − µ ) (5) βc where c(1 − α − β ) c= (6) 1 − c(α + β ) (7) γ = (1 − α c) 2 − β 2 c 2 . Obviously, for γ to be real it is required that (α + β )c ≤ 1 . With these substitutions we find that κ ( x, µ ) is a solution of the equation ∂κ ( x, µ ) cγ 1 + κ ( x, µ ) = µ (8) ∫ (1 + 3b1µµ ')κ ( x, µ ')d µ ' ∂x
2
−1
where 1−αc − β c b1 . 1−αc + β c The boundary conditions for the transformed flux κ ( x, µ ) will then be b1 =
µ < 0; κ (a, µ ) = Rκ (a, − µ ) κ ( a , µ ) R κ ( a , µ ) µ > 0. − = − −
(9)
(10)
where R=
βc . 1−αc + γ
(11)
Eliminating ψ (τ , − µ ) from eqn (5) with arguments µ and − µ we obtain 1−αc + γ βc κ ( x, µ ) + κ ( x, − µ ). (12) 2γ 2γ 1 1−αc + β c + γ 1 (13) ∫−1ψ ( x, µ )d µ = ∫−1κ ( x, µ )d µ. 2γ Utilizing the symmetry of the angular flux at x = 0 ψ (0, µ ) = ψ (0, − µ ) we obtain 1−αc + β c + γ ψ (0, µ ) = κ (0, µ ). (14) 2γ From eqns (13) and (14) we know the zero moments of the angular flux
ψ ( x, µ ) =
1
1
−1
−1
ψ 0 ( x) = ∫ ψ ( x, µ )d µ , κ 0 ( x) = ∫ κ ( x, µ )d µ as a function of x have a similar distribution and ψ (0, µ ) , κ (0, µ ) as a function of µ have a similar distribution. If we assume that b1 = 0 and κ 0 ( x) = cos( x / η ). (15) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
508 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII When eqn (15) is inserted into eqn (8) we obtain 2 aγ
aγ
a |µ| a (e |µ | − R ) + ( R − 1) cos( ) + ( R + 1)( ) sin( ) e |µ | η γη η c k (0, µ ) = . 2 aγ 2 µ [1 + ( ) 2 ][e | µ | − R ]
(16)
γη
(a) For β = 0 from eqn (11) it follows that R = 0 k (0, µ ) =
c 1 − cos(a / η )e − aγ /| µ | + sin(a / η )e − aγ /| µ | 2 1 + ( µ / γη ) 2
(17)
When α → 1/ c and a / η → 0 if we assume the scale flux as a function of x is a constant we obtain c − aγ / µ k (0, µ ) = (1 − e ). (18) 2 κ 0 (0) = cγ 1 − e − aγ + aγ E1 (aγ ) (19) where E1 ( x) is exponential integral function. Neglecting terms proportional to γ and of higher order cγ a[1 − γ 0 − log(γ a )] 1 ca (1 − α ){1 − γ 0 − log[(1 − α c)a ]} 1 where γ 0 is Euler’s constant γ 0 = 0.577216 .
(20) (21)
(b) For β ≠ 0 when α + β → 1/ c from eqn (11) it follows R = −1, κ 0 (a) = 0 , we obtain cos(a / η ) ≈ 0 and sin(a / η ) ≈ 1 k (0, µ ) =
c 1 . 2 1 + ( µ / γη ) 2
k0 (0) = cγη arctg (1/ γη ). η To get we use Eqs. (15) and (23) cγη arctg (1/ γη ) = 1. This is close to the discrete eigenvalues of the Case spectrum [8]. It shows that the expression 2ca (1 − α − β )(1 − α c + β c) / γ
(22) (23) (24)
approaches a constant when α + β → 1/ c . The limiting value is 2 (1.954 in reference [6]). 2ca (1 − α − β )(1 − α c + β c) / γ = 2.0. (25) (c) As shown by Siewert and Williams [9] and Sahni et al [6] eqn (8) can be transformed into an integral equation for the zero moments of the angular flux κ 0 ( x) . If we assume that b1 = 0 and κ 0 ( x) is an even function of x it will read
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
κ 0 ( x) =
cγ 2 ×∫
∫
a
−a
1
κ 0 ( y ) E1 (γ | x − y |)dy +
exp(
−2aγ
µ
){exp[
( y − x)γ
cγ 2
∫
a
−a
κ 0 ( y )dy
] + exp[
( y + x)γ
µ µ µ[1 − R exp(−2aγ / µ )]
0
509
(26)
]}d µ .
For β = 0 with a constant scale flux assumption eqn (26) will be cγ a (27) E1 (γ | y |)dy. 2 ∫− a Expand E1 ( x) at x = 0 and neglecting terms proportional to γ and of higher order, we could obtain eqs. (20) and (21).
κ 0 (0) =
4
Spherical harmonics method
For the Spherical harmonics method solution, the angular flux is expanded in a series of Legendre polynomials as N 2n + 1 ψ ( x, µ ) = ∑ (28) Φ n ( x ) Pn ( µ ). 2 n=0 This expansion (28) can now be substituted into eqn (3) in order to obtain the function Φ n ( x ) . Multiplying both sides of the resulting equation by Pm ( µ ) , integrating overt and utilizing the orthogonally properties and the recursion relations of the Legendre polynomials, after some rearrangement we have: n
d Φ n −1 ( x )
+ ( n + 1)
d Φ n +1 ( x )
+ ( 2n + 1) Φ n ( x ) dx dx = ( 2n + 1) [c (1 − α − β ) Φ 0 ( x ) δ n 0 b1c (1 − α − β ) Φ1 ( x ) δ n1 + α cΦ n ( x ) + β c ( −1) Φ n ( x )] n
(29)
n = 0,1, 2,… N .
One may employ the well-known procedure of seeking a solution of the homogeneous eqn (29) in the form Φ n ( x ) = Gn ( v ) exp ( − x v )
(30)
where the Gn (v) are some constants. Each of the Φ n ( x ) defined in eqn (30) will satisfy eqn (29) provided that the characteristic PN equations are satisfied:
( n + 1) Gn +1 ( v ) + nGn −1 ( v ) − ( 2n + 1) v{1 − c (1 − α − β ) n × (δ n 0 + b1δ n1 ) − c α + ( −1) β }Gn ( v ) = 0.
(31)
Eqn (31) has a homogeneous matrix form: M ( v ) G = 0.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(32)
510 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The coefficient matrix is (N + 1) × (N + 1) , and G = [G0 , G1 . . . Gn ]T . The unknown constant vector G is determined from the normalization G−1 (ν ) = 0 and G0 (ν ) = 1 . The general solutions of eqn (3) with N odd can be expressed, for n = 0,1, N , as Φn ( x ) =
( N +1)
∑ j =1
2
n Gn ( v j ) Aj Fn ( − x v j ) + ( −1) B j Fn ( x v j )
(33)
where Gn (−v) = (−1) n Gn (v) , Fn (± x / v j ) = exp(± x / v j ) and Aj and B j are coefficients to be determined from the boundary and symmetry conditions of the problem. The essential idea of the standard PN method is that Φ N +1 (v) = 0 , i.e. the permissible eigenvalueν j is the jth positive zero of GN +1 (v) . The determination of the roots is obtained using the Newton-Raphson iterative technique. For a finite slab of half-thickness a we apply the Marshak boundary condition
∫
1
0
P2 k −1 ( µ )ψ ( a, − µ ) d µ = 0
k = 1, 2,… ( N + 1) 2
(34)
to the general solution (31), and then obtain an eigenvalue equation which relates the critical dimensions a to the parameter c , or vice versa. This can be written in matrix form as (35) M ( a ) A = [ 0] where A is a vector with elements A k , k = 1, 2,… ( N + 1) 2 and the [( N + 1) 2]2 elements of matrix M k , j (a ) are given by
Mk, j ( a) =
( N −1)
2
∑ ϕ ( n, k ) G ( v ) cosh ( a v ) + G ( v ) sinh ( a v ) n =0
2n
j
j
2 k −1
j
j
(36)
where
( 4n + 1)( −1) ( 2k − 1)!( 2n )! . ϕ ( n, k ) = 2 2 k + 2 n −1 2 ( 2n − 2k + 1)( k + n ) n !( k − 1)! n+ k
(37)
Clearly eqn (37) is a linear system of algebraic equations. This system has a non-trivial solution (for A k ) if determinant M k , j (a ) vanishes, and this condition yields the desired results.
5
Modified spherical harmonics method
The PN approximation ( N odd) consists of truncating the expansion (28) after N + 1 terms, i.e. at n = N . One also chooses a finite number of points of the ν spectrum, given by the roots of the eqn (31) and GN +1 (v) = 0 . Since c > 1 , the root ν 1 is imaginary (we letν 1 = iη ) and very close to the discrete eigenvalue ν 0 of the Case spectrum [8]. The eigenfunction corresponding imaginary
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
511
eigenvalueν 1 is dominant part of the angular flux when α + β approaches the value 1/ c . It is necessary to count for the high-order terms of eqn (28) as the angular flux is a very strongly peaked function along the direction parallel to the slab surface. The modified spherical harmonics ( δ PN ) method is that using the finite width delta functions analyse the high-order truncation error of the angular flux and the high-order part of the angular flux is calculated analytically. Gn (ν 1 ) = Dn for n ∈ even and n ≥ N + 1 (38) where 1
Dn = ∫ δ ( µ )Pn ( µ )d µ . −1
(39)
From the previous section we know the finite width delta functions δ ( µ ) are expressed by eqns (18) and (22) for β = 0 and β ≠ 0 separately. 1 1 − e − aγ /|µ | if β = 0; − aγ 2 1 − e + aγ E1 (aγ ) δ (µ ) = 1 1 if β ≠ 0. 2γη arctg (1/ γη ) 1 + ( µ / γη ) 2
(40)
The value of GN +1 (ν 1 ) is not equal to zero at this time GN +1 (ν 1 ) = DN +1 . (41) To apply the Marshak boundary condition (34) we must take into account the high-order parts of angular flux so eqn (36) for j = 1 will be changed to
6
∞ ( N −1) 2 M k ,1 ( a ) = ∑ ϕ ( n, k ) G2 n (v1 ) + ∑ ϕ ( n, k ) D2 n (η ) n =0 n = ( N +1) 2 × cos ( a η ) + G2 k −1 ( v1 ) sin ( a η ) .
(42)
( N −1) 2 1 M k ,1 ( a ) = ∑ ϕ ( n, k )( G2 n (v1 ) − D2 n (η ) ) + ∫ P2 k −1 ( µ ) δ ( µ ) d µ 0 n=0 × cos ( a η ) + G2 k −1 ( v1 ) sin ( a η ) .
(43)
Numerical results and discussion
In order to examine the validity and accuracy of the present method two computer programs ( δ PN and integrate method) in FORTRAN were written to calculate the critical thickness. We took the results from integral equation method as reference values. The integral eqn (26) was solved iteratively by substituting improved flux approximation in to the right-hand side of the equation. When α + β → 1/ c the angular flux κ ( x, µ ) are high-order functions of µ for β ≠ 0 we use N = 24 to 520 double-Gauss quadrature sets for different combinations α , β and c .
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
512 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 1:
The critical slab thickness 2a obtained in PN , δ PN approximation and integrate ( Int ) method with different value of c, α , β and degree of linearly anisotropic scattering comparison with results of C. Yildiz [1].
c, α , β
b1
P11
δ P3
δ P11
1.2 0.70, 0.0
-0.3 0 0.3
2.95114 3.11594 3.32199 2.60780 2.66236 -0.52586 0.53742 -0.52156 0.53247 -1.14702 1.15204 1.15715 0.95199 0.95384 0.95569 0.33843 0.34093 0.34349 0.33164 0.33389 0.33618 0.67499 0.67993 0.68501 0.73696 0.74475 0.75285 0.93023 0.95138 0.97453
2.95434 3.14486 3.34232 0.86736 0.87926 -0.31261 0.32049 -0.17348 0.17586 -0.97472 0.98166 0.98875 0.00987 0.00987 0.00988 0.08039 0.08114 0.08191 0.00204 0.00204 0.00204 0.16057 0.16207 0.16360 0.45872 0.46617 0.47388 0.79248 0.81434 0.83624
2.93843 3.10476 3.31169 0.87132 0.87928 -0.31780 0.32095 -0.17428 0.17587 -1.02865 1.03315 1.03772 0.01707 0.01707 0.01708 0.11128 0.11188 0.11250 0.00378 0.00378 0.00378 0.22206 0.22326 0.22449 0.55192 0.55693 0.56202 0.88245 0.90186 0.92250
1.2 0.8333, 0.0 2.0 0.49, 0.0 2.0 0.4999, 0.0 1.2 0.0, 0.80
1.2 0.0, 0.8333 2.0 0.0, 0.49 2.0 0.0, 0.4999 1.5 0.33, 0.33 1.5 0.33, 0.3 1.5 0.42, 0.15
-0.3 0 0.3 -0.3 0.0 0.3 -0.3 0.0 0.3 -0.3 0 0.3
-0.3 0 0.3 -0.3 0.0 0.3 -0.3 0.0 0.3 -0.3 0 0.3 -0.3 0 0.3 -0.3 0 0.3
Int
3.08555 0.89557 0.32932 0.17913 1.01267 0.04210 0.14402 0.01852 0.28622 0.56570 0.88135
P11 P13* [1] 2.95115 3.11595 3.32199 2.60780 2.66236 2.72127 0.52586 0.53742 0.54996 0.52156 0.53247 0.54425 1.14702 1.15204 1.15715 0.95199 0.95384 0.95569 0.33843 0.34093 0.34349 0.33164 0.33389 0.33618 0.66691* 0.67168* 0.67658* 0,73009* 0.73770* 0.74562* 0.92990* 0.95144* 0.97506*
For the specified α , β , c and b1 we first computed the eigenvalueν 1 = iη from eqn (24) and start the calculation with some assumed value of halfthickness a , then we could calculate Dn (ν 1 ) by eqn (39). Except GN +1 (ν 1 )
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
513
and M k ,1 ( a ) the calculation procedures in present work are the same as standard PN method. After we obtain an improved value of half-thickness a and continue this process until we get a convergence accurate result. In table 1, we present the critical slab thickness 2a obtained in PN method, δ PN method and integrate ( Int ) method with different value of c, α , β and degree of linearly anisotropic scattering b1 . In reference [1] Yildiz had compared the results calculated by standard PN method with the results of Sahni et al [6] and others. The conclusion was that the standard PN method could give reasonable results for thick slab. We directly compare our results obtained by standard PN method with those in reference [1]. The agreement is generally within five or six significant decimal places for N < 13 . For N = 13,15 the agreement is generally within three or four significant decimal places. We couldn’t obtain converged results for some combination of α , β when α + β → 1/ c with b1 = 0.3 . When γ ≈ 1 the value of GN +1 is nearly zero. The low-order PN approximations generally give accurate results for thick slabs [1,2]. For example when α = 0.7, β = 0.0, c = 1.2, b1 = 0.0 , γ = 0.16 and G12 = 0.0066 the PN , δ PN methods give closely results. When the values α + β approach the limit value 1/ c the angular distribution is very strongly peaked along the plane of the slab. The critical slab thickness 2a varies rapidly with c and approaches to zero but the standard PN method give an unchanged result. For example while for α = 0.0, β = 0.4999, c = 2.0, b1 = 0.0 , γ = 0.02 , GN +1 = 0.2252 the critical slab thickness 2a are 0.33389 for P11 . The δ PN method gives 2a = 0.00378 for δ P11 . Even δ P3 approximation could give a reasonable result 2a = 0.00204 . In table 1 we could see when α = 0.8333 , β = 0.0 , c = 1.2 , b1 = 0.0 , γ = 4 × 10−5 , GN +1 = 0.164 the critical slab thickness 2a are 2.6623,0.87928 for P11 , δ P11 respectively. It is seen from Table 1 that the δ PN method has more accuracy than standard PN method but has less accuracy than integral equation method. When α + β → 1/ c the critical slab thickness 2a as a function of α , β approaches to zero more rapidly than real. We think that the errors occur in the lack of taking account of the high-order moments of the angular flux in the boundary condition eqn (34).
7
Conclusion
In this paper we have considered the slab criticality problem of the linear transport equation with forward, backward and linearly anisotropic scattering in a homogeneous slab. Using the asymptotic analytic method we obtain the asymptotic angular flux which expressed by finite width delta functions at the central point of the slab when α + β approaches the value 1/ c . Using the finite WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
514 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII width delta functions to consider more terms in the expansion of angular flux we could obtain accurately results with low-order N and less computational effort. The present scheme converges quite well and enables us to obtain accurate results even with the low-order formulas. The present method is applicable to large system, and also to very small system. The slab thickness as a function of α , β are continuously and smoothly for various α + β ranging from 0 to the extreme case 1/ c . The present method can also be extended to more general problems with two or three dimension high-order anisotropy and to multiregional energy dependent problems. We have started looking into these aspects and the conclusion awaits further work.
Acknowledgement This work was partially supported by the National Key Laboratory of Computational Physics under Grant No.51479050105ZW0906.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9]
C. Yildiz, Variation of the critical slab thickness with the degree of strongly anisotropic scattering in one-speed neutron transport theory, Ann. Nucl. Energy, 1998; Vol. 25, No. 8, pp. 529 540, C. Yildiz. Influence of anisotropic scattering on the size of timedependent systems in monoenergetic neutron transport, Journal of Physics D 1999; 32: 317. R.C. Barros and E.W. Larsen. A numerical method for one group slab geometry discrete ordinates problems with no spatial truncation error. Nuclear Science and Engineering 1990; 104: 199. W. A. Fiveland. Three-dimensional radiative heat transfer solutions by the Discrete Ordinates Method. AIAA J. Thermophysics 1988; 2(4): 309-316. J. E. Morel, A hybrid collocation-Galerkin-Sn method for solving the Boltzmann transport equations. Nuclear Science and Engineering 1989; 101: 72-87. D. C. Sahni, N. G. Sjostrand and N. S. Garis, Criticality and time eigenvalues for one-speed neutrons in a slab with forward and backward scattering. Journal of Physics D 1992; 25:1381. E. Inonu, Transport Theory and Statistical Physics 1973; 3: 137 K. M. Case and P. F. Zweifel, Linear Transport Theory. Addison Wesley, Reading, MA, 1967. C. E. Siewert and M. M. R. Williams, The effect of anisotropic scattering on the critical slab problem in neutron transport theory using a synthetic kernel. Journal of Physics D 1977; 10: 2031-2040.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 6 Structural and stress analysis
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
517
Inverse variational principle based coupled modeling of underground structures P. Procházka Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract In some previous papers of the author coupled numerical–experimental modeling of tunnels embedded in surrounding rock was based on minimization of a certain functional describing the steepest descend mode of differences of measured and computed values of stresses or displacements at selected points. The idea consisted of a choice of subdomains (patches), the eigenstrains in which were introduced using the unit impulse technique. Influence matrices were generated and the linear hull of eigenstrain effects together with the optimization problem lead to the identification of plastic stresses inside the domain describing the surrounding rock. Consequently, a nonlinear model in numerical analysis can be improved using eigenparameters as design parameters in optimization. The only problem remaining is how to select the patches. In this paper inverse variational principles are applied to help solve this principal problem. The 2D problem is solved with moving patches (support subdomains) with uniformly introduced eigenstrains. Keywords: coupled modeling, tunnel face stability, Inverse variational principles, Desai’s model.
1
Introduction
Using a very powerful tool, a combination of Transformation field analysis (TFA) and a certain plasticity rule (possibly softening included), back analysis of structures can be regarded as seeking the optimal distribution of eigenparameters (eigenstrains or eigenstresses) in the domain describing undeformed rock in a certain sense. For the first time the TFA was applied to optimization of prestressing of composite structures, [1]. The eigenparameters can represent many phenomena (not only prestress), and also the influence of plastic WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070521
518 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII deformation, or the influence of the length of purchase in tunneling. A similar approach was applied to nonlinear problems in composite structures, [2]. In the first above mentioned publication the areas with possible eigenparameters were firmly given. In the second publication the areas (patches) were selected from experience and also were done. Unit impulses of subdomain-wise uniformly distributed eigenparameters (generally linear or higher order polynomials) enable one to find material properties from comparison of results from experimental studies and numerical analysis at selected points, as was done in other papers of the author of this paper on geomechanical problems, [3, 4], for example. The only problem still occurring is: find the optimal distribution of patches (subregions), where eigenstrains are introduced or considered. This is a problem of combined optimization, where the principal variables depend on subdomains (patches), the uniform distribution (this is one of possible approximations) of eigenparameters is assumed. This problem is not easy to solve, as the optimization of principal variables must be iterated, and a reasonable tool for it should be found. One such tool can serve Inverse variational principles, which hold the volume of the domain as constant, and design variables are subdomains, or their representatives, [5].
2
Transformation field analysis
In this section the general procedure for coupled modeling on the firm patches is briefly introduced using the TFA. It may be done in terms of many modern numerical methods. First, let us consider that the body Ω under consideration (part of a structure, element, and system of more elements, composite, in our case rock surrounding tunnel) behaves linearly, i.e. Hooke’s linear law is valid in the entire body. When the problem is correctly posed, the displacement vector, strain and stress tensors can be obtained from the Navier equations, kinematical equations, and linear Hooke’s law. In the second step we select points, where the measured values are available, either from experiments in laboratory, or from “in situ” measurements. We also select points Ar, or disjoint regions (subdomains) Ωr, r = 1,...,n, from the body under study, and apply there successively unit eigenparameter impulses (either eigenstresses or eigenstrains) to get an influence tensors (matrices). Moreover, let the set of points where the measured values are known be Bs, s = 1,...,m. Then the real stress (σ ) s at Bs is a linear hull of stress (σ ext ) s at Bs due to external loading and eigenstrains ( µ ) r and (ε pl ) r , or eigenstress (λ ) r and relaxation stress (σ rel ) r at Ar (similar relations are valid for overall strain field ε or displacements u): (σ i ) s = (σ iext ) s + ( Pikσ ) sr ( µk ) r + (Qikσ ) sr ( ε kpl ) r ,
or (σ i ) s = (σ iext ) s + ( Rikσ ) sr (λk ) r + (Tikσ ) sr (σ krel ) r WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(1)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
519
(ui ) s = (uiext ) s + ( Piku ) sr ( µ k ) r + (Qiku ) sr (ε kpl ) r ,
or (ui ) s = (uiext ) s + ( Riku ) sr (λk ) r + (Tiku ) sr (σ krel ) r
(2)
where the Einstein summation rule has been used and the influence tensors P, Q, and also R and T may be identical, as any eigenparameter may stand for the plastic or relaxation parameter (say, eigenstrain may stand for plastic strain, which is obvious from (1) and (2)). The strain and stress components are written in vector form. Note that λ = − Lµ holds, where L is the elastic stiffness tensor. The first relations in (1) and (2) describe the initial strain method while the second relations in those equations formulate the initial stress method. On the other hand measured stresses (σimeas)s, or measured displacements meas s (u i) are available in a discrete set of points. A natural requirement is formulated in terms of steepest descent type “error functionals” I, which express that the values of measured and computed values be as close as possible: I σ [( µk ) r ] =
6
m
∑∑
[(σ i ) s − (σ imeas ) s ]2 → minimum,
(3)
[( ui ) s − (uimeas ) s ]2 → minimum,
(4)
í =1 s =1
or I u [( µ k ) r ] =
6
m
∑∑ í =1 s =1
where the sum is taken over i and s. Differentiating I by (µα)β yields a linear system of equations for (µj)l: (Aαk)βr (µk)r = Yαβ, α = 1,...,6, β = 1,...,m, where ( Aαk ) βr =
6
m
∑∑ ( Pikσ ) sr ( Piασ ) sβ i =1 s =1
Yαβ =
6
m
∑∑ [(σ imeas ) s − (σ iext ) s − (Qikσ ) sr (ε kpl ) r ]( Piασ ) sβ i =1 s =1
in the case (3), and ( Aαk ) βr =
6
m
∑∑ ( Piku ) sr ( Piαu ) sβ i =1 s =1
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
520 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Yαβ =
6
m
∑∑ [(uimeas ) s − (uiext ) s − (Qiku ) sr (ε kpl ) r ]( Piαu ) sβ i =1 s =1
in the case (4). Recall that the patches are selected as fixed, their position and shape are firmly given.
3
Nonlinear law given
The previous section was devoted to application of the TFA to coupled modeling assuming the starting (initial) stage of computation is linear elastic. This case is appropriate for large scale problems, involving plasticity, hereditary problems and some softening rules. On the other hand, probably a more precise approach would be to start with the plastic law, at least approximately. It is well known that some cases of softening lead to multivalued functions. The procedure described in the previous section cannot include this case. If the initial stage is described by a certain plastic rule, the larger scale of materially nonlinear problems can be solved in similar way as before. Let us concentrate on such problems. If a certain plasticity law is proposed we can write using the splitting of elastic and plastic influences the resulting stresses and displacements as: (σ i ) s = (σ iext ) s + (Qikσ ) sr ( ε kpl ) r ,
or (σ i ) s = (σ iext ) s + (Tikσ ) sr (σ krel ) r s
(ui ) =
(uiext ) s
+ (Qiku ) sr ( ε kpl ) r
(6)
,
or (ui ) s = (uiext ) s + (Tiku ) sr (σ krel ) r
(7)
From the above equations it immediately follows that, for example, (σ i ) s = ( S ikσ ) s + ( Pikσ ) sr ( µ k ) r , (ui ) s = ( Siku ) s + ( Piku ) sr ( µ k ) r ,
(8)
holds, i.e. the influence of elasticity and plasticity is hidden in the first terms of the right hand sides of (8). From (8) two possibilities obviously appear: Either plastic effects disappear in the first terms of the r.h.s. of (8) or they are considered there. Certain starting plastic rules involved in (8) are discussed in [4]. Using the expressions (8) and the minimum conditions (3) or (4), the conditions for a minimum are obtained from (5) with Yαβ =
6
m
∑∑ [(σ imeas ) s − (σ iext ) s ]( Piασ ) sβ i =1 s =1
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Yαβ =
6
521
m
∑∑ [(uimeas ) s − (uiext ) s ]( Piαu ) sβ i =1 s =1
The left hand sides hold their former expression.
4
Inverse variational principles
Following extended primary variational principles one can write the energy functionals on the whole domain Ω as: Π=
1 a (u, u ) − [ p, u ] → minimum 2
(9)
where a(.,.) is an energetic norm and [.,.] is the scalar product on the boundary Γ of Ω, with p being prescribed tractions. Let us divide Ω into m disjoint subregions (patches) Ωr, union of them is Ω. Then (9) can be rewritten as Π=
m
∑ r =1
1 a r (u, u ) − [ p, u ] → minimum 2
(10)
where ar(.,.) is an energetic norm on each Ωr. Then the problem appears not to be properly defined. In order to ensure that the problem is correctly posed, the volumes (or areas in 2D) have to be bounded and their measure has to be given. The functional (9) then is improved as: Π (u, Ω ) =
∑
1 [ a r ( u , u ) + ωr ( 2
∫
ΩdΩr − C r )] − [ p, u ] →
→ stationary
(11)
where Cr is a measure of Ωr, see [5], and ωr are the lagrangian multipliers. The internal energy is a sum of integrals over appropriate domains Ωr of potentials (W ) r , which in our case reads as: (W ) r = (σ i ) r [(ε i ) r − ( µ i ) r ]
(12)
where ( µi ) r has been considered uniformly distributed in each Ωr . Hence, Euler’s equations follow as: 1. Variation by displacements yields equilibrium equations involving partially uniformly distributed eigenstrains ( µi ) r . They are given from (5) for a supposed distribution (shape) of Ωr .
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
522 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 2. Approximating the problem in the sense of FEM with K, say, then the changes in the fields with respect to the subdomains can formally be written as: ∂Ω r 1 ∂K =0 U iU k + ωr 2 ∂pi ∂pi
(13)
where pr are internal parameters declaring the shape of the subdomain Ωr . From (10) it immediately follows that the lagrangian multipliers have to be constant for each r, i.e. on each subdomain Ωr all components of eigenstrain tensor remain uniform. 3. Partial differentiation of (8) by ω r ensures that the measures of the subdomains are unchanged. Some recommendations on how to introduce the internal shape parameters could be found in [5], for example.
5
Numerical procedure for two subdomains
To show the ability of the above submitted procedure consider a simply supported steel fiber reinforced concrete beam with the length of 30 cm, the height of 12 cm, the bending stiffness I = 1440 cm4, E = 2 GPa. The width is 10 cm. The problem is solved as a stretched plate, the shape of the external boundary of which remains constant and one patch is considered. Concentrated forces are applied at one third and two thirds of the span, i.e. four points test is studied. The symmetric case is solved, shear eigenstrains are neglected, and transversal eigenstrain disappears, too. The force F applied is 4 kN, distributed along the width, so that the stress in the elastic state is 1.67 MPa. Measured values of deflections are as follows: under the force at the lower edge of the beam it was 0.69 cm, at the middle of the span 0.828 cm. The initial stage is considered elastic, plasticity occurs due to eigenparameters, which stand here for plastic strains. For the optimized shape of the patch we use condition (4). Note that the number of unknown eigenparameters cannot exceed the number of measured values. This must be understood in such a way that one component of the eigenparameter tensor is one unknown. For example, if we take into consideration a full 2D tensor, than four components create the unknowns in one patch. Consequently, for one patch we need at least five measured values of either displacement, or stresses, or both, as obviously the conditions (3) and (4) can be combined. The strain at the middle of the span in the lower edge was calculated as 0.000835, while the resulting strain dropped to the value of 0.000738, i.e. the eigenstrain lowered the strain by approximately 0.0001. The movement of the boundary of the optimal patch undergoes criteria, which are described in the second example, which is more general. The final situation is described in Fig. 1, where the shape of the uniformly distributed eigenstrains is shown (we consider only one component of the eigenstrain tensor, namely the horizontal eigenstrain, according to our above mentioned assumption). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
523
Four point test on a beam with one patch.
The second example is much more complicated and shows us how to use the procedure in underground structure assessment, namely for description of behavior of the rock surrounding the tunnel lining. Also here, one patch is considered for simplicity. As in the eigenparameters also the influence of purchase can be involved, the problem of loading of the lining is solved as a 2D problem.
a) Figure 2:
b)
a) Starting triangular mesh and b) highlighted domain describes the patch considered.
The height of the domain, in which the problem is solved, is 30 m, the diameter of the tunnel is 10 m, the distance of the axis of the tunnel from the lower boundary of the domain is 15 m, and the width of the model is 15 m. A triangular mesh is depicted in Fig. 2a), and the starting shape of the patch is displayed in Fig. 2b). In these pictures as well as in the next pictures no tunnel lining is depicted in order not to disturb the contour lines (hypsography). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
524 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The problem starts with the solution of the plastic stage obeying the generalized Mohr-Coulomb hypothesis with the following material parameters: Modulus of elasticity E = 1000 MPa Plastic E = 800 MPa Residual E = 500 MPa Poisson’s ratio ν = 0.25 Plastic equals residual ν = 0.46 Shear strength C = 0.08 MPa Plastic C = 0.06 MPa Residual C = 0.02 MPa tan ϕ = 240 Plastic tan ϕ = 300 Residual tan ϕ = 100 Volume weight ρ = 2100 kg/m3 where ϕ is the angle of internal friction. Using the above said parameters describing material properties, which correspond with the class R3 of the rock according to geological standards. The tunnel lining is made from concrete and no plastic behavior is assumed. After computing the plastic state with the above parameters, the initial stage is created and the eigenstrains can be introduced. The initial shape of the patch is depicted by the highlighted subdomain in Fig. 2b). In this figure also possible movement of one nodal point is illustrated by thick lines. Parameters pi are distances of the patch boundary nodal points from the center of the tunnel in our case. Movement of each point causes also a change in the mesh, as is obvious from Fig. 2b). The measured values were also vertical deflections on the contact of the lining and rock. The values were taken from a scale model built up in stands, as described in [3], for example. There were nine measurement points along the lining; the values at symmetric points were averaged. In Fig. 3a) hypsography of vertical stresses in the starting plastic stage is depicted and in Fig. 3b) hypsography of vertical stresses in the final stage after optimization of the shape of patch is displayed. The difference between these two pictures is not as distinct as supposed, the plastic law and the material properties were selected in a good way, and the influence of the purchase is not too important. From this assertion immediately follows the conclusion that the eigenstrains can be also considered as a measure of error of the plastic law selected. On the other hand, if the choice of the plastic law is wrong, the initial stage starts with elasticity, for instance, as was the case of the previous example, more accurate results can be expected only if more patches are selected, not only one, as in our examples. In Fig. 4a), vertical displacements, which were compared with the measurements on the scale model, are again drawn in the form of hypsography. Important is the fact that at one of the measured points, at point A, the measured vertical displacement was 4.12 cm, so that the results are very versatile. For completeness in Fig. 4b) the shape of the patch in the final stage is also shown. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
a) Figure 3:
6
b)
Vertical stresses in a) plastic stage and b) after optimization.
a) Figure 4:
525
b) a) final displacements and b) shape of the optimal patch.
Conclusions
In some previous papers of the author it has been shown that the coupled numerical and experimental (scale) modeling or the on site measurements can basically improve identification of a numerical mechanical model. The only problem appeared the choice of subdomains (patches). No solution has been proposed so far. This paper tries to improve this lack of information using Inverse variational principles. Although simple examples are presented here, the generalization to more patches is straightforward. It is worth noting that for subdomains of large extent an extensive number of measurements are necessary. In former papers three or at most four subregions have been considered in applications to underground structures, particularly for WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
526 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII assessment of tunnel face stability. The reason consists of the fact that (5) is generally created for 3 in 2D or 6 in 3D components of eigenstrains (or eigenstresses), which means it is necessary to determine at least 24 unknown eigenparameters in 3D for four subdomains in each iterative step. From the point of view of numerical analysis this does not cause any problem, but to feed (5) at least by 25 measurements the original domain Ω can lead to quite a complicated problem or an insufficient set of data.
Acknowledgements The financial support of GAČR, project number 103/06/1124 is appreciated. The research has also been supported by a grant of Ministry of Education of the Czech Republic number MSM6840770001.
References [1] [2]
[3] [4] [5]
G. J. Dvorak, P. P. Prochazka: Thick-walled composite cylinders with optimal fiber prestress, Composites Part B 27B, 643-649, 1996 P. P. Procházka, A. E. Yiakoumi: Nonlinear transformation field analysis of inelastic composite structures, In Proc. Conference on Composites/Nano Engineering, Colorado, Univ. of New Orleans, CD, 2.7.-8.7. 2006. P. P. Procházka, J. Trčková: Coupled Modeling of Concrete Tunnel Lining, In Proc. Our World in Concrete and Structures, Singapore, 2000, 125-132. P. P. Procházka, J. Trčková: Assessment and Control of Tunnel Structures based on coupled modeling. Submitted to Géotechnique. P. P. Procházka: Shape optimal design using Inverse Variational Principles. Submitted to EABE.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
527
Elastic-plastic simulation of plate with a blunt slit subjected to uni-axial tension S. Ohtaki1, S. Kobayashi2 & T. Yamamoto3 1
Department of Mechanical Systems Engineering, Hokkaido Institute of Technology, Japan 2 Actis Co., Japan 3 J-tec Co., Japan
Abstract By the progress of a computer, the elastic-plastic simulation becomes easier under the mathematical assumption. However, results of the numerical analysis of the elastic-plastic problem depend on the assumption of yield conditions, definition of yield points and approximation of the stress-strain diagram of the material and other factors. The best way to testify the precision is to compare the numerical results with the experimental ones. In this paper, the authors study a numerical simulation of the elastic-plastic problem under plane stress by the finite element method. Calculation is executed by using FEM software LUSAS. The plastic theory is based on the strain incremental one, and Prandtl-Reuss equations are used. As a yield condition, von Mises’ one is adopted. The definition of the yield stress is determined by the proportional limit. Three approximations of stress-strain diagrams are selected. To verify the numerical results, an experiment is conducted under the same condition by the photoelastic coating method. However, it is not easy to evaluate the stress distributions from the isochromatic fringes. A numerical example of thin plate with a blunt slit subjected to uni-axial tension is presented. Stress distributions in the minimum cross-section and stress contours are presented and examined. Keywords: structural analysis, finite element method, elastic-plastic problem, stress concentration.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070531
528 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Machines and structures are usually composed of various kinds of metals. Stress concentration due to the existence of cracks or notches in metals causes fracture or failure of the structures. Therefore, it is important to investigate the elasticplastic behavior of metals. The finite element method is one of the most effective tools to deal with the numerical simulation of elastic-plastic problem. Various mathematical methods in the theory of plasticity have been proposed by many researchers [1–3]. Also, Ellyin and Wu analyzed the stationary crack simulation under the cyclic loading containing the effect by the over- loading cycle using their constitutive equations [4]. In this paper, simulation of elastic-plastic problem is studied. To evaluate the validity of the numerical simulation of the elastic-plastic problem by the finite element method, it is desirable to compare the result with an experimental one by the photoelastic coating method (PCM) under the same dimensions and conditions [5,6]. Important factors in the elastic-plastic calculation are the definition of the yield points and the assumption of stress-strain curves [7]. For example, simple prediction of a stress-strain diagram is an approximation with two bi-linear lines, taking the work-hardening ratio constant value during the plastic deformation. There are several ways of the definition of yield points. Numerical simulations are conducted for three cases subjected to the tensile load. The software called LUSAS is used for the numerical calculation so as to consider the convenience and visualization [8]. The incremental step-by-step calculation is adopted in the convergent process of Newton-Raphson method. Numerical example is presented for a rectangular thin plate with a blunt slit subjected to uni-axial tensile load. Stresses and strains in the minimum crosssection and contour lines are shown. The contour lines called quasi-isochromatic fringes by the finite element model are compared with isochromatic ones obtained by the PCM experiment. And the reinforcing effect of the PCM is also simulated by using three-dimensional solid elements.
2
Elastic-plastic theory
2.1 Yield function Considering the second and the third invariants of the deviatoric stress tensor
J 2' and J 3' , the yield condition f for the isotropic materials is written as the next equation. f = F ( J 2' , J 3' )
(1)
Where those two invariants can be expressed using the tensor notation as, J 2' = σ ij' σ ij' / 2 J 3' = σ ij' σ ij' σ ij' / 3
(2)
Assuming that the third invariants J 3' does not affect the yielding behavior, the von Mises yield condition is adopted and it is given as, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
f = 6 j2' − 2σ 2 2 2 = (σ x − σ y ) 2 + (σ y − σ z ) 2 + (σ z − σ x ) 2 + 6(τ yz + τ zy + τ xy ) − 2σ Y2
529 (3)
Under the plane stress, the yield surface is depicted with an elliptical form. 2.2 Constitutive equations The relations between stress and strain increments under the plane stress are written as In the elastic region
{dσ } = [D e ]{ε } where
(4)
{dσ } = {
σ x σ y τ xy
}
(5)
{dε } = {
ε x ε y γ xy
}
(6)
[D ] = 1 −Eν
T
T
1 ν
0 1 −ν 1 2
e
2
ν
(7)
In the plastic region
{dσ } = [D p ]{ε }
(8)
where
[D ] P
E S2 − 1 2 S 1 − ν = SYM .
SS νE − 1 2 S 1 −ν 2 S2 E − 2 2 S 1 −ν
S1 S 6 S S S − 2 6 S 2 S E − 6 2(1 + ν ) S −
(9)
where S=
4 2 ' σ H + S1σ x' + S 2σ y' + 2 S6τ xy 9 E S1 = σ x' + νσ 'y 1 −ν 2 E S2 = σ y' + νσ x' 1 −ν 2 E S6 = τ xy 1 +ν
(10)
(
)
(11)
(
)
(12) (13)
where, E, ν , H ' and σ i' are Young’s modulus, Poisson’s ratio, work-hardening ratio and deviatoric stresses, respectively.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
530 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Finite element calculation
3.1 Configuration Numerical example of a thin plate with a blunt slit under the plane stress has been calculated by the finite element method. Originally, the shape of the model is the same as the specimen conducted by the photoelastic coating method. The material used for the PCM experiment is made of aluminum alloy (A5052PH34) and the mechanical properties are shown in Table 1. Yield surfaces under the plane stress are depicted in Fig.1. The shape of the specimen and its dimensions are shown in Fig. 2. Without taking into account the geometrical symmetric condition, whole specimen is divided into the finite element model as shown in Fig. 3 using auto-mesh function. The total number of elements is 16176, and that of nodal points is 14680. Table 1:
H34
Mechanical properties and yield stress. YOUNG'S POISSON'S MODULUS RATIO GPa 72.7 0.29 σ 2/ σ
YIELD STRESS MPa 120
Y
σ 1/ σ
Y
Tr esca von Mi ses
Figure 1:
von Mises and Tresca yield surfaces.
3.2 Yield points and stress-strain diagram There are many definitions of yield points. We used two kinds of definitions. One is the proportional limit and the other is the intersection between two straight lines. In the elastic-plastic calculation, there are some approximate ways to predict the stress-strain diagram. One of the simplest ways is to approximate with bi-linear lines. The precise prediction of the stress-strain diagram is to use multi-linear lines to express the gradual change of work-hardening ratio H’. In the calculation of the plastic region, we deal with three cases. In the Case 1, the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
531
yield point is the proportional limit and work-hardening ratio is taken as a constant. In the Case 2, the yield point is defined with intersection of the two extrapolated lines and H’ is constant. In the Case 3, stress-strain curve is approximated with twelve straight lines. Stress-strain diagrams for three cases are shown in Fig. 4.
2
3 60
1
10
50
Figure 2:
Rectangular specimen with a blunt slit.
16176 elements, 14680 nodes Figure 3:
Finite element model.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
532 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 4:
4
Stress-strain diagrams of the aluminum alloy.
Numerical results
The stress component σ y of the tensile direction in the minimum cross-section for the Case 1 is presented in Fig. 5 for several loading steps. Similarly,
σ y for
the Case 2 is shown in Fig. 6. In the Cases 1 and 2, as the work-hardening ratios H’ are assumed to be constant, the maximum stresses near the tip of the slit are constant too. 250
250 5880[N]
7840[N]
9800[N]
11760[N]
13720[N]
3920[N] 7840[N] 11760[N]
200
5880[N] 9800[N] 13720[N]
stress[MPa]
strese[MPa]
200
3920[N]
150
150
100
100
50
50
0
0 0
Figure 5:
5
σy
10 distance[mm]
15
20
in the x-axis (Case 1).
0
Figure 6:
5
σy
10 15 distance[mm]
20
in the x-axis (Case 2).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 7:
Quasi-isochromatic fringe by FEM (Py=11760 N).
533
Figure 8: Isochromatic fringe by PCM (Py=11760 N).
The difference of definition of the yield points makes significant difference in the magnitude of stress distribution. In the case 3, the increase of the change of σ y in the plastic range is evident. From this fact, the numerical calculation had conducted using the stress-strain diagram of the case 3.
Figure 9:
Equivalent stress Mises).
σ
without coating in case of Py=8829N (Von
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
534 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 10:
Equivalent stress Mises).
σ
with coating in case of Py=8829N (Von
In the calculation with LUSAS, the von Mises yield criterion is adopted. Therefore, we can easily obtain the contour lines of equivalent stress. To compare the results by PCM experiment, Tresca’s quasi-isochromatic lines that are proportional to the difference of two principal stresses are calculated and shown in Fig. 7 for the case of Py=11760 N. The isochromatic fringes conducted by the PCM experiment are presented in Fig. 8 for the same loading step. The tendency of these results is roughly similar to each other, though quantitative analysis is not adequate yet due to the limitation of the maximum number of color values of the software. Thus, without complicated calculation of stress and strains of PCM experimental procedure, the validity of the results by the finite element can be assured by the comparison of these two Figs. 7 and 8. It is known that if the stiffness of the polymer coating which is adhered on the surface of the specimen in the PCM is larger compared with the surface metal, the reinforcing effect is not negligible. We have calculated the reinforcing effect with three-dimensional solid elements taking account of the stiffness in the thickness direction of the aluminum plate and polymer. The contour lines of equivalent stress σ without coating in case of Py=8829 N are shown in Fig. 9. Similarly, contour lines of σ with coating are shown in Fig.10. However, from these figures, the comparison of the quantities of the equivalent stress is not clear because of the difference of the color scale. By plotting the equivalent stress in the minimum cross-section, the reinforcing effect is calculated as 6 percent.
5 Conclusion In this paper, the finite element simulation has been conducted for the thin plate with a blunt slit subjected to uni-axial tension. Three cases had been calculated WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
535
with different definition of yield points and the approximation of stress-strain diagrams in the proportional tensile load. The stress distribution in the minimum cross-section and stress contour lines are obtained.
(1) The definition of yield point affects the magnitude of the distribution of stress state in plastic range greatly. The best approximation of stressstrain diagram is to use the proportional limit as the yield point and multi-linear work-hardening ratios of case 3. (2) The evolution of elastic-plastic boundaries is roughly similar to those obtained by the photoelastic coating experiment. However, quantitative analysis is not adequate in the present method. (3) The reinforcing effect of the polymer of the PCM experiment is simulated by three dimensional solid elements. It is found that the reinforced effect is about 6 percent which coincide with theoretical value.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
Marcal, P.V. and King, I.P., Elastic-plastic analysis of two-dimensional stress by the finite element method, International Journal of Mechanical Science, 9-3, pp. 143-155, 1967. Zienkiwitcz, O.C., The finite element method, Third Ed. McGraw-Hill, 1977. Owen, D.R.J. and Hinton, E., Finite element in Plasticity (Theory and Practice), Pineridge Press Limited, Swansea, UK, 1980. Ellyin, F. and Wu, J., Elastic-plastic analysis of a stationary crack under cyclic loading and effect of over load, International Journal of Fracture, 56, pp. 189-208, 1992. Zandman, F. et al., Photoelastic Coating, ISU Press & SEM, 1977. Theocaris, P.S., Experimental Mechanics, 3-9, 1963. Ikegami, K., A Historical Perspective of the Experimental Study of Subsequent Yield Surface for Metal-Part 1.2, British Industrial & Scientific International Translation Service, pp.1-33, 1976. LUSAS theory manual Version 13, FEA Ltd., UK, 2000.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
537
A simplified shear strength evaluation model for reinforced concrete corbels J. K. Lu1, S. Y. Kuo2, J. Y. Lin1 & S. H. Hsu3 1
Department of Civil Engineering, National Pingtung University of Science and Technology, Taiwan ROC 2 Department of Civil Engineering, De Lin Institute of Technology, Taiwan ROC 3 New Construction Office, Taipei City Government, Taiwan ROC
Abstract A shear strength model for reinforced concrete corbels is developed by modifying the softened strut-and-tie model. Using the concept of Lu and Wu, the constitutive equation is developed. Then, the constitutive equation is combined with the equilibrium equations of Hwang and Lee. The model is used to predict the shear strength of reinforced concrete corbels. The results of the model are compared with the experimental data and the results of ACI code. Keywords: softened strut-and-tie model, reinforced concrete corbels, shear strength.
1
Introduction
Corbels are cantilevers having shear span-to-depth ratios not greater than unity, which tend to control by shear as a deep beam, rather than flexural members. Reinforced concrete corbels are becoming a common feature in building construction. Simple design procedures to produce safe and economic corbels are therefore required. Much research is carried into investigation about the shear strength of corbels. In test, the most common modes of failure of corbels are crushing or splitting of the compression strut. ACI 318-95 [3] used the shear-friction method to calculate the shear capacities of corbels. It is shown that most of the shear capacities of corbels calculated by ACI code are underestimated [4–6]. ACI 318-02 [7] provides the strut-and-tie model as an alternate method to WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070541
538 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII calculate the shear capacities of corbels. A softened strut-and-tie model for predicting the shear strengths of reinforced concrete corbels is proposed by Hwang et al [4]. It is based on the strut-and-tie concept with satisfying equilibrium, compatibility and the constitutive law of concrete. Hwang and Lee [2] modified the softened strut-and-tie model to develop a simple predicting procedure. But, the procedure is still complicate. To further simplify the design procedure, the present paper developed a shear strength model for reinforced concrete corbels. Using the concept of Lu and Wu [1], the constitutive equation is developed. Then, the constitutive equation is applied with the equilibrium equations of Hwang and Lee [2]. The results of the present model are compared with the results of ACI code and the experimental data from published papers [6, 8–11].
2
The ACI model
The design procedure for corbels given by section 11.9 in ACI-02 [7] code is based on the shear-friction method. The shear capacity of the corbel Vn is obtained by:
Vn = µAvf f y
(1)
Vn ≤ 0.2 f c' bw d
(2)
Vn ≤ 5.6bw d
(3)
with
and
where Avf represents the area of shear-friction reinforcement; µ is coefficient of friction; bw is the web width and d is the distance from extreme compression fiber to centroid of tension reinforcement; f y represents the yield strength of '
reinforcement and f c represents the compressive strength of concrete.
3
The present model
In this paper, a simplified shear strength model for reinforced concrete corbels is developed by modifying the softened strut-and-tie model. The constitutive equation is developed by using the concept of Lu and Wu [1]. The diagonal compression stress is defined in terms of the yield strength of reinforced steel and the compression strength of concrete. Then, the constitutive equation is combined with the equilibrium equations of Hwang and Lee [2]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
539
3.1 Equilibrium equations The force equilibrium of a diagonal compression using a strut-and-tie perspective is shown in figure 1.
(a)
(b) (Hwang et al [4]) Figure 1:
The softened strut-and-tie model of corbel.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
540 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The vertical shear force Vv can be obtained by:
Vv = C d sin θ
(4)
where Cd represents the diagonal compression and the θ denotes the angle of inclination of the diagonal with respect to the compression horizontal axis. Also, the horizontal shear force Vh can be obtained by:
Vh = C d cosθ
(5)
By using the equation (4) and (5), following relationship can be obtained by:
Vv A v = = tan θ Vh A h
(6)
Then, the angle of inclination θ can be obtained:
Av Ah
θ = tan −1
(7)
where lv and lh represent the internal level arms of the vertical and horizontal shear couples, respectively. According to linear bending theory, the lv and lh can be obtained as:
lh = a
(8)
l v = jd
(9)
and
with the lever arm jd can be estimated as:
jd = d −
kd 3
(10)
where a presents the shear span and the kd represents the depth of the compression zone at the section with the coefficient k.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
541
The coefficient k is chosen as 0.375 [12] in this paper. Equation (10) can be expressed as:
jd = 0.875d
(11)
Substituting equations (8) and (11) into equation (7), we obtain
0.875d a
θ = tan −1
(12)
3.2 Constitutive laws The constitutive equation of concrete used by Hwang and Lee [2] is:
C d = Kζ f c' Astr
(13)
where K is the strut-and-tie index, ζ denotes softening coefficient, Astr is the effective area of the diagonal strut. Equation (13) is first suggested by Zhang and Jirsa [13]. The effective area of the diagonal strut Astr used by Hwang and Lee [2] is:
Astr = a s bs
(14)
with
a s = kd
(15)
where a s represents the depth of the diagonal strut, bs represents the width of the diagonal strut which can be taken as width of the corbel. The coefficient k is chosen as 0.375 [12] in this paper. Equation (15) can be expressed as:
a s = 0 .375 d
(16)
Substituting equation (17) into equation (15), we obtain:
Astr = 0.375dbs
(17)
Instead of equation (13), the compression strength Cd is redefined in present paper as:
C d = σ d Astr WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(18)
542 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII where σd represents the diagonal compression stress. In this paper, the diagonal compression stress σd is defined in terms of the yield strength of reinforced steel and the compression strength of concrete. Based on the concept of Lu and Wu [1], the σd is defined by this paper as:
σd = f1 (ρh , f yh ) + f 2 (f 'c )
(19)
where ρ h represents the ratio of horizontal reinforced steel and f yh represents the yield strength of horizontal reinforced steel. The first terms of equation (18), f1 (ρh , f yh ) present the effect of reinforced steel and the second term, f 2 (f 'c ) presents the effect of the compressive strength of concrete. In this paper, f1 (ρh , f yh ) and f 2 (f 'c ) are determined by fitting the proposed model to the experimental data of Foster, Powell and Selim [9]. It is based on that the average of ratio of the calculated shear strength Vv to experimental result Vt is 1.00. There are:
f1 (ρh , f yh ) =0.59 ρh f yh
(20)
and
f 2 (f 'c ) = 0.53f c' − 0.00143(f c' ) 2 with
f c' in MPa. Then, equation (19) can be expressed as: σd = 0.59ρh f yh + 0.53f c' − 0.00143(f c' ) 2
4
(21)
(22)
The procedure of numerical calculation
The procedure of determining the shear force corresponding to the reinforced concrete corbels is now further described. In this application, the
ρ h , f c' , f yv
a , bs, d, ρ v ,
and f yh are known. The procedure of the calculation for the
shear force case is shown in figure 2 and described as follows: Step 1. Calculate Astr by use of equation (18), Astr = 0.375dbs Step 2. Calculate θ by use of equation (12),
0.875d a
θ = tan −1
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
543
Step 3. Calculate σd by use of equation (22),
σd = 0.59ρh f yh + 0.53f c' − 0.00143(f c' ) 2 Step 4. Calculate Cd by use of equation (14), C d = σ d Astr Step 5. Calculate Vv by use of equation (4), Vv = C d sin θ
Figure 2:
Comparison of the theoretical results with experimental data.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
544 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Comparison of theoretical and experimental results
A total of 105 experimental data from the literature are used to compare with the present model. The experimental data are from Foster et al [9], Lin [11], Fattuhi and Hughes [8], Yong and Balaguru [6], and Fattuhi [10]. The calculated shear strength of present model and ACI code Vv are compared with the experimental results Vt. Figure 2(a) shows the theoretical results and the experimental data of Lin [11], Fattuhi and Hughes [8], and Fattuhi [10]. Figure 2(b) shows the theoretical results and the experimental data of Foster et al [9] and Yong and Balaguru [6]. It is seen that the ACI code are under estimate and the present model is quite satisfactory. Table 1:
The theoretical results and experimental data.
Author
Number of specimen
Foster et al [9]
22
Lin [11]
24
Ali and White [5]
11
Yong and Balaguru [6]
11
Fattuhi and Hughes [8]
37
Total
Vv Vt
105
ACI code AVG COV AVG COV AVG COV AVG COV AVG COV AVG COV
0.52 0.31 0.46 0.22 0.48 0.12 0.21 0.23 0.84 0.20 0.580 0.457
Present model 1.00 0.23 0.90 0.20 1.02 0.07 1.05 0.12 0.87 0.18 0.917 0.180
The average (AVG) and the coefficient of variation (COV) of the ratio of the calculated shear strength Vv to experimental result Vt is calculated and shown in table 1. It is noted that the AVG of the present model and ACI code, with respected to total experimental data, are 0.917 and 0.580, respectively. It is shown that the shear strength calculated from present model is closer to the experimental data than the shear strength calculated from ACI code. The COV of present model and ACI code are 0.180 and 0.457, respectively. It is shown that the calculated results from present model are more stable than the results from ACI code.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
6
545
Concluding remarks
In this paper, a shear strength model for reinforced concrete corbels is developed by modifying the softened strut-and-tie model. Using the concept of Lu and Wu [1], the constitutive equation is developed. Then, the constitutive equation is combined with the equilibrium equations of Hwang, and Lee [2]. Present model are used to predict the shear strength of reinforced concrete corbel. The results of present model are compared with the experimental data and the results of ACI code. It is seen that present model are compares quite well.
Acknowledgement The authors would like to thank the financial support provided by the National Science Council, Taiwan.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10]
Lu, J.K., & Wu, W.H., The application of soften truss model with plastic approach for reinforced concrete beams, Structural Engineering and Mechanics, An International Journal, 11(4), pp. 393-406, 2001. Hwang, S.J., & Lee, H.J., Strength prediction for discontinuity regions by softened strut-and-tie model, Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, 128(12), pp. 1519-1526, 2002. ACI Committee 318, Building Code Requirements for Structural Concrete (ACI 318-95) and Commentary (ACI 318R-95), American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, Michigan, USA, 1995. Hwang, S.J., Lu, W.Y., & Lee, H.J., Shear strength prediction for reinforced concrete corbels, ACI Structural Journal, 97(4), pp. 543-552, 2000. Ali, M. A. & White, R. N., Consideration of compression stress bulging and strut degradation in truss modeling of ductile and brittle corbels, Engineering Structures, 23, pp. 240–249, 2001. Yong, Y. K. & Balaguru, P., Behavior of reinforced high-strengthconcrete corbels, Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, 120(4), pp. 1182-1201, 1994. ACI Committee 318, Building Code Requirements for Structural Concrete (ACI 318-02) and Commentary (ACI 318R-02), American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, Michigan, USA, 2002. Fattuhi, N.I., & Hughes, B.P., Ductility of reinforced concrete corbels containing either steel fibers or stirrups, ACI Structural Journal, 86(6), pp. 644-651, 1989. Foster, S.J., Powell, R.E., & Selim, H.S., Performance of high-strength concrete corbels, ACI Structural Journal, 93(5), pp. 555-563, 1996. Fattuhi, N.I., Strength of FRP corbels in flexure, Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, 120(2), pp. 360-377, 1994. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
546 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [11] [12] [13]
Lin, R.-D., Behavior of Reinforced Concrete Corbels, Master thesis, Department of construction engineering, National Taiwan University of Science and Technology, Taiwan, 2002. Nilson, A.H., Design of Concrete Structure. 11th Ed, McGraw-Hill, NY, USA, pp. 146, 1997. Zhang, L. & Jirsa, J. O., A study of shear behavior of reinforced concrete beam-column joints, PMFSEL Rep. No. 82-1, Department of Civil Engineering, University of Texas, Austin, TX, USA, 1982.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
547
Post-buckling behaviour of a slender beam in a circular tube, under axial load M. Gh. Munteanu1 & A. Barraco2 1 2
Transilvania University of Brasov, Romania Ecole Nationale Supérieure d'Arts et Métiers ENSAM), Paris, France
Abstract This paper deals with the study of the behaviour of a slender beam introduced in a cylindrical tube and subjected to an axial compressive force. The beam is very long compared to its transversal dimensions and therefore it will buckle to a very small axial force. The post-buckling behaviour is examined. The study has important applications in the petroleum industry, for coiled tubing in the case of drilling in horizontal or inclined wellbores. The slender beam has a constant cross-section that can have any form, although a circular cross-section is the most used in practice. The problem has a geometrical non-linearity to which the non-linearity caused by the friction has to be added. Rotations could be large and a special isoparametric 3D beam finite element is elaborated: the EulerRodrigues quaternion was preferred to describe the finite cross-section rotations. The paper presents only the static case, but extending the presented approach to dynamic analysis is quite natural. The method is very accurate and it is rapidly convergent due to the fact that the exact equations, written for the deformed configuration, are solved. The iterative Newton-Raphson method was used to solve the nonlinear differential equations. Keywords: coiled tubing, finite element method, post-buckling behaviour, Euler quaternion, geometrical non-linearity.
1
Introduction
A long slender initially straight beam compressed and constrained within a circular cylinder is studied in this work. This problem presents a great interest in rock engineering and petroleum production. The beam buckles within the narrow space of a drill hole under the action of axial force and its own weight. Due to its WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070551
548 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII length, the beam will first buckle according to the classic Euler formula, a sinusoidal buckling, when the displacements are considered infinitely small. The post-buckling behaviour is much more important because the beam lies on the cylinder and friction will occur that diminishes the axial load transmission. The problem is highly complicated because it involves a geometrical non-linearity to which the friction has to be added. Several theoretical models were proposed, all of them based on analytical models, some of them complicated, [1, 2], or based on simplified (or even very simple) models using in general a variational approach, [3–12]. Experimental measurements were performed as well: some works are based only on experiments, [13, 14], while in other works the experiments were meant to verify the theoretical models, [1, 2, 4, 11, 12]. Almost all theoretical models assume that post-buckling shape is a helix that is not always true. Some of them consider even a constant pitch helix that it is obviously not exact mainly when the friction is taken into consideration, [4, 12]. In this work a numerical method based on finite element method is proposed. A special type of finite element is presented, based on some previous works, [15–17]. This finite element type is specially conceived for geometrical nonlinear beam systems and uses Euler-Rodrigues quaternion and the axial strain as generalized coordinates. It allows a very exact and fast convergent numerical model to be elaborated. The beam is initially straight and lies along a generatrix; it lies always on the cylindrical surface even after deformation due to the axial force. Two boundary conditions were examined, clamped-free beam and double hinged beam; significantly different results were obtained for these two cases.
2
Beam theory
Because of beam length, the Euler-Bernoulli beam theory is applied. The beam is considered initially straight and it has a constant cross-section. The first variation of the total potential energy has the expression:
δΠ = δU + δV = EA∫ δε 0 Τ ε 0 ds + ∫ δκ Τ Dκ ds − ∫ δu T pds + ∫ δϕ mds = 0. l l
l l δU
(1)
δV
where U is the deformation energy, V is the potential of the external load, u is the displacement vector, ϕ represents the small rotation vector, p and m are the distributed force vector and the distributed moment vector, respectively, acting on the beam. Efforts and strains are linked by the relations (Hooke’s low):
N = EA ε 0 , M = Dκ ,
(2)
where N is the axial effort, E is the Young modulus, A the cross-section area and ε0 is the axial deformation of the beam centreline; the moment vector M and the curvature κ have following expressions in the local reference frame:
M = (M 1
M2
M 3 ) , κ = (κ 1 κ 2 κ 3 ) T
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
549
Mt is the torque and M2, M3 are the bending moments; κ1 , κ 2 and κ 3 are the torsion and the two curvatures, that is the variation of angles between two local reference frames situated at the infinitesimal distance ds .The Hooke’s low matrix D is M t GI t M = Dκ or M 2 0 M 0 3
0 EI 2 0
0 κ 1 0 κ 2 . EI 3 κ 3
(4)
It, I2 and I3 are second order geometrical properties of the cross-section (I2 and I3 are the principal inertia moments); G is the transversal elasticity modulus. The main difficulty in 3D geometrical non-linear study, in classical incremental formulation, is that the rotations form no longer a vector. This is why in this work the Euler-Rodrigues parameters are used to describe crosssection rotation, [15–17]. They are defined for a finite rotation of angle θ around T the axis defined by the unit vector ν = (ν x ν y ν z ) . The rotation is
θ
θ
and by the vector sin ν grouped in the 2 2 following column matrix, the well-known Euler-Rodrigues quaternion: represented by the scalar l 0 = cos
T
θ θ θ θ ν x sin ν y sin ν z sin = (l0 , l1 , l 2 , l3 ) T . l = cos 2 2 2 2
(5)
In this work the finite rotation θ transforms the initial infinite small length element ds of the initial straight beam into the final position due to its deformation. The four Euler-Rodrigues parameters must verify the relation: lTl = 1 .
(6)
Knowing the Euler-Rodrigues parameters, the rotation matrix from the initial configuration to the actual one, for each cross-section, has the form:
(
)
2 l02 + l12 − 1 2(l1l2 − l0 l3 ) 2(l1l3 + l0 l2 ) ℜ = 2(l1l2 + l0 l3 ) 2 l02 + l22 − 1 2(l2 l3 − l0 l1 ) . 2(l1l3 − l0 l2 ) 2(l2 l3 + l0 l1 ) 2 l02 + l32 − 1
(
)
(
)
(7)
To solve the problem, the total potential energy (1) has to be minimized and usually numerical methods are used, finite element method being the most effective. The classical large displacement finite element approach considers as nodal unknowns (nodal generalized coordinates) small increments of nodal displacements and rotations and this approach leads to an extremely timeconsuming incremental formulation. In this work the unknowns are axial deformation ε 0 and the four EulerRodrigues parameters l. They are grouped into the generalized coordinate vector: q = (ε 0
l0
l1 l 2
l3 ) . T
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(8)
550 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Curvature vector may be easily expressed in Euler-Rodrigues parameters as:
κ = Gl ′ ,
(9)
where l ′ is the space derivative that is with respect to the curvilinear coordinates s. The G matrix has the form: − l1 G = 2 − l2 − l3
l0
l3
− l3
l0
l2
− l1
− l2 l1 . l0
(10)
The equations are written in the actual reference frame of the current crosssection and therefore the spatial derivatives are performed with respect of actual curvilinear coordinate S different of the curvilinear coordinate s for the initial configuration. As the small strain hypothesis was considered, we may consider that the length of the beam keep its length during the deformation: dS = (1 + ε 0 )ds ≈ ds . Thus the following symbolic expression may be written: ∂ ∂ ≈ . ∂S ∂s In the local reference frame, virtual small rotation vector is expressed in EulerRodrigues parameters as:
δ Lϕ = Gδl
(11)
δϕ = ℜGδl .
(12)
and in the global reference frame: Finally the displacements vector u of the current point has the form: 2(l02 + l12 ) - 1 1 u( s ) = u0 + (ℜn(1 + ε 0 ) − n)ds = u0 + 2(l1l 2 + l0 l3 ) (1 + ε 0 ) − 0 ds , (13) 0 0 0 2(l1l3 − l0 l 2 ) s
∫
s
∫
where n is the unit vector perpendicular to cross-section. Now there are all the ingredients to solve numerically the problem using the variational formulation (1).
3
Kinematic equations
In the case of the beam in contact with the tube, the deformed shape of the beam is given by the equations: x = x (s ) y = R cosϕ (s ) . z = R sin ϕ (s )
(14)
The following relations exists between angles θ, ϕ (see figure 1) and the abscise x (for small axial strain ε 0 ): WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
dx = sin θ ds cosθds dϕ = R
or
dx ds , dϕ cosθ = ds R
551
sin θ =
or
(15)
R being the radius of the tube, figure 1. Therefore the director parameters of an infinite small segment ds of the beam centre-line are: dx = sin θ , ds
dy = − R cosθ sin ϕ , ds
dz = R cosθ cosϕ , ds
(16)
where the angles θ and ϕ result from figure 1.That must coincide to the first column of the matrix ℜ given by (7): 1 + sin θ 2 2 l0 + l1 = 2 cosθ sin ϕ . l l l l + = − 12 0 3 2 l1l3 − l0 l 2 = cosθ cosϕ 2
(17)
It is easy to show that the Euler-Rodrigues parameters satisfying equations (17), satisfy also equation (6). The pipe (beam)
θ
R
ds
z
x
ϕ y
dx The tube Figure 1:
Definition of angles θ and ϕ.
The system resulting from (1) is nonlinear and the iterative Newton-Raphson method will be applied, that is at each iteration the system is solved in unknown increments. Equations (17) become in increments: l0 l3 - l 2
l1
l2
l3
l2
l1
l0
l3
- l0
l1
0 1 cosθ cosϕ 2 1 cosθ sin ϕ 2
δl0 0 0 δl1 0 δl 0 1 − sin θ sin ϕ 2 = , 2 δl3 0 1 sin θ cosϕ δϕ 0 2 δθ 0
to which the incremental form of the second equation (15) is added: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(18)
552 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII s
s
sin θδθ (1 + ε 0 )ds + ∫ cosθ δε 0ds . R R 0 0
δϕ = − ∫
(19)
Equations (18) and (19) represent the relations between the increments of EulerRodrigues parameters and the increments of the two angles θ and ϕ. There are 4 equations, linking 7 unknown functions, ε 0 , l0 , l1 , l2 , l3 , θ , ϕ , imposing the deformed beam to lie on the internal surface of a tube of radius R. Therefore only 3 independent generalized coordinates were chosen: T qˆ = (ε 0 l1 θ ) . (20)
4
Friction forces
Between the beam and the lateral surface of the tube there are reaction forces. Moment equilibrium equations for a slice of the beam, written in the local reference frame of each cross-section, is: ∂M ∂ (κ ) + n × R = 0 or D + κ × (D κ ) + n × R = 0 . ∂s ∂s
(21)
After each iteration, the generalized coordinates qˆ are known and the EulerRodrigues parameters are known as well; that allow the curvatures κ to be found. The axial effort N and the two shear efforts Q2 and Q3 (the components of the vector R) are computed using equation (21). Finally, from the force equilibrium equation written in the cross section local reference frame: ∂R +κ × R + p = 0 ∂s
(22)
it results the contact pressure p between the beam and the tube. Distributed force p will be represented in the cylindrical reference frame. Axes of the cylindrical reference frame are: 1 – x direction of the global frame (see figure 1), 2- normal direction and 3 – tangent direction in the yz global plane. The normal distributed force is p2 . The friction force cannot exceed the value µ p2 , where µ is the friction coefficient. If the tangential force is smaller than µ p2 , there is no relative motion between the points in contact belonging to the beam and to the tube. In any point the following condition must be respected: ~ p12 + ~ p 32 ≤ µ~ p2 ,
(23)
otherwise the “link” is broken and a relative motion is allowed. At each load step few iterations are needed in order to establish which among all nodes are moving and which are not because of the friction. The tube is compressed by an axial force with the condition that the tube always lies on the surface of the tube. In the absence of the friction the method is not incremental and the solution may be find directly for the final load of the load. But in the presence of the friction the approach must be incremental, the result depending on the history of the force variation. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
5
553
Two-node and three-node finite elements.
Special finite element
To solve the problem, finite element method was applied. Isoparametric twonode and three-node finite elements were used, figure 2. This finite element is described in detail in [15–17]. Each node has five degrees of freedom per node accordingly to (8). For the three-node finite element the shape function is:
s2 s2 s s s2 qk,i-1 + ( − 2 + 1) qk ,i + ( 2 + ) qk ,i +1 , k = 1...5 . (24) qk ( s ) = 2 − 2h 2h 2h h 2h The beam is divided in several finite elements and the load is applied incrementally. Finally a non-linear differential system is obtained from functional (1) using a procedure similar to the standard one:
E (q ) = K (q )q − Q = 0 ,
(25)
where K is the secant stiffness matrix that is function of q, obtained by assembling elemental stiffness matrices; q is the vector of the generalized nodal unknown (8) for the whole structure and Q is the vector of nodal loads. System (25) includes the equation (6) for each node. It is interesting to note that all elements of secant stiffness matrix K are polynomials in Euler-Rodrigues l and strain ε 0 . To solve the non-linear system, the iterative Newton-Raphson method is applied. At each step, at each iteration, equations (18) and (19) are used in order to replace nodal degrees of freedom (8) with (20), to impose the beam to lie on the cylindrical surface of the tube. In the load step i and for the k-th iteration it can be written: ˆ (k )δqˆ (k +1) + Eˆ (k ) = 0 , K i t
(26)
where: ˆ C , E = CE ˆ, q = Cqˆ , K t = C T K t
(27)
C being a square matrix provided by applying of equations (18) and (19) for all nodes of the discretization and δqˆ i(k +1) = qˆ i(k +1) − qˆ i(k ) . Kt is the tangent stiffness modulus, in fact the Jacobean J: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
554 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII J = Kt =
∂E . ∂q
(28)
The approximate evaluation of the Jacobean may be used, although in the paper the exact computing were performed: Kt ≈ K +
∂Q . ∂q
(29)
Often an under-relaxation factor β could improve the convergence: qˆ i(+k1+ 1 ) = qˆ i(+k1) + βδqˆ i(+k1+ 1 ) .
(30)
Angle θ [o]
z
18 16 14 12 10 8
θ
6 4 2 0
-8 -6 -4 -2
0
y
Axial force [N]
a) Rotation angle θ of the mid node versus axial b) Beam (pipe) view along x force. axis, the beam axis. Figure 3:
6
Post-buckling diagram.
Numerical example
To illustrate the method a MATLAB program was elaborate and the following example was analyzed, [6, 7, 13]: double hinged beam (pipe), length L=21340 mm, outer pipe diameter D=13.72 mm, inner pipe diameter d=6.35 mm, diameter of the tube D0=48.26 mm, Young modulus E=2.07e5 MPa, Poisson coefficient ν=0.3, 30 3-node finite elements, 61 nodes. Figure 3 shows the dependence angle θ versus axial force, dependence found by the computer code. The Euler buckling force is 7.45 N (see figure 3a) and much higher force values were studied. Figure 4 presents the deformation configuration of the pipe under an axial force of 800 N. One can see that the shape is not exactly a helix: the symmetry about the plane perpendicular on the beam, on the mid-node, has to be ensured. On the contrary, figure 5 shows the unsymmetrical deformed configuration of a clamped-free beam. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
a) Isometric view (view direction: [1; 0.006; 0.003]) Figure 4:
555
b) View along x axis, the hole axis.
Post-buckling shape of a double hinged beam; compression force 800 N. Clamped end
Free end
View direction: [1; 0.005; 0.005].
Figure 5:
7
Post buckling configuration for a compressed clamped-free beam.
Conclusions
In the case of complex structural problems, numerical methods, especially those based on finite element method, may describe much more exactly the real phenomenon than analytical methods. This is also the case for long and slender beam compressed in a cylinder tube, the topic of the present work. A special finite element type, mainly conceived for geometrical non-linearity of beam systems, was proposed which proved to be fast convergent and exact. Equilibrium equations are exact and written on the deformed configuration of the beam: this is possible only because the generalized nodal coordinates are the elements of Euler-Rodrigues quaternion and the axial strain. In this way the boundary conditions can be described better and a significant influence of boundary conditions was found even for quite long beams (pipes).
References [1]
Sorenson, K.G., Post buckling behavior of a circular rod constrained within circular cylinder, PhD thesis, Rice University, Houston, Texas, 1984. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
556 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17]
Chen, Yu-Che, Post buckling behavior of a circular rod constrained within an inclined hole, PhD thesis, Rice University, Houston, Texas, 1988. Miska, A & Cunha, J.C., An analysis of helical Buckling of Tubulars Subjected to axial and torsional Loading in inclined wellbores, Society of Petroleum Engineers, SPE 29460, pp. 173-180, 1995. Tan, X.C. & Forsman, B., Buckling of slender string in cylindrical tube under axial load: experiments and theoretical analysis, Experimental Mechanics, 35(1), pp. 55-60, 1995. Jang Wu & Juvkam-Wold, H.C., Coiled tubing buckling implication in drilling and completing horizontal wells, SPE Drilling & Completion, March, pp. 16-21, 1995. Miska, S., Qiu, W., Volk L. & Cuhna, J.C., An improved analysis of axial force along coiled tubing in inclined, horizontal wellbores, Society of Petroleum Engineers, SPE 37056, pp. 207-214, 1996. Kuru, E., Martinez, A. & Miska, S., The buckling behavior of pipes and its influence on the axial force transfer in directional wells, Society of Petroleum Engineers, SPE 53840, pp. 1-9, 1999. Qiu, W, Force transmission of coiled tubing in horizontal wells, Society of Petroleum Engineers, SPE 54584, pp. 1-7, 1999. Mitchell, R.F., Exact analytic solutions for pipe buckling in vertical and horizontal wells, SPE Journal, December, pp. 35-51, 2002. Mitchell, R.F., Lateral Buckling of pipes with connectors in horizontal wells, SPE Journal, June, pp. 41-52, 2003. Gao, De-Li, Gao, Bao-Kui, A method for calculating tubing behavior in HPHT wells, Journal of Petroleum Science & Engineering, 41, pp. 183188, 2004. Sun, C. & Lukasiewicz, S., A new method on the buckling of a rod in tubing, Journal of Petroleum Science & Engineering, 50, pp.78-82, 2006. Martinez, A., Miska, S., Kuru, E. & Sorem, J., Experimental Evaluation of the Lateral Contact Force in Horizontal Wells, Journal of Energy Resources Technology, 122(3), pp. 123-128, 2000. Kuru, E. Martinez, A., Miska, S. & Qiu, W., The buckling behavior of pipes and its influence on the axial force transfer in directional wells, Journal of Energy Resources Technology, 122(3), pp. 129-135, 2000. Barraco, A. & Munteanu, M.Gh., A special finite element for static and dynamic study of mechanical systems under large motion”, part 1, Revue européenne des éléments finis, Vol. 11(6), pp.773-790, 2002. Munteanu, M.Gh. & Barraco, A., A special finite element for static and dynamic study of mechanical systems under large motion”, part 2, Revue européenne des éléments finis, Vol. 11(6), pp.791-814, 2002. Barraco, A. & Munteanu, M.Gh., Dynamic study of elastic beam systems under large motion, Proc. of European Congress on Computational Methods in Applied Sciences and Engineering, ECCOMAS, Finland, 24 28 July, published in extensor on CD, 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
557
Structural properties of a new material made of waste paper J. Santamaria1, B. Fuller2 & A. Fafitis1 1
Department of Civil and Environmental Engineering, Arizona State University, USA 2 Center for Alternative Building Studies, USA
Abstract Papercrete is the name of a new construction material made basically of waste paper, cement and water. Contractors have started using papercrete to build low cost houses relying on empirical knowledge of its structural properties. The purpose of this study is to obtain some mechanical and physical parameters of papercrete by doing several laboratory tests. The samples tested were made following the most common procedures that papercrete makers are currently using. The experimental setup used to test the samples is briefly described and some test results are presented. Some conclusions and recommendations for the use of papercrete for building houses are also presented. Keywords: waste paper, recycling, sustainability, low-cost housing, greenconstruction.
1
Introduction
The necessity of low-cost housing has pushed people to look for alternative construction materials. “Papercrete” is a relatively new material basically made of waste paper, cement, and water. Papercrete is a slightly misleading name. It seems to imply a mix of paper and concrete, hence papercrete. But more accurately, only the Portland cement part of concrete is used in the mix – along with other admixtures. Although some sand and other additives to improve its behavior under compressive load may be used, the basic components are still the same. According to the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), the United States recycles about 45% of discarded paper annually, U.S. EPA, 2000 [10]. This WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070561
558 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII means that about 55% or 48 million tons of paper is thrown away or goes into the landfills. Conservatively speaking, it takes about fifteen trees to make a ton of paper. That means that 720 million trees are used once and then buried in a landfill each year. The volume of the paper material wasted every year is equivalent to the volume of a wall 48 feet high and 1 foot wide, around the entire perimeter of the United States, Fig. 1.
Figure 1:
Waste paper wall around the U.S.A. made of waste paper.
At the same time, in Arizona and many other states, there is a pressing need for affordable, sustainable housing. On Native American lands in Arizona alone, there is an immediate and pressing need for tens of thousands of homes. According to a report by the Arizona Housing Commission, “The urgent overriding message is clear; housing affordability is an impending crisis in Arizona”, Arizona Housing Commission, 2000 [1]. The research and testing on papercrete is very limited or nonexistent. From a scientific standpoint papercrete is, for all practical purposes, invisible. To the best of our knowledge there is no systematic experimental or analytical study of this material. So there are few ways to reference papercrete because there are no antecedents in research - only locations, structures and people who have built them. Some parallel work has been done on fiber cement composites for roofing and siding, Mohr et al. 2004 [5], but to our knowledge, no formal research. The purpose of this research is to determine if papercrete has suitable mechanical and physical properties so that it can be used as a construction material for houses, to find out what anecdotal evidence about it is accurate, and to determine areas of further study, if any. The parameters to be studied are the Young’s Modulus (E), thermal conductivity (K), thermal resistance (R), bond characteristics, and creep behavior.
2
Anecdotal evidence
As part of the search for anecdotal evidence several papercrete structures were visited and practitioners were interviewed. It was found that the locations of the structures represent a cross-section of climate and geography. Many of these structures are standing for years and they are quite attractive, Fig. 2. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
559
Papercrete structures are attractive, and said to have a number of positive properties.
Homes and other buildings of up to 3200 square feet have been built with papercrete for $25 per square foot, not including labor. Finished designer homes made of papercrete have cost $70-$80 per square foot, with labor included. There seems to be no harmful by-products or excessive use of energy in the production of papercrete, Hart 2004 [3]. Current mixes can be produced using electric motors powered by solar energy, McCain 2004 [4]. Since the mortar, exterior stucco and interior plaster used with papercrete is made of the same paper material, much wood and other construction materials used in framing and "building out" the interior and exterior of the home is saved. With an R-Value between 2.0 and 3.0 per inch, U.S. DOE 2002 [9], in walls 12 to16 inches thick, the long-term energy savings of buildings with papercrete is considerable for the homeowner and the environment. Papercrete is reported to have good sound absorption quality. It's also reported to be flame and fungus retardant, as well as bug, rodent and pest resistant, Patterson 2004 [6]. Since it is very light, it would be an ideal interior wall material for high-rise buildings in active seismic areas. Using it in place of concrete would reduce the gauge of steel framework and the depth of foundations - cutting materials, labor and energy costs significantly. Papercrete wall and roof material is, in itself, insulation. It surrounds, supports and insulates the structure's climate control, plumbing, and electrical systems. Communication, security, fire, moisture and structural stress monitors can be run between courses of the material during construction or cut into the walls after completion, Terry 2004 [7]. Vaults and domes made of papercrete have been built, Fig. 3, on walls with no reinforcement of any kind, Curry 2004 [2]. Due to the fact that it is so lightweight and easy to install, labor cost is reduced. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
560 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
Papercrete domes and vaults built without interior reinforcement.
Experimental structures, which are still standing, have been built without footings, directly on the ground and on sand bags, McCain 2004 [4]. Others have been built more conventionally on piers and on concrete footings and slabs, Terry 2004 [7]. Walls have been dry stacked, pinned with rebar, and poured in forms on the ground and then tipped up. They also have been poured monolithically, slip formed or used as infill in post and beam construction with a wood or steel framework, McCain 2004 [4]. Papercrete blocks made with sufficient Portland cement are fire retardant. They will not burn with an open flame. The blocks can be made waterproof by using a concrete sealer. In rural communities, with no current recycling services, making papercrete blocks increases the recycling of waste paper and creates new rural jobs and economic opportunities Fig. 4). Small communities, with even a modest waste paper stream, can start a cottage industry based on this material and save waste transportation fees to regional landfills.
Figure 4:
Papercrete house built in a small community.
The economic bonus is that there is no waste. Sawdust, cuttings, spills and broken pieces can be returned to the mixer for re-use, McCain 2004 [4]. The environmental bonus is that there is a sizable savings in trees and landfill space, new uses for other waste materials such as glass, fly ash and Styrofoam, and an estimated 50% to 70% savings in energy to heat and cool a papercrete home during its lifetime. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
561
Experimental program
3.1 Compressive test In theses tests an increasing uniaxial compressive load was applied at constant speed, uniformly distributed in order to develop the stress-strain curve and determine the stiffness of the material. The following testing procedure was used for the compression test: Since some samples had irregular faces, they were made flat by using normal commercial mortar cap. The samples were tested under uniaxial compressive force using a 100ton-compression machine, Fig. 5. The loading rate at the displacement control mode was 0.35 in/min, and all samples were loaded up to approximately 10 kips, unloaded, and reloaded to approximately 15 kips.
Figure 5:
Compression test.
Failure was defined by deformation criteria rather than load because the material is not brittle, and it does not exhibit descending branch in the stressstrain curve. It was found that at 15 kips the deformation was excessive, rendering the material useless. 3.2 Pull-out test The purpose of this test was to measure the bond capacity of a material by applying an increasing force to extract a corrugated steel bar that was previously driven. The following testing procedure was used for the Pull-Out Test: The samples were prepared by driving the rebar in the middle of a block of Papercrete. Two different kinds of samples were tested. The sample is subjected to an increasing load in order to pull out the steel bar. The loading rate at the displacement control mode was 0.35 in/min. In the same way as the compression test, failure was defined by deformation criteria.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
562 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3.3 Creep test The purpose of this test was to study the behavior of the material when it is subjected to a constant compressive load for a long period of time. The following testing procedure was used for the Creep Test: All creep samples were made by cutting papercrete blocks of approximately 3 in x 3 in x 9 in. The axial deformations were measured by a mechanical gage. Each sample was subjected to a constant load of approximately 300 lb for a period of time of four weeks approximately. It was found that practically all creep had taken place within approximately three weeks. The deformation was measured with 0.001 in. accuracy. PAPERCRETE Stress vs Strain Sample No2 300.00
Stress - psi
250.00
200.00
150.00
E=560 psi
100.00
50.00
E=1200 psi
0.00 0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
Strain - %
Figure 6:
4
Stress vs. Strain graph.
Test results and analysis
4.1 Compressive tests The data collected from the compression tests were used to develop stress-strain curves for each sample. The stiffness or elastic modulus of the material (E) is the slope of the stress-strain curve. A trend line was obtained using Microsoft Excel in order to get the right value of the slope of the curve, Fig. 6. Note that the material is non-linear, and as a result there is no Elastic (Young’s) Modulus. A working Young’s Modulus is an approximate value obtained from the stressstrain curves, and which can be used as an index to characterize the compressive behavior up to some stress. In practice, the allowable compressive stress is WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
563
expected to be at about this level. The softer part of the curve, Fig. 6, is probably due to irregularities of the surfaces of the specimens. The compressive test results of all samples are shown in Table 1. 4.2 Pull-out tests The data collected from five pull-out tests were used to develop a Load vs. Deformation graph for each sample. A typical force-deformation curve is shown in Fig.7. The maximum pull-out force for each specimen is given in Table 2. Table 1: Group 1 1 1 2 2 2 3 3 3 4 4 4 5 5 6 6 6 7 8 8 9 9 9 10 10 10 11 12 13 14 14 15 16 17
Sample 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 13 14 15 16 17-18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 30 33 35 36 37 60 38 39 40 41 42
Papercrete compressive tests.
Material
Proportions
Paper/Portland Paper/Portland Paper/Portland Paper/Port/Sand Paper/Port/Sand Paper/Port/Sand Paper/Port/Fly ash Paper/Port/Fly ash Paper/Port/Fly ash Paper/Port/Styrofoam Paper/Port/Styrofoam Paper/Port/Styrofoam Sludge/Port/Fly Sludge/Port/Fly Paper/Port/Glass Paper/Port/Glass Paper/Port/Glass Paper/Clay Paper/Port/Clay Paper/Port/Clay Paper/Port/Lime Paper/Port/Lime Paper/Port/Lime 1/8 inch grind 3/8 inch grind 5/8 inch grind Clyde T. Curry: Poured 2/13/05 Zach Rabon: Poured 2/05/05 Cardboard Pour 3/17/05 Paper/Port/Fly ash/Sand Paper/Port/Fly ash/Sand SRP Printing Paper Mixed Waste Paper Paper/Port/Fly Ash/Sand
1-1 1-2 1-3 1-1-5gal 1-1-10gal 1-1-15gal 1-.7-.25 1-.6-.30 1-.5-.35 15% Sty 20% Sty 25% Sty 1-.7-.25 1-.6-.30 1-1-5 gal 1-1-10 gal 1-1-15 gal 0 % Portland 1 bag mix 2 bag mix 1-.5-.5 1-1-1 1-1.5-1.5 1-2 1-2 1-2 Per yard Per yard .7 per yard 200 gal 200 gal 0.70 1/2 batch 0.70
Elastic Modulus 600 1200 2000 800 700 590 950 420 400 1200 1430 860 1390 2700 470 570 700 1394 855 1375 400 570 660 1550 2000 1200 1250 3000 220 1200 900 1500 1300 2100
4.3 Creep tests The data collected from the creep test were used to develop a Deformation vs. Time graph for each sample. Atypical curve is shown in Fig. 8. It is apparent that the deformation (creep) behavior under a constant load tends quickly to an WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
564 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII asymptote. To smoothen the curve, a trend line was applied using Microsoft Excel. Six samples were tested for creep and the results are tabulated in Table 3. Samples No2 and No4 were made using the corresponding mixtures in Table 1.
5
Conclusions and recommendations
Papercrete has wide-ranging implications for home construction and the environment. The challenge of papercrete is the lack of information about it. More research is needed in order to learn more about the material and to its properties. The results of this study indicate that papercrete, properly mixed and applied, should be safe and practical for two-story residential home construction. PULL OUT Load vs Deformation Sample No3 (double block)
700 650 600 550 500
Load - lb
450 400 350
Pmax = 285.3 lb
300 250 200 150 100 50 0 0.00
0.40
0.80
Deformation - in
Figure 7: Table 2:
Load – deformation. Pull out tests.
Group
Sample
Type
1 1 2 2 2
1 2 3 4 5
Single Single Double Double Double
Pmax (lb) 60.4 47.0 285.0 130.1 694.0
5.1 Compressive test When the samples were capped, all of them absorbed a lot of water very quickly. However, no apparent change in the samples after the seven day curing period was observed. During the compression test, the stress-strain curve is WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
565
monotonically increasing and the sample starts packing rather than disintegrating. For that reason, deformation is the criterion for failure. The stressstrain curves suggest that, papercrete is a ductile material that can sustain large deformations. Cement plays an important role in the compressive strength and behavior. Specimens with higher proportion of cement exhibit larger Young’s Modulus. As pointed out, the stress-strain curves exhibit a softer segment at the beginning. This is probably because of the inherent irregularities of the specimens due to shrinkage. It is believed that, in practice (for example in the construction of a wall), the self-weight of the structure will apply a moderate pressure which will bring the stress at the level of the working Young’s Modulus which can be used in design. PAPERCRETE Deformation vs Time Sample No4
0.1000 Dimensions: a=3.0in b=3.0in t=8.75in
Deformation - in
0.0800
Trendline
0.0600
0.0400
0.0200
0.0000 0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
Time - Days
Figure 8:
Deformation vs. time curve.
Table 3:
Sample No 2.1 2.2 2.3 4.1 4.2 4.3
Contac Area (in²) 9.0 9.0 9.0 9.0 9.0 9.0
Load (lb) 307.5 307.5 307.5 307.5 307.5 307.5
Creep test results.
Stress (psi) 34.17 34.17 34.17 34.17 34.17 34.17
Deformation creep (inch) 0.0108 0.0282 0.0177 0.0774 0.0831 0.0471
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
due
to
566 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 5.2 Pull out test The purpose of this test was to evaluate the pull-out capacity of a driven bar as a fastener. The load-deformation curve is monotonically increasing in a non-linear way until it reaches its maximum. Then it starts decreasing slowly due to the bar wrinkles or folds which prevent the opposite force (friction force) from decreasing drastically. All load-deformation curves exhibit a large number of peaks. This is because the material is broken and packed as the corrugated steel bar is driven by the pulling force. When the material is broken, the pulling load drops, and when the material starts packing, the load increases. The results exhibit considerable scatter. Since the corrugated steel bar was driven into the papercrete blocks by hammering, some factors such as perpendicularity, and packing produced by bar wrinkles or folds may contribute to the scatter. 5.3 Creep test During the creep test, the deformation-time curve is monotonically increasing in a non-linear way until it reaches its maximum. In general, the deformation due to a constant load stopped increasing in less than a month, which is a relative small period of time. It appears that creep depends on the amount of cement, increasing with increasing cement content. However the observed creep was rather small and it does not seem to pose significant structural problems.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
[6] [7] [8]
Arizona Housing Commission (2000) The State Of Housing in Arizona Retrieved October 6, 2005, from http://www.housingaz.com/UPLOAD/ HsgReprt.pdf Curry, C. Interview. Living In Paper (work in progress) [Videotape] Dir. Barry J. Fuller Bloomington, New Mexico October 4, 2004 Hart, K. Interview. Living In Paper (work in progress) [Videotape] Dir. Barry J. Fuller Crestone, Colorado June 9, 2004 McCain, M. (producer) (1991) Introduction to Fibercrete [Videotape] (Available from: RV Productions: Albuquerque, New Mexico) Mohr, B.J., El-Ashkar, N.H., and Kurtis, K.E. (2004) Fiber-cement composites for housing construction: state of the art review. Proceedings of the NSF Housing Research Agenda Workshop, Feb 12-14, 2004, Orlando, Florida. Eds. Syal, M., Hastak, M., and Mullens, M. Vol 2, Focus Group 2, 112-128 Patterson, E. Interview. Living In Paper (work in progress) [Videotape] Dir. Barry J. Fuller Silver City, New Mexico October 2, 2004 Terry, L. Interview. Living In Paper (work in progress) [Videotape] Dir. Barry J. Fuller Columbus, New Mexico June 7, 2004 Thomas, M. Interview. Living In Paper (work in progress) [Videotape] Dir. Barry J. Fuller Navajo Dam, New Mexico April 14, 2004
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[9] [10]
567
U.S. DOE (2002) R-value of papercrete [Email: Arun Vohra to Lex Terry] April 9, 2002 U.S. EPA (2000) Jobs Through Recycling Retrieved March 4, 2005, from http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/non-hw/recycle/jtr/comm/paper.htm
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
569
Non-Hertzian rolling contact stress analysis C. H. Liu & W.-E. Hsu Department of Mechanical & Electro-mechanical Engineering, Tamkang University, Tamsui, Taipei Shien, Taiwan, 251
Abstract In a previous study the three-dimensional rolling contact problem under Hertzian pressure has been dealt with. Two new initial guesses for the Newton-Raphson method were proposed, which always lead to convergent solutions for tangential stresses. However, non-Hertzian contact often appears in moderately used contact elements. The present study extends the previous study to cases with non-Hertzian contact. In particular the counter-formal case is treated. In this case the contact region can still be bounded by a plane, although the contact pressure is not Hertzian. The previous numerical algorithm is used to treat counter-formal contacts, and convergent results can always be obtained. Keywords: rolling contact, rail and wheel contact, non-Hertzian contact, computational stress analysis.
1
Introduction
Rolling contact occurs in many mechanical pairs, such as gear and pinion, cam and follower, wheel and rail, and also in ball to ball contacts in bearings. Many analytical as well as numerical techniques have been suggested to solve for rolling contact stresses. Basically these techniques can be grouped into the following three categories: the integral equation method [1–5], the method based on variational principles [6,7], and the mixed method [8–10] that makes use of both of the two preceding methods. Among the various techniques based upon integral equations, the numerical procedure developed by Liu and Paul [5] may determine tangential contact stress distribution for elastically similar bodies in rolling contact. Their iterative procedure showed fast convergence for cases with small spins, but might fail to converge for cases with even moderate values of spin. In a previous study by Liu and Hsu [11], Liu and Paul’s numerical scheme was improved by using two new initial guesses, so that it might also converge WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070571
570 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII under very large spins. In Liu and Paul’s original study, both Hertzian and nonHertzian contacts were treated, but only cases with Hertzian contact pressure were presented by Liu and Hsu. The purpose of this study, therefore, is to extend this previous study to cases with non-Hertzian contacts. The Hertzian pressure distribution was obtained under the following assumptions: 1. the contact region is very small so that it can be bounded in a plane; 2. in the vicinity of the contact region the two contacting bodies can be approximated by quadratic surfaces; and 3. the surfaces in contact are frictionless. While these are valid assumptions for new contacting surfaces, for moderately used contact elements, however, the above assumptions are generally not valid, and the corresponding contact pressures are non-Hertzian. In wheel and rail contact, although the pressure is non-Hertzian, but the contact region can still be confined on a plane [12]. In this study we assume that the loading is monotonically increasing, and that a fixed ratio of normal to tangential forces is maintained, so that only the final force values are considered. braking moment M
N
rolling direction
y
Mz upper body (body 1)
x
Fx z
: x
lower body (body 2)
rolling direction
Mx
(a)
Figure 1:
Fy
(b)
(a) two bodies in rolling contact; (b) tangential forces on contact region Ω.
2 Kinematic equation of rolling contact When two rolling bodies are pressed by a normal force N, the contact region Ω develops in the xy plane, as Fig. 1 shows. In addition to the normal force N, tangential force (Fx, Fy) and twisting moment Mz are also transmitted in the contact region. If the two bodies in contact are elastically identical, namely, they have the same elastic properties, then the problem can be separated into two parts: the normal problem and the tangential problem [13]. In the normal problem, the contact region Ω and the pressure distribution p(x,y) in the region are determined. Tangential tractions Tx(x,y) and Ty(x,y) in the contact region are then determined in the tangential problem. This separation is valid for elastically identical materials because the tangential tractions imposed later on the contact WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
571
region do not affect the conformity of the two bodies in contact. Hence the normal pressure and the size of the contact region remain the same. In this study we assume the two bodies rolling over each other are elastically identical. The non-Hertzian contact region Ω and the pressure p(x,y) in Ω are given. The purpose is to determine the tangential tractions Tx(x,y) and Ty(x,y) in the contact region Ω. When a braking moment M in the direction of −y is applied to body 1, a tangential force Fx develops in the contact region Ω to oppose the tendency of body 1 to slide over body 2. Likewise, a moment Mx along the x axis creates a tangential Fy in Ω. Figure 1(b) shows Fx and Fy in the contact region on body 2. As a result of Fx and Fy, certain points on the upper body (body 1) may slip over the contacting points on the lower body (body 2). The slippages sx and sy defined by ( s x , s y ) = ( v x1 − v x 2 , v y1 − v y 2 ) / V0 (1) represent the velocities at a point (x, y ) on body 1 relative to the point occupying the same position but on body 2. The normalization constant V0 is the rolling velocity when the two rolling bodies are rigid, that is, when they do not deform. The contact region hence reduces to a single contact point. In the case of gear and pinion pairs, rolling velocity V0 is the velocity of the contact point, and in the case of wheel-rail rolling contact, V0 is the velocity of the center of the rigid wheel. Johnson [1,2] derived the following kinematic equation for a state of steady rolling ∂ (2) ( s x , s y ) = (v x ,ν y ) + φ (− y, x) + 2 (u x , u y ) ∂x This equation shows that slippage (sx , s y) may be separated into three terms. The first term includes two constants, the longitudinal creepage νx and the lateral creepage νy. They represent the change in rolling speeds due to the previous mentioned moments M and Mx. Disregarding temporarily the tangential forces Fx and Fy developed in the contact region so that there becomes no resistance to M and Mx, then body 1’s rolling velocity deviates from its original value (V0 ,0 ). Note that equal but opposite moments −M and −Mx are applied to body 2 as well (not shown in Fig. 1), and a change in rolling speed of body 2 also occurs. Let (δVix , δ Viy) represents the change in rolling velocity of body i (i=1 or 2) from the value (V0 ,0 ), then longitudinal and lateral creepages νx and ν y are defined as (v x ,ν y ) = (δV1x − δV2 x , δV1 y − δV2 y ) V0 (3) The second term of (sx ,s y) is due to the moment Mz applied to body 1, and also the equal but opposite moment −Mz applied to body 2 (not shown in Fig. 1). At the point of application of Mz on body 1, which we assume to be far away from the contact region, body 1 rotates about the z axis with an angular velocity ω 1. Neglecting temporarily the resistant moment −Mz on body 1 so that body 1 can rotate freely, then the linear velocity at the point (x,y) in the contact region on body 1 is ω 1(−y, x). The velocity of this point relative to the same point on body 2 is then φ ( −y, x), where the constant φ is called the relative spin, or simply the spin, defined by the equation WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
572 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII φ = (ω1 − ω 2 ) V0 (4) In obtaining the first two slip components, namely (νx , ν y) and φ ( −y, x), the resisting forces (Fx , F y) and resisting moment M z were not taken into account. The elastic deformation caused by these forces (moment) was neglected. Let ux and uy denote the elastic displacements produced by (Fx , F y, M z) at a point (x ,y ) in the contact region on body 2. The relative slip velocity due to (ux ,u y) is given by the last term of equation (2).
3
Discretization
The elastic displacements (ux ,u y) in Eq. (2) are caused by the resisting forces Fx, Fy, and Mz, which are the resultants of tangential traction (Tx ,T y) in the contact region. Using principle of superposition, one may express (ux ,u y) as follows u x ( x, y ) f xx f xy Tx (α , β ) (5) dα dβ = ∫∫ f f yy Ty (α , β ) u y ( x, y ) Ω yx where fij(x, y, α , β ) are Cerruti functions [14]. For example, fxy represents the displacement at the point (x ,y ), in the x direction, which is produced by a unit force at the point (α , β ), in the y direction. The contact region is first replaced by a number of horizontal strips, as Fig. 2(a) shows, and each strip is further divided into several rectangular cells. Hence the contact region is discretized into n rectangular cells. The sub-region of Ω where relative slip occurs is called the slip zone, denoted by the symbol ΩS. The remaining region of Ω where relative slip is prohibited is called the stick zone (or locked zone), and we denote it by ΩL. Equation (2) is valid at each cell center, but instead of dealing with this equation directly, Liu and Paul [5], Hsu [15], and also Liu and Hsu [11] integrated Eq. (2) with respect to x to remove the partial derivative. Following the procedure suggested by Liu and Hsu, we integrate both sides of Eq. (2) from the center of the i'th cell (xi , y i), to a point (xU ,y i), also making use of Eq. (5), obtaining v ( x − xi ) − φyi ( xU − xi ) x n Txj hxx hxy s xj x U 2 2 2 + ∆x j = x x ( ) φ − dαdβ (6) h ∑ ∑ ∫∫ U i s h Tyj j = xi j =1 Ω yx yy yj v y ( xU − xi ) + 2 In the last equation (sxj , s y j) and (Txj , T y j) are slippage and traction at the center of the j'th cell, whose width is ∆xj; functions hij are defined by hij (xi , yi , α , β ) = f ij (xU , yi , α , β ) − f ij (xi , yi , α , β ) (7) U
j
and Ωj denotes the rectangular region of the j'th cell, over which the double integral is evaluated. Tractions and slippages are taken out of the integrals since we assume they take constant values in a cell. The upper limit of integration (xU ,y i) depends upon position of the cell center (xi , y i). Generally speaking (xU ,y i) is the closest boundary on the right of (xi ,y i). It can either be boundary that separates the slip-stick zone, or boundary of the contact region. For example, if (xi , y i) is point A, point B, or point C in Fig. 2(b), then xU is xS 1 , xS 2 , and xE , respectively. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(xs1 , y)
573
(xs2 , y) (xE , y )
a cell strip i
strip 2 strip 1
xB
:S
:L y
trailing edge
x x x C
E
x leading edge
(b)
(a)
Figure 2:
xA x
(a) Discretized contact region; (b) integration limits.
Note that equation (6) can be written at each cell center (xi , y i), with i=1,2,…,n, and for each cell center there are components in the x and in the y directions. Hence equation (6) implies 2n equations. In addition, when (xi , y i) is in the slip zone, tangential tractions in this cell satisfy Coulomb’s law of friction, i.e. (TxiS ) 2 + (TyiS ) 2 − ( µpi ) 2 = 0 , for i = 1,2,..., n S (8) In the last equation the superscript S means the associated variable is for the slip zone, in particular, (TxiS , TyiS ) is the traction of a cell i in the slip zone, and n S is the number of cells in the slip zone. The traction vector should be collinear with the slip vector, hence s xiTyiS − s yiTxiS = 0, i = 1,2,..., n S (9) Note that the last equation only requires traction and slippage to be collinear. We also require that traction on the surface of body 2 is in exactly the same direction as the relative motion of body 1 to body 2, hence s ⋅ T S ≥ 0 , or s xiTxiS + s yiTyiS ≥ 0, i = 1,2,..., n S (10) Therefore we have 2n+2 nS equations, given by Eqs. (6), (8), and (9), for the same number of unknowns, which are the 2n tractions (Txi ,T y i) and the 2nS slippages (sxi ,s y i).
4
Numerical procedure
If there are nL cells in the stick zone ΩL, we may write Eq. (6) nL times, each time (xi , y i) is replaced by a different cell center coordinate in ΩL, then we obtain 2nL equations as follows [11,15]
0 = e − At L − Βt S , ( xi , yi ) ∈ Ω L
(11) In the last equation t and t are traction vectors of lengths 2n and 2nS, respectively, representing tractions in the stick and the slip zones; A and B are L
S
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
L
574 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII coefficient matrices obtained by integrating Cerruti functions over cells in ΩL and in ΩS, respectively; e is the vector containing the constants of the first term on the right hand side of Eq. (6). Zero vector at the left hand side is due to the fact that no relative slip occurs in stick cells. Similarly we may write 2nS equations for cells in ΩS, as follows s = q − Ct L − Dt S , ( xi , yi ) ∈ Ω S (12) S L where s is the slippage vector of length 2n . We may solve t from Eq. (11) and then substitute it into Eq. (12), obtaining s = q − CA −1e + (CA −1 B − D)t S (13) Thus the procedure is to solve for s and tS from equations (8), (9), and (13). After tS is obtained, then tL can be found from Eq. (11). Since equations (8) and (9) are nonlinear, the Newton-Raphson scheme is utilized by Liu and Paul [5], Hsu [15], and Liu and Hsu [11]. The initial guesses suggested by Liu and Hsu are given below Initial guess 1: (ν x − φ y i ,ν y + φ x i ) µ p( x i , y i ) (T xiS , T yiS ) = , ( xi , y i ) ∈ Ω S (14) (ν x − φ y i ) 2 + (ν y + φ x i ) 2 Initial guess 2: (TxiS , TyiS ) =
µ p ( xi , y i ) ( xi − x P ) 2 − ( y i − y P ) 2
[− ( y
i
− y P ), ( xi − x P )] , ( xi , y i ) ∈ Ω S (15)
where (xp , y p) is coordinate of a point called spin pole, whose location is to be estimated, and we will discuss this later. These initial guesses will be used in the subsequent analysis. In addition to the equation-solving procedure discussed in the last paragraph, another iterative procedure is to determine the sizes of the stick and slip zones [5,11,15]. This procedure starts by assuming the whole contact region is the stick zone. Tractions of the first iteration tL can be obtained by solving Eq. (11), but without the last term. In subsequent iterations a slip zone generally appears, then tractions tS, tL, and slippage s are obtained using the previous mentioned equation-solving procedure. At the end of the an iteration, if traction at a cell in the stick zone equals to or exceeds its limiting value µp, then in the next iteration this cell is in the slip zone. Also, if inequality (10) is violated within any cell in the slip zone, then in the next iteration this cell is in the stick zone. The procedure terminates when all tractions in the stick zone fall below their limiting values, and inequality (10) is satisfied throughout the slip zone.
5 Results and discussions In the following analysis the non-Hertzian contact region and the pressure on the region are taken from Paul and Hashemi [12]. By using initial guess 1, the Newton-Raphson procedure may always converge within 1%, provided that a
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
575
coarse mesh with less than 30 cells is used. In a case with very large spin, the stick zone may become very small, and a very fine mesh is necessary to expose this zone. In such a situation initial guess 1 may lead to divergence, and we can only turn to initial guess 2, which requires an estimation of the spin pole coordinate. We follow a two-stage analysis procedure suggested by Liu and Hsu [11] for Hertzian contact. In the first stage initial guess 1 with a coarse mesh is used, tractions so obtained may indicate the spin pole location. With this spin pole location, in the second analysis one may use initial guess 2 in a fine mesh. We found this procedure also work for non-Hertzian contact. Figure 3 shows slip-stick boundaries for various values of normalized spin Φ, defined by Φ=Ea3φ /[µN(1−σ2 ) ], when the normalized longitudinal creepage Ea2ν x /[µN(1−σ2 ) ]=0.6; E is modulus of elasticity, σ is Poisson’s ratio, and a is the half length of the longest strip in the contact region, as shown in the figure. Figure 4 shows both the slip and stick zones under pure spin. One may notice that the stick zone may reduce to separated poles. In figure 5 we show the resultant force Fx and moment Mz due to longitudinal creepage ν x . All these results show that the initial guesses 1 and 2 may give convergent results under non-Hertzian contact.
Figure 3:
6
Slip-stick boundaries under various Ea 2vx [ µN (1 − σ 2 )] =0.6, Φ=Ea3φ /[µN(1−σ2 ) ].
spin
when
Conclusions
In this study it is shown that the numerical technique suggested by Liu and Hsu for Hertzian contact may be extended to cases with non-Hertzian contact. The two initial guesses suggested by them may be used together and convergence may always be obtained. For cases with large spins, initial guess 1 under a coarse mesh may provide spin pole locations, which are used in the analysis using initial guess 2, with a much finer mesh.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
576 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 4:
Slip and Stick zones under pure spin.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
577
Fx /(4µP0a2) or Mz /(8µP0a3)
0.35 0.3
F
x
0.25 0.2 0.15
M
z
0.1 0.05 0 0
0.5
1
1.5
Ea2ν /[µN(1-σ2)] x
Figure 5:
Tangential force Fx and twisting moment Mz due to longitudinal creepage νx.
Acknowledgement The authors gratefully acknowledge that this study was partially supported by the National Science Council of ROC under grant no. NSC95-2212-E-032-015.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
[7]
Johnson, K.L., The Effect of a Tangential Contact Force upon the Rolling Motion of an Elastic Sphere on a Plane, Journal of Applied Mechanics, 25, pp. 339−346, 1958. Johnson, K.L., The Effect of Spin upon the Rolling Motion of an Elastic Sphere on a Plane, Journal of Applied Mechanics, 25, pp. 332−338, 1958. Carter, F.W., On the Action of a Locomotive Driving Wheel, Proceedings of Royal Society, Vol. A112, pp. 151−157, 1926. Hills, D.A, Nowell, D., and Sackfield, A., Mechanics of Elastic Contact, Butterworth-Heinemann, 1993. Liu, C. and Paul, B., Rolling Contact With Friction and Non-Hertzian Pressure Distribution, Journal of Applied Mechanics, 56(4), pp. 814−820, 1989. Zastrau, B., Nackenhorst, U., & Jarewsky, J., On the Computation of Elastic-Elastic Rolling Contact Using Adaptive Finite Element Techniques, Proceeding of 3rd International Conference on Contact Mechanics, pp. 129−138, 1997. Wriggers, P., Computational Contact Mechanics, 2nd ed., Springer, 2006. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
578 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [8] [9] [10] [11]
[12]
[13] [14] [15]
Kalker, J.J., On the Rolling Contact of Two Elastic Bodies in the Presence of Dry Friction, Ph. D. dissertation, Delft University of Technology, Delft, Netherlands, 1967. Kalker, J.J., Computation of Three-Dimensional Rolling Contact With Dry Friction, International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, 14(9), pp. 1293−1307, 1979. Kalker, J.J., Wheel-rail wear calculations with the program CONTACT, Contact Mechanics and Wear of Rail-Wheel Systems II, University of Waterloo Press, Waterloo, Ontario, pp.3−26, 1987. Liu, C.H. and Hsu, W-E, “Three-Dimensional Rolling Contact Stress Analysis”, in Computer Methods and Experimental Measurements for Surface Effects and Contact Mechanics VII, editors J. T. M. de Hosson, C. A. Brebbia, and S-I Nishida. WIT press, pp. 269-278, 2005. Paul, B. and Hashemi, J. “User’s Manual for Program COUNTACT (COUNTerformal contACT stress programs),” Technical Report No. 4, FRA-ORD-78-72, (PB 286097/AS, available from National Technical Information Service, Springfield, Va.22151), 1977. Johnson, K.L., Contact Mechanics, Cambridge University Press, 1985. Love, A.E.H., A Treatise On The Mathematical Theory Of Elasticity, New York: Dover Publications, 1944. Hsu, W-E., Three-dimensional Rolling Contact Stress Analyses, Master thesis, Dept. of mechanical & electro-mechanical engineering, Tamkang University, 2005, in Chinese.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
579
The areolar strain concept applied to elasticity I. D. Kotchergenko Instituto Militar de Engenharia, Rio de Janeiro, Brazil
Abstract In contrast to the books that start with solutions of Lamé-Navier equations using complex variables, the present article starts with a presentation of the fundamentals of the complex theory of two-dimensional elasticity. A new strain expression is derived and the compatibility conditions for these strains are given. The fundamental equations for the isotropic and orthotropic plane elasticity are also presented in somewhat new complex forms. The homogeneous equilibrium equation is presented in a complex form that proved to be easily solvable. Kolosov’s general solution for the isotropic case is obtained in a fairly straightforward fashion. New equilibrium equations and boundary conditions for finite rotation are also given. Keywords: areolar strain, compatibility equation, finite rotation, complex elasticity.
1
Introduction
The development of the theory of two-dimensional elasticity hereof is grounded on the concept of areolar strain. This concept was first presented by Kotchergenko [8], in 1983, though containing some errors. In this approach the strain is obtained by the division of two complex-valued quantities associated with 2D vectors and called areolar strain owing to the fact that its real part represents a radial strain and its imaginary part represents either a circumferential strain or a rotation. The quaternion concept can probably be used to extend the areolar strain concept to the 3D vectors case. Improvements on the linear theory were recently presented, Kotchergenko [9,10]. Equilibrium equations for finite rotation and several other improvements are now included. A detailed review of the main results obtained until now is provided in order to make this article self contained.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070581
580 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
The areolar strain
Let a region in the plane of the variables z = x + iy and z = x − iy be mapped in a one-to-one manner onto the plane of the displacements u ( x, y ) and v( x, y ) by means of the transformation w( z, z ) = u ( x, y ) + iv ( x, y ) . Given the direction α of the vector z − z0 , where z and z 0 are two neighboring points of the plane, the areolar strain is defined as the gradient of the vector field w( z, z ) in the direction α , through the areolar derivative: ε = lim z → z0
∂w ∂w dz + dz w − w0 z ∂ ∂z = z − z0 dz
or ε = ∂w + ∂w e −i 2α , ∂z
∂z
(1)
−iα
where the polar form has been used for the ratio dz = | dz | e = e −i 2α . This iα dz
| dz | e
expression presupposes that z tends to z 0 , maintaining the direction α . Since 2
∂w ∂u ∂v ∂v ∂u = ( + ) + i ( − ) = θ + i 2ω , ∂z ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂y 2
∂w ∂u ∂v ∂v ∂u = ( − ) + i ( + ) = ξ + iγ , ∂z ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂y
(2)
the areolar strain can also be written in the form ε=
1
2 (θ
+ i 2ω ) + 1 2 (ξ + iγ )e −2iα .
(3)
When viewed in the polar form, the real part of the areolar strain represents a radial strain and the imaginary part represents either, a circumferential strain or a rotation. The second complex term is the complex shear strain. The components of the areolar strain are orthogonal as the quadratic form contained in the integrand of the work expression U = 1 / 2∫ C ij ε i ε j dV can be converted into its canonic form
U=
3
1
2
∫ [ 1 2(C11 + C12 )θ
2
+ 1 2 (C11 − C12 )ξ 2 + C13γ 2 ]dV .
(4)
Compatibility equations
If z0 and z are two points pertaining to the complex plane, their relative displacement is given by w − w0 = ∫ εdz = ∫ ( C
C
∂w ∂w dz )dz = + ∂z ∂z dz
∂w
∂w
∫ ∂z dz + ∂z dz .
(5)
C
Since w − w0 is independent of the path of integration C, dw =
∂w ∂w dz + dz ∂z ∂z
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(6)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
581
Fundamental modes of the areolar strain.
is a total differential. Consequentially, the displacement field must comply with the condition of continuity ∂ ∂w ∂ ∂w ( )− ( )=0 ∂z ∂z ∂z ∂z . (7) Separating the real and imaginary parts of this equation, the following compatibility equations are obtained: ∂ ∂ (2ω − γ ) + (θ + ξ ) = 0 , ∂y ∂x ∂ ∂ (2ω + γ ) − (θ − ξ ) = 0 . ∂x ∂y
(8)
Saint-Venant’s compatibility equation is obtained from these equations through elimination of the mode ω , by applying a cross-differentiation followed by a subtraction. Saint-Venant’s compatibility equation will then be satisfied for any rotational field, which may thus violate the compatibility conditions (8).
4
Equilibrium equations
For isotropic material, 1 2 (C11 +C 12 ) = λ + µ , 1 2 (C11 −C 12 ) = µ and C 13 = µ , thus the work expression given by eqn. (4) reduces to
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
582 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII U=
1
2
∫ [(λ + µ )θ
2
+ µ (ξ 2 + γ 2 )]dV
(9)
where λ and µ are Lame’s elastic material constants. The Euler equations for this functional are ∂θ ∂ξ ∂γ + µ( + (λ + µ ) )=0 ∂x ∂x ∂y . (10) ∂θ ∂γ ∂ξ (λ + µ ) + µ( − )=0 ∂y ∂x ∂y Taking into account that ∂ξ ∂γ ∂γ ∂ξ ∂ (ξ + iγ ) = ( + ) + i ( − ) = ∆u ( x, y ) + i∆v( x, y ) , ∂z
∂x
∂y
∂x
∂y
where the symbol ∆ stands for the Laplacian operator, Lamé’s homogeneous equilibrium equations can be presented in the following complex form: 2
∂ ∂ [(λ + µ )θ ] + 2 [ µ (ξ + iγ )] = 0 ∂z ∂z .
(11)
Multiplying each term of eqn (7) by a different complex elastic constant will result in an equation in terms of stresses. For isotropic material, undergoing small strain and small rotations, the operations required for obtaining Lame’s homogeneous equilibrium equation are ∂w ∂ λ ∂w ∂ − iω )] − ( 2 ) = 0 . [(λ + µ )( 2 ∂z ∂z ∂z 2 ∂z
(12)
Observe that only one out of the two iω , which appear in the term i 2ω , was removed. The term iω represents a local rotation. Taking the derivatives of ω from eqns. (8) and substituting into eqn. (12) will give eqn. (11)
5
Boundary conditions
Applying Green’s formula (e.g. Courant and Hilbert [1]) to eqn. (11), in the complex form, 2 ∫∫{ Ω
∂ ∂ 1 [(λ + µ )θ ] + [ µ (ξ + iγ )]}dxdy = ∫ (λ + µ )θdz − µ (ξ + iγ )dz , ∂z ∂z i
(13)
C
the traction vector on a boundary curve C results T = (λ + µ )θ − µ (ξ + iγ )e −2iα ,
(14)
where α points towards the direction of the vector element of arc dz of the closed contour curve C. Observe that if n the unit outward vector, normal to the element of arc ds = dz , then nds = −idz = 1 i dz . WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
6
583
Other forms for the equilibrium equations
The compatibility equations (7) can also be rewritten in the following complex form ∂ ∂ (θ + i 2ω ) − (ξ + iγ ) = 0 ∂z ∂z .
(15)
Equation (11) can hence be reduced to the following holomorphic function (Love, [4]), ∂ [θ + iη 2ω ] = 0 ∂z ,
where η =
µ λ + 2µ
(16)
. The modes θ and ω are hence harmonic functions.
The writer succeeded in rewriting the equilibrium equation in another form that proved to be easily solvable. The elimination of the derivatives of θ between equations (8) and (16), gives ∂ω λ + 2 µ ∂γ ∂ξ , 2 ( − ) = λ + µ ∂x ∂y ∂x λ + 2 µ ∂ξ ∂γ . ∂ω (17) 2 ( + ) =− λ + µ ∂x ∂y ∂y The elimination of the derivatives of ω , from the same pair of equations, gives µ ∂ξ ∂γ ∂θ ( =− + ), λ + µ ∂x ∂y ∂x µ ∂γ ∂ξ ∂θ ( − ). (18) =− λ + µ ∂x ∂y ∂y Combination of these equations yields: 2
∂γ ∂ξ ∂ξ ∂γ ∂ (θ + i 2ω ) = − χ [( + ) − i ( − )] , ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂y ∂z
(19)
Or after eqns. (2), ∂2w ∂z 2
+χ
∂2w = 0. ∂z∂z
(20)
∗ where χ = λ + 3µ for plane strain and χ = λ + 3µ , for plane stress, observing ∗
λ+µ
λ +µ
that λ∗ = 2λµ . λ + 2µ
7
General solution
Differentiation of eqn. (11) in z results
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
584 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII ∂ 2θ ∂2 [(ξ + iγ )] = 0 + 2µ ∂z∂z ∂z 2
2( λ + µ )
Since 4
2
∂ ∂z∂z
(21)
is the Laplacian operator and θ is a harmonic function, this
equation reduces to 2µ
∂2 ∂z 2
[(ξ + iγ )] = 0
,
(22)
∂2w 1 =− ϕ ' ' ( z) , ∂z∂z 2µ
(23)
or after eqns. (2), to 2
∂ ∂2w ( )=0 ∂z ∂z∂z .
Integration in z gives
where ϕ ' ' ( z ) is the conjugate of an analytic function. Integrating eqn. (23) in z, results ∂w 1 1 = (ξ + iγ ) = − [ zϕ ' ' ( z ) + ψ ' ( z )] . ∂z 2 2µ
(24)
Equations (20) and (23) furnish ∂2w ∂z which after integration in z, results
2
=
χ 2µ
ϕ ' ' ( z) ,
χ ∂w = ϕ ' ( z) + ζ ' ( z ) . ∂z 2µ
(25)
Differentiation of this equation with respect to z yields ∂ ∂w ( ) = ζ ' ' (z) . ∂z dz
1 ϕ ' ' ( z ) and hence 2µ 1 ζ ' (z) = − ϕ ' ( z) + c , 2µ
(26)
From eqn. (23), results ζ ' ' ( z ) = −
(27)
where c is a complex constant. Substitution into eqn. (25) yields ∂w 1 1 1 = (θ + i 2ω ) = [ χϕ ' ( z ) − ϕ ' ( z )] + (θ 0 + i 2ω 0 ) . ∂z 2 2µ 2
(28)
Using eqns. (28) and (24), the integration of the total differential, eqn. (5), gives Kolosov-Muskhelishvili’s general solution, [2,3,5,7]: w = w0 +
1 1 (θ 0 + i 2ω 0 ) z + [ χϕ ( z ) − zϕ ' ( z ) −ψ ( z )] . 2 2µ
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(29)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
585
The addition of Eqn (28) to its conjugate gives θ=
χ −1 [ϕ ' ( z ) + ϕ ' ( z )] + θ 0 . 2µ
(30)
The subtraction of Eqn (28) from its conjugate gives ω=
χ + 1 ϕ ' ( z) − ϕ ' ( z) [ ] + ω0 . 2µ 2i
(31)
Kolosov´s formulas, for stresses are obtained directly from eqns. (30) and (24): σ 11 + σ 22 = 2[ϕ ' ( z ) + ϕ ' ( z )] + 2(λ + µ )θ 0 , (32) σ 11 − σ 22 + i 2σ 12 = −2[ zϕ ' ' ( z ) + ψ ' ( z )] .
(33)
The areolar strain, in terms of analytic functions assumes the form ε=
8
1 1 1 (θ 0 + i 2ω0 ) + [ χϕ ' ( z ) − ϕ ' ( z )] − [ zϕ ' ' ( z ) + ψ ' ( z )]e −i 2α . 2 2µ 2µ
(34)
Equilibrium equations for an orthotropic plane
The writer explored the possibility of applying to the orthotropic plane case the same approach used with eqn. (11). Taking the compatibility equation in the form of eqn. (15) and removing one out of the two iω present into the term i 2ω ; then multiplying each complex term of this equation by different complex elastic constants, will result in the following equation in terms of stresses: ∂ ∂ (θ + iω ) − (b1 + ib2 ) (ξ + iγ ) = 0 . ∂z ∂z
(35)
∂θ ∂ + [(a1 + ia 2 ) − 2(b1 + ib2 )] (ξ + iγ ) = 0 . ∂z ∂z
(36)
(a1 + ia 2 )
Substitution of the derivatives of the rotation, obtained from eqn. (8), gives (a1 + ia 2 )
Lamé’s equilibrium equations are obtained letting a 2 = 0 , b2 = 0 , a1 = λ + µ and b1 = λ 2 . Application of Green’s formula to eqn. (36), gives the following generalization of the traction vector formula, previously depicted in eqn. (14): T = (a1 + ia 2 )θ − [(a1 + ia 2 ) − 2(b1 + ib2 )](ξ + iγ )e −i 2α .
(37)
Using the same procedure as the one used for obtaining eqn. (16) leads to the same Love’s form of holomorphic function: ∂ [θ + iη 2ω ] = 0 , ∂z
where η=
(a1 − 2b1 ) + i( a 2 − 2b2 ) . 2[(a1 − b1 ) + i (a 2 − b2 )]
Observe that for the isotropic plane, η will be reduced to a real constant. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(38)
(39)
586 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Separating the real and imaginary parts yields: ∂θ ∂ω ∂ω , = η1 2 +η 2 2 ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂θ ∂ω ∂ω , = −η1 2 +η 2 2 ∂y ∂x ∂y
(40)
with η = η1 + iη2 , where η1 =
a12 + a 22 − 3( a1b1 + a 2 b2 ) + 2(b12 + b22 ) 2[(a1 − b1 ) 2 + (a 2 − b2 ) 2 ]
η2 =
a 2 b1 − a1b2
,
.
(41)
∂ 2ω . ) ∂y 2
(42)
2[(a1 − b1 ) 2 + ( a 2 − b2 ) 2 ]
Differentiations of eqns. (40), yields ∂ 2θ ∂x 2
+
∂ 2θ ∂y 2
= η 2 2(
∂ 2ω ∂x 2
+
Other differentiations of eqns. (40), yields additionally: ∂ 2ω ∂x 2
=
∂ 2 ω ∂ 2θ 1 − (η 2 2 ) ∂x∂y ∂x∂y 2η1
∂ 2ω
and
∂ 2ω ∂y 2
=
∂ 2 ω ∂ 2θ . 1 + ( −η 2 2 ) ∂x∂y ∂x∂y 2η1
∂ 2ω
= 0 , and after eqn. (42), both ω and θ remain harmonics ∂x 2 ∂y 2 also for the orthotropic plane case.
Hence
9
+
Finite rotations
The gain of area during a plane deformation is given by dA = θ +
θ2 4
+ ω2 −
2
2
1 2 ∂w ∂w , (ξ + γ 2 ) = θ + − 4 dz ∂z
(43)
which is obtained from the determinant ∂u ∂u 1 + ∂x ∂y 1 + dA = . ∂v ∂v 1+ ∂x ∂y
(44)
Observing fig. 1, it can be seen that a finite “rotation” ω has a significant influence into the change of area of a plane elastic body. In some bending and buckling problems, it is admitted to disregard strain terms squared, except for
ω 2 , reducing dA to dA = θ + ω 2 . WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(45)
587
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
A rigid body rotation in this case can be approximated by the condition
θ + ω 2 = 0 . Then, for a point to describe a circular path of arc Ω = tan −1 ω , it is required that the expansion produced by the mode ω be neutralized by the shrinkage θ = −ω 2 . For the condition given by eqn. (45), the work expression assumes the form U = 1 / 2∫ (λ + µ )(θ + ω 2 ) 2 + µ (ξ 2 + γ 2 ) dxdy .
(46)
The Euler equations for this functional are (λ + µ )
∂ξ ∂γ ∂ω ∂ ∂ ∂θ (ωθ ) + (ω 2 ) − 3ω 2 ]=0, + ) + (λ + µ )[− + µ( ∂y ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂y ∂x
(λ + µ )
∂γ ∂ξ ∂ω ∂ ∂ ∂θ (ω 2 ) + 3ω 2 ]=0. + µ ( − ) + (λ + µ )[ (ωθ ) + ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂x ∂y ∂y
(47)
This system of equations can be written in the complex form (λ + µ )
∂ ∂ [(1 + iω )(θ + ω 2 ] + µ (ξ + iγ ) = 0 . ∂z ∂z
(48)
Applying Green’s formula, the traction vector on a closed curve C, in the undeformed reference frame, results T = (λ + µ )[(1 + iω )(θ + ω 2 )] − µ (ξ + iγ )e −i 2α . (49) Accordingly with eqns. (I.22) from Novozhilov [6], the shearing modes due to 1 1 finite strains are: ξˆ = ξ + θξ + ωγ and γˆ = γ + θγ − ωξ , hence discarding the 2 2 strains squared, other than those containing ω , results ξ = ξˆ − ωγ and
γ = γˆ + ωξ . If the following approximations are used accordingly: σx −σ y σx −σ y σ x +σ y τ τ θ +ω2 = , ξ= −ω and γ = + ω , 2(λ + µ ) µ 2µ µ 2µ
(50)
the equilibrium equations (47) in terms of stresses, referred to the undeformed reference frame, become ∂ ∂σ x ∂τ ∂ − (ωσ y ) − (ωτ ) = 0 , + ∂x ∂y ∂y ∂x ∂σ y ∂y
+
∂τ ∂ ∂ + (ωσ x ) + (ωτ ) = 0 . ∂x ∂x ∂y
(51)
These are exactly the equilibrium equations (II.49) given by Novozhilov, [6].
References [1]
Courant, R. & Hilbert, D., Methods of Mathematical Physics, Vol. II, Wiley: New York, pp. 350-351, 1989. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
588 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
[9] [10]
England, A. H., Complex Variable Methods in Elasticity, Wiley, pp. 2849, 1971. Kalandiya, A. I., Mathematical Methods of Two-Dimensional Elasticity, Mir Publishers, pp. 307-339, 1975. Love, A.E.H., A Treatise on the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity, Cambridge University Press, pp. 204-220, 1927. Muskhelishvili, N.I., Some Basic Problems of the Theory of Elasticity, Noordhoff, Groningen, 1963. Novozhilov, V.V., Foundations of the Nonlinear Theory of Elasticity, Dover Publications: Mineola, New York, pp. 83-84, 1999. Sokolnikoff, I.S., Mathematical Theory of Elasticity, McGraw-Hill, 1956. Kotchergenko, I.D., Unsymmetrical Plane Elasticity, Recent Advances in Engineering Mechanics, Proceedings of the Fourth Engineering Mechanics Division Specialty Conference, ASCE, eds. W.F. Chen & A.D.M. Lewis, Vol. I, pp. 385-388, 1983. Kotchergenko, I.D., Kolosov-Mushkhelishvili Formulas Revisited, 11th International Conference on Fracture, Turin, March 2005. Kotchergenko, I.D., Applications of Generalized Analytic Functions to Elasticity, CMM-2005-Computer Methods in Mechanics, Polish Academy of Sciences, June 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
589
Methodology for the manufacture of smart composites with thermoplastic matrix L. Elsoufi1,2, K. Khalil3, R. Lachat1, W. Charon1 & M. Zoaeter2 1
University of Technology of Belfort-Montbeliard (UTBM), M3M Laboratory, France 2 Lebanese University (UL), LPM laboratory, Lebanon 3 Centre universitaire de technologie (CUT), Lebanon
Abstract The adaptable mechanical structures in the form of Shell have found large developments and use in many applications, especially in the field of smart structures where the piezoelectric components are used as actuators and sensors. Many functional constraints prevent the control of a structure by elements reported on the surfaces of the object. Thus, the piezoelectric components necessary for the control of the structures will be integrated into this, i.e., in material, even the material of the wall. Certain work describes the manner and the performances of structures by using composite materials with thermoset matrices as structural support and piezoelectric components as the actuator or sensor elements. The current difficulties in recycling the thermoset materials are hindering the industrial development of such structures. For this reason, we propose to use composites with a thermoplastic matrix. Unfortunately, the current processes of achieving models in smart thermoplastic structures are not directly exploitable for the integration of components such as the piezoelectric actuators and sensors which are fragile and sensitive to temperature. This work evaluates the sizes typically reached in the process transformations of such composites with a thermoplastic matrix in order to be able to establish the behavior models for the realized structures. A thermo-mechanic testing method using dynamic mechanical analysis (DMA) is also proposed. Keywords: smart thermoplastic manufacturing, cooling rate, thermoplastic filling time, PZT sensor, piezoelectric properties degradation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070591
590 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Recent applications in smart structures and materials are limited by the manufacture of composites with a thermosetting matrix [2] such as: shape control of airplane wings [3], car bodies, reflector antennas [4], deformable mirrors, and actuators such as the so-called bimorph and C-block actuators [5, 6], which are widely used in the automation and aeronautics industries. This study is a contribution to modeling in smart thermoplastic structures manufacturing which have a great importance in recycling. The relatively high viscosity of melted thermoplastic materials leads the manufacturers of composites with thermoplastic matrix to raise the temperature of these materials during the manufacturing processes until temperatures can reach 1.5 to 2 times the melting point of these materials [1]. Among the processes we can enumerate: multi-material injection, multiphase injection, rolling, and thermoforming. The integration of components like memory-shape alloys such as the piezoelectric actuators or sensors in composite parts with thermoplastic matrix causes the thermal limit to exceed that of these components Tc/2 (Tc: Curie temperature of the piezoelectric component) which varies according to the type of piezoelectric. There are recent piezoelectric materials which have relatively high curie temperatures compared to those traditional ones [7], such as: 0.36BiScO30.64PbTiO3 and 0.3BiYbO3-0.7PbTiO3. However, these have not been commercialized yet because they are still under research. The aim of this study is to determine the relationship between the thermoplastic manufacturing conditions and those of commercial traditional piezoelectric materials. In this context, experimental tests have been carried out on piezoceramic plates by the dynamical-mechanical analysis test machine (DMA) which is called “Viscoanalyzer”. In this work, we will analyze the curvetype of temperature variation over time in different conditions of fabrication using simulation under ANSYS. The thermoplastic manufacturing process treated in this study is the injection molding of a rectangular model, in which we integrate a piezoelectric sensor. We vary the model thickness and the sensor position in order to study their thermal influence on the sensor and to minimize its exposure to heat. This introduction is followed by three sections which represent respectively: Modeling procedures, experimental results, and a conclusion.
2
Modeling procedures
In the injection process the thermal phenomena are often the slowest and they mainly control the time cycle as well as the degree of the damage of the piezoelectric component during the process. In practice, the cooling time of a molded part corresponds to the longest phase of the molding cycle as shown in figure 1. The thermal resistance of the piezoelectric sensor requires the knowledge of the thermal phenomena during the molding cycle. In this paper we present the various aspects of the thermal transfers during the thermoplastics injection process. We treat the cooling of the model and the heating of the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
591
piezoelectric sensor. Furthermore, we introduce concepts of compromise between the heating and cooling of the polymer, and the on-heating of the piezoelectric sensor during the melt plastic filling in the mould. The thermal analysis of the injection process requires the knowledge of three modes of heat transfers: conduction, convection and radiation. The conductive transfers take place in the materials (part and mould). The heat transfer between the wall of the cooling channels and the fluid of the regulation system is controlled by convective transfers.
Figure 1:
Cycle time.
2.1 Model description and properties The studied model is composed of a thin polypropylene plate (Borealis BD500P) which contains a piezoceramic sensor PZT made of two circular plates: yellow brass and ceramics as shown in figure 2. The polypropylene plate is molded in a steel mould of type AISI 1008. All properties are given by [9]. The properties of polypropylene (Borealis BD500P) are as follows: − density: ρ2 = 800 kg/m3 − thermal conductivity: k2 = 0.179 W/m.K − specific heat: c2 = 2800 J/kg.K − consistence (degree of viscosity): K = 11000 − index of pseudoplasticity: n = 0.308 The properties of the steel mould (AISI 1008) are as follows: − density: ρ1 = 7800 kg/m3 − the thermal conductivity (k1) of this type of steel is variable with temperature as shown in the table below: Table 1:
AISI 1008 thermal conductivity.
Temperature [°C] Conductivity [W/m.K]
0 65.2
100 60.2
200 54.7
400 45.2
− the specific heat (c1) is also variable with temperature as shown in the table below: Table 2: Temperature [°C] Specific heat [J/kg.K]
50-100 481
AISI 1008 specific heat. 150-200 519
200-250 536
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
250-300 553
350-400 595
592 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The properties of the piezoelectric ceramic (PZT upper plate) are as follows: − density: ρ3 = 7500 kg/m3 − thermal conductivity: k3 = 6 W/m.K − specific heat: c3 = 670 J/kg.K The properties of the yellow brass (PZT lower plate) are as follows: − density: ρ4 = 8750 kg/m3 − thermal conductivity: k4 = 159 W/m.K − specific heat: c4 = 380 J/kg.K The necessary data to calculation are as follows: − the mould is controlled using a coolant fluid at the temperature of Tm = 40°C − the injection temperature of polypropylene part is TM = 240°C − the initial temperature of the piezoelectric sensor is Tp = 25°C
Figure 2:
Description of the mould for simulation.
2.2 Modeling results The modeling of the transient problem is built under ANSYS by studying the thermal distribution over time of the upper part of the molding plate (above the piezoceramic sensor: between sensor and mould) and the piezoceramic sensor during manufacturing at all point in z direction. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
593
In order to study the several states of manufacturing influence of such composites with thermoplastic matrix on the integrated piezoelectric components, we analyze three sizes for the plate thickness and five positions for the sensor as follows: − h = 2mm with h1 = 0.5mm, 0.75mm and 1mm − h = 5mm and 10mm with h1 = 0.5mm, 0.75mm, 1mm, 1.75mm and 2.5mm 2.2.1 Part thickness influence To illustrate the part thickness influence on the injection thermal cycle and the piezoceramic sensor thermal resistance over time, three simulations were realized for three different part thicknesses h = 2mm, 5mm and 10 mm, to the same piezoceramic sensor position hp = 1mm as shown in figures 3 and 4. In the PP zone between mould and sensor, we notice an important increase in the temperature discard between centre and part surfaces with the increase of the global model thickness. In addition, this model thickness increasing causes an increment in the piezoceramic sensor temperature from 100°C to 140°C.
Figure 3:
Part thickness influence on plastic zone (hp = 1mm).
2.2.2 Sensor position influence Five simulations were realized on five various piezoceramic sensor positions with aim to study the thermal resistance of the sensor over time under various conditions of manufacture including its positions in model (figures 5 and 6). We notice a systematic increase in the sensor maximum temperature with its transverse penetration towards the centre of model to reach 160 °C as shown in figure 6. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
594 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 4:
Figure 5:
Part thickness influence on piezoceramic sensor (hp = 1mm).
Sensor position influence on plastic zone (h = 5mm).
2.2.3 Liquid plastic filling effect During the mould filling, a solid layer is formed on the flow surfaces (mould and sensor surfaces), this solidification is able to reduce significantly the available flow passage distance (liquid vein hv(t), fig.7). The reduction of the liquid vein, related to an increase in the filling rate, causes an important rise in the filling pressure of the mould. However, a significant reduction of the filling time involves an increasing in the pressure due WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
595
to flow increment. Finally, the evolution of the filling pressure related to the filling time, presents successively a decreasing in pressure profile passing by a minimum P* than increasing [8]: n
2(2 n + 1) 2 n P * ( z , hv , t * ) = 2 K n 3n + 1
−2 n
2n 1 − 3n + 1
− ( n +1)
z n +1
h −p (3 n +1)
α −n
(1)
The optimal filling time values are higher than the ones known in industrial practice. For evident reasons of productivity, it isn’t necessary to prolong the filling time until the minimum of the filling pressure. It is preferable to be located at the point that constitutes the best compromise between a significant reduction of the filling time and a minimum increase ∆P in the filling pressure. The optimal filling time is the average value of the filling times obtained by decreasing solidified hp – s(t) thickness and increasing solidified thickness z (t ) = αt * as follows [8]:
Figure 6:
Sensor position influence on piezoceramic sensor (h = 5mm).
Figure 7:
Flow section in the solidification course.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
596 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
tf
1 h p =
n +1 n
3n + 1 + h p ( n + 1) 2
n +1 n
×
(2)
3 n +1 1 h p n 2 n 2 2 n n +1 ∆P + 1 − n α 3n + 1 3n + 1 2 K 2(2 n + 1) x n +1 n
1 − −n n
The filling speed is given by [8] as follows: 2 1 3n + 1 3 aL 3 − 1.384 2 n 2 h V = 2n + 1 n n +1 KαLh − n −1 2 n k∆T
3
3n+ 2
(3)
with ∆T = TM - Tm and L = model length. For a plate with 5 mm of thickness (PP Borealis BD500P), we obtain tf = 12.6 s and V = 0.2 m/s which allow us to calculate the convection heat transfer coefficient of liquid plastic on the sensor (equal 18 W/m2K). This coefficient is necessary to re-modeling the problem in filling conditions.
Figure 8:
Filling influence on plastic zone (h = 5mm, hp = 1mm).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 9:
597
Filling influence on piezoceramic sensor (h = 5mm, hp = 1mm).
We notice that the filling process causes a big rise in the temperature maximum values of the different manufacture elements: 20% of temperature increment (fig.8) in plastic zone (sensor side) and 42% of sensor temperature increment (fig.9). The temperature increment and the cooling deceleration play an effective role in the reduction during the creation of solidified thermoplastic thickness on the cold surfaces (mould and sensor). However, the sudden and enormous temperature rise in piezoelectric sensor (figure 9) until exceeding the piezoelectric thermal limit causes the degradation of the sensor i.e. the degradation of these piezoelectric properties (polarization of the piezoelectric ceramic).
3
Experimental results
In this work, experimental tests were carried out in M3M laboratory on piezoceramic sensor by a dynamical-mechanical analysis test machine (DMA) which is called “Viscoanalyzer” of type METRAVIB RDS VA 2000, with an acquisition system (TEAC GX-1) used to measure the electric voltage produced by the tested piezoelectric sensor. The viscoanalyzer is a testing machine which makes it possible to determine the viscoelastic properties of materials. The dynamic analysis carried out by this machine allows the thermomechanical performance evaluation of materials and the choice of materials for a function of damping or sound-proofing, for the optimization of the formulation or manufacture processes for the forecast of the products durability. The operation principle consists on applying a sinusoidal force to a sample model and measuring the displacement results. A thermal enclosure makes it possible to cover an experimental window of temperature going from -150°C to +450°C. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
598 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The capacity of the machine is about 100 N. The frequency of the test-sample excitation varies from 0.001 Hz to 200 Hz. The materials tested can be solid, liquid or pasty. Several samples support making it possible to make the following tests: traction, compression, plane or annular shearing, annular pumping, bending, creep or strain relaxation tests. The principle used in this test installation is based on the relation between the applied sinusoidal displacement and the measured sinusoidal force responding to this displacement (stiffness and loss angle). The model studied in the experimental test is a circular actuator piezoceramic PZT (same properties in §2.1), simply supported on the periphery; and applying at the center of the plate a sinusoidal displacement of amplitude 50 µm and frequencies: 10, 15.85, 25.12, 39.81, 63.1, 100 Hz, with temperature variation as the protocol illustrated in figure 10. This experimental protocol allows us to measure the different sensor parameters and the voltage emitted after each temperature crawl up (10°C/min) and down (-5°C/min) in points k, l, m and n as indicated in figure 10.
Figure 10:
Experimental protocol.
The aim of this experience is to determine the degree of the mechanical and piezoelectric characteristics change during or after temperature variation.
4
Conclusion
In conclusion, we can notice through the results that the systematic increase in the temperature during the manufacture of smart composites with thermoplastic matrix causes an exceeding of the piezoelectric thermal limit. This fact makes a degrading in the ceramic crystal polarization of the piezoelectric components, i.e. the loss in the piezoelectric properties.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 11:
599
Variation curves of various parameters with the temperature increment measured by viscoanalyzer.
The empirical results obtained by viscoanalyzer show a beginning of this phenomenon from a temperature of approximately 75°C: until this temperature the voltage is reversible after each temperature crawl up and down. In addition, simulations show an important influence of the piezoelectric positioning component and the molded plate dimensions. In spite of these facts which are compatible in certain cases and incompatible in others, a comparison was made between modeling and experiment. This comparison shows the requirement of integrating the piezoelectric component in a position which takes into consideration two effects: On one hand the liquid plastic filling effect (solidification of the plastic on surfaces and the temperature increment of piezoelectric component). On the other hand the thickness of the manufactured model. These results constitute a beneficial contribution for the smart thermoplastic composite manufacture.
Acknowledgement The authors wish to acknowledge that this work was supported by the Francophone University Agency (AUF).
References [1] [2]
[3]
Cracknell, Dyson, Handbook Of Thermoplastics Injection Mould Design, Blackie Academic & Professional, pp. 10-80, 1993. Hori, Aoki, Ohira, Yano, New type of mechanical damping composites composed of piezoelectric ceramics, carbon black and epoxy resin. Composites Part A: Applied Science and Manufacturing, 32(2), pp. 287290, 2001. Tzou, Tseng, Distributed piezoelectric sensor/actuator design for dynamic measurement/control of distributed parameter systems: a piezoelectric finite element approach. J. Sound Vib., 138, pp. 17–34, 1990. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
600 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [4] [5] [6] [7]
[8] [9]
Agrawal B. N., Treanor K. E., Shape control of a beam using piezoelectric actuators. Smart Mater. Struct., 8, pp. 729–40, 1999. Brei, Moskalik, Deflection performance of a bi-directional distributed polymeric piezoelectric micromotor. J. Microelectromech. Syst., 6, pp. 62–9, 1997. Ervin, Brei, Recurve piezoelectric-strain-amplifying actuator architecture. IEEE/ASME Trans. Mechatron., 3, pp. 293–301, 1998. Eitel, Randall, Shrout, Rehrig, Hackenberger, Park, New High Temperature Morphotropic Phase Boundary Piezoelectrics Based on Bi(Me)O3-PbTiO3 Ceramics. The Japan Society of Applied Physics, 40(1), pp. 5999-6002, 2001. Mousseau, Sarda, Deterre, Thermique de l’injection des thermoplastiques /Optimisation. Technique de l’ingénieur, AM 3 685, pp. 1-18, 2005. MATWEB, www.matweb.com
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
601
Experimental investigation on the folding of axially crushed hexagonal tubes M. R. Said1, A. A. Mokhtar1, A. Alias2 & A. Ibrahim3 1
Faculty of Mechanical Engineering, Kolej Universiti Teknikal, Kebangsaan, Malaysia, 2 Faculty of Mechanical Engineering, Universiti Teknologi, Malaysia 3 Universiti Utara, Malaysia
Abstract The objective of this paper is to investigate the folding mechanism of an empty hexagonal tube made of mild steel with respect to the energy absorption. This includes the determination of the plastic wavelength, type of deforming mode and the mean load of the tube subjected to an axial loading. The introduction of chamfer at one end of the tube is also examined and studied. The comparison load-displacement curves between experiment and Finite Element Analysis (FEA) are made. The experimental mean load is also compared with theoretical analysis. The response of the hexagonal tube subjected to axial loading is observed through experiments. The formation of plastic fold length is observed and measured. The mean load and area under the load-displacement curve are calculated to obtain the energy absorption. By introducing the chamfer at one end, the deforming pattern can be determined, i.e. in-out chamfer gives a diamond mode while all-out chamfer gives a concentina mode. The FEA loaddisplacement curve agrees well with the experiment. However, the predicted mean load is overestimated, while the equivalent circular cylinder underestimates the experimental result. Keywords: energy absorption, hexagonal tubes, triggering, and crushed.
1
Introduction
Energy absorption systems made of thin-walled circular tubes and tube nests have been given significant attention by researchers for the past few decades. In particular, the initiation progressive axisymmetric and non-axisymmetrical WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070601
602 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII folding in tubes has been a subject of intense investigation by many investigators. Alexander [1] was first to present an analysis for the prediction of a mean crushing load, for a tube subjected to axial compression. He managed to obtain an expression for the folding length and the mean crushing load by implementing global energy balance. However, he assumed the tube to be folding into axisymmetric rings, in which the tube wall moves out of its initial position. But in reality there is outward as well as inward movement. This anomaly was first addressed by Reddy and Reid [2] albeit by an over prescribed hinge (four) mechanism. Wierzbicki et al [3] presented a more realistic three hinges mechanism in the form of a concentina collapse mode. The mechanism allows for radially inward as well outward folding in a proportion relative to the tube generator. The outer portion of the folding length relative to the total (inward plus outward) length was defined by the eccentricity factor. The mean load deduced was independent of the eccentricity factor, which was indeterminate. Singace et al [4] further modified Wierzbicki’s analysis enabling the determination of the eccentricity factor, which was in good agreement with the experimental results. The absolute mean crushing load produced by Singace et al [4] was similar to that of Wierzbicki et al [3] except for an added factor 5.632. These and other analysis are applicable only on the second and subsequent folds. The formation of the first fold is unique and there appears to be no analysis yet to describe it. Pugsley and Macaulay [5] observed diamond type folding in thinner tubes and derived a semi-empirical expression for the mean load. Horton et al [6] reported the findings of an extensive experimental study of quasi-static axial buckling of thin-walled cylindrical tubes, concluding that the buckling mode changed from axisymmetric to non-symmetric patterns if the geometric parameter, radius over wall thickness, t increases. Johnson et al [7] developed, a mechanism of inextensional mode of deformation of thin-walled tube under axial loading which involved the stationary and travelling hinges in the diamond mode and derived an expression for the mean crushing load. However, they [7] did not correlate the change of concentina to diamond mode. Tvergaard [8] investigated the influence of buckling pattern localisation, which could cause the transition of diamond mode to axisymmetric mode. The dependence of folding mode on tube geometry has been investigated experimentally by Andrews et al [9]. Square, rectangular, hexagonal are more popular than circular tubes in automobile industry. Early investigations [10,11] were concerned with rectangular tubes made of sheet metal and were aimed to understand the behaviour of vehicle body shells. Wierzbicki and Abramowicz [12] formulated kinematically admissible global deformation mechanisms for thin-walled rectangular tubes comprised of flat plates. Reid and Reddy [13], Reid et al. [14] and Reddy and Al-Hassani [15] have shown that introducing different fillers like foam or wood increase the overall energy absorption of the tubes. Said [16] presented experimental measurement of elastic half wavelength and plastic fold length during the crushing of rectangular tubes. No work has been found to study the effect of trigger by introducing the chamfer in one end tube. Abramowicz and Wierzbicki [17] developed a mechanism for predicting the crush behaviour of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
603
multicorner columns with an arbitrary corner angle. This was applied to find crushing strength of hexagonal tube under axial compression and produce a simple expression for the mean crushing load. As the hexagonal consists of 6 sides and circular is infinity sides, the correlation may be made by assuming the hexagonal sides as an equivalent circular cylinder. The objective of this paper is to investigate the folding mechanism of empty hexagonal tube made of mild steel with respect to the energy absorption. The effect of triggering with mean load and plastic folding is also examined.
2
Experiment
Axial compression tests were carried out on as-received 170 mm and 200 mm long hexagonal tubes made from the same tube. Longer specimens were labelled as HEX1 to HEX12 and shorter (170 mm long) specimens as HEX170. Some of them were marked with 4 mm grid circles and some chamfered at one end in order to trigger the mode of deformation. Distance of 4 mm is measured from a point of arc intersection to the next point. All the axial compression tests were on specimens in the as-received state only. Tests were carried out on a 200 kN universal testing machine at a loading rate of 10 mm/min.
3
Observations and discussions
This section describes the influence of triggering, the characteristic of loaddisplacement curves, and the effect of chamfer. This includes the determination of the plastic fold length, mean load and energy absorbed and also compared with the circular tube under axial loading. 3.1 Triggering the mode of deformation Mode of deformation of hexagonal tube under axial loading can be triggered by introducing the chamfer at one end. Without chamfering, the tube deforms in uncertainty manner, i.e. may deform in concentina or diamond or mixed mode. Experiments have shown that by introducing the chamfer, the mode of collapse can be determined. However, the edge of the tubes under investigations, have to be suitably chamfered. The chamfer was made to half of the original thickness of the tube and with an angle of approximately 450 as shown in Figure 1. This results in the axial end forces applied being offset with respect to the centreline of the tube wall. The larger the chamfer is the larger the eccentricity. Experiments have shown that if the chamfering one side only of all end faces (either inner or outer ends), tube collapses into concentina mode. With external chamfers on all faces (referred to as all-out chamfers), the first buckle was outwards and vice versa. However, if adjacent faces were chamfered on opposites edges (i.e. one on the outside and the other on the inside, referred to as in-out chamfers), the tubes were seen to fold into the diamond mode. In the inout chamfered tubes, fractures were observed along the corners when the chamfers were extended over the whole face width. By chamfering only over the central region, such corner failures were prevented. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
604 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
A schematic view of the tube wall, showing the chamfered angle. (a)
Op
(i)
(ii)
(b)
Figure 2:
(a) A typical load-displacement curve for a single hexagonal tube (HEX170). Insert: A one-sixth segment of a deformed specimen. (b) Deformed unchamfered tubes (i) Diamond mode (ii) Concentina mode.
3.2 The load-displacement characteristic for unchamfered specimens Figure 2 shows a typical load-displacement trace for an unchamfered specimen marked as HEX170 and the deformed tubes. A cross-section of the crushed specimen is shown in the inset. During compression, just before the peak load (point 1 in Figure 2a), a series of elastic ripples were noticeable in the sides of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
605
the hexagonal tube. It is noticed that, the peak load is 184 kN. Ripples disappeared when the load dropped (point 1 to 2) and were not noticeable afterwards. They reflect the state of buckling and influenced mostly by strainhardening characteristics of these tubes. At the peak load the tube buckled locally at the top end and initiated a plastic fold. The faces were observed to buckle before the corners collapsed indicating the start of plastic fold. The first fold was followed by a series of load fluctuations. Each cycle in the fluctuations (e.g. 3-5, 5-7 etc) corresponds to a plastic fold that formed in the tube at section labelled as A, B, C, D, E, F and G shown in the inset. The number of peaks in the load-displacement curve indicates the number of folds formed. The mean load during compression was calculated as the ratio of the area under the curve and the displacement is almost the same for all folds. A secondary (minor) load fluctuation was observed between the first and second primary peak only. Such fluctuation was not seen beyond the second peak. A characteristic (plasticbuckling) wavelength can be identified as, λp (=2H) as shown in the inset in which mode of deformation seen is of a concentina type, in which all the sides of the tube buckle in phase i.e. inward or outwards simultaneously. The plastic wavelength can be estimated from experiment, as the average length per fold in the deformed specimens. It was found that, λp = 33 mm, this also being approximately the displacement difference between two adjacent peaks in the load-displacement characteristic (Figure 2a). A detailed examination of the deformed specimen also indicated that, the first fold was at about 16 mm from top end as shown in the inset. From the calculation, it is noticed that the mean load is about 84 kN. Some specimens exhibited progressive incomplete diamond and concentina type folding patterns in a fold. The diamond type is where in adjacent sides of the tube were buckling out of phase (i.e. one inward and the other outward etc). Incomplete mode is a mixture of half concentina and half diamond in one plastic fold. For example, specimen HEX1 deformed in four incomplete diamond and concentina folds as can be seen from photograph in Figure 2b(i-ii). In some specimens, concentina fold formation was seen in the initial few folds and then followed by incomplete diamond and concentina folding mechanism was seen. For example in specimen HEX7, Figure 2b(ii), three concentina folds are followed by two folds of incomplete diamond and concentina. None of the specimen was seen to fold in mixed mode. Mixed mode is a complete concentina and diamond folds in the same tube. This concludes that unchamfered specimens exhibit uncertainty of folding mechanisms. A summary of results that includes mean load and plastic fold length for the entire specimen tested is shown in Table 1. This includes the specimens in which triggers are introduced to induce specific mode, i.e. concentina or diamond type of deformation. 3.3 The load-displacement characteristic for chamfered specimens Figure 3a-b shows typical load-displacement curve for in-out and all-out chamfered hexagonal tubes subjected to axial loading. In-out chamfered WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
606 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII specimen exhibits diamond mode, while all-out in concentina mode. The sequence of deformation for the case of all-out chamfers (point 0 to 15) is shown in Figure 4 corresponding to Figure 3b. Point 1 of the same figure indicates the peak load and the initiation of first plastic fold. The peak load shows 165 kN for both in-out and all-out chamfers. Table 1: Spec. no.
Summary of results of hexagonal tubes subjected to axial crushing. average
λp at mid
mean Load,
Energy absorbed W (Nm) at δ=100 mm
Mode of deformation and length of specimen, L Concentina, L=170 mm (unchamfer) 4 folds incomplete L=200 mm (unchamfer) 4 folds incomplete L=200 mm (unchamfer) Concentina, L=200 mm (All-out chamfer)
face (mm)
Fm (kN)
HEX170
33
84
8401
HEX1
36
84
8376
HEX2
35
84
8372
HEX3, 8, 11, 12
36
85
8488
HEX4
-
-
-
HEX5
36
86
8592
HEX6
-
-
-
HEX7
34
85
8477
HEX10
44
80
7939
Broke halfway, L=200 mm (in-out chamfer) Concentina, L=200 mm (all-out chamfer) Broke halfway, L=200mm (in-out chamfer) 3 folds Concentina, 2 folds incomplete, L=200mm Diamond, L=200 mm (in-out chamfer)
This means that insignificant effect on peak load for in-out and all-out chamfers, as the initial compression areas are the same. However, the load fluctuation (amplitude) for in-out chamfer is smaller than all-out chamfer by about 25 kN. Referring to Figure 3b, two secondary peaks (point 3 and 5) exist in load-displacement curve between the first and second primary peak and one between second and third primary peak. But, the secondary peaks were not seen after the third primary peak (point 8). The existing of two secondary peaks may be due to the plastic fold in contact with the top platen. However, the secondary peaks were not seen for the case of in-out chamfered specimen. A summary of results that includes the mean load, and plastic wavelength for all the specimens also is included in Table 1. It shows no significant change on with respect to mean load and plastic folding length for concentina mode for the case of all-out chamfered. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
607
Load-displacement curve of hexagonal chamfered tubes under quasi-static compression (a) In-out chamfer (b) All-out chamfer.
However, in-out chamfer produces diamond mode, which gives the lower mean load, thus gives less energy absorption. Figures 5a-b show the typical cross-sectional views of the deformation patterns of all-out and in-out chamfered specimen crushed under nominally identical conditions. Figure 5a illustrates an all-out chamfered specimen, exhibiting concentina folds, while Figure 5b shows cross-section view of the diamond mode seen in the crushed specimen with inout chamfers. 3.4 Effect of chamfer The effect of chamfer is observed for both all-out and in-out chamfer. The significant effect of all-out chamfer is noticed in the load-displacement curve (Figure 3b), which shows the existing of two secondary peaks at point 3 and 5. Figure 3b also show the repeatability of the peaks. No secondary peak has been found in in-out chamfer. The reason of non-existing of the secondary peak has not been explored. However, they also appear in unchamfered tubes but only one secondary peak exists at random. In general, from energy absorption point of view, the all-out chamfered tubes give a higher value of energy absorption. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
608 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Figure 4:
Sequence of deformation of axially crushed tube with all-out chamfer.
(a)
(b)
Figure 5:
Typical cross-sectional views showing deformation pattern.
3.5 Comparison with FEA and equivalent circular cylinder Figure 6 is the comparison of experimental load-displacement curves and those predicted by FEA [18,19], which are seen to be in good agreement. The FEA mean load is almost the same value with experiment. However the plastic fold length, λp(=36 mm) derived from the FEA [18,19] overestimates the experiment by 10%. The prediction of mean loads by various upperbound solutions for equivalent circular cylinder, Alexander [1] and Singace et al [4] and for hexagonal tubes, Abramowics and Wierzbicki [17] are also shown in the figure 6. The radius of an equivalent circular cylinder is assumed to be equal side length, b of hexagonal tubes. The mean load for the equivalent circular cylinders underestimates the experiment by about 30%. This is not surprising because WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
609
these solutions underestimate the mean load for the crushing of cylinder by about the same margin. Their plastic fold length, λp [4] is also underestimated by about 30%. The mean load predicted by the analysis of Abramowics and Wierzbicki [17] is 105 kN which overestimates the experiment by about 25%.
Figure 6:
4
Load-displacement curves for axial compression quasi-static loading and comparison of the mean load, Fm with previous researchers.
Conclusion
With chamfering, the tube deforms in certainty manner, i.e. in-out chamfer gives a diamond mode while all-out in concentina mode. However, a slightly higher energy absorption is obtained from concentina mode. It also shows no significant change on with respect to mean load and plastic folding length for concentina mode for the case of all-out chamfered. However, in-out chamfer produces diamond mode, which gives the lower mean load, thus gives less energy absorption. The mean load for equivalent circular cylinder underestimates the experimental result, however FEA give excellent results with experiment.
References [1] [2]
Alexander, J. M. “An approximate analysis of the collapse of thin cylindrical shells under axial loading”, Quart. J. Mech. Appl. Math, Vol.13, pp 10-14,1960 Reddy, T. Y. and Reid, S.R., “Plastic folding of cylinders under axial compression” Presented at Euro Mech. 1st European Solid Mech Conference at Munich, 1990
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
610 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16] [17] [18] [19]
Wierzbicki, T., Bhat, S. U., Abramowicz, W. and Brodkin, D., “Alexander revisited-a two folding elements models of progressive crushing of tubes” Int. J. Solids Struct, Vol. 29, pp. 3269-3288, 1992 Singace, A. A., El-Sobky, H. and Reddy, T. Y. “On the eccentricity factor in the progressive crushing of tubes” Int. J. Solids Struct Vol. 32, pp 3589-3602,1995 Pugsley, A. and Macaulay, M. “The large scale crumpling of thin tubes”, Quart J. Mech. Appl Maths, part 1, vol. 13, 1960 Horton, W. H., Bailey, S. C. and Edwards, A. M. “Nonsymmteric buckle patterns in progressive plastic buckling”, Experimental Mechanics, Vol. 6, No. 9. pp 433-444, 1966 Johnson, W., Soden, P. D and Al-Hassani, S. T. S. “Inextensional collapse of thin-walled tube under axial compression”, J. Strain Analysis Vol.12, No.4, 1977 Tvergaard, V. “On the transition from a diamond mode to an axisymmetric mode of collapse in cylinder shells” Int. J. Solids Struct, Vol.19, No.10, pp 845-8561983 Andrews, K. R. F, England G. L. and Ghani, E. “Classification of the axial collapse of cylindrical tubes under quasi-static loading” Int. J. Mech. Sci. Vol. 25, No. 9-10, pp. 687-696, 1983 Macaulay, M. A. and Redwood, R. G. “Small scale model railway coaches under impact”, Engineer, 1041-1046, 1964 Postlethwaite, H. E. and Mills, B. “Use of collapsible structural elements as impact isolators with special reference to automotive application”, J. Strain Analysis, 5, pp 58-73, 1970 Wierzbicki, T. and Abramowicz, W. “On the crushing mechanics of thin walled structures”, J. Appl Mech, Vol. 50, pp 727-734, 1983 Reid, S. R. and Reddy, T.Y. “Axial crushing of foam-filled tapered sheet metal tubes”. Int. J. Mech. Sci., Vol.28, No.10, pp 643-656, 1986 ] Reid, S. R., Reddy, T.Y. and Gray, M. D. “Static and dynamics axial crushing of foam-filled sheet metal tubes”, Int. J. Mech. Sci., 28, pp. 295322, 1986 Reddy, T. Y. and Al-Hassani, S. T. S., “Axial crushing of wood-filled square metal tubes”. Int. J. Mech. Sci., Vol.35, No.3/4, pp 231-246,1993 Said, M. R. “Axial compression of empty and filled rectangular tubes”. MSc. Dissertation, UMIST, U.K., 1988 Abramowicz, W. and Wierzbicki, T. “Axial crushing of multicorners sheet metal columns” J. App. Mech., Trans ASME., 56, pp 113-120, 1989 Said, M. R. “Energy absorption in certain cellular structures under uniaxial and biaxial loading” PhD. Thesis, UMIST, U.K., 2000 Said, M. R. Ahmad R. and Alias A. “ Finite Element Analysis of hexagonal tubes structure under axial loading” Proceeding in 1st International Conference On Safety and Security Engineering, pp 83-91, Rome, Italy, 2005
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
611
Application of the shakedown analysis in the elastic: plastic assessment of cracked plates M. A. Belouchrani Materials laboratory, E.M.P., BP 17C Bordj El Bahri Alger, Algeria
Abstract In this work, a new method in the elastic-plastic calculation of cracked plates, based on shakedown analysis, is presented. This method presents an interesting alternative to classical methods in the structure design, especially when the loading is variable. It permits, via a simple elastic calculation and a mathematical optimisation, the determination of a load domain situated between the elastic and the limit load domains, within which the loading can evolve arbitrarily, while insuring the reliability of the cracked structure versus the plastic ruin and the unstable crack propagation. Also, by taking into account the microstructure of the material and the residual stresses, this method allows the determination of a stress intensity factor corresponding to the shakedown state. This factor is comparable to the fatigue threshold and can be used in the crack admissibility criteria. Keywords: shakedown, crack, notch, finite elements analysis, stress intensity factor, fatigue threshold.
1
Introduction
The structures used in the aeronautics, nuclear plants and naval yards are generally plane forms, originally, constituted of ductile material plates (metals and alloys) that could support irreversible plastic deformations before to break, and that even when they contain manufacture defects or cracks. Cracks constitute the major problem of designers, because they can falsify completely the prediction of the conceived structure behavior, by accelerating their ruin through brutal propagation of these cracks. When a crack is detected in a system, the designer undertakes an analysis, where he will have to explore the brutal rupture risk, the plastic ruin risk and the foreseeable evolution of the fissure. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070611
612 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The most often, because of the geometrical singularity fathered by the crack, one uses the fracture mechanics, that has replaced the classical design methods. Nevertheless, one knows that the fracture mechanics alone cannot insure that a crack is admissible; it attends only what happens at the vicinity of the crack tip (front), where the strong constraints and deformations can cause plastic yield of the material and therefore the propagation of the crack. Criteria of defect admissibility of the fracture mechanics are naturally local, attached to event being able to happen at the crack tip. One knows also that even flawless, a structure cannot support unlimited loads, it finishes by bankrupting. To take into account these two modes of ruin and to anticipate the stability and the security of the cracked structure, Belouchrani and Weichert [1][2], have proposed a new approach by the application of the shakedown theory, that finds its preferential application framework when the loading is variable. This new approach consists of an extension of the static shakedown theorem to the cracked structures. The goal of this work is to present this new prediction method of the cracked plate security and reliability, by using the finite elements method and the nonlinear mathematical optimization. The crack is assimilated to a sharp notch according to Neubers material block concept [3].
2
Formulation of the shakedown theorem for a cracked body
It has been suggested [1,2], that a cracked body shakes down with respect to a given loading history, if a time-independent state of residual stress ρ D ( x ) exists, such that for all times t > 0 : ρ Dij, j = 0
in Ω
(1)
n j ρ Dij = 0
on Γσ
(2)
in Ω
(3)
(
F
σ ijc ( t ) + ρ Dij , σ y
)< 0
With a supplementary condition imposed on the admissible length of a typical micro-crack in the material a lim < a c (4) Here, F is the plastic yield surface assumed of Von-Mises type, convex by definition, σ y is the yield stress and a lim is the largest admissible crack length determined by means of shakedown analysis. In inequality (3), σ c ( x , t ) is the time-dependent stress state for a purely elastic comparison problem, differing from the original problem only by the fact that the material reacts purely elastically with the same elastic moduli as for the elastic part of the material law in the original problem. For the Lemaitre-Chaboche model [4] adopted for ductile fracture, a lim is given by [1,2] a lim
m +1 1 α = a0 + m K α −1
∫ (
)
1 D ρ ij L ijkl ρ Dkl dΩ Ω2
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
m
( m +1)
(5)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
613
Here, a 0 is the initial crack length, L is the positive definite and timeindependent tensor of elastic moduli, m and K are material constants characterizing the R-curve parameters and α is the shakedown safety factor. As mentioned before, the problem of stress singularity of the elastic stress field deserves special attention for the application of the shakedown theorem to cracked structures. In this case, no time-independent field of residual stresses ρ ° ( x ) satisfying inequality (3) can be found and classical shakedown theory does not deliver comprehensive results, even for loads for which limit states physically exist. We bypass this problem by assimilating the crack tip to a notch, following the concept of material block introduced by [3] and used in the same spirit as in the present work by [5]. So, following [6], the stress distribution in the neighborhood of the root of the notch given by rf = r + nε (6) with, according to figure 1, rf as the effective notch root radius, ε as the length of the Neuber material block (assumed to be a material constant), and n as the factor depending on the loading mode. The factor n is equal to 2 in mode I. Following this concept, the effective notch radius is equal to the original notch radius augmented of n times the dimension of the Neuber material block. ε
ε
r
ρf
rf
Figure 1:
Modified notch and crack.
In the case of a sharp crack, the radius at the root of the effective crack, denoted ρ f , can be obtained just by putting r = 0 in Eqn. (6) (7) ρ f = nε Eqn. (7) indicates implicitly that the crack can be treated as a notch with ρ f radius. Physically, Neubers material block may be explained as being the sum of the minimum number of individual microscopic material particles (such as grains in polycrystalline metals). The properties of which may differ from each other, but in average they should have the property of the macroscopic material. In [5], ρ f is put to be about ten times the size of a grain, for the mode I loading. Following this suggestion we write (8) ε ≈ 5ξ
3
Shakedown safety factor
We consider an elastic-plastic plate, subjected to uniaxial loads P(t). The values of P(t) vary arbitrarily with time t, but remain between prescribed loads Pmin WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
614 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII and Pmax . One then looks for the maximum value of the load factor α , such that the plate will shake down under the load αP( t ) . This load factor will be called the shakedown load factor α SD and can be determined as solution of the following optimization problem α SD = maxD α (9) α ,ρ
with the subsidiary conditions ρ Dij, j = 0
in Ω
(10)
n j ρ Dij = 0
on Γσ
(11)
F(ασ c (P) + ρ D , σ y ) < 0 in Ω ∀P ∈ [Pmin , Pmax ]
(
)
1 D m +1 1 α ρ ij L ijkl ρ Dkl dΩ a lim = a 0 + ∫ Ω α − m K 1 2
4
m
( m +1)
(12) < ac
(13)
Fatigue threshold and influence of the microstructure
In what follows, the classical concept of existence of a threshold K S for the stress intensity factor K I in opening mode I is used. K I = σ πa (14) Therefore, it is assumed that the micro-crack propagation does not occur if K I < KS (15) and the material state is safe against failure by fatigue. Among other parameters, the fatigue threshold is influenced by the microstructure of the material. Generally, it is admitted that K S increases with the size of the grain as has been observed on ferritic steels by [7–9]. It has been suggested that the dependence between K S and ξ1 2 (ξ is the diameter of the grain) are related by a linear function [7–9] K S = a 1 + b1 ξ1 2 (16)
where the dimensions of K S and ξ are, respectively, [MPa.m1/2] and [m]. Here, a 1 and b1 are material constants.
5 Shakedown stress intensity factor KSD With the shakedown load factor α SD computed for a cracked plate loaded in mode I, we will compute the stress intensity factor (Eqn. (14)) corresponding to the shakedown state by [10] K SD = α SD P πa lim
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(17)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
6
615
Numerical examples
Here, the finite element method is used combined with mathematical programming method to maximize the load factor under the subsidiary conditions (10)–(13) such that the yield criterion F is not violated in any point of the plate and that the admissible crack length a lim remains inferior to its critical value ac. The resolution of this mathematical programming problem is performed using the code LPNLP [11] that is based on an augmented Lagrangian method and the BFGS-algorithm. For the solution one needs: − the solution of the purely elastic comparison problem in the sense of shakedown analysis, − the construction of a time-independent residual stress field. To this end, we use the finite element force method based on the principle of minimum complementary energy [12]. This approach uses stress functions for the construction of the complementary energy function and represents an algebraic dual to the finite element displacement method. This method has been used by [13] for the study of limit and shakedown analysis of two-dimensional structures. 6.1 Shakedown loads domain: We consider a rectangular cracked plate, subjected to uniform loading (fig.2):
Figure 2:
Rectangular plate with lateral crack.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
616 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The obtained results (fig. 3) show that the safety load is reduced in the presence of crack; this reduction depends on the crack length. The load P2 amends adversely the domain of load and reduces the limits of the load obtained. While under the load P1, the influence of the crack is lesser because the stress concentration is less important, and is situated on crack lips, not in front of the crack tip. Figure 4 shows well that in the case of a cracked plate, the dimensioning based on the limit analysis is not recommended if the applied loads could vary in an independent way. 0.4
0.32
0.24
P2 P0 0.16 Shakedown domain a = 0.2 W a = 0.3 W a = 0.4 W a = 0.5 W
0.08
0
0
0.2
Figure 3:
0.4
P1 P0
0.6
0.8
1
Shakedown domain.
0.75 a = 0.5 W Limit analysis Shakedown 0.6
0.45
P2 P0 0.3
0.15
0
0
Figure 4:
0.2
0.4
P1 P0 0.6
0.8
1
Shakedown and load limits domains.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
617
1.25 Shakedown Limit analysis Limit analysis (analytic) 1
Load factor
0.75
0.5
0.25
0
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
a/W
Figure 5:
Influence of the ratio a/W on the load factor. 12.5
10
7.5
K SD 5
2.5
0
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
a/W
Figure 6:
Independence of K SD with a/W.
Figure 5 shows that for the cracked plate subjected to the load P2, the value of the limit load values agrees with the analytical ones. 6.2 Shakedown stress intensity factor KSD We have computed the stress intensity factor at the shakedown state for different crack lengths, the obtained results (fig 6), show that this factor K SD is crack length independent, and it can be considered as the safety parameter against the cracked structure ruin, by plasticity and crack propagation for the mode I of loading. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
618 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 0.075
0.06
0.045
K SD σy 0.03
0.015
0
0
Figure 7:
2
4
1
ξ2
6
8
10
Relation between K SD and ξ1 2 .
We have then studied the influence of the grain size on the shakedown stress intensity factor K SD , figure 7 shows that the ratio K SD / σ y varies linearly with ξ1 2 . K SD = a + bξ1 2 . σy
(18)
By comparing this equation with the equation giving the fatigue threshold, one notes that the yield stress influences the shakedown stress intensity factor. This can be explained by the fact that the shakedown intensity factor is computed by taking into account the yield stress and the largest admissible crack length. 6.3 Comparison of KSD and the fatigue threshold values for some materials To validate the proposed approach, a comparison is made between the values of K SD computed in the case of a rectangular plate solicited in mode I, the fatigue threshold K S given by [7] and the shakedown stress intensity factor K sh given by [5] for some materials. The characteristics of these materials are given in the Table 1. According to the results given in the Table 2, one remarks that the values of K SD agree with the values of K sh given by [5]. On the other hand, one notices a disparity with the fatigue threshold K S given by [7] for materials A and E. However, the results indicate that indeed K SD can be considered as fatigue threshold. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1:
Diameter of the grain and mechanical material data.
Material
Designation
ξ (µm)
σ y (MPa)
Docol 350 SS 141147 HP steel HP steel HP steel
A B C D E
8 15 29 45 82
260 185 210 160 120
Table 2:
619
Fatigue threshold and shakedown stress intensity factors.
Material A B C D E
KS 5.4 6.0 6.2 6.7 8.2
K sh 8.9 7.6 9.5 8.1 7.8
K SD 8.43 6.49 8.22 6.8 5.73
More, knowing that the relationship existing between the yield stress and the diameter of the grain has the following form [7,8]: σ y = c + dξ
−
1 2
,
(19)
σ y increases when the diameter of the grain decreases and since the residual
stress intensity increases with the increase of the elastic limit, one can say, considering the equation (16), that disparities observed between K SD and K S values are mainly caused by the residual stresses. One concludes that the computed stress intensity factor can be considered as a fatigue threshold taking into account the residual stresses.
7
Conclusion
In this work, we have presented a new method in the prediction of the inelastic cracked structures failure by the application of the shakedown analysis. This new method presents several advantages, among which, the facility of computation since one undertakes only an elastic calculation. Also, it allows going more far than the elastic limit in the structures design. We can also compute the fatigue threshold using this method.
References [1]
Belouchrani M. A., Contribution to the shakedown analysis of inelastic cracked structures, PhD Thesis, University of Lille, (1997).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
620 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
[8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Belouchrani M. A. and Weichert D., An extension of the static shakedown theorem to inelastic cracked structures, Int. J. Mech. Sci., 41, 163-177, (1998). Neuber H., Über die Berücksichtigug der Spannungskonzentration bei Festigkeitsberechnungen, Konstruktion 20 (7), 245-251, (1968). Lemaitre J. and Chaboche J. L., Mécanique des matériaux solides, Dunod, Paris, (1985). Huang Y. and Stein E., Shakedown of a cracked body consisting of kinematic hardening material, Eng. Frac. Mech, 54, 1, 107-112, (1996). Creager M., Master Thesis, Lehigh University, (1966). Wasen J., Hamberg K. and Karlsson B., The influence of Grain Size and Fracture Surface Geometry on the Near-threshold Fatigue Crack Growth in Ferritic Steels, Materials Science and Engineering A, 102, 217-226, (1988). Xu-Dong Li and Edwards L., Theoretical Modelling of Fatigue Threshold for Aluminium Alloys, Eng. Frac. Mech., 54, 35-48, (1996). Radaj D. and Zhang S., On the relation between notch stress and crack stress intensity in plane shear and mixed mode loading, Eng. Frac. Mech., 44, N°5, 691-704, (1993). Belouchrani M. A., Weichert D. and Hachemi A., Fatigue threshold computation by shakedown theory, Mech. Resea. Comm., vol. 27, N° 3, pp. 287-293, (2000). Pierre D. A. and Lowe M. J., Mathematical programming via Augmented Lagrangians, London: Addison-Wesley, (1975). Gallagher R. H. and Dhalla A. K., Direct flexibility finite element elastoplastic analysis, Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey, USA, (1975). Gross-Weege J. and Weichert D., Elastic-plastic shells under variable mechanical and thermal loads, Int. J. Mech. Sci., 34, 863-880, (1992).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 7 Experiments and analysis of reinforced concrete members (Special session organised by Professor C. G. Karayannis)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
623
Cyclic testing of reinforced concrete beam-column joints with crossed inclined bars C. E. Chalioris, C. G. Karayannis & M. I. Favvata Department of Civil Engineering, Democritus University of Thrace, Greece
Abstract The use of crossed inclined bars in external beam-column connections under cyclic deformations is experimentally investigated. For this purpose, test results of four Reinforced Concrete (RC) joint subassemblages subjected to constantly increasing pseudo-seismic loading are presented. The shear reinforcement in the joint area for two specimens was two pairs of inclined bars that formed a pair of X-type reinforcement. The other two specimens were conventionally reinforced joints (control specimens). The effectiveness of this X-type, non-conventional reinforcement on the overall seismic performance of the tested joints is examined. The beam and the columns of all the specimens were designed according to the requirements of ACI 318-02 and the recommendations of ACI-ASCE 352-02 (Type 2 exterior connections). The design of the joint area for one control specimen was also carried out according the ACI Design Codes and the required amount of steel stirrups (5∅8) was added in the joint body. The other control specimen had no stirrup at the joint area. Comparisons between the test results of the examined specimens indicated that the cyclic behaviour of the joints with X-bars was ameliorated with respect to the response of the control specimen without stirrups. Further, load capacity and hysteretic energy dissipation values of the joint with 2X-bars ∅14 were slightly lower than the values of the control specimen which joint area had stirrups (5∅8) according to the specifications of ACI Design Codes. Keywords: beam-column joint, cyclic tests, reinforced concrete, inclined bars.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070621
624 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The behaviour of beam-column joints has long been recognized as a significant factor that frequently becomes critical for the overall behaviour of Reinforced Concrete (RC) framed structures subjected to seismic excitations. The response of RC connections involves the influence of complex interacting phenomena such as shear, bond, confinement, fatigue, which even independently are not yet well understood [1]. Therefore, experimental research is very often the main method for the investigation of the parameters that influence and improve the joint performance [2]. It is also noted that detailed design recommendations for RC beam-column joints were first published in the last two decades in Europe and in the last three decades in USA. Attempts at any improvement of the seismic properties of these members are mainly focus on the use of non-conventional reinforcement, such as steel fibres, composite materials (FRPs), inclined bars and spiral reinforcement [3]. The first idea of the use of crossed inclined bars in RC joints was developed in 1984 [4]. Since then, further experimental and analytical studies indicated that joints with X-type reinforcement exhibited improved behaviour in respect to joints with conventional reinforcement [5–8]. The aim of the present work is to experimentally investigate the effectiveness of crossed inclined bars in external beam-column connections subjected to cyclic loading. Four RC joint specimens with different reinforcement arrangements in the joint area, that included X-bars and stirrups, were tested to the same constantly increasing cyclic loading sequence and useful concluding remarks were derived.
2
Experimental program
The experimental program of this paper includes 4 external beam-column joint specimens. The geometry of the specimens was the same; total columns height and cross-section dimensions 1800 mm and 300×200 mm, respectively, whereas beam length and cross-section dimensions were 1300 mm and 200/300 mm, respectively. The beam and the columns of all the specimens were designed according to the specifications of ACI 318-02 [9] and ACI-ASCE 352-02 [10] for Type 2 exterior connections (see Table 1 and Figure 1). The shear reinforcement of the joint area varied. First, control specimen JA-0 had no stirrups (2 vertical ∅10 column bars were placed through the joint area as in all the specimens). The joint area of control specimen JA-s5 was designed according the ACI Design Codes and 5∅8 steel stirrups were added (required amount of stirrups). Finally, specimens JA-2X12 and JA-2X14 had two pairs of inclined bars ∅12 and ∅14, respectively, which formed a pair of X-type reinforcement (Figure 1). Geometry and detailed reinforcement arrangement of the tested specimens are shown in Figure 1 and presented in Table 1. Concrete mean cylinder compressive strength at the age of 28 days was fcm = 34 MPa and steel yield strength was 580 MPa. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1:
Reinforcement arrangement of the beam-column joint specimens.
Specimen
Columns
JA-0
(+ 2∅10 middle bars) Stirrups: ∅8/50 mm
JA-s5
JA-2X12
JA-2X14
625
4∅14 (corner bars)
4∅14 (corner bars) (+ 2∅10 middle bars) Stirrups: ∅8/50 mm
4∅14 (+ 4∅12)* (corner) (+ 2∅10 middle bars) Stirrups: ∅8/50 mm
4∅14 (+ 4∅14)* (corner) (+ 2∅10 middle bars) Stirrups: ∅8/50 mm
*
Beam 4∅12 top 4∅12 bottom Stir.: ∅8/65 mm
4∅12 top 4∅12 bottom Stir.: ∅8/65 mm
4∅12 top 4∅12 bottom Stir.: ∅8/65 mm
4∅12 top 4∅12 bottom Stir.: ∅8/65 mm
Joint area (2∅10 vertical bars)
5∅8 (∅8/50 mm) (+ 2∅10 vertical bars)
2X∅12 (+ 2∅10 vertical bars)
2X∅14 (+ 2∅10 vertical bars)
The inclined X-bars in joint area were extended to the entire height of both columns. Test setup and instrumentation details are shown in Figure 2. Supports that allow rotation were used to simulate the inflection points assumed to occur at a point of the columns in a laterally-loaded frame structure. Column axial load with value equal to Nc = 0.05×Ac×fcm was applied during the tests. All specimens were subjected to full cycle deformations imposed near the free end of the beam by a pinned-end actuator. The moment arm for the applied load was equal to 1.2 m. Tested specimens were suffered a loading history of five full loading steps with maximum displacements ± 6 mm, ± 20 mm, ± 40 mm, ± 60 mm and ± 80 mm at each step. Every loading step included two full load cycles, thus, the loading sequence was performed the way it is shown in Figure 3. The imposed load was measured by a load cell with accuracy equal to 0.025 kN and the displacements of the beam were measured by linear variable differential transducer (LVDT) with accuracy equal to 0.01 mm.
3 Test results The hysteretic responses of the tested specimens are compared in Figures 4 and 5. Further, the values of the maximum bending moment (load capacity) and the hysteretic energy dissipation in terms of the area of the response loading cycle for each loading cycle and for each joint are presented in Table 2.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
626 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1502
200
72
5∅8
65
130
4∅12
in joint
300
1800
JA-s5
4∅12
50
600
200
1300
80
260
∅8
JA-0 130
50
JA-s5 4∅14+2∅10 240
160
200
300
80
∅12 − ∅14
724
∅8
182
65
130
300
1800
36 0
352
4∅12
4∅12
50
600 1300
200
724
JA-2X12 50
JA-2X14
Figure 1:
Geometry and reinforcement arrangements of the tested specimens.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
627
Load frame
actuator
Nc
load cell
actuator
LVDT load cell
P
1.20
+ 1.80 1.50
-
LVDT 1.30
LVDT
Figure 2:
Test setup.
80
Deformation (mm)
60 40 20 0 -20 -40 -60 -80
Figure 3:
Loading history.
In order to evaluate the effectiveness of the examined reinforcement in the joint area, the final cracking patterns of the tested joints are illustrated in the photos of Figure 6. Based on the damage modes and the observations of cracking propagation during the entire cyclic loading procedure of the specimens, it is deduced that crossed inclined bars inhibited the damage in the joint area and considerably improved the damage mode characteristics (distinct plastic hinges were formed). Further, the presence of stirrups (specimen JA-s5) proved to be
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Moment (kNm)
628 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0 -80
-70
-60
-50
-40
-30
-20
-10 0 -10
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
Deformation (mm)
-20 -30 -40
JA-0
-50
JA-2X12
Moment (kNm)
-60 -70 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0 -80
-70
-60
-50
-40
-30
-20
-10 0 -10
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
Deformation (mm)
-20 -30 -40
JA-0
-50
JA-2X14
-60 -70
Figure 4:
Comparison of the hysteretic responses of the tested specimens.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Moment (kNm)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
629
70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0
-80
-70
-60
-50
-40
-30
-20
-10 0 -10
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
Deformation (mm)
-20 -30 -40
JA-s5
-50
JA-2X14
-60 -70
Figure 5:
Comparison of the hysteretic responses of joints JA-s5 and JA2X14. Table 2:
Test results.
JA-0 JA-s5 JA-2X12 JA-2X14 Cycle Moment Energy Moment Energy Moment Energy Moment Energy (kN⋅m)
6-1+ 6-16-2+ 6-220-1+ 20-120-2+ 20-240-1+ 40-140-2+ 40-260-1+ 60-160-2+ 60-280-1+ 80-180-2+ 80-2-
39.8 -35.6 38.9 -32.4 62.6 -62.8 56.7 -54.2 64.6 -58.5 44.5 -38.7 38.6 -30.8 22.5 -19.6 -
(kN⋅m⋅mm)
178.1 149.4 1267.8 535.3 3454.6 1454.4 2164.8 899.4 -
(kN⋅m)
36.7 -41.4 35.7 -38.7 60.4 -61.2 54.2 -60.0 60.9 -64.2 59.2 -63.3 63.0 -63.6 59.0 -58.0 36.7 -38.8 15.3 -25.0
(kN⋅m⋅mm)
215.2 158.1 1405.2 1095.3 4013.4 3917.2 6644.7 4613.3 5414.0 2975.3
(kN⋅m)
33.7 -34.6 31.1 -31.1 62.6 -61.1 58.3 -59.0 64.2 -60.0 56.4 -57.0 55.8 -49.2 30.6 -27.0 13.8 -22.2 10.2 -16.4
(kN⋅m⋅mm)
206.7 227.8 985.9 885.6 3207.2 2625.9 4385.0 2143.6 1913.5 1202.5
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(kN⋅m)
33.8 -33.8 33.1 -32.9 63.0 -61.2 60.6 -58.9 65.4 -64.6 58.2 -64.3 59.4 -65.3 52.2 -50.3 36.6 -27.9 15.0 -13.0
(kN⋅m⋅mm)
275.5 196.3 969.1 767.3 3817.6 3479.9 5975.9 4417.7 3694.5 1731.7
630 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
JA-2X12 JA-0
JA-s5 Figure 6:
JA-2X14
Damage modes and crack patterns at the end of the loading sequence.
essential since stirrups increased the joint shear capacity and restrained the deformations of the bend anchorage of the beam’s bars that caused severe damages at the back of the joint area in the other specimens without stirrups.
4
Concluding remarks
Cyclic test results of four RC external beam-column joint specimens were presented herein, in order to investigate the effectiveness of crossed inclined bars as shear reinforcement in joint area. The specimens were designed according the specifications of ACI 318-02 and ACI-ASCE 352-02. Based on the hysteretic WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
631
responses and the cracking modes of the tested joints it is deduced that the overall seismic performance of the joints with X-type reinforcement was considerably improved with respect to the response of the control specimen without stirrups. Joints with X-bars, in comparison with the control specimen without stirrups, exhibited higher values of load capacity in most of the loading cycles and increased hysteretic energy dissipation practically in the entire loading sequence. This improvement was greater in the higher deformation loading cycles. Further, the hysteretic response of the specimen with 2X∅14 as shear reinforcement in joint area was slightly lower from the response of the control specimen with 5∅8 stirrups, which followed the guidelines of ACI Design Codes. Concerning the cracking patterns, the deformations of the bend anchorage of the beam’s bars (anchorage failure) in combination with the absence of stirrups in the joint area contributed to significant damage of the concrete cover at the back of the joint area. Stirrups restrained these deformations and kept the joint body quite intact. Specimens with X-bars performed enhanced damage mode since distinct flexural hinge was developed in the beam-joint interface.
References [1]
[2]
[3]
[4] [5] [6] [7]
Karayannis, C.G. & Sirkelis, G.M., Effectiveness of RC beam-column connections strengthening using carbon-FRP jackets, Proc. of the 12th European Conference on Earthquake Engineering, London, UK, PR 549, 2002. Karayannis, C.G., Sirkelis, G.M. & Chalioris, C.E., Seismic performance of RC beam-column joints retrofitted using light RC jacket - Experimental study, Proc. of the 1st European Conference on Earthquake Engineering and Seismology, Geneva, Switzerland, PN.136, 2006. Karayannis, C.G. & Sirkelis, G.M., Response of columns and joints with spiral shear reinforcement, Proc. of the 12th Int. Conference: Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements (CMEM), Malta, Wessex Institute of Technology Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol. 41, 2005. Paulay, T. & Park, R., Joints of reinforced concrete frames designed for earthquake resistance. Research report 84-9, Dept. of Civil Engineering, Univ. of Canterbury, Christchurch, New Zealand, 1984. Tsonos, A.G., Tegos, I.A. & Penelis, G.G., Seismic resistance of Type 2 exterior beam - column joints reinforced with inclined bars, ACI Structural Journal, 89(1), pp. 3-12, 1992. Karayannis, C.G., Chalioris, C.E. & Sideris, K.K., Effectiveness of RC beam - column connection repair using epoxy resin injections. Journal of Earthquake Engineering, 2(2), pp. 217-240, 1998. Bakir, P.G., Seismic resistance and mechanical behaviour of exterior beam - column joints with crossed inclined bars. Journal of Structural Engineering and Mechanics, 16(4), pp. 493-517, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
632 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [8]
[9] [10]
Tsonos, A.G., Improvement of the earthquake resistance of R/C beam column joints under the influence of P-∆ effect and axial force variations using inclined bars, Journal of Structural Engineering and Mechanics, 18(4), pp. 389-410, 2004. ACI Committee 318. Building code requirements for structural concrete (ACI 318-02) and commentary (ACI 318R-02). American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, Mich., 2002. ACI-ASCE Committee 352. Recommendations for design of beamcolumn connections in monolithic reinforced concrete structures (ACI 352R-02). American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, Mich., 2002.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
633
Tests and analysis of reinforced concrete beams under torsion retrofitted with FRP strips C. E. Chalioris Department of Civil Engineering, Democritus University of Thrace, Greece
Abstract The aim of the present study is twofold. First, the results of an experimental investigation on the torsional response of reinforced concrete (RC) beams retrofitted with epoxy-bonded carbon fibre-reinforced-polymer (FRP) strips as external transverse reinforcement are presented. Second, an analytical approach for the estimation of the torsional capacity and the entire behaviour of RC beams retrofitted with FRP fabrics is attempted. The experimental program comprises eight beams with a rectangular cross-section tested under pure torsion. Based on the measured values of the torsional moment at cracking and at ultimate and the behavioural curves of the beams, useful conclusions concerning the effectiveness of the FRP strengthening technique are indicated. Further, in order to describe the entire torsional behaviour of RC beams retrofitted with FRP, a method that employs the combination of two different analytical theories is used. The prediction of the elastic till the first cracking part is achieved using a smeared crack analysis for plain concrete in torsion, whereas for the description of the post-cracking response a modified softened truss model is proposed. The wellknown softened truss model is properly modified to include the influence of the FRP fabrics on the torsional response as external reinforcement. Analytical torsional behaviour curves are compared with experimental ones from the present study and the literature, and first concluding remarks are mentioned. Keywords: beams, reinforced concrete, fibre-reinforced polymers (FRP), retrofit, model, torsion, tests.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070631
634 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Torsion occurs more frequently in modern structures but rarely occurs alone. However, torsion forms one of the basic structural actions besides flexure, shear and axial force. Torsional failure of concrete members is initiated by the tensile stress developed due to a state of pure shear, which arises due to torsion [1]. Epoxy-bonded Fibre-Reinforced Polymers (FRP) materials to the surface of Reinforced Concrete (RC) members are considered as external reinforcement that can bear the developed tensile stresses. The advanced mechanical properties and the easy-to-apply character of these composite materials inspired the researchers to study their use on strengthening and rehabilitation of deficit concrete elements. A growing number of studies and applications in this area has been carried out for the flexural and shear strengthening of RC subassemblages under monotonic and cyclic deformations [2–4]. Nevertheless, the conducted research on the torsional upgrading of RC beams using FRP materials is quite limited and has preliminary and exploratory character so far. Earlier investigations indicated that FRP materials caused a significant increase on the torsional capacity of the tested beams [5–7]. Torsion of plain, steel reinforced and fibre reinforced concrete beams has extensively been studied by several experimental and analytical researches [8–11]. The present study deals with the upgrading of torsional resistance of RC beams using FRP fabrics, which is still an open field of study. The recent increase interest for the use of these materials, the catastrophic character of the torsional failure and the lack of relative studies are the main motives behind this effort. The objective of this work has two parts; an experimental and an analytical one. The experimental program consists of 8 specimens and aims to evaluate the effectiveness of the use of epoxy-bonded carbon FRP strips as external transverse reinforcement to RC beams subjected to pure torsion. The analytical part of the study employs a method that has already been used for the prediction of the entire torsional response of RC beams [12, 13]. This model derives from the combination of two well-known theories [1, 14] and it is properly modified herein, in order to include the influence of the FRP materials on the torsional behaviour.
2
Experimental program
The experimental program comprises 8 beams of rectangular cross-section sorted in two groups (Ra and Rb) and tested under pure torsion action. The crosssection dimensions of the beams of group Ra was 100/200 mm, whereas the beams of group Rb had cross-section dimensions 150/300 mm. Each group comprises four specimens. Two of them were strengthened using epoxy-bonded carbon FRP strips that wrapped around the rectangular cross-section of the beams as external transverse reinforcement. The longitudinal reinforcement of all
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
635
the tested specimens was the same; four deformed bars of diameter 8 mm (4∅8) at the corners of the rectangular cross-section. The transverse reinforcement of the beams varies (none, steel stirrups or/and FRP strips) as shown in Table 1. Reinforcement arrangement of all the tested beams is also presented in Table 1. The concrete compressive and tensile strength values were measured from supplementary compression and splitting tests, respectively, and equal to 27.5 MPa and 2.8 MPa for the beams of group Ra and 28.8 MPa and 2.9 MPa for the beams of group Rb. Steel yield strength was 560 MPa for the ∅8 deformed longitudinal steel bars and 350 MPa for the ∅5.5 mild steel stirrups. Unidirectional carbon FRP fabrics with thickness tf = 0.11 mm per ply were used as external transverse reinforcement (SikaWrap-200C). The fibre direction oriented perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of the beam. According to the FRP supplier data, the elastic modulus, the ultimate tensile strength and the elongation at failure of the fibres were 230 GPa, 3900 MPa and 1.5% mm/mm, respectively. A two-component rubber-toughened cold-curing-construction epoxy adhesive with density 1310 kg/m3, elastic modulus 3800 MPa and tensile strength 30 MPa was used for bonding the FRP strips to concrete (Sikadur 330).
Table 1:
Reinforcement and concrete strength of tested beams.
Beam code name
Steel bars (mm)
Steel stirrups (mm)
nf
Ra-c Ra-Fs150(2) Ra-S Ra-SFs150(2) Rb-c Rb-Fs200(1) Rb-S Rb-SFs200(1)
4∅8 4∅8 4∅8 4∅8 4∅8 4∅8 4∅8 4∅8
∅5.5/130 ∅5.5/130 ∅5.5/100 ∅5.5/100
2 2 1 1
FRP strips wf (mm) 150 150 200 200
sf (mm) 300 300 400 400
Af/sf (mm) 0.110 0.110 0.055 0.055
ρ sAn
ρ stn
ρ nft
(%)
(%)
(%)
1.01 1.01 1.01 1.01 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.45
0.38 0.38 0.38 0.38
0.33 0.33 0.11 0.11
All tested specimens had common total length equal to 1.60 m and were tested monotonically under pure torsion. Details about the experimental apparatus and the test procedure can be found in references 7 and 13. The values of torque moment at cracking and ultimate torque moment, as measured from the tests, are presented in Table 2. Further, the entire torsional behaviour of the beams is also presented in Figure 1 in terms of torsional moment versus angle of twist per unit length experimental curves.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
636 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Torsional moment (kN.m)
5 Ra-SFs150(2) 4 3
Ra-Fs150(2) Ra-S
2 1 0 0.00
Ra-c
0.05
0.10
0.15
Angle of twist per length (rad/m)
Torsional moment (kN.m)
10 Rb-SFs200(1) 8
Rb-Fs200(1) Rb-S
6 Rb-c
4 2 0 0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
Angle of twist per length (rad/m) Figure 1:
3
Experimental curves of the tested beams.
Behavioural model and comparisons with test results
The prediction of the entire torsional behaviour of RC beams strengthened with FRP strips is achieved using a combined approach that has already been proposed for RC beams [12, 13]. In the present study this method is extended to include the influence of FRP fabrics. The method employs the combination of two different analytical models, since the torsional response of RC members consists of a pre-cracking and a post-cracking part and justifies this WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
637
simulation [13]. The elastic till the first cracking part is described by a smeared crack analysis for plain concrete in torsion [1] and the post-cracking part is described by a softened truss model [14]. It is justified that for the elastic till the first cracking region the percentage of reinforcement has a minor effect on the torsional response and RC elements behave, more or less, as plain concrete members. Therefore, the analytical smeared crack model for plain concrete in torsion proposed by Karayannis [1] is applicable to RC beams for the prediction of the first elastic part till the developing of concrete cracking. The model is based on an analytical technique that employs constitutive relations expressed in terms of normal stress and crack width, for the behaviour of the crack process zones. Detailed derivation of the equations and the solution technique of this theory can be found in reference 1. For the calculation of the torsional behaviour of a RC beam strengthened with FRP strips in the post-cracking region the basic equations and considerations of the softened truss model [14] are adopted and properly modified. This method relies on solving three equilibrium and three compatibility equations along with the constitutive laws of an element taken from a member subjected to pure torsion. The equations of equilibrium and compatibility are based on the assumption that the material is continuous. Especially for the concrete in compression, it is considered that concrete struts strength is greatly reduced by the diagonal cracking caused by tension in the perpendicular direction (concrete softening). The influence of the epoxy-bonded FRP fabrics as external reinforcement is implemented as an additional component that contributes to the torsional resistance along with the steel reinforcement. Particularly, considering the state of stress in a finite concrete element of the cracked beam, which is assumed to lie in the plane of the shear flow, it is subjected to a set of stresses in the plane represented by Mohr’s circle [14]. Thus, from the stresses equilibrium the following relationships that include the influence of FRP reinforcement are deduced:
σ A = σ d cos 2 α + σ r sin 2 α + ρ sA f sA + ρ fA f fA σ t = σ d sin 2 α + σ r cos 2 α + ρ st f st + ρ ft f ft τ At = (− σ d + σ r ) sin α cos α where σ A and σ t are the normal stresses of the element in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively; σ d and σ r are the principal compressive and tensile stresses, respectively; α is the inclination angle of the diagonal compression struts; τ At is the shear stress; ρ sA and ρ st are the longitudinal and transverse steel reinforcement ratio, respectively; ρ fA and ρ ft are the ratio of the FRP fabrics in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively; f sA , f st , f fA and f ft are the stresses of steel and FRP reinforcement in longitudinal and transverse direction. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
638 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII It is noted that the above mentioned ratios are not the normalised reinforcement ratios presented in Table 1, but they are calculated by the following expressions:
ρ sA =
ρ fA =
AsA po t d
A fA po t d
for the steel bars and =
(n fA ⋅ t fA ) p fA po t d
and ρ ft =
ρ st =
A ft p ft po t d s f
=
Ast p st po t d s
for the stirrups,
(n ft ⋅ t ft )w f p ft po t d s f
for the FRP
fabrics in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively, where p o is the perimeter of the centreline of the shear flow; t d is the effective thickness of the compression zone in the diagonal compression struts; AsA is the total area of steel longitudinal bars; Ast is the area of one steel stirrup; p st is the perimeter of the steel stirrup; s is the spacing of steel stirrups; n fA , n ft and t fA , t ft are the numbers of plies and the thicknesses of one FRP ply of the epoxy-bonded FRP fabrics in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively; p fA , p ft are the perimeters of the strengthened beam cross-section using FRP fabrics in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively; w f is the width of the FRP strips; s f is the length along the beam over that FRP area is distributed, which is equal to the spacing between the centroid line of the FRP strips; A fA , A ft are the FRP fabrics area in longitudinal and transverse direction, respectively. Further, the developed tensile stress of the FRP fabrics is calculated by the strain of the fibres, ε f , using the following expression: f f = E f ε f ≤ f fu and
ε f ≤ ε fu ; where E f , f fu and ε fu are the elastic modulus, the ultimate tensile strength and the elongation at failure (ultimate strain) of the fibres, respectively. The shear flow derived from the Bredt equation has the form:
τ At =
T and therefore T = 2 Ao t d (− σ d + σ r ) sin α cos α 2 Ao t d
where T is the torsional moment; Ao is the area enclosed by the centreline of the shear flow. The compatibility equations relate the shear distortion in the wall, γ At , to the strains of the concrete and reinforcements:
ε A = ε d cos 2 α + ε r sin 2 α ε t = ε d sin 2 α + ε r cos 2 α
γ At = (− ε d + ε r ) sin 2α εA + εt = εd + εr WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
639
The inclination angle of the diagonal compression struts can be calculated by: tan α =
εA − εd εt − εd
The angle of twist per unit length, ϑ , is related with the shear distortion:
ϑ=
po γ At 2 Ao
Especially for the concrete in compression, it is taking into account the fact that concrete struts strength is reduced by the diagonal cracking caused by tension in the perpendicular direction (concrete softening) and appropriate constitutive laws with softening effect have been formulated [13, 14]. Analyses for the prediction of the torsional behaviour of the 8 tested beams and 5 more beams from the literature [5] using the proposed combined approach were performed. Analytical values of the torsional moment at cracking and the ultimate torsional moment are presented and compared with the measured ones in Table 2. Furthermore, full analytical torque curves for the behaviour of 4 beams are compared with the experimental ones in Figures 2 and 3. 10
5
4
Torsional moment (kN.m)
Torsional moment (kN.m)
9
3
2
1
Ra-SFs150(2)
8 7 6 5
Test results
4
Proposed model
3 2
Rb-SFs200(1)
1 0 0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
0 0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
Angle of twist per length (rad/m) Figure 2:
Comparisons between experimental and calculated curves.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
18
18
16
16
14
14
Torsional moment (kN.m)
Torsional moment (kN.m)
640 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
12 10 8
C2
6 4
12 10 8
C4
6 4 Test results [Ghobarah et al (2002)]
2
2
0 0.00
0.10
0.20
0 0.00
Proposed model
0.10
0.20
Angle of twist per length (rad/m) Figure 3: Table 2:
Comparisons between experimental [5] and calculated curves. Test results and analytical predictions of the tested beams.
Cracking torsional moment Ultimate torsional moment (kN⋅m) (kN⋅m) exp . exp . exp. calc. exp. calc. calc. calc. Present experimental study & Chalioris [7] Ra-c 2.39 2.33 0.975 * Ra-Fs150(2) 2.22 2.33 1.050 3.02 2.75 0.911 Ra-S 2.25 2.33 1.036 2.41 2.31 0.959 Ra-SFs150(2) 2.35 2.33 0.991 4.33 4.22 0.975 Rb-c 6.95 6.85 0.985 * Rb-Fs200(1) 6.73 6.85 1.018 9.32 8.72 0.936 Rb-S 6.90 6.85 0.993 7.15 6.90 0.965 Rb-SFs200(1) 6.93 6.85 0.988 9.80 9.60 0.980 Ghobarah et al [5] N2 5.00 5.75 1.150 11.02 12.11 1.099 C2 5.53 5.75 1.039 13.96 15.41 1.104 C4 6.57 5.75 0.875 15.83 17.12 1.081 C5 5.87 5.75 0.979 13.42 15.08 1.124 G2 6.29 5.75 0.914 13.15 14.52 1.104 *:post-cracking behaviour of the beam did not exhibit increased torsional strength. Beam code name
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
641
Concluding remarks
Retrofitting with epoxy-bonded FRP strips is a feasible strengthening technique for existing under-reinforced beams subjected to torsion. Strengthened beams exhibited better overall torsional performance than the non-strengthened control specimens. Failure of wrapped beams with FRP strips was partially delayed in respect to the failure of the control specimens and fibres initially prevented cracking. However, torsional diagonal cracks eventually appeared and widened in the unwrapped concrete of the beams. Two distinct regions are observed in a typical experimental curve of a RC beam with FRP strips. The different character of the response in these regions reveals the different nature of the load resisting mechanism in each part. For the prediction of the entire torsional behaviour of RC beams strengthened with FRP strips a combined method is adopted that employs a smeared crack analysis for the elastic till the first cracking response and a softened truss model that has been extended to include the influence of the FRP fabrics for the post-cracking response. Comparisons between analytical and experimental torque curves showed promising results.
References [1] [2]
[3]
[4] [5] [6] [7]
[8]
Karayannis, C.G., Smeared Crack Analysis for Plain Concrete in Torsion, Structural Engineering, ASCE, 126(6), pp. 638-645, 2000. Karayannis, C.G. & Sirkelis, G.M., Effectiveness of RC Beam-column Connections Strengthening using carbon-FRP Jackets, Proc. of the 12th European Conference on Earthquake Engineering, London, UK, PR 549, 2002. Tsonos, A. & Papanikolaou, K., Post-Earthquake Repair and Strengthening of RC Beam-column Connections (Theoretical and Experimental Investigation), Bulletin of the New Zealand National Society for Earthquake Engineering, 36(2), pp. 73-93, 2003. Chalioris, C.E., Shear Performance of RC Beams using FRP Sheets covering Part of the Shear Span. Proc. of the 1st International Conference on Concrete Repair, St-Malo, Brittany, France, Vol. 2, pp. 809-816, 2003. Ghobarah, A., Ghorbel, M.N. & Chidiac, S.E., Upgrading Torsional Resistance of Reinforced Concrete Beams using Fiber-Reinforced Polymer, Composites for Construction, ASCE, 6(4), pp. 257-263, 2002. Salom, P.R., Gergely, J.M. & Young, D.T., Torsional Strengthening of Spandrel Beams with Fiber-Reinforced Polymer Laminates, Composites for Construction, ASCE, 8(2), pp. 157-162, 2004. Chalioris, C.E. Torsional Strengthening of Rectangular and Flanged Beams using Carbon Fibre-Reinforced-Polymers – Experimental Study, Construction and Building Materials, available on-line from 16 Nov. 2006 (to appear in 2007). Karayannis, C.G. & Chalioris, C.E., Experimental Validation of Smeared Analysis for Plain Concrete in Torsion, Structural Engineering, ASCE, 126(6), pp. 646-653, 2000. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
642 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [9] [10] [11]
[12]
[13] [14]
Karayannis, C.G., Nonlinear Analysis and Tests of Steel-fiber Concrete Beams in Torsion, Structural Engineering and Mechanics, 9(4), pp. 323338, 2000. Karayannis, C.G. & Chalioris, C.E., Strength of Prestressed Concrete Beams in Torsion, Structural Engineering and Mechanics, 10(2), 165180, 2000. Chalioris, C.E., Cracking and Ultimate Torque Capacity of Reinforced Concrete Beams, Proc. of the Int. Symposia Celebrating Concrete: People and Practice, University of Dundee, Scotland, UK, Vol. Role of Concrete Bridges in Sustainable Development, pp. 109-118, 2003. Chalioris, C.E., Behaviour Model and Experimental Study for the Torsion of Reinforced Concrete Members, Proc. of the 3rd Int. Conference: High Performance Structures and Materials, Ostend, Belgium, Wessex Institute of Technology Transactions on The Built Environment, Vol. 85, pp. 459468, 2006. Chalioris, C.E. Experimental Study of the Torsion of Reinforced Concrete Members, Structural Engineering and Mechanics, 23(6), pp. 713-737, 2006. Hsu, T.C., Toward a Unified Nomenclature for Reinforced-Concrete Theory, Structural Engineering, ASCE, 122(3), pp. 275-283, 1996.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
643
Influence of masonry strength and rectangular spiral shear reinforcement on infilled RC frames under cyclic loading D. J. Kakaletsis Technological Educational Institution of Serres, Greece
Abstract The effect of two types of shear reinforcement of the concrete members and two types of masonry infills on the seismic performance of reinforced concrete (RC) frames was experimentally investigated. Six single-story, one-bay, 1/3-scale frame specimens were tested under cyclic horizontal loading, up to a drift level of 40‰. Bare frames and infilled frames with weak and strong infills were sorted into two groups: Specimens of group A had stirrups while specimens of group B had spirals respectively, as shear reinforcement. The frames were designed in accordance with modern codes provisions. The types of masonry infills had different compressive strength but almost identical shear strength. Infills were designed so that the infill lateral cracking load is less than the available column shear resistance. The results from the specimens of group A were compared with the results from specimens of group B, in terms of hysteretic response, ductility and energy absorption. From the observed responses of the tested specimens it can be deduced that the use of rectangular spiral reinforcement in the beam and columns, even in the case of strong infills, improved the seismic capacity of the examined infilled RC frames. Keywords: infilled R/C frames, masonry strength, spiral shear reinforcement.
1
Introduction
From the experimental investigations that were carried out by several researchers, [1–4], it has been shown that the presence of infill panels improves the seismic performance of a frame. The stronger the infill and the frame is, the higher is the seismic resistance (Mehrabi et al [5]). However the brittle shear failure of columns which might jeopardise the stability and repairability of a WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070641
644 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII structure must be avoided. The results also suggest that infill panels can be used for retrofitting existing RC structures. In this case, new panels must be designed in such a way that their strength will be compatible with those of the columns (Klingner and Bertero [6]). Therefore, the infilled frame is suggested to be designed to prevent or delay shear failure of the frame members, by designing them for high resistance to cycles of shear reversal, and by examining closely the relationship between column shear resistance and infill panel strength. The above demands must be satisfied by high percentages of transverse steel used in the beams and columns in excess of the proper concrete section and panel thickness. Henceforth, it is obvious that the improvement of the concrete response in terms of the confinement of frame members would help to the improvement of the total seismic response of the infilled frame. On the other hand it is generally accepted that the use of continuous spiral reinforcement in concrete elements with cyclic cross section can substantial improve the strength and the ductility of the concrete and henceforth the total seismic response and capacity of the structural element (Park and Paulay [7]). International codes in these cases propose increased performance factors for the concrete confinement (ACI 318, EC8). The extension of the use of continuous spiral reinforcement in elements with rectangular cross sections is a new promising technology that is believed it can improve the seismic capacity of structures. Considering that the application of the Rectangular Spiral Reinforcement (RSR) could contribute to the improvement of the external beamcolumn joint properties (Karayannis et al [8]) it is expected to contribute to the total improvement of the response of infilled frames. In this paper the experimental results that are presented are a part from an experimental program that has the aim to investigate the performance of masonry – infilled RC frames under in-plane lateral cyclic loads. The objects of the present paper were mainly of: (a) Finding the effect of two types of shear reinforcement that is spirals and equally spaced stirrups, on the hysteretic characteristics of infilled frames. (b) Examining the behavior of two types of masonry infills that is weak and strong, under identical geometry and loading conditions.
2
Experimental program
2.1 Test specimens The experimental program as shown in table 1 consisted of testing six singlestory, one-bay, 1/3-scale specimens of reinforced concrete frames. Specimens B and BS were bare frames, one with transverse steel in the form of common stirrups and one with continuous rectangular spiral reinforcement of the same spacing. Specimens S and SS were infilled frames with a solid weak infill of clay bricks, one with transverse steel in the form of common stirrups and one with continuous rectangular spiral reinforcement of the same spacing. Specimens IS and ISS were infilled frames with a solid strong infill of vitrified ceramic bricks,
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1:
Test specimens.
Masonry type Group
A
B
Specimen B S IS ΒS SS ISS
Bare frame
645
Weak
Strong
Shear reinforcement type Common Rectangular stirrups spirals
(a)
(b) Figure 1:
(c)
Description of infilled frame specimens: (a) Reinforcement detailing of the RC frame models (mm); (b) Infilled frame and instrumentation (cm); (c) Weak and strong brick units (mm).
one with transverse steel in the form of common stirrups and one with continuous rectangular spiral reinforcement of the same spacing. The geometric characteristics of the RC frames were the same for all specimens. The elevation, the corresponding cross-sections of the members and the design details for the RC frame specimens are shown in figs. 1a, b. The reinforced concrete frame represented typical ductile concrete construction, particularly structures built in accordance to currently used codes and standards in Greece. Masonry infills had WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
646 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII a height/length ratio h/l = 1/1,5 and were constructed with two selected brick types cut into two halves for complete simulation to the test scale. Their configuration is shown in fig. 1c. The former “weak” common clay brick usually used in Greece had a thickness 60 mm, while the latter “strong” vitrified ceramic brick that felt to be important for the specimen behavior had a thickness 52 mm. A representative mortar mix was used for the two types of infills contained the portions 1:1:6 (cement: lime: sand) and produced mechanical properties similarly to type M1 mortar according to EN 998-2 standard. Masonry properties were chosen in such a way to produce the desired lateral strength of the two types in a magnitude Vw,u = 27.36 or 25.58 KN lower than that of the lateral strength of the frame Vf,u = 40.28 KN as presented in the following paragraph. This closely represents actual construction in Greece. 2.2 Material properties Material tests were conducted on concrete, reinforcing steel and masonry samples. The mean compressive strength of the frame concrete was 28.51 MPa. The yield stress of longitudinal and transverse steel was 390.47 and 212.2 MPa respectively. The main results of mortar, bricks and infill masonry tests are presented in table 2. It can be noted from the table that the compressive strength of the “weak” masonry prisms was considerably lower than those of the “strong” while the shear strength of the bed joints in the “weak” and “strong” specimens with the same to the full size infills length / height ratio (l/h = fv/fn = 1.5/1) was almost identical. Table 2:
Mechanical properties of the materials used (MPa).
Material Properties MORTAR Compressive Strength fm BRICK UNITS Compressive Strength fbc MASONRY Compressive Strength ⊥ to hollows fc Elastic Modulus ⊥ to hollows E Compressive strength // to hollows fc90 Elastic Modulus // to hollows E90 Friction Coefficient µ (rads) Shear Modulus G Shear Strength without normal stress fvo Shear Strength with normal stress fv/ fn * On full size infills
Masonry type Weak Strong t = 6 cm t = 5.2 cm 1.53
1.75
3.1
26.4
2.63 660.66 5.11 670.3 0.77 259.39 0.08 0.38*/0.25* 0.33/0.22 0.39/0.30 0.21/0.37 0.20/0.73
15.18 2837.14 17.68 540.19 0.957 351.37 0.12 0.41*/0.27* 0.26/0.17 0.60/0.61 0.39/0.72 0.41/1.55
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
647
Test setup of specimen SS and loading program.
2.3 Test setup and instrumentation The test setup is shown in fig. 2. The lateral load was applied by means of a double action hydraulic actuator. The vertical loads were exerted by manually controlled hydraulic jacks that were tensioning four strands at the top of the column whose forces were maintained constant during each test. The level of this axial compressive load per column was set 50 KN (0.1 of the ultimate). One LVDT measured the lateral drift of the frame and a load cell measured the lateral force of the hydraulic actuator. The loading program included full reversals of gradually increasing displacements. Two reversals were applied for each displacement level. The cycles started from a ductility level 0.8 corresponding to an amplitude of about ±2 mm (the displacement of yield initiation to the system is considered as ductility level µ=1) and were followed gradually by ductility levels 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12 corresponding about to amplitudes 6, 12, 18, 24, 30, 36 mm (fig. 2).
3
Experimental results
The main output of the experimental investigation was a load – displacement curve for each frame (figs. 3, 4, 5a). The initial stiffnesses, critical loads, energy dissipation capacities and critical displacements attained during the tests of the six specimens were derived. It must be pointed out that the hysteretic characteristics of the weak masonry infill were some times larger because of the larger net bedded area for the weak masonry units. The appearance and propagation of cracking was also recorded for both infill and frame throughout each test (figs. 3, 4). Specimens “B” and “BS” were bare reference frames. Flexural cracks and corresponding plastic hinges occurred at predicted critical locations at the bottom and the top of the columns and the ends of the beam – at a drift 4-6‰ – (figs. 3a, 4a). Specimens “S”, “SS” and “IS”, “ISS” had solid weak and solid strong infill respectively. The nonlinear behavior was initiated by the cracking of the infill. Then developed plastic hinges at the top and the bottom of the columns – at a WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
648 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII drift 4-11‰ –. However, as shown by the damage patterns of specimens, the failure of the specimens “S” and “SS” with the weak solid infill (figs. 3d, 4d) was dominated by internal crushing in the infill – at a drift 19‰ – while the failure of the specimens “IS” and “ISS” with the strong solid infill (fig. 3f, 4f) was dominated by sliding of the infill along its bed joints – at a drift 14‰ –.
(a)
Figure 3:
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Lateral load – displacement hysteresis curves and failure modes of specimens of group A with stirrups: (a), (b) Bare frame; (c), (d) Weak solid infill; (e), (f) Strong solid infill.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(a)
(c)
(e) Figure 4:
649
(b)
(d)
(f)
Lateral load – displacement hysteresis curves and failure modes of specimens of group B with spirals: (a), (b) Bare frame; (c), (d) Weak solid infill; (e), (f) Strong solid infill.
In all infilled specimens the cracking of the beam occurred far from the column face towards the mid – span vicinity of the beam. Plastic hinges were developed at drifts higher than 11‰ or they did not developed at all. Generally WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
650 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII the infills restrained the beams from bending and, there by, postpone the development of plastic hinges in the beams. In the case of the present project shear failure of the columns was not observed.
4
Interpretation of experimental results
From the data shown in Table 3 it can be concluded that: For all cases lateral resistance (v) of infilled frames was from 1.63 up to 1.94 times that of the corresponding bare frames. Spirals increased resistance as far strong infills only. The residual resistance (βres) was observed to be increased in the case of strong infills. Spirals did not influence very much residual resistance. The presence of strong infills increased considerably the initial stiffness (k) of the system. Spirals decreased the initial stiffness. It should be noted that the confinement type of the surrounding frame members, did not influence considerably the limit states which had been regarded corresponding to the drifts (γy) and (γu). Only the specimen with strong infill of group B had ultimate limit occurring at a much lower drift level than that of group A. The presence and behavior of spirals increased the ductility factor (µ0,85), corresponding to a lateral force response equal to 85% of the maximum, only in the bare frame while the specimens with infills exhibited higher ductility than that of the bare frames. The total energy dissipation capacity (ΣW) of the infilled frames was of order 1,44 up to 1,64 times the capacity of the corresponding bare frames. It must be pointed out that infill strength and type of shear reinforcement did not influence very much the values of dissipation ratio. Specimens with strong infills and spirals seemed to loose a larger amount of strength and energy during the second loading cycle. From fig. 5b, it can be concluded that in all specimen cases spirals lessened the loss of stiffness. Strong infills increased the loss of stiffness because of different failure mechanism respectively to that of weak infills. From fig. 5c and fig. 5f it can be concluded that strong infills resulted in higher values of average added strength and average added energy dissipation to the system due to infills, especially at low displacement ranges, because those infills developed a better distribution of cracking than weak infills. Almost in all specimen cases, spirals lessened the effectiveness of an infill in increasing the lateral strength and the energy dissipation capacity of a frame. From the cumulative energy dissipated per cycle shown in fig. 5d it can be concluded that the contribution of spirals to energy dissipation capacity of the system seems to be slightly greater than the contribution of stirrups only at very high distortions and only in bare frame and frame with strong infill. Infill strength did not influence very much the dissipation capacity. From fig. 5e it is evident that the energy dissipation during a given cycle normalized by the total peak-to-peak displacement variation for that cycle was greatest just prior to crushing of the critical equivalent compression struts at about γ=13‰-20‰ in weak infills and prior to shear sliding at about γ = 7‰ in strong infills coinciding with the formation of plastic hinges in frame elements. After this, dissipation dropped with a steeper branch in the case of weak infills or with a smoother branch in the case of strong infills and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
651
continued to decrease gradually with increasing deflections, tending to reach the values of the corresponding bare frame. Spirals in bare frame at high distortion levels resulted in higher normalized energy dissipation capacity. Table 3:
Comparison of hysteretic characteristics for test specimens.
(a) Spec. Structural v γy γu k vlim µ0,85 βres V2/V1 W2/W1 ΣW/ΣWB Morphology (‰) (‰) (m. v.) (m. v.) Bare frame 1.00 stirrups 1.00 5.06 12.09 1.00 0.74 2.81 1.00 0.89 0.84 B
Weak infill stirrups 1.84 2.82 9.23 2.88 0.65 4.24 1.40 0.87
0.85
1.64
Strong infill stirrups 1.65 3.10 13.69 3.04 0.84 6.31 1.75 0.87
0.70
1.48
S
IS
(b) Spec. Structural v γy γu k vlim µ0,85 βres V2/V1 W2/W1 ΣW/ΣWBS Morphology (‰) (‰) (m. v.) (m. v.) Bare frame 1.00 spirals 1.00 3.44 15.50 1.00 0.54 3.97 1.00 0.90 0.70 BS
Weak infill spirals 1.63 2.77 13.33 1.92 0.51 4.09 1.47 0.87
0.79
1.46
Strong infill spirals 1.94 3.33 6.81 2.36 0.65 3.36 1.56 0.87
0.70
1.44
SS
ISS v: Lateral norm. resistance, βres: Residual nor. resistance, γy: Serviceability limit, γu: Ultimate limit, k: In. norm. stiffness, µ0,85: Ductility factor, ΣW: cumulative energy, V: max. Recorded force, W: Energy dissipation, 1/2: 1st/2nd cycle. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
652 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 5:
5
Comparison of displacements.
hysteretic
characteristics
versus
imposed
Conclusions
The authors have carried out investigations on several bare frames and infilled frames with weak and strong infills that were sorted into two groups based on the shear reinforcement, providing data for a parametric evaluation of different shear reinforcement and different infill compressive strengths. The experimental results indicated that the presence, behavior and failure of the infills can significantly improve the performance of RC frames. As long as the infilled frames are designed so that the infill cracking resistance will be less than the combined available shear resistance of the columns, the use of infills does not cause a brittle frame failure. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
653
Furthermore specimens with strong infills exhibited a better performance than those with weak infills in terms of the load resistance, stiffness, ductility and energy – dissipation capacity. Strong infills exhibited a better distribution of cracking than weak infills and, thereby, a more drastic mechanism of energy dissipation. The extension of the use of continuous spiral reinforcement in elements with rectangular cross sections is a new promising technology that is believed it can improve the seismic capacity of structures. However, considering that the application of the Rectangular Spiral Reinforcement was not observed to offer a clear total improvement of the response of infilled frames, it is recommended that more refined experimental techniques be pursued in future research.
References [1]
[2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
Fiorato, A.E., Sozen, M.A. & Gambel, W.L., An investigation of the interaction of reinforced concrete frames with masonry filler walls, Civil Engineering Studies, University of Illinois: Urbana. IL, Struct. Res. Series No. 370, pp.117, 1970. Maghaddam, H.A. & Dowling, P.J., The State of the Art in Infilled Frames, Civil Engineering Department, Imperial College: London, ESEE Research Report No, 87(2), pp. 231–284, 1987 Valiasis, T. & Stylianidis, K., Masonry infilled R/C frames under horizontal loading. Experimental results. Europ. Earthq. Engng, III(3), pp. 10–20, 1989. Comite Euro - International du Beton, Reinforced Concrete Infilled frames (Chapter 5). RC Frames under Earthquake Loading – State of the art report, ed. Thomas Telford: London, pp. 231–303, 1996. Mehrabi, A.B., Shing, P.B., Schuller, M.P. & Noland, J.L., Experimental evaluation of masonry-infilled RC frames, Journal of Structural Engineering, Vol. 122, March, pp. 228–237, 1996. Klingner, R.E. & Bertero, V.V., Infilled frames in earthquake resistant construction, Earthquake Engineering Research Centre, University of California: Berkeley, Report No. EERC 76-32, 1976. Park R. & Paulay T., Reinforced Concrete Structures, John Wiley & Sons: New York, pp. 118–122, 1975. Karayannis, C.G., Kakaletsis, D.J. & Favvata, M.J., Improvement of seismic capacity of external beam-column joints using rectangular spiral shear reinforcement. Proc. of the Fifth Int. Conf. On Earthquake Resistant Engineering Structures, Wessex Institute of Technology, Un. of Patras, Aristotele Un. of Thessaloniki, National Technical Un. of Athens: Skiathos, pp. 429–438, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
655
Application of the Cement Hydration Equation in self-compacting concrete’s compressive strength N. Anagnostopoulos, A. Gergiadis & K. K. Sideris Laboratory of Building Materials, Democritus University of Thrace, Greece
Abstract The development of the compressive strength of different self-compacting concretes is experimentally investigated in this research. The self compacting concretes belonged to different strength classes C20/25, C25/30, C30/37 and C35/45. A total of eight mixtures with different cements and different types of aggregates were produced. For comparison reasons additional conventionally vibrated concretes (NCC) of the same strength classes were also produced with the same cements and aggregates. The compressive strength of all mixtures was studied with the help of the cement hydration equation. The hydration number p was determined using the hydration criterion of mortar’s compressive strength. The compressive strength equations were therefore set up for all SCC and NCC produced and their compressive strength values at different hydration ages up to 15 years were calculated. The results indicate that in the case of SCC of all tested classes their compressive strength was significantly increased after the age of 7 days. This increase was much higher than the one measured on conventional concretes of the same strength class. It seems therefore that self compacting concretes produced with limestone filler have a significantly high safety coefficient, regarding the increase of their compressive strength at the late hydration ages. Keywords: self compacting concrete, cement hydration equation, compressive strength, limestone filler, aggregates.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070651
656 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Self compacting concrete is the latest achievement in the concrete technology ground. It is about a concrete which can be self consolidated without the use of any mechanical means, by its own weight exclusively. In that way the use of energy spending and noisy consolidation mechanisms can be avoided, while at the same time, due to decreased noise, better personnel communication is established. The convenience of flow and self consolidation, that the new concrete has, leads to brief placing and setting (RILEM [1]). In conclusion due to thorough consolidation SCC mixtures appear to have increased durability and as a result better reinforced concrete quality (Sideris and Sideris [2, 3]). Despite the extensive researches that have taken place in the last decade in order to clarify the new material behavior, the growth of its strength in due time has not yet been searched. At the same time the use of greater fine material quantities which are added in the case of SCC, has led to different hydration rate, especially during the first days, resulting to complications as far as the empiric determination of the strength mixture class is concerned (fracture f7/f28). For the reasons mentioned above, on the present paper the compressive strength growth of SCC of different strength classes, which have been produced by Greek materials, is studied. At the same time for comparison matters conventional concretes of the same strength class were produced. The compressive strength growth was studied using the implementation of the Cement Hydration Equation that was used in all mixtures
2
Experimental program
There have been produced SCC mixtures of different strength classes such as C20/25, C25/30, C30/37 and C35/45. The coarse aggregates used for mixture production were limestone and siliceous, while only limestone filler was used. Two different cement types of the same class were used (CEM II 42.5N) originated from Athens and Thessalonica. The one originated from Athens was used for mixture production using limestone aggregates which have been sent from a quarry in Attica, whereas the cement from Thessalonica was used for mixture production using siliceous aggregates from a quarry in Xanthi. In that way the image of the local cement market can better be simulated. The mixture production and the check of their rheological characteristics took place according to the European Guidelines for Self-Compacting Concrete: Specification, Production and Use [4]. At the same time conventional concretes have been produced in all strength classes with the same cement and aggregate proportion as in SCC. A total of eight SCC mixtures and eight conventional concretes were studied. For each concrete 150mm and 100mm (edge) cubes were prepared. The first specimens were used for the compressive strength assessment in 28 days, whereas the others were used for the compressive strength assessment in 2, 7, 21, 28, 60, 90 and 180 days. The mix proportions, their rheological features and their compressive strength in the age of 28 days are respectively listed in the following tables. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 1:
657
(a) Mix design characteristics of conventional concretes (NCC) produced with limestone aggregates; (b) Mix design characteristics of conventional concretes (NCC) produced with siliceous aggregates; (c) Mix design characteristics of self-compacting concretes (SCC) produced with limestone aggregates; (d) Mix design characteristics of self-compacting concretes (SCC) produced with siliceous aggregates. (a)
Mixture Proportions Cement (IIΑ/Μ42.5N) Silica Fume Silicate natural Sand Limestone crushed Sand Aggregates Water W/Paste Superpl/zer Slump (cm) fc,28 (Mpa)
NCC 20/25 Limestone
NCC 25/30 Limestone
NCC 30/37 Limestone
NCC 35/45 Limestone
280
325
370
450
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1022
940
870
805
880 186 0,66 1% 19 29,3
927 183 0,56 1% 19 36
955 185 0,50 1% 20 52,7
940 185 0,41 1% 20 56,7
(b) Mixture Proportions Cement (IIΑ/Μ42.5N) Silica Fume Silicate natural Sand Limestone crushed Sand Aggregates Water W/Paste Superpl/zer Slump (cm) fc,28 (Mpa)
NCC 20/25 Siliceous
NCC 25/30 Siliceous
NCC 30/37 Siliceous
NCC 35/45 Siliceous
330
350
430
430
-
-
-
20
430
280
530
510
655
610
385
385
760 212 0,64 1% 20 30,6
850 200 0,57 1% 19 41,6
760 200 0,47 1% 18 47,3
510 160 0,50 1% 17 53
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
658 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 1:
Continued. (c)
Mixture SCC 20/25 SCC 25/30 SCC 30/37 SCC 35/45 Proportions Limestone Limestone Limestone Limestone Cement 301,6 336 374 435 (IIΑ/Μ42.5N) 20 Silica Fume 184,2 136 104 100 Limestone Filler Siliceous Sand 861,6 916 898 808 Limestone Sand 800 800 800 800 Aggregates 186,8 173,6 180,6 192,2 Water 0,62 0,52 0,48 0,42 W/Paste 1,27% 1,63% 1,88% 1,51% Superpl/zer 75,5 75,5 77 76 Slump Flow (cm) 0,92 0,88 0,88 0,86 L-Box (H2/H1) 6,5 10,5 10 13,16 V-funnel (sec) 0,5 0,5 0,5 0,5 J-ring (cm) 35,8 48,3 50 55,3 fc,28 (Mpa) (d) Mixture SCC 20/25 SCC 25/30 SCC 30/37 SCC 35/45 Proportions Siliceous Siliceous Siliceous Siliceous Cement 337,2 353,4 432 435,8 (IIΑ/Μ42.5N) 20 Silica Fume 206 144 120 100 Limestone Filler 808 897,6 808 807,2 Siliceous Sand Limestone Sand 800 800 800 800 Aggregates 187,6 171,7 189,4 192,2 Water 0,56 0,49 0,44 0,44 W/Paste 1,61% 1,85% 1,88% 1,51% Superpl/zer 77,5 71,5 77 70 Slump Flow (cm) 0,97 0,8 0,93 0,85 L-Box (H2/H1) 6 11,47 7,25 6,78 V-funnel (sec) 0,5 0,5 0,6 0,5 J-ring (cm) 36,5 47,3 52,9 58,3 fc,28 (Mpa)
3
Hydration equation of cements
The cement hydration equation came forward for the first time in 1993 by Sideris [5]. The two phases of hydration (first and second phase) expressed by a hydration criterion K, are represented by straight lines in the coordinate system WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
659
(K - (1/t) p). The quantitative expression of hydration in relation to time t is given by the equation: or
K = K ∞ ± b × (1 / t )
p
K = K ∞ ± b × (1 / t )
−p
(1)
where: Κ= Κ∞ = b= t=
Hydration Criterion. Constant variable (intersection of the line with the y-coordinate). Line slope. Hydration time (days), (t>>0). Final hydration time = 15 years for curing temperatures of 5 - 60 oC and adequate relative humidity >90 %. p= Hydration number of the cement used for mixture production. This coefficient depends only on the chemical cement composition. The term hydration criterion envelopes any given established hydration criterion, of cement or concrete hydration, the way it is analyzed by Sideris and Sideris [2]. In the case of the compressive concrete strength criterion (fc) the general equation (1) transforms to
fc = f∞ − b × t − p
(2)
The application of the hydration equation procedure is analytically presented by Sideris and Sideris [3]. According to this procedure the hydration equations of the produced self compacting and conventional mixtures were determined. The hydration number p was defined in mortar specimens. The values which came up from coefficient p were later on used for linear correlation among fcmeas-t-p pairs (where fcmeas is the measured values of the concretes under study and t-p the corresponding hydration age (in days) raised in minus p) in order to define the compressive strength equations of the sixteen concretes which are under study. The procedure is presented suggestively in table 2 for the case of self compacting concretes using cement originated from Athens and limestone aggregates. The hydration equations of all mixtures the way the came up after the process mentioned above are listed in table 3. The graph of these equations is a straight line in the diagram of fc-t-p, where fc stands for compressive strength (measured in Mpa) and t-p stands for the modified time scale (t in days and p the hydration number of cement and the other cementitious materials which were used for this specific concrete production). By using these equations, one can achieve the calculation of the compressive strength which concrete mixtures develop in any age until the hydration end (15 years or 5475 days). These values are named as measured compressive strength values (fc,calc) and do not really differ from the experimental fc,meas values.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
660 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 2:
(a) Hydration equations of self-compacting concretes with CEM II 42.5N and limestone aggregates-strength class C20/25; (b) Hydration equations of self-compacting concretes with CEM II 42.5N and limestone aggregates-strength class C25/30; (c) Hydration equations of self-compacting concretes with CEM II 42.5N and limestone aggregates-strength class C30/37; (d) Hydration equations of self-compacting concretes with CEM II 42.5N and limestone aggregates-strength class C35/45. (a)
SCC-C20/25 Limestone Hydration 2 7 21 Age t (days) fc(meas) 13,67 24,33 35,33 (MPa)
Linear correlation among the values of fcmeas – t-0.424
t-0.424
fc(calc)
28
90
180
36,2 36,5
38,27
0,745
0,438
0,275
0,24 0,148
0,111
13,7
24,3
35,3
36,2
36,5
38,3
0,745
0,438
0,275
0,24 0,148
0,111
365
730
5475
0,082
0,061
0,026
Hydration number: p = 0,424. Correlation coefficient: r = 0.980979.Standard deviation: s = 2,11145 (%) Hydrations equation: fc(calc) = 43.9982 – 40.6362*t-0.424 MPa, t≥2 13.70
26.19
32.82 34.1
37.97
39.5
40.67
41.52
365
730
42.94
(b)
Linear correlation among the values of fcmeas - t-0.381
SCC-C25/30 Limestone Hydration 2 7 Age t (days) fc(meas) 17 32,5 (MPa) 0,768 0,477 t-0.381
fc(calc)
21
28
90
180
----
47,2
50,2
52,4
0,281
0,18
0,138
17
32,5
----
47,2
50,2
52,4
0,768
0,477
0,314
0,281
0,18
0,138
0,106 0,0811
5475
0,0376
Hydration number: p = 0,381 Relation coefficient: r = 0.9959.Standard deviation s = 1,554476 (%) Hydrations equation: fc(calc) = 61,0937 – 57,6024*t-0.381 MPa, t≥2 16,86
33,65
43,03
44,91
50,7
53,13
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
55,0
56,4
58,93
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 2:
661
Continued. (c)
SCC-C30/37 Limestone Hydration 2 Age t (days) fc(meas) 23,3 (MPa)
Linear correlation among the values of fcmeas- t-0.087
t-0.087
fc(calc)
7
21
28
90
45,6
49
58
61,8
0,942
0,844
0,767
0,748
23,3
45,6
49
58
180
365
0,676 0,637 0,599
730
5475
0,564
0,473
61,8
0,9415 0,8443 0,7673 0,7483 0,6761
Hydration number: p = 0,087. Correlation coefficient: r =0.999207. Standard deviation: s =0.691645 (%) Hydrations equation: fc(calc) =144.0134 – 127.9438*t-0.087 MPa, t≥2 23.55
35.99
45.84
48.27
57.5
62.6
67.4
71.9
83.5
(d) SCC-C35/45 Limestone Hydration 2 Age t (days) fc(meas) 29,5 (MPa)
Linear correlation among the values of fcmeas – t-238
t-238
fc(calc)
7
21
28
90
180
46,5
54,5
59
64
66,8
0,848 0,629
0,485
29,5
46,5
54,5
0,848 0,629
0,485
0,453 0,343 0,291 59
64
365
730
5475
0,246
0,208
0,129
66,8
0,453 0,343 0,291
Hydration number: p = 0,238. Correlation coefficient: r =0.995709. Standard deviation: s =1.421161(%) Hydrations equation: fc(calc) =87,4010 – 66,9769*t-0.238 MPa, t≥2 30,6
45,25
54,94
57,09
64,5 67,93
70,95
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
73,46
79,7
662 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 3:
Hydration equations of self compacting (SCC) and conventional (NCC) concretes a) with CEM II 42.5N from Athens and limestone aggregates (L) and b) with CEM II 42.5N from Thessalonica and siliceous aggregates (S)
SCC-20/25 L SCC-25/30 L SCC-30/37 L SCC-35/45 L SCC-20/25 S SCC-25/30 S SCC-30/37 S SCC-35/45 S NCC-20/25 L NCC-25/30 L NCC-30/37 L NCC-35/45 L NCC-20/25 S NCC-25/30 S NCC-30/37 S NCC-35/45 S
4
fc(calc) = 43.9982 – 40.6362*t-0.424, r = 0.980979,s = 2,111445 fc(calc) =61,0937 – 57,6024*t-0.381, r = 0.9959,s = 1,554476 fc(calc) =144.0134 – 127.9438*t-0.087, r =0.999207,s =0.691645 fc(calc) =87,4010 – 66,9769*t-0.238, r =0.995709,s =1.421161 fc(calc) = 75,4647 – 62,4647*t-0.224, r = 0.994447,s = 1,471585 fc(calc) = 69,3884 – 44,0293*t-0.253, r = 0.986597,s = 1,700644 fc(calc) =82,9112 – 70,3783*t-0.298, r =0.991974,s =2.355236 fc(calc) =85,9980 – 64,8322*t-0.238, r =0.993301, s =1.716112 fc(calc) = 33,2357 – 27,6425*t-0.422, r = 0.986239,s = 1,213672 fc(calc) = 38,1373 – 15,88879*t-0.422, r = 0.975240,s = 1,58887 fc(calc) = 65,4272 – 61,6919*t-0.422, r =0.997443,s =1,331999 fc(calc) = 77,2356 – 57,7096*t-0.238, r =0.993134,s =1.774112 fc(calc) = 51,0120 – 42,4016*t-0.36, r = 0.989084,s = 1,626802 fc(calc) = 52,4366 – 34,8214*t-0.36, r = 0.999773,s = 0,127685 fc(calc) = 57,5746 – 26,8129*t-0.36, r =0.990374,s =1,077980 fc(calc) = 77,6585 – 64,6109*t-0.236, r =0.989448,s =2,152820
Results and analysis
The equation graphs from Table 3 are presented for all mixtures produced in Figure 1. The mixture compressive strength alteration is comparably presented for self compacting (SCC) and conventional (NCC) concretes of all strength classes in Figure 2. The diagrams were drawn using the measured compressive strength values (fccalc) as they were calculated from the corresponding hydration equations. While studying those diagrams one can realise the alternation in the compressive strength development which self compacting mixtures have. Even though these mixtures were produced with the same cement quantity and similar w/c number compared to conventional concretes of the same strength class (table 1), they appear to have different compressive strength development, especially after the age of 7 days. This is mainly attributed to better grain placement from which the paste consists of: The use of great quantities of fine material (limestone filler) has as a result the filling of the gaps which are created after the formation of calcium-siliceous hydrous and finally the decrease in the active porosity of self compacting concretes (De Schutter et al. [6], Audenaert and De Schutter [7], Träghård and De Schutter [8], Audenaert et al. [9], Popee and De Schutter [10], Audenaert et al. [11]). This phenomenon leads to increased compressive strength of self compacting concretes. This increase gains is significance after the age of 7 days. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
663
80
100
80
fc (MPa)
fc (MPa)
60
60
40 40
20
SCC 20/25 Limestone
20
SCC 20/25 Siliceous SCC 25/30 Siliceous
SCC 25/30 Limestone SCC 30/37 Limestone SCC 35/45 Limestone
SCC 30/37 Siliceous SCC 35/45 Siliceous
t-p
t-p
0
0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
0
1
0.2
0.4
(a)
0.6
1
(b)
80
NCC 20/25 Limestone
80 NCC 20/25 Siliceous
NCC 25/30 Limestone NCC 30/37 Limestone
NCC 25/30 Siliceous NCC 30/37 Siliceous NCC 35/45 Siliceous
NCC 35/45 Limestone
60
0.8
fc (MPa)
fc (MPa)
60
40
40
20
20
t-p
t-p
0
0
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
0
0.2
0.4
(c) Figure 1:
0.6
0.8
1
(d)
Hydration equations of a) SCC concretes using limestone aggregates, b) SCC using siliceous aggregates, c) NCC concretes using limestone aggregates and d) NCC using siliceous aggregates in the modified time scale t-p (p values from Table 3).
The ratio of the compressive strength in the age of 7 days to the strength in the age of 28 days and 15 years (5475 days) as well as the degree of hydration at the ages of 7, 28, 365 and 5475 days are presented for all mixtures in Table 4. The calculations took place with reference to measured values of the mixture compressive strength in every age (fc, calc), which were defined by the equations in Table 3.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
664 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 80
100
SCC-C20/25 Limestone
SCC-C30/37 Limestone
NCC-C20/25 Limestone
NCC-C30/37 Limestone
SCC-C25/30 Limestone
NCC-C35/45 Limestone
NCC-C25/30 Limestone
80
NCC-C35/45 Limestone
fc (MPa)
fc (MPa)
60
60
40
40
20 20
0
0
28 days
15 years
1 year
28 days
(a)
1 year
15 years
(b)
80
80
60
fc (MPa)
fc (MPa)
60
40
40
20
20
SCC-C20/25 Siliceous
SCC-C30/37 Siliceous
NCC-C20/25 Siliceous
NCC-C30/37 SIliceous
SCC-C25/30 Siliceous
SCC-C35/45 Siliceous
NCC-C25/30 Siliceous
NCC-C35/45 Siliceous
0
0
28 days
15 years
1 year
28 days
(c) Figure 2:
1 year
15 years
(d)
Comparable diagrams of the compressive strength development of a) SCC and NCC concretes C20/25 και C25/30 using limestone aggregates, b) SCC and NCC concretes C30/37 και C35/45 using limestone aggregates, c) SCC and ΝCC concretes C20/25 και C25/30 using siliceous aggregates and d) SCC and ΝCC concretes C30/37 και C35/45 using siliceous aggregates
After studying Table 4, the difference in the development of self compacting concretes’ strength among 7 and 28 days, as well as in later ages (365 days and 15 years), becomes more than clear. Ratios f7/f28 and f7/f5475 are lesser in SCCs compared to NCC of the same strength class, which as a fact indicates that the increase of the compressive strength after the age of 7 days is greater in SCCs compared to NCCs of the same strength class. Indeed the compressive strength of the SCCs in the age of 28 days appears to be greater from 26 to 61% WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
665
compared to the strength of 7 days when the corresponding increase percentage in NCCs is in the order of magnitude of 19-31%. The respective percentages for the age of one year vary among 55 and 74% for the SCCs and 36 to 57% for NCCs. For the final hydration age (15 years) the respective percentages are 63 to 110% for SCCs and only 41 to 70% for NCCs. Table 4:
Ratios f7/f28 and f7/f5475, degree of hydration at the ages of 7, 28, 365 and 5475 days for all produced mixtures.
SCC20/25 L SCC25/30 L SCC30/37 L SCC35/45 L SCC20/25 S SCC25/30 S SCC30/37 S SCC35/45 S NCC20/25 L NCC25/30 L NCC30/37 L NCC35/45 L NCC20/25 S NCC25/30 S NCC30/37 S NCC35/45 S
f7/f28
f7/f5475
α7
0,76833 0,62347 0,7456 0,79261 0,76489 0,84219 0,76351 0,79773 0,7963 0,83513 0,76143 0,80047 0,78394 0,83783 0,89434 0,7640
0,61015 0,47514 0,500 0,57446 0,52832 0,65963 0,56136 0,58109 0,64831 0,70505 0,60031 0,58625 0,61051 0,69014 0,78549 0,53252
0,61015 0,47514 0,500 0,57446 0,52832 0,65963 0,56136 0,58109 0,64831 0,70505 0,60031 0,58625 0,61051 0,69014 0,78549 0,53252
α28
α365
α5475
0,79413 0,76209 0,67116 0,72477 0,69072 0,78323 0,73351 0,72842 0,81415 0,84424 0,7884 0,73238 0,77877 0,82373 0,87828 0,69702
0,94714 0,93331 0,87013 0,9007 0,88581 0,92376 0,91341 0,90156 0,95231 0,95912 0,9453 0,90344 0,93583 0,94865 0,96451 0,89043
1,00 1,00 1.00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00 1,00
In every case SCCs appear to have greater increase in their compressive strength when compared with NCC of the same strength class. The greater increase percentages appear in strength classes such as C20/25 and C25/30 due to greater limestone filler quantity that is added to the mixture. On the other hand, when the case is self compacting concretes of high strength class such as C35/45 then no limestone filler is used. Even though these mixtures developed higher strength compared to the corresponding conventional C35/45, they didn’t really differ in the f7/f28 and f7/f5475 ratios or in the degree of hydration in the ages of 7, 28 and 365 days. More than significant is the increase in the mixture compressive strength after the age of 28 days. It is well known that the strength in that particular age is the one which is taken into consideration about the structural calculations. But in structures the sum of the planning loads are really taken into consideration in ages not less than one year. This variation (f365-f28) indicates a security coefficient for structures. Compressive strength in the age of one year increases in SCC mixtures by 20 to 30% compared to the 28 days strength, when the corresponding percentage for NCCs is among 13 and 23%. If the security coefficient (f365-f28) for the same strength class concretes is examined using the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
666 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII equations of Table 4, it will become clear that it is every time by 25 to 40% greater for the case of SCC mixtures. It can then be said that the different development rate as far as strength is concerned, after the age of 28 days gives to self compacting concrete mixtures an extra security coefficient.
5
Conclusions
Self compacting concrete mixtures which are produced with limestone filler appear to have difference in compressive strength in the age of 7 days. Not only the f7/f28 and f7/f5475 ratios but also the degree of hydration at the ages of 7, 28 and 365 days are lesser compared to the same number in conventional concretes of the same strength class which were produced with the same cement amount and the same w/c ratio. This fact is independent of the strength class, the cement origin and the aggregates type (limestone or siliceous). The compressive strength development in later ages indicates an extra security coefficient for these mixtures. For the production of self compacting concretes of high strength class such as C35/45 no limestone filler amount was used. Even though these mixtures developed grater strength compared to the corresponding conventional concretes, they did not really differ in the f7/f28 and f7/f5475 ratios nor in their hydration degrees at the ages of 7, 28 and 365 days. After all it seems that the addition of limestone filler is the main reason which caused the different rate in the compressive strength development of self compacting concretes in later ages.
References [1] [2]
[3]
[4] [5] [6]
RILEM (1999): Self-Compacting Concrete”, State of the art Report of RILEM Technical Committee 174-SCC, Skarendahl Å. and Petersson Ö. Editors, p.154. Sideris K., Sideris K.K. (2003a): Ten Years Cement Hydration Equation and its Applications to Chemistry and Physics of cement paste, mortar and concrete, Xanthi 2003, ISBN 960-343-722-0. Chapter 1: Ten Years Cement Hydration Equation, p. 1-24. Sideris K., Sideris K.K. (2003b): Ten Years Cement Hydration Equation and its Applications to Chemistry and Physics of cement paste, mortar and concrete, Xanthi 2003, ISBN 960-343-722-0. Chapter 2: Application procedures of Cement Hydration Equation, p. 25-38. ΒIBM, CEMBUREAU, EFCA, EFNARC, ERMCO (2005): European Guidelines for Self-Compacting Concrete: Specification, Production and Use, May 2005, downloadable from www.efnarc.org Sideris K. (1993) The cement hydration equation, Zement-Kalk-Gips, 12 (1993), Edition B, pp. E337-E344. De Schutter, G., Audenaert, K., Boel, V., Vandewalle L., Dupont, D., Heirman, G., Vantomme, J., D’Hemricourt, J. (2003). Transport properties in self consolidating concrete and relation with durability: Overview of a Belgian research project”, Proc., Third Int. Symp. on SCC, WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[7] [8] [9] [10]
[11]
667
RILEM, Reykjavik, Iceland, Wallenik O. and Nielsson I. Editors, 799807. Audenaert K., Boel, V., De Schutter, G. (2003). Water permeability of self-consolidating concrete, Proc., 11th Int. Congr. Chem. of Cem., Durban, South Africa, Grieve G. and Owens G. Editors, 1574-1584. Träghård, Jan. (1999): Microstructural features and related properties of self-consolidating concrete”, Proc. First Int. Symp. on SCC, RILEM, Stockholm, Sweden, Skarendahl Å. And Petersson ö. Editors, 175-186 Audenaert, K., De Schutter, G. (2003). Chloride penetration in self consolidating concrete, Proc., Third Int. Symp. on SCC, RILEM, Reykjavik, Iceland, 818-825. Popee, A-M., De Schutter, G. (2005). Creep and Shrinkage of selfconsolidating concrete”, Proc., Design Performance and Use of SCC, Changsha, Hunan, China, Yu Z., Shi C., Khayat K.H. and Xie Y. Editors, 329-336. Audenaert, K., Boel, V., De Schutter, G. (2005). Chloride penetration in self-consolidating concrete by cyclic immersion”, Proc., Design Performance and Use of SCC, Changsha, Hunan, China, Yu Z., Shi C., Khayat K.H. and Xie Y. Editors, 355-362.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Section 8 Structural dynamics
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
671
Response of a double system beam and string with an elastic layer to the dynamic excitations L. Frýba, C. Fischer & Sh. Urushadze Institute of Theoretical and Applied Mechanics, Academy of Sciences of the Czech Republic, Prague
Abstract The beam with an axial force is coupled with the pretensiled string by an elastic layer of Winkler type. It is subjected to a row of moving forces. The theoretical model corresponds to a prestressed bridge. The governing equations form a coupled set of partial differential equations which are solved using the Fourier and Laplace-Carson integral transformation methods. A simple experimental model was constructed in a form of a plexiglass beam and two strings bound together with several spring and damping elements. The beam was excited by an electro-magnetic exciter and its response was measured at several places. Three steps of stiffness and damping characteristics of the elastic layer were proved to show their effect on the dynamic response of the double system. Its low response is searched. Keywords: prestressed beam, string, dynamic excitation.
1
Introduction
Many years standing effort has been devoted to damp the dynamic effects of both the highway and railway vehicles when they cross a bridge. For that purpose, a lot of systems were developed, e.g. elastic supports of bridges, triangular falsework system with controlled damping, double systems with two beams or two strings connecting together with an elastic layer, etc. They are briefly described in [1] and cited in details in [2] and [3]. They are, especially, the papers of Kawanazoe et al. [4] and Oniszczuk [5], who firstly introduced the double beam and double string system, respectively. However, each of the systems mentioned above shows its technical or economic effectiveness only in some specific conditions. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070661
672 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII On the other hand, the prestressed bridges, world wide used for highway as well as railway bridges of small and medium spans, form naturally a double system with two elements: beam and pretensiled strings. That’s the reason, why an idea arose – to bind both the elements with an elastic layer and dampers to diminish the dynamic response. The aim of the present paper is to show the effect of the double system beam and string and put a question on the effectiveness of damping.
2 Theory The Fig. 1 represents the theoretical model of a beam, pretensiled string and an elastic layer subjected to a row of axle forces. The axle forces Fn , n = 1, 2,3,..., N , move with a constant speed c from the left hand side to the right one. The simple supported beam and string provide the span l. The beam is subjected to an axial force N1 (generally tension), while the string is tensed by a force N 2 (in practice, of course, N1 = − N 2 ). An elastic layer of Winkler type binds together both the carrying elements, its characteristic is k 2
[N/mm ] and its viscous damping
Figure 1:
ωd 1 or ωd 2 , respectively.
Theoretical model.
A system of partial differential equations describes the dynamic behaviour of the Bernoulli-Euler beam and string:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
EI
673
∂ 4 v1 ( x, t ) ∂ 2v1 ( x, t ) ∂ 2 v1 ( x, t ) − N + + k [ v1 ( x, t ) − v2 ( x, t )] + µ 1 1 ∂x 4 ∂t 2 ∂x 2
∂v ( x, t ) ∂v2 ( x, t ) N +2 µ1ωd 1 1 − = ∑ Fnε n (t )δ ( x − xn ), ∂t n =1 ∂t (1)
∂ v2 ( x , t ) ∂ v2 ( x , t ) + µ2 + k [ v2 ( x, t ) − v1 ( x, t ) ] + 2 ∂x ∂t 2 ∂v ( x, t ) ∂v1 ( x, t ) +2 µ2ωd 2 2 − = 0. ∂t ∂t −N2
2
2
(2)
The following notations were applied: vi ( x, t ), i = 1, 2 – vertical deflection of the beam (i=1) and the string (i=2), respectively, at place x and time t, E, I – modulus of elasticity and inertial cross-section moment, respectively, of the beam, µi – mass of the beam (i=1) and of the string (i=2), respectively, per unit length,
δ ( x) – Dirac delta function, ε n (t ) = h(t − tn ) − h(t − Tn )
– the function describing the position of the
n-th force with respect to the beam, h(t ) = 0 for t <0 or h(t ) = 1 for t ≥ 0, respectively – Heaviside unit function, d n – distance of the n-th force from the first one, d1 =0,
tn = d n / c ; Tn = (l + d n ) / c, xn = ct − d n . The boundary and initial conditions, when the first force enters the beam, yield:
v1 (0, t ) = v1" (0, t ) = v1 (l , t ) = v1" (l , t ) = v2 (0, t ) = v2 (l , t ) = 0, vi ( x,0) = vi ( x,0) = 0, i = 1, 2 ,
(3) (4)
where the primes and dots denote the derivatives with respect to x or t, respectively. Several natural frequencies appear in the system (1) and (2) (without damping), which characterize the dynamic behaviour of individual elements: The circular natural frequency of a simple beam without string and axial force yields:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
674 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
ω j 4π 4 EI , j = 1, 2,3,..., f j = j , 4 l µ1 2π that one with the axial force N1 (tension) but without the string: ω 2j =
(5)
j 4π 4 EI j 2π 2 N1 + 2 , l 4 µ1 l µ1 while this one of the string with an axial force N 2
ω12j =
(6)
j 2π 2 N 2 . l 2 µ2
ω22 j =
(7)
Further on, the natural frequencies of the elastic layer
ω12k = k / µ1 ,
ω22k = k / µ2 ,
ω12jk = ω12j + ω12k ,
ω22 jk = ω22 j + ω22k
(8)
and, finally, the circular natural frequency of the coupled system beam and string reads: 1/ 2
Ω
2 1,2
1 1 = (ω12jk + ω22 jk ) ∓ (ω12jk − ω22 jk ) 2 + ω12kω22k 2 4
. (9)
The forced frequency of the moving force is:
ω= 3
πc l
.
(10)
Solution
For the solution of eqns (1) and (2), the Fourier integral transformation method is applied, [6], in the variable x l
Vi ( j, t ) = ∫ vi ( x, t )v j ( x )dx,
(11)
0
∞
µ
vi ( x, t ) = ∑ i Vi ( j, t )v j ( x ) j =1 Vij
(12)
and the Laplace-Carson method in the variable t: ∞
Vi ( j, p ) = p ∫ Vi ( j, t )e − pt dt , ∗
(13)
0
a + i∞
V j ( j, t ) =
1 1 ∗ V i ( j, p )eipdp, ∫ 2π i a −i∞ p
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(14)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
675
jπ x , l
(15)
where it is denoted
v j ( x ) = sin l
Vij = ∫ µi v 2j ( x )dx = µi l / 2 .
(16)
0
The transformed solution is received after the application of eqns (11) and (13):
2 jω ∆ i , i = 1, 2, n =1 µ1l ∆ N
Vi ∗ ( j, p ) = ∑ where
∆1 =
jω Fn
µ1
∆2 =
(17)
p e − pdn / c (1 − cos jπ e − pl / c )( p 2 + 2ωd 2 p + ω22 jk ), 2 2 p +jω 2
jω Fn
µ1
(18)
p e − pd n / c (1 − cos jπ e − pl / c )(2ωd 2 p + ω22k ), (19) 2 2 p +jω 2
∆ = ( p 2 + 2ωd 1 p + ω12jk )( p 2 + 2ωd 2 p + ω22 jk ) − (2ωd 1 p + ω12k ). .(2ωd 2 p + ω22k ).
(20)
In the first stage, we do not assume the damping (ωdi = 0) , then for the expressions
F1 ( p ) =
p( p 2 + ω22 jk ) , ( p 2 + j 2ω 2 )( p 2 + Ω12 )( p 2 + Ω 22 )
(21)
F2 ( p ) =
pω22k , ( p 2 + j 2ω 2 )( p 2 + Ω12 )( p 2 + Ω 22 )
(22)
the transformation relations (27.54) and (27.56) from [6] may be found
f1 ( t ) =
1 [( −Ω 2 BsinΩ 2t + Ω1CsinΩ1t − jω D sin jωt ) + A
(23)
ω22 jk + ( jωΩ1BsinΩ 2t − jωΩ 2CsinΩ1t + Ω1Ω 2 D sin jωt )] , jωΩ1Ω 2 ω22 jk f 2 (t ) = ( jωΩ1BsinΩ 2t − jωΩ 2CsinΩ1t + Ω1Ω 2 D sin jωt ), jωΩ1Ω 2 A
(24) where
A = BCD ,
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(25)
676 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
B = j 2ω 2 − Ω12 , C = j 2ω 2 − Ω 22 , D = Ω12 − Ω 22 .
(26) (27)
(28) In this way, the resulting deflections of the beam and string appear with respect to (12) and (14):
2 jω Fn [ f i (t − tn )h(t − tn ) − cos jπ f i (t − Tn )h(t − Tn )]. j =1 n =1 µ1l ∞
N
vi ( x, t ) = ∑∑ .sin
jπ x , i = 1, 2, l (29)
where the mutual relation (27.10) from [6] is used.
4
Numerical results
The deflection-time histories were calculated for several hundreds of cases in 3 series of different bridges. The eqn (29) was used for the undamped series, while for the damped cases, the inverse Fourier transformation and the ordinary differential equation with direct integration proceeded. The following case is demonstrated here as an example: series C with parameters: l=30 m, E=3.2×104 N/mm2, I=1.347×1012 mm4, µ1=1.1×10-2 Ns2/mm2, F = =4.8×105 N, N2= 5.6×106 N, k=100 Ns2/mm2, µ2=0.002 Ns2/mm2, ωd1,2=0.1 s-1 at low velocity 5 km/h and at speed 70 km/h .The responses of the beam mid- spans (in dimensionless form) are depicted in Figs 2 and 3. A row of 10 vehicles with axle loads F1=F3= 1.6×105 N, F2= F4= 4.8×105 N in distances d1= 0, d2= 3 m, d3= 12 m, d4 = 15 m (valid for Czech standard highways) and with the gaps of 9 m between the vehicles were assumed. 3 2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5
3 2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5
0
25
50
75
100
125
150
175
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
Figure 2: Deflection-time history at Figure 3: Deflection-time history at 70 km/h. 5 km/h. The Figs 2 and 3 symbolize the great effect of the speed of moving forces. It proves again the conclusions in [6] and, moreover, the Fig. 3 shows the possibility of resonance vibration, [1]. The lines of v1 (t ) and v2 (t ) almost WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
677
coincide in this case. It was derived in [2] and [3], that the eqns (1) and (2) depend on 6 dimensionless parameters. Then, it is difficult, particularly in practice, to develop the materials corresponding to the severe conditions for the parameters. Further on, the results in [2] and [3] show the ranges of parameters, which provide a low response of the beam subjected to a moving force.
Figure 4:
Laboratory model and cross-section of the beam.
5 Experiments A simple laboratory model of the investigated problem was constructed. A plexiglass beam is prestressed by two steel wires, see Figs 4 and 5, whereas the electromagnetic exciter stimulates a harmonic force to the beam at several places. The response of the beam was also measured at several places. The special spring and damping elements, see Fig. 6, imititate the elastic layer. Several number of elements, distributed along the beam, were used for experiments.. The spring stiffness and damping characteristics were changed in three steps : maximum (max), mean (mean) and minimum (min) using the spring and liquid parts of the elements. Figs 7 and 8 represent the beam acceleration v (devided by the exciting force F ) at N 2 = 1000 N as a function of the three steps mentioned above. The figures show, how the arrangement (max, mean, min) diminishes the beam response. The designation MP indicates the measuring point, where MP 6 is located at the midspan, while MP 3(4) or MP 9 at one or three quarters of the span, respectively. The Fig. 7 shows the beam response to the exciter at the 1-st harmonics 5.16 Hz, while the Fig. 8 that one at the 2-nd harmonics 22.18 Hz.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
678 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 5:
Figure 6:
6
Model at laboratory tests.
Spring and damping element.
Conclusions
The dynamic behaviour of the system beam and string bound together by an elastic layer is analysed. A set of partial differential equations describes the problem and is solved using the integral transformation methods. The equations are governed by several input parameters and, only in rear cases, the response of the beam with an elastic layer may be substantially lower than that one without the layer. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
679
1,40
M.P. 2
M.P. 3
M.P. 4
M.P. 5
M.P. 6
M.P. 7
M.P. 8
M.P. 9
M.P. 10
1,20
1,00
.. v/F
0,80
0,60
0,40
0,20
0,00
spring min damper min
Figure 7:
min mean
mean min
mean mean
max min
max mean
min max
mean max
max max
Damping of the beam with two spring and damping elements.
1,60
M.P. 2
M.P. 3
M.P. 4
M.P. 5
M.P. 6
M.P. 7
M.P. 8
M.P. 9
M.P. 10
1,40
1,20
.. v/F
1,00
0,80
0,60
0,40
0,20
0,00
spring min damper min
Figure 8:
min mean
mean min
max mean
max min
mean mean
min max
mean max
max max
Damping of the beam with six spring and damping elements.
The laboratory experiments show the diminishing effect at several steps of stifffness and damping characteristics of the speciál elements on the response of the beam. The spring and damping elements affect, first of all, the first harmonics. A development of new damping layer materials would be necessary. Therefore, the outlook for the practical applications of the double system beam and strings seems to be rather pessimistic in near future. The main reason for the last conclusion is the low ratio of the string and beam masses. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
680 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Acknowledgements The supports of the grants GA CR 103/05/2066 and GA AS CR A200710505 as well as the institutional plan ITAM AV OZ 20710524 are gratefully ackowledged.
References [1] [2]
[3]
[4] [5] [6]
Frýba, L., Dynamics of bridges under moving loads (past, present and future). In: D. Delgado, R. Calcada, J.M. Goicolea, F. Gabaldo (eds): Dynamics of High-Speed Railway Bridges. Porto, pp.25-44, 2005. Frýba, L. Fischer, C., Dynamics of prestressed beams coupled with a string. In: C.A. Brebbia, G.M. Carlomagno (eds): Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XII. Southampton, Boston, WIT Press, pp. 445-454, 2005. Frýba, L., Fischer, C., Vibration of coupled system beam and string under a moving force. In: C. Soize, G.I. Schuëller (eds): Structural Dynamics EURODYN 2005, Paris. Millpress, Rotterdam, Netherlands, Vol. 2, pp. 1035-1037, 2005. Kawazoe, K., Kono, I., Aida, T., Aso, T., Eibisuda, K., Beam-type dynamics vibration absorber comprised of free-free beam. Journal of Engineering Mechanics, pp. 476-479, 1998. Oniszczuk, Z., Transverse vibration of elastically connected double-string system, Parts I, II. Journal of Sound and Vibration, 232, Vol. 2, pp. 355386, 2000. Frýba, L., Vibration of Solids and Structures Under Moving Loads. 3-rd ed., Academia, Prague, Thomas Telford, London, 1999.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
681
Excessive accelerations in bridges for Korea high-speed railway J. W. Kwark1, J. R. Cho1, W. J. Chin1, B. S. Kim1 & E. K. Cho2 1 2
Korea Institute of Construction Technology, Republic of Korea Hyundai Engineering & Construction Co. LTD., Republic of Korea
Abstract When the Korean high-speed train (KTX) runs over a high-speed railway bridge, the high-speed railway bridge gives quite a large acceleration response. Local vibration at the large cross section, the impact from equally spaced sleepers, the vibration due to elastomeric bearings, and the vibration from the train itself are the causes of this acceleration response. Maximum peaks of the accelerations measured at the bridges are sometimes going over the limit value. Although it is smaller than 0.35G, the limit from the Korean Bridge Design Manual (BRDM), this acceleration response should be reduced for the safety of running trains with high-speed. In this paper, to reduce the acceleration response by controlling excessive local vibration at the large cross section, the vibration reduction method is studied. The result shows that the effect of elastomeric bearings on the vibration of the bridge is very large and that the vibration reduction device is effective against a wing mode local vibration PSC box girder bridge for the high-speed railway, which usually has a very large cross section, although it has little effect on global vibration modes such as flexural and twisting modes. The test of the vibration reduction device on the bridge in service has been performed in this study. Keywords: high-speed train, dynamic behaviour of bridge, reduction of vibration, damper, box-girder bridge, excessive acceleration.
1
Introduction
Approximately one-third of the whole length of the Gyeongbu high-speed railway line, which opened to traffic on April 1, 2004 in Korea, is constituted by
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070671
682 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII bridge structures. Except for particular sections like stations, crossings of highways and expressways, the elevated bridge structures have been typically built as PSC box girder bridges with span compositions of 2@40 m or 3@25 m. Especially, PSC box girder bridges with span composition of 2@40 m can be considered as the most representative bridge type among the bridges that have been designed and built on the Gyeongbu high-speed railway line. This selection has been decided since the design stage after comparative survey of various bridge types presenting reduced construction costs like PSC beam, preflex, T-shape girder, rahmen and PSC box girder bridges. Comparison finally resulted in the choice of PSC bridges due to the remarkable stability of their dynamic responses. Although diversified construction methods have been implemented according to the builders and site conditions, identical features and characteristics, that are single box with girder height of 3.5 m and width of 14 m, have been applied for the bridges. Such large sectional shape led to long span of about 7 m for the floor slab between the webs of the box girder and overhanging beams exceeding a length of 3 m in both sides. Differently from ordinary highway bridges crossed by indeterminate wheels on variable lanes, railway bridges present determinate loading conditions since trains are running on assigned tracks. In addition, at an arbitrary point of the bridge, vehicles running on a highway bridge act irregularly as punctual dynamic loads while trains are producing repeated dynamic loads through their regularly spaced wheels moving on a determinate track. Trains are thus acting as loading with definite frequency. However, if this frequency coincides with the natural frequency of the bridge, resonance will occur, producing excessive responses of the bridge and causing disastrous effects on the safety of the train crossing the bridge. As the dynamic response characteristics of the bridge depend on the relationship between its natural vibration modes (especially flexural modes) and the frequency of the applied load, it is necessary to perform investigations on the dynamic behavior of the bridge in order to secure running safety of the trains when deciding the type of high-speed railway bridge. To that goal, selected criteria have been set up in BRDM based on the European UIC. The major specifications related to the safety of the track are the acceleration of deck (0.35g), the deflection (L/1700) and the end rotation (5×10–4 radian). In spite of the importance of safety for high-speed railway bridges, studies on the dynamic behavior of high-speed railway bridges were practically neglected until the early 1990s. Recently, Chang et al. [1] proposed a two-dimensional train model considering bouncing and pitching motions to perform vibration analyses of bridges subject to moving articulated bogies train. In this study, the ballast covering the bridge was idealized by means of the classical theory of beam on elastic foundation. Thereafter, Ahn et al. [2] and Kim [3] attempted to suppress resonance by relating the span length of the bridge and the arrangement of the train. However, most of these studies remain theoretical and the absence of experimental studies is particularly overwhelming. Kwark et al. [4] proposed a first attempt to fill this void through experimental researches performed to investigate the dynamic responses of concrete box-girder bridges in 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
683
Field measurement on the dynamic responses
Running tests were performed in the test lane of the Gyeonbu high-speed railway line in order to check and inspect the trains, structures and facilities before the opening to traffic in 2004. Measurements of the dynamic responses of Yeon-Jae Bridge as shown in Fig. 1 crossed by the KTX, the Korean version of the French TGV, were carried out since 2002. Yeon-Jae Bridge is a PSC box girder bridge with span length of 2@40 m located in the experimental section of the Gyeonbu high-speed railway line.
Figure 1:
General view and measurement system of Yeon-Jae Bridge.
Diversified types of sensors like displacement transducers, accelerometers and end rotation measuring devices were installed in Yeon-Jae Bridge for site measurement. Measurements were performed irregularly during the running tests and at fixed intervals after the beginning of operational service. Measurement results of the bridge responses obtained through the sensing devices during the crossing of the KTX revealed that, except for the acceleration, all the responses exhibited sufficient level to secure running safety. Measured deflections and end rotation were seen to be largely below L/1700 and 5×10–4 rad, respectively. However, excessive acceleration responses were measured, which in extreme cases exceeded the limit specified by BRDM.
3
Excessive acceleration of the bridge due to running KTX
Excessive acceleration responses in PSC single box girder bridges were observed through site measurements during the preliminary tests performed in 2002 to examine the dynamic responses of high-speed railway bridges due to the crossing of the KTX. The occurrence of such phenomenon could be explained by the fact that measurements were carried out before operational service for trains without variation of their loads, and decision was taken to pursue long-term WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
684 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII measurement. As a result, excessive accelerations were measured in winter as temperature decreased. Fig. 2 plots the maximum acceleration responses measured in Yeon-Jae Bridge according to time.
Acceleration (g)
0.5 0.4
BRDM Limit
0.3 0.2 0.1 0.0
2003-01
2004-01 2005-01 2006-01 Time (year-month)
Figure 2:
Variation of maximum acceleration responses with time.
Maximum accelerations at the first span due to riding KTX along to the west lane 61km/hr
143km/hr
273km/hr
300km/hr
Maximum accelerations at the second span due to riding KTX along to the west lane
205km/hr 0.30
0.20 0.10 0.00 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
-0.10 -0.20 -0.30
85km/hr
112km/hr
142km/hr
180km/hr
259km/hr
301km/hr
0.20 0.10 0.00 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
-0.10 -0.20 -0.30 -0.40
Sensing Points(Distance from the west edge)
Figure 3:
14
Maximum acceleration(g or -g)
Maximum acceleration(g or -g)
0.30
2007-01
Sensing Points(Distance from the west edge)
Distribution of the maximum acceleration in the section of YeonJae Bridge according to the crossing of KTX.
On the other hand, even if accelerations were seen to surpass the limit value under very low temperatures, acceleration responses were also observed to be very large and approach the limit of 0.35g under normal temperatures. The reasons can be found in the conditions of the wheels and rails like side wear, the interface conditions between the ballast and the sleepers, the maintenance conditions of the ballast and the type of bridge. Most of these reasons depend on the state of the ballast and train rather than on the type of bridge. Measurements WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
685
revealed that perfect adhesion of the sleepers with the ballast could not be obtained, which led to impacts on the bridge each time wheels ran over the sleepers. Following, the regularly and continuously spaced sleepers together with the speed of the moving wheels were seen to affect the acceleration responses of the bridge. Moreover, local vibrations were predicted in Yeon-Jae Bridge since its section corresponds to a very large single box girder bridge. This prediction and the influence of the sleepers disposed at regular intervals were verified in view of the measurements plotted in Fig. 3.
4
Reduction of acceleration using damping devices
The acceleration responses occurring in Yeon-Jae Bridge under resonance appeared to be extremely large. Such resonance frequency corresponds to the first mode of the bridge under resonance speed. Three alternatives may offer solutions in order to prevent or reduce these excessive accelerations, which are preventing resonance, installing vibration-reducing devices, or adding masses in the inner sections of box-girder. Even if adjusting the stiffness of the bridge or adopting the recently reported resonance cancellation span length may prevent resonance, the former is economically inefficient and the latter cannot be applied on completed bridges. On the other hand, the methods which proceed by introducing isolating device, or added masses in the whole system of previously built bridges develop their performances only when the defection exceeds a definite level. However, in the bridge of interest, the stiffness being extremely large, deflection reaches barely several millimeters, which renders such method unpractical. Recalling that local vibrations and large accelerations occur in the bridge, a solution can thus be provided by reducing such local vibrations which will in turn reduce these excessive acceleration responses. The reducing effects on the local vibrations have been examined by applying external forces with frequencies corresponding to bending, torsion and flap modes at locations occupied by the moving train. The adopted isolating device is a viscous damper sustained between the top and bottom flanges at the center of the section of the bridge. A damping value of 5×108 N·sec/m has been considered regard to the specs provided for actually commercial viscous dampers. For a study on the method of vibration reduction of the bridge, a computer program for dynamic analysis of the bridge due to moving loads of high-speed trains was developed considering local vibration of box-girder and simulating damper device. Applicability of damper device to vibration diminution was evaluated numerically using the developed program. Dynamic responses according to trains running at various speeds from 150 km/hr to 400 km/hr were analyzed for the bridge installed with one and three dampers (case1 and case 3, respectively) or without damper (case 0). Fig. 4 plots the time histories of bridge accelerations due to high-speed train crossing with speed of 275 km/hr according to the eventual presence of damper device. Fig. 5 shows the reduction ratio of bridge accelerations brought by the set of dampers according to the speed of the train. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
686 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The effect of dampers
0.06
Acceleration (g)
0.04 0.02 0.00 0
500
-0.02 -0.04
case0
-0.06
Figure 4:
case1
Distance (m)
Comparison of accelerations of case 0 (without damper) with case 1 (with one damper).
Reduction ratio according to speed 1.00
Rati o
0.80 0.60 0.40
Case1 Case3
0.20 0.00 150
200
250
300
350
Speed (km/hr) Figure 5:
Reduction of accelerations provided by the set of dampers.
In order to examine the performances of the damping devices in reducing the local vibrations, various dampers were installed in the 2@40m PSC box girder bridge and running tests were conducted. Fig. 6 illustrates schematically the installation of the dampers. One damper was disposed in each span. A total of 8 load cases were considered. Table 1 arranges the reduction ratios of the vibrations caused by actually running high-speed trains obtained through the application of the dampers. Regard to the field tests, results verified that the vibration reduction effect reached a maximum of 26% owing to the use of the local vibration-reducing devices. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6: Table 1:
Installation setup of the dampers for the reduction of local vibrations. Vibration reduction ratio according to the damping devices.
Case Orifice damper Φ0.5 Orifice damper Φ1.0 Orifice damper Φ1.5 Orifice damper Φ2.0 Turnbuckle Rigid linkage Urethane Rubber
5
687
2nd span 4.17 % 25.85 % 6.88 % 13.65 % -0.12 % 5.39 % 8.91 % 8.81 %
1st span 7.32 % 11.12 % 2.72 % 10.68 % 11.16 % 15.43 % 10.15 % 23.53 %
Reduction of acceleration by installing added masses
The damping devices proposed to reduce the local vibrations were seen to produce effects to a certain extent regard to the field test results. However, these vibration reduction effects are lacking consistency, which makes such solution of poor efficiency in long-term, especially in view of the difficulties that are likely to occur in the maintenance. Since the vibration accelerations observed in the actual bridges of the Gyeongbu high-speed railway line are approaching or exceeding slightly the design values, necessity is to provide economically efficient as well as effective solution for maintenance while obtaining only vibration reduction effect. A solution can be supplied by increasing the mass of the bridge without changing its stiffness so as to realize reduction of the acceleration responses. Most of the bridges of the Gyeongbu high-speed railway line being box girder bridges, sufficient space can be secured inside the boxes to implement works. Accordingly, this space has been exploited to increase the mass of the bridges. A trial construction is planned on an actual bridge in the mid of 2007, and the expected effects of this solution have been verified theoretically through analytic study to date.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
688 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Fig. 7 illustrates schematically the laying of the additional masses. The added masses are laid inside the box girders above the bottom flange at 2 spans. The masses with length of 10 m, thicknesses of 25 cm (T25) and 50 cm (T50) are made of ordinary concrete so as to prevent change of the stiffness. Table 2 summarizes the values used to model analytically the bridges for the verification of the vibration-reducing effects of the bridges using the additional masses. The ratio of the additional masses to the whole self-weight reaches approximately 1.3% for the case with thickness of 25 cm, which corresponds to a very slight augmentation of the dead load while the first flexural frequency increases by about 14%.
Figure 7:
Schematic drawing of the performance improvement of existing bridges using additional masses. Table 2:
Mo del
Nat. Freq. (Hz)
Added Mass (%)
T0
4.49
0.0
Analytic model applying the additional masses. Remarks
10 m
T25
3.87
1.3
T50
3.81
2.6
10 m
0.25 m
10 m
0.25 m
10 m 0.5 m
0.5 m
Fig. 8 plots the acceleration response ratio according to the additional masses in the top flange at mid-section of the span under high-speed train running at 300 km/hr. It can be seen that the maximum response ratio of the models T25 and T50 are reducing respectively by 37% and 43%. Table 3 arranges the maximum reduction ratio for each model. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Table 3:
Maximum reduction ratio of the acceleration according to the added masses. Speed (km/hr)
Model
300 Resonance 300 Resonance
T25 T50 1.2
689
v
v
(300km/h riding)
(300km/h riding)
T25/T0 T50/T0
T25/T0 T50/T0
Acceleration Ratio
1
Reduction ratio (%) Cantilever Center of upper flange 2nd span 1st span 2nd span 1st span -20.8 -28.8 -36.6 -20.3 -9.8 -14.9 -7.6 -5.8 -42.9 -45.6 -38.2 -24.0 -11.5 -32.5 -9.4 -7.4
0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 1.2
v
(Resonance Speed)
v
(Resonance Speed)
Acceleration Ratio
1 0.8 0.6 0.4 T25/T0 T50/T0
0.2
T25/T0 T50/T0
0
Figure 8:
6
Reduction of the acceleration response brought by the added masses.
Concluding remarks
The most simple and efficient alternative to reduce the excessive acceleration responses occurring in high-speed railway bridges crossed by trains has been provided by means of small-size dampers and added masses. The applicability of these viscous dampers to reduce local vibrations has been examined theoretically and experimentally. The dynamic behavior of the bridge subjected moving loads by crossing trains has been analyzed using three-dimensional bridge model and tested at a field using various devices. Even if the solution reducing local vibration through the installation of such damping devices is also bringing some drawbacks in terms of maintenance, consistency of reduction effect and effectiveness, the method using additional masses to reduce excessive accelerations by simply increasing the mass is providing numerous advantages and, its significant effectiveness has been verified by means of theoretical study. The features found in this study are summarized hereafter. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
690 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (1) Even if the solution reducing the acceleration responses using local vibration-reducing devices has been verified to be effective, this solution appeared to be extremely disadvantageous in terms of maintenance, which makes such method of poor economic viability. (2) Based on the study results, the method adopting orifice dampers has been seen to be the most effective among the methods using local vibrationreducing damping devices. (3) The solution reducing vibrations using additional masses appeared to be extremely economical and was assessed as a valuable method. (4) Since the reduction effects appeared to not increase significantly with the size of the added masses, the selection of appropriate masses should be done with careful consideration. (5) Field tests are previewed for the method applying added masses to reduce he local vibrations.
Acknowledgements This study is part of a research on the R&D for high-speed railway supported by the Korea Ministry of Construction and Transportation.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Chang S.P., Kwark J.W. & Kim S.I., Vibration of steel composite railway bridges subjected to high speed train. Journal of Korean Society for Steel Construction, 10(4), pp. 577-587, 1998. Ahn Y.J., Kim S.J. & Shin Y.S., Dynamic Behavior of High-Speed Railway Bridges. Journal of Korean Society for Steel Construction, 20(3), pp. 375-384, 2000. Kim S.I., Bridge-train interaction analysis of high-speed railway bridges, Ph.D. Thesis. Seoul National University, Korea, 2000. Kwark J.W., Chin W.J., Kim Y.J. & Kim B.S., Dynamic Behavior of Concrete Box Girder Bridge due to Riding Korean High-Speed Train. Journal of Korean Society for Steel Construction, 23(1), pp. 27-36, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
691
Parameter identification for multiple modes of cable-stayed bridge cables using ambient vibration measurements from a single station W.-H. Wu, C.-A. Liao & C.-C. Chen Department of Construction Engineering, National Yunlin University of Science and Technology, Taiwan
Abstract The measurements and subsequent system identification of the cables play extremely important roles in health monitoring of the whole cable-stayed bridge. The technique of ambient vibration measurement where only the output signal is available has been commonly adopted to measure the cable-stayed bridges. In this case, it is most popular in the literature to combine the random decrement method together with the Ibrahim time domain method for system identification. To apply the above two methods for cable identification, however, the problem of imperfect random decrement signatures and the difficulty of conducting well-distributed measurements at various stations of a single cable have to be overcome. The crucial time shifting parameter is first explored in this study to extend the applicability of the Ibrahim time domain method. In addition, with the mode separation technique and a novel multiple random decrement method recently proposed, an effective method to identify the parameters of several cable modes merely based on the measurement of a single station is developed and demonstrated by applying it to the velocity record of a cable of the Chi-Lu cable-stayed bridge. The validation of this method is also provided in this paper. Keywords: ambient vibration measurement, Ibrahim time domain method, time shifting, mode separation, multiple random decrement method.
1
Introduction
The cables of cable-stayed bridges are the primary force-transmitting members of the whole structure system. Consequently, the measurements and subsequent system identification of the cables play extremely important roles in health WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070681
692 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII monitoring of the whole cable-stayed bridge. The dynamic response of the cable usually attributes to quite a few of the lower modes due to its low flexural stiffness. It is accordingly required to obtain the modal parameters of more modes in the identification of cable than other civil structures. With the advantages of mobility and easy setup, the technique of ambient vibration measurement has been recently applied to conduct the system identification for most of the cable-stayed bridges. Since only the output signal is available in this case, it is necessary to apply the system identification techniques based merely on output signals for determining the modal parameters of cables. Limited by in situ working constraints, it is usually difficult to conduct the measurement with multiple stations uniformly distributed along the same cable. Moreover, the insignificant signals from ambient vibration also induce problems such as noise pollution in practical applications. To tackle the above problems, it is aimed in this study to develop an effective method for accurately identifying the parameters of various cable modes merely based on the measurement of a single station installed on cables. For identifying the modal parameters simply based on output signals, it is most popular in the literature to combine the random decrement (RD) method together with the Ibrahim time domain (ITD) method. To apply the above two methods for cable parameter identification, however, two major problems need to be overcome. First of all, imperfect RD signatures may be usually induced from the cable measurements due to narrow-banded excitations. Furthermore, the ITD method is not valid to identify the parameters for multiple modes when only the measurement of a single station is available. The crucial time shifting parameter is first explored in this study to extend the applicability of the Ibrahim time domain method. In addition, with the mode separation technique and a novel multiple random decrement method recently proposed, an effective method to identify the modal parameters of cable is developed. Demonstrated by applying it to the measured velocity records of the cables of Chi-Lu cable-stayed bridge, the validation of this method is also provided in this paper.
2
Random decrement and Ibrahim time domain methods
In this section, the RD and ITD methods will be briefly reviewed to clarify a few problems for directly applying them in the modal parameter identification of cables, which provides the foundation for developing a novel and more effective identification method. 2.1 Random decrement method Assume that a linear system with n degrees-of-freedom is subjected to a stationary white noise with a zero mean. The corresponding equations of motion can then be expressed as: (t ) + Cx (t ) + Kx(t ) = f (t ) Mx
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(1)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
693
where M, C, and K represent the n × n structural mass, damping, and stiffness matrix, respectively. In addition, x(t ) signifies the displacement response vector and f (t ) is the excitation force vector. Considering that Equation (1) is satisfied by this system at instant ti , a time shifting of τ leads to: (ti + τ ) + Cx (ti + τ ) + Kx(ti + τ ) = f (ti + τ ) Mx
(2)
Selecting N different starting instants from eqn (2) and then computing their mean, it yields: ( τ ) + Cy ( τ ) + Ky ( τ ) = My
1 N ∑ f (ti + τ ) = 0n×1 as N → ∞ N i =1
(3)
N where y ( τ ) = ∑ x(ti + τ ) / N and 0 stands for a zero matrix with its dimension i =1 indicated in the subscript. Since f (t ) is assumed to be a zero-mean and stationary white noise, the right-hand side of eqn (3) has to become a zero vector when N → ∞ . Consequently, eqn (1) describing the forced vibration is now turned into another free vibration equation in the form of eqn (3) where the variable vector x(t ) is replaced by y ( τ ) . In general, a stable characteristic function y ( τ ) , usually called the random decrement signature in the literature, can be obtained when N > 500 (Cole [1]). It was also pointed out by other studies that N = 1000 is the optimal number of superposition and N = 100 is the minimum acceptable number (Jeary [2]). Taking a single velocity signal x (t ) for example, its random decrement signature can be obtained with the following detailed steps: 1. Choose a fixed value of velocity xs as the cutting threshold such that x (t ) is with values of xs at N different time instants t1 , t2 , "" , t N . 2. Set the extracted signal duration Td such that the extracted signal can adequately reflect the dynamic characteristics of system. 3. Extract N different time histories, all with a duration Td , from the measured signal. Average all those time histories to yield the corresponding random decrement signature y (τ ) .
2.2 Ibrahim time domain method If the random decrement signature can be obtained from the ambient vibration measurements of cables and sufficiently represents the corresponding free vibration response, the ITD method is then usually applied to determine the associated modal parameters. Consider the free vibration system illustrated in eqn (3), but replace the time variable τ by t. Transformation of this equation into the state space further results in a first-order differential equation:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
694 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII y 0n×n = y − M −1 K
I n× n y −M −1C y
(4)
where I indicates an identity matrix with its dimension shown in the subscript. Solving eqn (4) as an eigenvalue problem, the displacement and velocity vectors can be expressed, respectively as: 2n
2n
2n
y (t ) = ∑ Γi e λ t ; y (t ) = ∑ λi Γi e λ t = ∑ Φi e λ t i
i
i =1
(5)
i
i =1
i =1
where λi ’s are the eigenvalues of the system matrix and Γi ’s are the corresponding n × 1 eigenvectors. Based on eqn (5), the velocity vectors at s different time instants can be assembled into a matrix as
[y 1 y 2 " y s ] = [Φ1 Φ 2
e λ1t1 λ2t1 e " Φ2n ] # λ2 n t1 e
e λ1t2
e λ1ts " e λ2ts % # " e λ2 n ts "
e λ2t2 # e λ2 n t2
(6)
where y i = y (ti ), i = 1, 2, " , s . If eqn (6) is shifted forward in the time axis with m ∆ t and 2m ∆ t , respectively, then
Y = [ y 1 y 2 " y s ] = [Φ1 Φ 2
ˆ = [yˆ yˆ " yˆ ] = [Φ ˆ Φ ˆ Y 1 2 1 2 s
e λ1t1 λ2t1 e " Φ2n ] # λ2 n t1 e e λ1t1 λ2t1 e ˆ " Φ2n ] # λ2 n t1 e
(7)
e λ2 n t2
e λ1ts " e λ2ts = ΦΛ % # " e λ2 n ts
e λ1t2
"
e λ1ts " e λ2ts ˆ = ΦΛ % # " e λ2 n ts
(8)
e λ1t2
"
e λ2t2 #
e λ2t2 # e λ2 n t2
y i = y (ti + m∆t ) and yˆ i = y (ti + 2m∆t ), i = 1, 2, " , s. In addition, ˆ = Φ e λ 2 m∆t , i = 1, 2, " , 2n. Two combinations of eqns Φi = Φi e λ m∆t and Φ i i (6)–(8) can be obtained as
where
i
i
Y Φ Y Φ ˆ U = = Λ = ΨΛ and V = = Λ = ΨΛ ˆ ˆ Y Φ Y Φ
(9)
ˆ are 2n × 2n matrices. where U and V are 2n × s matrices and Ψ and Ψ Examination of eqn (9) reveals that if a system related matrix A is defined as WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
695
eλ1m+t 0 ˆ AΨ = Ψ = Ψ # 0
(10)
" 0 % # # # % 0 λ m+t " 0 e 0
2n
then eqn (10) obviously indicates that eλ m+t , " , eλ m+t are the eigenvalues of A and directly related to the system eigenvalues: λ1 , " , λ2 n . Pre-multiplying the first part in eqn (9) by A and applying eqn (10) lead to: 2n
1
ˆ =V AU = AΨΛ = ΨΛ
(11)
Therefore, the least squares method can be conveniently adopted to obtain A based on eqn (11), followed by the previously mentioned eigenvalue analysis. It has been shown in the literature that the eigenvalues of the state space system in eqn (4) have to be in complex conjugate pairs and the eigenvalues λ2 j −1 and λ2 j corresponding to the j-th mode are related to the modal frequency
ω j and modal damping ratio ξ j by λ2 j −1 , λ2 j = −ξ j ω j ± iω j 1 − ξ j 2 = α j ± iβ j , j = 1, 2, " , n
(12)
Consequently, the eigenvalues of A also appear in complex conjugate pairs as e
λ2 j −1m+t
,e
λ2 j m +t
(
)
(
)
cos β j m+t ± i sin β j m+t = a j ± ib j , j = 1, 2, " , n α j m+ t
=e
(13)
With eqn (13), it is easy to obtain: αj =
bj 1 1 tan −1 , j = 1, 2, " , n ln a j 2 + b j 2 and β j = aj 2m ∆ t m∆t
(
)
(14)
and then yield: ω j = λ2 j −1 = λ2 j = α j 2 + β j 2 and ξ j =
3
−α j ωj
, j = 1, 2, " , n
(15)
Parametric study for time shifting in the ITD method
The combination of RD and ITD methods, as described in the previous section, can usually provide meaningful results for several modal parameters if the ambient vibration measurements can be obtained for various stations of the target system and the frequency content of environmental excitations is not far away from that of a white noise. Unfortunately, the above two conditions are not always possible for certain civil structures, especially the cable-stayed bridge WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
696 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII cables. To overcome these critical difficulties in practical applications, a first step is to improve the accuracy of the ITD method if the input time history is not an ideally decaying function under free vibration. As described in Section 2.2, the matrix A utilized in the ITD method has to be constructed by shifting a certain amount of time and its eigenvalues are then solved to determine the modal frequencies and damping ratios of system. It is obvious that different adopted values for the number of shifted time steps m will certainly lead to different matrices of A and altered eigenvalues, especially for the case with a response not closed related to a free vibration function. The parametric study of m is consequently conducted in this section to determine the optimal selection. Table 1:
No. of shifted time steps m 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 150 200
Identified parameters of SDOF systems for various time shifting values. SDOF system with damping ratio 0.1% Natural Damping Eigenvalues Ratio Frequency of A ξ (%) ω (Hz)
SDOF system with damping ratio 1% Natural Damping Eigenvalues Frequency Ratio of A ξ (%) ω (Hz)
0.987 ± 0.156i 0.951 ± 0.309i 0.891 ± 0.454i 0.809 ± 0.587i 0.707 ± 0.707i 0.588 ± 0.809i 0.454 ± 0.890i 0.309 ± 0.950i 0.157 ± 0.987i 0.001 ± 0.999i
0.965 ± 0.155i 0.930 ± 0.306i 0.873 ± 0.450i 0.799 ± 0.584i 0.702 ± 0.705i 0.584 ± 0.806i 0.451 ± 0.887i 0.307 ± 0.946i 0.155 ± 0.982i
−0.156 ± 0.987i −0.308 ± 0.951i −0.453 ± 0.891i −0.586 ± 0.809i −0.706 ± 0.707i −0.808 ± 0.588i −0.890 ± 0.455i −0.950 ± 0.310i −0.986 ± 0.157i 0.236; −0.988 −0.002 ± 0.998i 0.189; 0.973
0.9999 0.9997 0.9997 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 0.9996 •
1.000 0.103 0.067 0.047 0.038 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.036 0.037 0.038 0.041 0.062 •
0.9996 •
0.035 •
−0.001 ± 0.993i −0.156 ± 0.980i −0.307 ± 0.944i −0.449 ± 0.883i −0.581 ± 0.801i −0.697 ± 0.699i −0.796 ± 0.581i −0.872 ± 0.448i −0.919± 0.303i −0.889± 0.124i 0.760; −0.999 0.001 ± 0.981i 0.535; 0.998
1.0259 1.0149 1.0096 1.0056 1.0027 1.0010 1.0005 1.0005 1.0006 0.9994 1.0004 1.0001 0.9997 0.9995 0.9993 0.9991 0.9988 0.9984 1.0069 •
14.006 6.719 3.736 1.650 0.724 0.488 0.453 0.436 0.430 0.427 0.418 0.419 0.450 0.496 0.535 0.588 0.734 1.170 3.596 •
1.0002 •
0.414 •
The simulated response functions for a single-degree-of-freedom (SDOF) system with various parameter values (natural frequency ω = 1Hz and damping ratio ξ = 0.1, 1% ) are adopted to investigate the effects of the time shifting parameter in the ITD method. For these two different cases, the same initial displacement and ground acceleration reflecting the measured environmental WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
697
excitation are assumed to compute the corresponding displacement time histories of 300 seconds. A threshold of 80% of the standard deviation of each time history and an extracted duration of Td = 150sec are adopted to carry out the RD method. Those selected values for the RD parameters do not correspond to the optimal choice (Liao [3]) and are intended to result in the imperfect RD signatures where the excitation effects are not totally filtered out. In addition, the examined values of m are limited to the time shifting range within a period of system, especially focused on the shifting less than a half of the period. It should be noted that m = 200 corresponds to a time shifting of a period since ∆t = 0.005sec is taken in computation. The identified frequencies and damping ratios from the ITD method for all these different cases are listed in Table 1. From the results in Table 1, it is evidently observed that the identified natural frequencies and damping ratios from the ITD method converge to stable values as the shifting parameter m gradually increases from small values, especially when the time shifting reaches one quarter of the system period ( m = 50 ). Nevertheless, the identified results would get worse if m keeps increasing to larger values. The worse case is bumped as the time shifting grows up to a half of the system period ( m = 100 ) where real eigenvalues of A are obtained and no feasible system parameters can be identified. The above comparison clearly indicates that the value of m corresponding to a shifting of one quarter of the system period is the optimal selection while the value of m corresponding to a shifting of a half of the system period needs to be always avoided. The reason why the shifting parameter m is capable of inducing such a critical difference can be explained by considering the periodic characteristics for the free vibration of SDOF systems. If the ITD method is applied on an ideal time history of free vibration, the time shifting of one half of the system period would only find another time history that is different from the original time history in signs and with a scalar factor. Thus, the associated matrix A will not be full-ranked and it is impossible to solve for sufficient eigenvalues. In a more general sense, the same problem will be encountered if the time shifting is taken as a multiple of one half of the system period. Theoretically, the other values of time shifting are eligible for effective identifications. When the RD signature is not an ideal time history of free vibration, however, different values of time shifting in the application of the ITD method will include deviated errors into A and produce the identified results with a variety of accuracy. As the time shifting is close to one quarter of the system period, the least related original and shifted time histories will be obtained and consequently lead to the optimal identification. Similarly, the values of time shifting such as three or five quarters of the system period will also yield pretty good results. As for the values of time shifting close to a multiple of one half of the system period, the shifted time history will be nearly dependent on the original time history such that real eigenvalues of A will be obtained and no feasible identification is possible. It is also noteworthy that the identified natural frequencies in different cases are all in excellent accuracy while the errors for the identified damping ratios may not be negligible. This problem comes from the fact that the RD method cannot totally exclude the effects of external excitations and will be next discussed. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
698 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
Multiple random decrement method
In a very recent study by the authors (Wu [4]), a novel multiple random decrement (MRD) method was proposed to successfully exclude the effects from background excitation. It will be briefly reviewed and illustrate in this section for developing an effective method to identify the modal parameters of cable. The ambient vibration measurement for a cable numbered L33 (length = 126.4 m and inclined angle = 26D ) of the Chi-Lu cable-stayed bridge close to the epicenter of 1999 Ch-Chi earthquake occurred in Taiwan can be taken as an example for illustration. In Figures 1 and 2, respectively, the originally measured velocity signal and its corresponding RD signature (cutting threshold = 0.8 × standard deviation of the original measurement and Td = half of the original time history) are displayed in both forms of time history and Fourier amplitude spectrum. It is noteworthy in Figure 1 that all the cable frequencies are nearly in an arithmetic sequence, as predicted by the string theory. However, there exist two additional peak frequencies. These two extra peak frequencies have been pointed out to be corresponding to two significant modal frequencies of the bridge deck (Liao [3]). From the cable’s standpoint, these two frequencies can be regarded as the particularly concentrated parts in the frequency content of external excitation. Even in this case where the excitation is far away from a white noise, Figure 2 indicates that the contributions from these two non-cable frequencies have been considerably suppressed after conducting the RD method. Therefore, in the cases where the excitation force is not close to a white noise, the RD method can still greatly raise the contributions from all the modal frequencies and also relatively diminish those from the rest frequencies even though the resulted RD signature may not be a perfect free vibration time history. Based on this generalized concept, a novel multiple random decrement (MRD) method was proposed. More specifically, the conventional RD method can be repeatedly applied on each round of the resulted RD signature to exclusively filter out the initially substantial effects of the excitation frequencies such that the goal of extracting the free vibration time history can be practically attained. 10000 Fourier Amplitude (cm)
Velocity (cm/sec)
1 0.5 0 -0.5 -1 0
Figure 1:
100
Time (sec)
200
300
1000 100 10 1 0.1
0
2
4 Frequency (Hz)
6
8
Original measurement for Cable 33 of the Chi-Lu bridge.
Two associated problems have to be solved before the MRD can be effectively applied in the identification of cable parameters. First of all, the extracted duration Td in each round of RD is the length of time history for the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
699
next round and thus needs to be taken as large as possible such that a sufficient superposition number N can be reached in the next round. But contradictorily, no adequate number N would be attained if a very large value of Td is selected in the current round. To balance this problem for mutually compensated N and Td in each round of RD, it was suggested (Wu [4]) to choose Td as a half length of the signal from the previous round. As for the second problem, the associated characteristic of the MRD method to also suppress the contributions from the secondary modes makes it impossible for the subsequent ITD identification to directly obtain meaningful parameters for several modes at one time. This obstacle will be overcome in the next section. Fourier Amplitude (cm)
Velocity (cm/sec)
10000 0.2
0
-0.2 0
40
Figure 2:
5
80 Time (sec)
120
1000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0
2
4 Frequency (Hz)
6
8
First round RD for Cable 33 of the Chi-Lu bridge.
Mode separation and example
Due to the inherited properties of uniformly separated modal frequencies and extremely small modal damping ratios, the interaction between any two modes of cable would be very limited. This feature was further exploited (Wu et al [4]) to develop a mode separation technique for effectively identifying the parameters of multiple modes. After Fourier transform is taken on the measured velocity time history, the modal frequencies of cable can be accurately determined from the associated Fourier amplitude spectrum. With these available modal frequencies to decide different frequency ranges for separation, the frequency response contributed by each mode of cable is then conveniently extracted in the frequency domain. In this research, the mid-points between any two adjacent modal frequencies are adopted to divide the frequency ranges for different modes. The corresponding time history for each separated mode is subsequently obtained by performing the inverse Fourier transform. Finally, the MRD method together with the ITD method can be independently applied on these individual modal responses to identify the dynamic parameters for each mode. Cable 33 of the Chi-Lu bridge is again taken as an example. The parameters for the first 10 modes of this cable are aimed for identification. After the mode separation is performed as previously described, the MRD technique is applied on each separated modal time history with a cutting threshold = 0.8 × standard deviation of the target time history and Td = half of the original time history for each round of RD. The MRD method is set to stop before the criterion of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
700 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII N ≥ 100 cannot be guaranteed. In addition, the ITD technique is also utilized to identify the corresponding parameters after each round of RD. As discussed in Section 3, the time shifting for each mode is in consistent correspondence to 1/4 of each modal period. The identified parameter values for each mode in all the RD rounds are arranged and listed in Table 2. Based on these results, it is obvious that the conventionally ambiguous modal damping ratios all reach stably convergent values, usually with very few rounds of RD. This trend shows that not a lot of RD rounds are required to obtain satisfactory parameters from identification and also indicates the effective performance of the approach proposed in this study.
Table 2:
Identified modal parameters of Cable L33 in each round of MRD. Identified modal parameters
MRD
ω1
ξ1
ω2
ξ2
ω3
ξ3
ω4
ξ4
ω5
ξ5
(Hz)
1st Round
(Hz) (Hz) (%) (%) (%) (Hz) (Hz) (%) (%) 0.913 0.2061 1.808 0.0745 2.720 0.0994 3.627 0.1546 4.534 0.0630
2nd Round
0.914 0.2312 1.808 0.0559 2.720 0.0934 3.626 0.2007 4.534 0.0685
3rd Round
0.914 0.2349 1.807 0.0530 2.721 0.1003 3.625 0.2324 4.533 0.0717
MRD 1st Round
ω6
ξ6
ω7
ξ7
ω8
ξ8
ω9
ξ9
ω10
ξ 10
(Hz) (Hz) (Hz) (Hz) (Hz) (%) (%) (%) (%) (%) 5.474 0.1302 6.365 0.0461 7.278 0.1075 8.221 0.0881 9.141 0.0480
2nd Round
5.473 0.1260 6.365 0.0444 7.279 0.1108 8.220 0.0696 9.141 0.0533
3rd Round
5.475 0.1140 6.365 0.0426 7.278 0.1141 8.220 0.0669 9.141 0.0560
4th Round
•
•
6.365 0.0431
•
•
•
•
•
•
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Cole, H.A. Jr., Methods and apparatus for measuring the damping characteristics of a structure. United States Patent No. 3,620,069, 1971. Jeary, A.P., The description and measurement of nonlinear damping in structures. Journal of Wind Engineering and Industrial Aerodynamics, 59(2-3), pp. 103-114, 1996. Liao, C.-A., Modal parameter identification for both the cables and girders of cable-stayed bridges based on ambient vibration measurements, Master Thesis, National Yunlin University of Science & Technology, 2007. Wu, W.-H., Liao, C.-A., and Chen, C.-C., A novel multiple random decrement method for modal parameter identification of cable-stayed bridge cables, International Operational Modal Analysis Conference 2007, paper no. 92, Copenhagen, Denmark, 2007.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
701
Experimental evaluation of dynamic properties of an incrementally prestressed concrete girder railway bridge S. I. Kim1, I. H. Yeo1, N. S. Kim2, J. W. Kwark3 & J. S. Lee1 1
Korea Railroad Research Institute, Republic of Korea Pusan National University, Republic of Korea 3 DKorea Institute of Construction Technology, Republic of Korea 2
Abstract The estimation of exact dynamic behavior is very important in railway bridges which can undergo resonance state from repetitive moving axle forces with uniform intervals. The dynamic interaction between bridge superstructures and passing trains is one of the critical issues concerning newly developed bridges designed with more flexibility. Therefore, it is very important to evaluate the modal parameters of PSC girders that have been newly designed before doing dynamic analyses. In this paper, a full scale incrementally prestressed concrete girder of 25 meters long as a test specimen was fabricated and modal testing on it at every prestressing stage was carried out to evaluate the modal parameters, including the natural frequency and the modal damping ratio. Young’s modulus was also obtained from global stiffness of the test specimen. During the modal testing, a digitally controlled vibration exciter as well as an impact hammer is applied, in order to obtain precise frequency response functions, and the modal parameters were evaluated with various construction stages. Keywords: railway bridge, modal test, dynamic performance estimation, moving train analysis.
1
Introduction
Repetitive moving forces with uniform intervals induced from a passing train can cause some undesirable behavior of railway bridges. The resonance of a structure can be broken out when the natural frequency of the bridge coincides with the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070691
702 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII exciting frequency of moving forces. For that reason, an exact application of the dynamic properties of a structure will lead to an exact understanding of the dynamic behavior of a structure under moving train loads. As an alternative of conventional prestressed concrete girders, various types of PSC girders are being developed for, and applied in, as roadway and railway bridges. Incrementally prestressed concrete girder (IPC) and concrete girders with encased steel I-shaped beams are two representative types of these newly developed girders. According to the design concept, these new types of PSC girders have considerable advantages in terms of weight, while presenting the capability of creating longer spans. However, the dynamic interaction between bridge superstructures and passing trains is one of the critical issues concerning these railway bridges that have been designed with more flexibility. Therefore, it is very important to evaluate the modal parameters of PSC girders that have been newly designed before doing dynamic analyses. The investigation of the dynamic behavior of bridges under moving loads dates back many years. During the past three decades, numerous experimental and theoretical study on moving loads problem of bridges has been carried out from early studies (Fryba, [3]) to recent studies (Yang et al. [6], Kwark et al. [4]). From simple concentrated force simulation to sophisticated interaction, various vehicle-bridge models and analysis methods have been implemented for more precise verification of the dynamic behavior of bridges under moving roadway or railway loads. However, most of experimental studies and theoretical studies are not related effectively. In the present study, dynamic properties from modal test of a full-scale girder are tried to be linked with the bridge-train interaction analysis for the estimation of dynamic performances. A 25-meter-long full scale IPC girder as a test specimen was fabricated and modal testing on it at every prestressing stage was carried out to evaluate the modal parameters including the natural frequency and modal damping ratio. Young’s modulus was also obtained from static loading tests. During the modal testing, a digitally controlled vibration exciter as well as an impact hammer is utilized, in order to obtain precise frequency response functions, and the modal parameters were evaluated with various construction stages. The sectional and material properties of design values can have a number of differences compared to what is actual constructed, and the damping ratio of a structure cannot but depend on assumption particularly. Thus, an understanding of the exact dynamic behavior of railway bridges should be started from the exact modal properties of an applied bridge.
2
Modal tests of an incrementally prestressed girder
2.1 General For the purpose of observing the modal properties of an IPC girder, modal experiments were performed sequentially, as shown in table 1. Experiments from Test I to Test IV were conducted in order to consider structural state changes according to the construction stages of an IPC girder. Test V was performed to WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
703
verify the mode shapes from the impact hammer. During the modal testing, a vibration exciter that was controlled digitally was utilized, as was the impact hammer, in order to obtain the frequency response functions more accurately. Figure 1 shows a complete view of a 25m full scale IPC girder model, a cross section of an IPC girder, and five channels of accelerometers and a LVDT used in experiments. Modal tests procedure.
Test Case
Structural Condition
Vibration Source
Test I
PSC girder only tensioned with bottom tendons
Hammer
Test II
PSC girder with slab composition
Hammer & Exciter
Test III
PSC girder tensioned with one of the upper tendons
Hammer
Test IV
IPC girder complete stages
Test V
Mode shape configuration
C
2000 Y1
Y0
Y2
Hammer & Exciter Hammer
A
B
Accelerometer Y3
Y4 1800
340 920 540
Table 1:
LVDT
200 400 1400
C'
Figure 1:
25000
B'
A'
A complete view and location of sensors.
In figure 1, Y0 and Y4 are used only in Test V, which is performed in order to examine the mode shapes resulting from the impact hammer test. The mass of the impact hammer was 5.5kg, and its frequency range was 0~250Hz. The vibration exciter was composed of two unbalanced masses of 100kg each, and had a frequency range of 0~12Hz. The sampling rate of the tests was set to be 500Hz for each channel. The time interval ∆t can be determined by sampling
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
704 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII frequency fA as shown in eq. (1), and the frequency resolution ∆f in the frequency domain can be acquired with the sampling data number N, as shown in eq. (2).
∆t = 1 / f A ∆f = 1 /( N × ∆t )
(1) (2)
2.2 Evaluation of modal properties A 25m full scale IPC girder for a railway bridge was fabricated and tested before the estimation of the dynamic performance under moving train loads. The natural frequency and damping ratio were evaluated from the modal experiments by the impact hammer and vibration exciter. The impacts by the impact hammer numbered 15~25 at the L/4 and L/2 points for each test. The vibration exciter is excited at the L/2 position of the model. Figure 2 shows APSD functions (Bendat and Piersol [1]) at each accelerometer, which were acquired from the impact hammer’s actions. The damping ratio can be evaluated by a half-power band width method from APSD functions. Figure 3 shows another response by the vibration exciter. In a resonance test by the vibration exciter, a sine sweeping was performed to cause a resonance state, and steady-state response could be acquired from the resonance frequency. The time history of each accelerometer from the resonance frequency was a free vibration response. The damping ratio was evaluated using the logarithmic decrement method. -8
-8
10
Power Spectrum of Acceleration
Power Spectrum of Acceleration
10
Mid hammer Y1 Average(N=15) 7.4463 -9
10
154.5410
-10
10
72.8760 124.3897
14.8926 23.4375 29.7852
-11
10
0
25
50
75
179.4434
7.4463
Mid hammer Y2 Average(N=15)
-9
10
-10
10
72.8760 125.6104 29.6631
-11
10
100 125 150 175 200 225 250
228.1494
181.1744 155.0293
15.0147
22.4609
0
25
50
75
Frequency(Hz)
100 125 150 175 200 225 250
Frequency(Hz)
-8
Power Spectrum of Acceleration
10
Mid hammer Y3 Average(N=15)
7.4463 -9
10
-10
72.8760
10
154.9072 124.3897
-11
10
23.5596 29.7852 14.8926
0
25
50
75
179.0772
228.7598
100 125 150 175 200 225 250
Frequency(Hz)
Figure 2:
APSD functions at Y1, Y2, Y3 (impact hammer tests).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 0.8
6.900Hz Y(1)
0.4
Power Spectrum
Acceleration(volt)
0.6
0.2 0.0 -0.2 -0.4 -0.6
3.0x10
-6
2.5x10
-6
2.0x10
-6
1.5x10
-6
1.0x10
-6
5.0x10
-7
2070-2RPM(6.900Hz) Y(1)
705
6.896Hz
0.0
-0.8 55
56
57
58
59
60
61
0
62
2
4
6
8
10
Frequency(Hz)
Time(sec) 0.06
6.900Hz Y(1)
Damping Ratio (ξ)
0.05 0.04 0.03
ξaverage=0.0252
0.02 0.01 0.00 5
10
15
20
25
30
35
Shifted Peak Number (m=4)
Figure 3:
Free vibration response, APSD function at Y2 and damping ratio (vibration exciter tests).
Table 2:
The 1st natural frequency and damping ratio from experiments and analysis.
Impact Hammer Resonance Tests by Vibration Tests Exciter 1st 1st Damping Bending Bending Damping Ratio Ratio Frequency Frequency TEST I 6.95 Hz 2.19 % TEST II 7.32 Hz 1.25 % 6.73 Hz 2.68 % TEST 7.45 Hz 2.70 % III TEST 7.45 Hz 1.43 % 6.90 Hz 2.57 % IV
Free Vibration Analysis 1st Bending Frequency 6.02Hz 6.79Hz
Table 2 summarizes the results of each experiment, and shows the fundamental frequencies in flexural mode and the damping ratio of the 25m full scale IPC girder model. It was found that the natural frequency from Test II had an increase of 5.32% before the composition of the deck. In addition, from a comparison of Test II and Test IV, through a tensioning of the upper tendon, an increase of 1.78% in the impact test and an increase of 2.53% in the resonance WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
706 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Normalized Magnitude of Power Spectrum
test were found. This result coincides with other theoretical and experimental studies concerning the effects of prestressing on the stiffness of structures (Dall’asta and Leoni [2], Saiidi et al. [5]). In the free vibration analysis that was done before the tests, the first bending frequency appeared at 6.01 Hz in Test I which was for a PSC beam-only, and 6.79Hz in Test IV which was for a complete IPC girder state. The result of the free vibration analysis agrees well with the vibration exciter tests, and the impact hammer test shows relatively higher values of natural frequencies. A compressive strength of 430MPa for a test specimen is similar to the design compressive strength of 400kgf/m2, and the additional weight by the vibration exciter is exceedingly small compared to the total weight of a 25m full-sized model. Therefore, it can be expected that the resonance test by vibration exciter is more credible than the impact hammer test. In order to verify these results, an impact hammer test (Test V) with additional accelerometers to acquire more detailed mode shapes of the model was conducted. From the result of Test V, it was found that the overall exciting force of impact hammer was insufficient for a massive 25m full scale model, and the first bending mode shape of the test model cannot be found accurately by the impact hammer tests. Therefore, the natural frequency from the impact hammer test results in higher values than the resonance tests by the vibration exciter. This can be explained in figure 4 which shows the effective length of the model. As expected, in the impact hammer test, a higher frequency must appear, as the first bending frequency is evaluated from an effective length of 22.07m. 1.2
Measured Mode Shape Polynomial Curve Fit
1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2
Effective Length = 22.073m
0.0 0
1.474
5
10
15
20
23.547
25
Location (m)
Figure 4:
Curve fitting of the effective length of test model from the impact hammer test.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
707
In order to estimate the damping ratio, it can be said that the logarithmic decrement method is more reliable than the half-power bandwidth method. In the present study, the damping ratio from a resonance test can be accepted as producing more reliable values, as the damping ratio tends to increase as the deformation of structure increases. However, the damping ratio varies with the acceleration response, indicating that the acquired free vibration response does not show exponential decay accurately. Therefore, the average value of several damping ratio is selected to representative the damping ratio for the test model. Finally, it can be concluded from Test IV that an IPC girder in the final stages has a damping ratio of 2.5%, as shown in figure 3. Consequently, the natural frequency of an IPC girder from the experiments has error of 1.62% comparing with the analysis. From this result, it can be concluded that the sectional and material properties of design values can be used for estimating dynamic performance. Conversely, a damping ratio of 2.5% would be adequate. These results from the modal tests can be used as credible input data for a dynamic analysis under moving train loads.
3
Conclusion
An estimation of the dynamic performance of railway bridges which undergo a uniform interval of axles and repetitive moving forces induced from the passing train is very important and it is essential for a newly developed bridge that have been designed with more flexibility. The sectional and material properties of design values can have a number of differences from the actual constructed values, and the damping ratio of the structure cannot but particularly depend on such an assumption. An understanding of the exact dynamic behavior of a railway bridge should be undertaken from the exact modal properties of the bridge to be considered. In this paper, a full scale IPC girder of 25 meters long as a test specimen was fabricated, and modal testing on it at every construction stage was carried out in order to evaluate the modal parameters, including the natural frequency and the modal damping ratio. During the modal testing, a digitally controlled vibration exciter and the impact hammer were utilized in order to obtain the frequency response functions more precisely. In addition, the modal parameters were evaluated varying through various construction stages. Various parametric studies on the dynamic behavior under the passage of a moving train can be performed for an estimation of the dynamic performances of an IPC girder railway bridge with the modal properties from the experiments. a.
It can be known from the modal tests that the impact hammer test can overestimate the natural frequency of the structure. The effective length of the fundamental mode of the structure can be shortened if the vibrating force against the experimental model is insufficient. The damping ratio also appears to increase as the deformation of structure increases. Therefore, a damping ratio from a resonance test can be accepted as producing more reliable values. In the present study, the
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
708 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
b.
c.
average value from experimentally produced damping ratios was selected as a representative damping ratio for the test model. Consequently, it can be concluded that a resonance test by a vibration exciter is more credible than impact hammer tests, and that attention is required if using an impact hammer in modal tests. The natural frequency of an IPC girder from the experiments has an error of 1.62% compared to the analysis. From this result, it can be derived that the sectional and material properties of the design values can be adequate for the dynamic performance estimation. On the other hand, a damping ratio of 2.5% is adequate for the dynamic performance estimation. The effects of prestressing on the stiffness of structures can be founded at every prestressing stage. This result coincides with other theoretical and experimental studies concerning the effects of prestressing on the stiffness of structures. However, further theoretical and experimental studies referring to this problem should be conducted for a more detail discussion.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
Bendat, J. S. and Piersol, A. G., Random Data: Analysis and Measurement Procedures (3rd Ed)., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 2000. Dall'asta, A. and Leoni, G., Vibrations of Beams Prestressed by Internal Frictionless Cables, Journal of Sound & Vibration, 222(1), pp. 1-18, 1999. Fryba, L., Vibration of Solids and Structures under Moving Loads, Noordhoff International, 1972. Kwark, J.W., Choi, E.S., Kim, Y.J., Kim, B.S. and Kim, S.I., Dynamic Behavior of Two Span Continuous Concrete Bridges under Moving HighSpeed Train, Computers & Structures, 82(4-5), pp. 464-474, 2004. Saiidi, M., Douglas, B., and Feng, S., Prestress Force Effect on Vibration Frequency of Concrete Bridges, ASCE Journal of Structural Engineering, 120(7), pp.2233-2241, 1994. Yang Y.B., Yau J. D. and Hsu L.C., Vibration of Simple Beams due to Trains Moving at High Speeds, Engineering Structures, 19(11), pp.936944, 1997.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 9 Dynamics and vibrations
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
711
A model of spur gears supported by ball bearings F. Viadero, A. Fernandez del Rincon, R. Sancibrian, P. Garcia Fernandez & A. de Juan Department Structural and Mechanical Engineering, University of Cantabria, Santander, Spain
Abstract In this work a model of a 2D spur gear transmission is described for analysis of tooth contact forces and deformations. Assuming the position of each wheel is known, the contact points between gears are obtained taking into account the geometric description of the tooth profiles including profile errors and relief modifications. Then the deformation in each contact point is separated into a global and a local term combining a finite element model and an analytical formulation originating from Hertzian contact theory. The proposed procedure does not need new element meshing for each angular position thus obtaining an important computational advantage. Afterwards, a non-linear system of equations is obtained and solved for each gear position in order to calculate the meshing contact forces. The model can include the possibility of bidirectional single-flank or double-flank action as well as friction forces in the out-of-action line. Once the contact forces are known, it is possible to use the procedure in the calculation of loaded transmission error and meshing stiffness. Furthermore, each gear is supported by ball bearings that are included in the model taking into account their clearance and their variable stiffness due to the change in the number of balls supporting the load. This variable bearing compliance modifies the gear centre distance and as a consequence the transmission error during a turn. Using this methodology a numerical example is presented where the static behaviour of a spur gear transmission is described and analysed. Special attention is focused on the influence of load level on the final loaded transmission error. Keywords: gear, transmission error, bearings, tooth contact, load ratio.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070701
712 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Gears are one of the most important mechanical components in many advanced machines. Ranging from industry to space, automotive or agricultural equipment, there are a wide range of machines that use gears. This fact justifies the interest in the study of gear dynamics with the aim of design, condition monitoring and vibration and noise control. In this sense it is possible to find works about topics related to gear dynamics such as profile modifications, surface generation kinematics, non-linear interactions, noise, friction, dynamic tooth loads, wear, contact and bending stresses, condition monitoring, efficiency, etc. All of these subjects are also closely related to the so-called Transmission Error (TE), which is defined as “the difference between the position that the output shaft of a drive would occupy if the drive were perfect and the actual position of the output” [1]. There are three main sources of TE: geometry, deflections and dynamics. Although transmission error is a common term used by the gearing community it is possible to add certain names depending on the source that produces the final TE. Thus, it is possible to distinguish between manufacturing, kinematic (sometimes confused with manufacturing), static and dynamic TE. In this work we are interested in the static transmission error also known as Loaded Transmission Error (LTE) as this could be used as an external input excitation for dynamic analysis [2] or as a measure directly related to the noise level of a certain gear transmission. There is also one other quantity of interest, the meshing stiffness, which governs the dynamic behaviour of geared systems acting as a parametric excitation of the gear pair. The periodic change of the number of contacting teeth pairs is one of the most important phenomena involved in gear dynamics. There are several approaches to include it in the dynamic models from the simple average throughout a meshing cycle to more accurate formulations taking into account the stiffness variation along the tooth profile for each pair [3,4]. Nevertheless, some aspects are normally neglected such as the elastic coupling between successive teeth under load, the non-linear variation with the load level or the influence of the support deflection in the final meshing stiffness. Many available dynamic models use a simple formulation for the gear stiffness as their interest is focused on dynamics neglecting all of the terms that could be very useful in certain cases. Special attention should be paid to the case of condition monitoring where a good description of the dynamic forces is crucial for good prediction of machinery condition [5]. The most accurate works [6,7] use the finite element method combined with contact algorithms for evaluating the forces in meshing teeth. Nevertheless, a new meshing is necessary for each angular position, thus making it a high consumption computational task. There are some proposals to avoid this such as the application of Artificial Neural Networks [8] or the combination of finite elements and analytical formulations for the contacts [9,10]. In this work a new model for analysis of contact forces between gear pairs including the interaction with rolling bearings is presented. The gear model is based on the formulation proposed in [9], while bearings include clearances and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
713
the non linearity due to the changing number of rolling elements supporting the load, following the approach proposed in [11]. Bearing clearances and variable stiffness modify the operation distance between gear centres as well as the pressure angle of the transmission. As a consequence, LTE, meshing stiffness and load ratio should be modified. In this work the proposed model is used only for quasi-static calculations in order to obtain the teeth contact forces and deflections as well as their derived quantities such as LTE, load ratio and meshing stiffness.
2
Gear contact forces
The calculation of gear contact forces requires the solution of three different problems; the description of the gear body geometry, the determination of the contact points as a function of the gear position, and the calculation of the contact forces themselves. The first task will be the definition of the tooth profiles in order to be able to solve the other problems. In this work, the gear generation will be based on a rack-type tool following Litvin’s vector approach [12] taking into account the possibility of tool displacements and also undercutting conditions. Furthermore, a rounding profile was added in the tooth tip to handle corner contact. Contact points and their corresponding separation distances (δi) have been obtained taking advantage of the analytical properties of involute profiles and tip rounding arcs. Positive values for separation distance mean that the points should be in contact and negative values indicate a non-contact condition. Two types of contacting profiles have been considered: involute-involute and involute-circle arc. The number of potential contact points will depend on the contact ratio (ε) and can be expressed as N = 2 ( Ceil (ε ) + 1) where Ceil(x) is a function that rounds x to the nearest integer towards infinity. Contacts on both flanks of any contacting tooth have been considered. In figure 1 the potential contact points for a spur gear pair with a contact ratio between 1and 2, which means two contact teeth pairs, are shown. The calculation of gear forces requires a relationship between the forces and displacements of the contact points. This relation should take into account not only the elastic deflection of a pair of teeth in contact but also the local deflection in the vicinity of the load as well as the load sharing between more than one teeth pair. Due to the complexity of gear geometry, which is composed of several parts (involute, fillet, tip rounding), a common procedure for handling this problem is the development of a finite element model for two gears or only a portion of their teeth and applying a type of gap elements in order to simulate the contact [6,7,13]. Special attention should be paid to the definition of contact loads and boundary conditions. The resulting load, neglecting frictional forces, should be approximated to the elliptic distribution characteristic of the Hertzian contacts. Furthermore, as the contact width will be affected by the load, a small size meshing in the vicinity of contact points should be provided to be valid from WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
714 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII low to high load levels. Finally, a different meshing is desired for each position of the contact along the tooth profile. This approach is very time consuming and would not be practical if a dynamic simulation were desired.
6 6
1
3
5 2
52 3 4
4
1
Figure 1:
Potential contact points.
Another possibility is to consider the elastic deflections divided in two different contributions: local deflections of Hertzian type in the vicinity of contact points and global deflections, also called structural, that include all the deflections (bending, and shearing) except those due to the local contact. Local deflections are normally approximated using a non-linear formulation based on Herztian theory or any of its variants. In this work, the local deformation was obtained applying the following expression derived by WeberBanashek for bi-dimensional problems. The deformation between the surface and a line at a depth h is uL (q) =
2 2 (1 −ν 2 ) h h ν q Ln + 1 + − πE L L 1 −ν
h L
2
2 h 1 + − 1 L
where q is the load intensity along the thickness and 2L is the extension of the elliptic distribution of the pressure around the location of the load, which can be written as L=
2 2 ρ p ρg 4 1 −ν p 1 − ν g + qρ ; ρ = E g π Ep ρ p + ρg
On the other hand, structural deflections have been obtained by means of a plane strain (or plane stress) finite element model presented in figure 2. The model only contains a certain number of teeth depending of the contact ratio of the gear pair. A unitary load is applied in each node in the profile of the tooth located in the vertical position, which will be called loaded active flank, obtaining the displacement in the rest of the nodes of the other teeth both in the right flank but also in the left one in order to apply the procedure in case of two tooth flanks contacts. The displacements obtained will be the flexibility coefficients (βi,j) which represent the displacement of the node j due to a unitary load applied in the node i of the loaded active flank. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
βi, j
Fi
Figure 2:
715
Fi
Load and displacements of the finite element model.
This procedure is not valid for the point where the load is applied, as it is a stress concentration point. In this case, a local finite element model with the same meshing as the global one and a depth h is used to correct the displacements in the vicinity of the load point. This model has a unitary load acting in the opposite sense to the one applied in the global model, considering the nodes on the boundary with the global model as fixed. The displacement obtained with this model is removed from the original one avoiding the inaccuracy in the local displacement of the node where the concentrated load was applied. Then, when n contacts take place, the structural displacements uSj of node j will be defined by n
uSj = ∑ ( β i , j Fi ) i
The total displacement of node j is obtained by addition of local and structural components for both gears, wheel and pinion, which for n contacts is
uTj = u Ljp ( F j ) + u Ljw ( F j ) + u Ljp ({ F1 ,..., Fn }) + u Ljw ({ F1 ,..., Fn })
Once the initial separations {δi} of the contact points are known as a function of the pinion and wheel centre displacement (rp,rw), and angular position, the load distribution {Fi} of gear teeth can be defined on the basis of the following conditions: compatibility of initial separations and elastic deflections and complementary condition to avoid non realistic negative loads. Taking into account the profile errors for each gear the resulting forces should be obtained from the following non-linear system of equations for n contact points defined by a positive separation distance G G G G G G δ i ({rp ,θ p } , {rw ,θ w }) = uTj ({rp ,θ p }{rw ,θ w }{ F }) + eip {rp ,θ p } + eiw ({rw ,θ w })
(
)
under the condition that Fi ≥ 0; i = 1,..., n Here rp and rw are both vectors representing the location for pinion and wheel, θp, θw are the angular positions for each gear and eip, eiw are the profile errors for gear and wheel corresponding to the contact point i. The geometric separation distance will be used as a first step for calculation of contact forces, considering only those that are positive. Nevertheless, the solution algorithm verifies the deflection in the other contact points looking for a new possible contact. Following this procedure it is possible to calculate the forces and their application direction as a function of gear position. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
716 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Ball bearing contact forces
Forces in ball bearings involve a similar problem to the gear contact. Again the changing number of contacting elements (see fig. 3) involves a variable stiffness. Furthermore, load increases the period with the maximum number of elements in contact and even the maximun number of contacts themselves. Fortunately, bearing geometry is simpler and the following assumptions can be made: • Planar movement is considered as in the case of gear forces. • Inner and outer races are rigidly fixed to the gear shaft and support. • Only deflections of Hertzian type are considered, neglecting bending and shearing of races and rolling elements. • The angular separation between rolling elements is constant (θb=2π/n). • Rolling elements roll on the surface races without slipping. The last assumption provides a simple expression to calculate the cage angular position, which controls the angular position for each rolling element, as r θ cage = θ shaft r+R where R and r are the outer and inner race radii (see fig 3).
c/2
i c/2
Y
θi
X r R
θb
Figure 3:
Schema of rolling bearing.
Force deflection relationship for the local Hertzian contact is defined by Fθ i = k Bδθpi with p = 3 / 2 for ball bearings where kB is the contact stiffness, both inner and outer contacts connected in series are considered, and δθi the radial deformation (geometric overlapping) of the ith rolling element (located in angular position θi), which will depend on the inner race centre movement (x,y) and the bearing clearance c δθpi = x cos θi + y sin θi − c Only positive radial deformations should be considered in the calculation of resultant force as otherwise the ball will not be in contact. Therefore, the resulting force for the ith rolling element is obtained as
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
717
1 δ θ i ≥ 0 Fθ i = k B H (δθ i )δθpi ; H (δθ i ) 0 δ θ i < 0 Finally the total force is obtained by summation of the n individual forces from each rolling element. The resultant force, knowing the angular positions θi, can be expressed by the x and y direction components, with the following equations, n Fx = k B ∑ H (δθ i )δθpi cos θi i =1 ; with θi = θ cage + θ b (i − 1) n Fy = k B ∑ H (δθ i )δθpi sin θi i =1
4
Application example
The models described in the previous paragraphs have been applied to a pair of gear wheels with the same number of teeth, each one supported by two identical ball bearings. The main gear parameters are contained in table 1, while the support data bearings are defined in table 2 Table 1:
Gear data parameters.
Parameter Number of teeth (Z) Module (m) Modulus of elasticity, E Poisson’s ratio Pressure angle Rack addendum Rack deddendum Rack tip rounding Gear tip rounding Gear face width Gear shaft radius Table 2:
Pinion / Gear 23 3 (mm) 210 (GPa) 0.3 20 (degree) 1.25 m 1m 0.25 m 0.05 m 15 (mm) 9 (mm)
Bearing data parameters.
Parameter Contact Stiffness kB Number of ball bearings n Radial clearance c Outer race radius Inner race radius
Value 7.055 109 N/m3/2 9 20 (µm) 14.13 (mm) 9.37 (mm)
Before carrying out simulations, taking into account both force models, each one is tested individually to validate it. The bearing model was tested applying an increasing load in the x direction (corresponding to a torque from -10 to – WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
718 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 100 Nm) obtaining the equilibrium position for a complete turn of the shaft (360 degree). The number of active contacts is shown in figure 4, while the corresponding orbits are shown in figure 5. It can be observed that a displacement in y direction appears even though there is no force applied in this direction. Moreover displacement in the y direction is greater than the displacement in x direction. Therefore, when bearings interact with gear forces a variation of the gear centre position should be expected and therefore a modification of the operation distance and pressure angle.
4 3.8 3.6 3.4
Elements
3.2 3 2.8 2.6 2.4 2.2 2 3000 2500 2000
300
Load (N)
350
250
1500
200
1000 500 0
Figure 4:
50
100
150 degree
0
Number of active elements.
-6
2
x 10
1.5
1
Y displacement (m)
0.5
0
-0.5
-1
LOAD -1.5
-2 2.5
3
Figure 5:
3.5
4 4.5 X displacement (m)
5
Orbits for several load values.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
5.5
6 -5
x 10
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
719
The gear model was also tested taking into account a fixed position for gear centres (rigid support) neglecting profile errors. Then an increasing torque (from 10 to 100 Nm) was applied and the turn angle necessary to obtain the desired torque that will be the LTE was calculated for several angular positions and the torsional stiffness was deduced as in reference [6].
-4
x 10 8 7
L T E (ra d ia n s )
6 5 4 3 2 1 0 100 80 0.1
60 Torque (Nm)
0.05
40
0 -0.05
20 0
Figure 6:
Angle (radians)
-0.1
LTE (radians) for several load values (rigid support).
6
7
x 10
Torsional Stiffness (Nm/rad)
6.5
6
5.5
5
4.5
Figure 7:
-0.1
-0.05
0 Angle (radians)
0.05
0.1
Torsional Stiffness for several load values (rigid support).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
720 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Both magnitudes are shown in figure 6 and figure 7 for several torque levels. Reference angular position corresponds to the contact in the primitive point without any clearance. It is clear that the torque increases the period of double contact (higher stiffness in figure 7) and the corresponding transmission error. -5
x 10 3
2
1
0
-1
-2
-3 -4
-3
-2
-1
0
1
2
3
4 -5
x 10
Figure 8:
Orbits for several load values with support flexibility.
-3
3.6
x 10
3.4
3.2
3
LTE (radians)
2.8
2.6
2.4
2.2
2
1.8
1.6
0
Figure 9:
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8 Angle (Degree)
1
1.2
1.4
1.6
LTE (radians) for several load values with support flexibility.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
721
Finally the whole model was tested with the same torque levels. This time the interaction between gears and bearings is recorded as can be seen in figure 8 where the orbits for each gear centre are shown. Figure 9 shows the resulting LTE corresponding to the orbits presented in figure 8, assuming a flexible support due the bearing flexibility. In spite of the fact that, in figure 9 it is not appreciated due to the scale, the model is able to predict an oscillation wave in the resulting LTE due to the bearing’s variable compliance. It should also be noted that the LTE shown in the figure 9 should be corrected removing the angular clearance that appears as a consequence of the variable position of gears.
5
Conclusions
A quasi-static model for the study of interactions between gears and ball bearings is presented. The main features of the model developed are the approximation of the gear contact by decomposition of local and global deformations and the inclusion of bearing variable compliance with the angular position. An application example was presented where the interaction between elements can be observed taking into account the effect of the load, obtaining several parameters representative of the system behaviour such as the LTE, centre orbits and the number of active contacts in bearings and gears. In this work some quasi-static analyses were presented, nevertheless one of the aims of this model was its application to the dynamic analysis of gear transmission. Taking into account this fact, special attention was paid to achieving a good compromise between accuracy and computational load.
Acknowledgements This paper has been developed in the framework of the Projects DPI2003-1845 and DPI2006-14348 funded by the Spanish Ministry of Science and Technology.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
J. Dereck Smith, Gear Noise and Vibration, Marcel Dekker, Inc, 1999. P. Velex, M. Ajmi, On the modelling of excitations in geared systems by transmission errors, Journal of Sound and Vibration, 290(3-5), pp. 882909, 2006. J. H. Kuang, Y. T. Yang, An estimate of mesh stiffness and load sharing ratio of a spur gear pair, Proceedings of the ASME International Power Transmission and Gearing Conference 1992. Y. Cai, T. Hayashi, The linear approximated equation of vibration of a pair of spur gears (theory and experiment), Transactions of the ASME, Journal of Mechanical Design, 116, pp. 558-564, 1994. A. Parey, M. El Badaoui, F. Guillet, N. Tandon, Dynamic modelling of spur gear pair and application of empirical mode decomposition-based statistical analysis for early detection of localized tooth defect, Journal of Sound and Vibration, 294(3), pp. 547-561, 2006. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
722 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Ian Howard, Shengxiang Jia, Jiande Wang, The dynamic modelling of a spur gear in mesh including friction and a crack, Mechanical Systems and Signal Processing, 15(5), pp. 831-853, 2001. Shengxiang Jia, Ian Howard, Comparison of localised spalling and crack damage from dynamic modelling of spur gear vibrations, Mechanical Systems and Signal Processing, 20(2), pp. 332-349, 2006. L. D. MacLennan, An analytical method to determine the influence of shape deviation on load distribution and mesh stiffness for spur gears, Journal of Mechanical Science Part C, 216, pp. 1005-1016, 2002. A. Andersson, L. Vedmar, A method to determine dynamic loads on spur gear teeth and on bearings, Journal of Sound and Vibration, 267(5), pp. 1065-1084, 2003. R.G. Parker, S. M. Vijayakar, T.B. Imajo, Non-linear dynamic response of a spur gear pair: modelling and experimental comparisons, Journal of Sound and Vibration 237 (3), pp.435-455, 2000. M. Tiwari, K. Gupta, O. Prakash, Dynamic response of an unbalanced rotor supported on ball bearings, Journal of Sound and Vibration, 238(5), pp. 757-779, 2000. F.L. Litvin and A. Fuentes, Gear Geometry and Applied Theory, Cambridge University Press, 2004. G. Bonori, A. O. Andrisano, F. Pellicano, Stiffness Evaluation and Vibration in a tractor gear, Proceedings of ASME International Mechanical Engineering Congress and Exposition (IMECE) 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
723
On a numerical model of a complete washing machine T. Argentini1, M. Belloli1, N. Gaudiano2, G. Fraternale2, F. Panetta1, D. Sabato1 & M. Vanali1 1 2
Department of Mechanics, Politecnico di Milano, Milano, Italy Indesit Company Spa, Fabriano (AN), Italy
Abstract We present a numerical model of a complete horizontal-axis washing machine and its validation. Our purpose is to develop an effective mathematical model able to predict the machine dynamics during steady-state spinning cycles, with a specific focus on the structural vibrations of the cabinet. The complete model couples a parametric linearized multi-body model under unbalanced-mass forcing for the drum unit and a structural finite element model for the cabinet. The drum unit and cabinet are connected by means of a suspension system composed of three extension springs and two dry-friction dampers. We present two different models to simulate the dampers’ behaviour and we compute the response of the cabinet using modal superposition. Besides numerical modelling, we carried out an extensive experimental campaign in order to characterize every element of the washing machine, to determine every parameter of the model, and to collect a large database to validate the model. Experimental results are reported in Argentini et al. “Experimental characterization of the vibro-acoustic behaviour of a complete washing machine. XXV IMAC, 2007”. A satisfying reproduction of the machine dynamics emerges from the comparison between numerical and experimental responses. The numerical model will be used to design and test new solutions to improve the dynamical response and to reduce structural vibrations. Keywords: washing machine, numerical model, multi-body, FEM, friction dampers, vibrations.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070711
724 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
In a market that is more and more oriented towards customer satisfaction, high performances together with high comfort levels provide the competitive edge to gain market share. In the case of washing machines, very high spin speeds (up to 1600 rpm) are offered to end-users. However, high performances often drop comfort levels: indeed, a drawback of having high spinning speeds is that the cabinet of the washer is forced at higher frequencies than it was designed for and it vibrates excessively, generating noise. Therefore, reducing the noise emitted during washing cycles, and specifically during spinning cycles, is a very attractive target, because it permits the matching of performance and comfort. Up to now, research and development of washing machines have been mainly carried on adapting existing machines by means of experimental and heuristic approaches, with high development costs and long research time. Within this scenario, considering that computational speed is continuously improving, numerical models are gaining ground as design tools that allow to improve products’ time-to-market and to reduce design costs. In this perspective, we present a numerical model of a horizontal-axis washing machine able to predict its dynamics. In particular, we focus our modelling on the dynamics during spinning cycles since, as we showed in [1], at these forcing frequencies the noise due to structural vibrations is particularly unpleasant for end-users. To obtain the global equations of motion, we divided the model into two distinct parts. The drum unit is modelled with a parametrical linear multi-body approach, using lumped parameters to represent the inertial, elastic or dissipative contribution of each element. A parametrical approach, i.e. the possibility to modify one or more elements independently, is necessary to get a versatile design tool; a linear approach is adopted since we study the steady-state dynamics of the drum unit, that during spinning cycles is forced in its seismographic zone, and therefore we account for small displacements and linearized equations of motion. To model the cabinet we used a finite element approach [2], and we used a reduced modal superposition to evaluate the vibratory response of some significant points.
2
Drum unit model
The model we used to schematize the system is depicted in Figure 1. The drum unit is composed of four rigid bodies: a plastic tub (in which we include the inertia of the electrical motor), a rotating stainless steel basket, and two concrete ballasts constrained at the tub. The unit is linked to the cabinet by means of three springs, two dampers and a gasket. An unbalanced mass, constrained to the tub with a known eccentricity, forces the system. The model global reference system is placed in a corner of the cabinet: from it, we define the coordinate of the points of interest, such as the centre of gravity of each body and the hinges of springs and dampers, as shown in Fig. 1.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
725
To write the equations of motion of the drum we consider six degrees of freedom (displacements and rotations of the tub) and the imposed angular velocity of the basket. Gballast1 tub’s local reference system Gtub Gmecc Gbasket
main reference system z x
Gballast2
Figure 1:
y
Idealization of the real washing machine: tub, gasket, suspensions, main and a local reference system.
The total kinetic energy of the drum is obtained through the sum of the kinetic energies of each body; N 1 [ M ] EkTOT = ∑ Eki , with Eki = yTi 2 [ 0] i =1
[ 0] y [ J ] i
=
1 T y M i y 2 i i
(1)
where y is a vector that represents the dofs of the centre of gravity of the i-th body, [M] is the local mass matrix, and [J] is the principal inertia tensor: these inertial and geometric properties can be easily retrieved from 3D solid models of new prototypes. The projection of the local principal references onto the global reference is made in two steps: first, we rotate it using a direction cosine matrix [Λθ] onto a reference system parallel to the global one and centred in Gi, i.e.: Second, we project the [Mi*] matrix onto the global reference system using a linear transformation matrix, [ΛT], which contains opportunely the three distances between global and local reference system.
Eki =
T T 1 T 1 T q i ΛTi Λϑi M i* Λϑi ΛTi q i = q i M i q i 2 2
(2)
To reproduce the effect of the unbalanced mass we consider it as an external force applied to the centre of mass of the tub. We write the equation of motion of the mass in the coordinate system of the basket, computing its kinetic energy and applying Lagrange’s formalism. With reference to Figure 3, the velocity of the mass vm can be written as follows: ecc
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
726 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII vxc = xc + θ yc e cos(θ yc ) − θ zc ey v yc = yc + θ zc e sin(θ yc ) + − θ xc e cos(θ yc ) vzc = zc − θ yc e sin(θ yc ) − θ xc ey
vmecc = vx2c + v y2c + vz2c
(3)
y esin(θyc ) z mecc
ey
θy c
x x θz c z
ey
ecos(θyc ) y
θx c
Figure 2:
Position of the unbalanced mass in the basket local coordinates.
It can be noticed that the velocity of the unbalanced mass has a non-linear dependence upon the rotation and on the angular velocity of the basket. Deriving these terms according to the Lagrange’s formalism, their dependence on the six degrees of freedom of the system is highlighted. Organizing the terms according to their dependence upon the six dofs of the tub and their derivatives, we can write the contribute of the unbalanced mass as follows:
Qc = [ M ecc (t ) ] qc + [ Recc (t ) ] qc + f ecc (t )
(4)
The terms [Mecc(t)] and [Recc(t)] contain the dependence of these elements on the accelerations and velocities of the tub, the external force fecc(t) contains the terms that have no dependence upon the chosen degrees of freedom. The elastic potential is due to the three springs. The general formulation of the potential energy for each spring is: T
∆lx 1 T 1 Vs = ∆l [ K ] ∆l = ∆l y 2 2 ∆lz
kx 0 0
0 ky 0
0 ∆l x 0 ∆l y k z ∆lz
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
727
where ∆l is a vector containing the dynamical extension of the spring projected onto the local orthogonal coordinate system of the spring, shown in Figure 3. The stiffness kx is the value found experimentally [1], whereas ky and kz are the stiffness values due to the fact that the spring is statically pre-loaded [5]. These values can be computed as:
k y = k x ∆l0
∂ ∆l ∂z A2
= kx yA =0
2
= kx z A =0
ldef − l0 ldef
(6)
ldef − l0 ldef
x
z
k z = k x ∆l0
∂ 2 ∆l ∂y A2
Figure 3:
Spring local coordinate system (2D view).
where yA and zA are the displacement of the hinge on the drum in the spring local reference, while ldef and l0 are respectively the pre-loaded and unloaded length of the spring. A big part of the dissipating contribution to the system is due to the gasket, which also preserves elastic properties. This element is not easy to model (with non-linear dependence on the amplitude and the frequency of motion) but, at the effects of our work, it is sufficient to consider a system of linear elastic and dissipative elements, placed in an equivalent point (see Fig.1). This point is the center of the porthole and, knowing its coordinates, we can write the potential and dissipating terms of the gasket. We consider as well the linearized gyroscopic effect due to the spin speed of the basket [5].
3
Damper models
Beside the gasket, most part of the dissipative energy is due to the two dampers placed under the washing machine tub (see Fig.1). During the experimental campaign, we evidenced the non-linear characteristic of these elements: we now propose two different models to reproduce this behavior. The first approach uses a formula that fits the hysteresis loop of the damper [3]: we will call it the closed form formulation, in witch the damper force can be expressed as: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
728 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII ∆f xv (t ) − xb f damper (t ) = f ab + ∓ f ab f 2 x 1 − 2 ab ± ( xv (t ) − xb ) ∆f s
(7)
where xv(t) represents the motion of the connection point of the damper with the tub, xb and fab are the last value of xv(t) and fdamper(t) before the reversal of the motion, ∆f is the amplitude of the hysteresis loop, and xs a parameter proportional to the slope of the hysteresis loop (see Fig. 4). The operators ± and ∓ change their value if the damper is in a compression or traction phase. 40 20 [N]
slope 0 -20 -40
Figure 4:
-5
0 [m]
5 x 10
-3
Hysteresis loops: closed formulation (dotted) and rheologic model (solid).
The second model implemented is a rheologic one. This model can be schematized with a one degree of freedom damper-spring-mass system that slides with friction (see Fig. 5). yd , y˙ d , y¨d kd xv , x˙ v , x ¨v md fdamper rd T
Figure 5:
Rheologic model scheme.
The damper force (fdamper) can be easily computed by force balance, considering that kd is a linear stiffness, rd a viscous damping and T is a friction force whose amplitude is proportional to the mass and whose sign is function of its velocity. A typical hysteresis cycle is represented in Fig. 4. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
729
For both models the determination of the parameters comes from the minimization of the error between the numerical and the experimental dissipated energy. The main advantage of the closed formulation model is its simplicity and the little computational time that it requires; unfortunately this method does not contain any information about the excitation frequency. Experimentally, we evidenced that this is acceptable for the real damper in the range over 5 Hz, therefore this model is very useful especially for spinning cycles simulations. On the other hand, the peculiarity of the rheologic model is its frequency dependent response and the consequent easiness of performing a sensitivity analysis since each parameter has a physical meaning. Its major drawback is the substantial increase in the integration time due to the reduced time step necessary to simulate the friction force and to the addition of one dof for each damper. To test both models we made a comparison with the real damper, using the results of the experimental campaign. In particular, we focus our attention on the total dissipated energy per cycle and on the frequency content of the force. In Fig. 6 we show the hysteresis loop in a test at 10 Hz with 5 mm amplitude of sinusoidal imposed motion. 40
[N]
20 Experimental Closed form Rheologic
0 -20 -40
Figure 6:
-5
0 [m]
5 x 10
-3
Hysteresis loop comparison between experimental and numerical dampers (5 mm, 10 Hz).
It can be seen that the non linearity of the experimental force (red line) is better represented by the rheologic damper (dotted line), but its dependence on the frequency and the motion amplitude is distant from the experimental one (solid line). Yet the closed-form damper (dashed line) has always the same behavior in the frequency domain and it best fits the area of the loop, even if it introduce more energy at higher frequencies (see Fig. 7). It is possible for the closed-form model to fit better the high frequency forces using a low-pass filter. Coupling these systems to the drum unit model, we evaluated that the closed form damper (especially during spinning cycles) guarantees the best agreement between experimental and numerical results for all the drum angular velocities from 600 to 1600 rpm. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
730 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
Cabinet model
A model of the cabinet is necessary to integrate the drum unit model in order to get a complete washing machine dynamical model. The cabinet, whose solid geometric model was available from its designers, can be modeled using a FEM approach [2]. The resulting FE model leads to very large structural matrices ( n = 817218 degrees of freedom, in our case), consequently solving directly the equation of motion is computationally expensive and time consuming. Experimental
[N]
10 10
10
Figure 7:
Rheologic Closed formulation
0
-2
-4
0
100
200 [Hz]
300
400
Force spectrum comparison between experimental and numerical dampers (5 mm, 10 Hz).
Figure 8:
Example of FEM analysis result, 18° mode at 81Hz.
Therefore, to predict the behaviour of the cabinet we developed a model using a reduced modal superposition approach using the results of a FEM eigenvalue analysis (see Fig. 8). We approximate the modal response using k eigenmodes of the n we arrange, considering a defined bandwidth, in our case 200 Hz. For this reason we need to solve a system of k decoupled single-dof equations in modal coordinates qi . Each equation has the following form:
qi + 2hiω0i qi + ω02i qi = Qi (t )
i = 1,… , k
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(8)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
731
where i in the mode number, hi the modal damping, ω0i2 the eigenvalue associated with the i-th mode, and Qi the force vector projected onto the i-th eigenvector. Forces in Qi are the forces transmitted by the three springs and the two dampers.
5
Model validation
It is important to verify that the hypothesis made during its development is justified by a good correspondence between numerical and experimental results. First we validate the tub motion, then we proceed with the cabinet motion. One of the model results, at an imposed angular velocity excitation, is the time history of the tub’s centre of mass, while experimentally we can evaluate the acceleration of six points on its surface [1]. Through an appropriate transformation matrix the output of the model has been made consistent with the experimental one. In Fig.9 we show a comparison between steady-state responses at different excitation frequencies: the washing machine is tested with the two dampers disconnected, and with an unbalanced mass of 190g. The model represents the response of the vertical accelerometers (z-front, zback), but, while in the experimental results the vertical mode is coupled to a yaw one, in the numerical response this phenomenon does not appear. The rear and lateral accelerometers responses (y-right, y-left, x-front, x-back) are overestimated at 1.5-3 Hz, while they are underestimated in the range 4-5 Hz. z front
Simulation 0.02
z back y right
[m]
0.015
y left x front
0.01
x back 0.005 0
1
1.5
2
2.5
1
1.5
2
2.5
3 3.5 [Hz] Experimental
4
4.5
5
4
4.5
5
0.02
[m]
0.015 0.01 0.005 0
Figure 9:
3 [Hz]
3.5
Drum unit motion: numerical vs. experimental.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
732 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII These discrepancies are due to the simplifications introduced in the gasket modeling as it has been evidenced by a comparison done excluding it. Since our objective is the simulation of the vibratory response of the cabinet at high rpms, it is more meaningful to see directly a comparison between the experimental and numerical responses of the cabinet for a high frequency excitation. The cabinet motion is measured with a number of accelerometers placed on the five panels. As an example, in Figure 9 we show the response of one point the cabinet during a spinning cycle with a 500g unbalanced mass at 1100rpm. As visible, the odd harmonics, which are the most relevant, are very close to the experimental one, whereas the even harmonics, whose contribution to the frequency content is minor, reflect the characteristics of the proposed models for the dampers.
2
[m/s ]
3
experimental
2 1 0
20
40
60
80
100 [Hz]
120
140
2
[m/s ]
3
180
200
simulation
2 1 0
Figure 10:
6
160
20
40
60
80
100 [Hz]
120
140
160
180
200
Spectra of the accelerometer placed in the centre of the cabinet left panel.
Conclusions
We summarized the passages taken to realize a numerical model of a complete washing machine. The linear approach adopted is justified by our initial hypothesis and by the results presented that validate the model for the simulation of the vibratory response of the cabinet during spinning cycles. The limits of the model are as well evidenced. This tool allows the prediction of the dynamic behaviour of the machine when it is modified by either moving the position of the concrete ballasts or adding other springs to the system. It is therefore a versatile design tool to test very easily many different solutions able to improve the system response.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
733
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
T. Argentini, M. Belloli, N. Gaudiano, G. Fraternale, D. Sabato, M. Vanali. Experimental characterization of the vibro-acoustic behaviour of a complete washing machine. XXV IMAC, 2007 F.Panetta, M.Belloli, S.Miccoli, A.Tosi, R.Viganò. Analisi numerico sperimentale del comportamento dinamico di una macchina lavatrice. In XXXIV Convegno Nazionale AIAS, 2005 B. Warner. An analytical and experimental investigation of racing car suspension system. Journal of commercial vehicle, 1996. A.A. Shabana, Dynamics of Multibody Systems, Third Edition, Cambridge University Press, 2005 G.Diana and F.Cheli: Dinamica e vibrazioni dei sistemi meccanici. Vol. 1 and 2. UTET Spiegel. Milano, Italy 1993.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Section 10 Detection and signal processing (Special session organised by Professor Z. Bielecki)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
737
EUV detection system with calibrated responsivity J. Mikolajczyk & Z. Bielecki Institute of Optoelectronics, Military University of Technology, Poland
Abstract We describe a measuring system of EUV radiation energy using special calibration responsivity. This system is specified by responsivity of 0.043 A/W at the wavelength range of 13.5±0.5 nm (FWHM=7.2%). A determination of the calibration responsivity for a laser-plasma source with Xe/He gas puff target is also discussed. This parameter makes it possible to reference measurement results to the standard wavelengths band of 13.5±0.13 nm (FWHM=2%). The value of the calibration responsivity depends on the spectra of measured radiation and features of the system elements. In this paper, the analysis and investigation results of the source and the measuring system are demonstrated. Keywords: EUV radiation, optical sensors, energy meter.
1
Introduction
Accurate measurements of energy radiation are very important in nanolithography. The resists or masks can be damaged due to the measurements errors. Nowadays, energy meters of EUV radiation are also used for testing of lithography tools. The investigations are connected with characterization of EUV radiation sources, features of optical elements, etc. The responsivity and measurement accuracy are the main features of the measuring devices. The parameters are referenced to a standard wavelength range of 13.5±0.13 nm. The range corresponds with the FWHM=2%. The developed commercial meters are usually built from multilayer mirrors and semiconductor detectors [1]. The mirrors simplify construction of the instruments. Using photodiodes makes it possible to achieve a high efficiency and plain measurements procedures. The pulse energy of radiation is determined by the measured charge generated in a photodiode, the value of the detector WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070721
738 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII responsivity and the features of optical elements. Achievement of appropriate selectivity of measuring spectrum (FWHM=2%) is important issue of construction process of the meters. The special mirrors with wavelength band of 2% have been constructed. Analyses and investigations showed that the mirrors are characterized by low reflectivity [2]. As the amount of photons reaching detector is limited, the instrument responsivity is decreased. The described effect is avoided using the optical elements with broader wavelength range and a special calibration factor. This factor provides to refer measured data taken in the broader spectrum to the arbitrary one. The factor value depends on spectra of the measured radiation and some performances of the instrument elements. Basing on this factor and the meter responsivity, the calibrated responsivity is calculated by SS = Cλ Sλ . (1) The construction of the laser-plasma source with gas-puff target necessitated application of an appropriate system for energy measurement [3]. The features of the commercial meters (their dimensions and prices) forced to design a special measuring system (M-EUV system) [4]. The small size, the high-calibrated responsivity and the fully automated measuring process, all are the main system advantages. M-EUV system uses Mo/Si multilayer mirror (FWHM=7.3%), silicon photodiode with integrated absorption filter and the calibration factor. To the best of analysed knowledge, this work presents the experimental results of the first investigation of the system with calibrated responsivity used for measurements of energy emitted by the laser plasma source with Xe/He gas puff target.
2
Calibrated responsivity
The determined value and the measured range of wavelengths describe the energy of source radiation using M-EUV system. The spectrum influence on measurement results is taken into consideration by determination of the system responsivity. The responsivity is the most important parameter of absolute energy measurements and it is defined by
RD =
∆Iph Pλ
,
(2)
where Iph is the current signal generated in detector and Pλ is the power of the exposing radiation. The spectral characteristic of M-EUV system responsivity depends on the mirror reflectivity and the detector responsivity. This characteristic is given by S λ = SDet R Mir . (3) Theoretically determined characteristic of the system responsivity is shown in Fig. 1.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
739
Figure 1: Theoretical characteristic of the system responsivity [5]. The maximum value is 0.043 A/W at the wavelength range of 13.5±0.5 nm. Analyses and investigations of the spectra generated from Xe/He gas-puff target gave an opportunity to calculate the calibrated responsivity of the M-EUV system. In Fig. 2, it is presented the spectrum of the source radiation in the two ranges of wavelengths 13.5±0.5 nm and 13.5±0.13 nm describing the system responsivity.
Figure 2: Radiation spectrum with analysed ranges of wavelength [5]. The marked areas specify the radiation energies in the chosen wavelength ranges. The energies are connected with the charge generated in the irradiated photodiode. The value of this charge is given by ∞
Q=Ω
∫ E(λ ) S
λ
dλ ,
(4)
0
where Ω is the solid angle of the source radiation. The energy value of radiation at the range of wavelengths of 13.5±0.13 nm is determined by
Q
E 2% (λ ) =
,
∞
Ω
∫ I(λ ) S
λ
dλ
0
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
740 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII where I(λ) is the normalized function characterising the spectrum of radiation and it is described by
∫ I(λ ) dλ = 1.
(6)
13.5 ± 0.13 nm
The expression given by ∞
S S( λ ) = ∫ I(λ ) S λ dλ ,
(7)
0
defines the calibration responsivity of the M-EUV system [1]. This responsivity depends on features of system elements and the source spectra. The spectra can be shifted by changing conditions of the plasma generation in the investigated source. The aforesaid conditions concern a delay of the nozzles valve opening with respect to a laser pulse, power density of Nd:YAG laser radiation on the target surface, position of a laser beam focus with respect to the gas target axis, pressure of the remaining gases in the source chamber, gases pressures in the valve nozzles [6].
3
Measurement method
Measurements of the calibration responsivity were taken using the laser plasma source with Xe/He gas puff target and the model instrument (E-Mon energy meter [1]). The main aim of the investigations was determination of energy radiation in two ranges of wavelengths 13.5±0.27 nm and 13.5±0.5 nm. The ranges are defined by spectral characteristics of mirrors reflectivity used in E-Mon meter and M-EUV system. The calibration responsivity (SS E-Mon) and measurement uncertainty of E-Mon meter referenced to the wavelength range of 13.5±0.13 nm is taken into consideration for determination of the M-EUV system responsivity. The calibration factor (CM-EUV) is determined by measured energies with EMon meter and M-EUV system. The value of the factor is given by
CM−EUV =
E 7% , E 3%
(8)
where E7% and E3% are the energy values in the wavelength ranges of 13.5±0.5 nm and 13.5±0.27 nm. This factor makes it possible to specify the calibrated responsivity of M-EUV system referenced to FWHM=2%. This responsivity is calculated by
S S M−EUV = CM−EUV S S E−Mon
4
.
(9)
Experimental results
The measurements of the source energy and determination of the energies ratio in two wavelength ranges were the main aim of the investigations. The researches defined the calibration responsivity and also the calibration factor of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
741
M-EUV system. The spectra of the radiation emitted by the laser-plasma source with Xe/He gas puff target were also analysed. The measurements were taken for different conditions of plasma generation in the source. 4.1 Influence of delay of Xe/He nozzles valve opening The delay of the nozzles valve opening with respect to a laser pulse has direct impact on a dimension and density of the gas target. Measured characteristics of the energy and the calibration factor as a function of the delay of Xe and Xe gas nozzles are shown in Fig. 3.
Figure 3:
Energy radiation and the calibration factor at various delays of Xe and Xe gas nozzles.
The value changes of the calibration factor with delay of Xe gas nozzle are up to relative value of 10%. Its mean value is 1.85±0.06. The maximum energy emitted by the source was achieved for delay from 650 to 850 µs. For He gas, a threshold delay was observed. The energy drops off dramatically for the delay of 200 µs. The noticed threshold has no influence on the factor characteristic. 4.2 Influence of Xe/He gases pressures in the valve nozzles The gases pressure similar to nozzles delay forms the target performances. This influence concerns the source spectra. The characteristic changes of energy and calibration factor as a function of the pressures are shown in Fig. 4. The increase in the energy radiation is determined by simultaneous increase in the Xe gas pressure. The maximum value of energy is limited by strength of gas pipes. The calibration factor characteristic follows the energy characteristics. For He gas pressure below 0.5 MPa, the optimal range of energies is observed. In this case, the calibrated factor decreases negligibly with He gas pressure. 4.3 Influence of pressure of the remaining gases The EUV radiation is absorbed not only by a solid body but also by a gaseous one. The remaining gas target can be accumulated in the chamber of the laserplasma source. The pressure of the remaining gas depends on the source WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
742 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII repetition and the efficiency of the vacuum pump. The measured value of the pressure was shifted from 10-6 to 10-2 mbar at the source repetition of 10 Hz. The changes of energy and the calibration factor for the remaining gases are shown in Fig. 6.
Figure 4:
Energy radiation and the calibration factor vs. Xe/He gases pressures in the valve nozzles.
Figure 5:
Energy and the calibration factor as a function of pressure of the remaining gases in the source chamber.
The energy and the calibration factor vary significantly with the Xe remaining gas. The threshold pressure of the energy dropping is observed near the value of 10-2 mbar. The calibration factor increases with the pressure build-up. Its mean value is 1.82±0.06. For the He gas, the described influences are not so noticeable. The mean value of the calibrated factor is 1.83±0.03. 4.4 Influence of position of a laser beam focus The valve construction makes it possible to control a beam focus position on the gas target space. Figure 6 shows energy and calibration factor characteristics varied with a position of a laser beam focus. The measured energy and the calibration factor decrease with shifting the target position more than value of +10 µm. The mean value of the calibrated factor was 1.77±0.06. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6:
743
Energy and the calibration factor as a function of positions of a laser beam focus.
4.5 Influence of energy radiation of Nd:YAG laser The Nd:YAG laser with output energy adjustment was used during the investigation procedures. The energy control was executed by changing a duration time of the active laser pumping. This time can be adjusted in the range from 200 to 2000 µs. Figure 7 shows the source energies and the calibrated factor for changes of duration time of the active laser pumping.
Figure 7:
5
Energy and the calibration factor vs. duration time of the laser pumping.
Results verification
The results were verified by spectral measuring of the source radiation. The analysed spectra were taken by the spectrometer consisted of the reflecting grating (HITACHI 1200 l/mm) and CCD camera (Roper Scientists). The values of the calibrated factor were calculated using the processed graphs of the measured spectra. The graphs were given by multiplication of the spectral characteristics of multilayer mirrors (used in the E-Mon meter and M-EUV system) and the source spectra. The example of the analysed graph is shown in Fig. 8.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
744 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 8:
Resultant graphs of the spectra detected by the E-Mon meter and M-EUV system.
The maximum differences between the data taken by the measuring instruments and the spectral analyses were observed for changes of position of a laser beam focus (12%), pressure of the remaining gases (9.5%), and delay of the Xe nozzle valve opening (8.8%). For other conditions of the plasma generations, the noticed differences were less than 4%.
6
Conclusions
The paper presents a unique system for energy measurement of radiation emitted by the laser-plasma source with Xe/He gas puff target. The experimental results specified not only the features of the system, but also characterized an influence of the conditions of the plasma generation on the source spectra. The measured responsivity of the system is 0.043 A/W in the range of wavelengths of 13.5±0.5 nm. For the maximum efficiency of the source, the calculated value of the calibrated factor is 1.79±0.03 in the wavelength range of 13.5 ±0.13 nm hence the system responsivity of 0.291±0.027 A/W. Using the mirrors with wider spectral characteristic of the reflectivity (worse selectivity) has improved the measuring performance of the system. Acceptance of the constant value of the calibration factor (independent on conditions of the plasma generation) is able to make the measurement error of 14%. The uncertainty of factor calculation was 7.4%. The relative value of the determined uncertainty of energy measurement in the spectrum of FWHM=2% is 10.1%. The presented system provides a simple, reliable solution to EUV energy measurements. That is why it is promising alternative for commercial meters.
Acknowledgements This work was financially supported by the Polish Ministry of Science and Higher Education in the frame of research project No 0004/T00/2005/29. The authors would like to thank prof. H. Fiedorowicz (Institute of Optoelectronics, MUT, Warsaw) for fruitful discussion and advice. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
745
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
Cross-Calibration of Extreme Ultraviolet (EUV) Energy Sensors International SEMATECH Technology Transfer #04024498A-TR http://www.sematech.org/docubase/document/4498atr.pdf. http://www.iof.fhg.de/departments/optical-coatings/vuv-euv-ray/projects /euv_schmalband_e.html. Kranzusch S. & Mann K. Spectral characterization of EUV radiation emitted from a laser-irradiated gas puff target, Optics Communications, vol. 200, Issue: 1-6, pp. 223-230, December 15, 2001. Mikolajczyk J., Bielecki Z. & Wojtas J. Testing system for extreme ultraviolet detectors, Processing of SPIE, vol. 5948, pp. 594822-(1-9), April, 2005. Bielecki Z. & Mikolajczyk J. Energy meter for Xe/He gas-puff laser plasma source, Optica Applicata, 2007 in print. Fiedorowicz H. & et al. Compact laser plasma EUV source based on a gas puff target for metrology applications, Journal of Alloys and Compounds, vol. 401, Issue: 1-2, pp. 99-103, September 29, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
747
Analysis of radiating structures placed on multilayer dielectric M. Wnuk & M. Bugaj Faculty of Electronics, Military University of Technology, Poland
Abstract In this work, a solution to the problem of electromagnetic fields scattering on periodical, limited, planar antenna structures, placed on the border of two dielectric layers is formulated. One led out of scattering this kind of structure and defined in its generalization for the case of antenna with a multilayered dielectric basis. By using Galerkin’s spectral method the problem was brought to an arrangement of algebraical equations with disposition on coefficients of the current’s disposition on metal elements of an antenna arrangement, with regard to disposition of field on Floquet’s harmonics. The complete transverse dimension of an antenna was taken into account by introducing antenna’s window functioning solution of unlimited antenna. The formalism allows the modeling of periodical actions, dielectrics, and composite antenna arrays. Keywords: Antenna arrays, multilayer dielectric, Green function.
1
Introduction
Antenna arrays usually consist of periodical metal structures placed on, or set in, multilayer dielectric. Changes of size or shape of each of the antenna’s elements allows for effective modelling of spectral characteristics of parameters of antenna array. These changes can also be modelled by the selection of geometrical and physical parameters of dielectric layer surface and coverage. In the case of big transversal dimensions of antenna (100 lengths of wave) and several dozen or more single radiating metal elements, characteristics of antenna radiation in good approach respond to characteristics of an unlimited antenna structure. When the condition of fulfilling periodicality of such an antenna is fulfilled and it is excited by a flat wave with linear and homogenize module faze, the problem of diffraction of such a structure is brought to an analysis of a single WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070731
748 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII elementary antenna cell. For structures of smaller shapes and fewer numbers of elements, effects connected with their limitation, especially boundary effects occurring on external cells can have an influence on characteristics of antenna work and should be taken into account during modelling them. So far, a strict method of solving the problem of diffraction on periodical limited structure is not known. Attempts to directly solve the question, with direct usage of spectral moment method, are only formally strict, because their exactitude is limited by limitations of dimensions of matrixes used in procedures of solving them [L-3,4,5]. z
y
(-M,N)
(M,N)
θ
-r
(-1,1)
dy
(0,1) (1,1)
ρ -
φ
(-1,0) (0,0) (1,0) (-1,-1) (0,-1) (1,-1)
x
(M,-N)
(-M,-N)
ε0 µ 0
ε1 b1 ε2 b2 ε3 b3 ε n bn
Figure 1:
Planar periodic multilayer antenna structure.
Nevertheless, for antenna arrays consisting of several or several dozen of basic cells of regular shape, this method gives good results. Other known methods of solving problems of diffraction on larger periodical structures, such as modifications mentioned in the above method by limiting the number of input base functions and accurate selection of their course [L-1] or iteration method used in solution by sequenced usage of fast Fourier transform are approached, and can be used only in some simple, easy to analyse cases. The analysis presented is based on the idea of window function [L-2] used in seeking current distribution and composed in the structure of a problem of diffraction on periodical unlimited structure. Presented in the paper is the sequence of the next steps of solving leads to strict solution and takes into account only predicted difficulties with convergence of the used procedure.
2
Diffraction of electromagnetic field on limited periodical antenna array
We consider a case with limited antenna array periodical in plane z=0 in direction of x and y “axis”. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
749
Antenna array, as stated before, can be set in any unlimited multilayer dielectric in planes perpendicular to axis z or placed on border of two layers of dielectric. For a simpler analyse we divide the antenna surface in plane z=0 on identical cells (Fig. 2) numbered with integer numbers (m,n), where the central point ((x0,y0) of the central cell(0,0) is placed at the beginning of coordinate system x=0, y=0, and points x=xm, y=yn are central points of next cells(m,n).
y' y ksinΘ
basic cell
ϕ
x Ω
dy
x' dx antenna plane
Figure 2:
Partition of the antenna surface on cells.
Antenna cells with carrier function hmn cover the part of plane z=0 responding to carrier function HMN(x,y) where:
H MN ( x , y ) = 1, dla x ∈ [− Md x , Md x ]i y ∈ [− Nd y , Nd y ],
H MN ( x , y ) = 0, dla x ∉ [− Md x , Md x ]lub y ∉ [− Nd y , Nd y ],
(1)
Integer numbers m, n number cells in direction of axis x m=-M,M+1,...,0,...,M-1,M and towards axis y n=-N,-N+1,...,0,...,N-1,N. Metalized elements are placed periodically on the same limited area of plane z=0 in each cell of antenna array (m,n) and cover the area of carrier function AMN(x,y):
∑a
mn
( x , y ) = AMN ( x , y ) .
(2)
m ,n
Let’s notice that functions HMN(x,y), AMN(x,y) are decomposed on components dependent from x and y:
H MN ( x , y ) = H MNx ( x )H MNy ( y ) , WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
750 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
AMN ( x , y ) = AMNx ( x ) AMNy ( y ) .
(4)
Because of the limitation of the antenna in plane z=0 antenna’s cells are distinguished, by their placement towards the beginning of coordinate system (x,y)=(0,0). However, in this case the solution (current distribution) is changing from cell to cell. In a periodical unlimited system each cell (m,n) can be a central cell. In a limited periodical system the central cell is univocally defined by its placement in the centre area of the antenna array. Every other cell is univocally defined by placement of its centre towards the centre of the array area (x,y)=(0,0). For further consideration it is necessary to define window carrier function HMNmn(x,y) of the antenna array. HMNmn(x,y) functions change themselves depending on in which cell a hypothetical beginning of coordinate system has been placed and are defined by vector translation (xm,yn)=(mdx,ndy) of function HMN:
H mn ( x , y ) = H 00 ( x − x m , y − y m ) = H MN ( x − x m , y − y m ) . (5) Their Fourier transforms equal respectively:
F ( H 00 )( k x , k y ) =
MNd x d y sin Mk x d x sin Nk y d y , Md x Nd y π2
(6)
H mnk ≡ H MN 00 (k xk , k yk ) = (d x d y ) −1 F ( H 00 )(k xk , k yk ) = =
H mnk ≡ H mn (k xk , k yk ) = H 00 (k xk , k yk ) ⋅
[
(7)
MN sin Mk xk d x sin Nk yk d y , Md x Nd y π2
]
[
]
exp − i (mk xk d x + nk yk d y ) = H 00 (k xk , k yk ) exp − i (mϕ xk + nϕ ky ) . (8) So, as we see Fourier transforms of the following cells experience phase modulation which equals to respective Floquet harmonic.
3 Solving the problem of electromagnetic field diffraction on antenna array with limited dimensions Formulating the problem of diffraction by defining matrixes of diffraction antenna array in spectral space, allows for direct introduction of window function to make a solution for unlimited case. [L-11]. In such a case only equations containing current distribution are modified:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
751
J ( x , y ) = H mn ( x , y )∑ j q ϕ q ( x , y ) = ∑ J k H mnk e k ( x , y ) , (9) q
(
k
)
E s ( x, y,0) = G ∗ J ∗ H mn ( x, y ) =
∑G J k
k
H mnk ek ( x, y )
(10)
k
It is obtained by multiplying amplitudes of their spectral representations by Fourier transform of window function H mnk responding to selected cell (m,n). Another form of window function Hmn(x,y) responds to each cell (m,n) because of its placement towards the central carrier of window function HMN(x,y). For each couple of numbers (m,n) another solution determining current distribution on the metalised part of cell (m,n) is calculated. . From the formal point of view, formulating and solving the problem of diffraction for an antenna array with limited dimensions should take into account the continuous spectrum of the value of the wave number k in spectral distribution of parameters field and currents. It means that one should use continuous Fourier transform instead of spectral distributions in those points which respond to discreet values of wave numbers of the following Floquet harmonics. The numerical solution of such a problem also in this case would bring the analysed problem to a problem with discreet spectrum used by numerical procedures such as fast Fourier transform (FFT). This is why it seems reasonable to use spectral distributions of analysed values with spectrum determined by harmonics responding to a case with unlimited periodical structure. So when concerning formal note of equations, except for modifications in the above equations by introducing a window function, formulating and solving presented problem of diffraction on unlimited periodical antenna structure is obtained by distribution of base functions, currents and fields on Floquet harmonics, in a way similar to unlimited antenna array:
ϕ q ( x , y ) = ∑ ϕ qk Ψ k ( x , y ) ,
(11)
J ( x , y ) = ∑ j q ϕ qk H mnk e k ( x , y ) ,
(12)
E t ( x , y ,0 ) = ∑ v ki Ψ k ( x , y ) ,
(13)
E t ( x , y ,0 ) = ∑ ( 1 ± Γk )v ki Ψ k ( x , y ) ,
(14)
k
q ,k
i
k
e
k
E t ( x, y,0) = ∑ v ks Ψ k ( x, y ) , s
(15)
k
by solving diffracted field with inducted currents, with usage of Green function WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
752 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII s ( x, y,0) = E tmn
∑G J k
k
H mnk ek ( x, y )
(16)
k
and throwing on, with usage of the Galerkin method, inducted currents condition of resetting total field on surface of metal antenna elements:
(
)
s E tmn ( x, y,0) AMN = E te ( x, y,0) + E tmn ( x, y,0) AMN = 0
(17)
As a result we obtain system with double matrix algebraically equations:
W j =V
i
NV = −U j
s
where:
[W ]kqj ≡ Wkqj =
[N ] pqij
* ki G kij ϕ qkj H mnk
(19)
i
*
qkj
[U ]
∑ψ
(18)
≡ N qkj = (1 + Γk )ϕ qkjψ kj
≡ U pqij =
∑
,
(20)
*
ϕ pki G kij ϕ qkj H mnk
(21)
k
[ j ]qj ≡
jqj ,
(22)
k
≡ ν ks ,
(23)
k
≡ ν ki .
(24)
[V ] s
[V ] i
Solution of these equations gives coordinates of current distribution:
[ j ]qxmn ≡ jqxmn , [ j ]qymn ≡ jqymn ,
(25) (26)
in a cell defined by indexes of window function Hmn Solving the above system of algebraical equations for the next window functions Hmn, we obtain current distribution Jmn on next cells (m,n) of limited periodical antenna array, so we obtain MxN solutions of the above system of equations for MxN courses of functions Hmn(x,y). Summarized current distribution on all cells at the same time can be presented in a following form:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
J ( x, y ) =
∑J
mn ( x,
y )amn ( x, y ) ,
753 (27)
m, n
where:
J ( x , y ) = ∑ j q ϕ q ( x, y ) = q
= ∑ J k ek ( x, y ) = ∑∑ j q ϕ qk ek ( x, y ) k
k
(28)
q
However, the final solution needs univocal connection of current distribution with raining and diffracted field. s
V = −W U
−1
NV
i
(29)
equivalent to construction of matrix of diffraction of antenna structure:
V s + + Γ V i − S S V i − 11 12 s− = i+ i+ S S V − Γ V 21 22 V
(30)
so it needs one univocal solution of above system of equations, which takes into account current distributions on all cells of antenna at the same time.
Figure 3:
Eight element antenna array.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
754 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
field pattern [dB]
Calculations have been made for a structure presented in fig. 3. Obtained results of calculations with comparison to the made measurement are presented in fig.4 although the time of calculations is very long, they are encouraging to further work in the direction. 0
P/Pmax [dB]
Theory
-10
Measurement
-20 -30 -40 -50
0
20
Figure 4:
4
40
60
80
100
120
140
160 180 angle [deg]
Radiation characteristic of antenna array.
Conclusions
Construction of antenna arrays placed on multilayer dielectric allows for the wanted modelling parameters and characteristics of the antenna array. An analysis of such a type of antennas which take into account the structure of the surface, true for each bandwidth, is based on the green function and moment method. The problem has been analysed, taking into account the distribution of field on Floquet harmonics, with usage of vector distribution on base functions. The proposed solution also allows for an analysis of antenna arrays with variable dimensions of a basic cell. It is a proposition of a precise and effective solution of problem of diagnosis on periodical antenna array with limited dimensions. One should stress, that a very important problem during solution is optimising the computer program in order to obtain maximum exactitude of calculations with minimal time needed.
References [1] [2] [3]
Hall P., James J.: “Handbook of microstrip antennas” Peter Peregrinus Ltd., London 1989 Oltman G.H. "Electromagnetically coupled microstrip dipoles", IEEE Transactions on Antennas and Propagation AP-29, No 1, 1981. Pozar D., Tsay W.: “Application of the FDTD technique to periodic problems in scattering and radiation”, IEEE Microwave and Guided Wave Letters, vol.3, August 1993. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
[9] [10] [11]
[12] [13]
755
Scott C.: „The spectral domain method in electromagnetics”, Artech House, London 1989. Hansen, Numerical Solution of Antennas in Layered Media, Wiley, New York, 1989. E. Munson "Conformal microstrip antennas and microstrip phased arrays ” IEEE Trans. Antennas and Propagation vol. 28 197 4 pp. 74- 78 K. S. Yee "Numerical solution of initial boundary value problems involving Maxwell’s equations in isotropic medias”, IEEE Trans. Antennas and Propagation, vol. 14, 1966. pp. 302 - 307. C. J. Railton, E. M. Daniel, D. L. Paul, J. P. McGreen "Optimized absorbing boundary conditions handicap the analysis of planar circuits using the finite difference time domain method” IEEE Trans. Antennas and Propagation vol. 41, 1993 pp. 290 - 296 Z. Bi, K. Wu, Ch. Wu, J. Litva "And dispersive boundary condition handicap microstrip component analysis using the FDTD method”, IEEE Trans. Antennas and Propagation, vol. 40, 1992. pp. 774 - 777 A. Taflowe "Advance in computational electrodynamics The Finite Difference Time Domain ” Artech House Boston, 1995 D. M. Sheen, S. M. Ali, M. D. Abouzahra, J. A. Kong, "Application of the three - dimensional finite difference time domain Method this the analysis of planar microstrip circuits “ IEEE Trans. he Microwave Theory and Techniques, vol. 38, 1990 pp. 849-857 Z. Bi, K. Wu, Ch. Wu, J. Litva, "Accurate characterization of planar printed antennas using finite difference time domain method" IEEE Trans. he Antennas and Propagation vol. 40 pp. 526-533 A. Reinex, B. Jecko "Analysis of Microstrip Patch Anntenas Using Finite Difference Time Domain IEEE Trans. Antennas and Propagation, vol. 37, 1989. pp. 1361 - 1369.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
757
Method of signal processing in passive infrared detectors for security systems H. Madura Institute of Optoelectronics, Military University of Technology, Warsaw, Poland
Abstract This article presents the construction and principle of operation of passive IR detectors (PIR detectors) of a large detection range. An important virtue of these detectors is highly efficient detection of slowly moving or crawling people. The PIR detector described here detects crawling people at a distance of 140 m. High signal-to-noise ratio was obtained by using a larger number of pyroelectric sensors, i.e., by using a larger number of detection zones (channels). The original electronic system for the PIR detector is presented in which DC signal amplifiers from pyroelectric signals are used. In order to ensure large detection ranges, a new method of signal analysis was used. Keywords: PIR detector, security systems.
1
Introduction
Main elements of security systems are PIR detectors. In general, detectors operating inside buildings have small detection range, small ranges of working temperature, and relatively simple algorithms of intruder detection. The detectors used for protection of objects or large areas (buildings, airports) have larger detection ranges and complex algorithms of signal processing on which significantly depend the efficiency of their operation. An essential drawback of currently available PIR detectors is low efficiency of detection of slowly moving or crawling people. It is because radiation from such objects is similar to background thermal noise. Moreover, to detect slowly moving or crawling people, the lower limit frequency of a transfer band of PIR detector should be near zero. By fulfilling this condition, increase in lowfrequency noise occurs causing a decrease in the next detector’s sensitivity. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070741
758 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Algorithms of intruder detection have to be different than these for typical PIR detectors. To detect crawling people, larger number of sensors should be used (more detection zones) which will cause an increase in signal-to-noise ratio because each of the sensors will “see” the smaller field of view. PIR detectors used in security systems for people detection operate in far infrared spectral range (8÷14 µm). In these detectors, the most frequently used are pyroelectric sensors allowing the detection of temperature changes as small as 10-6K. Application of a single pyroelectric sensor does not ensure distinguishing the events of an alarm nature from, so-called, false alarms caused by, e.g., air turbulences or background temperature changes resulting from sun radiation. Therefore in PIR detectors, the most frequently used are pyroelectric sensors with two active elements (two sensors) and an alarm signal is determined on the basis of analysis of a difference (or a sum) of their output signals [1, 2]. Usually, pyroelectric sensors are mounted, together with a transistor and a resistor polarizing its gate, in standard hermetic housings. A value of this resistor can be even up to 1011Ω, depending on the preamplifier configuration. JFET or MOSFET transistors are used most frequently as the amplifying elements that are mounted near a detector. Electronic Units
Unit of sensors with optical collectors Lens (germanium, gasir)
Optical Diaphragms
Figure 1:
2
Simplified diagram of PIR detector.
Construction of PIR detector
Main elements of PIR detector are: objective (mirror or refraction one), set of pyroelectric sensors, and electronic systems (Fig. 1). The sensors convert an optical signal emitted from the “being observed” surface into an electrical signal. This signal is processed in the electronic systems (it is amplified, filtered, sampled) and next it is analysed in a microprocessor system. The presented PIR detector detects the crawling people at a distance of 140 m. High signal-to-noise ratio was obtained due to application of the larger numbers of pyroelectric sensors, i.e., larger number of detection zones WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
759
(channels). Application of larger number of sensors forces the necessity to develop a complex optical system (Fig. 2). The optical system of the PIR detector has to ensure such a position of the detection zones to the avoid presence of the areas which are “not seen” by a detector [3–5]. Channel 6
Channel 2
Channel 4
Channel 7
Channel 5 Channel 3
4,5m
Channel 1
1,3m 17m 25m
43m
94m
100m
140m
Dual pyroelectric sensor
Figure 2:
Detection zones of PIR detector in horizontal and vertical planes (top) and pyroelectric sensors with optical concentrators and general view of a detection set with seven two-segment sensors (bottom).
Radiation signals caused by slowly moving, especially crawling, people are characterized by similar luminance amplitudes and velocities of its change in time such as fluctuations of background radiation. The signal amplitude from pyroelectric sensors is directly proportional to the velocity of a change of radiation signal in time (i.e., to the velocity of a moving object). A disadvantageous property of pyroelectric sensors is a voltage drift (pyroelectric detector is equipped with a field transistor operating as a voltage follower) which at low velocities of intruder movement can have temporal characteristics of signals, comparable with the characteristics originating from a moving person. Thus, in order that the sensor could efficiently detect slowly moving person, it is necessary to develop an algorithm distinguishing both characteristic features of signal changes from a sensor caused by a photon noise and signal changes caused by a temperature drift of a pyroelectric sensor. A simplified diagram of the electronic circuit of PIR detector is shown in Fig. 3. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
760 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Vcc R12
C2
PIR
C9
C8
U1A
C7
R6
C10
R4
C11
C14
R10
D2
R11
U3A U2A
U3B
U2B
Vout
C5
R5
SO SI SCK /CS
PWM
R9
A/D
Sunlight sensor
T1
D1
Heater
R14
U4
R15
Alarm
A/D
C6
Vcc C4
C15
R8
R7
C3
D3
C13
C12
R3
R2
9÷24V
DC/DC
Microprocessor
R1
C1
6,2V
Voltage Stabilizer
R13
A/D
D D
T2
RS485
U5
Temperature sensor
Figure 3:
Simplified diagram of electronic circuit of PIR detector (one channel).
A system of DC amplifier with regulation (by means of digital electronic potentiometers) of a level of a constant component consists of three operation amplifiers. The first U1A amplifier, because of significant output resistance of a pyroelectric sensor operates in a follower system and two consecutive ones in the systems reversing a signal phase. The first stage of amplification is realized by the operation amplifier U3A. It is characterized with the signal amplification, K1= - R4/R3. At its „+” input, a reference voltage is applied obtained from the resistance divider R5, R6, U2A (digital potentiometer) included between the supply voltage and the system ground. Reference voltage (regulated by means of a digital electronic potentiometer) is used for elimination of a constant component of a signal obtained from a pyroelectric sensor. This component is significantly changed together with temperature changes occurring near a pyroelectric sensor (because of a change of the output current change of a field transistor dependent on temperature). Next, the signal is delivered to the second amplifying stage of the U3B operation amplifier the amplification of which is K = - R8/R7. At its “+” input, it has the reference voltage obtained from the R9, R10, U2B resistance divider (digital potentiometer). This voltage (regulated by means of a digital electronic potentiometer) protects the amplifier against saturation state. The output signal is filtered in the filter made from R11 and C6 elements. The electronic potentiometers, used in a preamplifier, are connected through a SPI series bus with a controlling processor which on the basis of the output signal values makes current adequate regulations (change in the value of potentiometer resistances) of the values of reference voltages of particular amplifying stages. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
761
Knowing the NA and NB settings (number of a selected level) of particular digital potentiometers, their total resistances RA and RB and the values of amplifications of particular K1, K2 preamplifier stages, the signal value VOUT at the amplifier output can be calculated: VOUT = VIN K 1 K 2 − U pA K 1 K 2 − U pB K 2 (1) where VIN is the input voltage of the first amplifying stage, UpA is the reference voltage of the first amplifying stage, and UpB is the reference voltage of the second amplifying stage. The values of reference voltages of particular amplifying stages for 8-bit resolution of digital potentiometers settings can be calculated from the relationship:
U pA =
N Vcc R 5 + A RA R 6 + RA + R 5 256
(2)
U pB =
N Vcc R 9 + B RB R10 + RB + R 9 256
(3)
where Vcc is the supply voltage. The UpA and UpB values are currently matched by a microprocessor ensuring adequate dynamic of the amplifier and preventing the saturation state of particular amplifying stages. If the output voltage of the amplifier will be measured and analyzed by a microprocessor, which in its operation algorithm considers the shift of levels (potentiometer settings), it can be shown that the voltage calculated (by a microprocessor) can be significantly higher than the supply voltage. It is an important virtue of this system. Application of electronic potentiometers requires initial determination of their working ranges by means of external resistors. A better solution is application of digital-analogue converters instead of potentiometers. In a sensor’s electronic system, the system for measurement of sun radiation intensity was used. The information from this system is taken into account for in the intruder detection algorithm. The data from the temperature measurement system can be used for switching-on a miniature heater system mounted inside the PIR detector housing. A small increase in detector’s interior temperature (in relation to ambient temperature) protects against water vapour deposition on optical elements (lens, concentrator mirrors, optical windows of sensors).
3
Method of signal analysis
An object in the sensor’s “observation zone” (inspection zone) is detected when a conventional detection threshold is exceeded by a signal level at the detection system output, caused by IR emitted from an object. In order to minimize the probability of false alarms, an adaptation detection threshold should be determined “following up” the changing atmospheric conditions causing changes of “thermal scene” parameters [6].
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
762 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII N
a
1
a
M i=N i N
a
M N < i < N+M i N
a
M
M
i = N+M i N M
a
K
M
N+M < i < N+M+K i N M
a M
K
K
i = N+M+K i N M
a M
K
Number of samples
Figure 4:
K i > N+M+K
i
Method of creation of “time windows” in which samples of signals from pyroelectric sensors are analyzed.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
763
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
The analysis method is based on determination of an average moving in three “time windows” of a defined length [7]. The principle of formation of “time windows” is explained in Fig. 4. The windows are marked with N, M, and K letters while N > M >> K is assumed. Signal processing is carried out in the following way. The signal from a detection set is sampled and the voltages of successive signal samples of instantaneous values ai are added. The time window is formed, containing N samples, which in each consecutive cycle “shifts” by one sample. On the basis of an arithmetic average of voltage values of the samples in the window (Fig. 5), a value of the reference voltage level ϕ i is determined
ϕi =
1 (ai −N +1 + ai −N + ... + ai ) , for i > N N
(4)
where i is the sample number which takes the values i = 1, 2, 3, ...
N N
In following cycles of analysis N window is moving for one sample
N Signal
ϕi - reference level
5
Figure 5:
15
20 30 Number of sample
35
45
i
Sampled signal from a detection channel and the reference level ϕi calculated according to Eq. (4).
In the next window M, that is in the previously formed window N and containing M samples (for i ≥ N + M ), the instantaneous values of the signal β i (Fig. 6) are determined as a difference of instantaneous values of voltages of consecutive samples of the signal and the reference level voltage ϕ i
β i = a i − ϕ i , for i ≥ N + M . For further calculations, the absolute value βi is taken as
βi = ai − ϕi , for i ≥ N + M .
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5) (6)
764 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Deviation of signal value from reference level
βi
5
Figure 6:
15
20 30 Number of sample
35
45
i
Instantaneous deviation of the signal βi from reference level calculated according to Eq. (5).
On the basis of such determined data, the instantaneous value of the detection threshold voltage D i which for i > N + M is calculated as:
Di = A
1 ( βi −M +1 + βi −M + ... + βi ) , M
(7)
where A is the coefficient considering detector design parameters. For typical solutions, the A coefficient takes the values 1÷5. For PIR detectors of several detection zones and extended operation range, the A coefficient of the higher values for the zone being near detector is taken and A of the lower values is assumed for distant zones. In order to diminish the influence of sun radiation, precipitation, and ambient temperature, the instantaneous corrected detection threshold Dki is determined:
Dki = Di ⋅ k s ⋅ kw ⋅ kt
i > N +M
(8)
where k s is the correction coefficient considering sun radiation, k w is the correction coefficient of precipitation influence, and k t is the correction coefficient of ambient temperature. The correction coefficient k s increases the level of a detection threshold in the case of sun illumination [8–10]. The values of changes in a detection threshold were determined experimentally from investigations on the influence of sun illumination level on the increase in both object temperature and background thermal noise. Because the object is also illuminated with sun radiation, which increases its equivalent temperature, increase in a detection threshold value does not cause a decrease in a sensor range and undesirable disturbances are eliminated. The value of the k s coefficient was taken as 1÷1.5.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
765
Signal
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Figure 7:
15
20 30 Number of sample
35
45
i
Instantaneous value of the detection threshold voltage Di and the absolute values of βi signal.
The k w coefficient causes a decrease in a detection threshold in the case of precipitation in the detection zone of the PIR detector. When intensity of precipitation (rain, snow) is higher, IR is much more attenuated which results in lower radiation reaching the detector, thus the signal at its output is weaker. When keeping the same value of a detection threshold, the sensor range is smaller. The k w coefficient is just to compensate the influence of precipitation in such a way as to keep the sensor range unchanged. The value of the k w coefficient was taken in the limits 0.7÷1. In the next step, the samples in the time window K are analysed in which the parameter γ i is determined as an arithmetic average of the values of the signal samples βi :
γi =
1 ( βi −K +1 + βi −K + ... + βi ) , for i ≥ N + M + K . K
(9)
An object is detected (Fig. 8) in the analysed signal when the parameter γ i is higher than the instantaneous value of the corrected detection threshold Dki , i.e., when
γ i − Dki > 0 .
(10)
In Fig. 8, also short lasting disturbances of high amplitudes are illustrated (samples 18 and 45) which are not interpreted as object detection.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Value of parameters γ i , D ki
766 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
8 6
Detection level Dki
Detection of object γi - average value of |βi | in window K
4 2
5
Figure 8:
15
20 30 Number of sample
35
45
i
Object is detected when a value of γ i parameter exceeds a value of corrected detection threshold (in figure for samples No 26÷No 31). Channel 1 500 450 400 350 Signal
300 250 200 150 100 50 0 65
Figure 9:
4
70
75
80
85 t [s]
90
95
100
110
Signal in channel 1 of PIR detector recorded during night (ambient temperature 25ºC, velocity of human target 1 m/s, distance 140 meters).
Results of range investigations
The PIR detector is equipped with a data transmission path in the standard RS 485. For measurement results registration, special software developed for detector diagnostics was used. The software allows for signal registration from particular detection zones. In Figs. 9–11, the signals from the PIR detector are shown which were caused by a moving person in an inspection zone.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
767
Channel 1 200 180 160 140 Signal
120 100 80 60 40 20 0
Figure 10:
90
100
110
120
130 t [s]
140
150
160 170
Signal in channel 1 of PIR detector recorded during sunny day (ambient temperature 28ºC, velocity of human target 5 m/s, distance 140 meters). Channel 2 400 350 300
Signal
250 200 150 100 50 0 100
Figure 11:
150
200
250
300 t [s]
350
400
450
500
Signal in channel 2 of the PIR detector (ambient temperature 26ºC, velocity of crawling human target 0.1 m/s, distance 140 meters).
The investigation results, shown in Figs. 9–11, confirmed the proper operation of the PIR detector, in particular correctness and high efficiency of the signal processing method. Figure 10 shows that the detection threshold follows up (upper course) the thermal changes of a background which for this measurement case were caused by sun radiation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
768 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Acknowledgement This work was financially supported by the Polish Ministry of Science and Higher Education in the frame of research project No 0005/T00/2005/28.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
[6] [7] [8]
[9] [10]
ELTEC Instruments Inc.: Catalogue of firm products, P.O. Box 9610, Central Business Park, Daytona Beach, Florida 32120-9610, USA, 1996. Madura H., Sikorski Z., Polakowski H., Kastek M. Long-range passive IR sensor, Quantitative Infrared Thermography 5 QIRT’2000, Reims, France, 18-21.07.2000. Kastek M.: Method of objects detection in IR system of elongated detection zone. Doctors Thesis, Warsaw, The Military University of Technology Library, 2002 (in Polish). Madura H., Sikorski Z., Polakowski H., Kastek M. Automated stand for measurement of parameters of long-range passive IR sensor. Quantitative Infrared Thermography, Reims France, pp. 118-121, 2000. Kastek M., Madura H., Morawski M., Piatkowski T., Powiada E., Polakowski H. Test bed for measurement of angular parameters of passive infrared sensors. Infrared Physics & Technology, Volume 49, No 3, pp. 198-201, 2007. Leach G. A single performance measure for perimeter intruder detection systems, European Conference on Security and Detection, Conference Publication No 437, pp. 114-119. 28-30.04. 1997. Madura H., Kastek M., Powiada E. Method of objects detection by means of IR sensors, Polish Patent Office, Patent Application P-360064, Warsaw 2003 (in Polish). Polakowski H., Piątkowski T., Madura H., Kastek M., Stojak Z., Powiada E., Chmielewski K., Kulewski R. Method of disturbances correction in IR receivers, Polish Patent Office, Patent Application P-352889, Warsaw 2002, (in Polish). Madura H., Kołodziejczyk M. Influence of sun radiation on results of noncontact temperature measurements in far infrared range. Opto-Electronics Review, No 13 (3), pp. 253-257, 2005. Madura H., Piątkowski T., Powiada E. Multispectral precise pyrometer for measurement of seawater surface temperature. Infrared Physics & Technology Vol. 46 pp. 69-73, 2004.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
769
Influence of the displacement effect on compressed LFM signal parameters A. Kawalec, Cz. Leśnik, W. Komorniczak, W. Czarnecki & J. Pietrasiński Military University of Technology, Institute of Radioelectronics, Electronics Department, Warsaw, Poland
Abstract This paper deals with the digital signal processing in the application of a modern radar receiver. The influence of the signal discretization and its side effects on radar performance are considered. In particular, the paper presents the problem of the random displacement effect of LFM (linear frequency modulation) radar echo pulse beginning in accordance with the closest discrete time value. This effect has an impact on the characteristics of the pulse compression filter output signal. Its equivalence to the Doppler frequency shift has also been proven. The shift is responsible for additional, unwanted amplitude modulation of the signal samples on the output of the matched filter, as a result of the discretization process. The resulting losses of the signal level (LPG) can reach 4dB. The losses follow the function of the sampling frequency, whose relation has been developed. In addition, the displacement effect can significantly decrease the effectiveness of the MTI process. In the paper it has been shown that the influence of the displacement effect and discretization process on the relative level of the side lobes is not significant. The losses of PSL (Peak Side-lobe Level) do not exceed a fraction of dB. Characteristics evaluation of the discretization process has been performed on the basis of the proposed discrete time generation algorithm. The testing results are shown, as well as a discussion and some practical conclusions. Keywords: signal processing, linear frequency modulation, radar signal, ambiguity function, signal discretization.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070751
770 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The time representation of the signal at the matched filter output can be drawn from Woodward’s general definition of the radar ambiguity function: χ(τ, f D ) =
where:
u (t )
∞
∫ u (t )u * (t − τ )e
j 2π fD t
dt
−∞
,
(1)
-
signal complex envelope, u * (t ) complex conjugate of u (t ) , fD Doppler frequency shift, τ relative time shift (related to time of maximum output signal). During further consideration the radar ambiguity function modulus χ(τ, f D ) will be taken into account. The most popular type of radar signal is a pulse with inner linear frequency modulation (LFM). Its normalized time representation is as follows [1,2]: s (t ) =
µt2 t rect cos ω0 t + 2 T T ,
1
(2)
where: T ω0
- pulse duration, - carrier pulsation,
[
]
2 πB rad/s 2 , T B - total frequency deviation, t rect - uniform rectangular pulse: T
µ
- frequency slope, µ = ±
T T t 1 for − < t < rect = 2 2 T 0 for other t
.
The complex signal envelope of (2) is represented by: t u (t ) = rect T T 1
j e
µ t2 2
.
(3)
From (1) and (3) the equation describing the modulus of the LFM signal ambiguity function can be drawn [2]: WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
τ χ(τ, f D ) = rect 2T
τ τ T 1 − Sa (2πf D + µτ)1 − , T T2
771 (4)
where: sin x for x ≠ 0 Sa (x ) = x 1 for x = 0 An expression (4) shows that a frequency axis position of the signal maximum at the matched filter output depends on Doppler frequency shift along with a modulation described by the function: (1 − τ T ) . LPG [dB]
0.0
-10.0 BT=50 BT=100 BT=200 BT=400
-20.0
-30.0
-40.0 -1.00
-0.50
0.00
0.50
1.00
fD / B
a. PSL [dB]
-3.0 BT=50 BT=100 BT=200 BT=400
-6.0
-9.0
-12.0
-15.0 -1.00
-0.50
0.00
0.50
b. Figure 1:
1.00
fD / B
LPG (a.) and PSL (b.) values as a function of relative Doppler frequency shift.
Two of the most common matched filter output signal characteristics are as follows: LPG (Loss in Process Gain, the level of the mainlobe in no-match case U ML related to its maximum value in the perfect match case U MLmx ) and PSL (Peak Sidelobe Level, relative level of the maximum sidelobe U SL related to the maximum of the mainlobe U ML ):
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
772 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII LPG = 20 log
U ML U MLmx
, PSL = 20 log
U SL
.
U ML
The LPG and PSL parameters as a function of the Doppler shift normalized to the deviation are derived according to equation (4). The characteristics for selected values of time-bandwidth product BT are presented on Fig. 1 [4]. Minimum sidelobe level for zero Doppler shift is not a constant value, but it depends on time-bandwidth product BT. PSL parameter value fluctuations for low real (met in practice) values of Doppler frequency shift are presented on Fig. 2. PSL [dB] -13.0
-13.2 BT=50 BT=100 BT=200 BT=400
-13.4
-13.6 -0.10
-0.05
0.00
0.05
0.10
fD / B
Figure 2:
PSL values as a function of small values of relative Doppler frequency shift. PSL [dB]
-13.0
-13.2
-13.4
-13.6
-13.8
-14.0 0
200
400
600
800
1000
BT
Figure 3:
Minimum PSL as a function of time-bandwidth product.
Sidelobe minimum level can be found as a result of looking for the second extreme of the function described by the expression (4) under assumption that f D = 0 . Precise solution leads to very complicated expressions. That is why it is interesting to find the solution using numerical methods. Results of the calculations are shown on Fig. 3.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
773
Radar signal discretization
In the contemporary radar systems, the received echo signal is converted from its native analogue form to the digital representation. The conversion process is repeated with a sampling clock period t s . The same period characterizes the set of samples which forms the response of the matched filter used for signal matched filtering. In the perfect condition the beginning of the echo signal overlaps with the sampling period beginning of the analogue-digital converter. In the general case, due to the random position of the detected object (relating to radar location), those two time moments do not overlap. The first signal sample is delayed from the beginning of the signal of the time t j , which is shorter than t s . The problem is illustrated on Fig. 4. The mentioned phenomenon is called a displacement effect. s(t)
without displacement
with displacement effect
t ts
tj
ts
tj
f(t) fk´ fk
fp´ fp
Figure 4:
t tj
The displacement effect phenomenon.
The time shift fulfils the rule t j ∈ 〈 0, t s ) . In the case of LFM signal, the temporary signal frequency is a linear function of time. In the idealized case the first and last sample of the received echo signal correspond to the values of initial f p and final f k frequency. In reality the first and last sample corresponds to the other initial f p' and final f k' frequency. As a result the frequency relations are going to be as on Fig. 5. The displacement effect results are equivalent to the Doppler frequency shift whose maximum value is given by: µ ∆f mx = ts 2π . (5) According to equation (5), evaluation of the influence of the discretization process and displacement effect on the after compression signal characteristics can be reduced to examination of the Doppler frequency shift.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
774 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The carrier frequency shift of the LFM signal causes changes of both the main signal lobe level at the matched filter output and the signal location on the time axis. It is shown on the Fig. 6. For simplification, presented signals are limited only to the first sidelobe pair. f (t) fk´
displacement effe
fk f0´
∆f = f0
µ tj 2π
fp´ without displacement effect
t
fp
T
T /2
Figure 5:
Temporary frequency in the cases of the lack and presence of the displacement effect. |χ (τ, fDi)| 1
|χ (τ, 0)|
(1 + τ/T) |χ (τ, fD1)|
|χ (τ, -fD1)| (1- τ/T) τ 0
-T
Figure 6:
T
The output of the matched filter for chosen Doppler frequency shift values vs. time.
The time shift value can be found as an abscissa of the max of the function described by equation (4) for the constant f D value. Assuming f d = ∆f and t s << T the problem can be simplified to looking for the τ mx value when the Sa[] function argument equals zero. Than
(2π∆f
τ + µτ mx )1 − mx T
T µ = t j + τ mx (T − τ mx ) = 0 . 2 2
(
)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
775
Finally one can conclude that the signal max time shift at the matched filter output caused by an effect mentioned above is described by an equation as follows τ mx = −t j
and in an extreme case it can reach its max value described as follows τ mx = −t s . The minus sign means that the frequency shift caused by the discussed effect relates to a situation in which the Doppler frequency shift is an effect of a radial motion of a target towards a radar. As a result of the discretization process, the amplitude of the maximum mainlobe sample will deviate not only because of not being matched, but also in relation to the sampling clock (Fig. 7). |χ (τ/ts , ∆fi)|
µ ∆f1= 2π 0.5ts
|χ (τ/ts , 0)|
µ ∆f2= 2π ts
τ ts -3.0
Figure 7:
-2.0
-1.0
-0.5
0
1.0
2.0
The influence of fluctuations on the samples amplitude after discretization.
The maximum loss concerning the mainlobe will be approximately t j = t s 2 . The amount of the loss is a function of the sampling period and it decreases with the sampling frequency increase. The maximum frequency, resulting from the Nyquist criterion, for the base band LFM signal is roughly equal to its frequency deviation B.
3
Testing results
The simulation model including the discretization process and displacement effect has been developed in order to evaluate the quantitative changes of the signal parameters on the output of the matched filter. As a result a series of characteristics have been obtained. The parameter LPGd (for discrete time domain, for fixed time-bandwidth product BT and several relative values of sampling frequency) as a function of t j is presented on Fig. 8. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
776 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The value of t j is normalized to the maximum sampling period t smx according to the Nyquist criterion. The figure also shows a characteristic of LPGc (continuous time domain) as a function of mean frequency of the signal in the time range corresponding to t j . The losses of the output signal can reach as much as 4 dB. In practice for sampling frequencies up to 2B mentioned losses are still significant (about 1 dB). LPG [dB]
0.0
-1.0
-2.0 BT=const=100 LPGc LPGd, fs=4B LPGd, fs=2B LPGd, fs=B
-3.0
-4.0 0.00
0.25
0.50
0.75
1.00
t j / tsmx
Figure 8:
The relative level of the signal at the output of the matched filter as a function of tj and sampling frequency.
The lack of sensitivity of the parameter LPG in relation to the signal base for several constant values of the sampling frequency is shown on Fig. 9. Presented characteristics demonstrate that there is no relation between the loss of the signal level as result of the displacement effect and the signal base. The changes in the level of maxima of the mainlobe U ML and sidelobes U SL after discretization are a result of the displacement effect at the matched filter output (Fig. 10). The presented characteristics are normalized to maximum values of the main and sidelobes for the continuous time domain and by no frequency shift. LPG [dB]
0.0
-1.0
∆LPG -2.0 fs=const=B LPGc LPGd, BT=200 LPGd, BT=100 LPGd, BT=50
-3.0
-4.0 0.000
0.005
0.010
0.015
0.020
tj / T
Figure 9:
The relative level of the signal at the output of the matched filter as a function of tj and the signal base.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
777
UML , U SL, [dB] 0.00 -0.05 -0.10 BT=100, fs=4B main lobe peak sidelobe
-0.15 -0.20 -0.25 0.00
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
t j / tsmx
Figure 10:
The maximum of the main and side lobes after discretization as a function of relative tj.
Mentioned dependency results in the changes of the relative level of the sidelobes PSLd . It is shown for two various values of the sampling frequency (Fig. 11). The figure also presents the PSLc parameter for continuous time domain in the range corresponding to the maximum value of t j . Presented characteristics clearly show that the expected increment in the relative sidelobes level is not significant and does not exceed 0,1 dB. Moreover, for some values of t j there is an improvement related to the level of the sidelobes, dependent on sampling frequency, and it exceeds 1 dB. PSL [dB] -13.4
-13.8
BT=const=100 PSLc PSLd, fs=4B PSLd, fs=2B
-14.2
-14.6
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
t j / t smx
Figure 11:
4
The relative level of the side lobes as a function of relative value of tj and the sampling frequency.
Summary
The paper presents the influence of discretization process on the LFM radar echo signal. The displacement effect between a pulse beginning and a closest time discrete value is examined. The equivalence of both displacement effect and Doppler frequency shift was proved. The frequency shift is responsible for additional, unwanted amplitude modulation of the signal samples at the matched WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
778 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII filter output, as a result of the discretization process. The losses of the signal level (LPG) can reach 4dB. The losses follow the function of the sampling frequency whose relation has been derived. In addition, the displacement effect can decrease the effectiveness of the MTI process. In the paper it has been shown that the influence of the displacement effect and discretization process on the relative level of the sidelobes is not significant. The losses of PSL do not exceed a fraction of dB.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
Cook C.E., Bernfeld M.: Radar Signals: An Introduction to Theory and Application. Artech House, Norwood, MA, 1993. Levanon N., Mozeson E.: Radar Signals. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey, USA, 2004. Peebles P.Z., Jr.: Radar Principles. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, USA, 1998. Kawalec A., Komorniczak W., Leśnik Cz., Pietrasiński J.: Discretization Process Impact on Compressed LFM Signal Parameters. Conference Proceedings, MIKON-2006, XVI International Conference on Microwaves, Radar and Wireless Communications, Poland, Kraków, May 22-26, 2006, vol. 3, pp. 1184-1187.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
779
A comparison of estimation accuracy by the use of KF, EKF & UKF filters S. Konatowski & A. T. Pieniężny Department of Electronics, Military University of Technology, Poland
Abstract This paper considers the problem of applying the Kalman filters to nonlinear systems. The Kalman filter (KF) is an optimal linear estimator when the process noise and the measurement noise can be modeled by white Gaussian noise. The KF only utilizes the first two moments of the state (mean and covariance) in its update rule. In situations when the problems are nonlinear or the noise that distorts the signals is non-Gaussian, the Kalman filters provide a solution that may be far from optimal. Nonlinear problems can be solved with the extended Kalman filter (EKF). This filter is based upon the principle of linearization of the state transition matrix and the observation matrix with Taylor series expansions. Exploiting the assumption that all transformations are quasi-linear, the EKF simply makes linear all nonlinear transformations and substitutes Jacobian matrices for the linear transformations in the KF equations. The linearization can lead to poor performance and divergence of the filter for highly non-linear problems. An improvement to the extended Kalman filter is the unscented Kalman filter (UKF). The UKF approximates the probability density resulting from the nonlinear transformation of a random variable. It is done by evaluating the nonlinear function with a minimal set of carefully chosen sample points. The posterior mean and covariance estimated from the sample points are accurate to the second order for any nonlinearity. The paper presents a comparison of the estimation quality for two nonlinear measurement models of the following Kalman filters: covariance filter (KF), extended filter (EKF) and unscented filter (UKF). Keywords: nonlinear model, discrete Kalman filter, extended Kalman filter, unscented Kalman filter, integrated navigation system.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070761
780 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The classical Kalman filter is used for linear dynamic systems [1] moreover extended Kalman filter EKF for nonlinear systems [1, 3] or unscented Kalman filter UKF [2, 4–8]. Unscented Kalman filter with comparison to EKF is not based on linear model but operates on the statistical parameters of the measurement and state vectors that are subsequently nonlinearly transformed. The unscented Kalman filter is based on the unscented transform (UT). Kalman filtration [1, 3] is based on the following models of state and measurement vectors respectively: x ( k + 1) = f x ( k ) , u ( k ) , w ( k ) z ( k + 1) = h x ( k ) , v ( k )
for w ( k ) ~ N 0, Q ( k ) , for v ( k ) ~ N 0, R ( k ) .
(1)
Vector x(k) is n-dimensional state vector in the moment k, z(k) is p-dimensional measurement vector in the moment k, f(x, u, w) denotes nonlinear state function describing dynamic behavior of the system between k+1 and k moments, u is the input system vector, w is the noise state vector, Q is the covariance matrix of the noise state (denotes uncertainty in the dynamic model during transition from k+1 to k moments, h(x, v) denotes nonlinear measurement function, v p-dimensional vector of measurement noise, R is covariance matrix of measurement errors with dimensions p×p, P is covariance matrix of state vector with dimensions n×n.
2
Object dynamics and measurement models
In this paper process model is described by state vector in the following form: T
x = p x p y p z v x v y vz ,
v p
(2)
where p is three-dimensional position vector (in Cartesian coordinates). Vector v is three-dimensional speed vector. State matrix has the form: I F = 3×3 03×3
∆tI 3×3 , I 3×3
(3)
where ∆t is the time step between moments k and k+1, I is identity matrix. In this case the state vector (2) and state matrix (3) are identical for covariance filter (KF), extended filter (EKF) and unscented filter (UKF). 2.1 System with constant velocity The object moves with constant velocity (acceleration is zero). Velocity components (vx, y, z) are additive Gaussian noise. Fig.1 presents analyzed model in the graphic form. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII z
781
Object (px, py, pz ) r
φ θ Observer
x
y
Figure 1:
Positioning principle.
The measured parameters in the measurement model are: r – distance from object to observer (radar), θ – azimuth, φ – elevation. Dependency between object position in the Cartesian coordinates and measurements in spherical coordinates is described by nonlinear function. Thus the measurement vector is given by:
(
)
T
z = px2 + p y2 + pz2 arctan ( p y px ) arccos pz px2 + p y2 + pz2 .
r ϕ θ
(4)
Measurement matrix for discrete and unscented filters is given by: H = [ I 3×3
03×3 ] .
(5)
The vector function h(*) has the following form: h = [r θ ϕ ] . T
(6)
In the case of extended filter, linearization of the measurement function h for each measurement step by the use of partial derivative relatively to all elements of state vector should be made. The final measurement matrix for extended Kalman filter is as follows: ∂h H= ∂x
x = x( k )
= p y r2
px r
(r
2
−p
2 z
)
py r
px
r −p
−p
2 z
2 z
r
2
r −p 2
pz r
)
0 − r −p 2
p y pz
p x pz 2
(r
2
r2
2 z
2 z
0 0 0 0 0 0 , 0 0 0
(7)
where Cartesian object coordinates are given by: px = r cos θ sin ϕ ,
p y = r sin θ cos ϕ
,
pz = r cos ϕ .
2.2 System with complex movement As an example of complex dynamics, the object movement around z axis is presented. This situation causes nonlinear relationships both in state and measurement matrix. Figure 2 in detail illustrates considered object. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
782 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
Positioning principle.
One can see that a nonlinear relation exists between measurements from the system and elements of the motion: tan θ = vx v y ,
vx = vob sin θ ,
v y = vob cos θ ,
vob = vx2 + v y2 .
(8)
In the presented system initial values of vector state are described by the followings: x(0) = [ rob
0 hob
0 vob
0] . T
(9)
Nonlinear state functions (in the moment k) are defined as follows: rob cos arctan ( p y px ) + ω ( k ) ∆t f1 f rob sin arctan ( p y px ) + ω ( k ) ∆t 2 f3 p z ( k ) + v z ( k ) ∆t , f (k ) = = f 4 vob sin arctan ( p y px ) + ω ( k ) ∆t f 5 vob cos arctan ( p y px ) + ω ( k ) ∆t f 6 v k ( ) z
(10)
where the azimuth and the angular velocity of the object can be calculated via the following formulas:
θ ( k + 1) = θ ( k ) + ω ( k ) ∆t ,
ω ( k ) = vob ( k ) rob ( k ) for rob = px2 + p y2 . (11)
This nonlinear equation requires linearization, which in extended Kalman filter is performed around the estimated object’s trajectory. For the EKF state matrix has been calculated as a matrix of derivatives of nonlinear f(*) function with respect to the components of the state vector x. F = ∂f ∂x ,
where:
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(12)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
py v ∆tp p ∂f1 = x cos γ + rob ob 3 x + 2 sin γ px β ∂px rob rob py vob ∆tp y ∂f1 1 = − cos γ + rob sin γ 3 px β ∂p y rob rob ∂f1 ∂f1 ∆tvx ∂f1 ∆tv y = 0, = sin γ , sin γ , = ∂v y vob ∂pz ∂vx vob
py p v ∆tp ∂f 2 = x sin γ − rob 2 + ob 3 x ∂px rob β p rob x
783
, , ∂f1 =0, ∂vz
cos γ ,
py vob ∆tp y 1 ∂f 2 sin γ + rob = − cos γ , ∂p y rob rob3 px β ∂f 2 ∆tvx ∂f 2 ∂f 2 ∂f 2 ∆tv y cos γ , cos γ , =0, = = 0, = ∂v y vob ∂vz vob ∂vx ∂pz ∂f 3 ∂f 3 ∂f3 ∂f 3 ∂f 3 ∂f3 =0, =0, =1, =0, = 0, = ∆t , ∂v y ∂p y ∂pz ∂vx ∂px ∂vz vob ∆tp y 1 py v ∆tp ∂f 4 ∂f 4 = vob − = vob − 2 − ob 3 x cos γ , cos γ , ∂p y ∂px rob3 rob px β px β ∂f 4 ∂f 4 ( rob sin γ + vob ∆t cos γ ) = 0, = vx , ∂pz ∂vx rob vob ∂f 4 ∂f 4 ( rob sin γ + vob ∆t cos γ ) =0, = vy , ∂v y rob vob ∂vz
vob ∆tp y py ∂f5 ∂f 5 v ∆tp 1 = vob − = vob 2 + ob 3 x sin γ , cos γ , 3 ∂p y ∂px rob px β rob px β ∂f5 ( rob cos γ − vob ∆t sin γ ) ∂f5 = vx , = 0, ∂vx rob vob ∂pz ∂f 5 ∂f 5 ( rob cos γ − vob ∆t sin γ ) =0, = vy , ∂v y rob vob ∂vz
∂f 6 ∂f 6 ∂f 6 ∂f 6 ∂f 6 ∂f 6 =0, =0, = 0, =0, = 0, =1, ∂p y ∂v y ∂px ∂pz ∂vx ∂vz
for: γ = arctan ( p y px ) + ∆t vob rob , β = 1 + p y2 px2 . For discrete and unscented Kalman filter state matrix has a form given by (3). An observation matrix H in the measurement model is identical as in the first model (11).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
784 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Simulation results
The accuracy comparisons have been examined by the use of simulation in the Matlab environment. In order to ensure the same conditions, research of filters were realized with identical form of state vector covariance matrix Q, measurement vector R and initial state vector covariance matrix P(0) in both systems. Similarly to Julier et al [4] the following parameters of unscented transform have been assumed: λ = 3, β = 1, κ = 3. Furthermore the following values of noise covariance matrix have been applied: diag [ 0.0225 m 2 ]3x3 Q= 03x3
, diag [ 0.49 m s ]3x3
(13)
0.16 deg 2 ,
(14)
03x3
2 −2
covariance matrix of measurement noise: R = diag 0.7225 m 2
0.16 deg 2
initial covariance matrix of vector state errors: diag [1 m 2 ]3x3 P (0) = 03x3
.
03x3
diag [1 m 2 s −2 ]3x3
(15)
3.1 Examination of a system with constant velocity Examination results are presented for covariance filter (DKF – green line), extended filter (EKF – red line) and for unscented filter (UKF – blue line). The examinations results include values of mean square error (mse) of estimated state vector: mse *KF =
( xˆ − x real ) ( xˆ − x real ) T
n,
(16)
and covariance error P, according to Kalman filtering theory, estimated component of state vector x (Fig. 3–5): cov *KF = P ( k + 1) = F ( k ) P ( k ) F ( k ) + Q ( k ) . T
(17)
Mean square error and covariance error of speed components (Fig. 6–8) has also been done. 3.2 Examination of a system with complex movement The system examination conditions are the same as for system with constant velocity. Results for covariance filter DKF, extended filter EKF and unscented filter UKF are presented. They include values of mse error of estimated state vector and covariance error estimated components of the position (Fig. 9–11) and values of mse error and covariance error of speed components (Fig. 12–14).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
785
Figure 3: Mean square error of the estimated component px and covariance error Ppx of the position.
Figure 4:
Mean square error of the estimated component py and covariance error Ppy of the position.
Figure 5: Mean square error of the estimated component pz and covariance error Ppz of the position.
Figure 6:
Mean square error of and estimated vx covariance error Pvx of speed component
Figure 7: Mean square error of estimated vy and covariance error Pvy of speed component.
Figure 8:
Mean square error of and estimated vz covariance error Pvz of speed component.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
786 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 9: Mean square error of the estimated component px and covariance error Ppx of the position.
Figure 10: Mean square error of the estimated component py and covariance error Ppy of the position.
Figure 11:
Mean square error of the estimated component pz and covariance error Ppz of the position
Figure 12:
Mean square error of and estimated vx covariance error Pvx of speed component.
Figure 13:
Mean square error of and estimated vy covariance error Pvy of speed component.
Figure 14:
Mean square error of and estimated vz covariance error Pvz of speed component.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
787
The estimation of object speed in the Cartesian coordinates (Fig. 15-17) and determination of mean square error and covariance error of speed components (Figs. 18–20) has also been done.
Figure 15:
Estimated component.
vx
speed
Figure 16:
Estimated vy component.
Figure 17:
Estimated component.
vz
speed
Figure 18:
Mean square error of and estimated vx covariance error Pvx of speed component.
Figure 19:
Mean square error of estimated vy and covariance error Pvy of speed component.
Figure 20:
Mean square error of and estimated vz covariance error Pvz of speed component.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
speed
788 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3.3 Analysis of simulation results For nonlinear measurement model extended and unscented filters estimate the object position nearly identically. Discrete Kalman filter is becoming nonoptimal filter in the sense of minimizing the mean square error. When the mean square error is included within the area determined by the covariance error of the estimated vector state then filter is performing correctly. Last principle is satisfied for extended and unscented Kalman filters but not for DKF. During speed estimation one can see, that difference between extended and unscented filters is minimal. UKF gives smaller errors what results from nature of speed components, which are band-limited Gaussian processes. The bigger are the jumps of noise values the worse of extended Kalman filter performance is.
4
Conclusions
Results of estimation using Discrete and Extended and Unscented Kalman Filter for system with constant velocity and for system with complex movement show that Unscented Kalman Filter operating as algorithm of data processing in system with nonlinear dynamics guarantees the best quality. Nonlinear transform makes Discrete Kalman Filter not to be optimal in sense of minimum mean square error. Loss stabilization in EKF is possible for long measurement steps whereas decreasing of measurement steps enlarges computational costs as a result of complicated calculations of Jacobians. UKF algorithm does not require calculation of Jacobians which simplifies its complexity. The Unscented Kalman Filter provides effective estimation in case of strongly nonlinear models what recommends its use in practice.
References [1] [2] [3] [4]
[5]
Brown R.G., Hwang P.Y.C.: Introduction to Random Signals and Applied Kalman Filtering with MATLAB Exercises and Solutions. John Wiley & Sons, Canada, 1997. Gordon N.J., Ristic B., Arulampalam S.: Beyond the Kalman Filter – Particle Filters for Tracking Applications. Artech House, London, 2004. Grewal M.S., Andrews A.P: Kalman filtering Theory and Practice Using MATLAB. John Wiley & Sons, Canada, 2001. Julier S.J., Uhlmann J.K., Durrant-Whyte H.F.: A New Method for the Nonlinear Transformation of Means and Covariances in Filters and Estimators. IEEE Transactions on Automatic Control, vol. 45, no. 3, March 2000, pp. 477-482. van der Merwe R., Wan E.A.: The Square-root Unscented Kalman Filter for State and Parameter-estimation. Proceedings of International Conference on Acoustics, Speech, and Signal Processing, vol. 6, Salt Lake City, May 2001, pp. 3461-3464.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[6] [7] [8]
789
van der Merwe R., Wan E.A.: The Unscented Kalman Filter. Department of Electrical and Computer Engineering, Oregon Graduate Institute of Science and Technology, Beaverton, Oregon, 2001. Wan E.A., van der Merwe R.: The Unscented Kalman Filter to appear in Kalman Filtering and Neural Networks. Chapter 7. Edited by Simon Haykin, John Wiley & Sons, USA, 2001. Wan E.A., van der Merwe R.: The Unscented Kalman Filter for Nonlinear Estimation. Proc. IEEE Symp. Adaptive Systems for Signal Proc., Communication and Control (AS-SPCC), Lake Louise, Alberta, Canada, October 2000, pp. 153-158.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
791
Novel method for watermarking system operating on the HF and VHF radio links Z. Piotrowski & P. Gajewski Electronics Faculty, Military University of Technology, Poland
Abstract Modern watermarking systems operating on an acoustic layer of the host signal must meet a lot of constructional requirements. One of these requirements is watermark perceptual transparency at host signal presence and robustness to intentional and unintentional attacks. Developed systems also possess a dedicated bit rate for the steganographic mode or a data payload for the watermarking mode. The system presented in this paper relates to the watermarking systems class with blind detection procedure and operates on the host speech signal transmitted over HF/VHF radio links. System innovation consists of using the OFDM and SSDS techniques as well as a drift phase scanner on the receiver’s side. The system was developed for radio correspondent authorisation using HF/VHF radio links. Keywords: watermarking, steganography, information hiding, phase drift scanner, radio HF/VHF link, OFDM signal, Spread Spectrum Direct Sequence, coherent averaging, synchronization.
1
Introduction
The radio correspondent authorization problem in the HF/VHF links is very important for the reason that the degraded and distorted speaker’s recognition signal is basic authorisation element for the radio end-user. Authorisation is carried out “by ear” in a subjective manner, e.g. radio operator, using radio handset, assesses that his/her interlocutor possesses characteristic speech features and qualifies recognised speech to dedicated person. It is typical that after “short, subjective authorisation” the radio speech correspondence takes place usually using secret messages not accessible for third party users or outsiders. The subjective authorisation problem is more complicated when we take into WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070771
792 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII consideration the abilities of the modern vocoders technique: real time speech analysis and synthesis using vocal tract and pitch signal dedicated for one speaker and transformed to another one using the same speech features: tone quality, timbre, intonation, pitch, vocal tract parameters distribution etc. Synthesized speech quality and fidelity as well as intelligibility is ‘almost the same’ for the radio link end-user has good hearing (Human Auditory System with normal sensitivity). The radio correspondent authorization process so far, is based on open, public mechanisms of the ad hoc query and transient response using standard LCD radio display to indicate authorisation process. The authorisation data stream allocated into standard radio protocol frames (blocks) allows for effective transmission of the query-response block sentences using a dedicated radio and terminal developed and proposed by a producer. The mechanism of the hidden authorization of the radio correspondent presented in this paper is free from following disadvantages: - open, public query and response (authorization status displayed on LCD, signalling using buzzer etc.) - authorisation protocol defined by a producer - authorisation process not standardized for all telecommunication equipment, dedicated equipment only (radio model etc.) In the proposed system, the authorisation process takes place during the radio call at the host speech signal background. The system does not interfere either in the hardware or software radio station. The speech signal processed in the software watermark coder is passed to the radio station’s input (standard handset socket). The input speech signal is processed - this means that the binary correspondent’s Personal Identification Number represented by the binary signature is mapped in the frequency domain and a psychoacoustic corrected watermark is embedded into the host speech signal). The watermark in the host speech signal presence is perceptually transparent for the Human Auditory System (HAS).
2
Watermarking system
The developed system consists of a software watermark coder (embedder) and a decoder (extractor). Implementation was carried out in the Matlab scientific programming environment. The system process speech signal has a sampling frequency fs=48kHz and resolution 16 bits/sample. A two-way impedance commutator is used on the transmitters as well as the receiver’s side to switch over radio simplex mode: transmitting or receiving. Watermark embedding and extracting uses the off-line mode (not real-time processing). 2.1 Watermark embedding A basic block scheme of the watermark coder is shown in fig. 1. The watermark coder consists of two modulators: OFDM as well as BPSK SSDS. The OFDM modulator generates a watermark pattern based on mapped information in accordance with the PIN binary sequence. The OFDM mapper WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
793
allocates successive bits into individual frequency bins, in this way the OFDM pass band occupies the 6th and 37th frequency bins (FFT length 512 points and fs = 48kHz):
fs fs × 6 = 562,5 Hz , and × 37 = 3468,75 Hz FFTlength FFTlength
FFT Input: host speech
frequency masking analysis
shape-level watermark equalizer
IFFT
+ Output: watermarked speech
OFDM modulator
PIN
block ordering PN sequence
Figure 1:
SS DS modulator
Basic block scheme of the watermark coder.
Watermark data payload amounts are for the base block sequence (one frame, block) 16 bits. Each successive bit is represented by orthogonally distributed spectral pair lines α i , α i +1 . Logical bit “1” is mapped based on the following
α i > α i+1 , and for logical bit “0”: α i < α i+1 . two binary values are assumed: α ∈ {0,1} . The
spectral line amplitude value rule:
In the described system only information mapper work principle for the OFDM modulator is shown in fig. 2. The quick brown fox jumps over a lazy dog
11011010101011010111110101010110101111011... Bit:
1
1
0
f [Hz] 1 2 FFT bins
Figure 2:
3
4
5
6
OFDM information mapper – work principle.
The six chosen spectral lines are considered as spectral phase “pilots” used on the receiver’s side for the output phase drift estimation Φ ∆ of the radio link. The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
794 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII SSDS signal based on the preliminary BPSK modulator is used for synchronisation of the watermark sequence. The following parameters are assumed: conversion gain SNRSSDS = 24,77 dB , spread spectrum pass band:
Bs = 3kHz . A spreading signal is generated using a pseudorandom information sequence. Depending on the assumed block data format, a system can be considered as steganographic (OFDM sequence for data block precedes by SSDS sequence block) or watermarking (each OFDM block with the same data payload in the stream). A steganographic system has a dedicated bit rate, a watermarking system is characterised by a data payload parameter (16 bits in the case of the described system). The host signal is transformed to the frequency domain and psychoacoustic processing is performed using the Mpeg1 Layer1 algorithm to compute the Just Noticeable Difference threshold level (JND) as a difference between host level and the minimal masking threshold. The parameter Signal-to-Mask Ratio (SMR) is computed, separately for each critical sub-band (logarithmic Bark scale) for the watermark spectrum range. The SMR parameter is used for the watermark correction procedure (block: shape-level watermark equalizer) to ensure watermark signal perceptual transparency at the host speech signal presence. The corrected watermark in frequency shape and level is transformed back to the time domain using IFFT and summed together with the host signal. The developed system is based on direct host signal summing with corrected watermark, unlike the system described in [1] where the mean value of the host signal’s FFT magnitudes in the dedicated sub-band is computed to add the watermark spectrum line. An example of the watermarked signal spectrum is shown in fig. 3.
Figure 3:
Example of the watermarked signal spectrum (host speech signal) and hidden (JND level) watermark.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
795
2.2 Watermark decoding The basic block scheme of the watermark decoder is shown in fig. 4. The watermark decoder consists of a synchronisation block. This block uses a SSDS demodulator. The demodulator generates the same PN binary sequence as on the transmitter side, a 2kHz carrier wave allows one to make a transformation from 500-3500Hz into the base pass band. The decoding process based on correlation analysis finds synchronisation points for correct data block bit decoding. Optional LPC analysis (carried out in synchronizer block) is useful for the effective decoding process (the decorrelation procedure generates a residual signal with small standard deviation). Buffer delay delays the start of the data blocks for the decoding process. An example of a BPSK DS signal spectrum taking part in the decoding process is shown in fig. 5. Drift Phase Scanner
FFT
Synchronizer
SS DS demodulator
Figure 4:
Phase equalizer
Spectrum bins comparator
Buffer (delay)
PN sequence
Coherent Averaging
Output: Correspondent’s PIN
PIN
Basic block scheme of the watermark decoder.
Figure 5:
BPSK SSDS signal spectrum.
The synchronisation process is optional and useful only in the steganographic system case. The main goal of the projected algorithm is a watermarking system based on a drift phase scanner, a phase angle correction and a coherent averaging process. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
796 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The drift phase scanner method was developed and described in detail in the PhD dissertation [2] and then published in [3]. The decoded signal has ultimate frequency detuning (phase drift) caused by phase drift A/C and C/A converters’ (clock short-term stability) as well as output small stability heterodyne devices’ (in transceiver radios). Spectrum coherention as a key requirement for proper spectrum averaging must be met to decrease host speech signal standard deviation and receive proper coherent gain: SNRcoh = 10 ⋅ log10 (M ) (dB) (1) where: M - iterations number (signal block averaging) Example: signal duration equals 10 second, fs=48kHz and data block 512 samples gives: SNRcoh = 19,72 (dB). This result means that the watermark signal “hidden” under the host speech signal at value SMR < SNRcoh is still possible to be correctly detected, of course, if coherence is met. Spectrum averaging is based on the formula (2) for the chosen n spectral line: N
FFTcoh (n ) =
Figure 6:
∑ Re{FFTi (n )} i =1
N
N
+j
∑ Im{FFTi (n )} i =1
(2)
N
Example of searching radio link drift phase, result: rad/block.
φ=
-8.57e-4
The final result as a module for a complex number has a maximum value only in the case when the coherence requirement is met:
γ max = abs(FFTcoh (n )) WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
797
which means even a small drift value of the phase angle for dedicated spectral line during spectrum averaging will decrease the module value γ . The drift phase scanner searches the all angle range < −φ , φ > (limited for predicted output drift values and desired method resolution) to find the maximum value γ max . The searching process is based on virtual module computation. The virtual module is considered as a sum of modules for “pilots” spectral lines and is divided onto two stages: rough and precise searching (fig. 6, fig. 7). The output drift phase value found in the drift scanner is a base parameter in the block: phase equalizer. After the phase equalization process (phase value correction) the signal spectrum is averaged and spectrum bins are pairs’ compared to find the output PIN binary sequence. The watermarked host speech spectrum after coherent averaging after drift equalisation is shown in fig. 8. Input PIN signature on the transmitter side: [1111111111111111]. OFDM information mapper allocated energy to the frequency bins numbers: 7-38 (with DC component) in the following sequence: [10101010101010101010101010101010]. The PIN signature was decoded on the receiver’s side with 0 errors using spectrum lines comparator.
a)
b) Figure 7:
“Pilots” spectral lines before a) and after b) drift correction procedure Im-Re plots.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
798 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 8:
3
Watermarked host spectrum after coherent averaging.
Experimental results
Experiment number 1 was dedicated for perceptual transparency assessment and based on standard ITU-R BS 1116-1 subjective fidelity test. The full procedure and the environmental conditions that were required to be met were described in detail in [4]. Results for subjective assessment by listeners are shown in fig. 9. 1,00
0,00 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
SDG
-1,00
-2,00 -3,00
-4,00 track number
Figure 9:
ITU-R BS 1116-1 results for 10 tracks.
Subjective fidelity assessment was done for 10 (male/female) speech tracks with an embedded watermark and degraded by HF/VHF noise. These tracks were compared with host speech tracks degraded also by HF/VHF noise. Every measurement point was characterized by 15 listeners with normal hearing (based on preliminary audiogram tests). Measurement results were taking into a statistical estimation procedure with a 95% confidence level. A SGD score above -1 SDG value shows that the embedded watermark is completely transparent at the host speech signal presence. A SDG positive score shows listeners better assessed the fidelity watermarked speech signal in comparison with the host speech signal. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
799
Experiment number 2 was dedicated for estimating of the decoding data payload efficiency. The computer simulated model of the HF/VHF radio channel degraded watermarked signal as well as the simulation of the radio simplex mode was taken into account. The result of the radio simplex mode simulation for the output received signal is a set of short signal fragments with various durations. These signal fragments are decoded separately (averaging complex spectrum and modules computation) and finally summed, as shown in table 1. Experiment number 3 was dedicated for estimation of the decoding data payload efficiency in the real radio channel using a standard FM/AM modulator and a standard radio FM/AM receiver. The modulated watermarked signal (duration: 10 second) was transmitted over the radio channel and demodulated on the receiver’s side and decoded correctly in PC software (0 errors / 16 bits correct decoded). Table 1:
PIN decoding efficiency with simulation of the radio simplex mode and HF/VHF channel. SNR* (dB)
0.877 0.93 0.922 1.181 1.256 0.934 2.034 1.187
Track Avg RMS Power (dB) -20.4 -22.87 -22.65 -29.34 -23.68 -24.97 -47.44 -24.38
1.92 5.46 6.54 4.30 6.59 6.02 2.76 9.25
Decoder error / total 4/16 3/16 5/16 4/16 3/16 5/16 7/16 1/16
9.321
-24.77
5.64
1/16
Duration (s)
Track Track - part 01 Track - part 02 Track - part 03 Track - part 04 Track - part 05 Track - part 06 Track - part 07 Track - part 08
∑ abs(Re+ j Im)
01−08
Track 10 -25.99 11.27 0/16 SNR* - denotes: power of the spectral line “1” to power of the spectral line “0” ratio. Assumption: logical bit “1” is pair spectral lines mapped as a sequence “1” and “0”, logical bit “0” is pair spectral line mapped as a sequence “0” and “1”.
4
Conclusions
The proposed system proved the usefulness of the computer simulated HF/VHF radio link as well as of the preliminary radio link tests with FM/AM modulation. Watermark perceptual transparency at the host speech signal presence was confirmed in the experiment number 1 using subjective fidelity test ITU-R BS 1116-1. The watermark binary signature (PIN) is decoded correctly depending on the signal track’s duration time and SMR value. Tracks with duration time of 10 seconds were decoded with 1 error in experiment number 2 (computer simulation), and 0 error in experiment number 3 (radio link). The steganographic system mode is used when the SSDS signal is embedded into the host signal. The WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
800 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII phase drift scanner is a key element of this watermarking system and can be useful for providing the signal’s coherency. The system is dedicated for radio correspondent authorisation. At present the described system is implemented on TI DSK 6713 for real-time processing.
References [1] [2] [3]
[4] [5]
Nedeljko Cvejic, Tapo Seppänen, Spread spectrum audio watermarking using frequency hopping and attack characterization. Signal Processing, 84 (2004), pp.207-213, 2004. Zbigniew Piotrowski, Effective method of watermark embedding and decoding in the audio broadcast band. Military University of Technology, Warsaw, Poland, PhD dissertation, pp. 51-59, 2005 Piotr Gajewski, Jerzy Łopatka, Zbigniew Piotrowski, A New method of frequency offset correction using coherent averaging. Journal of Telecommunications and Information Technology, 1/2005, pp. 142-146, 2005 Methods for the Subjective Assessment of Small Impairments in Audio Systems Including Multichannel Sound Systems; Recommendation ITU-R BS.1116. Richard G. Lyons, Understanding Digital Signal Processing, Prentice Hall PTR Publication, 2004
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
801
Optoelectronic system for phase array antenna beam steering E. Sędek1, Z. Bielecki2, M. Muszkowski1, W. Kołosowski1, G. Różański2 & M. Wnuk2 1 2
Telecommunications Research Institute (PIT), Poland Military University of Technology (WAT), Poland
Abstract This paper presents a system for optoelectronic beam steering of a phase antenna array. The microwave signal from an RF generator controlled by a pulse generator is transmitted to the electrical input of an optical elevation control unit, which generates N microwave signals with independent amplitude and phase. The control unit utilizes an optical wave from a laser. All outputs of those control units are connected to inputs of N optical azimuth control units, which provide M linear element antennas control. Those units utilize an optical wave from a second laser. This way an M x N element of a planar antenna control is provided. The presented method is compared with the classical and electronic method, which consists of multi-bits microwave phase shifters for producing an electronic scanning effect. On the basis of this concept we realized 16-element linear antenna array printed on a dielectric substrate fully controlled by an optoelectronic system. A tuned wavelength laser in the range 1520–1600 nm and 10 mW optical output power has been used as an optical signal source. The optical signal is modulated by a microwave signal. The applied modulator operates in the third optical window, allowing optical signal modulation to 10GHz. Very high resolution and an excellent accuracy of the antenna beam positioning can be achieved. The optimal technique depends on the number of antenna elements, which implicates beam width. The presented method is preferred for very narrow antenna beams. Keywords: optoelectronic system, phase array antenna, beam steering.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070781
802 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Active phase array antennas [1,2] have played an ever more important role in modern radar systems. This direction of antenna techniques has been possible due to electronic space scanning within a wide range without the need for mechanical rotation of the antenna as well as free options in the generated beam spatial characteristic shaping, achieved through relevant control of numerous transmission elements. The microwave control signals distribution for traditional systems take advantage of shared axis systems and metal wave-guides of considerable size; all these - due to a large number of active elements in an array antenna - make impossible a simple delivery of control signals and reception of output microwave signals. The rapid development of optoelectronic techniques, in particular development of numerous modern optic elements, used for fiber optic transmissions and optic signals processing, provide a practical opportunity to solve these problems [3–5].
2
Electronic scanning of phase array antenna beam
Active phased array antennas are composed of the matrix of independent microwave transmitting-receiving elements (TR-modules) to which separate control signals are being supplied by means of the independent regulated phase shifter systems or through delaying lines. The proper positioning in space of the radiating elements, as well as proper power supply, shape the resultant field distribution, making it possible to achieve the desired direction characteristic [6]. The generated beam spatial characteristics and propagation direction are controlled electronically, by changing an amplitude and phase of the elementary signals distributed to the individual antenna elements. The beam steering accuracy and spatial characteristic distortions depend upon the number of the applied antenna transmitting elements and accuracy in defining the phase delays and microwave signals power. Phased array antenna beam steering [7, 8] is based on supplying antenna radiating elements by microwave signals with gradually increasing phases. In the case of one-dimensional active antenna, the phase difference between antenna array consecutive elements required for shifting the antenna beam off an antenna axis by θ angle, can be presented as follows:
α = 2π
d
λ
cos θ
(1)
where: λ - microwave signal wavelength, d - distance between the radiating elements. Based on the dependence λ = c / f , where c is the vacuum light speed, and f - microwave signal frequency, we obtain:
α = 2π ⋅ f
d cosθ c
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(2)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
803
The above equation indicates that the phase of microwave signals connected to the antenna consecutive elements is dependent upon the microwave signal frequency. Thus, the antenna operational frequency change results in the beam propagation direction change; in turn, this indicates that varying frequencies are being positioned in different directions. This phenomenon is known in the literature as beam squinting. This disadvantage limits the antenna operation to monochromatic signals, thus disabling wide band systems implementation. Substituting in eqn (2), the dependence α = 2π ⋅ f ⋅ t , where t is a time needed for the wave to change phase by α and transforming the equation, we arrive at a simple dependence for the delay time of the microwave signal distributed to the antenna consecutive elements to propagate the beam under the θ angle:
t=
d cos θ c
(3)
The above equation shows that the signal delay time between the consecutive antenna elements - as opposite to the phase - does not depend on frequency, implicating a possibility of wide beam operation. Thus, the phase - array – in this case – should be replaced with the time-array type of steering. This method of steering is defined in the literature as TTD (true-time delay).
3
Optoelectronic units
A block scheme of the optoelectronic unit for 2-dimensional control of an antenna beam is presented in Fig. 1. Laser 2
Optical
Fibre Optic Splitter
Laser 1
Optical
RF
Generator
Optical Azimuth Control Unit 1xN
Optical
1 2
2
3 M
1
1 2
2 3
{
M
{ {
Optical
Figure 1:
1
Azimuth
Generator
PULSE
M
1
1 2
2
3
2-dimensional optoelectronic control unit of antenna beam.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
804 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Microwave signals from an RF generator controlled by a pulse generator are transmitted to an electrical input of an optical elevation control unit, which generates N microwave signals with independent amplitude and phase. The control unit utilizes an optical wave from a laser. All outputs of those control units are connected to inputs of N optical azimuth control units, which provide M linear element antennas control. Those units utilize an optical wave from a second laser. This way an MxN element of planar antenna control is provided. A block scheme of a 1-dimensional optoelectronic control unit of an antenna beam is presented in Fig. 2. Optical Input
Electrical Input Driver
MZM
Optical Receiver
Fibre
Optical Receiver
Optic Network
Optical Receiver
Figure 2:
1-dimensional optoelectronic control unit of antenna beam.
Optical input of the unit is supplied by the optical carrier signal from a laser. Electrical input is supplied by a microwave signal from the RF generator. A Mach-Zender optical modulator has been used to perform modulation of the optical carrier wave by a microwave signal. The modulated signal is routed to optical receivers via a fibre optic network, where the optical signal is split on N or M outputs and amplitude and phase control of each signal is provided. Optical to electrical conversion is done by optical receivers. There are many different optoelectronic approaches to arrange fibre optic network to amplitude and phase control, which can be divided into coherent and non-coherent systems. A coherent approach is based on optical signal phase modulation using coherent detection. Non-coherent systems are based on different lengths of optical path applications to provide various delay times of optical signals. In this case phase shift is proportional to length of optical fibre as follows:
∆α = 2π ⋅ n ⋅ f
L c
(4)
where: n - refractive index coefficient, f - microwave signal frequency, L fibre optic length, c - light velocity. This means that the optical signal phase change required to generate a microwave beam from a planar antenna propagated in the required direction needs to use a large number of different length fibre optic lines. For each beam position another set of different lengths of fibre optic
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
805
is required, then we need M x N x R fibres, where R – number of beam position. Thus systems like this are very large and complicated. Generally large numbers of different optic techniques were applied to achieve a variable phase shift. Most popular applications are based on: optical switches, piezo-electric crystals, liquid and aqustooptic crystals, high dispersion fibres and bragg gratings. Two types of fibre optic techniques based on binary fibre optic delay line and dispersion delay line will be considered and compared to classic microwave phase shifters. The microwave beam position generated from a linear antenna can be described as follows:
c α d 2π ⋅
θ = arccos
f
(5)
where α is the phase difference of signals supplying antenna neighbour’s elements, and d is a space between antenna elements. Concerning classical microwave systems applying 5-bit microwave phase shifters, the maximum phase resolution is 11.25 degrees. Then the maximum beam position angle is 4.77 degrees. Using an optic delay line with optical switches and different lengths of fibres the maximum resolution of fibre length is equal to 5 mm so then the maximum beam position angle is 1.7 degrees for the 5GHz microwave signal frequency. Much higher resolution can be achieved using a dispersion delay line. In this case we need to apply a variable wavelength laser with 0.1nm resolution. Then the maximum phase resolution is equal to 0.25 degrees, and thus the maximum beam position angle is equal to 0.09 degrees for the 5GHz microwave signal frequency. The scheme of the control system applies a material dispersion phenomenon in single-mode optical fibres for a 16-element linear antenna as presented in Fig. 3. A tuned wavelength laser in the range 1520÷1600nm and an 10mW optical output power has been used as an optic signal source. The optic signal is routed to n electrooptic modulator.
MZM
Laser RF Generator
Driver LDO
1:2
LDZ
1:8
1:8
Attenuator
Optical Receiver Amplifier
Figure 3:
Antenna control system structure.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
806 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The applied modulator operates in a third optic window, allowing for 10GHz optical signal modulation. A specialised microwave amplifier has been applied as a modulator driver. The microwave input signal, following relevant amplification in a driver, is routed to the modulator electric input. Thus, an optic signal on the modulator output is amplitude modulated with an envelope according to the control microwave signal from the RF generator. Next, the modulated optic signal is distributed to a binary tree introducing the relevant microwave signal delays on individual outputs of the system. Optical signals are attenuated in fibre optic attenuators to obtain the required power distribution. Next, they are routed to the inputs of 16 optical receivers, performing optic electric signal conversion and finally distributed to the microwave amplifiers, thus additional amplifcation of 22dB is performed. The antenna beam control system requires selection of high dispersion fibre optic length LD and zero dispersion fibre optic length LZD, according to the operation laser wavelength range to obtain the desired antenna beam scanning range.
4
Control system measurements
Detail measurements of the developed system are based on measurements of the output signal power distribution and microwave signal delay between a modulating signal and 16 outputs signals of the control system. The measurements have been done on a microwave network analyser HP8720B. The power and phase of the microwave signal have been measured. The phase was converted into a time delay for a signal frequency equal to 5GHz. The antenna elevation characteristics have been calculated on the basis of the obtained results. Antenna beam scanning in the range of 0º ÷ 45º has been achieved. In figure 4 high compatibility between the position angle of a 16-element linear antenna characteristic in theory (black curve) and measurement (red curve) for a fibre optic dispersion delay line application can be observed.
Figure 4:
16-element linear antenna characteristics for 30º degree antenna beam position.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
807
Elevation characteristics of an antenna, calculated theoretically and based on measurements for a distribution of output power like cos2x + 0.4 are presented in Figs 5 and 6. Radiation characteristics of the 16-element antenna row, performed for a non-uniform signal power distribution at the control system outputs proves considerable compatibility with theoretical simulations. The developed system ensures an opportunity to control the beam propagation direction with an excellent accuracy equal to 0.1º.
Figure 5:
16-element linear antenna characteristics for 0º, 10º, 30º and 45º degree antenna beam position (simulation).
Figure 6:
Antenna characteristics for 0º, 10º, 30º and 45º degree antenna beam position (measurements).
5
Conclusion
Using digital microwave phase shifters the calculated phase shift must be approximated according to phase shifter resolution, then the accuracy of beam WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
808 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII positioning is equal to a few degrees. Application of optical weigh units in phase array beam forming provides full antenna characteristic control. Very high resolution and an excellent accuracy of the antenna beam positioning can be achieved. The optimal technique depends on the number of antenna elements, which implicates beam width. For very narrow beams the best solution is optical delay line application in weigh units providing high angle resolution and positioning accuracy.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
Mailloux R.J., Phased Array Antenna Handbook, Artch House Inc. 1994 Dufrêne R., Sędek E., Kołosowski W., Wnuk M., Lisowski J., Muszkowski M., Array Antenna Direction Characteristics Shaping Optic and Electronic Methods, PIT Works No. 127, Warsaw 2001 Zmuda H., Toughlian E.N., Photonic Aspect of Modern Radar, Artech House Inc. 1994 Kumar A., Antenna Design with Fiber Optics, Artech House Inc. 1996 Muszkowski M., Radar Signals Fiber Optic Transmission System, New Constructions and Technologies, Rościszów 1988 Seeds A.J., Application of Opto-Electronic Techniques in Phased Array Antenna Beamforming, Microwave Photonic, Technical Digest, MWP 1997 Frigyes I., Seeds A.J., Optically Generated True-Tine Delay in PhasedArray Antennas, IEEE Trans. Microwave theory & Tech., vol. 43. p. 2378-2386, Sept. 1995 Soref R., Optical Dispersion Techniques for Time-Delay Beam Steering, Appl. Opt. Vol. 31, No. 36, p. 7395-7397, Dec. 1992
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
809
Nitrogen dioxide detection using an optoelectronic sensor Z. Bielecki1, W. Kołosowski1, G. Różański1, E. Sędek2 & J. Wojtas1 1 2
Military University of Technology, Warsaw, Poland Telecommunications Research Institute, Warsaw, Poland
Abstract Sensitive laser absorption spectroscopy requires a long effective pathlength of the laser beam in the analyzed media. Traditionally, this requirement is satisfied using an optical multipass cell. We present the opportunities of detection of nitrogen dioxide using cavity enhanced spectroscopies. These techniques can be applied for construction of a fully optoelectronic NO2 sensor with a detection limit better than 1 ppb. The setup usually includes the resonance optical cavity, which is equipped with spherical and high reflectance mirrors, the pulsed or cw laser and a photomultiplier which is connected with the digital oscilloscope or with others digitizers. The optical signal leaving a cavity can be used to determine an absorption coefficient of the intracavity medium. Keywords: optoelectronic sensor, absorption spectroscopy.
1
Introduction
Nitrogen dioxide is one of the most important factors in atmosphere quality. At present, NO2 is commonly detected using the methods based on chemiluminescence. Their sensitivity reaches single ppb. Laser absorption spectroscopy is an effective tool in studies of gaseous species. The Beer-Lambert law for week absorption indicates that the minimum detectable concentration of absorbers is inversely proportional to the effective sample-path length, and directly proportional to the minimum intensity fluctuation detected by a photodetector. In order to increase the absorption sensitivity, the optical path through the absorber should be maximised and the relative-intensity variations should be minimised. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070791
810 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
Example of commonly used optical multipass cell.
Long optical path lengths for absorption can be achieved by the use of White or Herriott cells (Fig. 1), a passive high-finesse cavity or laser intracavity technique [1–3]. An effective absorption path length up to several kilometres has been obtained using laser intracavity absorption spectroscopy. Use of a high-finesse cavity permits hundreds, or even thousands, of traverses through the absorber, and thus reaches long effective path lengths and provides high detection sensitivity. One of the methods of laser intracavity absorption spectroscopy is cavity ring-down spectroscopy (CRDS). The CRDS based on the measurement of the time for light to decay within the cavity, has been developed for use with a pulsed laser (P-CRDS) or with a continuous-wave laser (CW-CRDS) with acousto-optic modulator or mechanical beam chopper (Fig. 2) [4, 5]. There are others methods using a high-finesse optical cavity consisting of two highly reflective mirrors (R > 0.9999) such as cavity enhanced absorption spectroscopy (CEAS) with off-axis laser and cavity adjustment, integrated cavity output spectroscopy (ICOS) with piezoelement or ring-down spectral photography (RSP) [5–8].
2
Experimental design
The laser intracavity absorption spectroscopy techniques share a common instrument layout. A basic schematic layout of the instrument design is shown in Fig. 2. In all cases, a laser light is coupled into high-finesse optical cavity, which is equipped with gas valves. The valves are connected with the gas mixing system, which allows for precise gas mixing and establishing the ordered NO2 concentration. The laser radiation can be directed to the cavity using two mirrors. Due to pulsed character of the radiation used, one can avoid various problems with the light modulation and the laser – cavity mode coupling. A photodetector, often PMT, monitors the power escaping from the cavity, which is proportional to the intensity inside a cavity. PMT can be equipped with the interference filter, the bandpass of which was well matched to the laser line. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
811
Example of CRDS setup.
Figure 3:
Idea of CRDS.
Next, the signal is recorded with a fast digital oscilloscope and after digitization usually a computer is used to store and analyze the measurement data.
3
Analyses
In CRDS technique, the gas sample is placed inside a high-finesse optical cavity. It consists of two highly reflective mirrors. A short laser pulse is coupled into the cavity. The light is reflected back and forth inside the cavity and, every time that the light is reflected, a small fraction of this light leaks out of the cavity and is registered by a photodetector (Fig. 3).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
812 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The presence of absorbing species in the cavity gives an additional loss channel for the light inside the cavity. If the absorption follows Beer′s law, the light intensity inside the cavity will still decay exponentially, resulting in a decrease in the decay time as
I (t ) = I 0 e
−
[(1− R )+αL ]c t L
= I 0e
−
t
τ ,
(1) where I0 is the initial intensity, c denotes the light speed, α is the absorption coefficient, and L is the resonator length. The decay time of radiation is measured once when the cavity is empty (Fig. 4, dashed line B) and next when the cavity is filled with the absorber (Fig. 3, line A).
Figure 4:
Decay signal from a cavity.
In an empty cavity, this ring-down transient is a single-exponentially decaying function of time with a 1/e CRDS time which is solely determined by the reflectivity of the mirrors and the optical path length between the mirrors. Speed of the decay intensity I(t) of the pulse of the laser light is dependent on the mirrors reflectivity coefficient R, the resonator length L, diffraction losses, and extinction, that is absorption and scattering of a light in the absorber filled cavity. Therefore, by measuring the resonator quality, determination of the absorption coefficient is possible. The resonator quality can be determined by measurement of the radiation decay time constant τ
τ=
L . c ⋅ [(1 − R ) + αL]
(2)
By comparison of decay times for these two cases, a value of the absorber density N can be found α 1 1 1 , (3) − N= = σ σ c τ τ 0 where σ denotes the absorption cross section, while τ0 and τ are the time constants of the exponential decay of the output signal for empty resonator and for the resonator filled with the absorber, respectively. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
813
When the high reflectivity mirrors (R > 0.9999) are applied, the absorption coefficients as low as 10-9 m-1 can be measured. There are several advantages to this approach. Since the absorption is determined from the time behaviour of the signal, it is independent of pulse-topulse fluctuation of the laser. Furthermore, the effective absorption path length, which depends on the reflectivity of the cavity mirrors, can be very long (several km), while the sample volume can be kept rather small. Another advantage is that the absorption is measured on the absolute scale. The CRDS technique can be applied with success when the molecule′s excited state does not fluoresce or can be ionized. In high-pressure samples, such as plasmas and flames, CRDS can be successfully used to extract quantitative absolute concentration data, which is nearly impossible by using other methods. As long as the mirrors with a sufficiently high reflectivity, detectors with a sufficiently sensitivity and fast time response, and tunable light sources are available, there is no intrinsic limitation to the spectral region in which CRDS can be applied. This method can be used from the ultraviolet part of the spectrum to the infrared spectral region.
4
Nitrogen dioxide concentration measurement
The nitrogen dioxide absorption cross section σ is shown in Fig. 5 [9]. The greatest σ values reached around 400 nm. There are several minima and maxima, but they varying about value of 6×10-19 cm2.
Figure 5:
NO2 absorption cross section.
In order to achieve a high value of limit detection of NO2 reflectivity, cavity mirrors and wavelength of a laser beam should be appropriately matched to the greatest values of nitrogen dioxide absorption cross section. Furthermore, to achieve long decay times and high precision of the decay time determination, the proper adjustment of the cavity is necessary. Moreover, the measurement with a good detection limit also requires appropriate filtration WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
814 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII of the investigated air. This is necessary in order to avoid the light scattering in the aerosol particles as well as the dust deposition on the mirror surfaces. When the concentration of aerosol particles in gas is similar to that in free atmosphere, the extinction of about 10-6 m-1 occurs, consequently at high sensitivity measurements, the losses due to the light scattering can be the same or larger than the absorption losses. Sensitivity of nitrogen dioxide optoelectronic sensor based on cavity enhanced spectroscopy technique is determined by detectable concentration limit NLimit, which is described by the formula
N Limit =
X , cσ (λ )τ 0
where X is the relative precision of time determination, and is equal to τ −τ X = 0 .
τ0
(4)
(5)
In Fig. 6, the dependence of sensitivity nitrogen dioxide sensor on cavity length and mirrors reflectivity is shown. The calculations were performed for 5% of decay time precision determination and absorption cross section equaled to 5.1 cm2. As it is shown in the picture, strong influence on sensor sensitivity has mirrors reflectivity.
Figure 6:
Dependence of NO2 sensor sensitivity on cavity length and mirrors reflectivity.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
815
Detectable concentration limit is also strongly biased by decay time precision determination. For instance, if 1% precision is ensured, sensor with mirrors, the reflectivity of which reached a value of 99.995%, provides possibility of measurement of 0.5 ppb of nitrogen dioxide, what is presented in Fig. 7. The dependence of NO2 sensor sensitivity on decay time precision determination and cavity mirrors reflectivity is shown.
Figure 7:
Dependence of NO2 sensor sensitivity on decay time precision determination and cavity mirrors reflectivity.
It is possible to reach highly precise decay time determination using coherence averaging of samples of signal from a photodetector [10]. Experiment shows, that thanks to this precision better than 0.2% is attainable after the averaged 10 000 CRDS pulses (Fig. 8).
5
Conclusions
In this paper, we have presented cavity enhanced spectroscopic technique which can be applied for construction of a fully optoelectronic NO2 detection system. A manner of resonator quality determination by measuring the time of the radiation imprisonment is not sensitive for the laser power fluctuation and photodetector sensitivity fluctuation.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
816 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 8:
Precision of decay time determination as a function of a pulses number.
The features of the described detection system show, that it is possible to construct a NO2 sensor, the sensitivity of which could be comparable with that of chemical detectors. Such a kind of system has several advantages such as: low price, small size and weight and possibility of detection of other gases. In the next stage of the experiment we are going to construct a fully optoelectronic system based on cavity enhanced spectroscopic technique for detection of trace concentration nitrogen dioxide.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
[6] [7]
J.U. White, Very long optical paths in air, J. Opt. Soc. Am. 66, 411, 1976. D. Herriott, H. Kogelnik, R. Kompfner, Off-axis paths in spherical mirror interferometers, Applied Optics, 3, p. 523, 1964. J. Doussin, R. Dominique, C. Patrick, Multiple-pass cell for very-longpath infrared spectrometry, Applied Optics, Vol. 38, No. 19, pp. 41454151, 1999. A. O’Keefe, D.A.G. Deacon, “Cavity ring-down optical spectrometer for absorption measurements using pulsed laser sources”, Rev. Sci. Instrum. 59, No. 12, pp.2544 – 2551, 1988. G.S. Engel, E.J. Moyer, F.N. Ketusch, J.G. Anderson, Innovations in Cavity Enhanced Laser Absorption Spectroscopy: Using in situ Measurements to Probe the Mechanisms Driving Climate Change, Earth Science Technology Conference, Laser Sensor Technologies, June, 2003. J.J. Scherer, Ringdown spectral photography, Chemical Physics Letters, No. 292, pp. 143–153, 1998. J.J. Scherer, J.B. Paul, H. Jiao, A. O’Keefe, Broadband ringdown spectral photography, Applied Optics, Vol. 40, No. 36, pp. 6725-6732, 2001.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[8] [9] [10]
817
R.F. Curl, F.K. Tittel, Tunable infrared laser spectroscopy, Annu. Rep. Prog. Chem., Sect. C, 98, pp. 219–272, 2002. M.F. Merienne, A Jenouvrier, B. Coquart, The NO2 absorption spectrum. I: absorption cross-sections at ambient temperature in the 300-500 nm region, J. Atmos. Chem., Vol. 20, No. 3, pp. 281-297, 1995. J. Wojtas, A. Czyżewski, T. Stacewicz, Z. Bielecki, J. Mikolajczyk, Cavity enhanced spectroscopy for NO2 detection, Proc. SPIE, Vol. 5954, pp. 174-178, 2005.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
819
Automatic processing analysis of infrared images for monitoring pantograph catenary interactions A. Balestrino, O. Bruno, A. Landi & L. Sani Dipartimento di Sistemi Elettrici e Automazione, Università di Pisa, Italy
Abstract This paper shows a new sensor based on infrared images for monitoring pantograph catenary interaction. Due to the displacement of the contact point with respect to the reference position an image processing analysis of each frame is performed by using the Hough transformation in order to detect automatically monitoring variables of interest (e.g. temperature at the contact point and the position of the support towers along the railway line). Keywords: infrared image, pantograph-catenary interaction, Hough transformation, segment detection.
1
Introduction
In order to improve the maintenance activities, a relevant objective for railway companies is the development of new sensors for a continuous monitoring of the quality of the current transmission between the overhead line and the collector strips of the pantograph. This problem is grown crucial with the introduction of the European Standard 96/48/CE about the interoperability. It is well-known that a poor electric contact between is the origin of arcing between the overhead wire and the collector strips of the pantograph. Several investigations have shown that the main damages of the overhead contact line installations are caused by the short term thermal effect of these arcing. The process which leads to the deterioration of the contact wire is associated with a localised recrystallization of the copper (i.e. a transaction to a stable crystalline microstructure with loss of all physical characteristics typical of the cold-drawn) and the formation of pits and dents on the surface. Unfortunately high speeds worsen the problem and a monitoring system has to be set up and tested to plan maintenance activity. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070801
820 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Previous research activity (Bruno et al [1], Barmada et al [2]) revealed that a new measurement system, based on a phototube sensor, could detect break arcs between the pantograph and the contact line. A different approach is a measurement of the quality of the overhead contact by using infrared cameras. Preliminary results based on the analysis of infrared images were proposed by Balestrino et al [3]. Measurements carried out during high speed test runs and a post processing of the data collected have revealed the effectiveness of the proposed method for detecting the losses of contact, in order to evaluate and test the performance of running pantographs and of the contact wires. The task of the proposed research is the application of tracking algorithm of predefined objects (e.g., the contact point on the pantograph strip) based on the Hough transform over a sequence of images acquired from thermo-camera, in order to monitoring variables of interest, (e.g., temperature at the contact point and the position of the support towers along the railway line).
2
Thermography for monitoring pantograph-catenary interactions
Thermo-cameras have not been used extensively in railway research. Main advantages offered by thermo vision are: a) it is a non-contact and non-destructive technique; b) it is suited to monitoring devices operating under high voltage or carrying high currents; c) is more informative than a standard camera image, because of its insensitivity to different weather conditions, to the daily-nightly runs or to the presence of tunnels. A critical aspect of thermo vision is that the exact temperature of the body under test cannot be directly revealed. Nevertheless infrared imaging is an excellent method for extracting a qualitative map of the superficial temperature. As a matter of fact thermal analysis gives a relative information on the temperature, following the reasoning of Runciman [4]: all objects at temperatures above absolute zero emit electromagnetic radiation. Radiation thermometry makes use of this fact to estimate the temperatures of objects by measuring the radiated energy from selected regions. Every physical process characterized by an increase or decrease in surface temperature is detectable with infrared thermography. The intensity of the emitted radiation depends on two factors: the body temperature and the factor emissivity of the surface, i.e. the ability of the object to radiate, defined by the Stefan-Boltzmann equation:
E = εσ T 4
(1)
where: E is the radiation in W/m2, ε the emissivity, σ the Boltzmann constant and T is the temperature in Kelvin.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
821
The emissivity factor ε lies between zero and the unity, depending on the material nature and on the superficial roughness. Infrared imaging systems convert infrared heat emissions into a picture that shows the relative temperature differences in a range of grey tones, or in a series of colours, in such a way that the desired temperature information is easily interpreted by the user. In fig. 1.a a typical infrared image of pantograph-catenary interaction in the case of a burst of arcing (i.e. losses of contact between catenary and pantograph) is shown (the train speed was 200 km/h in this case). The maximum infrared emission is in the neighbourhood of the contact surface between strip and wire. Interaction region between the overhead feeder and the strip shows a high thermal gradient. A continuous monitoring of the contact region leads to interesting information on the quality of the current transmission.
Figure 1:
3
Thermal image in case of a burst of arcing.
The automatic image processing
It is well-known that the contact point between the pantograph strip and the overhead line is not fixed. In fact the wire is zigzagged relative to the centre line of the track, to even the wear on the train's pantograph as it runs underneath. Moreover, because of the no uniform elasticity of the catenary, the height of the contact wire may change (e.g. entering a tunnel). Therefore a relevant displacement of the contact point may complicate the image processing, unless considering the knowledge of the moving spatial coordinates of the contact area. A first step for an automatic image processing analysis is to follow frame-byframe the position of some critical features (pantograph strips, overhead electric line). All these elements can be characterized by linear contours. This observation allows the use of standard algorithms for detecting straight lines inside each image under examination. The Hough transform is well-suited for detecting straight-lines in the real image: its application can be extremely useful for monitoring the contact point, characterized from the intersection of a segment representing the strip and a straight line representing the overhead line contact. Furthermore it can identify different rectilinear structures, such as the poles along the railway line, helping in finding a more precise correlation between the overheating of the contact point (or a burst of arcing) and the position of the train. A detailed description of the Hough transform is reported by Hough [5] and Deans [6]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
822 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The object recognizing procedure is depicted in the followings steps. a) Independently from the electronic format of the recorded file (we considered outputs in .bmp, .mpg or .avi formats), single frames are extracted from the image sequence. Each image is first stored in a matrix, then converted from true colour (RGB) to grey scale. b) Each image is suitably filtered for reducing noises and sharpen objects, then edges are extracted and image is then converted from a grey scale to a binary image. Edge detection was performed using Canny algorithm with a preliminary noise reduction (Canny [7]). After this step, each frame is represented by a binary image with edges evidenced. It is an easy task to identify the pantograph, the overhead contact lines and the poles. c) Object locations in every frame is characterised from an analysis of edges and a detection of reference straight lines. All straight lines can be localised using the Hough transform. In order to increase algorithm efficiency and to reduce computational burden, we suppose to know, within a limited variation, the position and the possible movement of the features to be monitored, therefore two observation windows into the image are locked: a first one includes the pantograph structure and the second one reveals the passage of the support structures. The straight line search can be limited inside these rectangular regions of the image. The procedure allows a quick detection of the object position and a repetitive algorithm allows following the trajectory of an object inside successive frames. After a first detection of the trajectory, it is a good strategy to eliminate frames with discontinuous trends of the object and to filter the image for reducing noise and to sharpen the image. Following this logic a software tool was created: it allows the user to detect automatically: 1. pantograph strip position; 2. catenary wires; 3. position of the poles. This procedure can be repeated for each frame of the sequence. Since the pantograph moves slowly with respect the frame rate of the camera, we can use the position of the strip detected in the previous image to window next image appropriately. So the computation time can be greatly reduced. 3.1 Position of the pantograph inside an image The pantograph appears at each frame and its position moves slowly. Small displacements both in vertical and in horizontal direction are allowed: they are due to the movements of the main frame and of the contact arms. In thermo images are evidenced two different pantograph heads and two different strips: the goal of the following study is to follow only the strip nearest the IR camera. Contact analysis is applied to the squared window of fig. 2.a, named reference box: its size and position inside the image will remain unchanged for the limited displacement of the pantograph head. Several segments are easily recognised by Hough transform (fig. 2.a): only the upper WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
823
Application of the Hough transformation. (a) Horizontal detected segments into the reference box of the strip. (b) Upper edge of the nearest strip. (c) Detected segments into the reference boxes of the lateral supports. (d) Detected lateral supports. (e) Detected line by Hough transformation. (f) Reference shape.
one represents the contact line for monitoring (fig. 2.b). Reference box allows following pantograph displacements along a vertical direction. For a correct analysis also the horizontal displacement has to be measured. Lateral displacements can be then esteemed from an analysis of the two lateral arms sustaining the pantograph heads (fig. 2.c). The two segments representing the external profile of these lateral supports can be identified by repeating the Hough analysis inside two new reference boxes, as shown in (fig. 2.d). The three reference boxes can be joined together for localising a triangle as the reference shape representing the pantograph, as shown in fig. 2.e and fig. 2.f Upper side of the triangle is representing the line useful for monitoring the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
824 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII contact with the catenary wires. Note that the representation of the pantograph head with a straight line is only an approximation of the real scenario. Nevertheless the maximum error accumulates in the lateral regions of the segment, where the pantograph head is not rectilinear: fortunately in such region an analysis of the contact is less relevant, since the local temperature is lower than in the middle zone of the segment. 3.2 Identification of the contact between pantograph and contact wire After the identification of the pantograph structure, the following step was devoted to a searching of the contact zone between pantograph and the overhead wire for monitoring the temperature and for checking a correct positioning of the contact wire in terms of its zigzagged movement, relative to the centre line of the track. In the case of the image sequences recorded along the railways from Florence to Rome, it can be observed that there are many straight lines, between them because two overhead wires (fig. 3.a) are in close proximity to the contact region.
Figure 3:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Identification of the contact between pantograph and overhead contact wire. (a) Image under examination (b) Detected straight lines representing catenary wires. (c) Detected boundaries (d) Identified contact region.
It must be highlighted that the contact points are not corresponding to the hottest points of the strip, usually in the middle of the contact strip. Hough transform can be applied again to detect overhead wires, as shown in fig. 3.b WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
825
many straight lines are detected. A selection of the correct contact wires was performed, based on the two following rules: contact wires are always adjacent and at the exterior of the set of the identified lines and contact wires are thicker than non-contact ones. The contact points are uniquely located via the following steps: 1) computing the intersection between the upper side of the triangle (pantograph head) and the two straight lines exterior to the pencil of lines (fig. 3.c); 2) analysing the colour distribution of the pixels inside the image, near the two points selected at step 1. The thickest line of the two is selected, for detecting the contact zone, whose extension is predefined by a fixed number of pixels in the direction of the middle of the pantograph head (fig. 3.d). 3.3 Passages under the portal structures of the railways In the case of a railway line with portal structures (e.g. the railway line connecting Florence to Rome) a similar method can be employed for detecting the poles. The horizontal structure is the easiest element to be recognized: it is the wider structure and it appears even if the poles are not included inside the image, as shown in fig. 4.a.
(a) Figure 4:
(b)
(a) Horizontal bridge sustaining catenary wires. (b) Observation box for counting the passages of portals.
Therefore counting passages of horizontal portals constitutes a safe method for localising the train position along the line: it can be performed using an observation box positioned in a suitable region of the image. An easy solution is to locate this box in a region where only the horizontal portals are passing, e.g., in the upper left side of each frame (fig 4.b). The Hough transform for straight lines recognizing can be applied inside the observation box and a reliable criterion of portal detection may be based on an accurate analysis of the number of identified lines. Its maximum value is very high in case of passages of portal structures: a threshold value is therefore useful for discriminating noisy images, or single straight lines passages.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
826 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
Experimental results
A preliminary laboratory test was carried out in order to yield the emissivity of the pantograph strip. In Italian Railways (3 kV d.c.) the contact material strip is copper (or copper based alloys). By using the IR camera software, the average emissivity of the strip was determined to be 0.2. The measurement equipment was then installed on board of an ETR500, a high-speed train of Italian Railways. IR-camera (produced by the Flir Systems) was located on the top deck of the locomotive, in front of the pantograph. The block diagram of fig. 5 illustrates the measurement chain. Trial runs have been carried out travelling along the railway line connecting Florence to Rome and vice versa.
Figure 5:
Measurement chain.
4.1 Portal structure detection an positioning of the overhead contact line In fig. 6.a and 6.b two plots are shown, the first one consider a portal structure detection, the second one reports the position of the contact point with respect to the centre of the pantograph head (a positive value means the contact point is located on the right w.r.t. the median position). They are referred to an analysis of 200 frames. Plots are functions of a position relative to the first frame analysed. Train speed was 200 km/h.
Portal structure
Position of the contact point (pixels)
1
0
0
0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20 0.22 Space (km)
30 20 10 0 -10 -20 -30 0
0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20 0.22
Space (km)
(a) Figure 6:
(b)
(a) Positioning of structural portal. (b) Contact point position respect to the centre of the pantograph head.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
827
4.2 Example of break arc detection Consider now 100 consecutive frames with a break arc corresponding to frame 50, shown in fig.7.a. The observation box is representative of the contact point. The observation box is representative of the contact point. Temperature profile along the strip surface for frame 50 is shown in fig. 7.b. Figure 8 shows the infrared map of the strip along the railway line connecting Florence to Rome between km 60 and km 63. Temperature peaks are correlated with arcing occurrences. This elaboration has been obtained by processing 2700 frame of the video sequence with a computation time of 540 s (using an AMD ® Athlon processor at 1.2 GHz).
(a) Figure 7:
(a) Frame 50 with break arc detection. (b) Temperature profile on the strip surface.
Figure 8:
5
(b)
Infrared map of pantograph strip along the railways.
Conclusions
The use of an infrared camera for monitoring the pantograph-catenary status has been proposed and experimentally tested. The temperature profile of the pantograph strip was detected on infrared images by using the Hough WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
828 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII transformation. An analysis of the stored images could help maintenance operations, revealing, for example an irregular positioning of the line. New typologies of pantographs, new materials for collector strips, and catenary layout can be thermically analyzed.
Acknowledgement The financial support of the Italian Ministry of University and Research - MIUR (Project on Innovative Controls in High-Speed Transport Systems) is gratefully acknowledged.
References [1]
[2]
[3]
[4] [5] [6] [7]
Bruno, O., Landi, A., Papi, M. and Sani, L. Phototube sensor for monitoring the quality of current collection on overhead electrified railways. In Proc. IMECHE, Part F: Journal of Rail and Rapid Transit, vol.215, n. 3, pp. 231-241, 2001. Barmada, S., Landi, A., Papi, M. and Sani, L., Wavelet multi-resolution analysis for monitoring the occurrence of arcing on overhead electrified railways, In Proc. IMECHE, Part F: Journal of Rail and Rapid Transit, vol. 217, n 3, pp. 177-187, 2003. Balestrino, A., Bruno, O., Landi, A., Masini, P., Mingozzi, E., Papi, M. and Sani, L. Infrared camera for monitoring pantograph-catenary interactions. In Proc. of World Conference of Railway Research 2003, Edinburgh (UK), pp. 1-7, 2003. Runciman, H.M. Thermal imaging, in Measurement, Instrumentation, and Sensors Handbook CRCnetBase 1999, J.G. Webster Editor, CRC Press, 2000. Hough, P. Method and means for recognizing complex patterns, in U.S. Patent 3069654, 1962. Deans, S, R. Hough Transform from the Radon Transform, in IEEE Transactions on Pattern Analysis and Machine Intelligence Vol. PAMI-3, No 2, pp.185-188, (Mar.1981). Canny, J. A Computational Approach to Edge Detection, in IEEE Transactions on Pattern Analysis and Machine Intelligence Vol. PAMI-8, No 6, pp.679-698, (Nov.1986).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
829
Architectural hot-swap in NURBS surfaces: versioning of case studies, work in progress A. Prichard-Schmitzberger California State Polytechnic University, Pomona, USA
Abstract This paper documents the testing of various applications of hot-swapping and precision modelling with minimal programming input reflecting the limited resources of small-scale practices. Hot-swapping identifies the principle of replacing components of a building during active design processes without altering its general appearance. The methodologies were tested through a series of courses on Digitally Enhanced Construction and Fabrication with architecture students at Calpoly Pomona. The teaching methodology allows not only the investigation of the required modelling accuracy but also the creation of prototypes and various versions of assembly alternatives. The paper covers the procedures developed to derive architectural form in a process of reverse engineering of specific architectural case. Flexibility or limitation of nonuniform surfaces for rapid prototyping and file-to-factory construction are investigated. Using versioning, a centralized design methodology with one source object for controlling and tracking 3d NURBS surfaces are detailed to material properties and using current building material which allows the implementation of pre-fabrication as well as mass-customization. Resulting projects allow assessment of time-consumption in the design-process; deviation of the proposed result from the original; overall complexity of assembly method; customization amounts of individual parts and manual effort. The procedures outlined in this paper would enable small architectural offices to enter competition with larger offices through integrating positive aspects of hotswapping in conjunction with prototyping without the typically necessary technical and fiscal casts. Keywords: hot-swapping in architecture, reverse engineering, versioning, computer integrated construction and manufacturing, design processes.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070811
830 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The course Digitally Enhanced Construction and Fabrication establishes first contact with so-called “file to factory” [2] scenarios and rapid prototyping in architecture. A major aspect of the course, however, focuses on the practical application and the supposed seamless exchange of digital information in 3dmodelling, simulating a typical small-scale practice. Small-scale offices experience on one hand the financial strain of software and equipment costs and on the other hand affordability of qualified employees to be in competing range with larger office structures.
2
Objective
The advance of BIM – Building Information Modelling – and the integration thereof in the curriculum for accreditation purposes offers another challenge to digital architecture and its educators. BIM is associated with the relatively ‘smart’ structure of current software packages, among them so-called parametric modelers such as Autocad Revit and Archicad. However, these particular programs differ in application from potential software packages such as Generative Components, running on Microstation platforms, due to the fact that the major input follows industry standards rather than input derived from a designed architectural model, enabling definition and specification of customized detailing. Hot-swapping, a term borrowed from computer hardware, describes a potential method which allows a) quick development of a base 3d model with enough flexibility and accuracy for future manipulation and b) exchange of construction methods up through a late stage of design and production. 2.1 Course setup The initial 10 week, 3 unit course layout encompasses a lecture portion with a brief introduction to the history of prototyping and numeric machining. Differentiation between polygonal, Boolean and NURBS modelling is necessary to establish an understanding for the advantages and disadvantages in creation processes. NURBS models offer mostly more flexibility due to their parametric setup. Polygonal mesh models represent complex structures themselves and are therefore undesired. Much of contemporary architecture shows intention and interest in generating quasi-automatic forms and structures, genetic algorithms, and parametric design methodology. They engage programming/scripting, setting inputs, initial conditions, controls, and performance, all of which are criteria to evolve a form or structure or to produce a “population” of possible architectural phenotypes which are then selected according to extrinsic criteria or self-referencing elaborated. Manuel DeLanda once characterized this shift towards the genetic algorithm as the third wave of digital modelling software, one which would finally supplant all the previous identities of “designer” and intentionality in favor of diagrammatic processes [3]. This process is mostly WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
831
formal and despite its aspiration a very often pseudo-scientific approach that appears removed from any material aspects. Hot-swapping follows a different premise. 2.1.1 Hot-swapping configuration Hot-swapping as a technique is detached from the architectural discussion on form and formal tendencies. The re-association with fabrication, construction and affiliated practices is tied to the computational procedures. The digital model serves as surface model and offers the conditions upon which material properties and structural methods can be exchanged in a timely fashion without the need for re-creating the geometries. In architectural education the tools are limited, and the understanding of architectural assembly is still a traditional one. Architectural construction methods are sequenced in accordance with the history of modernist, post industrial-revolution production, choosing pre-arranged certified techniques and using discrete building elements to form a hierarchical build-up sequence. These independent elements represent a simple nested hierarchy, easy to control in assembly and for its assembly schedule. 2.1.2 File-to-factory File-to-factory scenarios and the proclamation “one-building – one detail” [4] by K. Oosterhuis of ONL require a new production setting, reduction of material and the generation of assemblies at a pre-construction phase as well as a different structural fabrication scenario. While bypassing the rather linear, formgenerating relationship of architecture and technology, mostly represented through the software and its commanding algorithms, he further re-introduces the relevance of practical application, looking for a new position in the construction process. Utilizing the digital model not only for representational, diagrammatic or conditional purposes, but also for applying an entire material and assembly process as well as documentation method is core to Building Information Modelling. However closely related, his practical application does not submit to standardized detailing and building methods but offers via ‘hot-swapping’ and parametric design the ability to control the production process in conjunction with the digital model until a very late stage in the design-to-production process [5]. 2.2 Design methodology Throughout studies it appears that for an applicable generation of conditions which should allow a hot-swap of features, a parametric surface model provides the highest flexibility in a) establishing a controllable form and b) continually applying detailing features. For this investigation it is necessary that current discussions concerning performative aspects of surfaces strictly follow the practical application only to avoid unnecessary distractions from the objected goal. A reversed, traditional approach of developing a structural grid and forming the architecture after its constraints would limit any flexibility in the exchange of generation methods. Any parametric surface can be treated as a field WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
832 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII and therefore subdivided into elements, following a process similar to tessellation of digital surfaces first-hand. However, a structurally correct, generative tessellation would again require specific scripting effort. The engineering-design application mainly focuses on a realistic structural composite solution at this point. The maintenance of a relatively simple NURBS surface in Rhino3D offers a highly flexible base for any further manipulation, since the parametric values are reduced to few control-points in contrast to polygonal meshes, with a comparatively excessive amount of manipulation vertices. Structural application can be simply pulled, projected onto the surface or created via isocurves, fig. 1, and despite causing occasional undesirable, uncontrolled effects in varying degrees of the surface curvatures, the results remain largely flexible for manipulation. Further detailing is has a high level of time consumption due to the manual aspect of modelling; each elemental intersection is revisited with each alteration of the conditions and if necessarily corrected through either Boolean operations or remodelling.
Figure 1:
3
Example for pulling structure grids to a surface. (Student: D. Rogers).
Practical application
Given practical limitations the course setting intentionally abandons the introduction of scripting to investigate and manage architectural data in a more traditional sense. The importance of programming and respectively scripting is undisputed; programmability is a unique property of the digital medium. Design methodology might be opposed by the exactness inherent to programming itself; though this concern was not reflected by the objectives of this course.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
833
3.1 Concrete modelling The case-studies chosen for reverse engineering are F. Candela’s Restaurant Mantiales in Xochimilco, Mexico, built in 1958–59, and the 1959 version of F. Kiesler’s Endless House. Candela’s Restaurant Mantiales represents an elaborate thin concrete shell structure; the main form, a rotated Hypar – hyperbolic paraboloid (a non-planar surface in which at any point are two intersecting straight lines) represents a challenge in reconstruction itself without the support of a mathematical formula; in addition its non-conventional selfsupporting structure ultimately removes it from the typical possibilities to be developed under use of regular BIM approaches. Similarly, Kiesler’s Endless House follows in its bio-morphic structure a non-regular architectural form, which demands not only strategic modelling consideration but also understanding of complex geometries in space. Both models were reduced to slightly simpler geometries in order to allow adequate time-management of the course, fig. 2. 3.1.1 Reverse engineering In order to offer best resolution in the surveillance practice, Reverse Engineering (RE) is brought into consideration. RE is a process describing recovery or discovery of technological principles of a mechanical, or in this case architectural, application through analysis of its structure, function and operation, in architecture becomes comparable to a detailed case study. An architectural example can be evaluated and understood through its geometric, structural and technological assets. The procedure further enables understanding of core-principles of generating ruled surfaces and their flexibility as well as applying those principles to fixed parameters derived from the studied object.
Figure 2:
Deriving the Hypar from defining geometries. (Student: D. Rogers).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
834 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII 3.1.2 Versioning After assessment of scope and modelling technique the principle of versioning is introduced and applied in parts. Versioning describes a centralized design methodology with one source object for controlling and tracking and in chosen case studies students are assigned one successfully developed model to generate individual considerations of construction method. 3.2 Implementation Adopting the traditional method of tracing a digital line-drawing of the original architecture, a set of B-Splines and resulting 1/8 segments of NURBS surfaces for the Mantiales model are produced. To reconnect those after the rotational array is itself a transitional step, non-regular surfaces need to be inserted which transform a single a surface ultimately into a polysurface, reducing the flexibility of the system as a whole. Afterwards a cleaner surface can be derived through a lofting procedure from extracted sections and edges, fig. 3.
Figure 3:
Completing the full rotational structure for the Restaurant Mantiales (Student: M. Gonzales).
In the case of Kiesler’s Endless house the geometry is far more complex, tracing efforts to develop boundary curvatures and respectively cross-sectional shapes demand advanced modelling skills. A lofting method of interpolating equally spaced cross sections within the boundary trace-lines for individual pods provides satisfying results. A reduced geometric model of the exterior envelope of Kiesler’s project is developed. The blending of the pod-shapes to one joint shape adds a level of imprecision and deprives the NURBS model of its initial flexibility, fig. 3. Full parametric modelling as offered through Microstation GC might deliver a better, faster product; in current version of the House the time consumption is demanding to fall back on available tools with steep learning curve such as Rhino3D, fig. 4. In both Kiesler’s Endless House and Candela’s Restaurant Mantiales, various approaches in different complexities were repeatedly re-drawn to optimize the base model; these models received further manipulation through individual interpretations and considerations of structural systems through projections onto the surfaces themselves. This initial projections already allow first analysis and WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
835
re-application of different structural systems, which then, through simple sequenced processes of lofting and extruding lead to rudimentary but applicable structural solutions, figs. 5(a), (b). Any additional, engineered input from this point on illustrates the limitations of modelling without scripted environments. Despite the maintained precision, manual input of eventually corrected, structural or material assumptions would require re-adoption in a manual, linear fashion and therefore would add up to potential human error or imprecision as well as consumed time. (a)
(b)
(d)
(c)
Figure 4:
Development of Kiesler’s surface model (a) mesh transformation delivers uncontrollable surface, (b) pod-method generates more accurate solution, (c) pods are merged, (d) an isoparm curve skeleton is derived) (Student: J. Cabreras).
3.3 Results Results vary in quality, but demonstrate initial success of the conceptual state of hot-swapping method in architectural design. The ability to offer a multiplicity of solutions – versioning – in a relatively short time allows affability in material and engineering negotiation, fig. 6.
4 Conclusion: programmer – an architectural specialization Schedule, availability of technical support and architectural challenge remain key-factors for competition of small architectural practices to large offices; displayed approach demonstrates that with some geometric constraints the small
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
836 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
(a)
Figure 5:
(b) (a) Clockwise: (i), (ii) intersections between crossing members are derived manually, a time-consuming process, lacking specific accuracy, (iii) CNC-prototype underplayed the original drawing and (iv) laser-cut structural model (production time incl. file preparation 50 hours) (Students: J. Leong, E. Liu, H. Ming, A. Hernandez); (b) Clockwise (i), (ii) finalization for production, creation of cut-sheets for laser-cutting (student: M. Gonzales), (iii), (iv) Tessellation approach and detailing including tagging of different elements (Student: E. Scott.)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6:
837
Clockwise from top left: different approaches with different Prototypes, shingled surface model with diagonally braced sheet metal frame (Student: T. Vincent), hexagonal structure (Student D. Rogers), cut-sheet for welding mock-up (Student T. Vincent), tessellation model (Student E. Scott) and grid-lattice (Student M. Gonzales).
office is in competition with the traditional large office. However, hot-swapping as technique remains, despite improvements in modelling skills, modelling accuracy and software advancement, a prerogative of designers with adequate programming skills and education. Real-time events, as Axel Kilian points out, require programming of these events so that the computational event takes place during its calculated execution [6]. Common affordable and available software packages currently does not provide this commodity in other form than indigenous scripting language; scripting itself supports customization of software which does not inherently support enough flexibility in its command structure and can therefore be seen as a reverse approach itself. Software designed for architects seems to gear more towards implementing industry standards rather than generating a desirable tool for architectural design. Education itself and its accreditation systems abandon vital elements for at least allowing students to customize the appropriated software; neither descriptive geometry nor programming skills are enforced. Therefore educators are forced to rather comply with standards initiated by software producers and industry, than to represent a contributing element to the industry itself. Respectively, a small practice cannot currently take full advantage of new trends in architecture, due to the budget and schedule challenges for employment of specialists and the rigid hierarchy in construction business. Given the current climate of academic education in architecture programs and the lack of substantial pre-education in computing skills, the course is partially used to examine success and failure of the system in parts. Building Information Modelling appears to offer desirable appeal to such structures, relying on the safe implementation of established construction methods and materials. Alternative routes, as demonstrated in examples by practices of Frank O. Gehry Associates and ONL become showcases and demonstrate the position of corporation versus academia; academia is currently coerced to follow the lead of few successful WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
838 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII large practices an their techniques. Knowledge and understanding of engineering, industrial production sequences, explicit computational and geometric training simplify the architectural and respectively digital production process and would further allow architectural academia structures to regain its position as informant educator.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6]
Supported by a grant from the College of Environmental Design, California State Polytechnic University. Oosterhuis K, The Architect’s new Data-Driven Practice (Chapter 3). Hyperbodies, Towards an E-motive Architecture, Birkhaeuser: Basel, Boston, Berlin, pp7-10, 2003. De Landa, M.l, Philosophies of Design, The Case of Modelling Software, Verb Processing, Actar: Barcelona, 2001. Oosterhuis, K., Building Bodies (chapter 7), Hyperbodies, Towards an Emotive Architecture, Birkhaeuser: Basel, Boston, Berlin, pp 17-22,2003. Oosterhuis, K., Bier, H. Aalbers, C., Boer, S., Programmable Architecture, Proc. of ACADIA 23, Fabrication, pp 3-5, Cambridge and Toronto, Ontario, Canada, 2004. Kilian, A., The Importance of Programming, Defining Digital Space Through a Visual Language, p 13, Master of Sciences Thesis, Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Department of Architecture, 2000, http://destech.mit.edu/akilian/newscreens/thesis2000/pdfversion.PDF
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 11 Advances in measurements and experiments
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
841
Development of advanced instrumentation for operational oceanography G. Zappalà CNR IAMC, Messina, Italy
Abstract Operational oceanography is an applied science requiring new instrumentation to perform cost effective surveys. The use of XBT probes from Voluntary Observing Ships is a good way to obtain temperature profiles, but it is limited by the cost of the probes and of the operators on board. An automatic multiple XBT launcher was developed, to work unattended and be recharged by a crew member, without the need for a technician. Keywords: operational oceanography, marine monitoring, XBT, voluntary observing ships.
1
Introduction
The assessment of environmental conditions requires a series of measurements, with a good spatial and temporal resolution. The high cost and limits of traditional oceanographic surveys stimulate the use of new techniques to obtain a proper coverage. So, traditional moorings and oceanographic cruises are complemented with autonomous devices (e.g. drifters and gliders) and with the use of "ships of opportunity". In the framework of the EU funded "Mediterranean ocean Forecasting System Toward Environmental Prediction" (MFSTEP), several experiences were performed both in the use and in the development of advanced instrumentation. Started in 1999 as a part of the "Mediterranean ocean Forecasting System Pilot Project" (MFSPP), a Voluntary Observing Ship (VOS) program is still collecting temperature XBT profiles along seven Mediterranean transects, designed to study, in each of the sub-basins (the Algero-Provençal, the Tyrrhenian, the south Adriatic, the Ionian and the Levantine), the variability of the main circulation features [1]. Although less expensive than dedicated oceanographic cruises, the WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070821
842 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII use of commercial ships to launch XBT probes requires however the presence of one or more technicians on board the ship, with the related costs. In order to obtain cheaper operations, an automatic device was designed, to launch unattended up to eight probes, easy enough to be recharged by a member of the crew.
2
Materials and methods
An XBT probe has the shape of a small missile, contained in a plastic canister with an overall length of 36 centimetres and external diameter of 7 centimetres; its weight is about 1200 grams. The temperature sensor is a precision thermistor enclosed in the lead nose; the electrical wire to connect it to the measuring system is contained in two spools, one in the plastic body of the probe and the other one in the canister, that also hosts on its back the electrical connections towards the data acquisition system. Traditional use of XBT (expendable bathy-thermograph) probes implies the presence of a technician on board the ship to manually perform the "launch". The plastic canister is inserted in a hand-held "gun"; pressing the trigger the probe is released; while the probe falls into water, the wire inside it starts unreeling. The wire unreels also from the spool in the canister, compensating the movement of the ship and allowing the probe to freefall from the sea surface down to several hundred meters depth. A data acquisition board connected to a computer controls the measurement; when the wire breaks, the profile is completed and the system can be prepared for another launch. The nominal accuracy of the probe is 0,1°C. The depth is estimated as a function of time, using a formula of the kind Z(t)=At-Bt2. Acquired data can be transmitted using satellite or GSM-GPRS modems.
3
The automatic multiple launcher
The new system is an integrated set of mechanical and electronic hardware and software programs offering the maximum of flexibility. 3.1 The mechanical hardware Heart of the mechanical hardware is the launch tube, built in AISI 316 steel, in which the probe is fitted with its envelope. An upper cap, holding the electrical connections of the probe, closes the launch tube; opening the lower door the probe is released and falls into seawater. Two pneumatic cylinders control the door: a small one keeps it closed acting as a safety lock also in case of pressure loss, a bigger one moves it. In the actual MFS-VOS design, the system assembles on a frame eight launch tubes with their pneumatic actuators (fig. 1). A small compressor supplies compressed air to the system, keeping a reserve of 5 litres at 6 bar; a filtered pressure regulator is mounted to prevent damages to the pneumatic system.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
843
A close-up view of two launch cylinders with the pneumatic actuators.
Two versions of the launcher were built: the first to work hanged outboard the ship, the second to stay inboard, on a deck. Fig. 2 (left) shows the "outboard" version, and (right) the inboard one, mounting a funnel with a pipe to drive probes outboard.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
844 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
Figure 3:
The two versions of the multiple launcher.
The watertight boxes containing the electro-pneumatic valves (left) and the control computer (right).
Two watertight boxes host respectively the electro-pneumatic valves feeding the cylinders and the computerized control system (fig. 3). 3.2 The control computer hardware and software The control computer hardware and software are enhanced versions of those formerly designed to be used in environmental monitoring networks, described by Zappalà [2]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
845
3.2.1 The electronic hardware All operations are coordinated by an industrial grade Pentium computer, based on IEEE 696 compliant boards, interfaced with GPS, data acquisition and communication devices (fig. 4). Both analog and digital interfaces are available, to collect data coming from the most various devices (passive and active expendable probes, meteo sensors...). GSM -GPRS
SATELLITE
GPS
MODEM(S)
MODEM
RECEIVER OPERATOR CONSOLE
CONTROL ELECTRONICS AND DATA ACQUISITION SYSTEM
LAPTOP PC
POWER ACTUATORS
MULTIPLE LAUNCHER
Figure 4:
ANALOG AND DIGITAL INPUTS FROM PROBES AND SHIP SENSORS
Block diagram of the control computer and of the data acquisition and transmission system.
Remote communications are performed using a GPRS modem with an embedded TCP-IP stack; a serial port is available to connect other communication devices (e.g. satellite modems), but also other communications systems could be used. A balanced source circuit (fig. 5) was designed to interface standard passive temperature probes with 12 or 16 bit Analog to Digital Converters (ADC). Two equal currents are injected in both the wires coming from the probe and the potentials VA and VB are measured; the circuit is closed by the sea water to which the circuit is "grounded" through the ship's hull; the switch SW1 (a relay contact) allows to test the continuity of the probe circuit before the launch. The use of sea water as a third wire is necessary because of the high variability in the wire resistance also in probes belonging to the same production lot. Applying Ohm's law, we obtain the voltage across the wires, the thermistor and the fictitious resistor constituted by the sea water multiplying their resistance by the flowing current. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
846 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Sw1
I1
I2
Rballast
Rballast
A
x1 x2
B
Rwire1
Vw1
A
Vth
Vw2
Rwire2
to ADC B
x1
Vsea Rthermistor Rsea
Figure 5:
The schematics of the probe interface board.
Assuming we can write:
I 1 = I2 = I Rwire1 = Rwire2 = Rwire Vsea = Rsea x 2 I Vw1 = Rwire x I Vw2 = Rwire x I Vw1 = Vw2 = Vw Vth = Rth x I VA = Vsea + Vw VB = Vsea + Vth + Vw VB = VA + Vth
So, VA is the sum of the voltage across Rwire1 and Rsea (the resistance of sea water), VB is the sum of the voltage across Rwire2, Rthermistor and Rsea. The voltage across the thermistor is obtained subtracting VA from VB. To avoid any perturbation to the measurement, a multiple stage amplifier was used to adapt the signal coming from the probe to the need of the ADC; the circuit was built using high quality precision instrumentation amplifier ICs. The first stage uses unity gain configuration, having high input and low output impedance; the second stage is a differential amplifier with gain = 2; the third stage is a low output impedance low-pass filter with gain= 1 and ft = 40 Hz. Ten times a second, the mean of 16 (VB-VA) measurements is calculated; the resistance of the thermistor is obtained using Ohm's law, or, better, using the regression coefficients obtained after calibration of the circuit against a set of standard high precision resistors. The measured temperature is finally obtained using the standard formula by Steinhart and Hart [3]: T = -273.15 + {1 / [A + (B x ln R) + C x (ln R)3]} where: A = 1.29502 × 10-3, B = 2.34546 × 10-4, and C = 9.9434 × 10-8. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
847
The constants were determined empirically from laboratory tests of XBT thermistors [4]. 3.2.2 The software A local and a remote control programs were developed, able to manage 96 launch events. Launch options are: • northern than a defined latitude • southern than a defined latitude • eastern than a defined longitude • western than a defined longitude • far from a previous launch • at GPS time • at PC time Collected data are locally stored and can be transmitted as e-mails. The local control program was written in Microsoft Compiled Basic v. 7.1 and runs in Datalight DOS environment. Assembly language routines are used to manage the Analog to Digital Converter. This program, executed on the launcher control computer, is able to control all the launcher functions, i.e. real time and position acquisition, comparison against set points-times, launch, data acquisition and transmission, ancillary functions. Every hour, a “sequence manager” starts a macro-command sequence, that can be different for each time and is remotely reprogrammable; new releases of the software and of the sequences are uploadable to the station without suspending its normal activity. The macro-commands enable to manage the data acquisition and transmission, the mission programming, the station hardware and the measuring instruments. The entire system can be connected to a computer (local laptop or remote desktop), in order to use a remote control program (fig. 6), written in Microsoft Visual Basic, running in Windows environment. This program enables to set up all the launcher functionalities, prepare launch event sequences, transfer files to and from the launcher, and, if needed, to take control of all the launcher operations, including the time-position acquisition and comparison.
4
Tests
The automatic multiple launcher was tested in laboratory and during two short cruises. The in situ tests were performed in March 2006 using the Italian Hydrographic Institute vessel Magnaghi and in June 2006 with the ENEA boat S. Teresa, in the Ligurian Sea – North western Mediterranean. During these tests, data was recorded with the multiple launcher to verify the efficiency of the whole system (hardware and software), and, for comparison, XBT probes were launched with a standard Sippican system (hand launcher LM 3A, MK21 readout card). Figure 7 shows some profiles obtained by the multiple launcher. Temperature values measured with reference systems demonstrate the high quality of the multiple launcher profiles. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
848 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 6: °C
13
15
A screenshot of the remote control software. 17
19
21
23
25
-10
-60
-110
-160
-210
-260
-310
Figure 7:
Profiles obtained with the multiple launcher.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
27
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
849
Discussion and conclusions
Figure 8 shows the multiple launcher installed on the Magnaghi ship, assuring safety to operators and undisturbed operations. The use of a multiple launcher improves the cost effectiveness of an operational observing system. Working in the Mediterranean Sea with commercial ships, it is necessary to launch a probe every 20-30 minutes to obtain a good spatial resolution of the mesoscale phenomena on sections several hundreds of miles long, lasting up to 24-36 hours. So, using the manual launcher, at least two technicians are needed, with a cost up to 2000 USD for each travel; using the automatic launcher, it is possible to avoid this cost, or at least halve it, engaging one person only. The small number of electric and mechanic components reduces the risks of malfunctions; the remote control capability enhances the flexibility of the instrument and allows real time operations. The system proved its reliability and is open to further developments and improvements to be used with other expendable probes (XCTDs, T-FLAPs...).
Figure 8:
The multiple launcher installed on the deck of the Magnaghi ship.
Acknowledgements The activity was funded in the frame of the MFSTEP project, 5th EU FP. The Author acknowledges the support provided by N. Pinardi and G. Coppini. The work of technicians during these years has provided the necessary information for the design. The Author thanks G. Manzella and F. Reseghetti for the useful suggestions and A. Baldi and F. Conte from ENEA, for their technical support.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
850 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1]
[2]
[3] [4]
Pinardi, N., Allen, I., Demirov, E., DeMey, P., Korres, G., Lascaratos, A., LeTraon, P.Y. Maillard, C., Manzella, G., Tziavos, C., The Mediterranean ocean Forecasting System: first phase of implementation (1998 - 2001). Ann. Geophys., 21, pp. 3-20, 2003. Zappalà, G.: A software for environment monitoring networks, Proc. of the 10th Int. Conf. On the Development and Application of Computer Techniques to Environmental Studies, eds. G. Latini, G. Passerini & C.A. Brebbia, WIT Press: Southampton, pp. 3-12, 2004. Steinhart, J. S., Hart, S. R., Calibration curves for thermistors, Deep-Sea Research 15, pp. 497-503, 1968. Georgi, D. T., Dean, J. P., Chase, J. A., Temperature calibration of expendable bathy-thermographs, Ocean Engineering, 7, pp. 491-499, 1980.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
851
In-situ measurement of formwork pressures generated by Self-Compacting Concrete M. M. Giammatteo, A. Gregori & G. Totani Department of Civil Engineering, L’Aquila University, Italy
Abstract Self-Compacting Concretes (SCC) are a special category of concretes and directions for designing formwork relative to ordinary concretes do not apply to them. In this paper an experimental study on formwork pressure exerted by SCC is reported. The behaviour of the SCC was investigated in instrumented formworks provided for two different types of pressure sensors: common diaphragm pressure transducers and dilatometer cells. In situ measurements of formwork pressure were carried out on walls and concrete columns 6m and 9m high, 0.30m thick and 2.50 or 0.50m wide respectively. Successfully, both types of sensor were in agreement describing the continuous time variation of the pressures. Keywords: in-situ measurements, self-compacting concrete, formwork pressures, dilatometer cells.
1
Introduction
The horizontal pressure exerted by ordinary plastic concretes is generally calculated as a function of many parameters: final height and casting rate, vibration method, temperature of the environment and of the concrete, nominal dimension and shape of the aggregate, consistency of fresh concrete, setting time, typology of the additives used, formwork’s shape. Currently, design purposes for ordinary concrete are various, but the resulting pressure diagrams along the casting height are relatively unvarying (CIRIA [1], ACI [2]). Unfortunately, recommendations for designing formworks relative to ordinary concretes do not apply to Self-Compacting Concrete (SCC) which represents a relatively new technology developed in Japan since the 1980s (Ozawa et al. [3]). Driven by their own weight, SCCs quickly flow in the formwork and reach an optimum compaction degree without the need for vibration, also in case of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070831
852 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII heavily reinforced structures and/or of a narrow cross section. Saving in manpower is provided and noise pollution is reduced, improving working condition. Apart from the large use in the precast industry, a certain number of technical issues have slowed down its use in cast-in-place applications, in particular due to the lack of knowledge on the lateral pressure that such concrete can exert on formwork systems. In fact, directions for designing formworks relative to ordinary concretes do not apply to SCC, for which the design recommendation to design formwork for full hydrostatic pressure (fluid density of 2400kg/m3) drastically increases the cost of constructions made of SCC [4]. There are indications, however, confirming the possibility of saving considerable amounts of money when constructing formwork for SCC, because data of pressures measured both in the laboratory (Assaad and Khayat [5, 6]) and in the field (Skarendahl [7], Brameshuber and Uebachs [8], Billberg [9]) often resulted to be lower than hydrostatic. When measured SCC formwork pressure were found to be in agreement with the hydrostatic hypothesis, this behaviour from the concrete was mainly attributed to the effect of relatively high casting rates that, however, not always were higher than in other case with SCC behaving differently. The reason for so wide a range of literature results is still not clear, therefore extensive campaigns of experimental measurements are required for the validation of new predicting models. Various techniques have already been adopted, so far, to enquire the concrete behaviour into formwork. Pressure gauges and other alternative devices are often used for investigation curried out in form of experimental size tests and on reduced scale column of concrete cast and monitored into a laboratory. These approaches usually require delicate equipments conceptually more rigorous than other techniques that are more robust, maybe less sensitive but more appropriate for the field. In this second situation, monitoring the stress in the formwork anchors can already provide an indirect measure of the pressure exerted by the concrete (Brameshuber and Uebachs [8]). Although diaphragm pressure transducers have also been used in both the cases of laboratory and field measurements, the use of such kinds of devices has been criticized by Amziane et al. [10], Amziane [11] and Andriamantsilavo and Amziane [12]. They observed that, under the pressure of the fluid (liquid or gas), the membrane of a pressure transducer deforms and produces a variation in both the sensor wire resistance and the output voltage. This, however, makes unsure whether the measurement method suits hardening materials, like concrete, in the setting process. In fact, when the material is setting, the deformation of the transducers diaphragm due to the flow of freshly mixed materials, indeed, is not reversible, although no pressure is applied anymore. Consequently, a displacement controlled procedure can represent the most reliable technique for monitoring the concrete formwork pressures that, eventually, are influenced by the material setting. These authors, therefore, proposed an alternative method based on the balance of zero measurement procedure. Their apparatus, however, results to be as accurate as delicate, making the equipment not suitable for in situ measurement of formwork pressure. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
853
On the other hand, the same working principle is adopted by dilatometer cells that are currently used, in the geotechnical field, to conduct measures of lateral pressures in the ground (Flat Dilatometer Tests, DMT) (Marchetti [13], Marchetti et al. [14]). The apparatus, as described ahead, is so robust that is usually pushed for many meters deep into ground, being also insensitive to difficulties related to electric power supply (no needed), unstable signals, humidity, dusty etc. This makes the use of dilatometer cells an interesting option for appropriate descriptions of how the lateral pressure on formwork increases during the concreting and decreases with the material setting. In this paper, data of formwork pressure recorded by using this special technique were compared with those recorded by diaphragm pressure transducers, showing that dilatometer cells represent a reliable and easier alternative to more expensive way to measure formwork pressure.
2
Experimental investigation
The behaviour of various commercial SCC mixtures in the formworks was investigated performing in situ measurements of formwork pressure. The cast of real concrete elements took place in formworks designed for casting heights of 6 and 9m respectively. Effect on pressure due to different structural shapes was investigate comparing the case of walls and column measuring 2.50m and 0.50m in wideness and 0.30m in thickness. Formworks were instrumented disposing several diaphragm pressure transducers along their height: closer each other at the bottom part of the structure and gradually more spaced going up along the middle span of the main vertical facade. A picture of the wall formwork system is given in Fig. 1 together with the precise position of the sensors. In addition to pressure transducers, also alternative devices (named dilatometer cells) were applied, for the first time, for measuring formwork pressure in the construction field. Their description is given in the next section. Four of these cells were attached to the instrumented wall formwork system, all aligned at the horizontal level of 1.10m from the bottom of the cast. This provided redundancy in the acquisitions, and the mean of four measurements was assumed as value of the concrete formwork pressure at that level. This value was than compared with the readings from the pressure transducers mounted immediately above and below the four cells alignment. Pore water pressure in concrete mass was also detected, and a specific measuring devise was properly designed for this task. Two of this pore water pressure measuring devices were mounted, one for each side of the formwork, at the level of 1.10m from the structure bottom. The mean of the two readings was assumed as value of pore water pressure at that depth. Lateral pressures exerted by the tested SCCs were monitored during the filling of the formwork and for several hours after the end of the casting. Effect of various casting rate on concrete formwork pressure was investigate by repeating tests at different speeds. The adopted filling rates ranged from 3m/h to 12m/h. Due to the limited amount of concrete required for a test, and according to the mixing and pumping truck limitations, low values of the casting rate were respected dividing the cast in layers and suspending the discharge of WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
854 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII the concrete between a layer and the next. Height of these layers was fixed in 1m. Measurements of formwork pressure were carried out right after the discharge of any layer and repeated right before the cast of the next.
775
75
300
75
850
75
700
75
625
75
550
75
475
Figure 1:
300 250 200 150 100 50
25
25 50 50 50 50 50 50 50
600
400 350
25
Wall casting and sensors positions.
2.1 The dilatometer cell In the geotechnical field, dilatometer cells are known for being used in Flat Dilatometer Tests (DMT). They provide measures of pressure according to a displacement control procedure (Marchetti [13], Marchetti et al. [14] and Totani et al. [15]). Bigger, more robust and easier to be used than diaphragm pressure transducers, this type of sensors (Fig. 2a) consist in a 60mm diameter circular steel membrane (0.2mm in thickness) that, as result of an applied internal gas pressure, expands into the material which pressure has to be measured. The cells were attached to the formwork with its membrane being flush with the inside formwork surface. The in-situ test layout is given in Fig. 2b: the cell is connected to a control unit by a pneumatic-electrical tube transmitting the gas pressure and the electrical continuity. A gas tank, connected to the control unit by a pneumatic cable, supplies the gas pressure required to expand the membrane. The working principle of the cell is illustrated in Fig. 3a. During the pressure measurement, the dilatometer cell works as an electric switch (on/off). First the external lateral pressure keeps the membrane touching the cell body and the control unit emits a sound (circuit close). Now the operator starts increasing the internal pressure and, for some time, the membrane does not move and remains in contact with its WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
855
metal support (signal on). When the internal pressure counterbalance the external concrete pressure, the membrane starts moving and loses contact with its support (signal off). This causes the interruption of the signal and sound stops, so prompting the operator to read on the manometer (Fig. 3b) the “liftoff” lateral pressure.
steel membrane formwork system
Dilatometer cells (back side)
pneumatic cable cell body
control unit
gas tank
pneumatic cable
(a) Figure 2:
(a) Detail of a dilatometer pressure cell; (b) general layout of the in situ dilatometer test method.
(a) Figure 3:
(b)
(b)
(a) Dilatometer cell working principle; (b) control unit: manometers for pressure reading.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
856 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Due to the balance of zero pressure measurement method (null method), the dilatometer cell readings are highly accurate (1/20bar = 5kPa). Moreover, the entire equipment can measure values of pressure as high as 10MPa and over. 2.2 Self-Compacting Concrete mixtures Two SCC mixtures were tested. The basic combinations of ingredients, called Mixture A and B respectively, are indicated in table 1. Table 1: Materials Sand (0 – 6mm) Coarse aggregate (7 – 15mm) Portland Cement (32,5) Filler Superplasticizer Viscosity modifying agent Water/Cement Water/Binder
SCC mixtures dosages. kg kg kg kg lt lt
Mixture A 974 650 355 170 8.88 1.00 0.52 0.35
Mixture B 916 721 400 146 10.00 1.50 0.41 0.30
In order to maintain the desired condition of fluidity and prevent slump loss, use of different chemical admixtures where required (superplasticizers and set retarding). Several tests were first performed on Mixture A, and later on mixture B, this last designed to have similar fresh property than in case A with a reduced water/binder ratio from 0.35 to 0.30. Compared to mixture A, thixotropic behaviour of mixture B should be so increased and, consequently, lateral pressure exerted on formwork potentially reduced. An example of the SCC fluid behaviour is given in Fig. 4, were the concrete slump flow is being measured after the Abrams cone test.
Figure 4:
Abrams cone test: SCC slump flow.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
857
Results and discussion
Tests were performed on different days. Collected data of formwork pressure are exposed by graphs indicating the evolution of the lateral pressure during the filling of the formwork and after the casting end. Fig. 5 shows data of formwork pressures collected during the cast of a 6m high wall performed at the casting rate of 12m/h. Mixture A was used with a slump flow diameter of 620mm. SCC was found to behave in a perfect hydraulic way, maybe due to the combined effect of the set-retarding agent incorporated in the mix and the relatively high casting rate adopted. Broken lines in Fig. 5 highlight that also when DMT measures (star dots in the graph) did not overlap the pressure profile indicated by the transducers, data kept maintaining the alignment with the pressure transducers readings made immediately over and below the dilatometer cells level. This indicates that DMT technique can result in a reduced data scattering compared with use of common diaphragm pressure transducers.
C asting height [cm ]
700
DMT
600
1m
500
3m
2m
4m
400
5m
300
6m Hydraulic
200 100 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.2
1.4
Pressure [bar]
Figure 5:
Formwork pressure profiles during the cast of a 6m high wall adopting Mixture A. Casting rate 12m/h.
Formwork pressures were recorded for several minutes after the casting end as well. Pressure profile was found to reduce quite fast with time (Fig. 6). This suggests that adoption of lower casting rate values can help reducing the initial formwork pressure. In both Figs. 5 and 6, a perfect agreement can be seen between readings of formwork pressure collected by the diaphragm pressure transducers and the dilatometer cells respectively. DMT technique confirmed good performances and consistency also in different cases of in situ measurements of SCC formwork pressures. Also data collected on column shape structures instead of wall structures showed that readings of pressure curried out by dilatometer cells are fast and reliable and always in good agreement with those performed by the diaphragm pressure transducers. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
858 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII A last experiment was carried out monitoring the cast of a 9m high wall built at the casting rate of 4m/h. Mixture B was used adopting a slump flow diameter of 680mm. According to references Ferron et al. [16] and Gregori et al. [17], reduction in water and increase in superplasticizer dosages enhanced the thixotropyc behaviour of concrete. As expected, this provided some benefit on formwork pressures that, in fact, were found to deviate from the hydrostatic hypothesis already several meters before the casting end. Figure 7 shows that Mixture B maintained a perfect fluid behavior until the concrete level into formwork did not exceed 5m in height. hydrostatic pressures
C asting height [cm ]
700 600
pressures profile at the casting end 48 min after
500
80 min after 105 min after
400
DMT
300 200 100 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.4
1.2
Pressure [bar]
Figure 6:
Evolution of the formwork pressure profile with time after the end of the cast.
1000
Mixture B Formwork Pressure Profiles During the Cast of a 9 m High Wall (slump flow =680mm; casting rate v=4m/h)
900
DMT
height of the cast (cm)
800
1m 2m 3m 5m 6m 7m
700 600 500
8m 9m hydraulic pressure
400 300
pore water pressure
Dilatometer cells level
200 100 0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2
2.2
pressure (bar)
Figure 7:
Formwork pressures growth during the cast of a 9 m high wall using Mixture B. Adopted casting rate: 4 m/h.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
859
Keep casting above this level, formwork pressures stopped to grow at the bottom of the structure where, at the end of the casting, only 50% of the hydraulic pressure was measured. Data in the graph highlight that formwork pressure measured by diaphragm pressure transducers and dilatometer cells were in good agreement confirming this particular concrete behaviour. Pore water pressures in the concrete mass were also measured. At any stage of the concrete casting, response of the measuring apparatus to the variations of pore water pressure resulted instantaneous. The mean of two readings, taken at 1m from the bottom on both sides of the formwork, is indicated in Fig. 7 with blue dot signs. It can be noted that, according with laboratory results concerning simple cement pastes (Andriamanantsilavo and Amziane [12]), also in situ measurements of pore water pressures in concrete were found to be identical to the total lateral stress on formworks.
4
Conclusions
In this paper, results from an experimental campaign of study carried out in the construction field were reported. Lateral pressures exerted by different SCC mixtures were monitored in situ by use of instrumented formworks. Two different methods for measuring concrete formwork pressure were compared. Pore water pressure measurements in concrete mass were also curried out: specific devices designed and built on purpose were applied. Although intense work still have to be done in order to provide complete models for predicting SCC formwork pressures, the following main conclusions can be drawn: Lateral pressures exerted by fresh concrete into formwork can be monitored according to several approaches. Use of diaphragm pressure transducers can provide accurate description of the total lateral pressures profile along the formwork height. Formwork pressures decay due to the concrete setting is also detectable by the transducers. Electro-working devices, however, are usually delicate and expensive, requiring special cares to be managed and used in situ. Dusty, humidity and mechanical shocks are all undesired factors representing hindrances to a their direct application in the construction field. In alternative to diaphragm pressure transducers, DMT system represents a robust, cheap and sensitive technique able to provide high reliable in situ measures of concrete formwork pressures. In addition, also building cost of pore water measuring devices is relatively low. They have been used already for a long time in the geotechnical field, and here it has been proved that they can provide correct measures of the concrete formwork pressure in situ.
References [1] CIRIA (Civil Industries Research and Information Association); The pressure of concrete on formwork, Research Report No. 1, London, 1965. [2] ACI Committee 347-01. Guide to Formwork for Concrete, American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, MI, 32 pp., 2001. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
860 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [3] Ozawa, K., Naekawa, K., Kunishima, M. & Okamura, H., Development of high-performance concrete based on the durability design of concrete structures, Proc. 2nd East Asia and Pacific Conference on Structural Engineering and Construction (EASEC-2), pp. 445-450, 1989. [4] ACI Committee 347R-03. Guide to Formwork for Concrete, American Concrete Institute, Farmington Hills, MI, 32 pp., 2004. [5] Assaad, J. & Khayat, K.H., Effect of Coarse Aggregate Characteristics on Lateral pressure Exerted by Self-Consolidating Concrete, ACI Material Journal, V. 102, No. 3, pp. 145-153, 2005. [6] Assaad, J. & Khayat, K.H., Formwork Pressure of Self-Consolidating Concrete Made with Various Binder Types and Contents, ACI Material Journal, V. 102, No. 4, pp. 215-223, 2005. [7] Skarendahl, A., Self-Compacting Concrete for Improved Productivity, Working Environment, and Performance, IREX-Meeting, Paris, 12 pp, 1999. [8] Brameshuber, W. & Uebachs, S., Investigations on the Formwork Pressure Using Self-Compacting Concrete, 3rd International Symposium on SelfCompacting Concrete, Reykjavik, Iceland, pp. 281-287, 2003. [9] Billberg, P., Form Pressure Generated by Self-Compacting Concrete, 3rd International Symposium on Self-Compacting Concrete, 3rd International Symposium on Self-Compacting Concrete, Reykjavik, Iceland, pp. 271-280, 2003. [10] Amziane, S., Andriamanantsilavo, N.R. & Bandeau, P., An Experimental Study on the Pressure of Cement Based Materials Against Formwork, 15th ASCE Engineering Mechanics Conference, Columbia University, New York, NY, 8 pp., 2002. [11] Amziane, S., Setting Time Determination of Cementitious Materials Based on Measurements of the Hydraulic Pressure Variations, Cement and Concrete Research, 2005. [12] Andriamanantsilavo, N.R. & Amziane, S., Maturation of fresh Cement Paste Within 1 to 10m Large Formwork, Cement and Concrete Research 34, pp. 2141-2152, 2004. [13] Marchetti, S., In Situ Tests by Flat Dilatometer, ASCE Journal GED, Vol. 106, No. GT3, pp. 299-321, 1980. [14] Marchetti, S., Monaco, P., Totani, G. & Calabrese, M., The flat dilatometer test (DMT) in soil investigations, Report by the ISSMGE Committee TC16, Proc. of the 2nd Int. Conf. on the Flat Dilatometer, Washington, D.C., pp. 848, 2006. [15] Totani, G., Calabrese, M. & Monaco, P., Shaft resistance of piles driven in clay: field study of an instrumented full scale pile. Workshop in Pile foundations experimental investigations, analysis and design, Napoli, Italy, pp. 199-253, 1994. [16] Ferron, R., Gregori, A., Sun, Z. & Shah, S. P., Rheological method to evacuate structural build-up in SCC cement pastes, ACI Materials Journal, publication in press. [17] Gregori, A., Ferron, R., Sun, Z. & Shah, S. P., Experimental simulation of SCC formwork pressure, ACI Materials Journal, publication in progress. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
861
Evaluation of phenolic resins from one-pot microwave synthesis A. Britten, M. M. MacIntyre & A. Miadonye Department of Chemistry, Cape Breton University, Sydney, NS, Canada
Abstract The characteristics of oxalic acid catalyzed phenolic resins, synthesized using the conventional heating method and by a one-pot microwave process, were evaluated and compared. Phenolic resins were produced in an autoclave with reflux times of 3, 5 and 7 hours, and by one-pot microwave synthesis at different power levels (176.364, 315.092, 453.820, 592.548W) for reaction times of 15–90 minutes. UV-vis spectroscopy and FT-IR analyses showed similarities in the characteristics of the resins synthesized by both methods. Concentration of residual phenol in the products decreased with reaction time. For the conventional method the decrease in phenol after an initial 3hrs of reaction were 4.3% (in 5hrs) and 22.3% (7hrs), while in microwave synthesis at a power level of 176.364W and an initial reaction time of 30mins the phenol decreased by 33.05% (in 60mins) and 91.61% (in 90mins). At a power level of 315.092W and an reaction time of 15mins it decreased by 36.3% (in 20mins), 16.5% (in 25mins) and 10.8% (in 30mins). For resins from the conventional method, melting points increased with increasing reaction time 83oC, 97oC and 109oC for respectively 3hrs, 5hrs and 7hrs, and between 95oC and 103oC for resins from the microwave method at various power levels and reaction times. The FT-IR spectra analyses for the products showed strong similarity in characteristics, while the melting point data supported the GC-MS results that for the conventional method mostly the degree of polymerization depends on reaction time. The substitution of phenol with cresol results in resins with improved hardness and melting points, but these differences were not obvious in the spectral characteristics. It was also observed that for the conventional heating method the melting points of the CF pre-polymers produced were higher than those of the PF prepolymers (119ºC and 127ºC for 3hr and 5hr CF). One-pot microwave synthesis was found to reduce the polymerization time significantly and produced resins with shorter gel times. Closest similarities in characteristics were found between resins heated in an autoclave for 7hrs and the resins made by one-pot microwave synthesis at reduced reaction times. Keywords: phenolic resins, microwave synthesis, GC-MS, FT-IR spectroscopy, prepolymers, condensation polymerization. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070841
862 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
Phenolic resins, like other thermosetting resins, are very important because their use as engineering materials is increasing rapidly due to their good mechanical properties, high hardness, and excellent stability at high temperatures [1]. Traditionally, phenolic resins are synthesized by step-growth polymerization in an autoclave from phenol or substituted phenols with formaldehyde. The type of resin synthesized depends on the catalyst and the mole ratio of phenol to formaldehyde. The catalyst can be acid, base or neutral divalent metal such as Co, Mg, Zn, Cu or Ni. Figure 1 displays the reaction for the acid catalyzed formation of phenol formaldehyde (PF) which involves the hydrolysis of formaldehyde to methyl glycol. Phenolic resins prepared under acidic conditions are known as novolak, while resins prepared under basic conditions are called resoles [2–4]. Microwave chemistry applies microwave irradiation to chemical synthesis. Recent developments in microwave chemistry have provided scientists with a method of organic synthesis that is more efficient than traditional heating. Microwaves are a form of electromagnetic energy with wavelengths between 300-300,000 megahertz (MHz). Molecular rotation is a property that is affected within this region of electromagnetic spectrum however, molecular structure is not. Samples can be heated using microwave irradiation due to the wave-material interactions. These interactions transform electromagnetic energy from the microwave into heat through dipole rotation or ionic conduction. An important advantage that microwave-assisted organic synthesis has over conventional heating methods is that samples are heated rapidly in a homogeneous manner. Homogeneous heating creates higher yields and faster reaction times. This type of heating occurs in microwave synthesis because heat is generated within the reaction medium rather than being transferred from an external source [5–7]. OH
OH + 2n H2C O
n
H3O+
H2C
OH
CH2
(CH2)6N4
H2C
CH2
HMTL
n CH2
Phenol
Formaldehyde
Figure 1:
2
A-stage resin
n
C-stage resin
Typical reactions for formation of phenol-formaldehyde [2].
Experimental
2.1 Materials The reagents used for the synthesis were formaldehyde solution (36.5 – 38% v/v) from VWR International, loose phenol crystals, oxalic acid from Fisher Scientific Company and liquid m-cresol (99% purity) from Alfa Aesar. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
863
2.2 Resin synthesis Acid catalyzed phenol-formaldehyde (PF) and cresol formaldehyde (CF) prepolymers were synthesized using molar ratios of phenol or cresol to formaldehyde of 1: 0.8. The PF prepolymers were produced in autoclave with constant stirring and reaction times of 3, 5 and 7 hours. They were also produced by one-pot microwave synthesis at different power levels (PL): 176.364W (PL1), 315.092W (PL3), 453.82W (PL5), and 592.548W (PL7), for reaction times ranging from 15-90 minutes. The CF prepolymers were synthesized in autoclave with constant stirring for reflux times of 3 and 5 hours. 2.3 Resins analysis The Fourier transformed infrared spectroscopy (FT-IR) of the resins was obtained with a Nicolet spectroscopy, model 6700. The analysis conditions were 500 – 4000 cm-1 spectral range, 10 scans, and a resolution of 4cm-1. The samples were ground and vacuum pressed on KBr pellets of approximately 1mm thick. The determination of residual phenol in the resins were made with uv-vis spectroscopy by phenol absorbance method. Figure 2 shows a plot of uv absorbance determined for the molar concentration of phenol in aqueous solution. The plot used as reference source for the evaluation of residual phenol in the resins. 2
Absorbance
1.6
1.2
0.8
0.4
0 0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
Concentration (mol/L)
Figure 2:
UV Absorbance versus concentration of phenol in aqueous solution.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
864 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Gas Chromatography Mass Spectrometry (GC-MS) using an ICB-WAX 30m x 0.25mm ID x 0.25µm film column (J & K Scientific, Milton, Ont., Canada) was used to monitor phenol residues. GC conditions were: initial oven temperature 80oC, hold 1min, and then 20oC/min to 250oC; injector temperature 225oC; MS interface temperature 280oC. Phenol eluted at 6.6min. Chromatographic Total Ion Current (TIC) peak height and peak area were used for quantification. 250
Temperature (ºC)
200
150
100
50
Power level 1
Power Level 5
Power Level 3
Power Level 7
0 0
500
1000
1500
2000
Time (s)
Figure 3:
Relationship between time and temperature for 30min. microwave reactions of PF at different power levels.
3 Discussion of results The temperature was recorded at regular time intervals throughout the microwave synthesis processes. Figure 3 shows the relationship between temperature and time for PF synthesized in 30 minutes at different power levels. For each power level the temperature rapidly increased within the first 60 seconds to about 100oC. After this period of time the temperature of the reaction mixture increased steadily at different rates depending on the power level in use, except for PL 1 which remained at 100oC throughout the duration of the reaction. The pattern of increase in temperature of the reaction was similar for the other WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
865
three power levels, peaking in 20 minutes at different temperatures. The temperature difference observed for different power levels has also been reported by Liao et al [8], who showed that the higher the power, the higher the temperature and different equilibrium temperature is reached for each power level. Analyses from UV-Vis and GC-MS showed that the concentration of unreacted phenol in the products of PF prepolymers synthesized from one-pot microwave synthesis and conventional heating decreased with reaction time. Typical GC-MS chromatograms and spectra for phenolic resins using the conventional heating method for 7 hours and with microwave method for 30 minutes are compared in Figure 4. The decrease in phenol for the conventional method with an initial reaction time of 3hrs was by 4.3% (5hrs) and 22.3% (7hrs) as shown in Figure 5, while the decrease in phenol for the microwave synthesis of PF prepolymers at 176.364W after an initial reaction time of 30mins was by 33.05% (in 60mins) and 91.61% (in 90mins). At 315.092W after an initial reaction time of 15mins it decreased by 36.3% (in 20mins), 16.5% (in 25mins) and 10.8% (in 30mins). These trends are shown in Figure 6, and could account for the temperature profiles observed in Figure 3. The UV-Vis results are shown in Table 1. The FT-IR spectra analyses of the m-cresol modified PF resins showed strong similarity in characteristics between the resins. Figure 7 demonstrates the spectra of three different resins synthesized by microwave method at reaction times of 30 minutes. The modified resins were rusty brown colour and highly viscous, which formed very brittle solids. Conventional heating (7hrs)
Figure 4:
Microwave at PL3 (30min)
GC-MS chromatograms and spectra of residual phenol with two different synthesis techniques.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
866 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Table 1:
Method, reaction time, and absorbance at 297nm of residual phenol obtained from UV-Vis analyses.
Residual Microwave Energy Reaction Time Uv-vis Phenol absorbance (molar) 173.364W
315.092W
Conventional
30mins
1.139
0.122
60mins
1.117
0.115
15mins
1.222
0.147
20mins
1.205
0.140
3hrs
1.131
0.118
5hrs
1.118
0.115
7hrs
0.974
0.089
1.45
Conventional heating Power Level 1
Power Level 3
Absorbance
1.35
1.25
1.15
1.05
0.95 1
1.5
2
2.5
3
Log10 (time)
Figure 5:
Comparison of absorbance of residual phenol with time at different process conditions.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
867
1x107 1.E+07
176.364W 315.092W
Abundance
6 1.E+06 1x10
5
1x10 1.E+05
4
1x10 1.E+04
10
40
70
100
Reaction Time (min)
Figure 6:
Relative abundance of phenol with reaction time for two power levels.
80:20 phenol: cresol
50:50 phenol: cresol
20:80 phenol: cresol
Figure 7:
FT-IR spectra for cresol modified PF resins synthesized by Microwave irradiation method at 30 minutes reaction time.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
868 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The melting points of the PF prepolymers produced by the conventional heating method increased with increasing reaction time (83ºC, 97ºC and 109ºC respectively for 3hrs, 5hrs and 7hrs). Melting points varied between 95ºC and 103ºC for the PF resins formed by microwave synthesis at various power levels and reaction time. It was also noted that the melting points for the CF prepolymers produced by the conventional heating method were higher than those for the PF prepolymers produced by the conventional method (119ºC and 127ºC for 3hr and 5hr CF). The melting point data supported the GC-MS results that for conventional method mostly, the degree of polymerization depends on reaction time. Finally, close similarity in characteristics were found between resins heated in autoclave for 7hrs and the resins made by one-pot microwave synthesis at reduced reaction time.
4
Conclusions
Prepolymers of CF and PF, produced by the conventional heating method, have similar characteristics although PF prepolymers seem to be more malleable and have lower melting points. The degree of polymerization of phenolic resins produced by the conventional method depend on the reaction time and the strongest similarities between prepolymers produced in autoclave and by microwave synthesis is found between those produced by long autoclave reaction times and those produced by short one-pot microwave reaction times.
Acknowledgements This work was funded by USRA grant from Natural Sciences and Engineering Research Council of Canada, and the RP grant from Cape Breton University, Canada. The authors wish to acknowledge the contribution of Dr. D. Irwin for the microwave set-up and experiment.
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
Odian, G., Principles of Polymerization. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1970. Carraher, C.E., & Swymour, R.B., Polymer Chemistry: An Introduction. New York Marcel Dekker, Inc., 1992. Tigani, L.W., Pinhas, A.R., & Mark, J.E., Some Attempts at Introducing Flexibility into Phenolic Resins. Polym. Plast. Technol. Eng., 39(4), pp. 711-721, 2000. Poljansek, I. & Krajnc, M., Characterization of Phenol-Formaldehyde Prepolymer Resins by in Line FT-IR Spectroscopy. Acta Chim. Slov., 52, pp. 238-244, 2005. Hayes, B.L., Microwave Synthesis: Chemistry at the Speed of Light. NC: CEM Publishing, 2002
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
[6] [7] [8]
869
Gyorgy, I., Radiation Chemistry of Hydrocarbons (ed. G. Goldiak), Chapter 2, Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1981. Loupy, A., Solvent-free microwave organic synthesis as an efficient procedure for green chemistry, C.R. Chemie, 7, pp. 103-112, 2004. Liao, L.Q., Liu, L.J., Zhang, C., He, F., & Zhuo, R.X., Heating Characteristics and Polymerization of Caprolactone under Microwave Irradiation. J. Appl. Poly. Sc., 90, pp. 2657-2664, 2003.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
871
Modern techniques of measure and control of deformations – an experimental test: Senerchia landslide M. Caprioli & G. Strisciuglio Dipartimento di Vie e Trasporti, Politechnic of Bari, Italy
Abstract Control of movements and deformations is based on the comparison between surveys repeated in different times and in particular on the determination of a certain number of points. The topographical method represents one of the possible solutions in order to reach such an aim. A control network is constituted by reference points (located in stable zones) and control points (located in unstable zones). The movements can be of two kinds: “relative” between the control points (network deformations) and “absolute” (control points respective to the reference network). Its necessary, therefore, to estimate, during the time, the stability of reference points. In this work the stability of reference network – located in Senerchia (Southern Italy) and constituted for the monitoring of a landslide area with static GPS – has been investigated. Both the classical and the Bayesian statistical analysis have been executed on the network in order to identify small movements in comparison with accuracy of the measurements. The application of the Bayes theory on the network has confirmed its stability. Keywords: deformation analysis, statistical inference, Bayesian approach, GPS.
1
Network in deformation analysis
Control of movements and deformations is based on the comparison between surveys repeated in different times and particularly on the determination of the variation between the position of the points at the beginning and at the end of the considered period. The topographical method represents one of the possible ways to reach this aim. It can synthetically be summarized in the following phases: choice of the technique and instrumentation to be used, planning of the network configuration, monumentation of the vertexes, execution of the measurements WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070851
872 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII (manuals/automatic), data processing, deformation analysis using statistical inference, optimization of geodetic network. Nowadays the development of technology allows a great range of solutions for survey execution (digital levelling, motorized TPS, laser scanners, SAR, GPS with RTK transmission): our survey has been performed with GPS instrumentation. Static GPS is the most adopted method, especially when high precision is requested: the standard precision in relative positioning is 10-6 D or 10-7 D in some experiences, with particular elaborations and satellite configurations.
Figure 1:
GPS acquisition.
In deformation analysis, the optimal network configuration has a strategic role to reach desired accuracies, to define an efficient program of measurements, to establish a proper mathematical model for the description of investigated phenomena. A topographical network must be planned keeping in mind that it is necessary to effect measurements in hyper determined number, in order to reach evaluation of measurements uncertainty and of standard deviations. The redundant scheme of the network allows to make a preliminary analysis, with the aim to determine the presence of gross errors, and, in second phase, the network adjustment with the aim to get 3D points position and the estimated value of the accuracies with which they has been determined. In this paper the adjustment method is based on Gauss-Markov model. At the end of the adjustment process, it can be determined the interval of confidence for the respect of the position of every unknown point of the network (error ellipse/ellipsdoids). The analysis of the residuals is not enough to individualize gross errors: Date Snooping method (Baarda, [12]) proposes the use of normalized residuals of the measurements and local redundancy (contribution of every single observation to the general redundancy of the network). Control network is constituted by reference vertexes (points situated in stable zones) and by control vertexes (points situated in not stable zones, inside the monitoring zone). There are two typologies of movements: relative among the control points (deformations of the control network) and absolute (control points in comparison to a stable structure or to the reference frame. It’s important, therefore, to appraise, during the time, the stability of the reference vertexes. In this paper, the aim is to verify the stability a control network, constituted for monitoring a landslide area. The investigation results interesting especially for the particular location of a point. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
2
873
Control network of Senerchia.
Experimental test
Experimental test has been effected using campaigns of measurements related to the landslide of Serra dell’ Acquara-Vadoncello, Senerchia (SW Italy). The aim is to verify the application of the theoretical studies to a series of observations of control network, obtained using modern techniques of survey. The area of study is located in a zone of the southern Appennino, characterized by catastrophic events in 1980 and 1996, due to unstable nature of the area. The choice of such site is tied up to the presence of database coming from research works effected in the past years: data have been compared and integrated with those coming from the surveys directly effected. In this context, it is inserted the topographical study of the zone, finalized to the geodetic monitoring of small control network constituted by five vertexes. The particular location of vertex T4 (outside the landslide area of 1993 but inside the 1980 surface) requests a closer examination during the analysis, justifying the chance to use innovative tools/theory in the analysis of the observations (Bayes theory). The objective is to verify the stability of all the vertexes retained fixed and used as stations of distantiometric measurements to control position of points belonging to the landslide mass. Reference vertexes have been materialized through the construction of specific 3D concrete monuments (circular section 30 cm, height 120 cm) for the stable positioning of GPS antenna. During survey campaigns the following instrumentation has been used: • n° 2 LEICA GPS1200 (GX1230, 12 L1s + 12 L2s / WAAS / EGNOS) with Smart Track antenna AX 1202, Ground incorporated plane; • n°1 GPS LEICA System 500- SR530 double frequency (L1 codes C/A; L2 code P), antenna AT502, controller TR500; WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
874 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
Vertex T4 of the network.
• n°2 GPS Trimble 4700 (L1 code C/A,) with controller TSC1; • n°1 Smartstation with Smart Antenna. Use of Smartstation has allowed one to integrate GPS survey, primary source of data in the experimental test, with classical topographical data: angles and distances. Every GPS survey has been conducted in 3 independent static sessions, duration of 45 minutes. The tools rate has been planned of 10 seconds. The satellite configuration and the climatic conditions are optimal during the whole execution of survey operations. Download and post-processing phase have been executed in Geomatics Laboratory of Polytechnic of Bari, using software furnished with the receivers (Leica Geo Office 2.1 and Trimble Geomatics Office 1.01). All the data have subsequently imported in the second application to perform treatment according to the "single base" approach. At the end, the test of ratio has performed: it has broadly been always overcome the limit of 1.5 for GPS measurements. The network adjustment has been executed with least square method.
3
Classical analysis of the network movements
It has been decided to conduct on control points both the classical and the Bayesian analysis. While classical analysis has the purpose to quantify the entity of movements, the Bayesian approach has the purpose to identify the zones interested by significant movements. The simplification of the statistic problem is a necessary condition to allow the comparison among the results: therefore, the coordinates (N, E, h) of every vertex Pj (j=1,... ,5) of the network have been considered separately . The first hypothesis consists of considering not correlated coordinates in space and time (among the different sessions of measurements).
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 4:
875
GPS network and error ellipses.
The hypothesis to be submitted to inference is that movements are not significant:
H 0 : δx = 0 It is possible to build the following statistic parameter:
Z~
∆x
σ + σ υ22 2 υ1
.
Fixed the level of α=5% (corresponding to Z=1.96), the hypothesis H0 is approved (so the movement of the point is not significant) if:
− Z α ⋅ σ υ21 + σ υ22 ≤ ∆x ≤ Z α ⋅ σ υ21 + σ υ22 . 2
2
The calculation has been effected considering all the sessions of measurements that are divided in: GPS data coming from the effected surveys (fifth and sixth session); GPS data coming from a series of campaigns of measurements (first 4 sessions) conducted starting from the 1996. Sessions of measurements are totally 6: all data are the result of network adjustment effected with least square method.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
876 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 5:
GPS post-processed data.
In the following charts for every point of the network and for every coordinate (E, N, h), the observed values are the following:
Z oss = Z oss = Z oss =
∆E
σ + σ υ2i 2 υ1
∆N
σ + σ υ2i 2 υ1
∆h
σ υ21 + σ υ2i
As concerns Figure 6, on celestial background there are values of Zoss that underline the presence of a possible significant movement in comparison to the first campaign of measurements. Classical analysis furnishes unequivocal results on the planimetric coordinates, because the values of Zoss are inferior to the threshold value (1.96) denoting absence of movement. Some problem arises on the height, as it was possible to expect for GPS observations characteristics.
4
Bayesian analysis for the movements of the network
In Bayesian analysis, the only coordinate h got by the network adjustment in different times has been considered: classical analysis is not able to clearly WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
877
define the vertical behavior of control vertexes. The quantities to be considered therefore, are movement ∆h among the different sessions of all the not-fixed points:
(∆h )P
J
= (hi − h1 )Pj
with i = 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 and j = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5.
Figure 6:
ZOSS reported to the E, N and h coordinates.
We can suppose that ∆h follow a normal distribution:
(
)
∆h ~ N δh, σ h2 . Parameters of this distribution are average (unknown) and the known variance factor that is obtained by the effected least square adjustment. For every point of the network we have:
∆h = hi − h1 = δh + σ h .
δh
is an aleatory variable, distributed according to a normal density of
probability, of average µ and variance
δh
σ 02 : ~N
(µ ,σ ) . 2 0
Parameters of this distribution (prior function of Bayesian theory), are information of the problem (they will have been fixed during the numerical WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
878 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII analysis). Since we effect an analysis of vertical movements of points in landslide area, it is supposed that the movements are void or downward. Then, considering an axle opportunely directed, it is reasonable to impose previously a further condition: δh ≥ 0 . This condition becomes complicated to impose in classical inference. Bayesian theory, explicited all the terms, is:
f (δh / ∆h ) =
f (∆h / δh ) ⋅ f (δh ) = K
(δh − m ) − ∆h 2 q h ∆ h 2 + q 0 µ 2 − q ⋅m 2 ) ( − 2σ 2 − P0 e 1 ϑ (δh ) 2σ h2 2 = ⋅ ⋅e ⋅ δ (δh ) + ⋅e ⋅ ⋅ σ . A + B 2π ⋅ σ h 2π ⋅ σ 2π σ h σ 0 The analysis of the movements through the Bayesian approach can reduce then to the comparison between the two quantities: 2
P(δh = 0 \ ∆h) =
A A+ B
P(δh > 0 \ ∆h ) =
and
B . A+ B
From the comparison between the two quantities above, it is to be verified which of the two alternatives has greater probabilities to verify:
P0 A≡ e 2π ⋅ σ h
−∆h
2
2σ h2
and B ≡
σ ⋅e
−
(q ∆h +q µ h
2
0
2
−qm2
)
2
2π σ hσ 0
m ⋅ 1 − erf − . σ
All the terms that appear in these expressions are numerically determinable; particularly, the known values of µ and of σ0.
Figure 7:
Bayesian analysis.
In classical analysis the statistic test has been performed considering a level of significance α =5%. The interpretation of the results in the Bayesian analysis happens as shown in Figure 7. Six different elaborations have been effected, according to the initial hypotheses, always considering the only h coordinate, using a simplified model WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
879
and selecting different values of prior data. They calculated the values of P(dh>0) consequential from the comparison of all the measurement sessions with the first assumed as reference. Later, we present the results deriving from the sixth elaboration (Figure 8), in which we consider the following data prior: σ0 = 0.05 m for every network vertex, µ equal to the average of the ∆h in correspondence of every vertex .
Figure 8:
Bayesian analysis.
Prior data has been select exploiting the accumulated experience and knowledge of the phenomenon coming from a first analysis of raw data. It immediately emerges that, in all the elaborations, the numerical value of P(dh>0) calculated for network vertexes underlines that the relative movement is "not significant". The doubts appeared after the application of classical analysis has been resolved: there is no vertical movement of the vertexes.
5
Conclusions
The application of Bayes theory on the network has confirmed its stability during the time: significant movements are not present. The vertexes are stable and therefore usable as stations of measurements to control points position in landslide area. The application is limited only to the vertical direction because of classical analysis has already clarified the absence of planimetric movements. Results coming from Bayesian analysis are characterized by great coherence: also varying some prior data they appear stable. It is clarified, with Bayesian analysis, the behaviour of T4 vertex but it appears a necessary constant monitoring on it, due to its particular positioning. The application of Bayes theory is efficient for the aim of this paper: information insertion (critical phase of the procedure) has allowed to conduct a statistical analysis finalized to detect small movements in comparison to the standard deviation of the residuals. This method must not be considered as substitutive of classical analysis but integrative, because it uses the values of the parameters got with least square method. The difficulty of the Bayesian approach is to fit probability distribution to data and to make inferences from parameter distributions.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
880 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
References [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8]
[9] [10] [11]
[12]
Augutis, J., Zutautaite, I., Alzbutas, R., Uspuras, E., Iterative estimation of reliability parameters using the Bayesian approach, Risk Analysis IV, WIT Press 2004, ISBN 1-85312-736-1. Barbarella, M. & Radicioni, F., Kalman Filtering in levelling: an application, Global and Regional Geodynamics, Springer-Verlag, NY, 1990. Barbarella, M., Canuti, P., Fiani, M., & Vannocci, P., Controllo di movimenti gravitativi profondi, XIII GNGTS Proceedings, Rome, 551562. Bernstein, S., & Bernstein, R., Statistica Inferenziale, McGraw-Hill, 2003. Caprioli, M., Importance and role of the GPS permanent national network for topographic and professional application, ASI-CGS, Matera, 1997. Caprioli, M., Stability controls and deformations measurements in civil engineering works, Allied Publishers Ltd, ISBN 81-7764-245-6. Cina, A., GPS – Principi, modalità e tecniche di posizionamento, Celid, ISBN 88-7661-417-6, 2000. Erol, S., Erol, B., Ayan, T., A general review of the deformation monitoring techniques and a case study: analysing deformations using GPS/levelling, ISPRS-WG VII/5,XXth ISPRS Congress Geo-Imagery Bridging Continents, Istanbul, Turkey, 12-23 July 2004. Pinto, L., & al., Controllo delle deformazioni: un approccio statistico di tipo Bayesiano, VII ASITA National Conference, 2003. Sacerdote, F., Albertella, A., Cazzaniga, N., Applicazione di metodi bayesiani per il controllo delle deformazioni, VIII ASITA National Conference, 2004. Trizzino, R. & Sorgente, M., Ottimizzazione di una rete di controllo GPS per il monitoraggio di una frana, Proceedings of International Conference “Prevention of Hydrogeological Hazards: the Role of Scientific Research", 1996. Baarda, W., A testing procedure for use in the geodetic network, Neth. Geod. Comm., n°5, 1968.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Section 12 Industrial applications
This page intentionally left blank
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
883
Calculating the dilution between successive trainloads of iron ore during processing J. E. Everett Faculty of Economics and Commerce, The University of Western Australia, Australia
Abstract Iron ore is railed several hundred kilometres from inland mines to port, where it is crushed and separated into lump and fines products for shipment to customers. During crushing, each trainload is sampled and assayed to measure the grade, in iron, phosphorus, silica, alumina and a number of other minerals. Trainloads from different mines are of systematically different grade. Accurate product grades for each trainload, from each mine, are required for production planning and quality control. During crushing each trainload is contaminated with ore from the preceding and possibly from the following trainloads, so that the reported grade is biased by this dilution from the neighbouring trainloads. Although the dilution effect has long been recognised, it has not previously been quantified and therefore has not been corrected for. This paper describes the development, verification and use of a non-linear regression model enabling the amount of dilution to be estimated, so that the diluted grades can be corrected to undiluted grades. Keywords: quality control, decision support, mining, non-linear regression, weighted least squares.
1
Introduction
The quality of the ore product depends upon it closely matching target composition, not only in iron, but also in phosphorus, silica and alumina. The four critically important composition elements will be referred to as the vector {Fe, P, SiO2, Al2O3}. A number of other elements are also monitored. The customer blast furnaces are tuned to receive ore of the agreed target composition. Issues relating to quality control in iron ore production are discussed in [1,2]. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070861
884 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Iron ore is railed from five mines of differing average grades. At the port, run of mine trainloads are processed sequentially and separated into lump and fines products. Each trainload is sampled during processing. The lump and fines products are stacked onto lump and fines stockpiles, blended from the five mines The mine grades vary around consistently different means. For example, average Fe grade is considerably higher for Mine A than for the others. It has long been observed that trainload assays sampled at the port are biased according to the mine sources of trainloads processed before and after it. For example, a Mine A trainload followed and preceded by trainloads not from Mine A has lower Fe content than if its neighbours are other Mine A trainloads. The effect is because ore from the neighbouring trainloads contaminates the beginning and end of each trainload sample, during dumping, screening and crushing. As each trainload is processed, some material mixes into the next trainload. Each trainload sample has a sharp beginning and end, but the sample contains some material from the following and/or preceding trainloads. The dilution does not affect the estimated composition of the final product, because dilution of each trainload is compensated by dilution of its neighbours. But it does affect the reported composition of ore from each contributing mine, and this systematic error is important because it interferes with the planning and quality control for each mine. For each mine, each day’s production is planned to satisfy composition targets, based on mine estimates of the currently available ore sources. Comparison between mine estimates and subsequent port assays are used to monitor and adjust the mine estimates: this adjustment is compromised if the port assays have error, depending on which type of trainload preceded or followed them. A non-linear regression model is described, to estimate the average dilution from the preceding and following trainloads. It is shown that the lump and fines samples for 12 kilotonnes trainloads are each contaminated by nearly one kilotonne from the preceding trainload and a median of about 450 tonnes from the following trainload. The results of the analysis are now being routinely used to provide more accurate trainload grade data.
2
The model
Consider a variable X, with mean M., E[Xn] = M
(1)
X n = M + dn
(2)
where dn is the deviation for the nth observation Xn. M can be estimated as the average of Xn. But it can equally well be estimated as the value that minimises ∑dn2. The two formulations are equivalent, giving the same estimate for M, but the second formulation is a simple regression model.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
885
Now consider the grade Xn for a trainload portion, which may come from any one of the five mines. It has total tonnage Wn kt, of which p kt comes from the previous trainload portion, and q kt comes from the following trainload portion. The expected value of Xn is now: E[Xn] = (pMp + (Wn-p-q)Mc + qMq)/Wn
(3)
Xn = (pMp + (Wn-p-q)Mc + qMq)/Wn + dn
(4)
where Mp, Mc, Mq are the mean values for the previous, current and following trainload portions, each being MA, MB, MC, MD or ME, according to which of the five mines is its source. Define M as the vector {MA, MB, MC, MD, ME}, and unit vectors Sp, Sc, Sq to specify the source mines of the preceding, current and following trainload portions. For example, if the preceding trainload portion comes from Mine B, then Sp is {0, 1, 0, 0, 0}. Thus: Mp = Sp.M´; Mc = Sc.M´; Mq = Sq.M´
(5)
and equation (4) becomes: Xn = (pSp + (Wn-p-q)Sc + qSq).M´/Wn + dn
(6)
Equation (6) is a non-linear regression model. Ordinary least squares (OLS) regression minimises ∑dn2. Weighted least squares regression (WLS) weights the variance terms to minimise ∑Wndn2. This can be achieved by multiplying both sides of equation (6) by √Wn: Yn = Xn√Wn= (pSp + (Wn-p-q)Sc + qSq).M´/√Wn + en
(7)
The OLS solution to equation (7) is thus a WLS solution to equation (6), providing estimates of the dilution factors p and q and the mine means, M.
3
Data used and its preparation
The analysis to be reported here is based upon a total of 9,403 “Port Actual” records, for ore crushed during the period of about ten months. Each “Port Actual” record reported a trainload portion of lump or fines from a total of 2,468 trainloads, being 1,471 trainloads from Mine A, 548 from Mine B, 279 from Mine C, 108 from Mine D, and 62 from Mine E. Each trainload portion was processed through one of two buildings, “TCB1” or” TCB2”. Many trainloads were split between TCB1 and TCB2, with a trainload portion going to each. Successive trainload portions of the same
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
886 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII product (Lump or Fines) of the same trainload going through the same building were merged. For each building and product, the trainload portions were ordered by start time. For each trainload portion record, five fields were added for the each of the unit vectors Sp, Sc and Sq, to specify the preceding, current and following mine, as defined above. Each vector had four zero components, and a single unit component. Consider: Sp={0,1,0,0,0}; Sc={1,0,0,0,0}; Sq={0,0,0,0,1}
(8)
In the example of equation (8) the preceding, current and following trainloads come from Mines B, A and E respectively. Each trainload portion had a grade vector G, defining its assayed composition. Assays were available not only for the four control minerals {Fe, P, SiO2, Al2O3}, but also for {H2O, LOI, Mn, TiO2, CaO, MgO, S, K2O}. LOI is “loss on ignition”, a measure of moisture content. G = {Fe, P, SiO2, Al2O3, H2O, LOI, Mn, TiO2, CaO, MgO, S, K2O} The vector fields Prod = {L(ump), F(ines)} and Plant = {TCB1, TCB2} were added, specifying the product (lump or fines) and plant building for each trainload portion. For example, a lump trainload portion going through TCB2 has Prod = {1,0} and Plant = {0,1}. Fields Tp and Tq were calculated, as the time interval (in minutes) before the start and after the end of each trainload portion.
4
Discriminant analysis
Solution of the non-linear regression equation (7) requires that the mean values of X differ significantly between the five mine sources. The model could be run repeatedly, for each mineral, giving repeat estimates for the dilution. It is more efficient to let X be the linear composite of the minerals that best separates the sources. The “best” separation is defined as maximising the between-group variance divided by the within-group variance. The linear composite satisfying this condition is known as the first discriminant function. The second discriminant function again maximises the between-group variance divided by the within group variance, subject to the constraint that the second discriminant function is orthogonal (uncorrelated) to the first discriminant function. A useful description of discriminant analysis is supplied in the SPSS™ reference guide [3]. With five groups, four orthogonal discriminant functions can be extracted. We are interested only in the first discriminant function, since it has the greatest possible power to discriminate between the five groups. The statistical package
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
887
SPSS™ was used to apply discriminant analysis. The first discriminant function scores were added to the data file. The discriminant analysis was run separately for lump and for fines. The correlations between the mineral grades and a discriminant function are referred to as the “loadings” of the mineral grades on the discriminant function. The loadings for the first discriminant function, for lump and for fines, are tabulated below. Table 1:
Mineral
5
Fe
Loadings on the first discriminant function.
P SiO2 Al2O3 H2O LOI Mn TiO2 CaO MgO
S K2O
Lump -.53
.54
.09
.58 -.01
.87 -.04
.33 -.26 -.28
.29 -.17
Fines -.77
.47
.57
.60 -.01
.72 -.17
.22 -.29 -.33
.38 -.13
Model solution
The non-linear regression equation (7) can be solved to estimate p and q and the mine means M. The dilutants p and q are not necessarily constants, but may themselves be expressed as functions, of the trainload portion weight Wn, the crusher plant (TCB1 or TCB2), the product (Lump or Fines), time, et cetera. The model of equation (7) could be run separately for lump and fines, and it is to be expected that the mean value vector will be different for lump and fines. However, the two analyses can be combined. Letting the vector of mean values M be ML and MF respectively for lump and fines, equation (7) becomes the combined equation: Yn=Xn√Wn=(pSp+(Wn-p-q)Sc+qSq).(L.ML´+F.MF´)/√Wn+en
(9)
The statistical package SPSS™ was again used, to solve the non-linear regression model for the unknown parameters p, q, ML and MF, which could be expressed as functions. A range of physically believable models were tested, rejecting any terms not significant at the 5% significance level. The following model was found significant in all its terms: p = P1*Wn
(10)
q = Q1*Wn*exp(-H*Tq)
(11)
ML = {MAL, MBL, MCL+GCL*Time, MDL, MEL}
(12)
MF = {MAF+GAF*Time, MBF+GBF*Time, MCF, MDF, MEF}
(13)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
888 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Parameters defining p and q are of operational interest. All are significant at the 0.0001% level, as tabulated below. Parameters for ML and MF represent discriminant function score means and are of no further interest. The coefficients GCL, GAF and GBF, were all significantly negative, indicating that the means for Lump from Mine C Lump and for Fines from Mines A and B decrease with time. Slopes against time for the other means were tested, and none were significant at the 5% level. Table 2:
Dilution parameter estimates.
Parameter
6
StdErr
Sig.
P1
.083
.005
< 0.0001%
Q1
.119
.017
< 0.0001%
H/minute
.060
.012
< 0.0001%
Testing for further dilution models
The dilution model of equations (10) and (11) support the model for which: 1) The tonnage dilution from the previous trainload portion is proportional to the tonnage of the current trainload portion. 2) The tonnage dilution from the following trainload portion is proportional to the tonnage of the current trainload portion, declining exponentially according to the time gap between the current and following trainload portions. Further terms were added to the model of equations (10) to (13), one by one, to test if the model required significant augmentation. 6.1 Potential additions to the “p” model p = P0 + P1.Wn P0 = .034 +/- .023 Sig.(P0=0) =14%
(14)
p = P1*Wn.exp(-K*Tp) K = 1.92 +/- 1.11 Sig.(K=0) = 8.4%
(15)
p = P1.WnK
K = .808 +/- .091 Sig.(K=1) = 3.5%
(16)
p = (PB.TCB2+P1).Wn PB = -.0005 +/- .008 Sig.(PB=0) = 94%
(17)
p = (PF.Fines+P1).Wn PF = -.015 +/- .010 Sig.(PF=0) = 15%
(18)
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
889
6.2 Potential additions to the “q” model q = Q0+Q1.Wn.exp(-H*Tq) Q0 = -.016 +/- .019 Sig.(Q0=0) = 40%
(19)
q = Q1.WnK.exp(-H*Tq) K = .895 +/- .175 Sig.(K=1) = 55%
(20)
q = (QB.TCB2+Q1).Wn QB = -.042 +/- .020 Sig.(QB=0) = 3.7%
(21)
q = (QF.Fines+Q1).Wn
7
QF = -.019 +/- .024 Sig.(QF=0) = 43%
(22)
Results
None of the examined extensions to the model of equations (14) to (22) are significant at the 3% level. Two extensions, (16) and (21), significant at the 5% level, provide weak evidence that: 1) p may increase a little less than linearly with Wn. 2) q may be smaller for the second plant TCB2. It was concluded that the evidence for these effects was not strong enough to justify further complicating the model.
8
Undiluting the data
Having established that each trainload is diluted with a tonnage p from the previous rake, and q from the following rake, we can write the formula for calculating the trainload’s undiluted composition vector XU from its diluted composition XD, and the compositions XP and XQ of the preceding and following trainloads. XU = (XD – pXP – qXQ)/(1-p-q)
(23)
where p = 0.083, and q = 0.119*exp(-.06Tq) The dilution model of equations (10) and (11) was used to undilute the diluted data, in accord with equation (23). The compositions XP and XQ of the preceding and following trainloads should really be the undiluted values. For convenience, the diluted values were used instead, introducing a negligible second-order error. As an example of the undilution process, cumulative distributions for diluted and undiluted lump Fe values are plotted in Figure 1, and for lump Al2O3 values are plotted in Figure 2. The graphs show the results only for Mines A and B. Fe is consistently higher for Mine A, and undilution makes it higher still. Al2O3 is consistently lower for Mine A, and undilution makes it lower still. The reverse applies to Mine B. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
890 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 1:
9
Cumulative distributions for lump Fe, Mines A and B.
Conclusion
The results plotted in Figures 1 and 2 show examples of the undilution process. Similar comparisons can be made for the other three mines, and for the other minerals of interest, P and SiO2. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 2:
891
Cumulative distributions for lump Al2O3, Mines A and B.
It should be noted that the undilution applied to a particular trainload takes account of the particular trainloads that precede and follow it. If a trainload from a particular mine is preceded and followed by trainloads also from the same mine, then the undiluted composition will be close to the diluted composition. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
892 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII The procedure is now used routinely to improve the estimates of composition for trainloads from each mine. The greater accuracy has helped in improving the tracking of mine estimate errors and thus has improved the mine planning capability. The model of equations (9)–(13), leading to the undilution formula of equation (23) is somewhat counter-intuitive. It finds that the tonnage contaminated from the previous and following trainloads is proportional to the tonnage of the trainload being contaminated. Our expectation had been that the contamination should be a tonnage amount independent of the tonnage of the contaminated trainload. The significances of the model parameters in equations (10), (11), (14) and (19) support the counter-intuitive model. The model finds that the contamination from the following trainload decays exponentially, according to the time interval between the trainload being contaminated and the following trainload. The decay has a half-life of about twelve minutes. This makes sense. The sampling from a trainload stops when the operator judges that the trainload processing has finished. If the following trainload starts being fed in straight away, some of it will be picked up in the sample, but not if there is an appreciable time interval between the trainloads.
References [1] [2] [3]
Everett, J.E. Iron ore handling procedures enhance export quality, Interfaces, 26(6), pp. 82-94, 1996. Everett J.E. Iron ore production scheduling to improve product quality, European Journal of Operational Research, 129, pp. 355-361, 2001. SPSS, Reference Guide, SPSS Inc: Chicago, 1990.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
893
Rock bumps due to the creation of a dislocation during deep mining V. Doležel1 & P. Procházka2 1 2
University of Pardubice, Czech Republic Czech Technical University in Prague, Czech Republic
Abstract The safety of deep mines is sometimes threatened by sudden and hazardous failures of a coal face, as in the case of bumps, for example. It has been shown in many experimental studies that coal bumps are influenced either by stress, stiffness, and yield ability of surrounding rocks, or by dynamic effects associated with the failure of surrounding strata. In addition, bumps occurred in such parts of mines where there had been rapid stress changes over a short period of time. The dynamic effects associated with the failure of surrounding strata triggered bumps in these marginally stable seam structures. While it was not possible to evaluate the influence of mine stiffness directly, it was shown that coal bumps generally occurred in mines with uniaxial compressive strength and Young’s modulus ratios (roof to coal) exceeding 3 to 5. In addition, bump-prone coal exhibited the potential for storing high horizontal stresses. Yielding of the immediate roof and floor reduced horizontal stresses and enhanced gradual failure of coal. A method is proposed to assess coal bumps in which stress analyses, in situ strength data, stiffness and strength ratios of roof to coal, and affected wave magnitude resulting from strata failure and mining experience are incorporated. A rheological model is involved to fulfill the time dependence of the phenomenon of bumps. It has namely been shown in the literature that the time plays a decisive role in the possible occurrence of rock bursts. In our case the static (stability) problem is solved and the dynamical influence of inertia forces is initiated after occurrence of bumps. This is not of any importance for us, as we suppose that the mine is far enough from other openings (other mines). In this way the stability problem with possible rheology (or creep) is studied. Keywords: rock bursts (bumps), scale modeling, coupled modeling, natural existence of occurrence of bumps, numerical model of contact problem. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line) doi:10.2495/CMEM070871
894 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
1
Introduction
The paper deals with an application of coupled modeling in identification of dislocation occurring in coal mines threatening workers in the underground structures. The bumps can be induced for different reasons, one being the accumulation of energy in unpredictable dislocations. The measurement on site is very expensive and unreliable. One of the most reliable is physical modeling, which enables one to carry out parametric studies and after certain results from these models one can assess the most probable concentration of stresses. On the other hand, the stresses are measured in a very difficult way, so that numerical analysis should take place. In numerical analysis the contact problem in limit state estimation is based on data from physical modeling. The physical modeling seems to be the best for linear analysis. This is not the case of our study and large attempts have to be carried out to estimate the real behavior of the material. With support of physical modeling mathematical formulation and numerical treatment can lead to the danger of occurrence of bumps. In general, the large iteration should be used to solve the strongly nonlinear problem in both subdomains ranged in boundaries given by possible dislocations, and on the interfacial boundary (dislocations). In order to eliminate some principal directions of iteration the physical modeling is used and the numerical processes become bearable. A typical example from praxis verifies the theory based on back analysis. Extensive studies were done by Elices et al., Haramy and McDonnell [3] and Haramy et al., [4], who showed a methodology on how to estimate the possibility of bumps. In [2] the authors tried to explain reasons for bumps based on a couple of experiments. The conditions for bumps in coal mines under a strong roof are described in [3], where possible bumps are analyzed and explained. A methodology for assessment of pillars in longwall mining is suggested in [5]. Scale modeling of rock bursts is described in [6]. The method and equipment mentioned in [6] are very powerful for illustration of bump evaluation, as the extrusion of coal grains into free space can be seen in a natural way. Numerical modeling can be found in [7], for example, where the cracking is described by a cohesive zone method, which starts with Griffith and Barenblatt theories. A very promising method seems to be partition of unity, presented in [8], for example, where a theoretical explanation can be found, or in [9], where a direct application of the mentioned method to a cracking material is shown. Another method appropriate for description of cracking is called the manifold method; its advanced version is published in [10]. Discrete methods became very popular in describing nucleation of cracks and consequent occurrence of bumps. One of such method is denoted as free hexagons of statical particle flow code, [11]. Coupled modeling, consisting of implementation of results from experimental (scale) models into numerical computation, is proposed in [12]. It is based on involvement of eigenstrains or eigenstresses as design parameters in identification of material properties. In this paper the most dangerous crack in a rock overburden of a coal seam is determined. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
2
895
Experimental study
The principal objective of the experimental and numerical model research was the clarification of mechanical behavior of the coal seam and a close and distant overburden of one selected seam in connection with the origin of rock bumps in the proximity of localization in the north Czech Republic. The first phase comprised the simulation of exploitation of the seam under consideration. The extraordinarily difficult and exacting character of the problem required an unconventional approach to its solution. For this reason the physical model of equivalent materials was supplemented with a mathematical and a scale model. This combined approach was selected to make the individual partial methods mutually link up and complement each other to advantage and so enable a more comprehensive insight into the whole problem. As some data required by mechanical properties, particularly those concerning the shear and triaxial strength, were not available (the required measurements had not been made in the given area), it was necessary to verify the strength characteristics of the rock mass in the environs of the principal crosscut by a contact problem. Experiments with models from physically equivalent materials provided a detailed stress distribution in rock environment (with the assumption of its ideally elastic behavior) and supplemented very appropriately the results of measurements made on physical models. Generally, two concepts of rock bursts are distinguished: The first assumes that a first bump occurs and then the dislocation appears as a consequent of weakened overburden. The second idea starts with the dislocation in the overburden and the bumps is an aftermath of the situation caused by the cracked dislocation. The latter case is considered in this study after obtaining the realistic material properties from measurements on site. Hence the appraisal of the relations and consequently the maintenance of the situation on site can be carried out. The geometry and possible failure in the neighborhood of the face of the long wall mining is depicted in Fig. 1, where also the source of dynamic propagation is shown.
Figure 1:
Static and seismic energy released after limit concentration at the face of the wall.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
896 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
3
Verification of material parameters of rock environment
To determine the characteristics of equivalent material used for physical model construction it was necessary to comply with the requirements of physical similarity between the model and the rock environment. However, the measurements required for this purpose were not made in the full extent. For this reason it was decided to verify and/or refine the selected shear parameters of the rock mass by the DEM in such a way that the results for the free hexagons fed by data from laboratory experiments had to comply with the results from beards build up in the beginning of the construction of the mines. It appeared that there were deep differences in these results and the numerical approach had to be basically improved. Long term monitoring of the rock mass in crosscut environs has ascertained that its extraction does not impair ambient rock. Consequently the shear parameters not producing any extensive failure zone in the environs of the working may be considered as the basic shear strength of the rock mass. Under these assumptions the problems were formulated as follows: 1. The shear parameters were estimated on the basis of the rock strength (admissible values of the material parameters) in uniaxial compression and tension and literary data. Alternative A : c = 5.5 MPa φ = 35° σ + = 5.0 MPa where c is the cohesion (shear strength), φ is the angle of internal friction, and σ + is the tensile strength. 2. The non-linear problem, based on the same shear strength assumptions, was solved to refine the convergence of the working. 3. The problem solved as another alternative, was based on the following strength parameters: Alternative B: c = 10 MPa φ = 65.5° σ + = 4.1 MPa The difference in the extent of failure zones should show the minimum shear strength of the rock mass. The solution of all problems assumed the initial stress state due to overburden weight and characterized by the value of the coefficient of the side pressure Ke = 0.54. Physical non-linearity was concentrated on the dislocation. The program makes it possible to respect the different behavior of the materials in compression, in tension and after load relief. Compressive strength is controlled in accordance with the first failure theory, i.e., by a comparison of the maximum shear stress with the shear strength of the respective material. This control is performed only if the octahedral normal stress σoct is a shear stress. In the opposite case the control concerns shear according to the generalized Mohr theory of failure expressed in octahedral stresses.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
4
897
Solution of underground continuum by the BEM
In this part we briefly describe an implementation of the boundary element method to the solution of specific problems of underground continuum, for which the numerical method appears to be extraordinary advantageous. The method, among others, reduces the problem by one. Further good application of the boundary element method is the optimization and/or contact problems which concern the boundary only. Then, in spite of the finite element method it suffices to study a change of location of boundary elements only. The problem is solved as two-dimensional, i.e. a possible dislocation is long enough, and a narrow seam is considered. Moreover, the nonlinear behavior is considered in the region, which is sufficiently close to the dislocation, according to Mises theory. Suspicious dislocation is given from the experimental model from physically equivalent materials. In our following consideration we will concentrate on the physically nonlinear problems (nonlinear evolution is also included in boundary conditions). Let us solve the problem in domain Ω. We originate from the Cauchy equations:
(α + µ )
∂σ ij0 ∂ div u + µ ∆ ui + X i + ∑ = 0, i = 1,...,3 ∂x j ∂x i j
(1)
where div u =
∂u1 ∂u 2 , + ∂x1 ∂u 2
∆=
∂ ∂ + ∂x1 ∂x 2
and u = (u1, u2) is the displacement field, (X1, X2) are components of the volume weight and σij0 are components of the tensor of initial stress. These equations will be solved in the coordinate system 0x1,x2. In the sense of BEM, (1) may be reformulated in an equivalent form:
(
)
[
] (
* c k 1 (ξ )u1 (ξ ) = ε ijk , σ ij + [ pik , ui ] − uik* , pi − uik* , X i
)
(2)
where [.] are boundary integrals, (.) are plane integrals, ck1 is the matrix of coefficients depending on a position of ξ, p is the vector of external forces, and quantities with an asterisk denote the relevant quantities of the fundamental solution. From the Cauchy equations (respecting shearing stresses to be zero) we have the well known relations for a virgin state to get the initial stresses:
u1o = −
1 − 2ν X 1 x12 + const., 4 µ(1 − ν )
σ1o,1 = − X 1 x1,σ1o,2 = 0, σ 2o,2 = −
u 2o = 0 ν X 1 x1 1− ν
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(3)
898 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
5
Contact problem
Before we start the analysis preliminary considerations will be introduced. In order to explain the process of computation the two-dimensional problem will be treated. The three-dimensional problems are solved similarly. Let the problem be described from experimental study. Ωseam is the domain of the seam, for which the dislocation and the bearing capacity is to be assessed.
Figure 2:
Domain and denotation of the example under study.
After discretization of (2) in the sense of the boundary element method the problem leads to the system of algebraic equations: H 11 H 21 H 31
H 12 H 22 H 32
H 13 u G11 G12 A 23 u -c − G 21 G 22 A 33 u c+ G 31 G 32
g F G13 g - G 23 + G11 g c = Fc- g + F + G 33 c c
(4)
where the upper index - denotes "from the left" and + denotes "from the right“, g is the vector of prescribed surface forces along the boundaries Г and Гp, pc is the vector of surface forces on fictitious contact Гc and F includes the effect of volume weight. As the vector g contains known quantities we can rearrange the previous equations to obtain: H 11 H 21 H 31
H 12 H 22 H 32
g H 13 u G 12 p -c + G 13 p c+ F + G 11 A 23 u -c − G 21 p -c + G 23 p c+ = Fc- + G g21 g A 33 u c+ G 31 p -c + G 33 p c+ Fc+ + G 31
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
(5)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
899
Suppose now that for example u c− and u c+ is known. Then the problem is uniquely solvable, so that the matrix H 11 is regular. For a similar reason the matrices Hkk are regular, too. Also, the same assertion holds for the matrices G11,, i = 1,2. This is the general result of solvability of linear problems of elasticity by the boundary element method. We can conclude that the matrix H is singular, but the last submatrices are regular matrices. This is why it is possible to rearrange the system in the sense of matrix canonical transformations (in algorithm we use Gaussian elimination) to obtain: H 11 0 0
H 12 A 22 A 32
H 13 u B11 C11 - A 23 u c − B 21 {Pc } = C 21 C A 33 u c+ B 31 31
(6)
where the balance condition pc = pc− = − pc+
(7)
was employed. The matrices are known while the vectors u and p remain unknown. From the last form the reducibility follows and we can employ the following system of equations: A 32 u -c + A 33 u c+ − B31p c = c 21 A 22 u -c + A 23u c+ − B21p c = c 22
(8)
Generally, along the contact line only balance condition holds and the compatibility is prescribed with the aid of more complicated relations. For example, suppose that at each nodal point along the contact line holds:
[u]n = u1n − un2 ≥ 0 pt ≤ Tpn + c pt ≤ Tpn + c ⇒ Ελ > 0, [u ]n = − λpt
(9)
where T and c are prescribed coefficients (they may very along the contact), pn and pt are projections of tractions to the normal and tangential direction with respect to the contact line, respectively. Then Uzawa’s algorithm can be applied to the contact problem – see, e.g., [12]. In the domain the rheological model is applied according to Fig. 3 with the coefficients: Elasticity modulus E = 10 GPa, Poisson’s ratio ν = 0.21, peak cohesion = 1.2 MPa, peak angle of internal fiction = 300, dilation angle = 00, peak tensile strength = 4 MPa (not used), residua cohesion = 0.2 MPa, cohesion softening rate = 0.001, residua fiction angle = 200, fiction softening rate = 100, rock viscosity = 10-19 MPa (average used). WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
900 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Figure 3:
Schematic of the rheological model.
The critical shape of the searched dislocation is depicted in Fig. 2. The way of overall vertical stresses together with a description of typical longwall mining is illustrated in Fig. 4. Fig. 5 displays distribution of principal strain rates for two basic materials: the left describes a roof with plastic properties and the right material properties being “almost” brittle. The envelope of the peak stresses describes the most dangerous states for possible occurrence of bumps. The picture was obtained from numerical computation, based on tuned material properties from the scale model and in situ measurement of material parameters.
Figure 4:
6
Stress state in the ground after the excavation of the panel.
Conclusions
Geotechnical data, mining experience, and long-term underground observations were analyzed in an effort to better understand causes of violent failure in U.S. coal mines. There it was shown that coal bumps are influenced by the interaction WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
901
of geologic and stress conditions that govern the post failure behavior of coalmeasure rocks. Case studies provided new insight into the buildup of horizontal stresses, geometric factors that cause zones with high stress gradients, contrasts in stiffness and the mechanical properties of rock and seam, and failure of upper strata. In this paper a combination of experimental tests in scale models from physically equivalent materials provided input data for numerical models, the mechanical properties which were tuned to get a more realistic view of the real situation. The aim of the numerical model was to determine critical dislocation, which causes the critical state on the interface of the overburden and coal seam. The energy accumulated at the tip can be calculated from the numerical model after finishing the computation using the above described conditions. The decisive factors are principal strain rates. In any case, experience, numerical modeling, and engineering judgment should be used to assess the extent of yielding in mine roofs and floors; such controlled yielding may help reduce horizontal stresses and lead to less violent failures. Lack of yielding within the roof, coal, and seam promotes high bump potential where there is a high risk of a seismic event and a low factor of safety.
Figure 5:
Two types of material response in compression for varying principal strain rates.
Acknowledgements The first author has been financially supported by the Grant agency of the Czech Republic, project number 103/05/0679, and the second author was supported by the Grant agency of the Academy of the Czech Republic, project number IAA 2119402.
References [1]
Maleki, H., Jung, Y. & Hollberg, K: Case Study of Monitoring Changes in Roof Stability. Int. J. Rock Mech. Min. Sci. and Geomech. Abstr., V. 30, No. 7, 1395-1401, 1993.
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
902 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12]
Elices, M., Guinea, G.V., Gomez, J. & Planas, J. The cohesive zone model: advantages, limitations and challenges. Engineering Fracture Mechanics 69, 2002, 137-163. Haramy, K.H., & McDonnell, J.P.: Causes and Control of Coal Mine Bumps. USBM RI 9225, 35 pp, 1988 Haramy, K.Y., Magers, J.A. & McDonnell, J.P. Mining under strong roof. 7th Int. Conf. on Ground Control in Mining, Bureau of Mines, Denver, USA, 1992, 179-194. Haramy, K.Y. & Brady, B.T. A methodology to determine in situ rock mass failure. Internal report of Bureau of Mines, Denver, CO, USA, 1995. Mark, C.: Pillar Design Methods for Longwall Mining. USBM IC 9247, 52 p., 1990. Kuch, R., Lippmann, H. & Zhang, J. Simulating coal mine bumps with model material. Rockbursts and seismicity in mines, Gibowitz & Lasocki (eds.), Balkema, Rotterdam, 1997, 23-25. Babuska, I., Melenk, J.M.: The partition of unity method, Int. J. Numer. Meth. Engrg. 40 (1997) 727-758 Lin, J.S.: A mesh-based partition of unity method for discontinuity modeling, Comput. Meth. Appl. Mech. Engrg. 192 (2003) 1515-1532 Chen, G., Ohnoshi, Y., Ito, T. Development of high-order manifold method, Int. J. Numer. Meth. Engrg. 43 (1998) 685-712 Procházka, P. Application of discrete element methods to fracture mechanics of rock bursts. Engng. Fract. Mech. 2003. Dolezel, V. & Prochazka, P.: Characterization of dislocations in underground mass using coupled modeling. CMEM, Portland, Maine, USA, 2005, 333-341
WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 46, © 2007 WIT Press www.witpress.com, ISSN 1743-355X (on-line)
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
903
Author Index Abdalla I. E................................ 13 Abrahamsson L.......................... 85 Akgün Ş. .................................. 233 Alexandrov D............................. 75 Alias A..................................... 601 Alnuaimi A. S. ......................... 185 Anagnostopoulos N. ................ 655 Andreozzi A..................... 389, 411 Ansar M. .................................. 137 Argentini T. ............................. 723 Avichail-Bibi R.......................... 65 Balcius A. ................................ 457 Balestrino A............................. 819 Barraco A................................. 547 Belloli M.................................. 723 Belouchrani M. A. ................... 611 Bianco N. ................................. 411 Bielecki Z. ............... 737, 801, 809 Blazej J. ........................... 165, 171 Boran J..................................... 465 Britten A. ................................. 861 Bruno O. .................................. 819 Bugaj M. .................................. 747 Buonomo B...................... 255, 389 Butcher K. S. A.......................... 75 Caprioli M................................ 871 Černý R.... 339, 349, 357, 367, 377 Chalioris C. E. ................. 623, 633 Chambega D. J......................... 195 Chang J. ................................... 329 Char J. M. .................................. 25 Charon W................................. 589 Cheirsilp B............................... 225 Chen C.-C............................ 691 Chen Z. .................................... 137 Cheng E. .................................. 319 Chin W. J. ................................ 681 Cho E. K. ................................. 681 Cho J. R. .................................. 681 Ciaravino G.............................. 277 Ciaravino L. ............................. 277
Conley W................................. 177 Cook M. J. ................................. 13 Czarnecki W. ........................... 769 D'Alessio S. J. D...................... 425 de Juan A. ................................ 711 De Martino G........................... 307 De Paola F. .............................. 307 Deschênes C. ............................. 55 Djurić-Mijović D. .................... 117 Doležel V................................. 893 Elsäßer T.................................. 465 El-Shaarawi M. A. I................. 447 Elsoufi L. ................................. 589 Everett J. E............................... 883 Fafitis A. .................................. 557 Farshad F. ................................ 127 Favvata M. I............................. 623 Fazarinc M................................. 45 Fernandez del Rincon A. ......... 711 Fiala L...................................... 349 Fischer C.................................. 671 Foglia G. .................................. 399 Franchitti S. ............................. 215 Fraternale G. ............................ 723 Frýba L. ................................... 671 Fuks D. ...................................... 65 Fuller B.................................... 557 Furlan R. .................................. 297 Gagnon J.-M. ............................. 55 Gajewski P............................... 791 Garcia Fernandez P.................. 711 Gaudiano N.............................. 723 Gergiadis A.............................. 655 Giammatteo M. M. .................. 851 Giedraitis V. ............................ 457 Giuliano G. .............................. 215 Gjerkeš H................................... 35 Golia C..................................... 255 Goto M..................................... 205
904 Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII Gregori A................................. 851 Gylys J. .................................... 457 Han S.-Z................................... 205 Hartman S. ................................. 35 Hiwatashi T.............................. 109 H-Kittikul A............................. 225 Honner M................................. 475 Houdkova L. ............................ 465 Hrinda G. A. ............................ 243 Hsu S. H................................... 537 Hsu U. K. ................................... 25 Hsu W.-E. ................................ 569 Ibrahim A................................. 601 Jamal A. ................................... 447 Jancarek A. .............................. 165 Jerman M. ................................ 377 Kakaletsis D. J. ........................ 643 Kamaka M. .............................. 319 Karakoç C. ............................... 233 Karayannis C. G....................... 623 Kawagoishi N. ......................... 205 Kawalec A. .............................. 769 Kazakov K. ................................ 97 Kelnar J.................................... 367 Khalil K. .................................. 589 Kim B. S. ................................. 681 Kim C.-J................................... 205 Kim N. S. ................................. 701 Kim S. I.................................... 701 Kitamura M.............................. 155 Kiv A. ........................................ 65 Kobayashi S............................. 527 Köksal H. O. ............................ 233 Kołosowski W. ................ 801, 809 Komorniczak W....................... 769 Konatowski S........................... 779 Kotchergenko I. D. .................. 579 Kugler G. ................................... 45 Kuo S. Y. ................................. 537 Kwark J. W. ..................... 681, 701 Labbé O. .................................. 437
Lacasa G. ................................. 411 Lachat R................................... 589 LaHaye L. C. ........................... 127 Landi A.................................... 819 Lee J. S. ................................... 701 Leśnik Cz................................. 769 Li M. S..................................... 505 Liao C.-A................................. 691 Lin J. Y. ................................... 537 Liu C. H. .................................. 569 Long W........................................ 3 Lu J. K. .................................... 537 MacIntyre M. M. ..................... 861 Maděra J. ................................. 367 Madura H................................. 757 Manca O. ......................... 389, 399 Marini G. ................................. 307 Matsuda C................................ 319 Miadonye A. ............................ 861 Michálek P............................... 377 Mikolajczyk J. ......................... 737 Misirlioglu A. .......................... 485 Mokheimer E. M. A................. 447 Mokhtar A. A........................... 601 Munteanu M. Gh...................... 547 Muszkowski M. ....................... 801 Nardini S.................................. 399 Naso V. .................................... 411 Neves A. C............................... 147 Nulu S. C. ................................ 127 Nzali A. H................................ 195 Ohtaki S. .................................. 527 Palinek S.................................. 165 Panetta F. ................................. 723 Pavlík Z. .................................. 349 Pavlíková M..................... 349, 357 Pepper D. W. ........................... 495 Pernicová R. ............................ 357 Pieniężny A. T. ........................ 779 Pietrasiński J............................ 769 Pilevne E.................................. 485 Pina L....................................... 165
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XIII
Piotrowski Z. ........................... 791 Polat Z...................................... 233 Prichard-Schmitzberger A. ...... 829 Prochazka I. ............................. 171 Procházka P. .................... 517, 893 Pulci Doria G. .......................... 277 Ranucci A. ............................... 307 Rieke H. ................................... 127 Roizin Ya................................... 65 Rosemann N. ........................... 329 Różański G. ..................... 801, 809
905
Tamura A..................................... 3 Tansley T. L............................... 75 Taveira Pinto F. ....................... 147 Teng M. ................................... 319 Terčelj M. .................................. 45 Totani G................................... 851 Trajković M. ............................ 117 Tsutahara M................. 3, 155, 267 Turgay T. ................................. 233 Turk R........................................ 45 Tydlitát V................................. 377 Urushadze Sh........................... 671
Saanane B. B............................ 195 Sabato D. ................................. 723 Said M. R................................. 601 Sakamoto H. ............................ 109 Sancibrian R. ........................... 711 Sani L....................................... 819 Santamaria J............................. 557 Santiago-Avilés J. J. ................ 297 Šarler B. ..................................... 35 Sasaki H................................... 155 Scarlatos P. D. ......................... 137 Sędek E. ........................... 801, 809 Sideris K. K. ............................ 655 Sinkunas S. .............................. 457 Smirnov S. A. .......................... 287 Söder L. ..................................... 85 Sotero-Esteva J. O. .................. 297 Sroub J. .................................... 475 Stehlik P................................... 465 Strisciuglio G. .......................... 871 Tajiri S. ................................ 3, 267 Tamas M. ................................. 165
Vanali M.................................. 723 Veloso Gomes F. ..................... 147 Vertnik R. .................................. 35 Vesely Z................................... 475 Viadero F. ................................ 711 Vrba P...................................... 165 Vrbova M................................. 165 Wang X.................................... 495 Wnuk M........................... 747, 801 Wojtas J. .................................. 809 Wu W.-H. ................................ 691 Yamaguchi T. .......................... 109 Yamamoto M........................... 109 Yamamoto T. ........................... 527 Yang B..................................... 505 Yeo I. H. .................................. 701 Zappalà G. ............................... 841 Zdankus T................................ 457 Zoaeter M. ............................... 589
This page intentionally left blank
...for scientists by scientists
Computational The Wonderful World Methods and Experimental of Simon Stevin Edited by: J.T. DEVREESE, University of Measurements XII Antwerp, Belgium and G. VANDEN Magic is No Magic:
BERGHE, University of Ghent, Belgium This book gives a comprehensive picture of the activities and the creative heritage of Simon Stevin, who made outstanding contributions to various fields of science in particular, physics and mathematics and many more. Among the striking spectrum of his ingenious achievements, it is worth emphasizing, that Simon Stevin is rightly considered as the father of the system of decimal fractions as it is in use today. Stevin also urged the universal use of decimal fractions along with standardization in coinage, measures and weights.Stevin was the first since Archimedes to make a significant new contribution to statics and hydrostatics. The impact of the Stevin’s works has been multilateral and worldwide, including literature (William Shakespeare), science (from Christian Huygens to Richard Feynman), politics (Thomas Jefferson) and many other fields. Thomas Jefferson, together with Alexander Hamilton and Robert Morris, advocated introducing the decimal monetary units in the USA with reference to the book “De Thiende” by S. Stevin and in particular to the English translation of the book: “Disme: The Art of Tenths” by Robert Norton. In accordance with the title of this translation, the name of the first silver coin issued in the USA in 1792 was ‘disme’ (since 1837 the spelling changed to (‘dime’). It was considered as a symbol of national independence of the USA. ISBN: 978-1-84564-092-7 2007 apx 343pp apx £90.00/US$145.00/€135.00
Edited by: C.A. BREBBIA, Wessex Institute of Technology, UK and G.M. CARLOMAGNO, University of Naples di Napoli, Italy This volume contains the papers presented at the 12th International Conference on Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements (CMEM) held in Malta in 2005. These biannual conferences provide a forum to review the latest work on the interaction between computational methods and experimental measurements. New types of experiments allowing for more reliable interpretation of physical systems, result in a better virtual representation of reality. Experimental results are themselves increasingly dependent on specialised computer codes. It is only through the harmonious progressive development of the experimental and computational fields that engineering sciences will be able to progress. This volume contains over 80 papers grouped in the following sections. Computational and Analytical Methods; Experimental and Computational Analysis; Direct, indirect and In-Situ Measurements; Particle Methods; Structural and Stress Analysis; Structural Dynamics; Dynamics and Vibrations; Electrical and Electromagnetic Applications; Bioengineering Applications; Heat Transfer; Thermal Processes and Fluid Flow. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 41 ISBN: 1-84564-020-9 2005 944pp £330.00/US$528.00/€495.00 Find us at http://www.witpress.com
...for scientists by scientists
Elastic and Elastoplastic Contact Analysis
New Solutions in Contact Mechanics
Using Boundary Elements and Mathematical Programming
The result of around 20 years of research by the author, this book features some previously unpublished solutions that will be useful for scientific investigation and mechanical design. A boundary element algorithm for contact with friction is discussed and a demonstration version with 800 contact points is included on an accompanying CD-ROM. All of the chapters are more or less self-contained, while the derivations used are suitable for undergraduate students. Readers will also find new information which may aid further developments in this field. Contents: Introduction; Summary of the Basic Equations; Solutions for Plane Contact; Solutions for Axi-Symmetric Profiles; General Contact and Comparison with FEM and BEM Programs; Computation of Contact Problems; Gauss-Seidel Method for Frictional Contact Problems; Numerical Results for Incremental Load-Histories; Basic Equations and Solutions for Impact; Tangential and Torsional Impact of Spheres; Numerical Results for Impact; Applications.
A. FARAJI, University of Tehran, Iran This book presents a general elastic and elastoplastic analysis method for the treatment of two- and three-dimensional contact problems between two deformable bodies undergoing small displacements with and without friction. The author’s approach uses the Boundary Element Method (BEM) and Mathematical Programming (MP). This is applied to the contacting bodies pressed together by a normal force which is sufficient to expand the size of the contact area, mainly through plastic deformation, acted on subsequently by a tangential force less than that necessary to cause overall sliding. The formulated method described in this book is straightforward and applicable to practical engineering problems. Series: Topics in Engineering, Vol 45 ISBN: 1-85312-733-7 2005 144pp £48.00/US$86.00/€72.00
WIT eLibrary Home of the Transactions of the Wessex Institute, the WIT electronic-library provides the international scientific community with immediate and permanent access to individual papers presented at WIT conferences. Visitors to the WIT eLibrary can freely browse and search abstracts of all papers in the collection before progressing to download their full text. Visit the WIT eLibrary at http://library.witpress.com
J. JÄGER, Lauterbach Verfahrenstechnik, Germany
ISBN: 1-85312-994-1 2004 328pp+CD-ROM £119.00/US$190.00/€178.50
WITPress Ashurst Lodge, Ashurst, Southampton, SO40 7AA, UK. Tel: 44 (0) 238 029 3223 Fax: 44 (0) 238 029 2853 E-Mail: [email protected]
...for scientists by scientists
Computational Methods in Contact Mechanics VI Edited by: C.A. BREBBIA, Wessex Institute of Technology, UK Including discussions of mechanical models, numerical aspects, experimental measurements and engineering applications, this volume features the proceedings of the Sixth International Conference on Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements in Contact Mechanics. WIT Transactions on Engineering Sciences, Vol 38 ISBN: 1-85312-963-1 2003 232pp £89.00/US$142.00/€133.50
Computational Methods and Experimental Measurements XI Edited by: C.A. BREBBIA, Wessex Institute of Technology, UK, G.M. CARLOMAGNO, University of Naples, Italy and P. ANAGNOSTOPOULOS, University of Thessaloniki, Greece This book consists of over 70 papers from the eleventh international conference on this subject. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 33 ISBN: 1-85312-969-0 2003 776pp £232.00/US$371.00/€348.00
All prices correct at time of going to press but subject to change. WIT Press books are available through your bookseller or direct from the publisher.
Applied Numerical Analysis M. RAHMAN, Dalhousie University, Canada This book presents a clear and well-organised treatment of the concepts behind the development of mathematics and numerical techniques. The central topic is numerical methods and the calculus of variations to physical problems. Based on the author’s course taught at many universities around the world, the text is primarily intended for undergraduates in electrical, mechanical, chemical and civil engineering, physics, applied mathematics and computer science. Many sections are also directly relevant to graduate students in the mathematical and physical sciences. More than 100 solved problems and approximately 120 exercises are also featured. ISBN: 1-85312-891-0 2004 408pp+CD-ROM £149.00/US$238.00/€223.50
Moving Boundaries VII Computational Modelling of Free and Moving Boundary Problems Edited by: A.A. MAMMOLI, University of New Mexico, USA and C.A. BREBBIA, Wessex Institute of Technology, UK Features papers presented at the seventh international conference on this topic. WIT Transactions on Modelling and Simulation, Vol 36 ISBN: 1-85312-987-9 2004 392pp £129.00/US$206.00/€193.50 Find us at http://www.witpress.com
...for scientists by scientists
Mathematical Methods with Applications M. RAHMAN, Dalhousie University, Canada “This well-thought-out masterpiece has come from an author with considerable experience in teaching mathematical methods in many universities all over the world. His text will certainly appeal to a broader audience, including upper-level undergraduates and graduate students in engineering, mathematics, computer science, and the physical sciences. A fantastic addition to all college libraries.” CHOICE
Chosen by Choice as an “Outstanding Academic Title”, this book is a clear and well-organized description of the mathematical methods required for solving physical problems. The author focuses in particular on differential equations applied to physical problems. Many practical examples are used and an accompanying CD-ROM features exercises, selected answers and an appendix with short tables of Z-transforms, Fourier, Hankel and Laplace transforms. ISBN: 1-85312-847-3 2000 456pp + CD-ROM £175.00/US$269.00/€262.50
Introduction to Regression Analysis M.A. GOLBERG, Las Vegas, Nevada, USA and H.A. CHO, University of Nevada, USA In order to apply regression analysis effectively, it is necessary to understand both the underlying theory and its practical application. This book explores conventional topics as well as recent practical
developments, linking theory with application. Intended to continue from where most basic statistics texts end, it is designed primarily for advanced undergraduates, graduate students and researchers in various fields of engineering, chemical and physical sciences, mathematical sciences and statistics. Contents: Some Basic Results in Probability and Statistics; Simple Linear Regression; Random Vectors and Matrix Algebra; Multiple Regression; Residuals, Diagnostics and Transformations; Further Applications of Regression Techniques; Selection of a Regression Model; Multicollinearity: Diagnosis and Remedies; Appendix. ISBN: 1-85312-624-1 2004 452pp £122.00/US$195.00/€183.00
Introduction to Multi-Disciplinary Model-Building H.G. NATKE, Curt-Risch-Institute, Germany “.…a stimulating overview.”
MEASUREMENT + CONTROL
Designed for use by scientists and practitioners in a wide range of disciplines, this title highlights the advantages of model-building based on systems theory. It includes hints, methods and tools for obtaining reliable mathematical models and avoiding pitfalls ISBN: 1-85312-954-2 2002 396pp £119.00/US$184.00/€178.50 We are now able to supply you with details of new WIT Press titles via E-Mail. To subscribe to this free service, or for information on any of our titles, please contact the Marketing Department, WIT Press, Ashurst Lodge, Ashurst, Southampton, SO40 7AA, UK Tel: +44 (0) 238 029 3223 Fax: +44 (0) 238 029 2853 E-mail: [email protected]